summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--34864-8.txt9589
-rw-r--r--34864-8.zipbin0 -> 177147 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h.zipbin0 -> 420760 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/34864-h.htm13825
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/coverpage.jpgbin0 -> 40266 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/emblem.pngbin0 -> 10530 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/illus002.jpgbin0 -> 47693 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/illus097.jpgbin0 -> 47215 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/illus163.jpgbin0 -> 35402 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864-h/images/illus399.jpgbin0 -> 47566 bytes
-rw-r--r--34864.txt9589
-rw-r--r--34864.zipbin0 -> 177129 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
15 files changed, 33019 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/34864-8.txt b/34864-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..74293e2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,9589 @@
+Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: The Boys of Old Monmouth
+ A Story of Washington's Campaign in New Jersey in 1778
+
+Author: Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+Release Date: January 6, 2011 [EBook #34864]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: "WHAT ABOUT THE BOY?" (page 13)]
+
+
+
+
+
+THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH
+
+A Story of Washington's Campaign in New Jersey in 1778
+
+BY EVERETT T. TOMLINSON
+
+_Author of "Washington's Young Aids," "Guarding the Border," "The Boys
+with Old Hickory," "Ward Hill at Weston," etc., etc._
+
+[Illustration: The Riverside Press]
+
+BOSTON AND NEW YORK HOUGHTON MIFFLIN COMPANY The Riverside Press,
+Cambridge
+
+
+
+
+ COPYRIGHT, 1898, BY EVERETT T. TOMLINSON
+ ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+ I. OLD MONMOUTH 1
+ II. TOM INVESTIGATES 15
+ III. THE MEETING ON THE RIVER 27
+ IV. BENZEOR'S VISITOR 40
+ V. THE MESSENGER 53
+ VI. IN THE TEN-ACRE LOT 67
+ VII. THE PARTING OF THE WAYS 82
+ VIII. INDIAN JOHN 96
+ IX. THE YOUNG LIEUTENANT 112
+ X. THE STORY OF THE MISCHIANZA 126
+ XI. TO REFUGEE TOWN 141
+ XII. BATHSHEBA'S FEAST 156
+ XIII. WITH THE REDCOATS 169
+ XIV. THE WAY TO CRANBERRY 182
+ XV. THE BOAT ON THE BAR 195
+ XVI. TED WILSON'S VICTIM 208
+ XVII. A FRUITLESS CHASE 221
+ XVIII. A RARE BEAST 233
+ XIX. THE RELEASE OF BENZEOR 246
+ XX. THE FLEET OF BARGES 259
+ XXI. THE RIDE WITH THE LIEUTENANT 272
+ XXII. A SOLDIER WOMAN 286
+ XXIII. AN INTERRUPTED JOURNEY 298
+ XXIV. THE ABODE OF INDIAN JOHN 310
+ XXV. THE BEGINNING OF THE GREAT FIGHT 323
+ XXVI. THE BATTLE OF MONMOUTH 336
+ XXVII. THE RETURN TO BENZEOR'S HOUSE 349
+ XXVIII. THE RIDE TO THE MILL 364
+ XXIX. AFTER THE BATTLE 377
+ XXX. TOM COWARD'S PATIENT 390
+ XXXI. AMONG THE PINES 403
+ XXXII. CONCLUSION 416
+
+
+
+
+THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+OLD MONMOUTH
+
+
+OLD Monmouth is an expression dear to the heart of every native-born
+Jerseyman. The occasional visitor seeking health among its whispering
+pines, or relaxation in the sultry summer days along its shore, where
+the roll of the breakers and the boundless sweep of the ocean combine to
+form one of the most sublime marine views on all the Atlantic seaboard,
+may admire the fertile farmlands and prosperous villages as much as the
+man to the manor born, but he never speaks of "Old" Monmouth.
+
+Nor will he fully understand what the purebred Jerseyman means when he
+uses the term, for to the stranger the word will smack of length of
+days, and of the venerable position which Monmouth holds among the
+counties of the State.
+
+Monmouth is old, it is true, and was among the first of the portions of
+New Jersey to be settled by the Woapsiel Lennape, the name which the
+Indians first gave to the white people from across the sea, or by the
+Schwonnack,--"the salt people,"--as the Delawares afterwards called
+them. But the true Jerseyman is not thinking alone of the age of
+Monmouth when he uses the word "Old." To him it is a term of affection
+also, used it may be as schoolboys or college mates use it when they
+address one another as "old fellow," though but a few years may have
+passed over their heads.
+
+The new-comer or the stranger may speak of Fair Monmouth, and think he
+is giving all the honor due to the beautiful region, but his failure to
+use the proper adjective will at once betray his foreign birth and his
+ignorance of the position which the county holds in the affections of
+all true Jerseymen.
+
+Still, Monmouth is old in the sense in which the summer visitor uses the
+word. Here and there in the county an antiquated house is standing
+to-day, which if it were endowed with the power of speech could tell of
+stirring sights it had seen more than a century ago. Redcoats, fleeing
+from the wrath of the angry Washington and his Jersey Blues, marched
+swiftly past on their way to the Highlands and the refuge of New York.
+Fierce contests between neighbors, who had taken opposite sides in the
+struggle of the colonies for freedom from the yoke of the mother
+country, or step-mother country, as some not inappropriately termed her
+in these days, occurred in the presence of these ancient
+dwelling-places, and sometimes within their very walls. Many, too, would
+be the stories of the deeds of tories, and refugees, and pine robbers
+contending with stanch and sturdy whigs. Up the many winding streams,
+boat-loads of sailors made their way from the gunboat or privateer
+anchored off the shore, to burn the salt works of the hardy pioneers, or
+lay waste their lands as they searched for plunder or for forage.
+
+The forked trees along the shore, in whose branches the lookouts were
+concealed as they swept the ocean for miles watching for the appearance
+of the hostile boat, were standing until recent years. In their last
+days broken, it is true, and almost destroyed by the winter storms and
+their weight of long years, still they stood as the few remaining tokens
+of that century when our fathers contended for "their lives, their
+fortunes, and their sacred honor." At last the pathos and weakness of
+old age prevailed, and to-day there remains scarcely a vestige of those
+ancient landmarks.
+
+Perhaps if the boys and girls of New Jersey had been as mindful of those
+old trees as the Cambridge lads and lassies have been of the spreading
+elm beneath whose branches the noble-hearted Washington assumed the
+command of the little American army, some of them might still be
+standing; but as it is, the most of them have crumbled and fallen and
+disappeared as completely as have the men who sought the shelter of
+their branches in the trying times of '78.
+
+So, too, for many years stood the famous tree from whose limbs the noble
+patriot, Captain Huddy, was hanged,--as dastardly a deed as was
+committed by either side in that struggle which tried the souls of our
+fathers. But the trees are gone, and only a few quaint houses and
+venerable landmarks and heirlooms remain of those things which witnessed
+the contests, and deeds high or base, of that far-away time.
+
+The lofty monument on the old battle-ground of Monmouth is surmounted by
+the figure of a man whose face is shaded by his hand, as if he were
+still striving to obtain a glimpse of the redcoats in the darkness as
+they hastened to gain the Highlands and the refuge of the waiting boats
+which were to bear them away to the safety of the great city. But it is
+itself essentially modern, and only in its brief records, carved by
+patriotic hands upon its sides, and in its figure of the granite soldier
+standing upon its summit, does its suggestiveness lie. It looks down
+upon a thriving village and out upon the lands of thrifty and prosperous
+farmers, and there is nothing in all the vision to remind one that the
+soil was ever stained by the blood of soldiers clad in uniforms of
+scarlet, or of buff and blue.
+
+And yet, as fierce a struggle as our country ever knew occurred within
+the region. Women toiled in the fields while their husbands and sons
+fought, or even gave up their lives to drive away their oppressors. Yes,
+even in the battles some of the women found places, and Captain Molly
+Pitcher was only one among many who had a share in the actual struggle
+of the Revolution. Houses were doubly barred at night against the
+attacks of prowling bands of refugees or pine robbers, and many times
+were defended by the patriotic women themselves. Spies crept in among
+them, and evil men who owned no allegiance to either side seized the
+opportunity to prey alike upon friend and foe. At times it almost seemed
+as if the words spoken many centuries ago were then fulfilled, and that
+"a man was set at variance against his father, and the daughter against
+her mother, and the daughter-in-law against her mother-in-law, and that
+a man's foes were they of his own household."
+
+But with all the suffering and bloodshed there were many heroes and
+heroines, and even the boys and girls were not without a share in the
+struggles of the times which tried men's souls. The houses in which they
+dwelt may have disappeared and given place to far more imposing
+structures; their very names may no longer be recalled; but, after all,
+they displayed many qualities which the world ought not willingly to
+permit to die, and the heritage which they have bequeathed to us will
+lose nothing of its value if we go back in our thoughts and strive to
+comprehend more clearly the price which our fathers paid for the land we
+love.
+
+In the early summer of 1778, while the feelings of the Monmouth people
+had been deeply stirred,--and indeed the patriots of the county had
+been among the foremost to pass resolutions and be enrolled among the
+defenders of the new nation,--there had not as yet come the intense
+excitement which followed the advance of General Clinton's army from
+Philadelphia. The long winter at Valley Forge had at last come to an
+end, and when the British moved out from the city,--for holding it
+longer seemed to be useless,--Washington had led his troops into the
+town almost as soon as the enemy departed. Nor was that all, for he
+quickly decided to follow after the departing general, and overtake and
+give him battle before Clinton could lead his men across the Jerseys.
+
+The American commander knew that his own forces numbered nearly as many
+as those the British general had; and as, in spite of the dreadful
+sufferings of the winter, his men were in far better condition than they
+had ever been before,--thanks to the tireless energy of Baron
+Steuben,--he resolved to depart from Philadelphia and follow after the
+British.
+
+Clinton had sent the recently enrolled tories to New York by water, and
+as there were some three thousand of these alone, he soon decided that
+his troops must go by land.
+
+Accordingly, the journey was begun, but the Continentals, going a little
+farther to the north than the line of Clinton's march, planned to gain a
+position in advance of the enemy by the rapidity of their movements, and
+then, turning about in their course, fall upon the redcoats face to face
+and offer them battle in some advantageous place.
+
+The baggage wagons of Clinton stretched out in a long line of twelve
+miles as they followed after the army, and in other ways the British
+leader was somewhat embarrassed. Consequently, when he learned of
+Washington's plan, he quickly decided to change the direction of his
+march, and, by passing through "Old Monmouth," lead his army to the
+Navesink Highlands and there have them all embark for New York.
+
+Washington had first offered the command of his advance forces to young
+Lafayette, but he was somewhat perplexed by the return of General Lee to
+his army, and knew not just what to do.
+
+Lee had been captured a little more than a year before this time,
+through his own carelessness, near Morristown, and we may be sure that
+Washington was not greatly troubled by the loss. Lee had steadily
+opposed him, and was plotting to secure his position for himself.
+However, the British general Prescott, whose capture by the Americans
+had been effected in a manner not unlike that in which Lee himself had
+been taken, had been exchanged, and Lee once more returned to the
+American army.
+
+He was still the same Lee, sensitive, jealous, and suspected of being in
+league with Howe, who recently had sailed away for England to explain to
+Parliament the causes of his failures in the preceding year.
+
+Much as he disliked to make the change, Lee's return compelled
+Washington to recognize his presence, and after some tactful efforts he
+removed Lafayette and gave Lee his position as leader of the advanced
+forces. Lee had bitterly opposed the project of following Clinton, and
+steadily objected to the march across the Jerseys.
+
+Washington, however, was firm in his determination, and the march was
+soon begun; but the lack of confidence which he felt in General Lee must
+have sadly increased the troubles of the great commander, already beset
+by perils of so many kinds. Whether he was mistaken in his estimate of
+the man, we shall learn in the course of this story.
+
+Such then was the general condition of affairs as the summer of 1778
+drew on. Those of the people of Old Monmouth who were at home heard
+occasional rumors of the advance of the two armies, but few of them had
+any thought of the stirring scenes which were to be enacted in their
+midst before the summer was ended.
+
+It was now late in June. The summer had been unusually warm, and the men
+and boys, as well as the women, who were at home had labored busily in
+the fields, in the hope of an early as well as an abundant harvest. For
+those who cared to avail themselves of them, the markets in New York
+provided a ready place for the sale of their produce, and not only the
+tories, but some of the men whose sympathies as yet had not led them
+openly to declare their preferences for either side, or who perhaps
+cared more for the prices they were likely to receive in New York for
+the results of their labors than they did for liberty or any such
+abstract quality, were not averse to loading up the boats, which many of
+the farmers near the shore owned, and sailing away for the city.
+
+Down the lower bay one such boat was swiftly making its way one
+afternoon in June, 1778. On board were four men, three of whom
+evidently were in middle life, but the fourth was a sturdy lad about
+seventeen years of age, and it was plain that he was not in full
+sympathy with his companions. He took but little part in the
+conversation, and the expression upon his face frequently betrayed the
+feelings in his heart. The three men with him apparently did not give
+him much thought or attention, and evidently were too well satisfied
+with the results of their expedition to waste any time in questioning
+the lad as to the cause of his silence.
+
+"There's the old tree now," said one of the men as they came within
+sight of the landmark. "If nothing has gone wrong, we'll soon be in the
+Navesink."
+
+"Yes, and back at work again," grumbled another. "For my part I think
+Fenton and Davenport and the rest of the pine robbers have the easiest
+time of all. They swoop down upon some whig farmer, and all they have to
+do is to take what he has worked out. I don't see why it isn't all fair
+enough in war."
+
+"If it wasn't for that skull of Fagan, with that pipe stuck in its
+mouth, nailed up on the tree over there beyond the Court House, I'd go
+in myself," said the first speaker. "The grin on it is almost more than
+I can bear."
+
+"That'll do to frighten women and children with," said the third man,
+who had been silent for a time. "Fagan got a little too bold, that was
+the trouble with him. He carried it a little too far. I happen to know
+that there are some men who know enough to put a finger in, and not get
+it burned either."
+
+"Perhaps you've done a little yourself in that line, Benzeor Osburn?"
+queried the last speaker. "I've thought sometimes you could tell some
+tales if you wanted to."
+
+"And who knows but I might?" replied Benzeor. "I may be able to keep my
+place from being confiscated and sold, the way my brother's was two
+years ago, but that may not mean either that I don't know what's to my
+own advantage when I see it. You'd do the same, wouldn't you, Jacob
+Vannote?"
+
+"That I would," replied Jacob, "and so would Barzilla Giberson here,
+too. All we want is that some good man like you, Benzeor, should tell us
+how to do it."
+
+"I can tell you," said Benzeor quietly. "I've made up my mind that I've
+held off just as long as I am going to. I'm going in, and if you have a
+mind to join, I'll let you in, too."
+
+"Tell us about it," said Jacob eagerly. "What about the boy?" he added
+in a low voice, glancing toward the fourth member of the party as he
+spoke.
+
+"What? Tom Coward? He's a coward by name as well as by nature. You
+haven't anything to fear from him. He's been in my home since he was
+five year old. He won't make any trouble."
+
+Nevertheless, the speaker lowered his voice, and for a long time the
+trio conversed eagerly upon the new topic. So intent were they that not
+one of them noted the flush upon the lad's face at the brutal reference
+to him, nor saw the look of determination which came a little later in
+its place.
+
+Apparently Tom was not giving any attention to the men with him in the
+swift sailing boat. He retained his seat near the bow, and seemed to be
+interested only in the waves before him. A brisk wind was blowing, and
+the waters betrayed the tokens of a coming storm.
+
+The boat was pitching more and more as it sped on, and Tom watched the
+rolling waves, many of them capped with white and rising steadily
+higher and higher. The darker hues gave place to a lighter green as they
+rose, and the increasing roughness seemed to reflect somewhat the
+feelings in his own heart.
+
+Far away in the distance stretched the long sandy beach of the Hook,
+becoming more and more distinct as the boat drew nearer. The gulls were
+flying low, and the weird cries of the sea-birds were heard on every
+side.
+
+Suddenly Tom stood upright, and, after gazing intently for a moment at
+some object on the shore, turned to his companions and said,--
+
+"Some one's up in the tree, and the signal's out, too."
+
+The men instantly ceased from their conversation, and peered intently at
+the tree in the distance.
+
+Evidently the sight was not altogether pleasing, for with an exclamation
+of anger Benzeor Osburn, who was holding the tiller, quickly changed the
+course of the boat, and started back in the direction from which they
+had come.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+TOM INVESTIGATES
+
+
+THERE were many exclamations of impatience heard in the boat as Benzeor
+changed her course, and the helmsman himself appeared to be the most
+impatient of all. A drizzling rain was now falling and there were many
+signs apparent that a stormy night was approaching.
+
+"I wish I knew just what the warning was for," muttered Benzeor. "Fine
+night this, to be prowling around the bay in!"
+
+"There was no mistake about the sign, though," replied Jacob. "There's
+something wrong, or we shouldn't have seen the white flag. That means
+there's something going on up the Navesink."
+
+"All the more reason for going home then!" said Benzeor. "Who was on the
+lookout to-day? Does any one know?"
+
+"Yes, 't was Peter Van Mater," said Tom, who up to this time had taken
+no part in the conversation. "He told me yesterday that he was to be in
+the tree to-day."
+
+"What! Little Peter?" demanded Benzeor quickly.
+
+"Yes," replied Tom. "I saw him out by their cornfield yesterday. He was
+there driving away the crows and blackbirds."
+
+"Little" Peter was so called to distinguish him from his father who bore
+the same name; and although his son, a well-grown young fellow of
+eighteen, towered more than a half head above "Big" Peter now, the
+distinctive names given several years before this time still clung to
+them both.
+
+The Van Mater place joined the Osburn farm, and for years Tom and Little
+Peter had been the best of friends. On those rare occasions when a brief
+break in the arduous labors on the farms had come, together they had
+gone crabbing, or had sailed down to Barnegat, where the sea-fowl
+gathered in great flocks when the proper seasons came.
+
+Tom's heart had gone out to Little Peter as it had not to any other
+person. Peter's round face shone with an expression of good nature which
+nothing but the mention of a tory or a pine robber seemed to be able to
+ruffle. A reference to either of them never failed to arouse the dormant
+anger of the lad, and with all the intensity of his quiet and strong
+nature he hated both. For the Van Maters, even to the mother and the
+girls, were patriots of the strongest kind, and now Big Peter was away
+in Washington's army and had left his eldest son and namesake to protect
+the family and manage the farm in his absence.
+
+And Little Peter had accepted the task with an outward assent that
+deceived even his own father. Only to Tom had he mentioned his true
+feelings, and expressed his determination to buy up his time, so that
+he, too, might be enrolled in the patriot army.
+
+Tom Coward well knew that the words expressed Little Peter's feelings
+and desires rather than his purpose, for he was satisfied that nothing
+would induce his friend to desert his mother and the children in their
+time of need. But he had fully sympathized with Peter in his desire to
+buy up his time, and there were special reasons why the words meant much
+more to him than they did to his friend.
+
+About a decade before this time, when one of the numerous "September
+gales" was raging along the Jersey shore, a great crowd had assembled on
+the beach watching the efforts of a schooner they could see, about a
+mile out on the ocean, to weather the storm. All day long the crowd had
+remained there, powerless to aid the stricken people on board the
+storm-tossed boat, for this was long before the time of the life-saving
+crews and their noble work along the coast.
+
+Late in the afternoon on that eventful day, when the storm had abated
+somewhat, although the waves, like moving mountains of water, still came
+thundering in upon the beach, a boat had been manned and started forth
+to the aid of the people in their peril; but before the brave band could
+gain the schooner, she had foundered and gone to the bottom.
+
+The men who had gone forth to the rescue had been about to return to the
+shore, when they thought they saw something floating over the boisterous
+waves toward them. When a second glance was obtained they started
+swiftly toward the object, and, as they drew near, saw a huge cotton
+bale with a woman and a little lad strapped upon it. At last, after some
+desperate efforts, the bodies were rescued, but that of the woman was
+lifeless and that of the lad was nearly so.
+
+The rough men had brought both ashore, and, after some labor on the part
+of the women in the assembly, the lad had been restored, but the woman
+was beyond all earthly aid. Upon some of the clothing of the rescued boy
+the name Coward had been found, and "Tom" was improvised, for that would
+do as well as any other for the name of a stranger lad whose home and
+parents were to be, as the people of Old Monmouth thought, forever
+wrapped in mystery.
+
+Tom Coward had been the sole survivor of the wreck. For days some
+portions of the ill-fated schooner and its cargo were washed ashore, but
+no clue was ever found as to her name or destination.
+
+What to do with the rescued lad then became the perplexing problem among
+the simple folk of Monmouth, and it was at last solved by "binding him
+out" to Benzeor Osburn, which simply meant that Tom was to live with the
+man who had taken him until he was twenty-one years of age, and in
+return for the home he received he was to give his labor and life until
+that eventful day should arrive when he, too, would become a man.
+
+The lad had gone, for he had no voice in the matter, and all the home he
+had ever known had been with Benzeor and his family. Only a faint
+recollection of the wreck remained in his mind, but he had heard the
+story many times and thought much over it in secret. Often had he
+visited the unmarked grave in the churchyard, where he was informed that
+all that was mortal of his mother lay resting. But her name and face
+were both alike unknown to him. In his dreams, or when he had been
+working alone in some of the distant fields, it would almost seem to him
+that something of another existence would rise before him, or that he
+could almost see the face of a gracious woman bending low over him whom
+he could call "mother."
+
+Who he might be he could not determine. Who he was, was a matter much
+more easily settled, for all knew him as the "bound boy" of Benzeor
+Osburn; and while some of the country people might occasionally think of
+him as the little lad, who years before had been rescued from a sinking
+schooner, they seldom referred to it, and the past had been crowded out
+by the present. But Tom Coward had not entirely forgotten.
+
+Benzeor had received him into his home the more readily because, as he
+expressed it, "all of his boys had been born girls," and he felt the
+need of the aid and presence of a boy about the place. And Benzeor in
+his way had not been unkind to the stranger lad, or at least not
+intentionally so, but the labor on the farms in those days had been
+severe, and he was a man to whom money had been the one thing needful.
+He did not spare himself, and certainly he had no thought of sparing
+those who were dependent upon him; and, as a natural consequence,
+neither the girls nor Tom, and much less the overworked, spiritless
+little mother of the family, found much to relieve the monotonous round
+of labor on the farm.
+
+At first, Tom had not complained and had accepted all as a matter of
+course, but of late his heart had rebelled against his lot more and
+more. It was not that he did not appreciate the rough kindness which was
+extended to him, especially by the patient, uncomplaining mother and the
+two girls, Sarah and Mercy, who were nearest his own age. But certain
+undefined longings kept rising in his soul, he knew not how, and the
+increasing eagerness of Benzeor "to make his place pay" had apparently
+driven all else from the mind of his foster father.
+
+Perhaps more than any of these things, his interviews with his friend
+Little Peter had stirred his soul, for Peter had longings, too, and, as
+has been said, had even declared his intention "to buy up his own time."
+That he was a son in his own home, and was surrounded by the love of
+father and mother, had not made the purpose in Peter's heart appear in
+the least strange or unusual, for the custom was not unknown among those
+sturdy forefathers of ours. When they had cared for a boy in his infancy
+and helpless years, it was considered as no more than a just return that
+the years of early manhood, which would naturally be of value to the
+fathers in their labors on the farms, should belong not to the son but
+to the father. So whenever a well-grown boy felt that he would like to
+start in for himself, it was not unusual for him to offer, or to promise
+to pay as soon as he could earn the money, the amount which was
+considered as a fair equivalent for the value of his services in the few
+years before he became "of age," and could enter upon his own career.
+
+In those days the obligation of the child to his father was emphasized.
+In our own time the obligation of the father to his child is considered
+the more important, and all that love and devotion can offer are laid at
+the feet of the children.
+
+Perhaps justice lies somewhere between these two extremes, and no one of
+us desires to return to the harsher methods of those earlier years; but
+certainly the children who are so fortunate as to be born in these more
+fortunate times have some need of recalling the words of one who, long
+before the trying days of the Revolution, exhorted all to "honor their
+fathers and mothers."
+
+Be that as it may, Tom Coward thought much and long over his friend
+Peter's project, and even went so far at one time as to hint to Benzeor
+that he would not be averse to entering into some such arrangement with
+him. But Benzeor's indignation, and the grief with which Sarah heard of
+the proposal, had silenced him, and he had not referred to the matter
+again.
+
+None the less, however, did it remain in his thoughts, and of late the
+suspicion with which he had come to regard many of Benzeor's actions had
+increased his feeling of discontent, for Tom's sympathies were all with
+the colonies in their struggle.
+
+Many a time had he and Peter talked over the matter, and the eagerness
+of one to serve in the army was fully shared by the other. But Benzeor's
+patriotism seemed all to be dormant, and as the troubles increased, his
+zeal to make money steadily increased also. At times he would be absent
+from home for days together, and more than once Tom had been awakened
+in the night by the sound of strange voices heard in conversation with
+Benzeor in the room beneath that in which he was sleeping.
+
+Thoughts of all these things had been in Tom's mind throughout that
+voyage to New York, and they, as well as his youthfulness, served to
+explain the silence he had maintained since he had set sail. He had
+known, however, that Peter was to serve as the lookout that day, and
+when he volunteered the information it was the first time he had spoken
+aloud for a half hour.
+
+The rain now was steadily increasing, and the uneasiness of the men on
+board the little boat became more marked. They were far from the tree by
+this time, and no one appeared to know just what plan to follow.
+
+"If I was alone, I'd take all the risks," said Benzeor at last.
+
+"You needn't stop on our account," replied Jacob. "I don't believe
+there's much danger in starting up the river, any way, for my part.
+Little Peter may not have seen anything to amount to much. If you want
+to chance it, go ahead."
+
+"We don't just know what's ahead of us," said Barzilla uneasily. "It
+may be nothing, and then again it may not be. I wish there was some way
+of finding out before we risk too much."
+
+"Why not land farther down the shore and let Tom go up and see?" said
+Jacob. "If Little Peter's gone, it will mean the danger's gone, too, and
+if he hasn't, why Tom here can find out for us and report; though for my
+part I'm not afraid to go up the river as it is. It's too dark for any
+one to see us, or it will be soon."
+
+"That's a good suggestion," said Benzeor quickly, as he brought the boat
+about. "We'll land down the shore and let Tom go up for us. You're not
+too much of a 'coward' to do that, are you Tom?"
+
+"I'll go," said Tom quietly, although his cheeks flushed with anger at
+Benzeor's antiquated and brutal pun. He had heard it many times, but
+never without feeling angry, although he well knew that Benzeor spoke
+the words lightly.
+
+With the change in the course the wind seemed to increase. The spray was
+dashed into their faces, and the men were soon drenched. The sail had
+been shortened, but the little boat dashed ahead with ever increasing
+speed.
+
+"It's a rough night outside," said Benzeor, when at last he gained the
+desired point on the shore. "It's lucky for us we're inside the Hook.
+Now then, Tom!" he added. "Bestir yourself, lad, and come back soon."
+
+Tom leaped ashore and ran swiftly along the beach toward the tree. He
+was familiar with its location and knew that he could find it in the
+darkest night. The rain beat upon him and the darkness momentarily
+increased, but the wind was with him, and in a brief time he recognized
+the dim outlines of the tree.
+
+Then ceasing to run, he began to approach more cautiously. He was not
+positive that Peter was there now, for some one might have taken his
+place. Certainly caution was the better part in any event.
+
+He stopped and whistled the half dozen notes which he and Peter used as
+a call. He waited a moment, but as no answer was heard he advanced a
+little nearer and whistled again.
+
+"That you, Tom?" came from some one in the tree.
+
+"Yes," replied Tom.
+
+In a moment Peter dropped from his position, and began to explain to his
+friend the cause of the display of the signal of danger.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+THE MEETING ON THE RIVER
+
+
+"I'VE been here since noon," began Peter, "but it seems more like a
+whole day to me. I've listened to the calls of the sea-birds and heard
+the roar of the storm which I knew was coming, till it almost seemed to
+me I couldn't bear it any longer. I'm glad you've come, for I've got a
+chance to stretch now, and the sound of a voice will help to quiet my
+nerves again."
+
+"I didn't know you had any nerves," replied Tom. "But we can't stand
+here in this storm talking about such things. Benzeor sent me over to
+find out what you meant by hanging out the white flag. You haven't seen
+anything suspicious, have you?"
+
+"I have that," said Peter eagerly. "I was beginning to think that my
+coming here was all a piece of foolishness, when along about four
+o'clock--leastwise I should think it was about that time, though I
+didn't have any dial anywhere about to mark the time for me--what
+should I see but a whaleboat making for the river? You had better
+believe I forgot all about the time and everything else but the boat
+then, for I didn't know but some more of the Greens were coming up the
+Navesink on another trip such as they made the other day."
+
+Peter referred to an expedition which a band of several hundred tories
+from New Jersey, commonly known as the "Greens," had made a few weeks
+before this time. They had set forth from New York and had made a visit
+to some of their former neighbors and friends, and the tokens of their
+affection which they had left behind them had chiefly consisted of the
+ashes of burned homes and empty barns. The raid had been a cruel one,
+and its object apparently was more for devastation than for plunder, and
+many of the good people of Red Bank and Middletown and the adjoining
+towns had good cause to remember it so long as they lived. The numbers
+of the invaders had rendered them safe from all attacks, and the wanton
+destruction they wrought before they returned to New York had been the
+chief reason for keeping a watch stationed in the old tree every day
+since their visit. And Peter had received strict orders not to depart
+from his place of observation, if he saw anything suspicious, until he
+was satisfied that all danger was past. And Peter was faithful, that was
+well known, or he would not have been selected for the duty that day.
+
+"Well," resumed Peter, "I watched the boat till it went out of sight up
+the river. There were seven men on board of her, six of 'em pulling at
+the oars and the seventh steering. No more boats followed her, and I
+shouldn't have been suspicious if I hadn't thought I recognized the man
+who was steering."
+
+"Who was he?"
+
+"He looked to me a good deal like Fenton."
+
+"What? The pine robber?"
+
+"Yes, though of course I may have been mistaken. I never saw him but
+once and that was when he was a blacksmith over by the Court House
+before the war. My father had sent me over there to have one of the
+horses shod at his shop. I don't know that I should have remembered him
+if it hadn't been for something he did that day. I saw him take a
+half-inch bar of iron and bend it almost double with his hands. That
+made a great impression upon me, for I didn't believe there was another
+man in the colony who could do that."
+
+"Probably not," replied Tom. "But what made you think this was one of
+Fenton's whaleboats?"
+
+"Nothing but Fenton himself. Of course I've heard of the stories of what
+he's been doing since he became a pine robber. His gang is one of the
+worst, you know, and the minute I set my two eyes on him I suspected it
+was Fenton himself."
+
+"Why didn't you get word up the river as soon as you saw him?"
+
+"They've got watchers farther up, and that's their business. Besides, I
+didn't care to have him double me up the way he did that iron bar. Then,
+my business was to stay here and give the warning to anybody that might
+be going up the stream, you see. That's why I waved the flag when I saw
+you coming."
+
+"And they haven't come back yet?" inquired Tom eagerly.
+
+"No. That's what I'm waiting for. There isn't any fun in hanging out
+here in the wet, I can tell you. Just as soon as I can see that
+whaleboat coming out into the bay again I'm done."
+
+"All right, Peter, I'll go right back and report to Benzeor. Maybe he'll
+take you on board and carry you home."
+
+"Not unless I see the whaleboat again," said Peter doggedly as he
+prepared to climb to his seat in the tree again.
+
+Tom hurriedly departed and started to return with his message to the
+waiting Benzeor and his men, who he knew would be becoming impatient by
+this time. As he ran along the beach the storm smote him full in the
+face, but in spite of the driving rain the night was not very dark. The
+moon was near the full and gave sufficient light to enable him to see
+far out over the tossing waters. He could even discern the outlines of
+the little boat far up the shore, and as he ran swiftly forward he was
+thinking of the report he was to make to the waiting Benzeor, and his
+thoughts were not entirely pleasing.
+
+Fenton's deeds had become notorious in Old Monmouth. At the head of his
+brutal band, composed of men as desperate and reckless as he, he had
+pillaged and plundered throughout the county during the preceding year,
+and up to this time no one had been found strong enough to put a stop to
+his evil deeds. Any unprotected farmhouse was liable to receive one of
+his visits, and such a visit was seldom made without profit to the
+outlaws, for such in fact they were, and with their ill-gotten gains
+they hastened away to store them in their hiding-places among the pines.
+
+Nor was Fenton's band the only one which had its headquarters in that
+lonely and unfrequented region known in Old Monmouth as the "Pines."
+West, Disbrow, Fagan, Davenport, and many others of the lawless men, had
+engaged in similar occupations, and all had their hiding-places in the
+same wild spot, and in a measure protected and aided one another.
+
+Up to this time Fagan had been the only one to suffer the well-deserved
+penalty of his crimes, and in the preceding winter a band of two hundred
+of the desperate patriots had assembled and driven the famous, or rather
+infamous, outlaw to bay. At last he had been taken, and the infuriated
+men, mindful not only of the sufferings of their own families at his
+hands, but also of their possible future sufferings as well, had
+measured out a stern justice to the man, and with their own hands had
+hanged him from the long limb of a tree which stood by the side of the
+road which led from Monmouth Court House[1] to Trenton. Afterwards some
+of the patriots who had suffered most from his evil deeds had severed
+the skull from the body and nailed it to the tree, and then, placing the
+pipe between the grinning jaws, had left the uncanny sight as a warning
+to all who might be disposed to follow in the footsteps of the outlaw.
+
+For a few weeks the suffering patriots found relief, but only for a few
+weeks.
+
+Despite the terrible warning, the other bands of pine robbers soon
+renewed their labors, and now in the early summer of '78 the region was
+suffering more from the marauding bands than ever had been known before.
+
+It was all a part of the horrors of war. Sometimes, when we read of the
+brave deeds which have made famous some of the men who had a share in
+the struggle, we are prone to think only of the heroism displayed. And
+there was many a true hero in that and in every other war which our
+country has waged. We are never to forget that; but there was another
+side which has, to a large extent, passed from the memory of the present
+generation. The loss of property and of life, the sufferings of the
+women and children in the lonely homes, the barbarity and cruelty of
+evil men who, freed from the restraint of law in a time when the worst
+passions of men were aroused, gave free rein to their avarice and all
+that was bad in them, have frequently been ignored or forgotten. The
+glory of war or the pride in true heroism cannot entirely atone for the
+sufferings that were only too common in the scattered homes or lonely
+places.
+
+And Fenton's band was one of the worst. From their strongholds among the
+pines, into which few men had the hardihood to enter, they would set
+forth on horseback some dark night, and the tale they might have told
+upon their return was ever one of blood and sorrow. People tortured
+until in their agony they were compelled to yield up their scanty
+savings, raids upon the flocks and herds already becoming far too small
+for the necessities of their owners, burning houses, and men and women
+deliberately shot by the outlaws, were only a few among the many results
+of their raids.
+
+Not the least of the evils was the knowledge that among the people of
+Monmouth there were some who, while they might not openly be known as
+members of the bands, still gave the desired information to the leaders
+as to the places where possessions were secreted, or of the times when
+the patriots were aroused and it was best for the "Barons of the Pines,"
+as some termed them, to remain in hiding among the tall dark trees.
+Professedly, the outlaws acknowledged no allegiance to either side in
+the struggle, but somehow it had come to pass that a stanch whig was
+liable to suffer far more from their depredations than his tory
+neighbor, and as a natural consequence the feeling between neighbors and
+those who had been friends was becoming more and more strained and
+bitter.
+
+Thoughts of these things were passing rapidly through Tom's mind as he
+ran swiftly on through the storm to rejoin his companions. Fenton? Yes,
+he had heard of him too many times not to recognize his name and to feel
+well assured that a visit from him in such a night could promise little
+good for any of the patriots dwelling near the Navesink.
+
+"Well, what is it, Tom?" said Benzeor, as the panting lad rejoined them.
+"Is it Little Peter on the lookout? He must have seen a ghost to have
+warned us to stay out here in the bay in such a night as this. I'm wet
+to the skin."
+
+"It's Fenton," replied Tom huskily, for he had not yet recovered his
+breath. "Peter said he saw him and six of his men go up the Navesink
+about four o'clock."
+
+"Fenton?" said Jacob quickly. "Then we're in for a night of it. We don't
+want to fall into the hands of that pine robber when our pockets are as
+well lined as they are to-night."
+
+"I'm not so sure about that," replied Benzeor slowly. "There's ten
+chances to one that they won't come back before morning, and if they do
+they won't be likely to find us in such a storm as this."
+
+As he spoke a fresh gust swept the rain directly into their faces. The
+storm certainly was increasing, and the prospect of spending a night in
+the bay was dreary enough to cause the most stout-hearted to hesitate.
+And it may have been that other thoughts than that of the storm
+influenced Benzeor.
+
+At any rate he gruffly responded, "You can do as you please, but I'm
+going up the Navesink. If you're afraid, you can stay here or start out
+across the country on foot. You'll have to speak quick if you go with
+me, for I'm off."
+
+Benzeor turned and grasped the bow of his boat to push her off the
+beach upon which she had grounded. Before he had succeeded, however,
+Jacob spoke up quickly and said, "We're with you, Benzeor. If you can
+stand it, we can."
+
+"Get aboard then, every one of you!" said Benzeor gruffly.
+
+Tom and Barzilla quickly took their places in the stern, while Benzeor,
+with the aid of Jacob, soon sent the boat out from the shore.
+
+The sail was soon rigged and shortened, and the little party then
+started for the narrow mouth of the Navesink. The boat rolled and
+pitched in the storm, but Benzeor had her well in hand, and soon steered
+into the more quiet waters of the river. Tom could see the tree as they
+passed, and was positive that Peter could also see them, but no hail was
+given, and the point was soon left far behind them.
+
+Then up the narrower waters of the river the boat sped on in her course,
+but not a word was spoken by any of those on board. The storm was still
+raging and Benzeor's attention was largely occupied in managing his
+craft, and the others were busied with thoughts which perhaps they did
+not care to express.
+
+Tom was decidedly anxious. A meeting with Fenton and his band was
+something of which he was fearful, and as they sped on his fears
+increased each moment. Benzeor's apparent indifference had not deceived
+him, and deep in his heart there was a lurking suspicion that perhaps he
+might be able to account for it, if he felt so disposed.
+
+However, he too was silent, and a half hour had passed and as yet no
+signs of danger had appeared. Benzeor was steering as close inshore as
+the wind permitted, and Tom was beginning to hope that they would
+succeed in making their way up the river without being discovered.
+
+Suddenly Jacob, who was seated in the bow and was keeping a constant
+lookout ahead, shouted, "Port! Port your helm, Benzeor! Quick! Quick!"
+
+Benzeor instantly heeded the warning, but his quick movement barely
+served to enable them to pass a boat which loomed up in the darkness. It
+was a whaleboat, and with a sinking heart Tom saw that there were six
+men rowing, while a seventh was seated in the stern and was serving as
+helmsman.
+
+Instantly Peter's words flashed into his mind, and he knew that they had
+barely escaped a collision with the very boat which the lookout had
+discovered making its way up the Navesink late in the afternoon. The
+party could be none other than that of Fenton and his outlaw band.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[1] Freehold.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+BENZEOR'S VISITOR
+
+
+"HOLD on there! Hold on, I say! Stop, or we'll shoot!"
+
+The words were shouted by some one in the whaleboat, and Benzeor
+evidently was about to heed the sharp command. He quickly changed the
+course of the boat, and as the shortened sail flapped in the wind as the
+little craft came about, the whaleboat came alongside and some one
+reached forth with a boat-hook, and the progress was instantly stayed.
+
+Tom's heart was beating rapidly in his excitement. A wild impulse to
+leap into the river seized him, but before he could leave his position
+in the bow, two of the other crew clambered on board, and he knew that
+an attempt to escape would now be useless. Doubtless the men were armed,
+and the darkness was not deep enough to conceal him from their sight.
+His only hope now depended upon the actions of the men and the course
+which Benzeor should decide to follow.
+
+The sail was instantly lowered in obedience to the sharp command of the
+men who had boarded the boat, and, in great fear, the lad waited for the
+purpose of their captors to be declared. He drew back in his position in
+the bow, hoping to escape the notice of all on board, as he saw that
+Benzeor had arisen from his seat and stood facing the men.
+
+"Who are you? What ye out in a night like this for? Whose boat is this?"
+exclaimed the one who appeared to be the leader.
+
+"Is that you, Fenton?" replied Benzeor in a low voice.
+
+"Ho, it's Benzeor Osburn!" exclaimed the man, peering intently into the
+face before him as he spoke. "I thought it was strange we didn't find
+you in your house. We waited an hour as we agreed to, but when you
+didn't put in an appearance, we thought we'd start back. Where ye been,
+Benzeor? What's up now?"
+
+"I'd been back home in time if it hadn't been for the storm and an alarm
+we had back in the bay. I think ye'd better go back with me now, Fenton.
+I've got some facts that may interest you, and we can't talk them over
+here."
+
+"Who are these men with you?" inquired Fenton suspiciously.
+
+"Oh, they're all right. I'll vouch for them, every one," replied
+Benzeor. "You haven't anything to fear from any of my friends. Come up
+to my house and I'll tell ye all about it."
+
+Fenton hesitated a moment before he replied, and Tom peered intently at
+the man of whom he had already heard so many tales. He could see his
+great form, although he could not distinguish the features of his face
+in the darkness. His deep voice and gruff manner had not tended to allay
+the lad's fears, and now Benzeor's words and actions filled his heart
+with a new alarm. Was Benzeor about to cast in his lot with Fenton? His
+words betrayed the fact of their previous acquaintance, and all the
+recent suspicious actions of his foster father came back to him. No one
+in the party had yet spoken, except Benzeor and Fenton, but the recent
+conversation on board the boat, much of which Tom had overheard,
+convinced the troubled lad that no very strong protest would be made
+against any proposal that Benzeor might feel disposed to make.
+
+"I'm rather of the opinion," said Fenton roughly, "that it's about time
+you went home with me. I don't know who these fellows on board here are,
+and I don't care. You're the one I'm after, Benzeor, and it seems to me
+the time's come for you to join us or quit. You've been shilly-shallying
+long enough."
+
+"Hush! Don't speak so loud!" replied Benzeor anxiously.
+
+Fenton laughed outright at Benzeor's evident alarm, and, turning to his
+companions in the whaleboat, said, "I think we'd better take the boat
+along with us. We can land this crew anywhere along the shore, or we can
+sink 'em in the river, just which you please. It's too much of a storm
+for us to be hanging around here on the Navesink."
+
+"Fenton," said Benzeor, rising and stepping up to the side of the
+outlaw, "you'd better do as I say. I've got something to tell ye, and
+it's worth hearing, too."
+
+A low conversation followed between the two men which Tom, with all his
+efforts, was not able to hear. The result of it, however, quickly became
+apparent when Fenton turned to his companions and said, "It's all right,
+boys. You go on without me, and I'll join you to-morrow. I'm going up
+to Benzeor's now."
+
+The boat-hook was quickly withdrawn at his command, and the sound of the
+oars of the departing boat soon ceased to be heard.
+
+The sail of Benzeor's boat was then hoisted again, and once more the
+little party, increased now by the addition of Fenton, began to make
+their way up the Navesink. Though the rain was steadily falling, the
+wind was favoring, and the boat, handled by the skillful Benzeor, held
+steadily to its way. The low shores could be seen in the distance on
+either side, and an occasional light betrayed the location of some
+lonely farmhouse, whose occupants in the confidence begotten of the
+storm had ventured to sit up till a later hour than was customary in
+those days.
+
+Not a word was spoken on board the boat, and Fenton had taken a position
+near Tom from which he did not move. All were drenched, but a summer
+rain was something which none of them minded in such a time as that.
+
+When an hour had passed, Benzeor ran his boat closer inshore and in a
+few moments landed. Then turning to his companions he said, "Come over
+to my house to-morrow, Jacob, and I'll give you and Barzilla your
+shares of the money."
+
+"We'll go with you now," replied Jacob, evidently not desiring to put
+off the day of reckoning too long, a desire in which Barzilla also
+shared.
+
+"No, I can't fix it up to-night. You can take the bag, though, if you
+want to, and bring me my share to-morrow."
+
+Benzeor's confidence in his fellows served the desired purpose, and
+Jacob and Barzilla speedily departed, taking with them the little bag of
+gold which had been received as the price of the produce they had taken
+to New York.
+
+"Tom, you look out for the boat," called Benzeor, as he and Fenton
+started towards the little house whose outlines could be discerned in
+the distance.
+
+Tom obeyed, and as he worked over the little boat, looking well to all
+the details, his thoughts were far more busy than his hands. The changes
+which he had noted in Benzeor of late seemed almost to have reached
+their climax. Was the man intending now to go with Fenton? All his
+recent absences from home came up before the lad's mind, and the strange
+visitors he had received there of late were not forgotten. What was it
+Benzeor was planning to do? He was not much like the man he had been a
+few years before this time, and as Tom thought over all the changes, he
+was troubled more and more.
+
+He knew that Sarah had not been unaware of what was going on, for many a
+time had they talked it all over together. Sarah had remained a
+steadfast champion of her father, but Tom had not failed to see that she
+was none the less troubled by his strange actions. His grasping
+disposition had become more and more apparent of late, and while he had
+never in the presence of his family referred to anything he had in his
+mind to do against the patriots, his very silence in such times was more
+threatening than any words he could utter. But Sarah had steadily
+refused to believe that her father would desert the cause for which at
+the outbreak of the war he had professed the most ardent attachment;
+still, it was impossible for her not to discover, what Tom for a long
+time had seen, that he was strangely silent of late.
+
+The change in Benzeor Osburn had been so gradual as to deceive many of
+his friends and neighbors. All had known his "closeness," as the country
+people termed his love of money, but few of them had thought it would
+ever lead him into the position in which the man at that time really
+stood.
+
+Benzeor in '76 had been among the loudest in his expressions of loyalty
+to the cause of the colonies, and had been foremost in blaming his own
+brother for his "toryism." His brother's property had been confiscated,
+but Benzeor's had been left unmolested, so confident had all the whigs
+been in the sincerity of his expressions. And at the time Benzeor had
+meant what he said, and said what he meant. But never for a moment had
+he dreamed that the struggle would be such a long-continued one as it
+had proved to be, nor had he thought that patriotism would affect his
+own possessions. All that would be done would be to make a strong
+protest against the unjust taxation, for Benzeor had hated taxes as he
+did few things in this world, and then a compromise would be effected,
+which would permit the colonists to go on with their occupations, and
+the mother country would soon see that it was not to her own advantage
+to drive her rebellious children too far.
+
+The first shock had come to him when the Continental Congress had
+declared the country to be a free and independent nation. That was
+going too far, Benzeor thought, and so he freely expressed himself; but
+still hoping that a compromise of some kind would be made, and that his
+own possessions would not be disturbed, he had uttered no further
+protests, though his voice ceased to be heard in favor of the rebellion.
+
+As further events betrayed the weakness of the patriot cause, and he had
+found that patriotism was likely to prove a somewhat expensive virtue,
+his feelings had undergone a still more decided change. At first he had
+entered into one or two secret projects by which he had succeeded in
+enriching his own pockets, and the success had so affected him that as
+his patriotism decreased his hopes of gains correspondingly increased;
+and soon from deeds for which he tried to justify himself, he had been
+gradually drawn into others which even his own seared conscience
+proclaimed to be wrong. In some of the latter he had come into contact
+with the outlaws of Fenton's class, and his association with them had
+soon banished the feeling of disgust he had formerly cherished for them,
+until it had even come to pass that Fenton himself was a not unwelcome
+guest in his own home.
+
+At first the visits had been made secretly, and the promises of rich
+harvests to be reaped, as the result of their evil deeds, had appealed
+to Benzeor more strongly than even he himself was aware. The lawless
+times, the constant turmoils, the bitterness between those who had
+recently been the warmest of friends, the ease with which raids were
+made, and the apparent impossibility of detection, had all combined to
+arouse the avaricious Benzeor more and more; and now not very much was
+needed to draw him still farther within the toils of Fenton and his
+band.
+
+Not all of these things were apparent to Tom when at last he left the
+boat and started towards the house, but he had seen sufficient to make
+him suspicious of Benzeor, and he was as perplexed as he was troubled.
+All his own feelings had gone out more and more to the patriot cause,
+and more than once had he been sadly tempted to depart from his home
+without waiting for the formality of buying up his time, and he had even
+gone so far as to suggest to Sarah several times what he had it in his
+mind to do. Sarah's grief, however, and the confidence which she still
+professed to feel in her father, as well as the dislike in his own heart
+to do anything which bore any resemblance to stealing,--for so the
+troubled lad regarded the taking of time which did not really belong to
+him as the bound boy of Benzeor Osburn,--had hitherto held him back. How
+long such feelings would continue to sway him Tom could not decide when
+at last he lifted the latch and entered the kitchen.
+
+Benzeor and his guest were seated before the fire which had been started
+in the wide and open fireplace, and were drying their wet clothing as
+they conversed eagerly together.
+
+As Tom came in, Benzeor glanced up hastily and said, "You can go to bed,
+Tom. You must be wet and tired, and there is a lot of work to be done
+to-morrow." Benzeor's voice was not unkind, but Tom did not fail to see
+that his presence was not desired. He quickly lighted a candle with a
+splinter which he thrust into the fire and held until it was in a flame,
+and then went up the low stairway to his room directly over the kitchen
+in which the men were seated.
+
+As he entered the room he noted the gleam which came through the open
+space near the rude chimney, and, placing the candle on the low table,
+he advanced and peered down at the men. He could see both plainly, and,
+after observing them for a moment, he was about to turn away and take
+off his dripping clothing, when he suddenly stopped. He had overheard a
+word which caused his heart to beat much more rapidly, and in a moment
+he was upon his knees striving to hear what more would be said.
+
+He remained in the same position for an hour, and at last arose only
+when Fenton opened the door and went out into the darkness. Then Benzeor
+closed and barred the door, and started directly up the stairway.
+
+Instantly Tom blew out his candle and leaped into bed, all wet and muddy
+as he was, and drew the bedclothes close up around his face.
+
+Benzeor came slowly on and then stopped before the door of Tom's room.
+The lad was trembling in his excitement, for he well knew that if the
+man should enter and discover that he had not removed his clothing
+before going to bed, his suspicions would at once be aroused. And above
+all things Benzeor's suspicion at that time was what Tom most desired to
+lull.
+
+There were wild thoughts in Tom's mind of leaping from the bed and,
+rushing past the man, making a break for the outside. Perhaps the man
+might not enter, however, and, trembling with fear and excitement, Tom
+waited.
+
+It seemed to him that a long time had elapsed, and still no sound
+outside the door could be heard. Had Benzeor gone on? The light of his
+candle which still shone through the cracks disproved that. What could
+he then be doing?
+
+Tom tried to conjecture what must be going on on the stairway, but the
+silence was still unbroken. The minutes were like hours to the
+frightened lad. It seemed to him as if the beatings of his heart must be
+heard throughout the house.
+
+His suspense was soon ended--when Benzeor lifted the latch and Tom felt
+the light of the candle streaming in full upon his face.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+THE MESSENGER
+
+
+FOR a moment Tom closed his eyes and waited for the words which he
+expected and feared to hear. His body was trembling and all his strength
+was required to prevent his teeth from chattering. If Benzeor should
+enter the room Tom knew that at once his predicament would be
+discovered, and in the present state of his foster father's feelings he
+was aware that he could expect no mercy at his hands.
+
+He heard no footstep, but he felt that the light of the candle was still
+shining upon his face and knew that Benzeor had not departed. At last,
+unable to bear the suspense longer, he opened his eyes, for he felt that
+he must see what was going on in the room. There stood Benzeor in the
+doorway holding the candle with one hand, and intently regarding the
+apparently sleeping boy before him.
+
+"I'll be down directly," said Tom drowsily, as if he were just awaking.
+"I didn't know it was time to get up. I'll be with you in a minute."
+
+"It isn't time to get up," replied Benzeor slowly. "I'm just going to
+bed. I stopped to see if you were all right. Have you been asleep long?"
+
+"I--I don't know. Is there anything wrong?" Tom still kept the
+bedclothes drawn tightly about his face, and although he was feigning
+that he had been sleeping, he was in a state of terror. If Benzeor
+should approach the bed he well knew what would follow.
+
+"No, there's nothing wrong," replied Benzeor. "I just wanted to see if
+you were all right. It's been a hard trip, and there's much work to be
+done to-morrow."
+
+Tom closed his eyes and did not continue the conversation, hoping that
+the man would feel satisfied and leave him to himself. Nor was he
+disappointed, for Benzeor soon withdrew and closed the door behind him.
+
+Tom could hear him as he stumbled about in the adjoining room, preparing
+for bed. Frightened as the lad had been, he had not failed to notice the
+expression upon Benzeor's face. It seemed to him that fear and
+recklessness were combined there, and that in the recent decision which
+the man had made, he had bidden farewell to everything good in his
+nature.
+
+Benzeor had not been without his good qualities. Even then, in spite of
+his alarm, Tom recalled his rough kindnesses, and thought how much
+better in many ways his foster father had treated him than had some of
+the true fathers treated their own sons, for the times were rough and
+the one thing which was demanded of all the growing boys was implicit
+obedience to their elders. And this obedience had been ofttimes
+compelled by no gentle means. The use of the strap upon boys who were as
+large as their fathers was not unknown, and no one ever thought of
+resenting the harsh treatment. But Benzeor had seldom struck him. Tom
+almost wished that he had, for it would make the carrying out of the
+project he had already formed much easier.
+
+Then, too, all the kindness he had received at the hands of Benzeor's
+wife and of the girls came back to him. It was true that this had been
+largely of a negative character, but in times like these through which
+the troubled lad was then passing, even that was not forgotten. He had
+toiled early and late, and knew that he had given more than a full
+equivalent for the scanty food and rough clothing he had received. But
+after all, Benzeor's home had been all the home he had ever known, and
+he was not unmindful of the benefits he had received.
+
+His soul now, however, was in a state of turmoil. The words he had
+overheard had proved conclusively that Benzeor was a changed man, and as
+Tom thought of the project which Fenton had presented, and into which
+his foster father had entered with apparent eagerness, his own
+indignation increased. The long waiting was past now, and the time for
+action, the time of which he had dreamed and thought so much of late,
+had come at last.
+
+He removed the bed-clothing and sat up on the side of the bed, listening
+intently. Benzeor had ceased to move about in his room, and the sounds
+which now came indicated clearly that he was asleep. Against the little
+window the rain was still beating, and the darkness was so intense in
+the room that Tom could not distinguish any object.
+
+For several minutes he continued in his position, undecided whether he
+had better make the attempt to depart from the house by the way of the
+stairs, or through the window in his room. If he should select the
+former, the stairs would be sure to creak under his feet; and then, too,
+there would be the bars which must be drawn from the door. There were
+too many possibilities of detection to make that method of departure the
+desirable one.
+
+If he should go through the window, all he would have to do would be to
+drop upon the woodpile directly beneath,--a pile which Tom knew was
+there, for he himself had drawn and cut the wood only a few days before
+this time. He decided to use the window.
+
+Stepping slowly and carefully, he approached and quietly raised the
+sash. As he looked out into the night, the farm buildings could be seen,
+and yonder was the road he was to seek.
+
+Hesitating no longer, the resolute boy crawled through the open window,
+and then, clinging for a moment to the sash with his hands, dropped upon
+the woodpile below. There was a noise as the wood rolled from under him,
+but, quickly rising, he ran to the long lane which led out to the road,
+and then stopped to learn whether his departure had been discovered or
+not.
+
+The silence was unbroken. The outlines of the rude little house stood
+out in the darkness, the rain was falling steadily, and the heavy clouds
+hung low over the earth. Not even the dog had been disturbed, and with a
+lighter heart Tom turned and ran down the lane and was soon in the road.
+
+The mud was now thick and heavy, and he found his progress difficult.
+But as he had not far to go, he ran steadily on, and soon came within
+sight of Little Peter's house. There was no light to be seen within it,
+and he was not at all certain that his friend had returned.
+
+He approached and stood beneath the window of the boy's room, which,
+like his own, was over the kitchen. Then he gave the low whistle which
+they both had used as a "call." At first there was no response, and when
+he had given it two or three times he concluded that his friend had not
+returned from his work as the lookout in the tree by the mouth of the
+Navesink. Nothing then remained to be done but to rouse the family, for
+Tom was determined, and was well aware that what he planned to do must
+be done quickly.
+
+Approaching the kitchen door he rapped loudly upon it. Twice had he
+repeated the summons before a window was raised, and some one looking
+out upon him called, "Who's there? Is that you, Peter?"
+
+"No, it's not Peter. It's Tom Coward, and I want to get in. I've got
+something to tell you."
+
+"I'll be down in a moment," said Peter's mother, for Tom had recognized
+the voice as her's.
+
+Tom soon heard the heavy bars withdrawn, and in a brief time the door
+was opened, and then closed and carefully barred behind him.
+
+"What's wrong, Tom?" inquired the woman anxiously. "Has anything
+happened to Peter?"
+
+"I don't think so," replied Tom. "He was all right when I left him a few
+hours ago down by the Hook. But what I want to know now is whether
+you've had any word from his father?"
+
+"Not a word, except that it's reported the army's on the march again.
+Why do you ask?"
+
+"I don't know that I ought to tell you," replied Tom hesitatingly, "but
+the truth of the matter is that I happened to hear that he was coming
+home."
+
+"You've heard something more than that, Tom Coward," said the woman now
+thoroughly alarmed. "I know you've heard more, or you wouldn't have come
+over here at this time of night and in such a storm. What is it? What is
+it?"
+
+Tom perceived that he had gone too far to retreat now, and so he began
+his story. He did not go into all the details, for as yet he did not
+desire to implicate Benzeor, at least in the eyes of all his neighbors.
+
+"The way of it is this," began Tom hesitatingly. "I happened to be
+to-night where I overheard the talk between two men, and one of 'em was
+Fenton, the pine robber."
+
+Tom could perceive the expression of alarm which swept over the face of
+the woman, who was still standing before him. Apparently ignoring it,
+however, he went on. "It seems that both of the armies are on the march
+across Jersey, and that Washington has halted over by Hopewell. Somehow,
+Fenton had got word that your husband was coming home for a day, and
+he's fixed up a plan to trap and take him."
+
+"I haven't heard a word," said the woman slowly. "When was he coming?"
+
+"To-morrow."
+
+"And Fenton knows of it?"
+
+"Yes. And he knows something more, too, or at least he pretends to. I
+heard him say that you had some money hidden in an old sock, which you'd
+stored away in the garret."
+
+Tom saw the woman start at his words, and knew then that Fenton's
+statement had been correct, although he could not conjecture how the
+pine robber had received his information. Little Peter's mother was a
+resolute woman, but even the stoutest heart might well be alarmed to
+hear that Fenton was aware of such possessions.
+
+"Have you any idea when Little Peter will come home?"
+
+"No. It's too bad to keep him out in such a night. And we need him here
+now."
+
+"I'll wait till he comes," said Tom quietly. "There's no danger
+to-night, but I want to see him, and I don't think you'll object to my
+staying, will you?"
+
+"No," said the woman eagerly. "Oh, what times these are! My husband has
+been in the army more than a year, and the end hasn't come yet. What
+will become of us? What shall we do? Tom," she added suddenly, "what was
+Fenton going to do with him if he caught him?"
+
+"Take him and send him to New York. You know there's a reward for every
+prisoner taken. But he hasn't got him yet."
+
+"No, that's so; and what's more he won't either, if it can be prevented.
+Have you told Benzeor about it? Hark! There's some one at the door now!"
+
+The woman was not mistaken, for a low tapping on the kitchen door could
+be distinctly heard. For a moment neither spoke, but they could not
+conceal their fears from each other. Just then a stronger gust of wind
+drove the rain with added force against the windows. The sound of the
+storm seemed to increase the fear of those within the house. Perhaps
+Fenton himself had even then come; or, as was more probable, Tom
+thought, his own departure had been discovered, and Benzeor had come for
+him. As between the two, Tom decidedly preferred to meet Fenton at that
+time.
+
+Again the low rapping was heard, and Tom knew that some response must be
+made. "I'll open the door. Maybe it's Little Peter come back," he
+whispered.
+
+"No, it isn't Peter. He wouldn't come in that way."
+
+"I'll find out who it is," replied Tom more resolutely, although his
+heart was oppressed by a great fear. His hands were trembling, and he
+almost expected that the moment he drew back the bars a rush against the
+door would be made.
+
+"You stand ready to push against the door," he said as he grasped the
+bar. Slowly he drew it back, and standing away from the slight opening
+called out, "Who's there?"
+
+No reply was heard, and the wind which swept through the open space
+quickly extinguished the candle, leaving them both in total darkness.
+For a moment Tom thought they were being attacked, and he instantly
+slammed the door back, and shot the bar into its place.
+
+The rapping upon the door was quickly repeated, and the voice of some
+one outside could be heard. "Don't light the candle again," whispered
+Tom. "It'll let them see what's inside here. Who's out there?" he called
+in louder tones. "Who's there? You'll have to tell who you are, or we
+shan't let you in. Who is it?"
+
+Another rap was the only reply, and Tom was almost decided not to heed
+the summons longer, but to leave the callers, whoever they might be, out
+there in the storm.
+
+"I'll go upstairs and look out of the window," whispered Peter's mother;
+and, creeping softly out of the room, she soon made her way up the
+stairway to the room overhead from which she had replied to Tom's own
+summons a few minutes before.
+
+Tom waited and listened. The rapping was not repeated, and no sound
+could be heard outside the door. What could it all mean? Had the
+marauders gone around to some of the windows? These were barred by heavy
+inside shutters, and no light could be seen to reveal the presence of
+any one. The darkness in the room was intense, and Tom almost thought he
+could feel it. He was breathing hard in his excitement, but he had not
+left his position by the door.
+
+Soon he heard the sound of the woman returning down the stairway. He
+waited breathlessly, and she soon rejoined him.
+
+"I can't see but one man," she whispered. "He's right there in front of
+the door."
+
+"Is it Benzeor?"
+
+"I couldn't see. You'd better open the door and let him in. We can
+handle one."
+
+Tom did not feel so positive about that, but bidding her light the
+candle, he again drew back the bar. "Come in! Come in! Quick!" he
+called.
+
+Some one pushed past him, and the door was instantly closed and barred
+again.
+
+The candle was not yet lighted, and in the darkness he felt as if some
+one were about to grasp him. He could almost feel hands upon him now. He
+stepped farther back from the door, and waited in breathless suspense
+for the candle to be lighted.
+
+After several attempts, the woman succeeded in igniting a splinter from
+the embers in the ashes on the fireplace, and the beams of the lighted
+candle quickly dispelled the darkness.
+
+"It's Indian John!" said Tom with a great sigh of relief as he saw the
+man before him.
+
+The visitor was a strange appearing being, clad in the leggings and
+moccasins of his race, while over his shoulders he wore a faded coat
+which once had done duty for some Continental soldier. His dark eyes
+burned as if they had caught a reflection from the sputtering candle,
+but with a countenance unmoved he gazed quietly at his companions in the
+room.
+
+"Oh, John, what a fright you gave us!" said the woman at last. "What
+brings you here on a night like this?"
+
+The Indian made no reply, save to draw a letter from the pocket of the
+dripping, faded coat, and quietly held it forth to the woman.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+IN THE TEN-ACRE LOT
+
+
+LITTLE Peter's mother instantly grasped the letter, and seating herself
+by the table, and drawing the candle nearer, at once began to read. Tom
+watched her eagerly, but she did not speak, and the expression upon her
+face did not betray any of the emotions in her heart.
+
+The Indian still stood motionless in the position he had taken when he
+first entered the room, and except for the occasional turning of his
+dark eyes from the boy to the woman, so far as appearances went he might
+have been a statue. The rain still dashed against the windows, and the
+sounds of the wind outside showed that the storm was unabated. The
+flickering candle served to intensify the darkness, and the alarm which
+Tom had felt had not entirely departed.
+
+The woman read the letter all through carefully, and then, without a
+word of explanation, began to read it again. Tom hardly knew what to
+do. He had given her his warning, and whether she would care for his
+further services he could not determine. He did not feel like
+interrupting her, and yet he feared that his presence now might not be
+altogether welcome, for he had no means of knowing what the message was,
+or who had sent it.
+
+His uncertainty was quickly dispelled, however, as the woman laid the
+letter upon the table, and turning to him said, "You were right, Tom.
+Peter is coming home; but how you found it out, I cannot even guess."
+
+Tom did not feel at liberty to enlighten her upon the subject beyond
+what he had told her already, for he was sadly troubled about Benzeor
+and his relations with Fenton. Doubtless Benzeor was implicated, but
+matters had not yet gone so far that he felt he was at liberty to betray
+his foster father to the neighbors.
+
+"Yes," resumed the woman, "Peter is coming home, but only for a day or
+two."
+
+"Where is he? What does he say of the army?" inquired Tom.
+
+"Washington is at Hopewell, as you said, Tom. When he found out that
+Clinton really intended to march across Jersey, he detached General
+Maxwell's brigade and some of the militia to obstruct and bother the
+British, and Peter was in the militia, you know. They were to keep close
+to the redcoats, and by their skirmishes keep them from going too fast,
+and so give Washington a chance to pass them, and then, when the place
+he wanted was found, turn about and fight. When the army crossed the
+Delaware at Coryell's Ferry, Washington sent Colonel Morgan with six
+hundred of the riflemen to reinforce Maxwell, and with the rest of his
+men he set out to march toward Princeton."
+
+"I thought you said he was at Hopewell now," said Tom.
+
+"So he is, Peter writes, but Hopewell isn't but a few miles from
+Princeton, you know, and he decided to stop there and give his army a
+good rest. Peter writes that all the men now think that Clinton is
+marching so slowly on purpose, and that his plan is to let the Americans
+go on into the lower country and then gain the right of our army by a
+quick march and get possession of the higher ground on the right of our
+men. Peter writes that that is what all the Continentals think Clinton
+is trying to do, and so General Washington has halted at Hopewell.
+That's only five miles from Princeton, you see, and he is going to stay
+there a few days so that he can give his men a good rest before any
+engagement takes place; and he can find out what Clinton's plans are,
+too."
+
+"And while the army is waiting there, Big Peter thinks he'll run up home
+for a day, does he?" said Tom.
+
+"Yes, that's just it. He's sent me word of his coming by Indian John,
+here. But you must have been delayed John," she said, turning to the
+Indian as she spoke.
+
+"Heap wet," said the Indian quietly.
+
+"When does he say he expects to be here?" inquired Tom.
+
+"To-morrow; no, to-day, for it must be long past midnight now. I
+shouldn't be surprised to see him any time."
+
+"Well I've given you my message, and you'll know what to do now. I think
+perhaps I'd better be going back home, that is, unless there's something
+you think I can do to help you."
+
+"No, there's nothing more now, Tom. Little Peter will soon be here, and
+with him and Indian John in the house, I don't think we shall have much
+to fear. It was good of you to come, Tom. I shall never forget you, and
+I know that Peter will not, either. I am sadly troubled, but I think it
+will be all right."
+
+"Good-night, then," said Tom.
+
+"Good-night, and thank you again for all your trouble and kindness."
+
+Tom drew back the bar, and, opening the door, passed out into the night,
+little dreaming that he had looked upon the face of Little Peter's
+mother for the last time.
+
+As he ran along the lonesome road, he could see that the clouds were
+breaking, and in low masses were swept by the wind across the sky. The
+rain had almost ceased now, but the air was damp and heavy and strangely
+oppressive. Perhaps it was the oppressiveness which affected Tom more
+than the excitement through which he had just passed, for the lad was
+much depressed as he came nearer to Benzeor's house. All the
+conversation he had overheard between the men came back to him, and he
+almost wished that he had not left Peter's mother alone with Indian John
+and the children. His feeling of obligation to Benzeor had mostly
+departed now, and as he recalled the plots of his foster father his
+heart was hot within him. He even thought of going over to the Court
+House and reporting the matter to Sheriff Forman that very night; but
+the hope that Benzeor still might not join Fenton in the evil project
+they had formed deterred him, and as he just then obtained a glimpse of
+the house which for more than ten years had been the only home he had
+ever known, his mind was recalled to his own immediate plans. At least
+he had given Peter's mother the warning, and if Fenton's band should
+make the proposed visit, in any event she would be prepared to receive
+them.
+
+At first Tom thought he would not return to his room, but would pass the
+night in the barn; still the fear that Benzeor might discover his
+absence, and be led to suspect its cause, quickly presented itself, and
+the troubled lad decided to go back to his accustomed place.
+
+Carefully he climbed up on the woodpile, and grasping the sill drew
+himself up and passed through the open window. He stood for a moment in
+the room and listened intently. Not a sound could be heard, and even the
+long drawn-out snores with which Benzeor had been wont to proclaim to
+the household the fact that he had entered the land of dreams were
+silent now. He waited several moments, and as the silence was still
+unbroken he proceeded carefully to remove his wet clothing, and climbed
+into his high bed.
+
+For the first time then he realized how thoroughly tired he was. The bed
+had never been more grateful to him, and a heavy sigh of relief escaped
+his lips. He heard the crowing of the cocks and knew that the morning
+could not be far away now.
+
+Not even the exciting events of the day, or the treacherous project of
+Benzeor, or his anxiety for the safety of Little Peter's father, now
+availed to keep the wearied lad awake.
+
+How long he slept he did not know, but it was broad daylight when he
+opened his eyes. Some one was pounding upon his door, and with a
+confused thought that Fenton was besieging the house, or that Washington
+had begun an attack upon Clinton's forces, he quickly sat up in the bed
+and listened.
+
+The summons was repeated, and Tom at once realized where he was and what
+was expected of him. There was no mistaking Benzeor's rude method of
+proclaiming the presence of the morning, and if he had had any doubts,
+they would have been quickly dispelled by the words which followed.
+
+"Come, Tom, get up! It's high time we were at work again!"
+
+"I'll be down in a minute," replied Tom as he leaped out of bed and
+hastily dressed.
+
+While he was engaged in that occupation he tried desperately to collect
+his thoughts and think of some way out of the troubles which he feared
+were sure to come that day. Should he tell Benzeor plainly that he could
+no longer remain under his roof? Ought he to tell him what he had
+overheard the night before? Had the time come for him to declare himself
+and to take the open stand which he had for a long time secretly planned
+to do? Thoughts of Sarah and the toiling, careworn little mother of the
+household presented themselves before his troubled mind, and the longer
+he thought, the more perplexed he became.
+
+The problem was not solved when he passed down the stairs and went out
+of the house to the barrel which stood beneath the corner of the eaves.
+He took the rude wooden bowl and filled it with water, and desperately
+tried to arrive at some conclusion as he bathed his flushed face.
+
+The family were already seated at the breakfast-table, and the sounds of
+Benzeor's gruff voice could be distinctly heard through the open
+windows. The hens with their broods were moving about the yard, and the
+dog came and rubbed against his leg as the lad dried his face and hands
+on the rough towel that was hanging near the water barrel. The storm had
+passed, and the summer sun was shining clear and strong now.
+
+As he lifted his eyes and looked out over Benzeor's fertile lands, only
+a vision of peace and restfulness could be seen on every side. It was
+all so different from the storm which was in his own soul that Tom
+almost groaned aloud as he turned to enter the kitchen and take his
+accustomed place at the table.
+
+As he entered the room, Benzeor said, "You're late this morning, lad,
+but I thought I would let you sleep, you had such a hard day of it
+yesterday. But there's no trip to New York this morning, and not likely
+to be one again soon."
+
+Benzeor's manner was not unkind, and as Tom glanced at him he wondered
+whether the man was in any wise suspicious of him or not. Apparently he
+was not, but without making any reply Tom seated himself and quietly
+decided to wait until they were alone before he spoke of what was in his
+mind.
+
+"Tom," said Benzeor after a brief silence, "I want you to go over to the
+ten-acre lot to-day. The ground's wet, but the corn there needs hoeing,
+and we can't wait."
+
+The "ten-acre lot" was on the border of Benzeor's possessions, and was
+nearly a mile distant from the house. On all sides it was bordered by
+woods, and was as lonely a place as could be found in all the region.
+
+"Are you going, too?" inquired Tom, with an apparent indifference he was
+far from feeling.
+
+"No. I've got to go in another direction to-day. I may not be back at
+night either, though I can't say as to that. You'd better take your
+dinner, too, Tom, and I'll leave one of the muskets for you. You can
+load it up with bird-shot and keep the blackbirds and crows away.
+They're raising the mischief this year, and corn's going to be worth
+money this fall, if I'm not greatly mistaken."
+
+Tom made no reply, although his heart was beating a little more rapidly
+than usual. Benzeor's absence from home promised little good, and the
+words which he had overheard the night before came back now with
+redoubled force. Where was Benzeor going? And why did he send him to
+work in the distant field, when he was positive that some of the corn
+nearer the house was in far greater need of hoeing than that in the
+ten-acre lot?
+
+However, he did not voice his questions, and immediately after the
+breakfast was over Benzeor mounted his horse and departed up the road,
+going in the opposite direction to that which led to Little Peter's
+house.
+
+Tom went up into the unfinished room in which Benzeor kept his guns and
+ammunition, but instead of taking the musket to which the man had
+referred, he selected a rifle, and loaded it with a ball instead of the
+bird-shot as Benzeor had directed. Just why he did this Tom could not
+have explained even to himself, but somehow there was the feeling in his
+heart that he might need to be prepared to deal with larger game that
+day than the thieving blackbirds or the noisy crows.
+
+"I've got your dinner all ready, Tom," said Sarah, as the boy came back
+with his gun into the kitchen. "Why, you've got the rifle!" she added in
+surprise, as she noted the weapon he had in his hands. "There's nothing
+wrong, is there?" she said anxiously.
+
+"I hope not. I don't know. I thought I'd take this gun," replied Tom in
+some confusion.
+
+Sarah said nothing more, but Tom knew from her manner that she was
+alarmed. He would have been glad to quiet her fears, but the anxiety in
+his own heart rendered him somewhat embarrassed, and without saying
+anything more he shouldered his gun, and picking up the little pail, or
+"blicky," as the country people termed it, having adopted the Dutch word
+whether they themselves were Dutch or not, he set forth on his walk to
+the distant ten-acre lot.
+
+He stopped in the barn long enough to select a hoe, and then with the
+added implement resumed his journey across the fields. When he came to
+the borders of the woods through which he was to pass, he turned and
+looked back at the house.
+
+Sarah was still standing in the doorway, and as she saw Tom stop she
+waved at him the sunbonnet which she was holding in one hand by the
+strings. Tom waved his "blicky" by way of a return, and then entered the
+woods, which shut out the view of all that lay behind him.
+
+The birds were flitting about in the trees and filling the air with
+their songs. The squirrels darted along the branches, stopping only
+occasionally to chatter at the intruder. High over all he could see a
+fish-hawk and his mate circling in the air, and Tom knew that their nest
+was not far away, and doubtless they were watching him to see that he
+did no harm to their little ones, which by this time must be well grown.
+
+As he came near to a marshy little pond which lay in the centre of an
+open place in the woods, he stopped for a moment when he heard the angry
+notes of a ground thrush near by. He soon saw that the bird was engaged
+in a fierce contest with a water snake which had crawled up the bank and
+doubtless had been endeavoring to make his breakfast upon the
+fledgelings in the nest he had discovered.
+
+Tom watched the contest for a moment, and then advanced to the aid of
+the bird, which was beating the ground with her wings, and occasionally
+darting swiftly at her foe. His approach was instantly seen by the
+snake, which quickly abandoned the contest, and, squirming down the
+bank, slid into the stagnant water; but Tom could still see the head
+which was lifted above the water, and the glittering little eyes were
+intently watching his movements, although the rest of the long slimy
+body was concealed in the pond.
+
+"That's just like Benzeor," said Tom aloud, as he dropped his pail, and
+picking up a stone threw it savagely at the head he could see a few
+yards out from the bank.
+
+The head instantly disappeared, and Tom turned to watch the bird, which
+now was hopping about in the bushes, uttering harsh little notes of
+relief.
+
+"You're all right now, old lady," said Tom. "Go back and tend to your
+babies. I only wish I could serve every crawling thing the way I served
+your enemy."
+
+He soon arrived at the end of his journey, and, placing his gun within
+easy reach, began his task for the day. Why he had put off his
+conversation with Benzeor he could not explain. But the energy with
+which he began his work served to afford a measure of relief for his
+pent-up feelings, and when the noon hour at last came he had done far
+more work than a morning often witnessed.
+
+Once he had stopped suddenly when he thought he heard the report of a
+gun in the distance. The sound had twice been repeated, but it seemed to
+be muffled and far away, and as he resumed his labor he tried to
+persuade himself that it was only Little Peter firing at the blackbirds
+or the thieving crows.
+
+The reports had made him anxious, however, and when he had stopped for
+dinner he had kept his gun near him all the time. The silence served to
+increase his feeling of loneliness. On every side stood the forests; and
+the great trees, which had never as yet felt the stroke of the axe, were
+companions without sympathy.
+
+With a feeling of desperation Tom soon resumed his labors. The sun
+passed over his head and began to sink below the tops of the taller
+trees. He had stopped for a moment to wipe his dripping face and gain a
+brief rest, when he was startled by the sight of some one emerging from
+the forest.
+
+He gazed for a moment intently at the new-comer, and soon recognized
+Sarah. What was the trouble? Her dress had been torn by the bushes, her
+hair had become loose and was streaming down her back. But her
+disheveled appearance was not the worst, for as Tom dropped his hoe and
+ran across the lot to meet her, he saw that her eyes were filled with an
+expression of terror, and her face betrayed the wild alarm which seemed
+to possess the swiftly running girl.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE PARTING OF THE WAYS
+
+
+"WHAT'S wrong, Sarah? What is it? What is it?" said Tom excitedly, as he
+drew near the almost breathless girl. "Has anything happened at the
+house?"
+
+"Oh, Tom!" was all that Sarah at first could say. The reaction from her
+excitement and the swift pace at which she had been running had come,
+and the frightened girl burst into a flood of tears.
+
+Tom looked on in helpless amazement. Sarah was usually such a strong and
+self-contained girl that her present distress was all the more
+perplexing. He looked at her a moment, feeling how utterly unable he was
+to comprehend the state of her feelings and how helpless he was to aid
+or comfort her. Benzeor might be faced; and even Fenton, in spite of the
+fear with which Tom regarded him, might be met; but a weeping girl was
+entirely outside the realm of all his previous experiences, and he stood
+leaning upon his gun, eager to do something to aid Sarah, and feeling a
+deep sympathy for her as he silently watched her.
+
+Perhaps his silence was the very best aid he could offer, for in a brief
+time the resolute Sarah gained control of herself, and lifting her
+tear-stained face to that of the troubled lad by her side she said, "Oh
+Tom, they've killed Little Peter's mother!"
+
+"What!" exclaimed Tom in amazement. "Killed her? You can't mean it! Who
+killed her?"
+
+"Yes, they shot her, and have carried off his father, too."
+
+"I don't understand, Sarah," said Tom more quietly. "Tell me about it."
+
+"Little Peter came over to our house just a little while ago to leave
+the children, and he told us all about it. It seems, he was the lookout
+yesterday down by the Hook and didn't get home till it was almost light
+this morning.
+
+"He said he went up to his room and laid down upon his bed, and must
+have gone to sleep, but he was waked up by the sound of the voices of
+men in the house. He jumped out of bed and listened, and pretty soon he
+heard one of them tell his mother that she must hand over the money she
+had hidden in a stocking up in the garret, and tell where his father
+was.
+
+"She refused to do either, and then Little Peter hurriedly dressed and
+ran down the stairs, but some of the men just grabbed him and held him
+fast so that he couldn't do anything to help his mother. He said the men
+all had masks on their faces except Fenton, for he thinks it was
+Fenton's band that did the work, and he was sure he recognized the
+blacksmith."
+
+"No doubt about that!" exclaimed Tom. "What did they do then?"
+
+"They held his mother while some of them ran up into the garret, and
+pretty soon one of them came back with the stocking. They made quite a
+time over that, and Little Peter thought they wouldn't do anything more,
+but it seems they didn't find as much money in the stocking as they
+expected. Little Peter explained it to me by saying that his mother had
+divided it, and had hidden a part in the garden back of the house and
+left only a part in the stocking.
+
+"For a little time they didn't suspect that, but wanted to know where
+her husband was. Of course she didn't tell them. How could she, when he
+wasn't there? Well, they searched the place high and low. They tore open
+the feather beds, and broke down the walls in two or three places, but
+they couldn't find Peter. Then they went out into the barns and searched
+them, but not a trace of him could they find. They must have been pretty
+angry by that time, for when they came back to the house they told her
+they knew there must be more money than they had found in the stocking,
+and she must tell them where it was.
+
+"Just then one of the children called out that she knew where it was for
+she had seen her mother dig a hole in the ground and put a bag of money
+in it. Two of the men then took the child out into the garden and tried
+to make her show them the place where the money was, but she must either
+have forgotten or else did not know, for the men came back into the
+house more angry than before, and told her mother that she must go with
+them and show them the place.
+
+"Of course she refused, and then Fenton raised his gun and told her he'd
+give her till he could count five, to tell. She didn't say a word, and
+when the blacksmith had counted four he stopped a minute to give her a
+chance to speak. He waited, and as she only shook her head the outlaw
+pulled the trigger and shot her in the breast."
+
+"And killed her?" inquired Tom in a low voice.
+
+"Yes, killed her. The bullet must have struck her heart, for Little
+Peter said she fell dead. They threw the body on the bed and then they
+turned upon Little Peter. He said he thought his turn had come then, but
+at that very minute the guard they had stationed down by the road came
+running into the house, and going up to Fenton whispered something in
+his ear.
+
+"Little Peter didn't know what it was, he said, but in a minute Fenton
+turned to his men and gave them some directions, and they all stopped
+and went out of the house, that is, all except two, who were looking
+after Little Peter and the children.
+
+"In almost no time Little Peter heard some one coming up the lane on
+horseback and stop right before the kitchen door. He heard him jump off
+from the horse, and after a pause of a minute the men all made a rush
+out of the house. Pretty soon they came back, and Little Peter saw that
+his own father was a prisoner in their hands.
+
+"He said his father took on fearfully when he saw his wife dead, and
+what the men had been doing, but in a minute they bound him hand and
+foot, and put a gag in his mouth, and then he was as helpless as a baby
+in their hands.
+
+"Little Peter said he didn't know what was coming next. He thought
+they'd torture him or his father into telling where the money was, or
+would set fire to the house; but before they could do anything the guard
+came running into the house again and called out that some one was
+coming.
+
+"They only stopped long enough to tie Little Peter to the post of the
+very bed on which his mother was lying dead, and then they made a break
+out of the house and took their horses and were off down the lane in no
+time."
+
+"How did you hear about it? How did Little Peter get away?" said Tom
+slowly.
+
+"Why, in a few minutes Indian John came into the house, and he set
+Little Peter free. 'Twas lucky for him that he did, for Fenton might
+have come back, you see."
+
+"And Little Peter came over to your house with the children, then?"
+
+"Yes, he brought them all over, and they're at our house now. But, oh
+Tom, it's dreadful! dreadful! I'm so afraid they'll come to our place
+next, and so I ran out here to get you. Come Tom! Come right away! They
+may be there now!"
+
+Tom hesitated, not knowing just what to do. He was only a boy, and knew
+that alone he could do nothing against Fenton and his band. But the
+appeal of Sarah and the unprotected condition of the children and her
+mother moved him strongly, and his first impulse was to return with the
+frightened girl.
+
+"Sarah," said he abruptly, "where is your father?"
+
+"Why, you know he went away this morning, and he hasn't come back yet.
+He said he might not be back before to-morrow morning. We're all alone,
+Tom, and you must come right away. Oh, it's awful!" And Sarah buried her
+face in her hands again as she spoke.
+
+It was almost upon Tom's lips to tell her what he knew of Benzeor. But
+the misery of the weeping girl before him was even stronger than the
+impression produced by the sad tale she had just related, and he could
+not quite bring himself up to the point of telling her what he
+suspected,--that her own father had been connected with the attack upon
+Little Peter's home. But he had decided now as to the course of action
+he must follow.
+
+"Sarah," said he gently, "there isn't the least danger in the world that
+your house will be attacked. I can't tell you how I know, but I know
+it's so."
+
+"But we're all alone, Tom! I don't know what you mean! We're as likely
+to be attacked as any one. You must go back with me! We must go right
+away, for they may be there now! Poor mother, she was so frightened that
+she didn't want me to leave and come over here for you! Come! We must go
+right back now!"
+
+"Sarah, I'm never going into that house again. You can tell your father
+that I've slept for the last time under his roof."
+
+"Not going back with me?" said Sarah aghast, and looking up in surprise
+as she spoke. "Not going back?" she repeated, as if she did not fully
+understand what Tom had said.
+
+"No, I'm not going back," said Tom firmly. "You know I've been thinking
+a good while of leaving, and after what you've just told me I know the
+time has come."
+
+The color slowly faded from Sarah's face and a different expression came
+into her eyes. Even her alarm was apparently forgotten for the moment,
+and as Tom looked at her, her eyes seemed to snap and a sneer replaced
+the look of sorrow.
+
+"Tom Coward, you're afraid!" she said; "that's what's the trouble with
+you. You're afraid, that's what you are! You'd rather leave mother and
+me alone there with the children than run any risks of meeting the
+blacksmith! I wouldn't have believed it, but my father was right. You're
+a coward by nature as well as by name."
+
+"Sarah"--began Tom, his face flushing at the words of the angry girl.
+
+"Don't 'Sarah' me! I know you now! I never could have believed it,
+never! But I've heard you with my own ears, and now I know it's true!
+You're afraid! You're a coward, that's just what you are! Oh, you're
+well named, you are! Very well, sir, it shall be as you say. Perhaps we
+shall be better off without you than we would with you, for it would
+only make another child for us to look after if you should come back!
+I'll go back home and face Fenton and every one of his band myself! I'm
+afraid, but I'm no coward!"
+
+[Illustration: "TOM COWARD, YOU'RE AFRAID!"]
+
+Turning abruptly away, after giving Tom a glance which he never forgot,
+she started resolutely and swiftly back along the pathway which she had
+followed in her flight to the ten-acre lot.
+
+Tom looked after her in helpless amazement. Never before had he heard
+such an outburst from the gentle and even-tempered Sarah, who had been
+the leading spirit in Benzeor's household. The children had gone to her
+with their troubles rather than to their mother, and Sarah had never
+failed to have a word of comfort or of help for every one. Even Benzeor
+himself had come to depend upon her judgment in many of his affairs, and
+she had been as patient and gentle with him as she had been with the
+troubled little ones.
+
+And to Tom she had been the one true friend he had ever known. Somehow
+she had always understood him, and from the days of their early
+childhood it had always been a matter of pride to him that he was her
+acknowledged champion and protector. Many a time, when he was a sturdy
+little lad, had he taken her part against the tormenting boys in the
+school. For her he had carved quaint and strange looking dolls out of
+horse-chestnuts, and the childish Sarah had never failed to receive
+them with many expressions of pleasure, and had lavished a wealth of
+affection upon them which was almost as pleasing to Tom as to the little
+mother herself. For her he had gathered the chestnuts in the autumn and
+the bright colored flowers in the springtime; and when, with the passing
+of the years, there had come to them both new feelings and new
+interests, he still had shared with her all those dimly perceived
+ambitions and longings which are ever present in the boyish heart when
+it arrives at that position where it can look out upon the time when the
+boy is to become a man.
+
+Perhaps Tom had enjoyed her sympathy and interest the more because of
+the loneliness of his own position. But Sarah never by word or act had
+caused him to feel that he was only Benzeor Osburn's "bound boy," and
+not truly one of the household.
+
+Tom was thinking of some of these things as he watched the departing
+girl, and, forgetting for the moment all the anger and shame which her
+last words had aroused, he called aloud after her.
+
+"Sarah! Sarah!" he shouted. "Wait a minute! Come back! Come back!"
+
+Sarah apparently did not hear him, or heed him if she heard, and without
+once turning her head or looking behind her soon disappeared in the
+forest.
+
+An impulse to follow her seized Tom, and he even ran a few steps after
+her, but quickly stopped. How could he explain himself to her without
+informing upon Benzeor? And then her sorrow would be harder for him to
+bear than her present anger, hard as that was. No; all he could do was
+to remain silent for the time, and trust that in the future some
+explanation might be made which should set him aright once more in the
+estimation of the best friend the homeless boy had ever known.
+
+The departure of Sarah left him face to face with the perplexing problem
+of what he was now to do. To return to Benzeor's house was impossible;
+but where should he go?
+
+Tom stood for several minutes in deep thought. There was no home which
+would now be open to him except Little Peter's, and that had been
+wrecked by the dreadful deeds of Fenton and his followers. Washington's
+army he had heard was at Hopewell, and that was at least forty miles
+away. It was to the army he had ultimately hoped to go, and perhaps the
+present was the very time to which he had been looking forward so long.
+
+The longer he thought about it the more strongly was he impressed with
+the conviction that his best plan would be to try to make his way to
+Hopewell, or to the place to which the army might have moved by this
+time. It was true he was without provisions, and he knew of no place in
+which he would be likely to obtain any, or in which he might find a
+resting-place for a night. Of the long journey he thought but little,
+for a walk even of forty miles had no terrors for him.
+
+Tom decided to start for Washington's army, but first he must stop at
+Little Peter's and learn what his friend's plans were to be, and offer
+him such aid as it lay within his power to give.
+
+The decision once made, Tom picked up his rifle, which now he somehow
+had come to regard as his own property, and started through the forest
+toward the distant road.
+
+When at last he gained it and started towards Little Peter's home, he
+was startled as he saw some one running down the road, and his first
+impulse was to conceal himself in the forest and wait for the stranger
+to pass; but his fears were relieved when he recognized the long lope of
+the runner, and then knew that his old friend Indian John was
+approaching.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+INDIAN JOHN
+
+
+INDIAN JOHN had for years been a frequent visitor in the home of
+Benzeor, as he had in many of the other homes of the region. He was an
+old man now,--how old no one knew, perhaps not even Indian John
+himself,--but he had lingered about old Monmouth long after the
+Schwonnack had taken possession of the lands and his own tribe had
+gradually relinquished their homes and mostly withdrawn from the region.
+
+For months together he would disappear, and no one would know whither he
+had gone, although it was thought that he was on a visit to some of his
+kindred, who had withdrawn farther into the interior of the country; but
+he would soon return and resume his wandering life. At such times,
+Indian John would be restless and uneasy. Perhaps then he realized more
+fully the loss of the homes of his ancestors, and his heart would be
+filled with thoughts he never uttered. He continued to be friendly with
+the settlers, and though he never refused to accept the food which
+almost every housewife was willing to give him, he had never been
+willing to pass a night under a roof. It was commonly reported that he
+used a cave in the woods not far away as his abode, but he never had
+welcomed any one there, nor had any one ever seen the aged Indian in the
+place. Still the report was believed, and "Indian John's cave" was a
+well-known name among the boys of Old Monmouth.
+
+Between Tom and the lonely warrior there had been a very strong feeling
+of sympathy, although not even Tom himself was able to explain it. It
+had come about, however, as the result of an accidental meeting between
+them a few years previous to this time. Tom had gone down to the shore
+one day when a storm had been raging, and the great breakers had been
+rolling in upon the beach.
+
+As the lad had walked on over the sand, he had been surprised to see the
+figure of a man in the distance, standing motionless, and evidently
+watching the tumult of the angry waters. He had not changed from his
+position as Tom approached, and the lad did not know that his presence
+was even recognized by the Indian, who seemed to be absorbed in his
+reflections as he looked out over the tossing waves.
+
+Tom had gone on and at last touched the Indian upon the shoulder. Indian
+John had then slowly turned his head, and Tom knew that his presence had
+been perceived, but for a moment neither had spoken.
+
+Then the aged warrior, with a gesture toward the ocean, had said, "Boy
+no home. Warrior no home. Brothers."
+
+It was the first time Tom had known that Indian John was aware of his
+own early history, and his heart had been deeply touched by the sympathy
+of the red man.
+
+"Boy no home. Warrior no home. Both like waves. Driven here. Driven
+there. No rest. No home. Storm there. Storm here," said the Indian
+laying his hand upon his bosom as he spoke.
+
+From that time, although Indian John never referred to his loneliness
+again, a strong bond of sympathy had existed between the two, and every
+time Tom had seen the old man, he thought of his quiet eloquence in the
+presence of that storm which they both had witnessed from the shore.
+
+And Indian John had been kind and thoughtful to all the white children
+of the region. He had made bows for the boys, and taught them their use,
+and as their skill had increased, his pride was as marked, although it
+had not been as demonstrative, as that of the youthful warriors
+themselves. He had taught them how to make and set their traps for the
+foxes and the rabbits, and how to catch the eels in the river.
+Apparently his happiest hours had been those which he passed with his
+young companions.
+
+Highly as the boys had prized the lessons he had given them, still more
+did they prize the marvelous tales which Indian John could tell. To them
+he told what the waves were saying when they came rolling in upon the
+sandy shore. He knew what the tall trees were whispering when the wind
+swept through their branches and brought the leaves into contact with
+one another. The hoarse calls of the wild geese, when they passed high
+overhead on their long journeys in the spring and autumn, were all known
+to Indian John, and the screams of the eagles and the fish-hawks were
+all in a language which he clearly understood.
+
+He knew, also, all the tales his fathers had told him of the first
+appearance of the Woapsiel Lennape in Old Monmouth, when, in the spring
+of 1524, John de Verrazano, in his good ship The Dolphin, had entered
+Sandy Hook, and had soon after written a long letter to King Francis the
+First of France, and had given a full account of the marvelous
+adventures which had befallen him, and the no less marvelous country he
+had discovered. He had heard, also, of the visit, in the summer of 1609,
+which Sir Henry Hudson had made in The Half Moon, and how that one of
+his crew had fallen as the first victim of the rage of the Indians at
+the invasion of their lands.
+
+The tale which Tom had always enjoyed most, however, was that of the
+origin of the troublesome little pests which, in the warm days of the
+summer, were the torment of the people, for Jersey mosquitoes were not
+unknown in those far-off times of the Revolution.
+
+It seemed that ages before this time, indeed away back in the days
+before John de Verrazano or Henry Hudson had come, or even the memory of
+the oldest warriors could run, the Great Spirit had permitted two huge
+monsters to appear and prey upon the red men of Monmouth as a penalty
+for some crime they had committed, a crime the nature of which Indian
+John did not know, or, if he knew, he never explained.
+
+In size these monsters were larger than any house. They had long slender
+legs which held their huge bodies higher in the air than the tallest
+trees could have done. They also had immense wings, which, although they
+were as fine in texture as the finest silk, were so large and strong
+that when the huge monsters used them they created such a breeze that
+even the strongest trees of the forest fell before them.
+
+Their most distinguishing characteristic, however, was an immense
+"bill," which was as long as the tallest pine-tree and as sharp and
+delicate in its point as that of the smallest needle. With this they
+wrought incalculable destruction and suffering among the helpless
+people. The largest man served only as a single "bite," and the bodies
+of little children seemed only to whet the appetite of these savage
+monsters.
+
+The helpless warriors knew not what to do. They sacrificed, and prayed,
+and besought the Great Spirit to free them from their tormentors, but
+all was without avail. Their prayers were unanswered, and the Great
+Spirit was not appeased.
+
+No man could describe the destruction wrought by the huge tormentors.
+Whole tribes disappeared before them, and it soon came to pass that the
+warriors dared not venture forth in search of food for their starving
+little ones, who were kept concealed in dens and caves of the earth.
+Watchers were stationed to give warning of the approach of the monsters,
+for their great bodies cast shadows upon the earth like those of the
+low-passing clouds on a summer day, and long before they appeared in the
+sky the cry of the watchman sent all within the sound of his voice to
+their places of refuge under the ground. Not even then were they always
+safe, for the monsters could bore into the ground with their bills, and
+often brought to the surface the body of a man, who struggled and kicked
+much after the fashion of a frog impaled on the beak of some long-legged
+heron. The torments of the people increased. The women neglected their
+fields, and the warriors remained in their hiding-places, while the
+frightened children cried for food.
+
+At last, rendered desperate by their sufferings, the warriors of the
+entire region banded themselves together, and one day fell upon the
+monsters as they were lying asleep in a valley which their immense
+bodies almost filled.
+
+The carnage was frightful to behold. All day long the contest was waged,
+and the multitudes of men that fell could not be counted up for numbers.
+But at last the red men were victorious, and when the few remaining
+warriors left the field of battle, their enemies lay stretched upon the
+valley, dead.
+
+Great was the rejoicing among the people. They came forth from their
+hiding-places, and their feastings and songs of victory were continued
+for two entire days. The land was freed from its tormentors, and peace
+and prosperity would now return, or so at least they thought.
+
+Great was the astonishment and sorrow of Indian John's forefathers when,
+upon the third day, they discovered that their troubles were not ended.
+As decay had begun to work upon the dead bodies of the mammoth
+mosquitoes, little particles became loosened, and as they were lifted
+into the air by the summer wind, each tiny and separate atom became
+endowed with life and received a body in shape exactly like that of the
+huge monsters themselves, only they were exceedingly small in size. Day
+after day clouds of these tiny torments were borne away by the breezes
+from the valley of the dead, and, filled with a burning desire to avenge
+the death of their parents, they fell upon the unprotected people.
+
+From these there had been no relief. The camp-fires of the warriors did
+not avail, and although the men went valiantly forth to give them
+battle, their efforts were all futile, and from that day until the
+present time the Jersey mosquito has remained a foe to the red man and
+the white, and ever consumed by the one purpose, to avenge the death of
+the parents, who had fallen years ago in their battle with the
+red-skinned warriors of Old Monmouth.
+
+To Indian John this story of the origin of the pests of New Jersey had
+been eminently satisfactory, and never by word or deed had he shown that
+he had the slightest doubt of the accuracy of the tradition which had
+come down to him through many generations. Tom at first had received the
+account with all the implicit faith of an ardent admirer of Indian John,
+and his first rude shock had come when Benzeor had laughed aloud upon
+his relating the story with all seriousness one morning at the
+breakfast-table. With the passing of the years other doubts as to the
+entire reliability of some of Indian John's stories had crept into his
+mind. Alas that it should be so with us all! But his strong regard for
+the old warrior had never ceased, and Tom's heart was glad that morning
+when he recognized the new-comer as his long-time friend.
+
+"Where have you been, John?" he said, as the Indian approached.
+
+"See Peter."
+
+"Have you seen him?" said Tom eagerly. "Where is he? Has he got away?"
+
+"How?" replied the Indian quickly; and Tom at once perceived from the
+expression upon his face that he was aware of some but not of all the
+recent events in Peter's home.
+
+As he related the story which Sarah had told him, Indian John made no
+reply, although his eyes seemed to blaze as he listened to Tom's words.
+He then explained that he had left the house soon after Tom had departed
+on the preceding night, to intercept Big Peter on the road and give to
+him the warning which his wife had bidden him to carry. But Peter must
+have returned by a different route from that which he had been expected
+to use, and as a natural result Indian John had not seen him, the
+warning word had not been given, and Big Peter had returned to learn of
+the sad death of his wife and to be carried away a prisoner by Fenton
+and his brutal band.
+
+"I don't know just what to do now, John," said Tom. "I want to go and
+join the army. You have been there, and perhaps you would like to go
+back with me."
+
+Indian John had been with the soldiers in Washington's army, but he made
+no reply to Tom's words, and indeed the lad was not certain that he had
+heard, for he stood looking upon the ground and evidently was thinking
+deeply.
+
+"Where Little Peter now?" said the Indian abruptly, looking up at Tom as
+he spoke.
+
+"I don't know. Fenton didn't take him with him, though I don't know why
+he didn't."
+
+"Little Peter home," said the Indian decidedly. "Go see Little Peter."
+
+Tom hesitated. He, too, had longed to go to his friend, not only to
+express his sympathy but also to learn what his plans were to be, for he
+knew that Little Peter would not remain in his home now. Indeed, he
+could not, if he would, after such a scene as that which he had
+witnessed there. But Tom's mind was filled with thoughts of Benzeor, and
+a meeting with him certainly was not very desirable at that time.
+
+"Go see Little Peter," said the Indian again, starting on up the road as
+he spoke.
+
+"All right, I'll go with you," replied Tom, as he joined his companion.
+
+Little Peter's house was not far away, and he would not lose much time
+in going there. It was almost night now, and if his friend should be at
+home they might be able to devise some plan by which they could act
+together. Besides all that, Tom was more than glad to have an
+opportunity to express his sympathy for his friend in his sorrow.
+
+They soon came within sight of the house, and both stopped when they saw
+a little group of people near the garden. Tom knew at once what their
+presence meant, for they were near the spot where two of the members of
+the family had been buried. He had seen the rude wooden headstones which
+marked their graves many times before this.
+
+The few neighbors who had assembled to perform the last rites for Little
+Peter's mother had just returned to the house as Tom and Indian John
+approached. Tom at once went to his friend, and the warm grasp of the
+hand was all he could give. Not one of the children save Little Peter
+was there, and the hurried duties had been hastily performed by kind,
+though rough hands.
+
+The two boys withdrew from the house, and after an awkward silence Tom
+said in a low voice, "What are you going to do now?"
+
+"I'm going to leave the children at Benzeor's house. He has been very
+kind, or rather Sarah has, Tom. And then I'm going to start for Refugee
+Town; I think father may be there."
+
+"Refugee Town?" said Tom in surprise. "Do you think that will be safe?"
+
+Tom well knew the place. It was a spot on the outer beach of the Hook,
+where some of the more desperate refugees, tories and negroes, had
+assembled. A few huts and tents served as their dwelling-places, and the
+men were supposed to be in league with the men on board the boats which
+the British had stationed near by, for a part of Howe's fleet was
+already anchored there, waiting for the coming of Clinton's men.
+Clinton's original plan had been to march across Jersey to New
+Brunswick, there embark his men on the Raritan, and sail away for New
+York; but the rapid march of Washington had caused him to abandon the
+project, and word had been sent for the fleet to be ready for him when
+he should arrive at the Highlands.
+
+Refugee Town had become a familiar name within the past few weeks.
+
+"No, it isn't safe exactly, but I've got to do something for father. If
+he's taken to New York and shut up in the sugar-house I'll go with him;
+and if he's still there at the Town I may be able to do something,
+though I don't know what," said Little Peter sadly.
+
+"But there are the children," protested Tom. "What'll become of them?"
+
+"They're at Benzeor's, and they'll be all right. You'll help look after
+them, won't you?"
+
+"I've left Benzeor's."
+
+"Left Benzeor's? What for?"
+
+"I'm going to join the army. It's time I was doing my share."
+
+Tom gave no other reason. He knew the children would be safe at
+Benzeor's, and with what Little Peter then had it in his mind to do it
+would perhaps be unwise to tell him all he knew. However, he intended
+to tell him all, and that soon.
+
+"Going to join the army?" repeated Little Peter, as if he did not
+comprehend the words.
+
+"Yes; you know I've been thinking of it a long time, and now that
+they're on the march, and coming this way, I've made up my mind that my
+turn has come. I didn't know but you would want to go, too, now."
+
+"I'd like to, but I can't. I've got this other matter on hand. Come into
+the house, Tom, and spend the night with me. You can start in the
+morning as well as now, and besides it's almost dark. You can't go in
+the night."
+
+Tom hesitated, but finally consented, and with his friend went into the
+house which so recently had been the scene of the greatest sorrow which
+had ever entered Little Peter's life.
+
+Indian John followed them, but after his custom refused to remain,
+although he promised to return early in the morning. One of the women of
+the neighborhood had stayed to look after Little Peter's immediate
+wants, but as soon as her duties were done she departed for her own home
+with an eagerness she could not entirely conceal. And Tom did not blame
+her, for he himself was not without fear when at last Little Peter
+closed the doors for the night, and, after having slipped the heavy bars
+into their places, the two boys sought their bed in the low room over
+the kitchen.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+THE YOUNG LIEUTENANT
+
+
+IT was long before daylight when the boys were stirring on the morning
+which followed the events recorded in the preceding chapter. No one had
+disturbed them, and with the return of the day their courage was
+somewhat revived. Tom, however, had decided to start at once for the
+army, which he knew from Indian John's words was not many miles away. He
+was thoroughly familiar with all the roads in the county, for he had
+ridden over them many times in company with Benzeor, or when he had been
+sent on errands to the more remote regions by his foster father, and
+consequently had no fears of losing his way.
+
+Little Peter did not urge his friend to accompany him on his expedition
+to Refugee Town, for he was aware of the perils that were likely to
+beset him on his journey. He would not listen to any of the protests of
+Tom, for he was fully determined to learn what had become of his
+father, and even share his experiences if the occasion demanded. And Tom
+could not find it in his heart to blame Little Peter, hopeless as he
+considered all his efforts likely to be. Perhaps he would do the same
+thing if his own father had been carried away by the pine robbers, and
+he found himself conjecturing how it was a boy would feel in such
+circumstances as those in which his friend had been placed. The feeling
+was one of which he knew nothing by experience, and his own loneliness
+seemed to press upon him with a heavier weight.
+
+However, he still said nothing to Little Peter concerning Benzeor's
+recent actions, for he was well assured that his friend's younger
+brothers and sisters could be in no place where they would so easily
+escape all further troubles for the present as in his foster father's
+house; and then all of Little Peter's plans would be changed at once if
+he knew the part which his neighbor had taken in the tragedy which had
+recently occurred.
+
+"Perhaps Indian John will go with me," said Little Peter. "He'll be a
+great help if he'll go."
+
+"That he will," replied Tom, "and I'm sure he'll be glad to go with
+you. I should like to go myself."
+
+"That's all right, Tom; I know you would, but you couldn't do any good,
+and might only get into trouble yourself. Perhaps I'll be with you in a
+day or two, if I don't hear anything about my father down by Refugee
+Town,--that is, if Benzeor is willing for the children to stay in his
+house. I'll have to look after them, you see, for it's likely I'll have
+to be father and mother, as well as big brother, now," he added sadly.
+
+"I know, I know," said Tom; "but I'm hoping you'll have good luck, and
+if the army really is coming here, it may be that you'll get some help
+from the Continentals if you need it then. Good-by, Peter."
+
+"Good-by, Tom," replied his friend.
+
+Tom placed some bread in his pockets, and then started forth on his
+journey. Somewhere off towards Hopewell the American army must be,
+according to all the reports which had come, and to that place he must
+make his way. The time for which he had been waiting at last had come,
+and with a lighter heart than he had known for days the lad began his
+journey.
+
+The summer morning was clear and warm. The birds were flitting about in
+the trees and filling the air with their songs. In spite of the heat,
+there was a delicious freshness in the early morning air, and as he
+walked rapidly forward he soon came to feel a sense of exhilaration
+which not even the loss and grief of his boy friend could entirely
+banish.
+
+By the time the sun rose red and full in the east, he had placed several
+miles between him and Little Peter's home, but with unabated zeal he
+steadily pushed onward, resolved to make the best possible use of the
+early hours before the more intense heat of the day should come.
+
+By the middle of the forenoon more than ten miles had been left behind
+him, but he was beginning to feel the effects of his exertions. His face
+was flushed and streaming with perspiration. The rough road was hot and
+dusty, for only a single day had been required to dry out all the
+vestiges of the recent storm. He was beginning to feel somewhat tired,
+and was about to stop for a brief rest by the roadside, when he saw some
+one approaching on horseback.
+
+He quickly drew back among the trees which grew close to the road,
+thereby hoping to escape all notice by the stranger; but his plan was
+quickly changed when he discovered, as the horseman came nearer, that he
+was clad in the uniform of the Continental army. His relief was greater
+when he recognized the man as the son of one of Benzeor's neighbors, who
+more than a year before this time had enlisted and had passed the
+preceding winter in Valley Forge.
+
+He quickly resolved to hail the man as he passed, and accordingly
+stepped out into the road and waved his arms as a signal for the
+horseman to stop. The man quickly heeded, and as he drew the rein and
+checked his horse he peered down at the lad by the roadside, and Tom's
+fears were instantly relieved when he perceived that he had been
+recognized.
+
+"Why, Tom Coward, what are you doing here? Nothing wrong over home, is
+there?"
+
+"Yes, there is;" and Tom at once proceeded to give young Lieutenant
+Gordon an account of all that had occurred in the past three days.
+
+"That's bad," said the lieutenant slowly, patting his horse's dripping
+neck as he spoke. "That's bad. I wish I could take a company and go over
+there this minute. I can't, though; it's out of the question. But the
+army will be here shortly now, and there may be a chance to give these
+pine robbers a dose then. Where are you going now, Tom?"
+
+"I thought I'd start for the army," replied Tom. "I've no other place to
+go to, and I've been waiting to join it a long time."
+
+The lieutenant smiled at the lad's words as he replied, "That's all
+right. You're a well-grown fellow, and I doubt not they'll find a place
+somewhere for you in the Jersey militia. There are younger fellows than
+you there."
+
+"So I hear," replied Tom eagerly. "Indian John told me the army was over
+by Hopewell, and had halted there, so I thought I'd put straight for
+that place."
+
+"There isn't very much of the militia there now," said the lieutenant.
+"They're mostly regulars at Hopewell, and I doubt not have started from
+there before this."
+
+"Where are the militia then?" said Tom quickly. "I've got a rifle here,
+and if I'm to join them I want to know where they are."
+
+"That would be a little difficult to say just at present, my lad,"
+replied the lieutenant, assuming a more fatherly air than the
+difference between their years would seem to warrant. "That would be a
+little difficult to say."
+
+As Tom plainly showed his disappointment, the young officer continued:
+"You see it's this way, Tom. It was early in the morning of the 18th
+when the last of General Clinton's forces marched out of the city of
+Philadelphia. They went by the way of Gloucester Point, about three
+miles below Camden, and then the entire force, with Knyphausen and his
+Hessians in advance, marched over to Haddonfield and halted there. We
+had means up at Valley Forge of finding out what was going on, and
+before they were fairly out of Philadelphia some of our scouting parties
+and light horse were in the city, and they gathered in about sixty or
+seventy prisoners and were back again at the Forge with the men and the
+news. By three o'clock that same day General Lee's division had started,
+and by five o'clock General Wayne's had gone, too. They lost no time
+over there, I can tell you."
+
+"But I don't understand," said Tom. "Where are the militia, and what are
+you doing here?"
+
+"That's what I'm explaining to you," replied the lieutenant. "Well, at
+five o'clock the next morning,--that was the 19th of June, you
+know,--Washington had the rest of the army on the march for Coryell's
+Ferry; but the roads were so heavy--for we've been having some great
+rains this month--that the divisions which had been sent out didn't
+cross the Delaware until Saturday morning, and the main body till
+Monday. And all this time the British were mighty careful, let me tell
+you. They thought Washington was after their baggage-wagons and stores,
+you see. Clinton and his main body moved out of Haddonfield on Friday,
+but he left Knyphausen and his Dutch butchers, as well as two brigades
+of the regulars behind him, while he marched eight miles up to Evesham
+and went into camp there. He wanted to keep his train of baggage-wagons
+well protected, you see, for the militia were doing all sorts of
+mischief. You wanted to know where they were. Well, that's where they
+were."
+
+"They're away down at Haddonfield, then, are they?"
+
+"No, no. But they'd been sent out to bother the British, you see, and
+try to hold them back by skirmishes and a few such gentle deeds. They
+were tearing up bridges and firing at the regulars from the woods, and
+doing all sorts of things. Why, when Clinton was marching from
+Haddonfield to Evesham, General Leslie, who was in command of his
+advanced guard, fell in with a party of these very militia I'm telling
+you about. Leslie hid some of his men in a rye-field, and they saw
+Captain Jonathan Beesley. He was a captain in the Cumberland County
+militia, you know, and had been in the army two years,--yes, and he was
+one of the best men we ever had, too, let me tell you. Well, Leslie's
+men saw Beesley and a couple of his officers reconnoitring in advance of
+their companies, and they fired on them. Captain Beesley was wounded,
+and of course they took him prisoner and carried him with them into
+camp. They tried to get him to own up what Washington's plans were, but
+Captain Beesley just stopped them by saying they wouldn't get a word out
+of him. And they didn't; but the next day the poor fellow died from his
+wounds. They'd taken him into Hinchman Haines's house, you see, and that
+was where he died. I understand that they buried him there with the
+honors of war, and I understand, too, that they've given permission for
+the body to be taken up and placed in the Friends' burying-ground down
+at Haddonfield. It may have been done before this, for all that I know.
+Captain Beesley was a good man. The redcoats couldn't do too much for
+him."
+
+"But where are the militia now? That's what I want to know."
+
+"And that's what I'm trying to tell you. This is too hot to be standing
+out here in the road. Let's go into the shade. I've got time enough, and
+it may be a bit safer there, too."
+
+The lieutenant led his horse a short distance into the woods, and,
+slipping the bridle-rein over his head, he permitted him to graze, while
+he himself resumed his story.
+
+"At four o'clock the next morning,--that was Saturday, the
+20th,--Clinton took up the line of march, but he only went seven miles,
+as far as Mount Holly, and there he halted till Monday. On Sunday,
+Knyphausen joined him, having marched by the way of Moorestown. The next
+morning they all marched on to Black Horse and halted again, but at five
+o'clock Tuesday morning they were up and at it once more. They divided
+their forces there a bit, Leslie going by the way of Bordentown,
+Clinton keeping on along the road to Crosswicks, while Grant and the
+Dutch butchers brought up the rear and served as a kind of guard for the
+baggage-train. All this was only yesterday, the 23d, you see."
+
+"But where are the militia now?" protested Tom. "They are the ones I
+want to join, not the British. You keep telling me about them. What I
+want is the other side."
+
+"Listen, then, and you shall hear. Yesterday General Dickinson, with the
+Jersey militia, was right there in Bordentown."
+
+"What! when the British came up?"
+
+"Yes, when the British came up, that is, when Leslie's division did. Not
+all of the militia were there, though. A good many had been withdrawn
+and posted where they could do the most good. There weren't very many
+left in Bordentown, but when they found out that Leslie was almost upon
+them, they made up their minds in very short order that the climate
+there was not the best in the world, so they cleared out and left. But
+before they went they left a few slight tokens of their regard. They
+pulled up the planks of the bridge there over Crosswicks Creek, and
+raised the draw so that Leslie had to find another crossing-place.
+Before they did that they tried to fix up the bridge, but they were
+fired upon, and I understand that four were killed and quite a large
+number were wounded.
+
+"Clinton, too, wasn't finding his road all covered over with roses
+either. About five hundred of our men met him as he came up nearer to
+Crosswicks, and they thought they were ready, but they weren't anything
+of the kind. They had cut down a lot of trees and stretched them across
+the road, but that didn't stop the British. They came on just as if they
+didn't mind marching over such little things as trees, and there was a
+little skirmish there, and two or three of the redcoats were killed. One
+of their officers was shot and they took him up to a house near by, and
+left him there. Of course the Americans couldn't stand there long, but
+they didn't run very far.
+
+"Well, the British divisions joined then and started on again. They came
+to another bridge and our men had it all fixed so that they could just
+let it fall by one or two strokes of an axe. They had one or two little
+cannons there, too."
+
+"Who did? The British?"
+
+"No, our men. You know Sam Clevenger, don't you? Well, he stood there
+on the bridge with his axe in his hands when the British came in sight.
+He'd cut the sleepers almost through, and when he saw the redcoats
+coming, he lifted his axe, and the third time he struck down went the
+bridge and all. Then Clevenger started to run, but the British fired at
+him and he fell dead. They'd shot him in the back of the head. Our men
+then fired their cannon once or twice, but all they hit was the Friends'
+meeting-house. Of course the British didn't mind that, and then our men
+pulled back and left. That was only yesterday. I shouldn't be surprised
+if the British were over here by Allentown or Imlaystown now, or it may
+be both."
+
+"What! not more than ten or fifteen miles away?" said Tom excitedly.
+
+"That's what I say. And they'll be nearer, too, before they're farther
+off, let me tell you."
+
+"Why? How? What do you mean?"
+
+"They'll never go to Brunswick or Amboy, for Washington's right in front
+of them, and ready to head them off. They'll just have to come this way
+or go back, and that they won't do, for 'Britons never retrograde.'
+That's one of their pet words, you know. Isn't that what John Burgoyne
+said, too?"
+
+"I don't know anything about that," said Tom. "Then General Washington
+has been using a part of the militia and a part of the regulars to
+bother Clinton and keep him from getting to Brunswick or Amboy, has he?"
+
+"Yes, that's just it."
+
+"Well, I shan't have very far to go, then, to join them now."
+
+"Oh, you're not going to join them. You're coming with me. You're just
+such a lad as I have been looking for, and you can help me, if I'm not
+greatly mistaken."
+
+As Tom made no reply except to look up in surprise, the young officer at
+once began to explain to him the nature of the task to which he had
+referred.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+THE STORY OF THE MISCHIANZA
+
+
+"I'VE been sent out, as a good many others have been, to look up the
+bridges over the creeks" (the young officer called them "runs," as many
+of the Jerseymen did then, and still do for the matter of that) "and
+find out the lay of the land. As I happened to be born in Old Monmouth,
+and lived here till I was a man grown, it was naturally thought I'd be
+pretty well informed, so you see I was selected for this special work. I
+don't know that I object to it, but I'd rather be back with my men."
+
+"And that's what you've been doing, is it?" said Tom.
+
+"Yes, I've been in that work ever since the British started out from
+Philadelphia. I've kept just a little ahead of the men all the way, and
+have gone back every night to report, and then the next day they'd
+follow all my plans. You see I've got a map of every road in the county
+here," and as he spoke the young lieutenant drew from his pocket a
+paper on which had been traced every road and every little stream in the
+region, while the places where bridges were to be found were indicated
+by red marks.
+
+"Whew!" he added, throwing back his coat. "Isn't it warm! I don't
+believe there's been a summer like this in years. We've had showers and
+thunder-storms almost every day. The air now feels as if we'd get
+another one pretty soon, too."
+
+The air was exceedingly sultry, and a strange stillness seemed to be
+resting over all. Not a leaf was stirring, and as Tom looked up through
+the tops of the trees the bright blue of the sky appeared to be more
+intense than ever he had seen it before. Here and there separate masses
+of heavy clouds could be seen, which, with the sunlight streaming
+through them, glistened almost like silver. He knew the signs well.
+There was the appearance of a coming shower.
+
+"It's too hot to go on," said the young lieutenant. "I'm almost afraid
+to take my horse out in such heat. I've got the most of my work for the
+day done, though, and I thought that perhaps you might be able to help
+me out, Tom. You must know every bridge in this part of the country.
+Now you go over this map with me, and tell me if the places are marked
+right. I've been gone so long I'm not sure of myself, but you ought to
+know. It'll save me a trip in this broiling sun, if you can help me."
+
+Tom took the map and looked over it carefully. He was thoroughly
+familiar with the roads and streams, as the lieutenant had intimated,
+and in a brief time he had given him all the information he possessed.
+
+"There," said the lieutenant at last, folding the paper and restoring it
+to his pocket again, "that helps me out. I'd been over most of the way,
+and the two or three places you have told me about finishes the whole
+thing. I'm ready to go back and report. I think I'll take a bite,
+though, before I start, and wait and see what the weather is likely to
+be."
+
+Going to his saddle-bags the young officer brought out the dinner which
+he carried with him. "Sometimes I stop at some farmhouse and get
+something to eat," he explained, "but it isn't always safe to trust to
+that, you see, so I always go provided. I want you to join me, Tom.
+It'll seem almost like old times."
+
+The horse had been tied to one of the trees, and, as the lieutenant
+seated himself upon the ground, Tom gladly joined him. He was tired and
+hungry, and the piece of bread which he had in his own pocket would
+keep, and, as he was aware that he might find further use for it, he was
+the more willing to accept the invitation which had been given him. For
+a few minutes neither spoke, for they both seemed to be intent upon the
+immediate duty.
+
+As soon, however, as the first pangs of his hunger were relieved Tom
+said, "I never understood just why it was that the British left
+Philadelphia. They'd been there all winter, and after holding the city
+so long I never could understand why it was that they abandoned it
+without even a skirmish. What did they do it for?"
+
+"Why, the way of it was this," replied the lieutenant, taking an
+unusually large bite of the bread he was holding in his hand, as he
+spoke. "You see, we'd been trying for a long time to get up some kind of
+a treaty with France. Ben Franklin, and I don't know who all, had been
+over there trying to work it up, and at last the Frenchmen agreed. Our
+Congress ratified the treaty on the 4th of last May, and that
+completely changed the plans of the redcoats."
+
+"I don't see just how that could do it," replied Tom, somewhat puzzled.
+
+"Why it really means a declaration of war by the French against the
+British. I don't believe the Frenchmen care very much for us, barring
+young Lafayette and a few others of his kind, but they hate the British,
+and took this way to get even with them. It's expected that they'll send
+a fleet over here, and of course the redcoats have got to be ready to
+meet it,--that is, if they can. Well, Philadelphia doesn't amount to
+very much any way in war times. It isn't very easy to get into it, so
+the British there thought they'd better get out and go over to New York,
+which was a good deal more likely to be threatened by the French fleets.
+That's the cause of the change, my lad."
+
+"I should think the redcoats would feel like giving up, now that the
+French are going to join us."
+
+The young officer laughed as he replied: "That's just where you're
+mistaken, my young friend. They don't feel that way after they've sent
+so many armies over here and have spent so much money in discovering
+us, you see. And then, too, they don't object to getting a few taxes and
+such like things out of us, either. I've a dim suspicion that the
+Frenchmen may have just a bit of a dream that they may get back some of
+the country that dropped out of their hands during the French and Indian
+war. But, however that may be, we're glad to have their help now, for we
+need it badly enough, and will have to let the future take care of
+itself."
+
+"I don't see that any one can blame the British for wanting to hold on
+to us. They have spent a lot of money, and lots of their soldiers have
+been killed in the wars with the Indians and the Frenchmen."
+
+"Oh no, we don't blame them," laughed the lieutenant. "We don't blame
+them. It's all natural enough for them to want to hold on to us, but how
+about ourselves? What about the Stamp Act and the tea tax? What about
+all their oppression and the way they've treated us? They seem to forget
+that we're men of like passions with themselves. Oh, it's all natural
+enough for them to want to keep a good hold on us, but it's just as
+natural for us to object to being held on to. And, Tom, such things as
+have happened lately, too! Why, this story about Little Peter's mother
+is only one of a thousand here in Jersey. I've been pretty much all over
+the colony--the state, I mean--and it's the same story everywhere. It's
+just plundering, and robbing, and worse. And then to bring over here
+those Dutch butchers,--that's the worst of it all! To think of hiring
+those butchers! Why, it just makes my blood boil to think of it! And
+against us, too, who are their own blood relatives! That's more than
+human nature can stand!"
+
+Tom felt the contagion of the young lieutenant's enthusiasm, but he made
+no reply, and his companion continued, "The redcoats had a great time
+when they cleared out of Philadelphia. I was there and saw it myself."
+
+"You were there? I thought you were up at Valley Forge all winter!"
+
+"So I was, when I wasn't in Philadelphia. I had to go there sometimes,
+but I never wore my uniform then. Oh no, I didn't think it was very
+becoming to my peculiar style of beauty, so I always left it behind me."
+
+"What were you, a spy?"
+
+"That isn't what we call it," replied the young officer, lowering his
+voice and glancing quickly about him at Tom's words, "Never mind what I
+was, but I was there and that's enough. I'm telling you now about the
+time the redcoats had when Sir William Howe gave over the command to Sir
+Henry Clinton. His officers got it up as a kind of a farewell, you see.
+They called it the Mischianza."
+
+"What's that? I don't understand."
+
+"What, the Mischianza? Oh, that's an Italian word, and means a 'mix up'
+or a 'medley,' or some such thing; I don't know just what. But I'm
+telling you now what it was, and what they did. It commenced with a kind
+of a regatta which they'd arranged in three divisions. Up the river in
+front came the Ferret galley, and on board were some of the general
+officers and their ladies. Then came the Centre galley,--that was called
+the Hussar,--and carried both the Howes and Clinton and their suites,
+along with a lot of ladies. Behind came the Cornwallis galley, in which
+were Knyphausen and some of the British generals, and, of course, a lot
+of ladies.
+
+"Well, sir, they looked fine, I can tell you, for I was in the crowd
+which watched the affair from the shore, and I saw every bit of it. On
+each quarter of the galleys there were five flatboats, all lined with
+green, and having lots of people on board. Then, in front of the
+galleys, were three more flatboats, and a band of music was on board of
+each, and they could play, too, let me tell you, if they were redcoats.
+Six rowed along each flank, and they were all dressed up in bright
+colors, and so were the ships and the transport boats, which made a line
+all the way down to the city. All the wharves were crowded and the
+people were just wild. The boats started out from Knight's wharf--that's
+away up in the northern part of the city, you know--and rowed all the
+way down to Market wharf. There they rested on their oars, the bands
+played 'God save the King,' the people shouted and sang, and I couldn't
+help feeling something of the excitement, though I hate the very sight
+of a redcoat.
+
+"Well, they landed at the Old Fort, and the bands were still playing,
+and the Roebuck fired seventeen guns and then the Vigilant fired
+seventeen more. The grenadiers had been drawn up in a double file on
+shore, and the company then marched up between the lines. They had
+horsemen there, too, and what with the bright dresses of the ladies and
+the bright favors of blue and white ribbons on the breasts of the
+managers, who moved in front of the procession, and the uniforms and
+all, it was a great sight. I should have thought Lord Howe would almost
+have been sorry he was going to leave.
+
+"The avenue led up to a big lawn, which was all fixed up with arches and
+rows of benches, rising one above another, where the ladies were to be
+seated; and then they had some tilts and tournaments, something as they
+used to have in old England. There were young ladies there, too, lots of
+them, and they were all dressed up in Turkish costumes, and such like.
+
+"Pretty soon the trumpets sounded, and then a band of knights, dressed
+in red and white silk, on horses all decked out in the same colors,
+advanced. Lord Cathcart was the chief, and he had squires to carry his
+lances and others to carry his shield, and two black slaves with silver
+clasps on their bare necks and arms held his stirrups. The band then
+marched around the square and saluted the ladies, and then the herald,
+after a great flourish of trumpets, declared the ladies of the Blended
+Rose were ahead of all others.
+
+"When the challenge had been given the third time, some other heralds
+and a trumpeter came in, along with a lot of knights dressed up in black
+and orange, and after going through a lot of motions and the bands had
+played, the herald proclaimed that the Knights of the Burning Mountain
+were prepared to contest the claim of the others. Then the gauntlet was
+thrown down and picked up, and the encounter began.
+
+"After they had met four times, the two leaders, Lord Cathcart and
+Captain Watson, advanced and began a contest between themselves. After
+they had kept it up a little while, the marshal of the field rushed in
+between them, and declared the ladies were all right on either side, and
+commanded the men to stop. Then bands filed off in different directions,
+playing lively tunes and saluting the ladies as they marched.
+
+"Then the whole company marched through great arches to the garden, and
+then up into the hall, which had been painted up to resemble Sienna
+marble. They had a faro table in that room and one great cornucopia all
+filled with flowers and fruit, and another one empty. Then they went to
+the ballroom, which was all painted in pale blue, and there were
+festoons of flowers, and I don't know what all. I never saw anything
+like it before. There were eighty-five big mirrors in the room, and they
+were all fixed out with ribbons and flowers, and as they sent back the
+light from the branches of waxlights, it made the room look bright
+enough, I can tell you. On that same floor they had four drawing-rooms,
+where they got their refreshments, and these rooms were all decorated
+and lighted up, too.
+
+"They kept up the dancing till ten, and then the fireworks began and the
+windows were all thrown open. I remember that the first of the fireworks
+was a great bouquet of rockets,--but that was only one, and they kept it
+up till twelve o'clock.
+
+"When midnight came, the great folding doors, which had been all covered
+over with flowers so that no one knew they were there, were thrown open,
+and there was a great room all decorated and lighted up, most too
+wonderful to tell about; and there, too, was a great table, which they
+said had twelve hundred dishes on it--just think of that, will you?--and
+four hundred and thirty people could sit down to the table at the same
+time.
+
+"They had supper then, and when they had finished that part of the
+programme the herald and trumpeters entered and proclaimed the health of
+the king and the royal family. Of course all the people there responded,
+and then there was a toast for the knights, and the ladies, and lots of
+others, and there was a great flourish of trumpets as each toast was
+announced.
+
+"Then they all went back to the ballroom and began to dance again. They
+kept it up till four o'clock, and I don't know how much later, for I
+left then."
+
+"And you saw it all?" said Tom slowly.
+
+"Yes, almost every bit of it; 'twas a great sight, too. The like of it
+has never been seen before on this side of the water, and never will be
+again, I'm thinking. By the way, Tom, I heard a man there called by your
+name. It was Captain Coward, I think--though it may have been colonel or
+judge; I don't just recollect."
+
+"I'm sorry for him."
+
+"You needn't be. Just show that the name's of no account. But I've got
+to start now. I wish I could take you with me, but I can't. I'll see you
+soon, though, so good luck to you till we meet again."
+
+"But it's raining," said Tom quickly, as the patter of the falling
+drops could be heard on the leaves.
+
+"Can't stop for that; I'm due at five o'clock, rain or no rain. Good-by
+to you, Tom, and thank you for your help. You've saved me a hard ride in
+such a day as this!"
+
+The young lieutenant was gone, and Tom waited for the shower to pass.
+The rain continued only a few minutes, but left the air still more
+sultry than it had been before, and walking became much more difficult.
+
+However, Tom started on as soon as the rain ceased, and kept steadily to
+his work until the sun was low in the heavens. His thoughts had been
+withdrawn, in a measure, from the camp at Hopewell, and he was thinking
+of the description which the young lieutenant had given of the
+Mischianza, and the brilliant scene which it must have presented. What
+could the poor and desperate Continentals do against men who had feasts
+like that? And Captain, or Colonel, Coward, who was he? Tom found
+himself thinking of the man, and wondering how he came to have the name.
+
+He turned the bend in the road and saw a band of soldiers marching
+directly toward him, and not far away. Startled by the sight, he
+stopped a moment and gazed intently at them, striving to discover
+whether they wore red coats or buff; but they were covered with dust and
+he could not decide.
+
+He quickly realized that he must act, and he had just turned about,
+prepared to run back in the road, when he heard several shots fired at
+the approaching men from the woods by the roadside.
+
+The band instantly halted and prepared to defend themselves. Without
+waiting to watch the contest, he once more turned to run, when he
+obtained a glimpse of men behind him, partially concealed among the
+trees and standing with their guns raised to their shoulders, and with
+their attention fixed upon the advancing soldiers.
+
+Were the men friends or foes? Tom could not determine; and, trembling
+with fear and excitement, he stopped. He was between the opposing bands,
+while off on his right it was evident that other men were concealed.
+Thoughts of the Mischianza and of the captain with the unfortunate name
+were all gone now. He could not advance; he dared not retreat.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+TO REFUGEE TOWN
+
+
+WHEN Little Peter reëntered the lonely house after his friend Tom
+departed, the full sense of his own sorrow for the first time swept over
+him. Up to this time the necessity of action had prevented him from
+fully realizing his loss. The death of his mother, the capture of his
+father, the provision he was compelled to make at once for his younger
+brothers and sisters, had so absorbed his thoughts that he had had but
+little time to dwell upon his own sorrow.
+
+With the departure of Tom, however, there came the reaction, and for a
+few moments the heartbroken lad was almost overcome. The very silence
+was oppressive. The only sound he could hear was the loud and regular
+ticking of the tall clock which stood in one corner of the kitchen. How
+proud his mother had always felt of that ancient timepiece! Many a time
+had she told him of its history and the pride with which she had
+received it from her own father, when as a young bride she had first
+entered the new house which henceforth was to be hers. To Peter, it
+almost seemed as if the stately clock had been a member of the family,
+and its voice was almost human to him. On the summer afternoons, when he
+was a little fellow and his mother had been busied in her household
+duties, he had often stretched himself upon the sanded floor, and,
+resting his face upon his hands, with eager eyes had gazed up into the
+face of the old timepiece and listened to the swing of its long
+pendulum, which for him had had a language all its own.
+
+And now in the light of the early morning the old clock still stood in
+the corner and regularly ticked off the passing hours, as if it were
+unmindful of all the sad scenes to which it had recently been a witness.
+And yet to Peter it almost seemed, too, as if there was a tone of
+sadness after all in the monotonous tickings that day. Perhaps the old
+clock was striving to express its sympathy for the sorrowing boy, but
+not even its sympathy must be permitted to interfere with its duty in
+marking the passage of the swiftly flying minutes.
+
+The few antiquated chairs were standing just as they had stood when his
+mother had been there. The brass-rimmed mirror, the one ornament of the
+room, which hung over the low mantelpiece, reflected the scene before
+it, but in all the picture one figure was wanting and would be
+forevermore. Overcome by the full knowledge of his loss, Little Peter
+bowed his head upon his hands and leaned low upon the table, and burst
+into a flood of tears--the first he had shed since the sad event had
+occurred. Indian John was forgotten, the few chores about the place were
+ignored, and for a time the heartbroken lad gave way to his sorrow for
+the loss of his mother, upon whose face he never was to look again.
+
+How long he remained in that attitude he did not know, but he was
+recalled to the necessities of the present by the sound of footsteps
+outside the door. His first thought was that Indian John had returned,
+and he hastily rose to greet him; but quickly he perceived that the
+new-comer was not his Indian friend, but Barzilla Giberson, one of his
+nearest neighbors. If Little Peter had looked carefully into his
+neighbor's face, he would doubtless have noticed that the man was
+evidently somewhat troubled, and apparently was not overjoyed at the
+prospect of an interview; but the lad was too busied with his own
+thoughts and sorrows to bestow a critical examination upon a neighbor's
+countenance, and Barzilla's evident uneasiness, therefore, was all
+passed by unnoticed.
+
+"Good-morrow to you, Little Peter," said Barzilla. "The women folks
+wanted me to come over and say to you that you were welcome to make your
+home with them, if you so chose."
+
+"Thank you, Barzilla," replied Peter. "If I were going to stay here I
+should be glad to do that, but I'm going away this morning."
+
+"Sho! Ye don't say so! Where ye goin', if I may be so bold as to ask?"
+
+"I'm going to look up my father."
+
+"Where ye goin' to look him up?" said Barzilla, somewhat uneasily.
+
+"I'm going down to Refugee Town first. I don't know what I'll do if I
+don't find him there."
+
+"Ye won't find him there," said Barzilla quickly. "In course I don't
+know where he is," he hastily added, "but I don't b'lieve ye'll find him
+there; and, besides, that's no place for a lad like you to go to alone,
+for I take it ye're goin' alone?"
+
+"Yes, I'm going alone," replied Peter, to whom Barzilla's anxiety was
+not apparent.
+
+"In course it isn't for me to say what ye shall do and what ye shan't,
+but I don't believe a trip there will do ye any good. Ye've got to
+remember that other folks has suffered, too. Yer marm isn't the only one
+that's been shot, and yer pop isn't the only man that's been carried off
+by the British."
+
+"It wasn't the British that carried my father away," said Peter quickly.
+
+"'Twan't the British? Who was it then, I'd like to know?"
+
+"'Twas Fenton and his band, that's who it was."
+
+"Sho! I can't believe that! I reckon ye're mistaken, Peter. It must 'a'
+been the redcoats."
+
+"It was Fenton," repeated Peter decidedly.
+
+"I can't b'lieve it," said Barzilla, rising as he spoke. "I can't
+b'lieve it. However, Peter, we'll look after yer place. The women folks
+or I will do the chores for ye, while ye're gone. It's only neighborly,
+ye know, and what's friends good for if they can't help in a time like
+this?"
+
+"Thank you," said Peter quietly. "There isn't much to be done, but if
+you'll look after what there is, I shall be glad. The children are at
+Benzeor's house, you know."
+
+"So I hear. So I hear. Well, they're in good hands; ye can rest easy
+about that. Well, I must be a-goin'. Ye still think ye'd better go down
+to Refugee Town, do ye?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, good luck to ye. Good luck to ye. We'll look after the place,"
+called Barzilla as he departed.
+
+If Peter had gone to the door, he would have discovered that Barzilla
+had not departed to go to his own house, but that after he had entered
+the road he had turned quickly and started in the direction in which the
+Navesink lay. But as Peter did not rise from his seat, he missed all
+that, and, besides, in all probability he would only have been puzzled
+by his neighbor's actions and unable to account for the haste with which
+he had made the change.
+
+Peter prepared his breakfast, and then waited for the coming of Indian
+John. The minutes passed, but the Indian did not put in an appearance,
+and the lad began to suspect that he would not return. At last, when the
+sun had appeared, his suspicions passed into certainty, and, resolving
+to wait for him no longer, he closed the house and started resolutely
+on the path which led down to the bank of the Navesink, where he kept
+his little skiff concealed.
+
+He soon arrived at the familiar place, and, after taking his oars from
+their hiding-place on the bank, pushed the little boat out into the
+stream and began to row. The heat of the morning soon began to make
+itself felt, but Peter did not cease from his labors. He was thinking of
+his father and where he might then be. He was hoping that he would be
+retained and sent to New York as a prisoner, for Little Peter was well
+aware of the value of the reward which was offered for every prisoner
+taken; but Fenton, eager as he was for money, was not likely to incur
+any unnecessary risk for himself by keeping any one near him who might
+prove to be a source of danger. And Little Peter knew that his father,
+especially after the recent events, was not likely to be quiet. Of what
+might then occur, the lad hardly dared to think. He only knew that what
+he was to do must be done quickly, if it was to avail, and he rowed on
+and on without once stopping for rest.
+
+He had covered about half the distance he was to go, when he heard a
+hail from down the river. Hastily turning about at the unexpected
+summons, he saw a little cat-boat slowly coming up the river, and now
+not many yards away.
+
+"It's Benzeor Osburn," said Peter to himself, as he obtained a glimpse
+of the man at the helm. "But who's that with him? It's Jacob Van Note.
+Yes, and that's Barzilla Giberson, too. What in the world"--
+
+His meditations were interrupted by Benzeor's hail, "Where ye bound this
+mornin', Little Peter? There's to be no lookout to-day, is there?"
+
+"I haven't heard of any," replied Peter, looking at Barzilla and
+striving to understand how it was that the man who had so recently left
+his house could now be with Benzeor sailing up the Navesink.
+
+"I came down here after I left you," said Barzilla, as if he felt that
+he must reply to the question expressed in Peter's manner, "and I fell
+in with Benzeor, so I stopped and came back to tell him all about the
+doin's that have been goin' on since he went away. Benzeor's been gone
+from home two days and more, ye know."
+
+"Has he?" replied Peter. "No. I didn't know. Benzeor, the children are
+at your house. Sarah said I could leave them there and she'd look after
+them. If it isn't all right, I'll take them away as soon as I come
+back."
+
+"It's all right. In course it's all right. Barzilla here has been
+tellin' me about your troubles. It's hard, Peter, but then ye know that
+lots of people have been served the same way. 'Misery loves company,' ye
+know."
+
+As Peter made no reply, Benzeor quickly began to talk again, too quickly
+the lad might have perceived, if he had not been so filled with his own
+thoughts that all else seemed to escape his observation. "Barzilla tells
+me as how ye're goin' down to Refugee Town to look up yer pop. Is that
+so?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, I'm tellin' ye it won't do any good. He isn't there--leastwise,
+that is, I don't believe he's there. In course I don't know anything
+about it, but it stands to reason he isn't. Ye'd better let me take yer
+skiff in tow, as I've done with Barzilla's, and come along back with
+us."
+
+"I think I'll go on. If I don't find him there I can report to Captain
+Dennis. Perhaps he'll be able to help me a bit, if it's not too late."
+
+Captain Dennis was in command of the local militia, and he and his men
+already had had several skirmishes with the pine robbers. Indeed, the
+militia had been enrolled with the very purpose of protecting the
+scattered homes from the inroads of the outlaws and refugees. Thus far,
+however, their efforts had not met with a very marked success.
+
+Peter did not observe the scowl which crept over Benzeor's face at the
+mention of the name of Captain Dennis. "Have it your own way then," said
+the man gruffly. "They say there's no fool like an old fool, but for
+downright foolishness give me the young fool every time. I'm tellin' ye
+that ye won't find yer pop down at Refugee Town, but ye'll have to find
+it out for yerself, I suppose."
+
+Surprised as Peter was at the abrupt change in Benzeor's manner, his own
+purpose was not changed, and without replying he picked up his oars and
+began to row again. He could see the men in earnest conversation as he
+drew away from them, but it had not yet entered his thoughts that
+anything could be wrong with them. He was puzzled to account for
+Barzilla's unexpected presence, but his offer to look after his home in
+his absence was still fresh in his mind, and left no room for suspicion.
+
+As for Benzeor, Little Peter knew that he was considered as a strange
+man,--"odd," the country people termed it,--and he gave little heed to
+him or his words. His one purpose now was to go to Refugee Town. He had
+but little fear of meeting the men who had assembled there, although he
+knew they were all desperate and reckless. They would not harm him, he
+thought, and it was possible that he might find his father there, or
+learn of his whereabouts. Just what he would do if he should find him,
+he did not know. In any event, he would be with him again, and if he was
+to be sent as a prisoner to the sugar-house in New York, or to the
+Whitby or the Jersey, at least his captivity might be shared.
+
+Accordingly, Little Peter rowed steadily forward and in the course of an
+hour arrived at the mouth of the Navesink. Then he landed and hauled his
+skiff up on the shore, striving to conceal it among the bushes which
+grew there. It was only a mile now across the sandy strip to the shore
+of the ocean, and the lad began to walk rapidly. Refugee Town was not
+far away, and the end of his journey would soon be gained.
+
+The heat of the sun was now intense. Across the sands he could see
+eddies in the heated air, and he felt as if he were breathing the blasts
+from an oven. His face was streaming with perspiration, while the touch
+of the sand beneath his feet seemed almost as if it would blister them.
+
+He soon arrived at a place from which he could look out upon the ocean,
+and it was with a sigh of relief he felt its first cool breath upon his
+face. Refugee Town now was not far away, so he began to run.
+
+He stopped as he saw two gunboats riding at anchor about a quarter of a
+mile out from the shore. What could it all mean? They were British
+vessels, their flags disclosed that; but what was their purpose in
+casting their anchors there?
+
+He was upon the beach now, and stopped for a moment to gaze at the
+graceful vessels. He thought he could almost make out the figures of the
+sailors on the deck. And a little boat was just approaching the larger
+of the gunboats. Doubtless it had been ashore and was now returning.
+
+"How!"
+
+Peter turned suddenly as he heard the exclamation, and saw Indian John
+standing before him. His alarm subsided as he recognized his friend, and
+he said reprovingly, "I thought you were going to go with me this
+morning, John. Why didn't you?"
+
+"John been. Go to 'Gee Town. No fader there."
+
+"What, my father isn't there? Are you sure, John?"
+
+The Indian made no reply, evidently considering his first words
+sufficient. He was gazing intently at the boats in the distance, and
+Little Peter almost unconsciously turned and followed his look. At first
+he could discover nothing to indicate what had interested his companion;
+but he soon saw that the little boat, which he had thought was returning
+to the gunboat, was coming to the shore. Startled by the sight, he was
+about to inquire of John whether he knew anything concerning the
+vessels, when he heard a shout.
+
+At a distance of a hundred yards up the beach he saw a motley crowd
+approaching. Negroes and poorly clad men were among them, and the
+appearance of all revealed that they were doubtless from Refugee Town.
+
+Their own presence was discovered at the same time, and a shout greeted
+them.
+
+"Come!" said Indian John quickly; and in an instant Little Peter obeyed,
+and both were running swiftly over the sand along the beach.
+
+Their flight was greeted by another shout from the men behind them, and
+one or two guns were discharged, but the bullets passed harmlessly over
+the heads of the fugitives. One glance, however, showed Peter that some
+of the men had started in pursuit.
+
+"They're after us, John!" he said in a low voice to his companion.
+
+Instantly increasing their efforts, they sped swiftly on in their
+flight, but the shouts, which were now redoubled, betrayed that the
+pursuit had not been abandoned. On and on ran pursuers and pursued,
+while at intervals a gun was discharged and the calls and shouts could
+be distinctly heard.
+
+[Illustration: "THEY'RE AFTER US, JOHN!"]
+
+For a half mile the flight had continued, and Peter was beginning to
+feel that he could go no farther. The hot air of the summer morning, the
+burning sand beneath his feet, as well as the weariness arising from his
+previous exertions, combined to sap his strength. His breath was coming
+in gasps now, and down his face the perspiration was pouring in
+streams. He felt that he could go no farther.
+
+Another glance behind him showed that the men had not abandoned the
+pursuit. A half dozen of them were still running swiftly along the
+beach, and to Little Peter it seemed as if they were gaining upon him.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+BATHSHEBA'S FEAST
+
+
+INDIAN JOHN had been slightly changing the direction in which they were
+running, although Little Peter had not perceived the change. At first
+they had kept close to the water's edge, and at times the creeping tide
+had rolled up to their feet. As his companion had gradually drawn closer
+to the higher ridge which extended somewhat farther back from the beach,
+Peter had thought nothing of the slight divergence, except that the
+Indian was desirous of keeping a little farther from the water.
+
+Along this ridge in advance of him, Peter saw that thick bushes and
+stunted trees were growing, and he thought of the possibility of finding
+some hiding-place there; but he was hardly prepared for the change which
+Indian John then made. They had just passed a bend in the ridge which
+shut out the view of their pursuers, and come to a little gully which
+the winter storms had in the course of many years cut deep into the
+bank. Here Indian John turned sharply, and, bidding his companion follow
+him, turned directly into the woods, which extended from the shore far
+back into the adjoining country.
+
+Little Peter instantly followed, but they had not gone many yards before
+they came suddenly upon a wigwam in the midst of the forest. Indian John
+stopped, and, after a few hurried words with the Indian who was standing
+near and who had silently watched the approaching fugitives, beckoned
+for Peter to follow him, and both entered the conical shaped dwelling
+and threw themselves upon the ground.
+
+The lad was so thankful for the respite, and was so nearly exhausted by
+his efforts, that for a time he said nothing, being only too glad of an
+opportunity to rest. Every moment he expected to hear the voices of
+their pursuers, and more than once was on the point of starting forth
+from the hut and resuming his flight, so certain was he that the men had
+discovered the hiding-place.
+
+After a time he was positive that he was not deceived. He could hear the
+voices of men in conversation with the Indians, and all of his fears
+returned. His companion placed his hand upon the arm of the trembling
+lad, and Peter waited, listening intently, and fearful every moment that
+some one would enter the hut and summon them to come forth.
+
+The conversation lasted several minutes, and then abruptly ceased. Peter
+could not determine whether the strangers had departed or not; but he
+waited anxiously and did not speak.
+
+The moments slowly passed and his suspense increased. It seemed to him
+that he must escape from the place in which he was concealed. The very
+air was strangely oppressive, and the ignorance as to what was going on
+outside the wigwam increased the anxiety of the frightened boy.
+
+He did not know where he was, nor who were the people whose abode Indian
+John had so unceremoniously entered. No voice within or without the hut
+could now be heard, and the silence itself added to his alarm.
+
+He could see that Indian John was seated upon the ground with his head
+resting upon his knees. He had not moved nor changed his position since
+they had entered. Motionless as a statue he remained seated, as if he
+were utterly unmindful of all about him.
+
+"John!" whispered Little Peter at last.
+
+The Indian raised his head and looked at his companion, but did not
+speak.
+
+"John, don't you think we'd better start on again?"
+
+Indian John still made no reply, and his head dropped again upon his
+knees. Peter then perceived that his companion intended neither to speak
+nor to depart, and that he must wait in silence for him to explain his
+purpose, or to act.
+
+The impatient lad endeavored to possess his soul in patience, but as the
+moments passed his anxiety and fear increased. The uncertainty, he
+thought, was even more difficult to be borne than was the pursuit
+itself, for action of some kind was then possible, while this waiting in
+silence was almost unbearable. Not a sound could now be heard. The very
+birds were silent under the burning heat of the noontime, and the
+grating notes of the crickets had ceased.
+
+At last it seemed to him he could bear it no longer, and he was about to
+arise and go forth from the hut, regardless of consequences, when some
+one entered and spoke a few words in an unknown tongue to Indian John.
+
+"Come," said the Indian gently, standing erect as he spoke; and Little
+Peter at once followed him out into the open air.
+
+He glanced quickly about him, but no one was to be seen except three
+Indians, one of whom was a man, and the others, two women. Little Peter
+instantly recognized them as Moluss, or "Charlie" Moluss, as many of the
+whites called him, and his wife and her sister.
+
+The two women were busily engaged in preparing the contents of a small
+iron vessel, which was hanging from a stick supported by two forked
+branches, driven into the ground, and beneath which a brisk fire was
+burning.
+
+One of the women was feeding the fire, while the other was stirring the
+contents of the hanging pot. A savory odor greeted Little Peter's
+nostrils, and as soon as he perceived that he was in no immediate danger
+he realized that he was hungry; and, with the passing of his alarm,
+there came an eager interest in the occupation of the two women before
+him.
+
+Little Peter had seen the trio many times before this. They had their
+home with others of their tribe in a little settlement several miles
+back in the interior. This settlement was commonly known as Edgepelick,
+or Edge Pillock, and to it the Indians had gradually withdrawn after
+they had disposed of their lands, for the good people of Old Monmouth
+were as scrupulous as their New England cousins in not taking the lands
+from the dusky owners without giving a so-called equivalent for them.
+
+It is true that this "equivalent" sometimes was a barrel of cider, or a
+piece of bright-colored cloth; but perhaps the Indians thought that was
+better than nothing, and as their lands were certain to be taken from
+them, even such an equivalent as that which was offered was not to be
+despised, and so they had submitted to the unequal exchange. At all
+events, the exchanges had been made, and in the summer of 1778, many of
+the Indian families were dwelling in Edge Pillock, and there continued
+to reside until the year 1802, when the men who had driven such shrewd
+bargains with them caused them all to be removed to Oneida Lake, in the
+neighboring State of New York.
+
+Charlie Moluss, with his wife and her sister, had been frequent visitors
+in Little Peter's home, and he knew them almost as well as he did Indian
+John. Somehow, they had not been content to abide continuously in Edge
+Pillock, and at least twice each year came down to the shore, where they
+erected a wigwam, and while Moluss fished and gathered oysters and
+clams, the women made baskets and sold them among the scattered homes of
+the settlers. Doubtless this, then, was their annual visit, thought
+Little Peter, and their abiding place had been known to Indian John, who
+had sought its shelter as a place of refuge from their pursuers. And
+Little Peter was quite content, at least for the present, and his
+feeling of relief was not diminished by the savory odor which now arose
+from the iron vessel.
+
+Charlie Moluss's wife was a strikingly handsome Indian woman, and was
+known as Bathsheba, which the irreverent settlers had shortened into
+"Bath," as they had her sister's name into "Suke."
+
+Bathsheba was considered as an Indian queen, and the respect which the
+Indians showed her was, to a certain extent, shared by the white people,
+especially by the Quakers. She was regarded as a highly intelligent
+woman, and the most prominent people of the region were always glad to
+welcome her to their homes.
+
+Little Peter thought of all these things as he seated himself upon the
+ground beside the two men, who were, apparently, as deeply interested in
+the occupation of the women as was he, himself. The work went steadily
+on, and, while Peter found that his hunger was increasing, he
+nevertheless listened to what Indian John told him of Moluss's success
+in turning their pursuers back to their camp at Refugee Town. Some of
+them had followed the fugitives as far as the wigwam, but had turned
+away after the Indian had professed his inability to give them the
+information they desired, and, doubtless, before this time, were safely
+back in "'Gee Town," as Indian John termed their little settlement by
+the Hook.
+
+Just why they had been pursued Indian John could not explain, but he had
+connected it in some way with the appearance of the boat off the shore,
+and Little Peter was not inclined to differ from his conclusion. He was
+satisfied now that his father was not to be found in Refugee Town, and
+he had decided to go farther down the shore to the place where he
+thought he would be likely to find Captain Dennis, or some of the local
+militia who had been stationed near to protect the salt works and
+strive to hold back the pine robbers, many of whom had their places of
+concealment not far away.
+
+Just at present, however, the thought of his dinner was uppermost in his
+mind. He eagerly watched Bathsheba and her sister in their work, and,
+from their movements, he concluded that his waiting time was soon to
+end. One of the women entered the wigwam and brought out several small
+wooden bowls. Into these she dipped some of the steaming contents of the
+iron vessel, placing each bowl upon the ground when it had been filled.
+
+A word from Bathsheba caused Moluss to arise, and, approaching the fire,
+he took one of the bowls in both hands and then seated himself upon the
+ground and proceeded to blow with his breath upon the soup, preparatory
+to drinking it.
+
+His example was speedily followed by Indian John and Little Peter, who
+took their bowls and seated themselves beside Moluss on the ground. An
+expression of deep satisfaction was manifest upon the faces of the two
+men, while the women, apparently proud of their success in the culinary
+art, looked on with evident pleasure. Little Peter also raised the bowl
+in his hands and blew upon it.
+
+"Good!" said Moluss, taking a long draught. "Good hop! Hop good!"
+
+"Good!" muttered Indian John, following his friend's example. "Good hop!
+Good hop!"
+
+"What?" said Little Peter suddenly, placing his bowl again on the ground
+before him as he spoke. "What was that you said, John?"
+
+"Good! Good hop," replied the Indian, with evident satisfaction.
+
+"You don't mean to say that hop-toads are in this soup, do you?"
+
+"Um!" replied Indian John, with a grunt of pleasure. "Good! Little
+hop-hop! John like um! Good hop! John like um little hop-hop!" And,
+suiting the action to the word, he proceeded to take a deeper draught of
+the savory mixture.
+
+All of Little Peter's hunger, however, had disappeared. He quickly arose
+from his seat, and, with an expression of disgust upon his face, which
+he could not entirely repress, prepared to pass the group and go into
+the forest.
+
+A loud laugh greeted his action, and as he passed Moluss, the Indian
+held forth his bowl, and said, "Peter like um hop-hop? Good! Moluss like
+um hop-hop! John like um hop-hop! Squaw like um hop-hop! All like um
+hop-hop! All like um hop-hop! Peter like um, too?"
+
+Little Peter was not to be tempted, and the broad grin upon the faces of
+the women, as well as the loud laugh of the men which followed him as he
+turned into the forest, did not tend to overcome his feeling of disgust.
+How was it possible that they could be willing to eat such filthy
+creatures as hop-toads? Little Peter was all in ignorance of some of the
+dainty viands which, under high-sounding names, are served up in our
+modern restaurants, and so, as a matter of course, could draw no
+comparison between the tastes of the rude, uncivilized savages and those
+of the more highly cultivated men of our own times. Perhaps he would not
+have compared them if he had been possessed of the prophet's foresight.
+He knew, however, that his own hunger had disappeared, and as he walked
+on he found many excuses for his uncivilized friends. They were welcome
+to their own customs, but they must not expect him to join them in their
+feasts.
+
+He had gone so far from the wigwam by this time that he thought the
+repast, which had so highly delighted his friends, would be ended by
+the time he could walk back. Accordingly, he reversed his steps, but as
+he walked on his own pressing problem returned in full force.
+
+His father was not to be found in Refugee Town, of that he felt certain;
+for, while Indian John had not said much, he knew him so well that he
+was satisfied he had known whereof he had spoken.
+
+Where, then, could he be? It was currently reported that Fenton's band
+had a place in the lower part of the county, to which they carried their
+booty and from which they started forth on their raids. It was just
+possible that his father had been taken there by the outlaws in their
+flight, but he would not long be retained there. Fenton knew what
+American prisoners were worth in the New York market, and, doubtless, he
+would find some means by which he could send him there. And the pine
+robber would act soon, too, for with the approach of the armies, there
+would be many opportunities for his own special work, and he would not
+long be hampered by the presence of a single prisoner, whose value would
+be slight compared with that of the plunder he might secure.
+
+Little Peter decided that what he was to do he must do quickly. He
+would start at once for the place where Captain Dennis's men were said
+to be, and place the entire matter in their hands. The captain was a man
+whose bravery was well known in Old Monmouth, and he was ever ready to
+aid the scattered settlers.
+
+Captain Dennis would surely help him, too, Peter thought, and, with his
+heart somewhat lightened, he began to walk more rapidly. He would return
+to the wigwam and inform Indian John of his decision. If John would go
+with him, he would be glad of his aid, but, whether he went or not, the
+lad felt that his own problem was, in a measure, already solved.
+
+"Little Peter, is that you?"
+
+The startled lad looked up quickly at the unexpected summons, and saw,
+standing directly in his pathway, nine men. Each had a musket in his
+hands, but they wore no uniforms, and for a moment Little Peter could
+not determine whether they were friends or foes.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+WITH THE REDCOATS
+
+
+THE fear in Tom Coward's heart, when he discovered that he was between
+the lines of the soldiers, made him almost desperate. The men before him
+already had raised their guns, and at any moment he expected to hear
+their report. When he had glanced behind him he had seen that the men
+there were also prepared to shoot, and he was in a position where he was
+likely to receive the discharges of both sides.
+
+Along by the side of the road was a deep ditch, which had been worn by
+the spring floods. Just at present there was no water in it, and Tom
+instantly threw himself upon the ground, and, still grasping his gun,
+rolled toward the place. As he slipped over the side he heard the
+discharge of the guns, and his heart almost stood still in his terror.
+The bullets, however, had all gone over his head, and the lad was
+unharmed, although he was so frightened that even the thoughts of his
+own personal safety were almost driven from his mind.
+
+Shouts and calls followed the discharge of the guns, and then there was
+a rush of men past the place in which he was lying. From the direction
+from which the men had come, Tom concluded that those who were behind
+him had fled, and that the others were in swift pursuit of them. He did
+not dare to raise his head, nor try to obtain a glimpse of the
+combatants, but lay still in his hiding-place, hoping that in the
+excitement his presence would not be discovered. The shouts continued,
+but as they sounded farther and farther away, the trembling lad
+concluded that pursuers and pursued must have turned the bend in the
+road. If they kept on, he would soon be able to crawl forth from the
+ditch, he thought, and in the woods would find some place in which he
+might remain until all the immediate danger had passed.
+
+Still, he did not yet dare to leave his hiding-place, and, as the
+moments passed, his own fears and anxiety were not allayed. His face and
+hands were covered with the mud which had clung to them when he had slid
+into the ditch. The mosquitoes gathered about him, and, do what he
+would, he could not drive off the tormenting little pests. The
+sultriness which had followed the brief storm was almost unbearable, and
+Tom felt as if he could not have selected a worse place in which to
+conceal himself. There had not been much of any "selecting" about it, he
+grimly thought, for he had crawled into the first shelter that presented
+itself. A place in the muddy ditch was to be preferred to one in the
+middle of the road, and between two contending bands of soldiers. Here
+the bullets were not likely to find him, at least for the present, and
+his only hope depended upon the possibility of his presence not having
+been heeded. Perhaps the soldiers in either band had been so intent upon
+watching what the others would do, that a frightened lad between their
+lines would not be discovered.
+
+This hope was not strong enough to induce him to leave his shelter, and
+he decided to remain in the ditch until he was satisfied that all danger
+was past. The moments dragged on, and the silence which had followed the
+brief contest was unbroken. The heat was becoming more and more intense,
+and Tom felt that he could not remain much longer in his present
+position. Still, he waited and listened, but the sound of the cawing
+crows was all that he could hear. He counted off the minutes, and when
+what he judged must be an hour had passed, he concluded to remain there
+no longer. The men had not been heard in all that time, and doubtless
+must have disappeared from the immediate vicinity.
+
+The sight of the men had shown Tom that he was nearer the army than he
+had supposed. For a moment the thought of his former eager desire to
+join it came into his mind, and when he contrasted his feelings then
+with those he now had, his present position seemed almost ludicrous.
+Bespattered with mud, hiding in a ditch by the roadside, in constant
+fear of the return of the men, he certainly did not present the
+appearance of a very brave young soldier. Even Tom smiled as he thought
+of all this, but he was wiser than he had been a few days before this
+time, and the sound of guns was not exactly like that of which he had
+dreamed.
+
+Tom Coward was not lacking in bravery, however, but the position in
+which he had found himself certainly was a trying one, and perhaps the
+boldest of us might have done no better had we been caught in his
+predicament.
+
+The time had now come, he thought, when it must be safe for him to
+venture out upon the road again, and, grasping his gun, he prepared to
+climb out of the ditch, when he suddenly paused as he thought he heard
+the sound of voices once more.
+
+Yes, there could be no mistake about it; the men were approaching from
+the direction in which both bands had disappeared.
+
+He crouched lower and waited for them to pass. If they were foes, it
+certainly would be wiser, as well as safer, for him not to attract their
+attention; and if they were friends he was hardly in a condition to
+present himself before them.
+
+The men were coming nearer, and were almost opposite his hiding-place
+now. The lad's excitement returned, and he leaned harder against the
+muddy bank. It seemed to him as if the loud beatings of his heart would
+betray him.
+
+The band had halted, and were within a few feet of the ditch. What could
+it mean? Had his hiding-place been discovered? He crouched still lower,
+and did not once look up. He clutched his gun in his hands as if he
+thought he could lean upon that. The suspense was intense, and almost
+unbearable.
+
+"Hello! Here's some one in the ditch!"
+
+Tom's heart sank, and, as he glanced hastily upward, he saw a redcoated
+soldier peering down at him. The end had come, and all his efforts to
+conceal himself had been in vain.
+
+"The fellow's alive," exclaimed the soldier in surprise. "Come up out of
+that and give an account of yourself!"
+
+Tom obeyed, and, crawling up the bank, stood facing the men. There were
+thirty-five or forty of them, and, as he saw that they were clad in the
+British uniform, he realized that he was in the presence of the enemy.
+The suspense, at least, was ended now, and, as he glanced at the
+soldiers, in spite of the fact that he was well aware of his danger,
+much of his alarm had disappeared, for Tom Coward was not unlike others
+in being stronger to face the actual condition than the uncertainty
+which is connected with the approach of perils.
+
+The men glanced curiously at him a moment and then burst into a loud
+laugh. The troubled boy at first could not discover the cause of their
+merriment, but as he glanced at his hands and saw that they were covered
+with the mud which was not yet dry, he realized that doubtless his face
+and clothing were in the same condition. And Tom's appearance was not
+very prepossessing at that moment. His hat was gone, his face was so
+completely covered with mud that any one would have had difficulty in
+deciding whether he was white or black, and his bearing was far from
+being bold.
+
+The laughter of the men continued until an officer approached and said,
+"Who are you? What were you hiding for?"
+
+Tom hesitated a moment, and then replied, "I was trying to keep out of
+the way of your bullets."
+
+Again the soldiers laughed, and the officer said, "You didn't differ
+very much from the other fellows in the band, although they took to the
+woods and you to the ditch."
+
+"What band?"
+
+"Why, those men of Dickinson's we've just driven away. You don't mean to
+say that you didn't belong to them?"
+
+"I didn't belong to any band," said Tom slowly. "I was just coming
+across the country, and when I stepped out into the road I found I was
+right between you and the other fellows. I crawled into the ditch, for I
+was afraid that both of you would hit me."
+
+"Quite right, my lad, quite right. But how does it happen that you carry
+a rifle? The most of the Yankees are glad enough to get muskets, and
+here you are traveling round the country with a rifle. I'm afraid your
+story won't do, my lad. We'll have to take you along with us, and let
+you tell your story to the colonel."
+
+Tom perceived that any further protest on his part would be useless,
+and, as the word to advance was at once given, he obediently took his
+place in the ranks and marched on with the men.
+
+The heat was so intense that they were compelled to halt frequently for
+rests. A few of the men evidently were Hessians, and their high
+jack-boots, their heavy fur hats, as well as the short broadswords they
+carried, in addition to the short guns or carbines which were slung over
+their shoulders, seemed sadly out of place under the burning heat of the
+summer day. Tom did not know how the British officers had protested
+against the customs of their allies, so unsuitable in the country in
+which they were fighting; but the men from Hesse were obstinate, and,
+firmly believing that the equipment which had been good enough for them
+in the old country would certainly be good enough in the new, clung to
+the uncomfortable garments and unwieldy arms, unmindful alike of the
+jeers of their comrades in arms and the danger they incurred by the use
+of them.
+
+In the course of two hours the band arrived at a little camp in command
+of a man whom the leader addressed as Colonel Simcoe. Tom was at once
+summoned by him and taken into the presence of the colonel, or
+lieutenant-colonel, as he then really was.
+
+"What have you here?" inquired the colonel, glancing at Tom as he spoke.
+
+"We picked this fellow out of a ditch back here. We had a little brush
+with a band of Dickinson's men, but they didn't wait for us. We chased
+them a mile or two up the road; but the day was so warm, and as the
+rebels took to the woods, we soon gave it up and came back. We found
+this fellow on our return. He claims he doesn't belong to the rebels;
+but as we found that he carried a rifle, we thought best to bring him
+into camp with us. We didn't know but he might be able to give you some
+of the information you wanted just now."
+
+"You did right, lieutenant. I'll talk with him later. Now tell me what
+you learned. Did you hear anything more about Washington? How are the
+roads and the bridges?"
+
+"The rebels have been tearing up the bridges, and Dickinson has a good
+many of the militia scattered along in the woods. I rather suspect they
+are planning to serve us as the countrymen served Lord Percy up at
+Lexington."
+
+"I fancy we shall be able to put a stop to that, though your report is
+much like that which I have found out myself. Did you hear anything more
+of Washington?"
+
+"I couldn't get a word out of anybody. I don't believe he's moved from
+the position he held yesterday, though."
+
+For several minutes the men conversed, and when at last the younger
+officer departed, Colonel Simcoe turned to Tom and said, "Now, my lad,
+I'll listen to your story."
+
+"I haven't any story," replied Tom. "I was coming through the woods back
+here, and when I stepped out into the road I found myself right between
+the two bands, and as I was afraid I'd be caught by the fire of both of
+them, I crawled into the ditch to be out of the way. That's why I'm
+covered with this dirt," he added apologetically.
+
+"You don't need any one to confirm your words as to that," said the
+colonel, smiling slightly, as he spoke, at Tom's appearance. "Now what I
+want to know is who you are and what you were doing with a rifle? Few
+people here carry rifles, I find."
+
+Tom hesitated a moment, not knowing just what to say in reply to the
+question. The colonel was watching him intently, and the lad felt that
+he must say something. "I live back here," he said at last. "I've lived
+in Old Monmouth all my life. I'd started out from home to go to--to--to
+some of my friends, and, as I told you, I got caught between the lines."
+
+"How about the rifle?"
+
+"My father had the other guns and I had to take that. The last thing he
+told me was to take a gun and scare the blackbirds and crows from the
+ten-acre lot."
+
+"Is your father a loyalist?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"That's good; and now if you can answer my questions, perhaps I'll be
+inclined to let you go. You say you've lived here all your life. Do you
+know all the roads and bridges? Could you find your way anywhere in the
+county?"
+
+"Yes, sir; I think I could."
+
+"Tell me about the bridges. Have many of them been torn up?"
+
+Tom did not know, but he thought of his meeting with young Lieutenant
+Gordon that morning, and boldly answered, "Yes, sir."
+
+"How does it happen that your good father and the other loyalists permit
+that?"
+
+"My father's not at home, and there are too many of the pa--of the
+rebels."
+
+"I thought you told me your father sent you out with your gun," said the
+colonel quickly. "How is that? How could he send you if he wasn't at
+home?"
+
+"He sent me before he left," replied Tom, his voice trembling in spite
+of his efforts to control it.
+
+"Do you know where Washington is?" inquired the colonel abruptly.
+
+"I hear he's up by Hopewell. I don't know." Tom might have added that he
+would be glad to learn, but his wish was not expressed.
+
+"That's right. He _is_ at Hopewell. Is there any talk about his plans?
+Have you heard of any rumors among the rebels as to what he plans to
+do?"
+
+"Yes, sir. I hear he is planning to fall on Clinton's baggage train."
+
+"Sir Henry Clinton, you mean, I suppose," said the colonel sharply. "Do
+you think you could find your way from here to Cranberry?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Do you know every road?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Very well, then, I shall expect you to go with a party to-night and
+show them the way."
+
+"But," protested Tom, "I thought you said I could go if I answered your
+questions."
+
+"You'll have to stay now. Your father's a good loyalist, you say, and
+he'll not object to his son's remaining here for a day or two and
+serving as a guide. I'll see that you have some supper and are ready to
+start before it's dark."
+
+Tom left the colonel's presence, and with a heavy heart turned to look
+about the little camp.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+THE WAY TO CRANBERRY
+
+
+IT was late in the evening when Tom started from Colonel Simcoe's camp
+in company with the lieutenant, whose name he had learned was Ward, and
+the band of six men. A hearty supper had greatly refreshed the weary
+lad, and although he was aware that his companions were not without
+suspicions of him, he still had hopes that he would be able to convince
+them of his knowledge of the country roads, and then could leave them.
+His efforts to convince the colonel that he was merely a country lad,
+who had taken no part in the hostilities, had not been without a measure
+of success, and if they met with no mishap on the road, doubtless they
+would be willing for him to depart.
+
+As to leading the little band into Cranberry, Tom had not the slightest
+objection to that, for it would be going directly toward the place where
+Washington's army lay, and every step was one nearer the men whom he was
+most eager to join.
+
+The entire party were mounted, and a horse was also provided for Tom. To
+be sure, the steed was not a remarkable one, yet, as the lad looked him
+over before he mounted, he was satisfied that riding would be much
+easier than walking, and of walking Tom had had sufficient, he thought,
+on that hot June morning.
+
+"Now, my lad," said Lieutenant Ward, as the party prepared to move, "if
+you do well by us this night, I have two half joes for you in my pocket.
+On the other hand, if you fail us, or try to lead us into any trap, you
+shall have a good taste of the lead my men carry, or know how it feels
+to dance at one end of a rope with your feet a good yard from the
+ground. You hear what I'm saying, don't you?"
+
+"Yes, sir," Tom replied. "I can lead you straight to Cranberry, but of
+course I can't tell what men we shall meet on the way. All I know is
+that General Dickinson has men out, just as you have."
+
+"Never mind your 'General' Dickinson. I only wish we might have the good
+fortune to meet the rebel himself. You show us the way and we'll look
+after any of his men we may fall in with. All we want of you is to show
+us the way. They won't be likely to be out on the road in the night."
+
+Tom by no means felt so positive concerning that as the lieutenant did,
+but the word to start was then given, and mounting his horse he departed
+from the camp with the men.
+
+The moon was now full and hung low in the heavens like a great ball of
+fire. The frogs in the swamps were croaking loudly as the men rode past.
+The air of the summer night was almost motionless, and the heat of the
+day had only slightly decreased with the coming of the darkness. In all
+his life in Jersey, Tom had never known a hotter "spell"--as the natives
+termed it--than they had experienced during the past few days. A Hessian
+was riding beside him, and Tom could not understand how it was that he
+still insisted upon wearing the heavy fur hat in such weather.
+
+So intensely warm was the night that the band were compelled to halt at
+frequent intervals to rest their dripping steeds. The occasional breeze
+was like the hot breath from an oven, and, in spite of the fact that he
+was riding, Tom's face was wet with perspiration. The progress was
+necessarily slow, but the lad soon came to Doctor's Creek, and as they
+found the bridge across that stream intact, the lieutenant was pleased
+and warmly praised the young guide.
+
+The Assanpink Creek was crossed not long afterwards, and as the bridge
+across that also was still standing, the elation of the leader was
+visibly increased and he ordered the men to halt for another rest. Some
+without removing their clothing waded into the stream, which was narrow
+and shallow where they were, and led their horses in after them. The
+heaving sides of the poor beasts were wet with sweat and foam, and the
+men themselves seemed to be but little better. Tom thought he had never
+suffered more from the heat.
+
+After a rest of a half hour the men resumed their journey. Thus far no
+one had been met on the road, and the confidence of the band was
+steadily increasing, in spite of the fact that they were approaching the
+region in which the American army was supposed to be.
+
+Five miles farther on they came to Rocky Branch and the bridge over this
+stream was as strong and safe as those they had left behind them.
+
+"The half joes are likely to be yours, my boy," said the lieutenant.
+
+Tom made no reply, for he was thinking that something beside safe
+bridges might be discovered before they arrived at their destination.
+Only one more stream remained to be crossed, and then they would be in
+Cranberry. Just where they were then to go, or what was to be done, Tom
+did not know. Not a word had been spoken to him concerning the object of
+the expedition, and all that he was expected to do was to lead the band
+to Cranberry.
+
+"How much farther have we to go, my boy?" inquired the leader.
+
+"That depends upon the place you've started for," replied Tom. "We shall
+be in Cranberry after we've gone about ten miles farther, but it covers
+a good many miles. The township is a big one."
+
+"We'll decide that after we get there. Have we any more streams to
+cross?"
+
+"Yes. The Millstone river isn't very far away now."
+
+The rests had become so frequent that morning could not be far away, Tom
+thought. With the appearance of the sun their dangers were likely to be
+increased, but he made no mention of the fears in his heart, and the
+band soon started on again.
+
+When they arrived at the Millstone, the first break in the success of
+the expedition was found, for the bridge was down. This plainly showed
+that the Americans were not far distant now, and as the lieutenant drew
+rein on his horse, he said,--
+
+"This means that Sir Henry will find difficulty in getting his baggage
+train across here. Do you know whether the stream can be forded?"
+
+"Yes," replied Tom, pointing as he spoke to a place a little farther
+down the stream. "We can wade our horses across there."
+
+"But can the baggage wagons be driven through?"
+
+"That I cannot say. I think not."
+
+"We'll soon find out," said the lieutenant, leading the way to the ford.
+
+The men all followed him, but as the water came well up to their horses'
+flanks, it was at once evident that Clinton would find great difficulty
+in getting his baggage train across. The party halted near the bank
+after they had crossed the stream, and the lieutenant had an earnest
+conversation with one of his men.
+
+Tom could not hear their words, but he had no doubt that they were
+discussing the possibilities of Clinton's march by the way they had
+come that night.
+
+"We'll go on a bit farther," said the lieutenant at last, and the men
+obediently mounted and followed their leader.
+
+The gray of the dawn had just appeared in the east, and the air was
+filled with the songs of the birds. They were now in the township of
+Cranberry, and the end of their journey could not be far away, Tom
+thought, although he did not know what that end was to be. Thus far they
+had come without trouble, but with the coming of the morning, and their
+proximity to the American army, their difficulties were likely soon to
+be increased.
+
+The men were silent as they rode slowly forward, and were keeping a
+constant watch on every side. The sun by this time had made its
+appearance, and the day gave promise of being even warmer than the
+preceding one. Before them they could see two rude little houses on
+opposite sides of the road and at the end of lanes which led back from
+the roadside. The one on the left Tom instantly recognized as the abode
+of a Quaker named Nathan Brown, or "Friend Nathan," as his neighbors
+called him. Many a time had Tom been there, and even then he recalled
+many of the quaint expressions of the gentle man who had steadily
+opposed all the hostilities, in accordance with his creed which forbade
+even the resistance to tyrants.
+
+As the lieutenant saw the two houses he drew the rein on his horse, and
+the party halted.
+
+"It's time we had some breakfast," he said. "I am wondering whether we
+can't find something here in these houses. Do you know anything about
+them, my lad?"
+
+"I know the man that lives in the house on the left. He is a Quaker,"
+replied Tom.
+
+"All the better for us. I think I'll let you go up to his house, and
+I'll send a man up to the other. The rest of us had better stay here and
+keep watch, for there may be some prowling rebels around here, for all
+that we may know."
+
+"I'll go," said Tom quickly. "But I can leave you then, can't I? We're
+in Cranberry now and all you wanted of me was to lead you there."
+
+"Yes, if you wish," replied the lieutenant. "You've done well, but you'd
+do better still to go back with us. The rebels are not far away, and you
+may get into trouble. You must do as you like, though," he added.
+"You've earned your pay," and he drew the two half joes from his pocket
+and handed them to Tom.
+
+The lad received the money, no small amount to him, and, after thanking
+the lieutenant, started quickly up the lane which led to Nathan's house.
+As he glanced behind him, he perceived that one of the men had started
+towards the other house, while all the others had dismounted and were
+still in the road, although they evidently were keeping a careful watch.
+
+When Tom drew near the house he saw the Quaker standing in the doorway.
+His broad-brimmed hat and the peaceful expression upon his face were in
+marked contrast to the warlike men he had just left behind him in the
+road.
+
+"How now?" said Nathan, as he perceived who the approaching man was.
+"Thee travels early, Friend Thomas; I trust all is well at thy house."
+
+Tom quickly dismounted, and in a few words explained how it was that he
+happened to be there, and what the purpose of his visit was.
+
+"Thee doesn't say so!" said Nathan in surprise. "And the redcoats even
+now are at my door and seek refreshment?"
+
+"They are out in the road. They want some breakfast, and I think they'll
+pay you for it."
+
+"Friend Thomas, I think I can trust thee. I have known thee since thou
+wert a little lad. Ah, these are sad times for men of peace! The sons of
+Belial are on all sides. Verily, these days are days of wrath."
+
+Tom was puzzled by Nathan's manner and made no reply. The man turned
+quickly into the house and soon returned with a well-filled stocking in
+his hands. Tom instantly surmised what the stocking contained, for he
+was well aware of the banking purposes to which that article of clothing
+was turned in many of the homes.
+
+"Come with me, Friend Thomas," said Nathan, grasping a hoe as he spoke
+and leading the way into his garden. There he dug a hole, and, placing
+his "bank" within it, covered it again with the earth.
+
+"But Nathan," protested Tom, "if these men search your place for money
+they'll find this spot, and it'll show at once you've hidden something
+there. The earth is all fresh and moist here, and it's dry all around
+it."
+
+"Yea, thou speakest truly, Friend Thomas, but I have a thought by which
+I may yet outwit these men of war. Tarry here till I return."
+
+The Quaker instantly turned and again entered the house. In a moment he
+appeared, bearing a large bowl in each hand. One contained water, which
+he poured over the place where his money was concealed, and the other
+was filled with corn. He quickly scattered the corn over the wet ground,
+and then, turning towards the barn, called, "Chick! Chick! Chick! Come,
+chick! Come, chick!"
+
+Instantly there was a fluttering within the barns, the doors to which
+were wide open, and the hens came running from every direction.
+
+Nathan's face took on a meaning smile as he watched his flock hastening
+toward him for their breakfast, and then, turning to Tom, he said, "Is
+it plain to thee, Friend Thomas, that it is still possible for a man of
+peace to outwit these sons of Belial? Now go and tell thy companions
+that such food as I have shall be set before them."
+
+Tom laughed at the trick of the Quaker, and then ran back to his horse,
+and, mounting, started towards his recent companions, whom he could see
+still waiting in the road. Doubtless they were becoming impatient by
+this time, and, without waiting to go all the way back to the road, he
+stopped at a distance and called to them, beckoning with his hand for
+them to come, as he shouted.
+
+As soon as he perceived that the lieutenant heard him, he turned about
+and once more rode back to Nathan's house. He then dismounted and tied
+his horse to a post which stood near to the kitchen door.
+
+As he glanced up he saw that the leader was riding alone up the lane and
+now was near the house. Just then he heard the sound of a horse behind
+him, and, turning quickly about, saw young Lieutenant Gordon dash past
+him on horseback.
+
+Amazed by the sudden and unexpected appearance of his friend, he stood
+still and watched him as he rode swiftly up the lane directly toward the
+approaching men. Gordon was leaning low on his horse's neck, and Tom
+could see that he was grasping a pistol in his right hand.
+
+Before the startled lad could fairly realize what was occurring, he saw
+the young lieutenant raise his weapon and aim it at the approaching
+horseman. He waited for the report, but none came. Again Gordon raised
+his pistol, and once more it flashed without a report.
+
+His heart almost stopped when he perceived that the other members of the
+band had now entered the lane and were riding towards their leader,
+although as yet they were far behind him. The young lieutenant had also
+discovered them, and, instantly turning his horse about, dashed back up
+the lane, with the British lieutenant in swift pursuit.
+
+Unmindful of Tom, they swept past him, and Gordon turned the corner of
+the barn. Twice around the barn the men raced their horses, and then
+Gordon turned his horse into the open doorway and dashed through to the
+other side.
+
+After him followed the leader of the British band in desperate pursuit,
+and then, as Tom glanced up, he saw his recent companions come shouting
+and hallooing into the yard which was between the barn and Friend
+Nathan's little house.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+THE BOAT ON THE BAR
+
+
+WHEN Little Peter discovered the presence of the men before him, his
+first impulse had been to turn and make a dash into the woods; but the
+call which he heard quickly changed all that. As one after another of
+the band appeared, he recognized some of them as men who had been
+enrolled in the local militia, and his alarm for a moment subsided.
+
+The one who had addressed him he remembered as a young man not much
+older than himself, who had all the summer been away from his home,
+busied with his friends and neighbors in protecting the salt works along
+the shore, and striving to hold back the outlaws from their raids in the
+county.
+
+The salt works were of especial value at this time, as some of them were
+owned by the government and aided in increasing the scanty revenues of
+the poverty-stricken country. Several of them already had been burned by
+tories or bands of sailors, who had landed from some of the gunboats
+which had come to anchor off the shore for the purpose of inflicting
+such damage as lay within their power upon the adjacent region.
+
+"What are you doing here, Peter?" repeated the lad who had first spoken.
+
+As Little Peter now recognized the men before him as friends, he quickly
+related to them the story of the sad misfortunes which had come upon his
+home; and the many expressions of anger and sympathy which his words
+called forth were not unwelcome, we may be assured, to the troubled boy.
+
+When his brief story was told, the young man who had hailed him said,
+"We're on an errand that may fit into your feelings a bit. We're short
+one man, too. Don't you want to join us?"
+
+"What are you trying to do?"
+
+"We've just had word that a boat is aground off here on the bar, and
+we're going to see if we can't get her. We've got a whaleboat down here
+on the shore, and we're going to put out in her and see if we can't pull
+the other boat off and bring her in with us."
+
+"But there are a couple of gunboats not more than three quarters of a
+mile out," protested Peter. "You can't do anything while they are
+there."
+
+"We can try," said the man who was acting as the leader. "We're one man
+short, as Lyman here has just said, and if you feel inclined to join us
+we shall be glad to have you."
+
+Little Peter hesitated. It was not alone the danger of the enterprise
+which troubled him. He was thinking of his father and his own purpose to
+discover whether he had been sent to New York or not.
+
+When he explained the cause of his perplexity, the leader said, "That's
+all right, Peter. We're going down to Tom's River just as soon as we've
+taken this boat out here. You see, our watch told us the boat is loaded
+with supplies, and, if we can get her, we're going to do a double deed,
+for we'll keep the others from having them, and we'll make good use of
+the stuff ourselves. Now, if you'll go along with us, you'll make
+another oar for us, and we'll be all the more likely to succeed. Then
+you can go with us down to Tom's River, and poor company will be better
+than none in times like these."
+
+"I'll go," said Little Peter quickly, and the march was at once
+resumed.
+
+As they approached the wigwam, where Peter had left his Indian friends,
+he stopped for a moment to explain to Indian John the cause of the
+change in his plans.
+
+John listened quietly until the lad had finished, and then said, "Me see
+um again."
+
+Little Peter did not understand just what the Indian meant by his words,
+but he did not wait to inquire, for his friends were already in advance
+of him, and he hastened to rejoin them.
+
+No one spoke as they silently walked on to the shore, but when they had
+gained the bluff, Lyman suddenly said, "There! Look there, will you? The
+word was all right. The boat's aground out there on the bar."
+
+Little Peter instantly recognized the boat as the one which he had seen
+approaching from the gunboats, and for which the band of men from
+Refugee Town had evidently been waiting. Doubtless they had mistaken him
+and Indian John for members of the neighboring militia, and the cause of
+their pursuit was now explained.
+
+The men did not hesitate now, but going to a place a little farther up
+the shore, they hastily removed a pile of brush and drew forth the long
+whaleboat which they had concealed beneath it. The boat was not heavy,
+and, lifting it in their arms, they bore it down to the water's edge.
+
+Then grasping its sides, they ran with it into the water, and, at the
+word from the leader, scrambled on board. In a moment they were all
+seated, the long oars were drawn forth, and the men gave way with a
+will.
+
+Little Peter was in the bow, next to his friend Lyman. The excitement
+now for a time banished from his mind the thoughts of his sorrow, and
+even the search for his father was for the moment forgotten.
+
+About three-quarters of a mile out at sea were the two gunboats riding
+at anchor, and resting as gracefully upon the water as if they had been
+birds. Directly before them was the supply boat, about a quarter of a
+mile from the shore, and not more than that distance in advance. They
+could see that four men were on board, and they were still striving
+desperately to push her off from the bar on which she had grounded.
+
+Not a word was spoken on the whaleboat now, and the men were all rowing
+with long and steady strokes. The ocean was unusually calm, but every
+lift of the heavy groundswell disclosed to them more clearly the
+outlines of the boat they were seeking. Their purpose had not yet been
+discovered by the men on the other boat, or if it had been discovered no
+token was displayed. It was more than possible that they were regarded
+as friends coming to the aid of the unlucky boat.
+
+In this manner several minutes passed, the whaleboat, meanwhile, making
+rapid progress over the water, driven forward by the efforts of the
+determined men. The long, sandy shore stretched away in the distance,
+the masses of clouds in the sky seemed to be lined with silver as the
+rays of the sun shone through them, and not a sound could be heard
+except the heavy breathing of the men and the regular clicks of the oars
+in the row-locks.
+
+In spite of the peacefulness of the scene, however, all the men in the
+whaleboat fully realized the desperate nature of their undertaking, and
+the likelihood that in a moment everything might be changed. Still,
+there were no evidences of action on the gunboats, and the men on the
+grounded boat betrayed no signs of alarm.
+
+"There are some men on the shore up yonder," said the leader, as he saw
+a group standing on the beach directly opposite the boat they were
+seeking. "They don't seem to be able to help them," he added. "I don't
+believe we've anything to fear from them. Give way, men! Give way!"
+
+The band responded with a will, and the whaleboat darted forward with
+increasing speed. The other boat lay only a few yards away, and the end
+had almost come. The excitement on board was intense now, and, although
+no one spoke, the expression on every face betrayed the feelings of the
+men. They could see that the others were watching them, but still they
+manifested no alarm at the approach of the whaleboat.
+
+As the latter ran in alongside, and the men quickly backed water, one of
+the sailors on the stranded boat--for such their uniforms disclosed them
+to be--called out, "You're just in time, men! We thought we'd never get
+this tub off the bar. The tide's coming in, but we're stuck fast."
+
+"That's just what we came for," replied the leader, as he threw a rope
+to the other boat. "Now make fast and we'll yank you off before you know
+it."
+
+One of the sailors caught the rope and made it fast, but evidently a
+change came over his feelings then, for, glancing suspiciously at the
+men before him, the one who had acted as the leader said, "You're from
+Refugee Town, aren't you? You're strangers to me, but I take it for
+granted you're all right!"
+
+"No, sir; we're militia from Old Monmouth. We've come out here to get
+you and your boat, too. Here, none of that!" he quickly added, as he saw
+the men turn to grasp their guns. "We'll send you to the bottom before
+you can tell your names if you try any of your games on us."
+
+At his command the men in the whaleboat quickly covered the others with
+their guns. For a moment the silence was unbroken. The advantage for the
+present was very decidedly with the attacking party. Not only did they
+outnumber the others, but they were also in a condition to act, and act
+quickly. The situation, however, could not long remain as it was. The
+gunboats were not more than a half mile away, and, doubtless, assistance
+would be sent as soon as the predicament of the men should be
+discovered.
+
+Then, too, there were the men on the shore to be reckoned with.
+Apparently, they had no boat with which they could come to the rescue
+of the luckless sailors, but they might soon obtain one, for Refugee
+Town was not far away. Why they had not already gone there was not
+apparent. Perhaps they were trusting to the aid of the rising tide and
+the efforts of the men.
+
+"Pass over your guns!" said the leader on the whaleboat.
+
+The men obeyed, and silently picked up and handed their guns to the
+attacking party.
+
+"Now we'll see what can be done," said the leader, after he had
+deposited the weapons on the bottom of the whaleboat. "These fellows are
+harmless now, and we'll take our oars and see if we can't pull them off
+from the bar."
+
+His men grasped their oars and began to row. The rope tightened, the
+boat started a little, but still stuck fast to the bottom. Again the men
+pulled desperately, but with all their efforts they could not move the
+grounded boat.
+
+"I'm afraid we'll have to cast overboard a part of the load," said the
+leader, when the third effort proved as futile as its predecessors.
+
+He arose from his seat and grasped the rope to pull the whaleboat
+nearer, when the four men before him suddenly united in a loud shout,
+and, leaping from their seats, together grasped some other guns which
+had been concealed beneath the sailcloth, and, turning about before
+their captors could recover from their surprise, stood aiming their
+weapons directly at their faces.
+
+"It's our turn," laughed one of the men. "You'll hand over your own guns
+now!"
+
+No one in the whaleboat moved from his position. The leader still stood,
+leaning over the side and grasping the rope with his hands. Every one
+had been so startled by the unexpected summons that he seemed almost
+incapable of action.
+
+"Come, be quick about it!" said the sailor, as the men still did not
+move.
+
+A faint sound of a shout now could be heard from the shore, and the
+movements of the men there, as they ran about the beach, betrayed the
+fact that they were aware that something was wrong. In the distance,
+Little Peter could see that two barges filled with men were starting
+forth from the gunboats. The situation was becoming rapidly worse,
+critical as it then was.
+
+"Their guns aren't loaded, men!" called the leader suddenly. "They can't
+harm us."
+
+Still his men did not respond. For an instant no one moved, while their
+fear was plainly evident from the expressions upon their faces. No one
+knew whether the leader's words were true or not, and in breathless
+suspense they waited, fearing every moment to hear the reports of the
+guns in the other boat.
+
+As the men did not fire, the leader quickly shouted again, "They're not
+loaded, I tell you! They can't hurt us! Don't pay any attention to
+them!"
+
+His words instantly served to arouse his companions, for they now knew
+that if the guns had been loaded they would have been discharged before
+this.
+
+The sight of the barges which had started forth from the gunboats, and
+the increasing confusion of the men on the shore, combined to render the
+attacking party desperate now. Whatever they were to do they must do
+quickly.
+
+The leader called to his companions to cover the others with their guns,
+and, drawing the whaleboat close up, said: "The boat's loaded with guns
+and powder! That's just what we want. Now you take your oars and push
+while my men row," he added, speaking to the sailors. "The first one of
+you that draws back will get a dose of lead. Now! Quick! Do as I tell
+you!"
+
+The men sullenly laid down the empty guns, and, picking up their oars,
+began to push against the sandy bottom. The men in the whaleboat were
+rowing desperately, and soon could feel that the other boat had started.
+
+It was not yet free, however, and the leader called again to the
+sailors, "Harder, men, harder! You aren't half pushing. That's right!
+Harder yet! Harder, I say! We'll be out of this in a minute. Give way,
+men! You aren't asleep, are you? Pull! Pull!"
+
+In his eagerness, the leader laid down his gun, and, hastily grasping an
+oar, began to pull with his companions. Slowly the grounded boat
+responded to their efforts. Inch by inch it slipped from the bar, but
+was not yet free.
+
+Meanwhile, the confusion on the shore was increasing. The men were
+running up and down the beach, waving their arms and shouting. The two
+barges were coming swiftly from the gunboats, and if the loaded boat was
+not soon dragged from the bar, it would once more be in the possession
+of the enemy.
+
+They were still working desperately. The perspiration stood out in great
+drops upon their faces. They braced their feet against the seats in
+front of them and put forth all their strength. The moments seemed like
+hours to the struggling men, but the loaded boat was slow to respond to
+their efforts. It was steadily yielding, however, and at last they saw
+the boat slide from the bar and rest easily upon the open water.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+TED WILSON'S VICTIM
+
+
+A SHOUT arose from the eager crew as they perceived the success which
+had crowned their desperate efforts, but an answering shout from the men
+in the two approaching barges quickly recalled them to the necessity for
+further and immediate action. Why it was that the guns of the gunboats
+had remained silent they could not understand, but there was no time now
+for investigations. It was sufficient that they had not been molested
+thus far; and as the leader at once gave the command for them to resume
+their labors with their oars, the men at once responded and gave way
+together, the supply boat still being towed.
+
+The whaleboat had been built for speed, and was long, narrow, and light.
+Had it not been for the laden supply boat, which as yet they were not
+willing to abandon, they would easily and speedily have drawn away from
+the pursuing barges. As it was, they swept forward swiftly, and
+apparently were almost holding their own in the race.
+
+For several minutes the desperate efforts of the men continued. The
+heavy clouds had gathered in the sky, and the blaze of the sun had
+disappeared. The air was sultry and oppressive, and the unusual calm
+which rested over the waters indicated that the storm which had been
+threatening was fast approaching. No one glanced at the heavens,
+however, the set and streaming faces indicating that the immediate task
+in hand was sufficient of itself to occupy all their thoughts.
+
+On and on rowed the men, and on and on swept the pursuing barges. Less
+than a quarter of a mile lay between them, and, heavily laden as the
+supply boat was, it materially decreased the speed which otherwise the
+whaleboat might have made. The moments passed, but the efforts were not
+relaxed. Together, the long oars struck the water, and the bodies of the
+men swayed back and forth as if they were controlled by a common
+impulse. The distance between the boats was not materially changed,
+although if any change was to be seen it was in favor of the barges.
+
+"This will never do," said the leader at last, letting his oar go, and
+rising in his seat as he spoke. "Here, you men," he added, grasping his
+gun and facing the prisoners in the other boat as he spoke, "it's time
+for you to work your passage. Take those oars and pull your prettiest!
+Four oars are better than one, and I can do more with a gun than I can
+by pulling. Take your oars, every one of you, and the first one to drop
+will be fired on!"
+
+The four men in the supply boat sullenly obeyed, and the increased
+impulse of their efforts at once became manifest. The leader stood in
+the stern of the whaleboat facing the prisoners, and watchful of their
+every movement. His words of encouragement served to inspire his
+companions, and for a time it appeared as if they were gaining upon
+their pursuers.
+
+Still, the distance between them did not materially increase, and such
+efforts as the men were then making could not be long maintained.
+Indeed, signs of distress were already becoming apparent, and Little
+Peter felt every time he drew in his oar as if he had not strength
+enough left to pull another stroke. His face betrayed the pain he was
+suffering, but his condition was not much worse than that of some of
+the other men with him in the boat.
+
+The exciting contest could not be continued much longer, and as the
+leader glanced about the boat he almost decided to cut the rope which
+held the supply boat, and, leaving that behind, seek safety in flight.
+
+He had drawn his knife from his pocket, and was standing ready to free
+them from their heavy load, when the rain began to fall. In a moment the
+wind swept down upon them, and the storm was at hand.
+
+Prom the first of the pursuing barges came a shot, but no damage was
+done, and the leader muttered, "That's all right. It's a farewell salute
+you're giving us. You might as well say good-by to us, for I take it
+you'll never see us again."
+
+The waves were now rising, and the rain was falling in torrents. Between
+them and the shore it almost seemed as if a cloud intervened, so heavy
+was the downpour. The voice of the leader could hardly be heard by his
+men. The deep-toned thunder sounded almost continuously, and the darting
+lightning appeared to be all about them. In escaping from one peril they
+had encountered another.
+
+The barges could now no longer be seen, and, with the passing of the
+fear of pursuit, the men gave all their attention to their efforts to
+keep the whaleboat out of the trough of the rolling waves. Still, the
+supply boat was not cut loose, for the determined men were resolved to
+hold to that so long as it lay within their power to do so.
+
+For a half hour the shower continued, and although much water was
+shipped, and the men were compelled to bail the boats, they behaved
+well. When at last the storm had passed and the low mutterings of the
+thunder sounded far out to sea, they all looked keenly behind them to
+discover the whereabouts of their pursuers.
+
+Neither of the barges was to be seen. Doubtless, with the approach of
+the shower, they had both put back to the gunboats for safety. The
+whaleboat had weathered the storm, and the supply boat was still safely
+in tow.
+
+Drenched though the men were, new strength seemed to come with the
+knowledge that they were no longer being pursued, and then, relieved of
+their fear, they continued on their way down the shore.
+
+They frequently stopped for rest and to scan the waters behind them,
+but no boat could anywhere be seen. Nor was any one to be discerned upon
+the beach. Doubtless the men from Refugee Town had fled for safety and
+shelter, or, as the leader grimly said, "They were afraid of being wet,
+for water was something to which all the men assembled there were
+strongly opposed."
+
+For mile after mile they held steadily to their course, even their
+excitement apparently having mostly disappeared. The supply boat
+contained guns and ammunition, and if there was anything of which the
+militia stood in need, it was of that very commodity.
+
+At first it was thought that they would put in at the entrance to Shark
+River, but it was soon decided to continue on their way until they
+should come to Manasquan Inlet, and then go up the river to a place
+where some of their friends were to be found. To gain Tom's River they
+would be compelled to keep on to Barnegat Inlet, and then retrace their
+way up Barnegat Bay, to the place where the river entered; and as that
+would require a voyage of thirty miles more, no one regretted the change
+in the plan.
+
+They were all nearly worn out by their exertions, and no one knew what
+British vessel might be met before they could gain the shelter of Tom's
+River.
+
+Little Peter, in spite of his eagerness to go on to the place where he
+hoped to learn something concerning his father, was so weary from the
+work of the day, and as he had not tasted food since early that morning,
+he rejoiced with the others when at last the boats turned into Manasquan
+Inlet and began to make their way up the little stream.
+
+The sun was now low in the western sky, and the night would soon be upon
+them. The shadows already were lengthening when the two boats passed out
+of the inlet into the waters of the river. The leader, however, had not
+yet given the word to rest on their oars, and Little Peter did not know
+where they were to pass the night.
+
+The whaleboat kept steadily on in its course, and the wearied men were
+still pulling at the oars. The river was becoming narrower now, and more
+than one was hoping that the word would soon be given for them to land.
+
+Suddenly, the leader called to his men, and, standing erect, pointed
+excitedly to a place on the shore not far in advance of them. His
+companions quickly looked in that direction and saw on the little point
+of land, around which the river swept in its course, two men standing
+in the water. But what was it they were doing? One of them was holding
+the other and frequently forcing his head beneath the surface of the
+river. He would hold him in that position for a moment and then lift him
+upon his feet again, and shake him, much as a dog might have done with a
+rabbit. Apparently neither had observed the approaching boats, nor had
+either uttered a sound which the men in the whaleboat could hear.
+
+"The fellow's drowning him!" said the leader excitedly. "He's drowning
+him. Give way, men, and we'll lend a hand."
+
+The men, no less excited than their leader, instantly responded, and the
+boats dashed rapidly forward. The eyes of all were fixed upon the two
+men before them, and the leader shouted and called; but apparently,
+unmindful of their approach, the strange actions continued. The larger
+of the two men again and again forced the head of his companion under
+the water, and then would lift him up and repeat the shaking. So
+thoroughly intent was he upon his strange occupation, that he did not
+once heed the hail, or even glance toward the whaleboat.
+
+Nearer and nearer swept the boats, and finally, when they were almost
+upon him, the man ceased his efforts and glanced coolly up at the
+approaching men, still, however, retaining his grasp on his victim, who
+apparently was helpless in his hands.
+
+A startled exclamation escaped Little Peter's lips when he saw that the
+smaller of the men was none other than his own neighbor, Benzeor Osburn.
+"Help him! Help him!" he said excitedly to the leader. "It's Benzeor!
+It's Benzeor Osburn! He's my neighbor! He's being drowned! He'll be
+killed!"
+
+"Be still!" said the leader roughly. "It's Ted Wilson that's got him.
+Ted knows what he's doing. What's the trouble, Ted? What's gone wrong?"
+he added quickly, addressing the man who still held Benzeor tightly in
+his grasp.
+
+The huge man slowly turned his head as he heard himself addressed, and
+Little Peter thought he never before had seen such an expression of rage
+upon any human countenance. His great muscular arms were bare, and his
+entire body seemed to express the marvelous strength he possessed.
+Benzeor was not struggling, and indeed there seemed to be but little
+hope of protecting himself from the powerful man whose prisoner he was.
+
+Little Peter could see that, although Benzeor was almost breathless, he
+had recognized him, but he made no effort to speak and scarcely glanced
+at the men before him.
+
+"What's wrong, Ted?" repeated the leader. "What's the matter with the
+man?"
+
+"The matter isn't with the man, it's with me," said Ted slowly, speaking
+in a deep, gruff voice, which betrayed the strong feeling under which he
+labored.
+
+"You're not going to drown him, are you?"
+
+"Naw--though the snake deserves it. Drownin' is too good for such as
+he!"
+
+Ted had not moved from his position, and still was standing up to his
+waist in the water.
+
+"Tell us about it. Maybe we can help you a bit."
+
+"Naw, ye can't help any. It's my business. I don't mind tellin' ye how
+it came about, though. This forenoon I sold some corn and stuff up here
+at the mill, and got my pay in coin, too. Well, this fellow was there
+and he saw me get paid off, and I half suspected the reptile from the
+way he looked at me when he saw me take the money. Here you!" he
+quickly added, as Benzeor struggled slightly. "Ye want some more, do ye?
+Well, I'll give ye all ye want and all ye need, too," and again he
+thrust the helpless Benzeor's head beneath the water.
+
+"Let him up. You'll drown him!" said the leader, when Ted had held his
+victim several seconds under the water.
+
+"It's no more than he deserves," replied the huge man, nevertheless
+lifting his victim and shaking him again. "Now will ye keep still?"
+
+As Benzeor was unable to reply, Ted again turned to the men in the boat
+and said, "Well, I took that money home and gave it to Sallie. She's my
+wife, ye know, and I always gives her what money I get, not that it's
+ever very much, though. I didn't ferget the eyes o' this fellow,
+however, and I told Sallie,--she's my wife, ye know, and as likely a
+woman as there is in Old Monmouth, if I do say it as ought not to,--I
+told her to keep a good lookout for the pine robbers, fer I had a kind
+of a suspicion this here reptile might know where they was, and might
+get word to 'em, too.
+
+"I took my axe and went off down into my swamp-lot to cut some wood, and
+left Sallie up in the house. Sallie's my wife, ye know. I felt uneasy
+like all the time, but I worked on for three hours or more, but I kept
+a-gettin' uneasier and uneasier, and, finally, I just couldn't stand it
+any longer and put straight fer the house.
+
+"'Twas mighty lucky I did, too, I'm tellin' you, fer when I came in
+sight o' the house,--ye can see it up there now," and Ted pointed to his
+home, a short distance up the bank, giving the unfortunate Benzeor an
+additional shake as he did so,--"I see somethin' was wrong. There was
+three or four men a-standin' out by the big maple in front o' my house,
+and the minit I looked I see what they was up to. Somebody was a hangin'
+from a bedcord they'd threw over a limb o' that very maple-tree.
+
+"Mebbe ye know how I felt when I see it was my Sallie; she's my wife, ye
+know. They was a-drawin' her up and then lettin' her down, and I knew
+then they was tryin' to make her own up where that money was. I had my
+axe in my hands, and when I see what they was up to, I didn't wait very
+long, I'm tellin' ye. I cut Sallie loose,--she wasn't very much hurt;
+she's my wife, ye know,--and then I took after the rascals. They
+scattered in every direction, but this vermin started for the river and
+I after him."
+
+"You got him, I see."
+
+"Did I get him? Let him answer for hisself."
+
+And the angry Ted again shook the helpless Benzeor until the men
+wondered that his trembling limbs still held together.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+A FRUITLESS CHASE
+
+
+THE surprise of Tom Coward was not diminished as the novel race
+continued. Twice through the open doors of the barn dashed the two
+riders, their horses' hoofs slipping on the rough floor and almost
+throwing the men from their seats. Both continued to maintain their
+positions, however, and would no sooner disappear from Tom's sight than
+they would be seen coming around the corner of the barn again, the young
+American lieutenant still in advance and the British officer in close
+pursuit.
+
+Friend Nathan was standing in the doorway of his house, and, in spite of
+his peaceful professions, there was an eager expression upon his face
+which betrayed the fact that he was not an uninterested observer of the
+strange contest. Tom had not moved from his position, and his excitement
+had almost deprived him of the power of speech.
+
+Again through the open doorways of the barn the riders had urged their
+swiftly running horses, but as yet their relative positions had remained
+unchanged. The British officer was leaning forward on his horse's neck
+and endeavoring to grasp the bridle of the young lieutenant's horse, but
+the quick movements of the latter had prevented him, and the mad race
+continued.
+
+As Lieutenant Gordon dashed around the corner of the barn, and for the
+fourth time prepared to enter the open door, Tom saw that the other
+members of the band were just entering the yard. The excited lad could
+not longer remain silent. His friend was beset by new perils and must be
+warned.
+
+"Look out! Look out!" shouted Tom.
+
+Young Gordon looked up and for the first time beheld the increase in the
+number of his enemies. Without hesitating a moment, he turned his horse
+toward the low fence and cleared it at a bound. Then, directly across
+the open lot toward the woods in the distance he urged his trusty steed,
+and almost before the men in the yard perceived what had occurred, he
+had placed a considerable distance between him and the barn.
+
+The confusion, however, lasted but a moment, for, with a shout, several
+of the men urged their horses forward, and, leaping the low fence,
+renewed the pursuit. Those who did not follow raised their guns and
+discharged them at the fleeing officer; but either his movements were
+too swift, or their excitement prevented them from taking careful aim,
+for the bullets went wide of their mark, and in a very brief time the
+young lieutenant disappeared within the woods, and soon after his
+pursuers followed him.
+
+"Thee didn't seem to catch him," said Nathan blandly to the men who
+remained in the yard.
+
+"They'll get him. They'll get him," replied the leader. "They'll soon
+run him down, never you fear. But he's a bold fellow, there's no mistake
+about that. What did you call out to him for?" he added, turning sharply
+to Tom.
+
+"Did I call out to him?" replied Tom. "I don't just know what I did, I
+was so excited. I thought you had him."
+
+"So I would, if it hadn't been for the barn floor."
+
+Tom thought the barn floor was perhaps as much of a disadvantage to the
+pursued as to the pursuer, but he discreetly held his peace and said no
+more.
+
+"Now, old man, you can get us some breakfast. My men will be back here
+in no time with the young rebel, and will have all the better appetite
+because of their morning's work. You can feed us all, can't you?" said
+the officer.
+
+"I have spoken to Rachel. Doubtless she will do her best for thee."
+
+The men at once proceeded to place their horses in the barn and serve
+them freely from the Quaker's store. Then they entered the house and
+seated themselves at the table which Rachel had spread for them,
+although they first stationed one of their companions as guard.
+
+For a time no one spoke, so busied were they in their occupation, and
+Tom Coward was not one whit behind any of them. He was tired and hungry,
+and the breakfast was doubly welcome to him. Rachel moved quietly about
+the room, her drab dress and broad white collar being in marked contrast
+to the brilliant uniforms of her self-invited guests.
+
+"Old man," said the officer at last, "I wish you'd tell me how it
+happened that that young rebel was here on your place. You weren't
+sheltering him, were you?"
+
+"Nay," replied Nathan. "In times like these, Friends are not prone to
+shelter any soldiers. Our guests are only those who come without any
+bidding of ours."
+
+"Ha! ha!" laughed the officer. "I fancy you mean that as a reproach for
+us. Well, we'll pay you for our breakfast, never you fear about that.
+Your scruples don't carry you so far that you object to receiving a
+return in good yellow or white metal, do they?"
+
+"The laborer is ever worthy of his hire. I shall be thankful for any
+equivalent it may seem good unto thee to bestow upon me."
+
+"That's right, that's right. Trust a broad brim for that every time. I'm
+not complaining, old man, I'm not complaining. You don't happen to know
+just where the rebel army is at present, do you?"
+
+"It is reported that Washington is on the march for this very place.
+Even now he may be approaching."
+
+"Do you know that?" inquired the officer in a lower tone.
+
+"Nay. I know nothing of their movements. It is all of the current report
+I am speaking to thee. I fear me that a man of peace is likely to suffer
+double ills between the two armies, for it is also reported that the
+British and their Hessian companions are also likely to march through
+this very region."
+
+If the officer had glanced at the old Quaker he would have discovered
+that there was a very keen expression upon his face as he ventured the
+last supposition. But as he did not look up it was all lost upon him,
+and perhaps if he had seen it, he would not have understood its meaning,
+since his host was ostensibly a man of peace.
+
+"I'm not so sure of that," said the officer quietly. "We've come to look
+over the land and report to Colonel Simcoe. What makes you think the
+rebels are near here, and are likely to march this way?"
+
+"I will tell thee truly. The young man whom your companions are pursuing
+slept last night in my barn. He informed me frankly that Washington was
+to pass this way"--
+
+"And fall on our army?" broke in the officer eagerly.
+
+"That is the natural inference for thee to draw. It's a sad day for the
+Friends. They are ground between the upper and the nether millstones,
+for I understood thee to say that the British also were to come
+hither."
+
+"You can understand what you please," replied the leader gruffly.
+"You've given me the information I most desire and Colonel Simcoe would
+be glad to reward you for it, but being, as you are, a man of peace, of
+course you wouldn't be willing to take anything from a man whose
+occupation is blood letting. Hello! here's the guard!" he added, rising
+abruptly from the table as he spoke. "What's wrong?"
+
+"Nothing," replied the guard, "except that our men are returning from
+the woods."
+
+"And did they catch the young rebel?"
+
+"No, or at least he's not with them now."
+
+All hurriedly left the table and rushed out into the yard, Tom also
+going with them. The men could be seen returning across the lot, but it
+was at once evident that the young lieutenant was not with them.
+
+"What's the trouble? How was it that you let the slippery little rebel
+get away from you?" demanded the leader, as the soldiers once more
+entered the yard.
+
+"Simply because he could ride faster than we could," replied one of the
+band in a surly tone. "His horse was fresh and ours had been out all
+night."
+
+The officer was angry, but, after a few sharp words to his men, he bade
+them enter the kitchen and get their breakfast.
+
+"Did thee find him?" inquired Nathan.
+
+"No, we didn't find him. I'd chase him right into camp if it wasn't that
+I must hurry back to the colonel with the word you've given me. You're
+sure about what you told me?"
+
+"What did I tell thee?" inquired Nathan blandly.
+
+"About the march of the rebels," replied the officer angrily. "I half
+believe you're in league with them yourself, in spite of all your
+whining words. If I thought you were I'd leave your body for the crows
+to pick."
+
+"And is that the method which seemeth to thee to prove thou art right,
+and that I am no man of peace?"
+
+"Oh, never mind, old man, never mind my words. Perhaps I'm a little too
+hard with you. This young rebel's getting away from us has put me out of
+temper. What I want to know is whether you believe what you said about
+the rebels coming through Cranberry."
+
+"I have given thee the words as they were given me. I am not in the
+councils of the 'rebels,' as it seemeth good to thee to call them, and
+cannot say more. It is for thee to judge, not me, who am a man of peace
+and not familiar with the ways of warlike men."
+
+By this time the men had finished their breakfast, and a hurried
+consultation followed. The decision at which they arrived was soon
+apparent when the leader approached Nathan, and, holding forth some
+silver in his hand, said, "There, take that for the breakfast you've
+given us."
+
+"I thank thee," replied Nathan, accepting the money.
+
+"Are you going back with us, lad?" said the officer, turning to Tom as
+he spoke.
+
+"No. You said all you wanted of me was to point out the way to
+Cranberry."
+
+"So I did, but if this old man speaks the truth,--and I'm inclined to
+think he does,--you'll be better off with us than you will be to stay
+behind when the rebels are coming. You'll have a good horse to ride,
+too; you must not forget that."
+
+"I think I'll stay. I'm not afraid of the rebels, and can find my way
+all right." Tom's heart was beating rapidly, and the fear that
+permission for him to remain would not be granted was uppermost in his
+thoughts.
+
+"Have it your own way, lad, have it your own way. I only spoke what I
+thought was for your own best good."
+
+He gave a few orders to his men, and in a brief time the band departed,
+riding swiftly up the road and soon disappearing from sight.
+
+"This was not a bad morning's work, Friend Thomas," said Nathan, when at
+last the men were gone, jingling the silver in his pocket as he spoke.
+
+"It was a good deal better than I ever expected to have," replied Tom.
+
+Neither of them realized, however, the full consequences, for Nathan's
+words, in addition to what the officer had already discovered, caused
+him to return in all haste with the information he had received to
+Colonel Simcoe. That officer, upon receiving the word, which was
+corroborated by other discoveries he had made, at once reported to Sir
+Henry Clinton, and an immediate change in the plans of the British was
+made. The advance to the Raritan was speedily abandoned, the route to
+the Highlands was at once chosen, and it was decided that the army
+should march by the way of Monmouth Court House. The battle of Monmouth,
+which soon followed, thus became possible, and that, with all its
+consequences to the struggling patriots, turned upon the information
+which Colonel Simcoe had received, and which he speedily carried to his
+commander.
+
+Upon such slight events do those which we sometimes call the greater
+ones turn. Perhaps as we grow older and wiser we shall come to perceive
+more clearly the true relation which the so-called little things of life
+bear to the greater ones. A very wise man once declared that "he who was
+faithful in the little affairs of life was very greatly faithful." In
+any event, we have partially learned the lesson that it is a test of
+true greatness to be able to do little things well, and that the very
+best evidence of a man's being able to do the greater things is that he
+is willing to do the smaller ones, as they come to him, faithfully and
+honestly.
+
+However, neither Nathan nor Tom was moralizing after this fashion when
+they entered the house after watching the departure of the British
+soldiers. Tom then related all his recent experiences to Nathan, not
+omitting the story of Benzeor's misdeeds.
+
+The old Quaker listened attentively, and it was apparent from his
+frequent expressions of anger that his interest in the success of the
+Continentals was not entirely banished by his peaceful professions.
+
+"What thee needs now, friend Thomas," he said, when at last the lad's
+story was ended, "is a good rest. Rachel has a bed ready for thee."
+
+Tom followed his friend to the room upstairs, and soon stretched himself
+upon the bed. How grateful it seemed to the weary lad! For a moment he
+gazed at the four high posts, but soon everything was forgotten and he
+was asleep.
+
+How long he slept he did not know, but he was awakened by Nathan, who
+called to him and said, "Friend Thomas, there is some one below who
+desires to see thee."
+
+Tom leaped from the bed and followed the Quaker down the stairs,
+wondering who it was that wished to see him. There were confused
+thoughts in his mind of the British officer and Benzeor, but he was not
+in the least prepared for the sight upon which he looked when he entered
+the room.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A RARE BEAST
+
+
+IT is necessary now for us to turn and follow some of the movements of
+that army which Tom Coward was so eager to join.
+
+Sir Henry Clinton fully understood that he had little to gain from an
+engagement with Washington's army at this time. The Americans were not
+holding any position which he desired to gain, their stores and
+equipments were of slight value, and if Washington should be defeated,
+the result would be that his men would simply be scattered in the
+surrounding region, where they would still be free to carry on their
+straggling methods of warfare, and harass the British by falling upon
+their baggage trains and shooting at the men as they marched along the
+country roads.
+
+On the other hand, Clinton's stores were numerous and of no little
+value. The loss of them would be a serious blow to the redcoats, while
+the possession of them by the Continentals would put new life into the
+cause of the poorly equipped patriots. And above all of these things,
+the danger which now threatened from the approach of a French fleet led
+the British commander to hasten forward to the defense of New York,
+which he feared was likely to be the first place to be attacked by the
+allies of the colonies.
+
+The very motives which caused Sir Henry to wish to avoid an engagement
+were those which appealed most strongly to Washington to enter into one.
+He had but little to lose and much to gain. A defeat for the British
+would mean a weakening of the defense of New York, and the long train of
+baggage wagons was a most tempting prize. The possession of those stores
+would replenish the scanty supplies of the Americans; and, as we know,
+Washington had eagerly pushed his army forward, hoping to gain a
+position in advance of the British and fall upon them in some
+advantageous position which he himself could select.
+
+The main body had advanced as far as Hopewell, as we have already
+learned in the course of this story, but there had halted for a brief
+time. The weather had been unusually trying, and as a consequence the
+men were suffering intensely. Even the "oldest inhabitants" had never
+known such a summer. The thermometer had climbed well up into the
+nineties and then had stayed there. The frequent thunder showers
+apparently did not cool the air and afforded no relief, as the
+sultriness seemed to be increased by each one. The roads had become
+heavy and well-nigh impassable in places, and when at last the men had
+marched to the plains of Hopewell, Washington wisely halted to give them
+their much needed rest.
+
+Another matter led the great commander to remain there for a time. He
+had now gained a position which offered him a considerable advantage,
+and he wished to call a council of his officers to consult concerning
+his further movements.
+
+Accordingly, the second of the councils since the army had departed from
+Philadelphia was then called, and the one question in the mind of the
+commander was this: "Will it be advisable to hazard a general
+engagement?"
+
+General Charles Lee, who was second in command, and was by some even
+then suspected of being in secret league with Howe, was present, and his
+voice was soon heard. Lee was a Welshman, brilliant in certain ways,
+and had seen much service in the armies of Europe. Many had preferred
+him to Washington as the commander-in-chief of the American armies, and
+Lee himself was not averse to the idea. He affected to regard Washington
+with contempt, looking upon him as a man who lacked military training
+and of but little ability. His jealousy already had been the cause of
+many serious troubles, and at the present time, in spite of the fact
+that he had been exchanged for the British general Prescott, captured in
+a manner not unlike that in which Lee himself had been taken in a
+previous winter at Morristown, he apparently was unmindful of all the
+regard bestowed upon him, and was not unwilling to see Washington make
+some mistakes which would bring upon the leader the anger of his
+fellows, and perhaps open the way for Lee to gain his position. This
+view of the case is certainly to be preferred to that which marked him
+simply as a traitor and in league with the enemy, although in all
+likelihood both, in a measure, were correct. Probably Washington
+understood the man thoroughly at the time, and we may be certain that
+his troubles were not decreased by his knowledge.
+
+Lee was possessed of a strikingly ugly face, and his plain features were
+the cause of many rude jests among the soldiers who were opposed to him.
+But whatever his lacks in personal beauty or moral character may have
+been, he at least had a most persuasive tongue. His eager and impulsive
+manner, his commonly accredited ability, and his foreign training, which
+had great influence among many of his ruder and unpolished companions,
+caused some of the men about him to become ready listeners to what he
+had to say.
+
+In the council which Washington called at Hopewell, Lee exerted himself
+to the utmost to oppose the proposition to enter into an engagement with
+the advancing British. So persuasive were his words that the majority of
+the officers voted with him that it would not be advisable to detach
+more than fifteen hundred men from the main body to harass the enemy on
+their flank and rear, while the remainder of the army should preserve
+their present position relative to the British, and be governed by
+circumstances.
+
+Just what Lee's motive was is not fully apparent. Whether he wished to
+avoid a battle or simply desired to cause Washington to fail in taking
+advantage of the favorable opportunity, which Lee himself must have seen
+had presented itself, is not clearly known. It may have been a
+combination of both wishes.
+
+General Wayne bitterly opposed the proposition of Lee, and generals such
+as Greene, Lafayette, Steuben, and others, expressed themselves as being
+decidedly of the opinion that, at the very least, twenty-five hundred
+men should be detached from the main body and sent forward to carry out
+Washington's plan.
+
+Lee's motion, however, prevailed; but while Washington seemingly
+consented to the decision of the council, we can now see, as we look
+backward, that his own purpose was not changed. Perhaps he was
+strengthened in his opinion by the words of General Wayne and General
+Greene, spoken after the breaking up of the assembly, for we know that
+they then expressed themselves very freely to their leader.
+
+Apparently yielding to the expressed wishes of the majority, Washington
+dispatched General Scott with fifteen hundred men "to gall the enemy's
+left flank and rear," as he expressed it in the letters he wrote that
+day to General Dickinson and the president of the Continental Congress;
+and on the following day advanced with his army to Kingston, and halted
+there on the very day when Tom Coward arrived at the house of Friend
+Nathan Brown in Cranberry.
+
+As Tom came down the stairs and entered the room below, his surprise was
+great when he saw young Lieutenant Gordon standing before him.
+"Where--where did you come from?" said the astonished boy. "I thought
+they chased you out into the woods!"
+
+"So they did. So they did," laughed the young officer; "but that doesn't
+mean that I was bound to stay there, does it? I had spent the night with
+Friend Nathan here, and I had such a good time I almost decided to come
+back for another. And then, too, I left a lad here whose face haunted
+me, he looked so scared and white."
+
+"I was scared," said Tom, "for I thought they'd got you. How in the
+world did you ever manage to get away from them?"
+
+"Oh, I've learned by experience," replied the lieutenant, laughing.
+"This was about the closest call I ever had, and once there, when my
+horse slipped on the barn floor, I thought I was done for; but it's all
+come out right, you see. When I once got into the woods I knew I was
+all right, and I didn't have to go very far, either. About noon I
+thought I'd venture back and see what had become of Friend Nathan and
+Tom Coward, for I didn't believe those redcoats would stay here very
+long after they found out that our army is over here by Kingston."
+
+"Kingston?" said Tom quickly. "Kingston? Why, that's only ten miles from
+here!"
+
+"Correct, my son; correct. They'll be nearer yet, very soon."
+
+Tom was excited in a moment, and eagerly began to ask many questions.
+The young lieutenant replied to them all, and then said to the Quaker,
+who had remained silent during the conversation, "And now, Friend
+Nathan, you feel sure that those redcoats will carry the word back to
+Clinton that we've turned out of our way to meet them, do you?"
+
+"Verily, I do," replied Nathan. "It was for the very purpose of learning
+the plans of Washington that they dared to venture as far as this. I
+endeavored to learn from the soldier what effect he thought his report
+would have upon the British leader, but he did not speak in many words.
+Doubtless he considered them valueless to a man of peace. But thy
+surmise is correct, I doubt not."
+
+"Then the sooner we put out of this the better, Tom; that is, if you're
+still of the same mind you were day before yesterday."
+
+"I'm ready to go," replied Tom eagerly.
+
+The thought of the American army being only ten miles away aroused all
+his enthusiasm once more. He knew nothing of camp life, and the
+hardships were not in his thoughts. He knew that he had no place to
+which he could go, and now that he had left Benzeor's home he felt like
+an outcast. Besides, he had dreamed of joining the army, and, now that
+at last the longed-for day had arrived, all his curiosity and eagerness
+returned in full measure.
+
+"But I haven't any horse and you're mounted," he added. "I don't see how
+I can go with you. You can't wait for me to trudge along on foot."
+
+"That is something of a poser," replied the lieutenant. "No, it's a fact
+I can't waste much time on the road with such news as I have to carry
+back to camp. Perhaps my horse will carry double part of the way."
+
+"I have a beast I might let thee have," said Nathan.
+
+"That's the way to talk!" said the lieutenant eagerly. "Where is this
+horse of yours?"
+
+"It is out in the back lot in the woods. My heart was filled with fears
+of the war men, and I dared not to leave any of my property within their
+sight."
+
+As Nathan still hesitated, the lieutenant said quickly, "Hurry up,
+Nathan! Get your horse and let us start. We've no time to lose."
+
+"Thou knowest that I am a man of peace," said the Quaker slowly. "It is
+not for me to waste my property in this wicked war."
+
+"That's the way the wind blows, is it?" laughed the lieutenant. "Well, I
+don't know that I can promise you very much, but I'll do what I can for
+you after I get back to camp. But I'll tell you what, Nathan, you'll not
+be the loser to give up the horse to us, and with a good grace, too.
+Both of the armies are likely to pass this way, and you won't have much
+left on your place, I can tell you. Now, if you give it up you may get
+something for it, and then, too, you'll have the credit of doing
+something for your country."
+
+"What did the war men give thee, Friend Thomas? Did I not hear thee say
+that the war men rewarded thee for thy services?"
+
+"Yes," said Tom quickly, drawing the two half joes forth from his pocket
+as he spoke. "Here they are. You can have them and welcome."
+
+"The beast is not what would be considered a valuable one, Friend
+Thomas, and yet he is still capable of rendering some service to me. I
+will take one of thy half joes and leave the other with thee. Then thou
+canst see that I am suitably repaid after thou hast joined thy comrades
+in the war."
+
+The young lieutenant slyly winked at Tom as the lad handed the man one
+of his half joes, and then said, "Hurry up, Nathan! We've got to start
+soon, and ought to be off now. We'll do the best we can for you, as we
+said. You're going to give us something to eat, aren't you, before we
+go?"
+
+"It shall be according to thy desire. Rachel, if thou hast some milk and
+a small portion of corn bread, set it before these guests whilst I am
+gone for my beast."
+
+The old man departed, and his wife carried out his request. The
+lieutenant and Tom at once seated themselves at the table and hastily
+ate the food she set before them, for neither knew when another
+opportunity might be found. In the ten miles which lay between them and
+the army of Washington many adventures might be awaiting them, and it
+was only the part of wisdom to make the most of the present.
+
+"I have thy beast for thee," said Nathan, soon afterwards entering the
+room. "He is not what might be called by thee a swift beast, but he is
+still possessed of some excellent qualities. Thou hast promised to see
+that I am further rewarded for my gift."
+
+Tom and the lieutenant hastened out of the room to examine Nathan's
+"gift," and, as they saw the horse which he had tied to the post, they
+both stopped in surprise and the lieutenant broke into a loud laugh.
+
+"Oh, Friend Nathan," said he, adopting the Quaker's style of speech,
+"thou art a friend indeed! Dost thou call that thing a 'beast'? Thou
+hast cheated the lad woefully. A good half joe for that scarecrow? Thou
+oughtest to reward Thomas for riding him, for I am of the opinion that I
+shall be compelled to carry him into camp in two pieces if he mounts
+that 'razorback.' Oh, Nathan, Nathan! Who would have believed it of
+thee?"
+
+The horse was old and gaunt. A spavin was apparent in one leg, while on
+another was a great ringbone. One eye betrayed its blindness, and,
+altogether, the poor animal presented a most woe-begone and helpless
+appearance.
+
+"He hath not beauty, as I told thee," said Nathan soberly. "But he is of
+value to me, and thou hast promised to see that I am suitably rewarded."
+
+"Oh, Tom! Tom!" laughed the lieutenant. "What a sight you'll be on the
+back of that bunch of bones! There's no help for it, though. Come on and
+we'll see what the poor 'beast' can do!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE RELEASE OF BENZEOR
+
+
+BENZEOR'S plight was a sad one, but as he gazed about him in his
+helplessness the only face upon which he could discover any traces of
+sympathy or compassion was that of Little Peter. The lad had had no
+suspicion of his neighbor, and was ignorant, as we know, of the part
+which Benzeor had taken in the attack on his father's house. Even now it
+was difficult for him to believe that Ted had spoken truly. He must have
+been mistaken, Peter thought, as he recalled the kindness of Sarah and
+Benzeor's wife in permitting the children to find a shelter in their
+home.
+
+Perhaps the perplexed lad's face betrayed his feelings, for just at that
+moment Benzeor looked up and said,--
+
+"There! That boy knows me!" and he pointed at Little Peter as he spoke.
+"He knows all about me, for he's a neighbor of mine. I tell you there's
+been a mistake. I'm not the man you're"--
+
+Benzeor's words were suddenly interrupted by Ted, who thrust his head
+again under the water, and when he lifted him out once more the prisoner
+was sputtering and gasping for breath.
+
+"Made a mistake, did I?" exclaimed the angry giant. "Well, mebbe I did,
+but I reckon the biggest one was in not keepin' you under the river all
+the time. Runnin' round here prowlin' on defenseless women folks and
+tryin' to steal what little money they've got left! Drownin' 's too good
+for such as you!" And, unable to restrain himself, the angry man again
+shook his helpless victim till it seemed as if the little breath Benzeor
+retained must be driven from his body.
+
+"I--I--I'm telling you the truth," gasped Benzeor when he had recovered
+sufficiently to be able to speak again. "Won't you help me? Won't you
+save me from this--this--man?" he pleaded, turning to the men in the
+whaleboat. "That--that boy there knows me, and he'll tell you I--I--I'm
+all right. Won't you, Little Peter? Please! Please, tell them!"
+
+"Do you know him?" said the leader to Little Peter.
+
+"Yes," replied the lad quietly.
+
+"Ye don't know any good of him, do ye?" said Ted, interrupting, and
+tightening his grasp upon the collar of his victim as he spoke.
+
+"He is a neighbor of mine, as he said. I never knew any bad of him. And
+his wife and girl are taking care of the children. I know that." Little
+Peter was perplexed, and his suspicions had been aroused by the
+discovery of his neighbor in his present predicament, but the
+recollection of Sarah's kindness moved him to refer to their recent
+actions, in the hope that he might aid her father.
+
+"Ho! ho! ho!" laughed Ted. "Then his wife takes care of her children,
+does she? She must be a wonderful woman to do that. Well, let her take
+care of her brats, and I'll take care of her man, and good care, too!"
+
+As Ted acted as if he were about to renew his attentions, the leader
+hastily said, "The lad doesn't mean this fellow's children, but his own
+little brothers and sisters," and in a few words he related the story of
+the attack on Little Peter's home, and the sad loss which had occurred
+there.
+
+"Ye don't say so!" said Ted, bestowing a glance of sympathy upon the
+boy. "That's bad! It is indeed! And ye say this fellow has taken yer
+little brothers and sisters into his place?"
+
+"Yes," said Peter eagerly.
+
+"Well, all I can say is that I'd about as soon put a hawk to look after
+chickens, if it was my doin's."
+
+"Yes," said Benzeor quickly, striving to take advantage of the
+impression which Little Peter's words had momentarily created. "Yes, the
+children are all at my house, and being well looked after, too. That
+doesn't look very much, does it, as if I was a bad man? I tell you
+there's been a mistake! There's been a mistake! I didn't have anything
+to do with the attack on this man's place. Help me! Help me!" he hastily
+cried out, as Ted acted as if he were about to repeat his former
+actions.
+
+"Hold on a minute, Ted. Perhaps the man's got something more to say,"
+said the leader.
+
+"I am a-holdin' on. Can't ye see that?" replied Ted grimly, once more
+tightening his grasp upon the unfortunate Benzeor's collar.
+
+"I have got something to say. Something you want to hear, too," said
+Benzeor eagerly, and appealing to the leader in the whaleboat as he
+spoke.
+
+"Say it," said Ted gruffly.
+
+"The British are going to make an attack on the ship down in the bay."
+
+"What's that you say?" said the leader quickly. "Do you mean on the
+Washington?"
+
+"Yes, yes, that's just what I mean. There are a couple of gunboats off
+the shore here now, and they're going to land some men and get her back
+again."
+
+"There are two boats off the shore, Ted. I happen to know that, for this
+very craft we've got along with us we took from them this afternoon,"
+said the leader. And he briefly related the story of the capture.
+
+"There, ye see I'm right!" said Benzeor, eager to follow up the
+impression his words and those of the leader had created. "Now if you'll
+help me out of the clutches of"--
+
+"Keep still, you!" interrupted Ted angrily. "It'll be time enough for
+you to talk when I let go on ye. I reckon nobody is a-goin' to take you
+out o' my clutches till I get good and ready to let ye go. Now then,
+stand up straight and speak yer piece like a little man! How did ye
+happen to know the British was a-goin' to make an attack on the
+Washington?"
+
+"I heard one of the men up by your house say so."
+
+"I thought ye didn't have anything to do with that attack on poor
+Sallie! She's my wife, I'd have ye know. I thought you was a-sayin' you
+wasn't there, and all the time I see ye, and chased ye right out o' my
+yard, clear down to the river! And now ye say ye heard one of the men
+there tell about the plan the British have on deck to get the Washington
+back again!"
+
+"I didn't say I wasn't there," pleaded Benzeor. "All I said was that I
+didn't have anything to do with it, and I didn't."
+
+"Ye"--began Ted, all his anger instantly returning.
+
+"Hold on, Ted! Hold on! Let's hear what the man has to say," exclaimed
+the leader.
+
+"I'll hold on, never ye fret yerself about that!" replied Ted, still
+retaining a firm grasp on his victim, but nevertheless abandoning the
+action he had evidently had in mind.
+
+"I was there, I'm not denying that," pleaded Benzeor; "but I didn't have
+a gun in my hands, and I didn't touch the rope either. I fell in with
+the men and they made me go with them. I just couldn't help myself. And
+it was while I was there I heard 'em talking about the plan to take the
+Love--I mean the Washington," he hastily added. "They're going to take
+her in the morning."
+
+"You mean they're going to try to take her," said the leader.
+
+"Yes, that's what I mean; they're going to try to take her."
+
+"The reptile may be tellin' the truth," said Ted soberly. "I had some o'
+the best o' the Washington's cargo myself. Ye know they brought about
+all that was aboard o' her up to Manasquan, and sold it here, or
+leastwise Marshal John Stokes sold it for 'em. I happen to know about
+that, and the vermin here may be tellin' the truth. Sometimes he does it
+by mistake, I suppose."
+
+A few weeks prior to this time the British ship Love and Unity ran
+ashore near Tom's River. There were those among the people of the region
+who wagged their heads and winked slyly whenever they referred to the
+misfortune of the vessel, for it was a prevailing impression there that
+the pilot had not been especially favorable to the British, and more by
+design than by accident had grounded the vessel near the shore.
+
+Be that as it may, the militia had quickly rallied, and as most of the
+men were as much at home upon the water as they were upon the land, they
+seized the unfortunate Love and Unity, and brought her safely into port
+as a prize.
+
+The cargo was considered a very valuable one, consisting, as it did,
+chiefly of sugar and various liquors highly prized by the men of those
+days, and, after being duly advertised, was sold by John Stokes at
+Manasquan.
+
+The Love and Unity was renamed the Washington, and at this time was
+lying at anchor near the mouth of Tom's River, within the shelter of
+Barnegat Bay. As most of the men in the whaleboat, as well as the mighty
+Ted himself, were familiar with these facts, the words of Benzeor
+naturally created a far deeper impression than they might otherwise have
+done.
+
+"I'll tell ye what," said Ted suddenly, turning Benzeor about so that he
+could look directly into his face as he spoke, "ye seem so well posted
+I've half a mind to let ye go."
+
+"I'm telling you just exactly what I heard," said Benzeor, his hope of
+escape instantly increasing. "That's what I heard the men say."
+
+"And it was in the mornin' when they was goin' to come?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, I'm a-goin' to let you off. Hold on a minit," he added as Benzeor
+strove to free himself. "I haven't finished yet. I'm thinkin' of lettin'
+ye go on one condition."
+
+"What's that?" said Benzeor eagerly.
+
+"I'm comin' to that pretty quick. I'm pretty comfortable here, so to
+speak, and don't appear to be in such a hurry as you." As the two men
+were still standing in the water, and Benzeor's teeth were chattering
+from cold or fear, the words of the huge man were perhaps not fully
+appreciated by his prisoner. "Ye appear to be so happy over yer
+information--though fer my part I don't see what ye held it back till
+this time fer--that I'm a-goin' to give ye a treat. I'm a-goin' to let
+ye go, yes, I am; ye needn't be scart about that. Ye're goin', and I'll
+tell ye where ye're goin', too. Ye're goin, to join the crew o' this
+whaleboat and go down and help them defend the Washington against her
+enemies. That's the condition I'm placin' on ye, and that's what I'm
+goin' to do with ye."
+
+And the powerful man picked Benzeor up in his arms and placed him in
+the whaleboat next to Peter, who, we may be sure, had not been an
+uninterested observer of all that had occurred.
+
+"There ye be," said Ted, breaking forth into a loud laugh as he saw the
+dripping Benzeor hastily take his seat and glance apprehensively toward
+him. "Now, then," he added, turning to the leader, and still remaining
+in the water, which came well up to his shoulders as he placed his hand
+on the side of the supply boat, "if ye want me to, I'll take charge o'
+yer prize. You'll be puttin' straight fer Tom's River, I doubt not, and
+ye won't want to be bothered by an extra craft. I'll hide her in a good
+place up the shore, and likely enough I may come down to the bay myself
+in the night. Ye'll be settin' up a-waitin' fer me, won't ye?" he added,
+speaking to Benzeor.
+
+As that individual made no reply, Ted again began to converse with the
+leader of the band, and in a few minutes all the details were arranged.
+The captured boat was to be left in his charge, and soon the whaleboat
+started down the river toward the ocean.
+
+The sun had now disappeared from sight, but the approach of night was
+all the more favorable for the plans of the men. When once they were
+out on the ocean, they hoisted a sail and sped rapidly down the coast.
+
+A sail of a little more than twenty miles brought them to Barnegat
+Inlet, and as they entered the bay it was decided to make use of the
+oars again. It was almost midnight when at last they saw the Washington
+at anchor in Tom's River, and their hail was quickly answered.
+
+Little Peter was so thoroughly wearied by the labors of the long day
+that he was rejoiced to be told that he could turn in for the night.
+Benzeor was to have a hammock near him, and, tired as the lad was, he
+eagerly began to ply the man with questions when they had withdrawn from
+their fellows.
+
+"Benzeor, I came down here to find out about father. I suppose you know
+he was taken by Fenton's gang and that my mother was shot?"
+
+"I heard about it."
+
+"It was terrible, Benzeor. I don't know what I should have done if Sarah
+hadn't taken the children. 'Twas good of her, and of you, too, for you
+know all about it, I see. I shan't forget it very soon."
+
+As Benzeor made no reply, Peter continued: "I don't know just what to
+do to find out about father. The pine robbers have their quarters down
+here, I'm told, and I thought I'd tell Captain Dennis about it and
+perhaps he would send out a party to search for him. I didn't know just
+what to make of your being here at first, but I see you have had trouble
+with them, too. That was mean of Ted to treat you as he did when you
+said the pine robbers made you go with them. Was it Fenton's band that
+got hold of you?"
+
+"Yes; that is, I don't think so. I'm not just sure who they were."
+
+"Couldn't have been Fenton then, for you know him when you see him, I'm
+sure. Benzeor, don't you think I'd better report the capture of my
+father to Captain Dennis and ask him if he won't send out a searching
+party?"
+
+"No," said Benzeor slowly. "I don't think that will do any good."
+
+"Why not? What else can I do?"
+
+"Why, the fact is," said Benzeor, "I heard those men talking about your
+father, too."
+
+"Did you?" said Peter eagerly, sitting up in his hammock as he spoke. He
+could not see his companion's face in the darkness, and perhaps it was
+as well for the troubled lad that he could not, for he would have seen
+little to comfort him expressed upon it.
+
+"Yes, I heard 'em. There's no use in your reporting it to Captain Dennis
+or to any one else."
+
+"Why not? Why not? They haven't shot him, have they?"
+
+"No. He's been sent to New York."
+
+Peter said no more. The thick darkness seemed like that within his own
+soul. All his efforts had been worse than useless, and the troubled boy
+knew not what next to do.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE FLEET OF BARGES
+
+
+THE present visit was by no means the first which Little Peter had made
+to Barnegat Bay and the vicinity of Tom's River. Before the outbreaking
+of the war he had occasionally gone there with Webberly West, the most
+noted hunter of deer and wolves in all the region. Great had been the
+pride of Little Peter when he had returned home with his first deer,
+some four or five years before this time; and, as he lay in his hammock
+that night, again and again his thoughts wandered from his present
+difficulties to the days when he had tramped through the region with the
+venerable hunter Webberly.
+
+The old man had died just before the war began, but many of his quaint
+expressions and kindly acts remained in Little Peter's memory. He it was
+who had taught him how to dig the pits and cover them over with brush,
+and place the tempting pieces of meat as a decoy for the prowling
+wolves. Little Peter could never forget the first time success had
+crowned his efforts, and he had looked down upon the eyes of the wolf
+which had fallen into the pit. He could feel the thrill of that
+excitement even now.
+
+And Webberly had taught him also how to catch the great snapping turtles
+which abounded in the streams. Sometimes turtles were taken which
+weighed fully thirty pounds each. What savage creatures they were! and
+yet the old hunter had handled them as if he had known no fear. A
+constant war was waged upon these creatures by the settlers for two
+reasons, one of which was that they were highly valued as an article of
+food. The captive would be thrown into a barrel and for a few days fed
+upon the refuse from the tables, to which perhaps at times more
+substantial food would be added, and then when the turtles had gained
+the proper degree of plumpness, a feast would be made to which friends
+and neighbors were not infrequently invited. The eggs of the turtles
+also were highly valued; and so plentiful were they in the warm sand
+along the shore that a bushel-basket was frequently filled with them
+after a brief search. It was true the foxes were as eager as the men to
+dig out and devour the turtles' eggs, but the supply appeared to be
+almost inexhaustible and there were more than enough for all.
+
+Another reason which prompted the settlers to prey upon the huge turtles
+was the fact that their ducks suffered from the savage creatures. A
+turtle would seize a duck in his claws and tear and devour the bird in
+an incredibly short time. Naturally, the owners of the ducks objected to
+the methods of the turtles, and a constant warfare was the result.
+
+Peter had occasionally gone down to Barnegat with Indian John also. The
+Indian always seemed to know just where the clams could be found in
+greatest abundance, and he knew as well just how they ought to be
+cooked. He would dig a hole in the sand and then fill it with wood, to
+which he would set fire. Then the clams would be poured into the place
+and covered over with seaweed and brush. When a sufficient time had
+passed, the brush and seaweed would be raked out, and the cooked clams
+were considered as a great luxury. This custom of the Indians was
+bequeathed to the whites, and their method of cooking the clams remains
+in some portions of the land until this day.
+
+Between the thoughts of his own troubles and his recollections of former
+visits to the place in which he then was, not much sleep came to Little
+Peter that night. The knowledge that his father had been sent to New
+York--for the troubled lad did not think of doubting Benzeor's
+words--and the prospect of an attack upon the Washington on the
+following morning were both sources of deep anxiety to the sadly
+troubled boy. Only four men were on board when the whaleboat had
+returned; and while the addition of the ten men she brought, or eleven
+if Benzeor was to be included in the list of the Washington's defenders,
+materially increased her strength, still, the prospect of a strong
+defense was not very bright, and if the truth was known Little Peter was
+not the only one on board who passed a sleepless night.
+
+In addition to all this, the lad was sorely troubled as to his own
+future movements. With his father a prisoner in New York and the
+children quartered for the present at Benzeor's, Little Peter could not
+determine what was best for him to do. To go to the city and seek to aid
+his father there would be worse than useless now; nor was he able to
+provide for his younger brothers and sisters. The problem had not been
+solved when at last he fell into a troubled sleep, from which he was
+awakened by the sound of men moving about on deck.
+
+Hastily arising, and noting that Benzeor already was astir, he soon made
+his way up to his companions. The sun was well up in the eastern sky,
+and the men were preparing for such a defense as might be made against
+any attempt to retake the boat.
+
+Little Peter found that the most of the men did not believe that any
+such attempt would be made; and the suspicion with which they regarded
+Benzeor increased the feeling of sympathy which the lad felt for him,
+for to him it seemed as if his neighbor had been most unjustly treated,
+not only by the powerful Ted, but by the men of the whaleboat as well.
+He thought he had abundant cause for believing in Benzeor's honesty, for
+had he not received his own little brothers and sisters into his home?
+Surely, a man who would do that could not be bad, and his indignation
+against his recent companions increased as he noticed their
+ill-concealed dislike for his neighbor.
+
+The men all had breakfast on board; and while a constant watch was
+maintained, nothing as yet had been seen to arouse their suspicion that
+an attack was likely to be made. Even Little Peter was beginning to
+think that either Benzeor had been mistaken or that the British had
+changed their plans, and that nothing would be done that morning. He was
+about to approach the leader and explain to him the necessity for his
+own departure, when he was startled by a cry from the watch.
+
+Looking out over the bay, Little Peter could see a number of barges
+approaching. Startled by the sight, he counted the boats until he could
+distinctly make out eight of them. Doubtless there were eight or ten men
+in each boat, and altogether there must be at least seventy in the
+approaching party.
+
+The excitement on board the Washington at once became intense. The men
+stood together on the deck watching the little fleet on the bay. The
+only means by which they could defend themselves were their muskets, and
+it was soon discovered that these would not avail much against the
+enemy, for with the aid of a glass it was discovered that in the bow of
+one of the approaching boats a small cannon had been mounted.
+
+A hurried consultation was held by the men on board, to which neither
+Little Peter nor Benzeor was invited; the former because he was
+considered too young to be of much account, and the latter because no
+one trusted him.
+
+"They'll get this craft now," said Benzeor, approaching the place where
+the lad was standing. "Perhaps these fellows will believe me another
+time."
+
+There was a tone of exultation in Benzeor's voice that startled Little
+Peter, and turning quickly about he said, "You did speak truly, Benzeor.
+I wish I were out of this. We stand no chance at all."
+
+"You needn't be alarmed. There won't be any fighting done. You took my
+part yesterday, and I'll not see you suffer now. I'll fix you out all
+right."
+
+"You'll fix me out? I don't see what you can do. We ought to leave the
+ship this minute. I don't see what we're waiting for." Little Peter
+spoke anxiously and was at no pains to conceal the alarm he felt.
+
+"I hope they won't run," said Benzeor quietly. His air of confidence was
+confusing; but as yet Little Peter was not suspicious of his neighbor.
+
+"They don't act as if they were going to," said the lad quickly, as the
+assembly of the men broke up and all began to rush about the deck.
+
+"Come, my lad! come!" said the leader. "Lend a hand here! And you, too,"
+he added to Benzeor; "bestir yourself."
+
+Benzeor's face fell, but he was in no position to refuse to obey. Such
+defenses as the Washington possessed were rolled together behind the
+rail, and it was at once evident that the men were not planning to give
+up the ship without a struggle.
+
+The long whaleboat was placed in readiness to receive them, in case
+flight became necessary, and then the men waited for the approach of the
+attacking party.
+
+The boats came steadily on, keeping well together. Little Peter found
+himself sharing in the excitement, but as the outlines of the men became
+more distinct his fears increased. What could be done against so many,
+for it was now seen that there were more men in the barges than at first
+had been estimated. The boats were spread out in a semicircle, but they
+were all converging toward the Washington, and plainly would begin the
+attack together. There were more of those small cannon also than at
+first had been seen; and as the boats came nearer and nearer, it was
+discovered that a man was standing near each and ready to fire at the
+word of command.
+
+The faces of the men on board the Washington were all pale now, and not
+a word had been spoken for several minutes. Each man was intent upon the
+movements of the men in the barges, and did not turn away from the sight
+before him. Benzeor was the sole exception, and Little Peter could not
+understand the meaning of the half exultant smile upon his face. For
+himself, he was too badly frightened to speak, and the evident fear
+manifested by his companions did not tend to allay his own.
+
+The waters in the mouth of the river spread out almost as smooth as
+glass. The rays of the morning sun were reflected from the surface of
+the water and made it sparkle like silver. The occasional call of some
+seabird or the flight of the low flying gulls were all that broke in
+upon the silence, but no one heeded them. It was that slow moving but
+steadily approaching fleet of barges that held the attention of all.
+
+Little Peter wondered why the command to shoot was not given, for the
+boats were all within range now. His own hands were trembling in his
+excitement, but he was eager to act. At one moment he longed to leap
+overboard and try to swim to the shore, and then again he would feel as
+if he must do something to check the approach of those men in the
+barges.
+
+Not a word had yet been spoken, however. The oars of the approaching men
+could now be distinctly seen as they rose and fell together. Steadily on
+and on came the little fleet, and now could not be more than two hundred
+yards away. Why did not the men on board do something? He felt that the
+time for action had come, but all were standing silent and motionless,
+apparently fascinated by the sight before them. The smile on Benzeor's
+face was almost mocking, and Little Peter saw him look from the fleet to
+the men on board, almost as if he were exulting in their predicament.
+What could it all mean? Why was not something done? Surely the time for
+action had come, but still no one spoke.
+
+A hail now came from the approaching fleet, and the man who evidently
+was in command stood up in his place. He was still too far away for his
+words to be heard, and again the barges, which had halted for a moment,
+resumed their approach and with an increased speed.
+
+"Men," suddenly called the leader of those on board the Washington, in a
+low voice, "we must get out of this! We're outnumbered seven or eight to
+one, and it would be just murder for us to stay here. Man the whaleboat,
+and we'll put out for the shore."
+
+The hopelessness of any defense was so apparent that the men instantly
+responded and made a rush for the whaleboat, which had been made ready
+for just such an emergency. In a moment the men were on board and had
+grasped their oars preparatory to starting for the shore, when Little
+Peter suddenly noticed that Benzeor was not with them.
+
+"Hold on! Hold on a minute!" he called. "Benzeor isn't here!"
+
+The leader, who had remained on deck to be the last to leave, turned
+quickly at the words and discovered Benzeor striving to conceal himself
+among the defenses which had been piled together against the rail.
+
+"Here, you!" he shouted. "Come out of that and get aboard! Be quick
+about it! I'll wing you if you don't," he added, raising his gun as he
+spoke, noticing that his call was not likely to be heeded.
+
+Benzeor quickly responded, and sullenly took his place on board the
+whaleboat; but the men were all too intent upon their escape to bestow
+much attention upon him.
+
+In a moment the leader leaped on board and gave the order to give way.
+The long whaleboat darted swiftly forward as the men began to pull
+desperately at their oars. They needed no encouragement now, for, with
+their departure from the Washington, their only hope of safety lay in a
+quick passage to the shore, which lay about a hundred yards away.
+
+A shout from the men in the barges greeted the appearance of the
+whaleboat as it shot out into sight, but the hail was not heeded. One of
+the small cannon was discharged, and from one of the barges came a
+volley; but only one man was hit, and the whaleboat rapidly increased
+its speed.
+
+The shore was near now, and the desperate men were putting forth all
+their strength. The barges did not pursue, for the sailors were intent
+upon gaining the ship first of all. In a few moments the whaleboat
+grounded, and the men leaped out and started quickly for the woods which
+grew close to the shore.
+
+Little Peter was in the rear, and as he turned back to see what would be
+done by the other party, he was astonished to see Benzeor turn quickly
+and start at full speed for the whaleboat again. In a moment he had
+leaped on board, and, seizing one of the oars, with a strong push sent
+the boat far out upon the river.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+THE RIDE WITH THE LIEUTENANT
+
+
+TOM COWARD followed young Lieutenant Gordon as he led the way to the
+post to which Friend Nathan had tied the steed, and then stopped and for
+a moment gazed ruefully at the beast. His friend's good-natured laugh
+broke forth again as he beheld Tom's evident hesitancy about mounting to
+the back of the animal; and surely to a boy who had been accustomed to
+ride the colts in Benzeor's pastures without saddle or bridle, and dash
+about the lots in sheer delight at the antics and efforts of the
+unbroken steeds to dislodge their rider, there was not much to inspire
+or impress him in the sight of the broken-winded beast which Nathan had
+provided. Even the horse himself appeared to be conscious of his
+degradation, and stood motionless and with hanging head, as if he, too,
+would protest against any warlike efforts on his part.
+
+"I've only one request to make, Nathan," said the lieutenant. "I'm sure
+you will not object to it, but I think I'd better make it before we
+start."
+
+"What is thy request?" said the Quaker.
+
+"If General Washington once sees that horse, he'll want it for himself.
+You'll not object, will you, to his use of it?"
+
+"Nay. I think not that George Washington will care for this beast of
+mine," protested Nathan soberly, and apparently not suspecting that the
+young officer was poking fun at him. "Still, he may be able to make him
+of some use. Thee will not forget to see that I am suitably rewarded?"
+
+"Never fear as to that, though I doubt not my friend Tom here will be of
+the opinion that you ought to pay him handsomely for the pain he will
+suffer after he has ridden your beast a few miles. That is, if the horse
+can go as far as that."
+
+"Thy heart may rest easy as to that. He may limp when he first starts,
+but as soon as his joints are warmed he will do thy service."
+
+"We'll warm his joints, then," laughed the lieutenant. "You might be
+warming him up now, Tom," he added, turning to his companion, "while I'm
+getting my horse ready. He's in the barn, and I'll join you in a minute
+or two."
+
+In a brief time the officer returned, but his steed was showing the
+evidences of his recent hard work, and Nathan's eyes twinkled with
+satisfaction at the sight, for his own horse, perhaps, might not then be
+at such a disadvantage, and the prospect of a "suitable" reward became
+more promising.
+
+The young men quickly mounted, and, after thanking their host in a
+substantial manner for his hospitality, started down the long lane which
+led to the road beyond. Tom's horse limped painfully and caused no
+little delight to young Gordon, who again and again laughed aloud and
+offered all manner of suggestions to the lad concerning the impression
+he would create when the army should discover his approach.
+
+At times Tom thought of dismounting and, turning the horse loose in the
+road, strive to make his own way on foot; but the creaking joints of the
+poor beast seemed to find relief with action, and the young riders had
+not gone far on their way before, to the surprise of both, Nathan's
+steed was proving his ability to keep up with the lieutenant's horse,
+which evidently had been overridden and was in no condition for a hard
+ride.
+
+But, with the discovery of the service which Tom's horse might render,
+all the disposition to regard their journey lightly departed from the
+riders, and the serious nature of their undertaking rendered both of
+them silent. The American army could not be far distant now, but between
+them and it all the dangers had not disappeared. The visit of the
+British band at the home of Nathan Brown had indicated that other
+parties might be in the region on similar errands; but Tom was not
+thinking of these possibilities so much as was the young officer who was
+riding by his side.
+
+Tom's meditations were mostly concerning the American army. For months
+his strongest desire had been to join it, and now that the time had come
+when his desires were likely to be satisfied, he discovered that much of
+his eagerness was gone. Not that he had any thought of turning back, but
+the proximity of the two armies clearly indicated that a meeting between
+the forces was not improbable, and Tom's thoughts were largely of that.
+The glamour was all gone now, and the serious nature of his undertaking
+was uppermost in his mind. The silence also of his companion did not
+tend to allay his fears, but the lad did not refer to them, and was
+doing his utmost to make his horse keep up the pace at which he was
+going.
+
+"Whew! This is a warm morning! Let's give our horses a drink and a
+rest," said the lieutenant at last, as he turned into a little brook
+that crossed the road.
+
+Tom followed his example, and the dripping horses thrust their heads
+deep into the water. The sun had now appeared and the beams fell full on
+their faces. The air was motionless, and even at that early hour was in
+places quivering under the heat of the summer sun. The very birds were
+silent, while high overhead the heavens were like brass. On the horizon
+masses of dark clouds were piled, and a low, deep rumble startled both
+the young riders.
+
+"Was that a cannon, or was it thunder?" inquired Tom quickly.
+
+"Thunder. We may hear the cannon before long, though."
+
+"Why don't we start on, then? The sooner we gain the army the better. We
+don't want to be caught in here between them." Tom spoke anxiously, and
+his fear was as apparent in the expression upon his face as in his
+words.
+
+"We've got to give our horses a bit of a rest. Mine has been going hard
+all night, and yours won't be able to go far in such heat as this. We'll
+have to be careful of their strength, or we shall be worse off than we
+are now."
+
+"Have you been out all night? What have you been doing?"
+
+"Finding out what Clinton is up to. When I was talking with Nathan I
+knew all the time more about it than he did."
+
+"Did you find out?" said Tom eagerly. "What are the redcoats doing now?"
+
+"Pretty much the same thing they've been doing right along. They're
+making a change in the direction they're going, unless I'm greatly
+mistaken. And then, too, they've done something else which doesn't
+promise very well."
+
+"What's that?"
+
+"They've drawn all their stronger forces into the rear guard and sent on
+the Hessians with the baggage train in front, for one thing."
+
+"Why do you suppose they have done that?"
+
+"Oh, they've an idea, I fancy, that we're going to try to take their
+supplies. They'll find out, though, that we're after men more than we
+are after their baggage wagons. However, that explains the change in
+the direction of their march, if I'm not greatly mistaken. They've put
+the Hessians in front and the best men behind."
+
+"I wish they had left the Dutch butchers there!" said Tom impulsively.
+"I hate the Hessians. I hate the very name and sight of them! Think of
+it! A lot of men just hired to come over here and shoot and kill and
+steal! I wish they had been left where they were, that is, if General
+Washington is ready for them!"
+
+"I think you'll find him ready when the time comes," remarked the
+lieutenant quietly. "But about the Hessians. I don't like them any
+better than you do, but somehow I can't bring myself to feel about it as
+some of the men do. I can't see that they're to be blamed for being
+brought over here, or even being engaged in such work as they're doing;
+and I know more about that than you do, too. The ones who are the worst
+are not those who have come over here, but those who have sent them.
+Just think of a petty little prince, or king, being able to hire out a
+lot of his own subjects to pay off his own debts with! These men feel
+just the same as you or I would, I have thought. They have wives and
+mothers and children, and yet they have to leave them all and come over
+here and be marks for our bullets, whether they want to be or not. They
+just haven't anything to say about it. They're told to come and come
+they must, though there won't be so many to go back as came over, I'm
+thinking. At least, I'm going to do all I can to thin out their ranks,
+though I feel sorry for the poor fellows all of the time."
+
+This was a new way of looking at the hated "Dutch butchers," at least it
+was entirely new to Tom Coward. He had heard only the expressions of
+rage among the colonists which their coming had aroused, and their
+strange words and brutal acts had never received much mercy in the
+judgment which he had heard passed upon them by his acquaintances.
+
+The anger of the patriots, perhaps, was but natural; but the employment
+of the Hessians has not furnished the only instance in history where the
+first and most apparent view has not always been the most correct one.
+Indeed, it frequently happens that the troubles between men, to say
+nothing of boys, arises from a misunderstanding; and it is the part of
+wisdom, as well as of justice, to look below the surface and try to
+discover the true conditions.
+
+"Then the British are to be blamed, if what you say is true," said Tom,
+after a brief silence. "They are the ones at the bottom of it all."
+
+"Yes, the British are the ones who are most to be blamed. But even
+there, Tom, if I'm correctly informed, it's the leaders and not the
+people. The way I understand it is that the rank and file of the common
+people in England are opposed to this war, and would put a stop to it in
+a moment if they could."
+
+"If they could?" repeated Tom. "I don't understand what you mean."
+
+"Just what I say. The very best people in England have, from the very
+beginning of this war, been opposed to the taxes, the use of the
+Indians, and the hiring of these Hessians. It's the king and Lord North
+and a few others of the pig-headed fellows who are doing it all. Tom, my
+father and my mother both came from England. As far back as I can
+remember they have told me stories of our old home and of the friends we
+have over there. Why, do you know it's been the dream of my life to go
+over there some day, and meet some of my cousins and see the place
+where my father and mother were born."
+
+"I didn't know you were a tory," said Tom slowly.
+
+"Tory? I haven't a drop of tory blood in my veins, and hope I never
+shall have."
+
+"But--but--you talk like one."
+
+"Is it tory talk for me to say I don't blame the Hessians for coming
+over here, but those who hired them and sent them? Is it tory talk for
+me to say I love to think of the place where my father and mother were
+born, and that I should be glad to look into the faces of those who bear
+the same name I do, and who have some of the same kind of blood in their
+veins? Is it tory talk for me to say that I'm proud of what Old England
+has done, or rather of many things she has done, from the days of
+William the Conqueror until now? And that belongs to me as much as it
+does to them, for my own grandfather was one of the bravest men in the
+whole British army! This war is like one between brothers, and it's all
+the more wicked on that account. And it's worse yet, because the most of
+the Englishmen are not in favor of it at all."
+
+"I don't just see why you don't fight with the redcoats, instead of
+against them, then."
+
+"Because this is my home and this is my country, and because the king
+and his court aren't fit to govern cannibals, to say nothing of men. No,
+sir, it's just because I do believe in all I've said that I'm fighting
+for my country and shall till the war is ended--which I hope will be
+soon!"
+
+"And would you shoot a redcoat or a Dutch butcher?"
+
+"Every time! It was a sad thing that the war had to come, but as come it
+did, it would be sadder still not to do everything in our power now to
+carry it through. I'm sorry for the Hessians, but I'd shoot every one of
+them if I could do it. I'm sorry for the redcoats, and I know they are
+not to be blamed, or at least some of them are not, but I'd mow them
+down now, every one of them, as I'd cut the grass in haying-time. Fight?
+Why, my lad, I'm in this war from the crown of my head to the sole of my
+foot! And I wouldn't stop till the redcoats cry 'enough,' or we drive
+them right into the Atlantic ocean, the way Parson Tennent used to tell
+about the pigs in Gadara being chased by the devils right into the sea.
+Not that I think the ones who are doing the chasing are in any way
+connected with the swine drivers in the parson's story," he added,
+laughing lightly as he spoke. "But we must be going. Our horses are
+rested now, and we'll be running into a thunder-storm before we see the
+Continentals, if we don't look out."
+
+The ride was quickly resumed, but Tom Coward was silent and sadly
+puzzled to account for his friend's words. Apparently, he was
+enthusiastic in his devotion to the cause of the patriots, but he had
+never heard any one talk in that manner before. His friends and
+neighbors were all hard and bitter, and the bitterness seemed to
+increase as the war continued. But here was his friend, fighting with
+all the devotion of his heart, and yet not blaming the very men he was
+trying hard to conquer for the part they were taking in the war.
+
+It seemed to him all strange, and while he was deeply impressed by many
+of the words of the enthusiastic young lieutenant, his own feelings were
+of a very decidedly different character. For a half hour they rode
+forward as swiftly as their steeds could carry them, but the heavy
+clouds had meanwhile been climbing higher in the heavens, and the
+mutterings of the thunder had now become deeper and heavier.
+
+"We'll put into that barn ahead there, and wait for the storm to pass,"
+said the lieutenant, pointing as he spoke to a rude barn by the
+roadside.
+
+As the rain was now falling, Tom was glad to follow the advice, and in a
+few moments they approached the open door. They had not dismounted when
+a strangely clad being stepped forth from the barn and shouted:--
+
+"Halt, will yez? I'll be after havin' yez give an account of yerselves,
+that I will."
+
+Tom glanced up in fear and surprise, and the sight before him did not
+tend to allay his alarm. The soldier presented a gun, but was its bearer
+a man or woman? A long petticoat certainly looked like the garb of a
+woman, but the soldier also was clad in an artilleryman's coat, while a
+cocked hat and feathers crowned the head of the strange being.
+
+Tall, broad-shouldered, and with a voice that was gruff and deep, the
+strangely clad soldier bore but slight resemblance to a woman, though
+the dress certainly seemed to proclaim the sex of the speaker.
+
+The rain was now falling in torrents and Tom was drenched in a moment;
+but in the brief silence which followed the demand of the soldier, he
+could not determine what course his companion would decide to follow.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+A SOLDIER WOMAN
+
+
+"WHY, Molly, you aren't going to keep us out here in the rain, are you?"
+
+Tom looked up in surprise as he heard the young lieutenant's words; and
+while his fears were somewhat relieved by the assurance that his
+companion evidently had recognized the peculiar being before them, his
+confusion was not diminished by the reply which the strangely clad woman
+quickly made.
+
+"Sure, and it's me bye! It's me beautiful bye! Come in, me darlint! What
+for should ye be standin' out there in the storm?"
+
+The two dripping young soldiers speedily accepted the invitation, and
+entered the barn, leading their horses with them. To their surprise they
+now discovered that several men were also in the building, and that
+other horses were stalled in the barn.
+
+The appearance of Tom's horse was greeted by a shout of delight, and the
+person whom Lieutenant Gordon had addressed as "Molly" approached, and,
+after critically examining the poor beast for a moment, said:--
+
+"And where in the world did ye be after findin' that? It's a pity, it is
+indade, to be after compellin' such poor bastes as that to be fightin'
+the Dootch butchers! Sure, and it's the surgeon the poor thing is after
+needin'."
+
+Molly's hair was of a bright red color, her face was covered with
+freckles, which were like great blotches upon the skin, and her eyes
+were so faded as to be almost colorless; but her expression was so
+evidently one of good nature that Tom was compelled to join in the laugh
+which her words raised among the half dozen men who quickly assembled to
+pass judgment upon the steed which had been led into the barn.
+
+"Oh, that's something we bought back here to carry my friend as far as
+the army."
+
+"It's lucky, it is, that ye haven't very far to go, thin," laughed
+Molly.
+
+"Perhaps you're right, Molly," replied the lieutenant. "How far back is
+the army now?"
+
+"About a mile, I'm thinkin'."
+
+"What? What's that you say? Only a mile from here?"
+
+"That's what I'm tellin' yez. The army's been marchin' in the night; but
+this rain will be after compellin' it to halt right in--in Gooseberry,
+as I'm told they call it."
+
+"Cranberry," laughed the lieutenant.
+
+"Cranberry or Gooseberry is all one and the same thing to me. Now, me
+bye, ye'll be after wantin' some breakfast, I'm thinkin'. Jest say the
+word and I'll be fixin' ye out, and have a bit left over for yer poor
+baste, which doesn't look as if he'd been livin' any too high of late."
+
+"No, no, Molly," protested the lieutenant quickly, and, as Tom thought,
+with an eagerness he could not understand. "We're not hungry, for we had
+some breakfast before we started this morning. We did indeed," he added,
+as he noted the woman's apparent unbelief. "We're not hungry, but it's
+kind of you to think of us, and we thank you just the same as if you had
+fed us."
+
+In the course of the conversation between the young lieutenant and the
+men in the barn, Tom learned that the main body of the army was now less
+than a mile away. The little band had been one of the advance parties,
+and the storm had compelled them to seek the shelter of the barn by the
+roadside.
+
+Meanwhile, the rain continued to fall, and long after the thunder ceased
+the storm showed no signs of abating. The water almost covered the road
+and penetrated the roof of the barn, which was far from being in a good
+state of repair. The heavy downpour, however, did not seem to cool the
+air, and the men and horses were in a sad plight. Just why they should
+have sought the shelter, which virtually was no shelter at all, Tom
+could not understand; but he asked no questions, and busied himself in
+listening to the conversation of the men, and watching the intrepid
+Molly, who to all appearances was not aware of the fact that she was not
+as much of a true soldier as any of the men.
+
+After a half hour had passed the lieutenant approached the boy, who was
+standing before the open door, looking out upon the storm.
+
+"Who is she? What is she?" inquired Tom, indicating by a glance of his
+eyes the strange woman whom his friend had addressed as "Molly."
+
+"She? Oh, she's the wife of one of the cannoneers. She's been in the
+army for a long time. She's from New Jersey, too, I understand, though
+her husband's home is in Pennsylvania."
+
+"I didn't know there were women in the army."
+
+"Oh yes, there have always been some. Why, even on that expedition of
+Arnold's to Quebec there were several women who marched all the way with
+their husbands, and they say they stood the long tramps and the cold
+better than a good many of the men did."
+
+"Why did you call this woman 'Molly'? Is that her name?"
+
+"Oh, in the army, or at least in this army, the women have been the ones
+to bring us water on the warm days, and so we call each one Molly
+'Pitcher.' They've been kept busy during this hot spell, too. This
+woman's name I believe is really Molly, though,--Molly McCauley. Then
+you didn't expect to see women with their husbands in the army?" laughed
+the lieutenant, as he noticed that Tom was regarding Mistress McCauley
+curiously.
+
+"No, I didn't. I don't think I like it."
+
+"You'll find all sorts and kinds of people in the ranks. Some of the
+women have been worth more than the men. There was one up at Fort
+Clinton. She was very much such a looking woman as Captain Molly here,
+only she was a good deal more careless. They used to call her 'Dirty
+Kate,' because she wasn't always very neat in her personal appearance.
+But she was brave as a lion, and such a fighter! Why, she fired the last
+cannon at the British, as they came scrambling over the ramparts, which
+happened to be about the same time our men were leaving. Well, Kate's
+husband was a cannoneer, just as Molly's here is, and he was holding the
+match in his hand ready to fire the gun when he saw the redcoats coming,
+and the sight suddenly reminded him that he had some work to do outside
+the fort which demanded his immediate attention. Well, Kate just picked
+up the match her husband had dropped, touched off the cannon, and then
+scampered away after the men. She was a brave woman, and so is Captain
+Molly, here. She'd do as well as Kate did, if she had the chance, and
+perhaps she will before the end comes. I shouldn't want to have her
+fight me, I can tell you!"[2]
+
+Tom turned and looked again at the woman. She stood talking with her
+husband now, and her strange garb served to intensify her peculiarities.
+Her great size and evident strength were plainly to be seen, but her
+face beamed with good nature, and her enjoyment of the life she was
+living was indicated by her every word and action.
+
+Tom thought of Sarah, and the contrast between her gentleness and the
+rough appearance and masculine manners of Captain Molly aroused within
+him a feeling which was not altogether in favor of the soldier woman. It
+is true that the name of Sarah is unknown to-day, while that of Captain
+Molly Pitcher is recorded in all our school histories; but, after all,
+notoriety may not be the most valuable quality in life, and while the
+names of many men and women who lived quiet, faithful, honest lives may
+have been forgotten by their descendants, they may not have been of the
+less value to the world because of that fact. A good name is sometimes
+better than a notorious one, and an honest man, though he may be soon
+forgotten, may be greater than a dishonest man whose name is frequently
+mentioned. Few of us would desire to be like Benedict Arnold, although
+his name is a very familiar one to all.
+
+"I don't see any use in staying here," said Tom at last. "It's wet
+inside the barn, and it can't be much worse outside. Why don't we start
+on?"
+
+Now that he was so near to the American army, the lad was eager to go
+forward. All his dreams and visions of the forces which were fighting
+against the redcoats came back to him, and his impatience to proceed
+increased each moment. Perhaps the sight and presence of Captain Molly,
+as well as the account the young lieutenant had given of her, had
+created a still greater desire in Tom's heart to quit the place; but, be
+that as it may, he was ready to go, and apparently his companion shared
+in his feeling.
+
+"If you think your horse will stand up for a mile, we might do as you
+say," replied the lieutenant. "I think we'll be going on," he added,
+turning to the men as he spoke. "I've some important information to give
+the general, and as I don't see any signs of the rain stopping, I think
+we ought not to delay longer. We can't be much worse off than we are
+now."
+
+"Sure, and ye'll not be after goin' out in such a storm as this!"
+protested Molly. "It would be a shame to take that poor baste out into
+the rain now. He has all he can do to stand up in the barn, to say
+nothin' of havin' to be carryin' a load. It's the last drop that'll be
+after breakin' of his back, yez know."
+
+The men all laughed at the woman's words, but the lieutenant was not to
+be deterred, and accordingly the horses were brought forth and the two
+men speedily mounted. Tom's horse was limping painfully when he started,
+and as the lad glanced backward he could see Captain Molly standing in
+the doorway, her hands resting upon her hips, and her broad, freckled
+face beaming with delight over the sorry spectacle he was well aware
+that he presented.
+
+A feeling of disgust arose in his heart as he watched her. Surely she
+must be lacking in all the qualities which he had most honored in the
+women he knew. Coarseness was in place of delicacy, boldness instead of
+modesty, and her entire bearing was such that Tom never afterwards could
+hear her name mentioned without expressing his disgust. Not even the
+bravery of the deed which Captain Molly Pitcher did not many hours after
+this time, and which Tom Coward himself witnessed, entirely banished the
+prejudice which he entertained against the coarse, good-natured, manly,
+unwomanly woman.
+
+The storm had ceased when, after a short ride, Tom and his companion
+first came within sight of the American army. All the long pent-up hopes
+of the lad were now about to be fulfilled, and for the first time in his
+life he was to look upon the men whose names and deeds had long been
+familiar to him. His eagerness brought a smile to his companion's face,
+but while he watched the lad he did not speak.
+
+Molly Pitcher had spoken truly, and the American army had halted after a
+brief march from Kingston in the preceding night, and now were compelled
+to remain during the entire day in Cranberry. Only the advance corps had
+moved forward, and at that time were holding a position on the road to
+Monmouth Court House and within five miles of the rear of the British.
+
+In spite of his own excitement, and that which was apparent among the
+men in the camp when Tom and the lieutenant entered, the lad's first
+feeling was one of keen disappointment. Were these the men of whom he
+had heard so much and from whom so much was expected? Mud-stained, worn
+by their recent exertions, plainly showing the effects of the intense
+heat, many of them without uniforms, some hatless and coatless, to the
+vision of Tom Coward they presented far more the appearance of a mob
+than of the orderly and well-trained soldiers he had expected to see.
+
+The young lieutenant had left him as soon as they entered the camp,
+leading the two horses away with him,--a fact over which Tom did not
+long lament, we may be sure. An hour passed before the young officer
+returned, for he was to make a report of all that he had learned, and
+Tom's hopes were not strengthened as he watched the men about him during
+his companion's absence.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon noticed the expression upon Tom's face when he
+rejoined him, but, attributing it to the fear which he supposed the lad
+felt, he did not refer to it, and in the labors which soon followed no
+opportunity to explain was given by either.
+
+General Dickinson, with the New Jersey militia, was not with the main
+body, as we already know, and Tom found that he could not be assigned to
+them. Through the lieutenant's influence, he was to be retained with the
+main body, and to assist in serving as a guide for the army, an office
+which Tom was well fitted to hold, although it was not just in accord
+with the plans he had formed in his own mind.
+
+Reports came into the camp during the day which clearly indicated that
+the advance corps was too far away to be properly supported at once in
+the present condition of the roads. But on Saturday morning Lafayette,
+with his troops, was ordered to file off by his left towards
+Englishtown, and in the same day the main body, under General
+Washington, marched out from Cranberry and encamped within three miles
+of the place.
+
+This brought the two opposing armies now within eight miles of each
+other, while General Lee's forces, five thousand strong, without
+Morgan's dragoons or the New Jersey militia, were three miles nearer the
+British.
+
+Such was the condition of affairs on that night of Saturday, June 27
+(1778), and Tom Coward, as well as many of the men in Washington's army,
+slept but little, with the knowledge that on the morrow the long delayed
+battle would doubtless be begun.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[2] In many of our histories the "Captain Molly" of Monmouth has been
+confounded with "Dirty Kate" of Fort Clinton. They were, however, two
+women,--not one. Lossing, in the first edition of his _Field Book of the
+American Revolution_, referred to them as if they were identical, but
+the correction was to have been made for his second edition, and was in
+type, but through an oversight was omitted.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+AN INTERRUPTED JOURNEY
+
+
+THE surprise of Little Peter at the unexpected action of Benzeor was
+increased when the escaping man seated himself in the whaleboat and
+quickly began to row the long craft back toward the Washington.
+
+"Hurrah for the redcoats! Hurrah for King George! Hurrah for the
+British!" shouted Benzeor defiantly.
+
+This boldness was as surprising to Peter as the sudden departure had
+been; but, as he glanced toward the Washington and saw that the
+attacking party had already boarded her, and then realized that he
+himself had been left alone by his recent companions, he was quickly
+recalled to the necessity of action on his own part. Without waiting to
+observe the further movements of Benzeor or the British, he instantly
+turned and entered the woods; but a quarter of an hour had elapsed
+before he overtook the men, whom he found resting by the side of the
+road which led past the home of Ted Wilson.
+
+To this house the entire party now made their way, and as Ted listened
+to the story of Benzeor's perfidy, his anger broke forth afresh.
+
+"I never ought to have let the rascal go!" exclaimed Ted excitedly. "I
+had him right there in the river, and if you hadn't interfered with me
+I'd have fixed him so that he never would have betrayed any one again.
+Now the rascal's where he can keep up his evil doings."
+
+"He's shown where he stands, any way. That's some comfort," said one of
+the men.
+
+"It may comfort you, but it doesn't me," replied Ted. "I'm a peaceable
+man, I am, and I never cared much about whether it was to be the King of
+England or the Continental Congress that ruled over me. I don't see as
+it would make very much difference to me, for my part. But when that
+rascal hangs my Sallie up on the limb of a tree,--Sallie's my wife, ye
+know,--why, then Benzeor Osburn has jest got to look out for himself."
+
+Ted's anger was so evident that Little Peter almost had a feeling of
+sympathy for Benzeor, angry as he himself was at the treachery his
+neighbor had displayed.
+
+"Are you going to follow him up, Ted?" inquired the leader.
+
+"Am I goin' to follow him? That's just what I'm going to do! I'm goin'
+to send Sallie and the babies over to your house, and I'm just goin' to
+leave my place here,--they can't steal that, any way,--and follow up
+Benzeor Osburn till I find him. I don't care if he runs clear to the
+other side of the Alleghany Mountains,--I've heard as how there was some
+mountains by that name away out west somewhere,--why, Benzeor'll wake up
+some fine mornin' and find himself a-shakin' hands with me. Yes, sir,
+this land o' ours may put up with the Hessians, but it isn't big enough
+to hold such a fellow as Benzeor! Hangin' Sallies! I'll put a stop to
+his fine work! Sallie's my wife, ye know!"
+
+"Remember us to him when you meet him, Ted," said the leader. "You can
+charge him for the loss of the Washington, too!"
+
+"His door will be free of all chalk scores when I'm done with him," said
+Ted savagely. "That's goin' to be my work, clearin' the land of pine
+robbers, just as I once cleared it of pine stumps!"
+
+"We must start on now," said the leader. "Take your wife and children up
+to my house, Ted. The women can fight together against the pine robbers,
+if they come there."
+
+"They won't come there," replied Ted. "There'll be fewer of 'em when
+I've done my duty. There'll be no more hangin' Sallies. Sallie's my
+wife, ye know."
+
+"I suspected as much from your words," said the leader. "Are you going
+with us?" he added, turning, as he spoke, to Little Peter.
+
+"No," replied the lad.
+
+"What are you going to do now? You can't get your father out of the New
+York prisons. You'd better come with us."
+
+"I can't. I've other work to do."
+
+"Have it your own way, my lad, though I think you're making a mistake
+not to come with us."
+
+The band soon departed, leaving Little Peter and the huge Ted behind
+them. There was slight likelihood that the men who had captured the
+Washington would venture on shore to pursue the fugitives, and the
+knowledge of this fact had made all the parties feel comparatively safe.
+
+"What are you goin' to do now?" said Ted, when he and Little Peter were
+left alone.
+
+"I'm going straight to Benzeor's house. After what I have just seen, I'm
+afraid to leave the children there another minute. I never would have
+thought Benzeor was a traitor, never! But he is, there's no doubt about
+it now! I don't know what will become of them. I don't know where to
+turn, or what to do."
+
+Little Peter then went on to relate the story of the sad loss which had
+occurred in his home, Ted listening meanwhile with intense interest.
+
+"It's Benzeor's work!" he said excitedly when the lad at last stopped.
+"Yes, sir! You mark my words, Benzeor Osburn was at the bottom of it
+all. You'll have to go in with me and help rid the land of him! The
+rascal! Goin' round hangin' Sallies and shootin' mothers!"
+
+"I've all I want to do to look after my little brothers and sisters,"
+said Little Peter quietly. "I don't know what I can do with them, but I
+can't leave them at Benzeor's!"
+
+"No more you can't," said Ted. "I'll tell you what to do with 'em. Jest
+bring 'em all down here and leave 'em with Sallie over at the captain's.
+I think they'll be safe enough there."
+
+"Thank you; but it's most too far to bring them, I'm afraid. It's a good
+twenty miles from here, and we haven't a horse left."
+
+"I wish I could let ye have one, but all of mine are gone too, except
+one little mule; and you'd have to turn him round and make him go
+backward if you wanted to go anywhere, he's such an obstinate little
+beast. I'll tell you what I'll do, Peter! Just as soon as I've taken
+Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--and the babies over to the captain's,
+I'll go with ye and help ye out. That's what I'll do for ye."
+
+"Thank you again," replied Peter, "but I don't think you had better do
+it. You may be needed around here, and I don't know yet what I shall
+do."
+
+"Maybe you're right, Peter, maybe you're right. Well, have it your own
+way. When are you goin' to start?"
+
+"Right away."
+
+Little Peter at once bade his friend good-by and started forth on his
+long walk. He had appreciated the offer of the mighty Ted, but there
+were many reasons why he wished to be alone, for a time at least.
+Benzeor's treachery was still so fresh in his mind that he knew not what
+to do, and the excitement attending the escape from the Washington had
+not yet disappeared. Then, too, he did not know what the angry giant
+might be moved to do. Ordinarily good-natured and easy-going as the
+powerful man was, when once his wrath was aroused there would be no
+limits to what it might lead him into. And Little Peter's heart was too
+heavy, under the burden of his recent sorrows and present perplexities,
+to permit the lad to be drawn aside from the task which had presented
+itself to him.
+
+He had gone about half the way down the long lane which led from Ted's
+house to the road, when he heard some one calling to him. Looking
+quickly behind him, he discovered Ted himself running rapidly down the
+path toward him.
+
+Startled by the sight and fearful that some new danger had appeared, he
+stopped, and then turned back to meet the man.
+
+"What is it? What is it?" he called.
+
+Ted stopped as the lad called, and, shaking one of his great fists in
+the air, replied, "Hangin' Sallies! Hangin' Sallies!"
+
+"What? Have they tried it again?"
+
+"No! Once was enough, I should think, when Sallie's my wife, ye know! I
+just wanted to remind ye what the password was. It's 'Hangin' Sallies,'
+that's what it is! Ye won't forget it, will ye?"
+
+"No," replied Peter soberly. "I'll try to keep it in mind."
+
+"That's right! See that ye do! Hangin' Sallies, that's the word. I jest
+wanted to remind ye of it, that was all. Hangin' Sallies! Hangin'
+Sallies!"
+
+Little Peter resumed his journey, but, until he passed around the bend
+in the road, whenever he looked behind him he could see the mighty Ted
+standing in the lane, and shaking his fist in the air if he perceived
+that the lad beheld him.
+
+What a strange man Ted was, thought Little Peter as he walked on. He had
+known him for years, as had most of the people in Old Monmouth. His
+feats in the country wrestling matches had made him famous, and
+marvelous were the tales told concerning his almost superhuman strength.
+It had been related that Ted one time had lifted a great ox bodily from
+the ground, and Little Peter had believed the report. And yet, with it
+all, Ted had always seemed to him like a boy. Kind-hearted, ever willing
+to grant a favor or do anything within his power for another, he had
+never before seen him when his wrath was kindled. "Hanging Sallies!"
+Perhaps Ted's feelings were only natural when he had discovered the
+pine robbers in their cruel act. Benzeor would not be likely to escape
+from his hands so easily, if the angry man once held him in his grasp
+again.
+
+But Sallie Wilson was still alive, and the lad thought Ted's position
+was far better than his own. His mother shot by the pine robbers, his
+father sent away a prisoner, perhaps to die of starvation in those
+dreadful prison ships of which so many stories already had been told,
+and his younger brothers and sisters homeless and helpless, and all
+looking to him as their sole support. What could he do? Surely no one in
+Old Monmouth had suffered more than he, although Old Monmouth itself had
+known more of the evils of war than almost any other portion of our land
+in all that fearful struggle of the American Revolution.
+
+"How?"
+
+Little Peter's meditations were suddenly interrupted by Indian John, who
+stepped forth into the road and greeted him with his customary
+salutation.
+
+"Where did you come from, John? I thought you were up in Moluss's
+wigwam."
+
+"Moluss gone, Bath gone, John gone, too. Come to help friend. Find
+fader?" he suddenly added, peering keenly, as he spoke, into Little
+Peter's face.
+
+"No; my father has been sent to New York."
+
+"Bad. What boy do now?"
+
+"I'm going back to Benzeor's to look after the children."
+
+The Indian's eyes betrayed the question he might have asked, but did
+not. Indian John soon induced his companion to abandon the road and
+follow him through the forests. Many a mile was saved in this manner,
+and, under the burning heat of the sun, the shade of the great trees was
+most grateful to the sadly troubled lad. There was something in the
+presence of the majestic trees which seemed to appeal to Little Peter.
+He was alone and yet not alone with such companions. Indian John also
+seemed to share in his feelings, and seldom spoke. For mile after mile
+they continued on their journey, and the shadows were lengthening when
+at last they stepped forth into the road, which Peter recognized, and
+then knew that Benzeor's house was not far away. The long journey would
+soon be ended now, and fresh hope came to the weary lad, as he thought
+that he would see the children again.
+
+What he should do with them, however, was a problem still unsolved, and
+the solution apparently was no nearer than when he had set forth on his
+journey from the home of Ted Wilson. With all of the anger which had
+come with the discovery of Benzeor's treachery, Little Peter could not
+bring himself to believe that either Sarah or her mother had any
+knowledge of his evil deeds. His confidence in them was still unbroken,
+and his sole hope was that they might be able to suggest some plan by
+which the children could be cared for. As for leaving them at Benzeor's,
+that was impossible; and as the lad thought again of the discovery of
+his neighbor's crimes, he quickened his pace, and he and his companion
+began to walk more rapidly along the hot and dusty road. Not more than
+two miles remained between them and the end of their journey, and, in
+his eagerness, Little Peter almost forgot his weariness and constantly
+urged the Indian by his side to increase their speed.
+
+They had been in the road but a few minutes when they heard the sound of
+horsemen approaching from behind them. All unsuspicious of danger,
+Little Peter and Indian John halted, waiting for the men to pass. There
+were five of them in the band, and all were riding swiftly. Their horses
+were dripping, and with almost every step flung the foam from their
+mouths. Surely something must be wrong, to induce men to ride like that
+upon such a warm day, thought Little Peter; but his surmises were
+quickly driven from his mind when he recognized Fenton and Benzeor in
+advance of the band.
+
+Startled by the unexpected sight, he hardly knew what to do. The men
+were too near for him to hope to escape their notice now; and, even
+while he hesitated, he saw Benzeor quickly draw the rein on the horse he
+was riding and leap to the ground.
+
+"Get him! Shoot him! Stop that boy!" shouted Benzeor.
+
+Indian John had been keenly watching the approaching band, and as he
+heard the shout of the angry man, he touched Peter upon the arm, and
+said, "Come."
+
+Little Peter instantly responded, and followed his companion as he
+started swiftly across the open lot toward the woods which lay beyond
+it.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+THE ABODE OF INDIAN JOHN
+
+
+THE pursuit of Little Peter and Indian John was not long continued, nor
+was a single gun discharged; a fact for which the frightened lad was
+unable to account at the time, although on the following morning the
+cause for it was made clear.
+
+Wearied though the lad was by his long journey, the shout of Benzeor had
+provided an impulse sufficiently strong to compel him to keep up with
+his companion, who was running swiftly toward the shelter of the woods
+which were not far away.
+
+In a brief time the breathless fugitives gained its shelter, and then
+for the first time turned and glanced behind them. The men had turned
+back and now could be seen still standing by the roadside, near the
+place where Peter and the Indian had started across the lot. What they
+were doing could not be discovered; but, without waiting for further
+investigations, the flight was at once resumed, and, keeping well
+together, the lad and his companion ran swiftly forward, and soon the
+distance between them and the pine robbers had been still further
+increased.
+
+The sunlight had now departed from the forest, and the dusk had settled
+over all. The air was close and oppressive, and Peter's dripping face
+betrayed the force of his recent exertions and the excitement under
+which he was laboring. Already the night birds had made their
+appearance, and here and there among the branches of the lofty trees the
+bats could be seen darting about in quest of their evening meal. The
+very silence served to increase the feeling of utter loneliness which
+swept over the weary, heartbroken lad, and for a moment it almost seemed
+to him as if any further efforts on his part were as useless as they
+were difficult. Benzeor's anger promised little good for the children
+who had been left in his home, and fears for his little brothers and
+sisters were mingled in Little Peter's mind with the consciousness of
+his own weariness and the thought of his own forlorn condition.
+
+Difficult as the problem doubtless was, he knew he must not give way to
+it, and when Indian John indicated in a few moments that the time had
+come when they must go on, the lad resolutely again turned to follow
+him, although he had not the slightest conception of the plan which was
+in his companion's mind.
+
+Carefully they walked on through the increasing gloom, and within a half
+hour Little Peter heard the sounds of a running brook in the distance.
+He instantly recognized the locality, for many a time had he and Tom in
+the springtime followed the course of the "run," as the people of Old
+Monmouth called the stream, and the strings of fish which they had
+brought home with them had borne ample witness to the success which had
+crowned their efforts.
+
+But none of these things were in Little Peter's mind as he followed
+Indian John, who had now turned and was proceeding along the bank and
+making his way up the stream. As they walked on, the sound of a
+waterfall began to be more and more distinctly heard, and soon they came
+out into a place from which, in the deepening gloom, the falling waters
+could be seen. Into the basin which had been formed by the sharp fall of
+the stream, a tall, large tree had fallen years before this time. Its
+broken roots had torn up the earth, and now stood like a barrier on the
+bank, and Indian John led the way directly toward this spot.
+
+As they approached, Peter discovered a hole in the rocks, but he was not
+prepared for the action of his companion; for, without a word, the
+Indian dropped upon his hands and knees and crawled into the entrance
+and speedily disappeared from sight.
+
+Hesitating only a moment, Little Peter soon followed his companion, and
+after crawling along on his hands and knees for a number of yards,
+suddenly beheld a large, open space directly before him. Indian John had
+provided a light by this time, for he had been willing to follow the
+customs of his more civilized neighbors to the extent of making use of
+candles, and as Peter arose and glanced about him, he knew at once that
+he was in the cave which it was reported was the abode of the red man.
+
+Frequently as the lad had passed the very place into which he had
+crawled that night, it had never occurred to him that it was anything
+more than a hole in the rocks that formed the bank of the "run," and his
+surprise was therefore the greater at the sight before him. The spot was
+considerably above the bed of the stream, and consequently was
+comparatively dry. Straw and dry leaves lay scattered about over the
+floor, and the sheltered place apparently was safe from all approach or
+danger.
+
+Indian John at once indicated to his companion that he was to pass the
+night there, and the weary lad was glad to accept the invitation, and
+soon stretched himself upon the bed of straw. The light of the candle
+was extinguished, and the Indian then speedily followed the example of
+Peter. The sounds of the running brook came faintly to the ears of the
+troubled lad, but that was all he could hear. The darkness was intense,
+and for a time the fear of other occupants of various kinds prevented
+Peter from sleeping, but at last even that was forgotten in the
+dreamless sleep that followed.
+
+When he awoke, Little Peter at first could not determine where he was,
+but as the outlines of the cave were seen in the dim light which
+penetrated it, the experiences of the preceding day were recalled, and
+he quickly arose. Indian John was not in the cave, however, and as the
+lad now was aware that the morning had come, he hastily crawled through
+the passageway that led to the bank.
+
+As he regained the bank, he saw that his companion was busily engaged in
+roasting some birds he had shot. The sight was a welcome one, for Peter
+was now aware of the fact that he was decidedly hungry, and, following
+his companion's advice, he departed in search of some berries to add to
+the morning meal. In the course of a half hour he returned with his hat
+well filled, and, after bathing his hands and face in the cool waters of
+the brook, prepared at once to join his companion.
+
+For a few minutes neither spoke, but the rapid manner in which the
+roasted birds disappeared showed that conversation was not uppermost in
+their minds.
+
+At last, when several of the birds had been eaten, and many of the
+berries had disappeared, Indian John turned to his companion and said,
+"Boy want 'hop-hop' now? Plenty 'hop-hop.' Make um good."
+
+"No, no," replied Peter quickly. "The birds are enough. Where did you
+get them, John?"
+
+"Shoot um. Plenty birds; plenty 'hop-hop.'"
+
+"You must have been up early this morning, John. I didn't hear you."
+
+The Indian made no reply and remained silent for several minutes. Then,
+turning abruptly and looking keenly at Peter, he said, "What boy do
+now?"
+
+"I don't know," replied Little Peter disconsolately.
+
+The words brought him face to face again with the problem that must be
+solved. The fresh cool air of the morning, the silence of the forest,
+and, above all, the enjoyment of the breakfast which John had provided,
+made him at first wish that he might remain there and forget all the
+troubles that were so near. But Peter was not a selfish lad, and knew
+that the motherless children must be provided for.
+
+"I was going to Benzeor's," he said after a time, "but I don't know what
+to do now. I can't understand what he meant by coming back here in broad
+daylight after what has happened. He knows that I know all about it, and
+that was the reason why he wanted to catch me last night. I can't go up
+to his house now, and yet I don't dare leave the children there,
+either."
+
+"Boy go," said Indian John quietly.
+
+"But I can't go, John. How can I? There were four men with Benzeor, and
+you heard what he said. It wouldn't be safe for me to go there now. I
+don't know what to do."
+
+"Boy go; Benzeor no there."
+
+"Benzeor not there? How do you know? What makes you think that, John?"
+
+"John been there."
+
+"When? This morning?"
+
+The Indian nodded his head, and then said, "Man no there. Girl there.
+Two, t'ree little Peters there. Boy go. All safe."
+
+"You don't mean it?" said Peter eagerly, and standing erect as he spoke.
+"Come on, then, John; we'll start this minute."
+
+"Boy go; Indian no go."
+
+"Why not? I thought you were going with me."
+
+"John no go. John no home, no papoose, no notin'. All white man now. All
+gone. Indian no stay. Boy go."
+
+"All right, John; I won't urge you. But if you're right, and Benzeor
+isn't at home, you needn't be afraid."
+
+The Indian's eyes snapped at the words, but he made no reply, and Little
+Peter was too eager to start now to realize the force of his own words.
+As he departed, he saw his recent companion standing on the bank of the
+brook in an attitude as if he were listening to sounds far off in the
+forest. Perhaps if the lad had realized that it was the last time he
+would ever behold the face of Indian John, he would have lingered
+longer; but, as it was, his desire to go to Benzeor's house and learn of
+the present condition of the children banished all other thoughts from
+his mind, and in a few moments he had started toward the road.
+
+He retraced his way across the open lot, and as he came within sight of
+the road he suddenly stopped, as he saw a mounted man there. Apparently
+the man was alone, and what was strange was the fact that he apparently
+was not moving.
+
+Little Peter waited several minutes, but as the man still retained his
+position, and no one joined him, he resolved to proceed. Approaching
+cautiously, and ready to run at the first appearance of danger, his
+surprise was increased as he beheld the strange manner in which the
+horseman was seated on his beast. Instead of sitting with his face
+toward the head of his steed, his position was exactly reversed, and to
+all appearances he either was going in a direction opposite to that of
+his horse or else was riding backward.
+
+Puzzled to account for the strange attitude, Peter also noticed as he
+approached that the beast on which the man was mounted was a mule and
+had stopped in the middle of the road. In a moment he recognized the man
+as Ted Wilson, and with a shout he ran forward.
+
+"Why, my lad, what are you doing here?" exclaimed Ted, as he beheld the
+approaching boy.
+
+"It's more to the point to ask what you are doing here. What are you
+sitting on that mule that way for? What have you stopped for? Why don't
+you go ahead?"
+
+"There are several good reasons," replied Ted blandly. "In the first
+place, if the mule won't go, I can't go. Then, if he stops, I have to
+stop, too. As to the reason for my being here, why, I'm looking for
+Benzeor."
+
+"I don't know where you expect to find him," laughed Peter--forgetting
+his own anxiety for the moment in the ludicrous sight before him.
+
+"Well, I got to thinking of it yesterday after you left me; and when I'd
+taken Sallie and the babies up to the captain's,--Sallie's my wife, ye
+know,--I jest made up my mind as how I'd got to look after Benzeor afore
+he did any more damage. Goin' around the country hangin' Sallies! The
+rascal! Old Monmouth never'll be safe till Benzeor Osburn has been
+'tended to. And if I'm not the man to do it, I don't know who is. So
+Jeshurun and I decided to start out last night, and we've been travelin'
+ever since."
+
+"Jeshurun? I don't see anybody with you," said Peter, glancing quickly
+about him as he spoke.
+
+"Ha! ha!" laughed Ted. "Ye're lookin' too far afield, young man. This
+here fellow's Jeshurun. Whoa, Jesh! Whoa!" he suddenly added, as the
+mule darted to one side and turned several circles in the road before
+his rider could stop him.
+
+"Yes, sir; this is Jeshurun, and a more onery little beast never lived.
+I told ye about him yesterday, and how he'd suddenly take it into his
+head to go backwards for a bit. That's the reason I ride him this way
+part of the time. He thinks I want to go the other way, ye see, and
+that's how I come it over him by jest sittin' the wrong way, too.
+Besides, a good twist of his tail is worth more than a bridle sometimes.
+Instead of controllin' him with a bridle, as any decent beast would be
+glad to have me do, I just have to steer him by twistin' his tail,
+same's I use the rudder in my boat, ye see. Whoa there, Jesh! Whoa
+there! What's the matter with ye, anyhow? Whoa! Whoa!"
+
+These last remarks of Ted were caused by a sudden movement on the part
+of Jeshurun, whose heels were thrown into the air, while with his teeth
+he almost literally bit the dust. The mule was small and the feet of his
+rider almost touched the ground, and the antics of the pair caused Peter
+to laugh aloud.
+
+"Where did you get that name for him?" he inquired when quiet was
+restored.
+
+"Oh, it came to him jest natural like. Two years ago when I bought him,
+and was a-leadin' him home, I got him into the yard and then he just
+began to make his heels fly like a pair o' drumsticks. It's likely there
+was some noise made by him or me, I don't jest know which, and the first
+thing I knew, Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--and a whole lot o' folks
+came a-runnin' out o' the house to see what all the rumpus was about.
+They was havin' meetin' in the house, though I didn't know anything
+about that, or I wouldn't have argued with the mule as I was doin', o'
+course. Well, sir, if you'd believe it, the parson had been a-preachin'
+about somebody in the Old Testament. His text was: 'But Jeshurun waxed
+fat and kicked: thou art waxen fat, thou art grown thick, thou art
+covered with fatness.' Yes, sir; those were his very words. Well, when
+Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--set eyes on this here beast, she said
+Jeshurun should be his name, and Jeshurun it's been ever since. Whoa
+there! Whoa, I say! What ye up to now?"
+
+Perhaps Jeshurun objected to the story, for he suddenly whirled about
+and started swiftly up the road. In vain Ted tried to restrain him, but
+after his attempts failed, he turned and shouted, "I'll see you farther
+on! Jesh'll get tired o' this."
+
+As Jeshurun and his rider disappeared in a cloud of dust, Little Peter
+quickly recovered from his surprise and started briskly after them.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+THE BEGINNING OF THE GREAT FIGHT
+
+
+THE morning of Sunday, June 28, 1778, dawned clear and warm. Not a cloud
+could be seen in the sky, and the air was motionless, save in occasional
+places where it quivered under the burning heat of the summer sun. By
+eight o'clock the thermometer already had indicated ninety-six degrees,
+and before the day was done it had risen considerably above a hundred.
+
+The British forces had now arrived within ten or twelve miles of the
+Heights of Middletown, and if once they should succeed in gaining that
+position, all attempts on the part of the Americans to attack them would
+be worse than useless, for it was now as well known by Washington as it
+was by Clinton that British vessels were lying at anchor off Sandy Hook,
+ready and waiting to receive the advancing army and its stores on board,
+and transport all in safety to New York.
+
+Clinton, as we already know, still believed that the Americans were
+seeking only to capture his stores and train of baggage wagons, and,
+therefore, wisely had placed them in the care of General Knyphausen and
+the Hessian soldiers, in advance of the place of danger, as he supposed,
+and also of the place where the brave leader himself took his stand with
+his men. All of the British grenadiers, light infantry, and chasseurs of
+the line were encamped in the strong position that Clinton had selected
+in the parting of the road which led from Monmouth Court House to
+Middletown, the right wing extending about a mile and a half beyond the
+court house itself, while the left lay stretched for three miles along
+the road from Allentown. Thick woods afforded strong protection to the
+flanks, while a swamp extended toward the rear and the left, and woods
+also covered their front. The British general had chosen his place
+wisely, and there he waited until that eventful Sunday morning.
+
+General Washington was well aware of all that was going on, and had
+determined to attack the British the moment they moved from the position
+they then occupied. Late on Saturday night, the commander had given
+orders for General Maxwell to send out parties of observation, who were
+to watch the British and report instantly any signs they might discover
+of an attempt to retreat during the night, and to keep up a constant
+communication with himself. General orders had also been given Lee to be
+prepared to attack Clinton's forces the moment they should depart from
+their camping-place.
+
+General Lee's treachery or incompetency, or both, are well known to-day,
+and the only cause of surprise is that General Washington should have
+given him such discretionary orders. The great commander must have been
+fully aware of Lee's true feelings, for already he had suffered much
+from his jealousy and his traitorous designs; but perhaps the rest of
+the army did not know what Washington himself well knew, and on the eve
+of battle he chose the lesser of the two evils, and thought he would
+suffer less by permitting Lee to continue to act, than he would from the
+misunderstanding and confusion that might arise if he dealt with the man
+at that time as he justly deserved. At all events, his orders were
+somewhat general, and the fact that he had not given specific commands
+is all that remains to-day to be quoted in favor of the guilty Lee.
+
+It was about five o'clock in the morning when a messenger arrived in
+Washington's camp from General Dickinson--who, with the New Jersey
+militia, was nearest the enemy's lines--with the information that the
+front of the British line had begun its march toward the Heights of
+Middletown. Instantly Washington's army was put in motion, and one of
+his aids was sent in all haste to inform General Lee of the movement of
+the British, and to urge him forward to attack them at once unless some
+very strong obstacle should be found, and to assure him that the main
+body of the American army would be rushed forward to his support.
+
+I am very certain that if my readers could somehow have been privileged
+to witness the march of Washington's soldiers, they would not have been
+greatly impressed by the sight. Many of them were without uniforms, and
+their flushed and streaming faces under the burning heat, while they
+bore an expression of determination, after all would not have been very
+prepossessing in their appearance. Numbers of the Continentals had
+either cast aside their coats or rolled them up and strapped them across
+their backs, so that entire ranks appeared to be marching to battle in
+their shirt-sleeves. However, although their personal bearing was not
+made more forceful by the absence of coats, their personal comfort was
+decidedly improved; and, as we shall soon see, their work in the battle
+was not hindered by their lack of bright colored uniforms.
+
+Meanwhile, the advanced corps under General Lee had moved from
+Englishtown, and was now advancing toward the British. The redcoats were
+also in motion, and the left wing had marched more than a mile beyond
+Monmouth Court House when it discovered that the American columns had
+out-flanked it on the north. Lee's forces had marched along the main
+road, successfully crossing the deep ravines and causeways. They had
+halted frequently to receive reports from the scouts and the men in
+advance as to the movements of the British, but these reports apparently
+were somewhat contradictory and created some confusion among the
+American ranks.
+
+One of these halts had been made near the "new church," which was so
+called to distinguish it from the smaller structure, which until 1752
+had stood upon the same site. This "new church" was of wood, its sides
+covered with shingles, and painted white. There such famous preachers as
+Whitefield, the missionary Brainerd, Tennent, and others had given their
+messages of peace, but it can be safely asserted that in all its long
+history the "old" church or the "new" had never seen such a "service" as
+that which was held there on that Sunday morning in June, 1778. Before
+the day was done bullet marks and the effect of cannon shot were
+apparent on its walls, and while the roof and even the steeple were said
+to have been covered with people on that day, who had assembled to watch
+the battle, probably no other congregation in all our land had ever been
+gathered by such summons, or had taken their seats on the roof of the
+building instead of in the accustomed place within the walls.
+
+Young General Lafayette, who had command of Lee's right, soon passed the
+Court House, and was advancing upon the other end of the British line on
+the south at the same time when the left wing was folding about
+Cornwallis on the north; and General Wayne, who was in command of the
+American centre, was also pressing strongly forward. Apparently, all
+things were favoring the rugged Continentals, and had it not been for
+Lee's cowardice or treachery, or both, they would have won the battle
+there and then, before Washington could come with the aid of his
+advancing troops.
+
+Some slight minor engagements had already occurred, though not one of
+them was of much importance; but now General Wayne discovered that most
+of the British forces before him had descended from the high ground they
+had occupied and were advancing along the same route, over the plains of
+Monmouth, which the Hessians had followed when they departed earlier in
+the morning.
+
+Instantly the impetuous Wayne sent a messenger to General Lee requesting
+permission for his own "troops to be pressed on." No such permission was
+given, however, until it was discovered that a band of eight or nine
+hundred of the redcoats had halted, and, turning about, appeared to be
+inviting an attack. General Wayne was then ordered to take about four
+hundred men and advance.
+
+Despite the smallness of the number, Wayne eagerly obeyed, when the
+Queen's light dragoons were sent back by Clinton to check the movement.
+
+So excited was the little band of Americans that they instantly formed,
+and drove the horsemen back upon a body of foot soldiers who had been
+sent to their aid. A much larger body of troops were soon discovered to
+be moving upon General Wayne's right, but he immediately opened fire
+upon them with the two pieces of artillery he possessed, sent back for
+reinforcements, and gallantly prepared for the battle.
+
+During this time General Lee apparently was trying to cut off the force
+with which Wayne was engaged by making a detour and falling upon the
+line of Clinton's march between the rear of the main body and that
+detachment.
+
+This action of Lee's, together with those which three of the others of
+the divisions of the American forces were making at the same time, led
+Clinton to suppose that his baggage train was what the Americans were
+striving to gain. As we already know, this, all the time, had been his
+understanding of the purpose of Washington, and now the action and
+movements of the various bodies of troops strengthened his suspicion.
+
+The first thing the British commander did was to send the Queen's light
+dragoons against Wayne. Then he sent a detachment from the men in
+advance to strengthen his own right, and next he arranged for the main
+body, of which Lord Cornwallis was in command, to form on the plain and
+prepare to attack General Lee and the various divisions which were under
+him at the time.
+
+General Wayne and his brave men were now fighting desperately, and to
+all appearances success was about to crown his efforts, when he was
+dumfounded by an order he received from Lee to make only a feigned
+attack, and not to press too hard against the redcoats in front of him.
+
+Wayne did not know what to make of the order. He was chagrined and angry
+to receive such a word at a time when all things seemed to favor his
+determined band. It is said that he made use of some very forceful
+language, and even expressed his opinion of his superior officer in no
+very complimentary terms; but he was too good a soldier not to obey;
+and, although he could not understand what Lee meant by giving him such
+directions at such a time, he held back his men, hoping all the time
+that Lee himself would come up and grasp the victory which almost seemed
+to be in his hand.
+
+General Lee had been watching the movements of the British, and
+perceived what Clinton was trying to do by the actions to which we
+already have referred. Instead of meeting them boldly, and permitting
+his soldiers, who were all now eager for the battle, to advance, he at
+once prepared to withdraw them from the field.
+
+Young Lafayette had just discovered a body of British cavalry advancing
+toward Lee's right, and, quickly riding up to his commander, he begged
+for permission to advance and gain their rear, and so cut them off from
+the main body.
+
+"Sir," replied Lee, "you do not know British soldiers. We cannot stand
+against them. We shall certainly be driven back at first, and we must be
+cautious."
+
+"It may be so, general," said Lafayette quietly, "but British soldiers
+have been beaten, and they may be again. At any rate I am disposed to
+make the trial."
+
+Reluctantly Lee yielded, so far as to permit the brave young marquis to
+wheel his column by the right and make an attempt to gain the left of
+the British, but at the same time he ordered three regiments to be
+withdrawn from Wayne's command, thereby weakening him for reasons which
+neither Wayne nor any one of his men ever understood.
+
+General Lee then rode off to reconnoitre, as he afterwards declared, and
+to his astonishment discovered another large body of British soldiers
+marching back on the Middletown road toward the Court House. If there
+was one thing more than another which Lee apparently disliked at that
+time, it was the sight and presence of men clad in scarlet coats, and he
+instantly gave orders for the several corps in his division to retreat,
+or to make a "retrograde movement," as he afterwards explained it.
+
+His friends claimed for him, and, indeed, Lee afterwards claimed for
+himself, that he had only ordered the right to fall back, and had
+commanded the left, under Scott and Maxwell, to advance, and his order
+was misunderstood; and that when Maxwell's men perceived the retreat of
+their comrades on the left, they thought all was ended and they must
+save themselves. But, at all events, proof of the truthfulness of his
+statement was wanting, and all his men were soon retreating toward the
+"new meeting-house," on the roof and steeple of which were assembled the
+people of the congregation.
+
+Few of the men beside Lee himself knew why the retreat was made. The
+soldiers were angry and were giving vent to their feelings in terms
+which had not been carefully selected. General Wayne's men were the only
+ones who had even fired a shot, and the anger of Wayne himself was
+steadily increasing. Every soldier felt as if he were being robbed of
+success, which by right belonged to him and to his country.
+
+Between the "meeting-house" and the parsonage, General Washington, all
+unaware of Lee's disgraceful actions and the retreat of the advanced
+division, met a fifer, who appeared to be in great haste to leave the
+region.
+
+Reining in his horse, the great commander ordered the fleeing man to
+halt, and then said sternly:--
+
+"Who are you? Do you belong to the army? Why are you running in this
+fashion?"
+
+"I am a soldier," replied the trembling man, "but all the Continentals
+are running, too."
+
+"It isn't true! It can't be true! I'll have you whipped if you dare to
+mention such a thing to another living man!" cried the astonished
+commander.
+
+Nevertheless, he put the spurs to his horse, and in a few minutes
+discovered two or three other men, who apparently were in as great
+haste to depart as the fifer had been.
+
+Instantly the trembling men halted at his sharp command, and again the
+excited general demanded an explanation of their actions.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+THE BATTLE OF MONMOUTH
+
+
+EVIDENTLY, the reply which General Washington received from the men, who
+were as greatly frightened by the bearing of the commander as they had
+been by the sight of the redcoats, did not convince him that they had
+spoken truly. He had not heard any firing, except that of a few cannon a
+considerable time before this, and he could not believe that the picked
+men under Lee's command had ingloriously retreated without making even
+an attempt to stand against the forces of Sir Henry Clinton.
+
+This second report, however, caused Washington to send forward two of
+his trusty officers, whom he ordered to ride swiftly in the direction of
+the Court House, and, after they should have discovered the true
+condition of affairs, to report instantly to him.
+
+As the two brave men quickly obeyed and started their horses into a run,
+they met on the bridge the members of a regiment in a disorderly
+retreat. A little farther on another regiment was discovered, and soon
+still another appeared in sight.
+
+Colonel Ogden, who was in command of the last, in a towering passion
+declared, in reply to the question of the officers, that Lee's men were
+indeed retreating and that "they were flying from a shadow."
+
+Still hoping that they would find that a stand had been made farther
+back, the two officers pushed eagerly forward and soon met General
+Maxwell and his men. That gallant officer was also in a state of great
+anger, and not only confirmed the report that Lee was retreating, but
+also added some words of his own, expressing his opinion of that officer
+and of the movement in words that would have caused the cheeks of the
+treacherous general to tingle, if he had chanced to hear them.
+
+Still hoping against hope, the two aids pressed forward and soon met
+General Lee himself. His face at all times was decidedly plain, and
+indeed, as we know, he had the reputation of having the "ugliest face in
+America;" but at this time a scowl rested upon it which doubtless did
+not tend to increase his beauty, and he sullenly refused to reply to the
+questions of the men.
+
+The two officers did not long delay to talk to him, but still urged
+their horses swiftly forward, although the straggling, disorderly troops
+now almost filled the road, and their worst fears were confirmed each
+moment.
+
+At last, in the post of danger and nearest to the pursuing British, the
+two officers discovered General Wayne and his men. "Mad Anthony" was
+certainly "mad" at that time, and while he assured the aids that the
+retreat was genuine and general, at the same time he declared that it
+was absolutely needless. He also declared that "Lee had drawn off his
+best men at the very time when he was facing a body of British far
+superior to himself in numbers, but that even then the redcoats could be
+beaten if a stand were made against them."
+
+There was no time for an extended conversation, but, doubtless, the two
+officers understood what the exceedingly vigorous language of Mad
+Anthony Wayne was intended to convey, and after receiving the
+suggestions he sent by them to General Washington, and assured now that
+they had discovered the worst, they put spurs to their horses and rode
+swiftly back to give the information they had received to the great
+commander.
+
+Meanwhile, General Washington himself had not been idle, we may be well
+assured. Riding swiftly forward, he met band after band of the
+retreating, disorderly Continentals, and heard many expressions of anger
+and disgust, very like to that which had already greeted the two
+officers he had sent forward.
+
+At last, in the rear of the retreating column, he met General Wayne and
+his angry men. Hastily summoning Mad Anthony and two or three of his
+officers, the great leader told them that he "should depend upon them
+that day to give the enemy a check," and quickly directed General Wayne
+to form his men, and, with their two pieces of artillery, strive to stop
+the progress of the redcoats.
+
+It was just at this moment that General Lee himself rode up, and the
+scene which followed was one which those who witnessed it never forgot.
+There is no more sublime sight in all this world than the towering
+passion of a great man. Not pettiness, not irritability, but the just
+and righteous anger of a noble, large-hearted man in the presence of
+wickedness.
+
+General Washington probably never before in all his life had been so
+angry as he was at that time. Thoughts of the cause of the country he
+loved, the lives of thousands of brave and devoted patriots, the sight
+of angry, desperate men all about him, the disappointment at the loss of
+what he had confidently counted upon, the loss also of that for which so
+many noble men had been sacrificing and toiling through many weary days
+and on their long marches, rushed upon him like a flood. And before him
+stood the guilty man who alone was to be blamed for it all. Small wonder
+is it that Washington was almost beside himself with rage and sorrow.
+
+The name of Benedict Arnold is one that is hated to-day by every
+American schoolboy, for, after all, most boys can be trusted to hate
+evil in whatever form it presents itself. But the treachery of Benedict
+Arnold had at least the merit of being unmasked and comparatively open,
+for he took his stand boldly on the side of the redcoats, whom he at one
+time had fought with a bravery none can ever forget. But the memory of
+Charles Lee has not even that redeeming quality, for his actions on the
+field of Monmouth can only be explained on the ground of treachery or
+cowardice, and a coward is not very greatly to be preferred to a
+traitor. If both Lee and Arnold had fallen in battle, how much better
+it would have been for them and their friends, for "a good name is to be
+preferred above great riches," and they left neither. Perhaps the
+strange desire which Lee later expressed in his will, that his "body
+should not be interred in any church or churchyard, or within a mile of
+any Presbyterian or Baptist church," was not entirely out of keeping
+with the man himself.
+
+The conversation between Washington and Lee at the time they met on the
+retreat at Monmouth has been variously reported; but doubtless the fact
+that those who heard it were as excited as the generals themselves may
+in part account for the differences in the reports which have come down
+to us. We may be sure the conversation was not extended to the length
+which some have said it was, or that it savored largely of the
+high-flown expressions which have been quoted.
+
+One of the men who was present is reported to have said that Washington
+in his sternest manner looked at Lee, and demanded, "What is the meaning
+of all this, sir?"
+
+Dismayed by the terrible appearance of the commander-in-chief, and
+mortified that he should be so addressed in the presence of his
+soldiers, the crestfallen general could only stammer, "Sir? sir?"
+
+Again the enraged commander demanded the meaning of the retreat, and Lee
+attempted to explain. His orders, he said, had been misunderstood, his
+officers had not obeyed his commands, he had not thought it wise to
+attempt to make a stand against the British with his detachment; but the
+angry Washington would not stay to listen to the lame attempts at
+explanation, and muttering something about a "poltroon," he hastened
+back to the high ground between the meeting-house and the bridge, where
+he quickly formed the regiments which were waiting there.
+
+Apparently thinking better of his words, he then rode back to General
+Lee and inquired whether he still desired to retain the command on that
+height or not. "If you will," he added, "I will return to the main body
+and have it formed on the next height."
+
+As Lee accepted the offer, Washington said: "I expect you will take
+proper means for checking the enemy."
+
+"Your orders shall be obeyed," replied Lee, "and I shall not be the
+first to leave the ground."
+
+Meanwhile, the British general Clinton had also been busy. He had
+ordered back many of the troops which the Hessian general Knyphausen
+commanded, and was making vigorous attempts to compel the Americans to
+keep up the retreat, which Lee had ordered with such disastrous results.
+
+The forces under Mad Anthony had rallied at the call of their leader,
+and were bravely holding their position near the parsonage. The British
+grenadiers climbed over the fence which crossed the lot in front of
+Wayne, but were quickly driven back by the angry Continentals.
+
+Again the determined British advanced, and again were driven back. Then
+their brave leader, Colonel Monckton, placing himself at their head, and
+calling upon his men to follow him, led the charge. But Mad Anthony and
+his men were waiting for them, and under their terrible fire the brave
+colonel and many of his men went down as the grass falls before the
+scythe of the mower. Desperate was the struggle then for the body of the
+fallen leader. Hand to hand, clubbing their muskets, using their
+bayonets any way, every way, the men fought on; but the band of sturdy
+Americans held both the body and the place, and as the British fell back
+it was not to attack Mad Anthony's men again during that day.
+
+Sir Henry Clinton then moved the main body of his troops against the
+left of the Americans, where General (Lord) Stirling was in command, but
+the batteries were so well handled that there also the redcoats were
+repulsed.
+
+Then they turned toward the American right; but that sturdy blacksmith
+from Rhode Island, Nathanael Greene, was there, and no better success
+crowned their desperate and determined efforts. And Mad Anthony and his
+men had rushed to the assistance of their comrades. When his men
+perceived the nature of the work which was expected of them, they
+prepared for the action after their own peculiar manner. As we already
+know, many of them had cast aside their coats when they entered the
+battle, but now some of them stopped and deliberately rolled up their
+shirt sleeves. A shout greeted the men, when their action was perceived,
+and in a moment their companions had followed their example. Then, with
+cheers and calls, the unsoldierly appearing soldiers rushed into the
+fray, and so vigorous was their work that soon the redcoats were
+compelled to retreat behind the defile, where the first stand had been
+made in the beginning of the battle.
+
+There they felt secure. On either side lay heavy swamps and thick woods,
+while in front of them was a narrow pass, through which the Americans
+must go if they continued the attack.
+
+And that was just what General Washington determined to do. Carefully he
+arranged for divisions to move upon the right and upon the left, while
+the artillery was to be brought up and pour its terrible fire directly
+into the front of the position the British had taken.
+
+The men responded with a will, but before the detachments could gain the
+desired position the night had come, and darkness spread over the field,
+wrapping friend and foe alike within its folds. Although the eager
+Americans could not then advance, they resolved to pass the night in the
+positions they then held, which were very near to the lines of the
+British, and renew the attack as soon as the light of the morning came.
+
+Guards were established, and then the entire army prepared for the
+night. The exhausted men threw themselves upon the ground, many of them
+lying at full length with their arms spread wide and their faces resting
+directly upon the sand. Seldom have men been more completely worn out
+than were those hardy soldiers on that day of the battle of Monmouth.
+Many had fallen, and when their friends examined their bodies for the
+marks of the fatal bullets not a scratch could be found.
+
+The beams of the summer sun had accomplished what, in many instances,
+the bullets of the enemy had failed to do. All day long the sun had hung
+in the heavens like a great red ball of fire. Steadily the heat had
+risen higher and higher, until it had arrived at a point which even the
+"oldest inhabitants" could not exaggerate in their stories. The tongues
+of some of the men had swelled so that speech became impossible. The
+poor Hessians, condemned to wear their heavy fur hats, left many a
+lifeless body behind them which the heat had conquered before the
+desperate Americans could accomplish the same result.
+
+For hours that night not a sign of life appeared in the American camp.
+Motionless as logs the exhausted soldiers lay stretched upon the ground,
+and the sounds of their deep breathing were all that could be heard.
+They had not stopped even to bury their dead, so little life did the
+living men apparently retain.
+
+Great was the astonishment in the American camp when the first faint
+streaks of the dawn appeared on the following morning, and it was
+discovered that not a soldier remained in the British camp. Sir Henry
+Clinton had permitted his weary men to rest until ten o'clock, and then,
+in silence, preparations were made to join the forces of General
+Knyphausen, who, meanwhile, had marched on and gone into camp at Nut
+Swamp, near the Heights of Middletown.
+
+The British soldiers hastily had collected their wounded, leaving only
+forty of the poor fellows behind them, and then under the light of the
+moon began their march to the position which Knyphausen was holding. So
+wearied were the American soldiers, so heavy was their slumber, and so
+silent were all the movements of Clinton's men, that their departure was
+not discovered before the morning came, and by that time the redcoats
+were with the Hessians and safe from all danger of an attack.
+
+General Washington considered a further pursuit as "impracticable and
+fruitless," and greatly to the chagrin of his army no attempt was made
+to push forward. The great battle of Monmouth had been fought. The
+soldiers hastily prepared to bury their dead, and so hurried were their
+movements that one man afterwards declared he had seen the bodies of
+thirteen men cast into one shallow pit which had been dug in the sand.
+Yet the Continentals were neither brutal nor indifferent. A British army
+was near them, and desperate haste was considered necessary.
+
+The results of the battle, its effect upon the redcoats and buffcoats,
+and those who wore no coats at all, and the parts which Tom Coward and
+certain other of our acquaintances had taken in the struggle, we must
+reserve for another chapter.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+THE RETURN TO BENZEOR'S HOUSE
+
+
+THERE were several motives in the mind of Little Peter which made him
+eager to overtake Ted and the fat and kicking Jeshurun, not the least of
+which was the sense of protection he felt in the presence of the
+powerful man. Boyish as Ted was in many ways, his great size and
+wonderful physical strength made him a companion to be desired in the
+midst of such dangers as the troubled lad was compelled to face in those
+sad times in Old Monmouth.
+
+Accordingly, Little Peter ran eagerly forward, hoping to overtake Ted
+before he should arrive at Benzeor's house, which now was not more than
+two miles away. Long before he came within sight of the place, he
+discovered Ted and his steed in advance of him, and from their
+motionless attitude he quickly concluded that Jeshurun had been seized
+with another attack of obstinacy.
+
+His surmise proved to be correct, and as he came nearer he beheld Ted
+seated by the roadside holding Jeshurun's bridle in his hand, and
+apparently waiting patiently for the time when the little beast should
+decide to continue his journey.
+
+"I'm glad to see you, lad," remarked Ted, as Little Peter approached. "I
+left you rather suddenly back there, but when Jesh makes up his mind to
+start, it's time for me to go, too, and I can't always stop to say
+good-by to my friends. It's easier than walkin', though, but I wish I
+knew some way to fix the little rascal. I've been thinkin' as how, if
+Jeshurun kicked when he waxed fat, it might be that if he waxed thin,
+the kickin' would go, too, along with the fatness. I say, Little Peter,
+I want to ask ye a question."
+
+"All right, Ted, go ahead," replied Little Peter, as he fanned his
+dripping face with his hat and took a seat beside his companion.
+
+"In your opinion," said Ted soberly, "is the oyster a wild animal, or a
+tame one?"
+
+"What?"
+
+"Is the oyster a wild animal or a tame one? Maybe you don't think he's
+an animal at all, only just an insect; but my opinion is that he's an
+animal, and what I'd like to know is whether he's wild or tame."
+
+"He isn't savage, anyway," remarked Little Peter demurely.
+
+"I'm not talkin' about whether he's savage or not, but whether he's wild
+or tame. That's been a-botherin' me a good bit, and I just can't find
+any answer. Whoa! Whoa there, Jesh! What's the matter with ye? If ye
+want to start on, I'm your man." These last remarks were directed at the
+mule, which had begun to display some of the qualities of the famous
+character for whom he had been named; but his owner's words served to
+calm him, and Jeshurun soon stood in such an abject attitude that, to
+one who was not familiar with his ways, wickedness and kicking would
+never have been suspected of him.
+
+"Maybe the oyster's a bird more than he is an insect," said Little
+Peter. "When his shell is spread out it looks something like wings."
+
+"No, he isn't a bird, he's a animal," said Ted, "and what I want to know
+is whether he's a tame or a wild one."
+
+"What do you want to know for?"
+
+"Why, the way of it is this: Some time ago I planted an oyster-bed off
+the mouth of the river, and the first thing I knew my neighbors was
+a-helpin' themselves to it. When I said I didn't like that very much,
+and those oysters was mine, all the men did was to laugh. Yes, sir, jest
+laughed," repeated Ted, as if he felt aggrieved at the levity of his
+neighbors. "Then, they went on to tell me that I couldn't plant oysters,
+same as I did 'taties and things in my garden. Oysters was wild things
+and belonged to anybody that found them, jest the same as turtles and
+clams and wild geese did. I've been a-puzzlin' my head a good deal over
+it, and I can't make it out. I planted them oysters for Sallie,--she's
+my wife, ye know,--and as long as she had all she wanted of 'em, I
+didn't care how much the neighbors helped themselves; but when it comes
+to sayin' that them oysters I planted don't belong to me, but any one
+can go and take all he wants, jest as if they was clams, or
+gooseberries, or--or--or--saltwater, I don't know what to do about it.
+What do you think, Little Peter?" he added anxiously.
+
+"I don't know; I never thought of it before."
+
+Absurd as the question appears to us, it was far from being so to the
+people of Old Monmouth in the times of which we are writing. So warm
+had the discussion become that it was soon after carried into the
+courts, and in 1808 a case was tried before the supreme court, but no
+definite decision was gained. In 1821 another famous trial was held, and
+finally in 1858 the supreme court decided that oysters were both tame
+and wild. Where they had grown naturally and without being planted, they
+were to be considered as wild and the property of any one who chose to
+take them; but where they had been planted, and there was no natural
+growth, the oysters were "tame" and the property of the one who had made
+the bed. Even after that decision there was trouble for a long time in
+Old Monmouth over the question, although to-day it is generally accepted
+that a man may own oysters as he does other animals.
+
+"I'm sorry ye can't help me," said Ted.
+
+"So am I, but I'm not thinking of oysters just now. I want to go up to
+Benzeor Osburn's more than anything else."
+
+"I'm with ye. We're so near, maybe Jeshurun will be willing to go, if he
+doesn't have to carry me on his back. I'll try him and see."
+
+To the surprise of both, Jeshurun appeared to be willing to resume the
+journey and obediently followed Ted, who led him by the bridle rein
+which he slipped over the mule's head.
+
+In this wise they all walked on, but as they came nearer to the end of
+their journey, conversation ceased. Little Peter was thinking of the
+children and trying to devise some plan by which he might care for them.
+What his companion's thoughts were did not appear, but the expression
+upon his face had undergone a change, and from the occasional word he
+dropped, which sounded very like "Hangin' Sallies," the lad thought he
+knew what was going on in Ted's mind. What would occur if Benzeor should
+be found at his home, Little Peter could not determine; but he felt
+assured from Ted's manner that this time his neighbor would not escape
+so easily as he had when the angry man had given him his involuntary
+bath in the waters of the Shrewsbury River.
+
+However, there was a deal of comfort for the lad in the company of his
+powerful friend; and as Benzeor's little house now appeared in the
+distance, he was more and more rejoiced that he was not compelled to
+approach it alone. If Indian John's words were correct, Benzeor was not
+there now; but it was more than possible that John had been mistaken,
+or that the man had returned since his visit in the early morning.
+
+These possibilities were sufficiently strong to increase Little Peter's
+excitement, and when they turned into the lane which led up to the house
+his heart was beating rapidly and his breathing was hard and fast. As he
+glanced toward the place, he suddenly discovered some children playing
+in the yard and instantly recognized two of them as his own little
+brothers.
+
+The children, then, were safe; and with a sigh of relief he turned to
+his companion and said, "There are my little brothers! They're all
+right, and so far it looks better."
+
+"Hangin' Sallies!" muttered Ted; and Little Peter said no more, as he
+perceived that his companion's rage over the treatment his wife had
+received had returned with increased force.
+
+Suddenly out from the barn beyond the house started two men on
+horseback, riding directly down the lane toward them. Startled and
+perplexed by the sight, both Little Peter and Ted stopped and waited for
+the men to approach. If the lad had been alone he would instantly have
+turned and fled without waiting to see who the strangers were; but
+Ted's presence restrained him, and although he was thoroughly alarmed,
+he waited with his companion.
+
+As the horsemen came nearer he discovered that they were Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote, the two men who had been with Tom and
+Benzeor on their voyage to New York just before Tom's departure from his
+foster-father's home. Quickly recalling what Tom had reported of their
+conversation at that time, the sight of them now did not tend to allay
+his fears; but Ted's presence was a source of comfort, and, although he
+was trembling in his excitement, he did not speak.
+
+Barzilla instantly stopped his horse as he recognized Little Peter, and,
+leaning forward on his horse's neck as he spoke, said, "Where's
+Benzeor?"
+
+"I don't know," replied Little Peter. "Isn't he here?"
+
+"No, he isn't here. He came back last night, but he's gone again, and
+the women folks pretend they don't know where he is. It's lucky for
+him."
+
+"What do you want of him?"
+
+"You and he both will know more about that after we've found him,"
+replied Barzilla, as he touched his horse with his spurs, and both men
+rode swiftly down the lane and soon disappeared from sight up the road.
+
+Little Peter told his companion of his suspicions as they resumed their
+walk, and Ted quickly stopped, and, shaking his fist in the direction in
+which the horsemen had disappeared, said, "Hangin' Sallies! Maybe I'd
+better take after them, if I don't find Benzeor."
+
+"No, no, Ted. Come on, we're almost here now."
+
+They soon entered the yard, and as the children discovered the presence
+of their brother they ran eagerly to him and threw themselves into his
+arms.
+
+"I want to go home. I want to go home. May we go home now?" said one of
+them.
+
+Little Peter's eyes filled with tears as he lifted the child in his arms
+and said, "No, I'm afraid not. We haven't any home now."
+
+"But I want to go home," persisted the little fellow pleadingly. "I
+don't want to stay here any longer. I want to go home."
+
+"Hasn't Benzeor been good to you?"
+
+"Yes, but he isn't here. I want to go home. I want to go home."
+
+Little Peter glanced up and saw that Ted's face was moving strangely,
+and that the tears were streaming from his eyes. The powerful man had a
+heart as tender as a woman's, and the piteous pleadings of the homeless,
+motherless little lad were more than he could endure.
+
+"Here, Little Peter!" said Ted hastily. "You go in the house, and I'll
+look after the babies while you're gone. Here, my lads and lassies all!
+Come take a ride on the back of Jeshurun."
+
+In a moment the grief of the little ones was forgotten, and, laughing in
+their delight, they were lifted upon the back of Jeshurun, who to all
+appearances had suddenly become as mild and gentle as a lamb.
+
+Little Peter glanced back at the laughing group as he started toward the
+house, and then looking up beheld Sarah standing in the doorway. Her
+face was red with weeping and she evidently was in great distress.
+
+"Why, Sarah!" exclaimed Little Peter. "What's the trouble? What is it?"
+
+"My father! My father!" sobbed Sarah, burying her face in her hands.
+
+"What's happened to him? Is he killed? Is he dead?"
+
+"No, no. It's worse than that."
+
+"Worse than that? What do you mean?"
+
+"Oh, Little Peter, don't _you_ know?" exclaimed the girl, looking up
+again as she spoke.
+
+Peter made no reply. He did not know just what it was to which Sarah
+referred, and although he had his own suspicions, he did not feel that
+he could refer to them in the presence of the troubled girl.
+
+"Have you seen Tom?" said Sarah suddenly.
+
+"No. He's in the army, I think, and I haven't been near that."
+
+"You wouldn't have to go very far. They say they're both near here, and
+that there either has been a battle or there will be one soon. I wish
+Tom was here. If you see him, won't you tell him to come back just as
+soon as he can?"
+
+"Yes, if I see him. I don't know that I shall very soon, though. I don't
+know what to do, Sarah. I came to see about the children."
+
+"They're all right. They seem to be now, don't they?" she said, as a
+burst of laughter came from the noisy group. "Perhaps you don't want to
+leave them here now, though," she added, her eyes filling with tears
+once more as she spoke. "I wish you would leave them. It isn't much we
+can do for you, but we want to do what we can."
+
+There was an intensity in Sarah's manner which Little Peter could not
+understand. He was in ignorance of all that Sarah knew, and perhaps if
+he had known his reply might have been somewhat different.
+
+"It's good of you, Sarah. I don't know what to do or where to go."
+
+"You can stay here, too."
+
+"No, no. I can't do that," he said hastily; and then fearing that he had
+said too much, added, "I'll leave the children for a little while.
+They'll be safe here till after the battle you tell about."
+
+"I wish you would, Peter. You couldn't please us better. Who's that man
+with you?" she added, apparently for the first time becoming aware of
+Ted's presence.
+
+"A man to see your father," said Little Peter evasively. "Is he home?"
+
+"No, no," and Sarah shuddered as she spoke. "He came last night, but he
+didn't stay long. He went away again, and I don't know when he'll come
+again. It'll be a long time. I hope"--
+
+What Sarah hoped for she did not explain, and Little Peter said, "I
+want to talk with Ted before I say anything more. He's the man out there
+with the children. I'll be back in a minute."
+
+Many minutes passed, however, before the lad returned. He called to Ted
+and for a long time they talked together. Ted was decidedly averse to
+the plan of leaving the children in Benzeor's home, and freely offered
+to take them with him to the place where he had left Sallie and his own
+little ones, also venturing to refer several times to the fact that
+Sallie was his wife.
+
+Pleased as Little Peter would have been to accept the offer, Sarah's
+pleadings could not be forgotten, and as he felt that the children would
+be safe where they then were, he declined the kind offer of Ted.
+
+"I'll tell you what, my lad," said Ted at last. "If the armies are as
+near here as the girl says they are, the thing for you and me to do is
+to go over there. They may need us, too. The most I've done so far has
+been to look out for that stuff the men brought up the Shrewsbury in the
+supply boat. That's all in good hands now, and I'm free to go. Jesh will
+be glad to go, too."
+
+"But you can't leave Sallie and the babies."
+
+"Yes, I can, too. Sallie's my wife, ye know, and when I took her over to
+the Dennises I told her I might not be back for a week or two. She won't
+be disappointed, and Jesh will be tickled to pieces to join the army.
+Jest look at his ears now. When his ears is that way, I always know
+Jeshurun wants to fight the Dutch butchers."
+
+"We've no other place to go to, or at least I haven't," said Little
+Peter thoughtfully. "Well, we'll do as you say. I'll go and tell Sarah."
+
+"I'm so glad you'll leave the children," said Sarah eagerly, when Little
+Peter reported the decision which had been made. "It isn't much we can
+do, as I told you, but we do want to do everything we can for you."
+
+"It's good of you to take them."
+
+"It's good of you to leave them. There's one thing, though, I must tell
+you. We haven't much to eat in the house. There's some meal over at the
+mill, and father would have gone for it if he'd been home to-day. But he
+isn't here and I don't know what we'll do."
+
+"You'd like to have me go over there and get it, before we start," said
+the boy. "Have you got your horses yet?"
+
+"Yes, there are two in the barn, and you can take the heavy wagon. It's
+kind of you to do it, Little Peter, but it won't take you long, and you
+don't know how much it will help us just now."
+
+"I'll go right away."
+
+Little Peter turned and explained to Ted the cause of the delay. At
+first, Ted insisted upon going with him, but as the lad explained that
+only two hours would be required for the journey, he persuaded him to
+remain.
+
+In a few minutes the two horses had been led forth from the barn, and
+hitched to the wagon ("geared" was what Ted called the task), and then
+Little Peter mounted the seat, grasped the reins in his hands, and
+turned down the lane, on what proved to be the most eventful ride in all
+his life.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+THE RIDE TO THE MILL
+
+
+THE early morning had not yet gone when Little Peter started on his
+journey to the mill. He knew the place well, for many a time had he gone
+there for his father. It was an antiquated structure beside a pond,
+which had been formed by a dam built across the very brook near which he
+and Indian John had passed the preceding night.
+
+The work at the mill had been somewhat interrupted since the outbreak of
+the war, but the increasing necessities of the people of Old Monmouth
+had led the miller to resume his labors, and Sarah had informed Little
+Peter that he would surely find him in his accustomed place.
+
+At times, the road led through the woods, and the boy could almost touch
+the bushes that grew close to the sandy roadway on either side. His view
+was somewhat obstructed by these,--and that fact, together with the
+unbroken stillness that rested over all, combined to make Little Peter
+watchful, and somewhat fearful as well.
+
+The sunlight flickered through the treetops and cast fantastic shadows
+on the ground. The horses did not increase their speed above a slow
+trot, for the heat was oppressive and the sandy road was heavy; and,
+eager as Little Peter was to be back again at Benzeor's house, he had
+not the heart to urge on the toiling beasts. The mill was not more than
+three miles from the place from which he had started, and at the pace at
+which the horses were then going the lad thought he would be back in
+less than two hours.
+
+He had covered about half of the way to the mill when his horses, with a
+sudden snort of fear, darted to one side of the roadway. Little Peter
+quickly drew the reins tight, and stood up to discover the cause of the
+alarm.
+
+Two men stepped from the bushes into the road, and as they grasped the
+horses by their bits the lad at once recognized them as Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote.
+
+"We thought you were Benzeor," exclaimed Barzilla, as he discovered who
+the driver was.
+
+"I've got his horses," replied Little Peter.
+
+"So I see. What are you doing with them?"
+
+"Going to the mill. You know the children are at Benzeor's house, and
+Sarah wanted me to go for some meal. She said there was none in the
+house and her father wasn't likely to be home in time to get it, so I
+came for it."
+
+"Where's your father?"
+
+"He's been sent to New York."
+
+"So I've heard. Little Peter, do you know who made the attack on your
+house?"
+
+"It was Fenton's gang, I'm sure."
+
+"So am I, and I ought to know, for I was there myself."
+
+"You there?" exclaimed Little Peter. He did not refer to the suspicions
+he had entertained concerning the very men who then stood before him;
+but he had never expected them to declare their actions so boldly. The
+alarm which he had felt, when the two men had suddenly presented
+themselves in the road, was greatly increased now, and for a moment he
+glanced quickly about as if he were seeking some avenue of escape.
+
+"Yes, we were there," resumed Barzilla, apparently ignoring the lad's
+alarm. "I didn't know but you knew it, and I've felt mean enough about
+it, too. We didn't have anything to do with what happened there," he
+hastily added; "but the truth is, we thought it was about time some kind
+of a stop was put to the doings of the pine robbers,--so Jacob, here,
+and I pretended to go in with them. Of course we didn't like the work,
+but we hoped we could learn enough about their plans to trap them. And
+we've almost succeeded. We've been as busy as you have, my lad, and
+pretty soon we hope the murderers of your mother will be run to cover."
+
+Little Peter had never thought of the scheme which Barzilla mentioned,
+and at first he did not know whether to believe him or not. Certainly
+appearances were against him, but he was in no position to dispute the
+statement.
+
+"Is that what Benzeor was doing, too?" he inquired.
+
+"Benzeor? Benzeor Osburn? Don't you know what he had to do"--
+
+"Hold on, Barzilla," interrupted Jacob. "Little Peter doesn't know about
+him, or he wouldn't let the children stay there."
+
+"Why? What do you mean? Aren't the children safe there?" said Peter
+quickly.
+
+"Safe? They couldn't be safer if they were in China, or some other
+heathing land," said Barzilla. "Even Benzeor's horses are safe. There
+isn't such a team as that left in Old Monmouth," he added, "and if his
+beasts aren't touched, I don't think you need to worry very much about
+the young ones."
+
+"I don't understand," said Little Peter.
+
+"You don't need to," said Jacob quickly, "You've got enough to worry
+about, my boy, without bothering your head over Barzilla's words. He
+talks too much, anyway. You just go on and get the meal for Sarah;
+that's all you need to think about now."
+
+"Yes, but Little Peter ought to know a bit more," said Barzilla
+doggedly. "The truth is that we've run some of Fenton's gang into these
+very woods. There are several of us scouring the region, and it's only
+fair to tell you that you may run across some of 'em if you keep on. For
+my part I advise you to turn back and not go to the mill at all. It
+isn't safe."
+
+"Nobody'll touch him. Let him go on," said Jacob. "The children will
+have to be fed, and he might as well get the meal. He's safe enough."
+
+"He can do as he pleases," muttered Barzilla.
+
+Little Peter was perplexed, for the actions and words of the men were
+sadly confusing. Tom had reported to him some of their previous
+conversations, and his own suspicions, as we know, had been aroused. If
+Barzilla spoke truly now, he was in no slight danger himself, while the
+very decided difference of opinion between the two men tended to
+increase his confusion.
+
+"I'm goin' to tell you some more," said Jacob. "Last night some of
+Fenton's gang went over to Mr. Farr's. You know the old man, don't you?"
+
+"You mean Thomas Farr, the old man who lives with his wife and daughter
+over on the road to Imlaystown?"
+
+"That's the very man. Well, Lew Fenton and some of his gang went over
+there about midnight, and attacked the house. There wasn't any one in it
+but the old man and his wife and their daughter, and you know she's old
+enough to have arrived at years of discretion, to put it mildly. The old
+people barricaded the doors with logs of wood just as soon as they
+discovered who the men were.
+
+"The pine robbers tried to break the door down with some fence rails,
+but when that failed, they fired a volley of bullets right through the
+door. One ball broke the leg of the old man, but still they wouldn't let
+the pine robbers in. Then the villains went around to the back door and
+succeeded in smashing that in. They stuck a bayonet into the old man,
+who was helpless on the floor, and then they murdered his wife right
+before his eyes. One of the men struck the daughter with the butt of his
+gun, but, although she was pretty badly hurt, she managed to get out of
+the house.
+
+"Fenton's gang didn't wait to plunder the place, but, as they were
+afraid she'd raise an alarm, they all cleared out. 'Twas mighty lucky
+for them that they did, for there was a lot of us near by. You see we'd
+seen Benzeor"--
+
+"Hold on, Jacob. That's enough. Now, Peter, you see what's going on, and
+it's my opinion that some of Fenton's gang, and maybe Fenton himself,
+are in these very woods. That's why I advised ye not to go on. Now you
+can do jest as ye like, for you've got pretty much the whole story."
+
+"I think you'll be all right," said Jacob. "It's only a little way up to
+the mill, and the children need that meal. I should go if I was in your
+place, and if I didn't have to keep watch here, I'd go with ye myself."
+
+"I'll go," said Little Peter quietly.
+
+"Good luck to ye, then," said Barzilla. "We'll see you here when you
+come back."
+
+Little Peter picked up the reins and at once started, leaving the two
+men behind him, who remained standing in the road, and watched him until
+he disappeared from sight. The lad's feelings, however, had undergone a
+very decided change. He was convinced that the story concerning the aged
+Thomas Farr was true, and he was also persuaded that his suspicions of
+Jacob and Barzilla were unjust.
+
+Every tree now might be the hiding-place of Fenton, or some of his band.
+Each moment he expected to see some one step forth into the road before
+him and stop his horses. The very silence in the woods served to
+increase his alarm. He quickened the speed of the horses, and soon they
+were wet with foam, as they toiled on through the heavy sand. The cry of
+a bird, or the chattering of a squirrel, caused the excited lad to
+glance fearfully in the direction from which the sound came. To his
+excited imagination the woods were filled with his enemies, and more
+than once a fallen tree or a broken branch took on the outlines of a
+man.
+
+It was with a feeling of intense relief that at last he saw the
+crumbling old mill before him. The sound of the water, as it dropped
+from the dam to the bed of the brook below, was like music in his ears;
+and when he discovered the miller himself standing in the doorway, he
+again increased the speed of his horses, and soon halted before the
+mill.
+
+"I've come for Benzeor Osburn's grist," he said, as he leaped from his
+seat to the ground.
+
+"They must be pretty hungry over there, from the looks of your horses."
+
+"They are. Has any one been here this morning?"
+
+"Not a soul. There's no work now, with all this fighting going on. Have
+you heard anything from the soldiers?"
+
+"Not much, only that both the armies must be near here now."
+
+There was nothing, however, in the presence of the old mill to indicate
+that war's rude alarms were to be heard anywhere in the region. The
+monotonous sound of the falling water, the dull hum of the big wheel,
+the little garden which the miller had planted near his log house close
+by, the dog lying asleep on the doorsill, the little urchins playing in
+the waters of the brook, the hens fluttering in the roadway and covering
+themselves with dust,--all seemed to declare that only peace and quiet
+were to be found in the region.
+
+And yet, only a few miles away two great armies had assembled, and, on
+the morrow the summer air would resound with the booming of cannon, and
+many a buffcoat and redcoat would be left lying side by side upon the
+plains of Old Monmouth, never again to be mindful of the struggle, or
+hear or heed the calls of their officers as they led the men into
+battle.
+
+At that very time, if the words of Barzilla Giberson were true, the
+woods, which extended between the mill and the main road, concealed some
+of the hated pine robbers, as well as outraged patriots who were
+searching for their enemies.
+
+The wagon was soon loaded, the miller's share of the grist having first
+been set aside, and Little Peter climbed up on the seat and grasped the
+reins, as he prepared to start again.
+
+"You'd better be careful," said Little Peter. "I'm told some of the
+pine robbers are hiding in these woods."
+
+"I'm not afraid," laughed the miller. "I never harmed them and they
+won't harm me."
+
+The lad related the story of the attack upon the house of Thomas Farr,
+but still the miller to all appearances was not deeply impressed.
+
+"I haven't any money and they've nothing to gain by disturbing me. I
+grind my grists just the same, whether it's a king or Congress that
+rules over me, and I don't care much, for my part, which it is. I don't
+bother my head about such things. All I want is good water and plenty of
+corn, and I'm happy all the day long."
+
+Little Peter had given his warning, so he said no more, but bidding the
+miller good-day, he spoke to his horses and at once departed.
+
+His load was heavier now than when he had come, and consequently he was
+compelled to let his horses walk. Even then the sweltering beasts
+labored heavily under the intense heat, and he was compelled to stop
+frequently and permit them to rest in some cool and shady spot.
+
+His own fears had not departed, however, but every turn of the heavy
+wheels brought him nearer to the main road, and once there he thought he
+would be safe. Already one of the three miles had been left behind him,
+and he was about to start on, after the brief rest he had given the
+horses, when he was startled by the sound of something breaking through
+the bushes that lined the road in front of him.
+
+Tremblingly he waited a moment, gazing with frightened face at the place
+in the road where the man, or animal, or whatever it was, would first
+appear. His suspense was not relieved when a horse and rider broke
+through the bushes and stopped only a few yards in advance of him.
+
+Little Peter's face was deadly pale when he instantly recognized the man
+as none other than Lewis Fenton himself. He noted the great size, the
+broad shoulders, the powerful arms, for the pine robber was riding
+without a coat, and his shirt-sleeves were rolled back, disclosing the
+great bunches of muscles; but more than all else the brutal face
+terrified him.
+
+Before he could speak or move, Fenton leaped to the ground, and leaving
+his horse by the roadside approached the wagon.
+
+"How now, young man? Give an account of yourself. Where you going? Who
+are you? As I live, if it isn't Little Peter Van Mater!" he added in
+evident astonishment.
+
+As he spoke, he grasped the frightened lad by the shoulder and dragged
+him to the ground. Then the brutal, cowardly man struck him two savage
+blows. The sight of the woods and even of the pine robber faded from
+Little Peter's eyes, and the unconscious boy dropped heavily upon the
+sand. Even then Fenton was not satisfied, for again and again he kicked
+the body, apparently not yet convinced that life was extinct.
+
+But Little Peter suffered no pain. With sightless eyes, his
+blood-stained face looked up at the blue sky above the treetops, but
+neither the passing clouds nor the further actions of the brutal pine
+robber were heeded by the lad.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+AFTER THE BATTLE
+
+
+TOM COWARD, as we know, had been selected to serve as one of the guides
+of the American army. The roads were not so numerous as to cause any
+fear of serious trouble from confusion; but boys and young men from the
+region were nevertheless assigned to this duty, and in some instances
+were said to have been so greatly excited as to have failed in finding
+the way themselves. To this cause some assigned the failure of Morgan's
+dragoons to enter the battle; but doubtless there were other causes as
+well which prevented that terrible band of riflemen from having a share
+in the struggle.
+
+Tom had been reserved to move with the troops that were under the
+command of General Washington himself, and that followed the division
+which General Lee had failed to lead into battle. Frightened as the lad
+was, he still noted keenly all that was occurring about him, and had
+been as highly excited as any over the interview which took place
+between Washington and Lee when the latter was retreating. The
+impressions he there received were those which the people of Old
+Monmouth ever after retained concerning Charles Lee, for he was
+remembered, not for his experiences abroad or for his successes in the
+south, but as the man who had been the traitor in the battle.
+
+When the engagement began, Tom's duties as guide were ended, but as no
+one gave him any instructions, he was driven from one band of men to
+another, and while he still retained the rifle which he had taken when
+he had departed from Benzeor's house, he had not made any use of it.
+
+For a time he remained within sight of the young lieutenant, and they
+were together when in the early part of the battle Captain Molly had
+done the deed which has caused her name to be remembered until this day.
+Molly had marched with her husband, and as the advanced batteries opened
+fire upon each other the intrepid woman had been running back and forth
+between the men and a little spring, which was near by, bringing water
+to her husband and his companions. Her task was no light one in the heat
+of that day.
+
+As she had started to return from one of her visits to the spring, she
+turned just in time to see her husband fall as he was advancing to his
+post, for he was a cannoneer, as we already know. Molly hastily ran to
+his assistance, but she at once perceived that he was dead. She heard an
+officer order the cannon to be moved from its position, but instantly
+controlling her grief, she declared her purpose to take her husband's
+place. Amidst the cheers of the men she did so, and so bravely and well
+did she perform the duty, that after the battle was ended General Greene
+himself presented her to the great commander and related the story of
+her bravery. Washington added his words of praise and bestowed upon her
+a lieutenant's commission. The men received the news with loud cheers,
+and then themselves bestowed upon "Molly Pitcher" the title of "Captain
+Molly," and as Captain Molly she was known thereafter.
+
+Another story, told afterwards by the Frenchmen, reflected great credit
+upon General Clinton, and perhaps in a measure atoned for the action of
+that commander in wantonly burning so many of the houses in Old
+Monmouth. An American officer with about twenty of his men advanced
+under the English batteries to observe their position. The redcoats
+opened fire, and the officer's aid-de-camp fell at his side. The men,
+who were dragoons, instantly turned and fled,--that is, all save the
+officer, who, although he was directly under the fire of the cannon,
+calmly dismounted and advanced to discover whether the fallen man was
+dead or not, or whether the wound had been mortal. Quickly discovering
+that the man was dead, the American officer, visibly weeping, turned and
+remounted his horse and slowly rejoined his comrades. The officer was
+the young Marquis de Lafayette, and his white charger had been
+recognized by General Clinton, who himself ordered his men not to fire,
+and doubtless thereby saved the life of the brave young nobleman. It was
+long cherished as the one deed of mercy in the midst of a campaign and
+battle which left its marks of suffering and sorrow on every side.
+
+An instance of the other side of the British commander's character came
+to Tom's attention not long afterwards, when he heard of the misfortune
+of an old lady seventy years of age, in whose house General Clinton made
+his headquarters. The British officer, noticing that his hostess had
+caused all of her better furniture and valuables to be removed, informed
+her that she need have had no fears for the safety of her possessions,
+for he himself would protect her and them, and urged her to have them
+brought back again. As the old lady expressed her fears and objected, he
+repeated his assurances so strongly that she yielded and sent a man with
+a wagon to the place in which they had been concealed.
+
+When the wagon-load arrived in front of her door, she in person applied
+to the British commander for a guard; but the permission was refused
+and, not even giving her a change of dress for herself or her aged
+husband, the goods were at once confiscated, and the old lady was
+compelled to give up her bedroom and sleep with the negro women upon the
+floor of the kitchen.
+
+Among the congregation which had assembled at the "new church" to watch
+the battle was one man who, instead of joining his friends upon the roof
+or steeple, took his seat upon one of the gravestones. Not long
+afterwards, a cannon-ball came speeding in that direction, and struck
+the unfortunate man.
+
+The congregation upon the roof did not wait for the customary
+benediction to be pronounced, we may be sure, and while the most of them
+hastily dispersed, a few remained to carry the wounded man into the
+"meeting-house," where he died within a few minutes, and the stains of
+his blood remained for many years upon the floor. It was within six feet
+of the west end of this same "new church" that the body of the
+unfortunate British Colonel Monckton, over which the contending forces
+had such a desperate struggle, was buried.
+
+Within the vicinity of Monmouth Court House many houses and farm
+buildings were set on fire and burned by the redcoats, some of whom
+openly declared that there was no hope of conquering the rebels until
+"they had burned every house and killed every man, woman, and child."
+Just how they expected to conquer _after_ they had burned the buildings
+and slain the people is not clear to us to-day; but doubtless the
+expression and the purpose alike were born of the fury of the battle,
+and was only one among many of the results of war, which even in its
+mildest forms appeals to all that is bad in men. And as the campaign in
+Old Monmouth presented none of the milder forms of war, such deeds,
+terrible as they were, were not unnatural.
+
+Nor were they all confined to one side, for the men in buff and blue
+were as much aroused as the men in scarlet, and, while naturally the
+anecdotes and incidents of the battle are largely those of the cruel
+deeds of the redcoats, doubtless if all things had been recorded, we
+should have found that many of those brave ancestors of ours were not
+entirely guiltless of similar deeds.
+
+An unusual story was that of Captain Cook of the Virginia Corps, who was
+shot through the lungs. He was carried into a room in a near-by house
+and ordered by the surgeon not to speak. A brother officer came into the
+room and tenderly asked of the wounded man whether anything could be
+done for him. Captain Cook, in spite of his sufferings, was mindful of
+the surgeon's words and made no reply. Mistaking the cause of the
+silence, his friend departed from the house and reported to Washington
+that Captain Cook was dead, and then the commander ordered a coffin to
+be placed under the window of the room in which the brave captain was
+supposed to be lying dead. But Captain Cook was not dead, nor did he
+die until many years afterwards, and lived to visit several times the
+good people in Old Monmouth, who had tenderly ministered to his wants
+until he was able to rejoin the army.
+
+After the battle, many of the dead were found beneath the shade of
+trees, or beside the little streams to which they had crawled for
+shelter or for water; and many of these had perished, not from wounds,
+but from their labors in the intense heat of the day. Several houses at
+Monmouth Court House were filled with the wounded after the battle, and
+every room in the Court House itself was likewise filled. The suffering
+soldiers lay upon the straw which had been scattered over the floors,
+and the groans and cries of the wounded and the moanings of the dying
+resounded together. The faces of many were so blackened that their
+dearest friends did not recognize them, and as fast as they died their
+bodies were taken and buried in pits, which were only slightly covered
+by the sand.
+
+A similar service was rendered for the enemy's dead, and among them was
+found a sergeant of dragoons whose immense body had been a familiar
+sight to both armies, for the man was said to have been the tallest
+soldier ever seen in all the struggle of the Revolution, and to have
+measured seven feet and four inches in height.
+
+So, side by side, or in neighboring graves, the nameless bodies of
+friends and foes were left for their last long sleep. The roar of the
+cannon, the shouts of the men, the calls of the officers, the bitter
+feelings of the awful war were never to disturb or arouse them again.
+They had done their part, and done it well; but the land for which they
+struggled could never mark their resting-places, nor perhaps recall the
+names of all. But the heroes whose names we praise would never have been
+honored except for the part the faithful and brave, but nameless and
+forgotten, heroes took. In honoring the one class, let us never forget
+to pay a tribute of honor and of praise to the unknown and forgotten
+heroes of Old Monmouth.
+
+The loss of the Americans in the battle had been three hundred and
+sixty-two. That of the British, while it was reported to have been four
+hundred and sixteen, was doubtless much greater, for the Americans
+buried no less than two hundred and forty-five of the redcoats, and had
+no means of knowing how many had been carried away. Washington himself
+believed the loss to have been as great as twelve hundred.
+
+Who were the victors on the plains of Old Monmouth? What were the
+effects of the campaign upon the fortunes of the struggling States? Most
+American writers have claimed that the victory belonged to the
+Continentals because they had driven the British from the field, while
+many British writers have claimed that it was a drawn battle.
+
+Certainly, Washington must have felt bitterly disappointed, for he had
+hoped to defeat the enemy and capture their baggage and stores. His
+failure to do so was not due to the British, but to the treachery of
+Charles Lee. Had Lee carried out the orders given him, there can be
+little doubt to-day that the battle of Monmouth would have aided in
+putting an end to the war long before peace came.
+
+We are not concerned by what might have been the result, however, but by
+what was the result. Clinton succeeded in withdrawing his troops and
+saving his baggage train, and with both soon after embarked (June 30)
+upon the ships which Lord Howe had been keeping in waiting off Sandy
+Hook, and thereby gained the safety of New York. But his men were
+greatly disheartened, and came to regard the despised "rebels" in an
+entirely new light. Indeed, within a week more than two thousand
+deserted, the most of whom were Hessians, and the confidence of those
+who remained was sadly broken. While it is a current saying that
+"nothing succeeds like success," it is also evident that nothing fails
+like failure, and this was as true in those trying days of the
+Revolution as it is to-day, and General Clinton soon found it to be so.
+
+Upon the Americans, the moral effect of the campaign and battle was more
+needed than the material effect. Valley Forge was passed now,
+Philadelphia had been abandoned by the British, and the Americans had
+found upon the plains of Old Monmouth, as they had at Trenton and
+Princeton, that their men were not inferior to their enemies, while
+their officers were among the best the world had known. The opponents
+and enemies of Washington, and they were many at the time both within
+and without Congress, were compelled to be silent, and the great
+commander was free to face his difficulties and dangers, which were not
+ended after the battle of Monmouth. That campaign had served chiefly to
+place behind him one more of his problems, but, as we shall see, many
+yet remained to try the soul of the noblest American of them all.
+
+Meanwhile, what had become of the lad Tom Coward? Alarmed by the battle,
+not daring to fight and yet not knowing where to withdraw, although his
+fear had not been strong enough to lead to such a result, he was driven
+about by the movements of the men, and in one of the lulls which came in
+the conflict, he found himself almost alone. He was near a barn which
+stood beyond the borders of the battlefield, and was just about to turn
+the corner when he stumbled over the body of a fallen man.
+
+As he glanced down, he was almost overcome when he discovered that the
+soldier was his friend, the young lieutenant. A hurried examination
+revealed that he was still living, though he was badly wounded in the
+throat. The lad lifted the head of the suffering man, but a groan caused
+him to desist. Almost overcome by grief and fear, he turned to seek for
+aid.
+
+[Illustration: HE DISCOVERED THAT THE SOLDIER WAS HIS FRIEND]
+
+As he looked quickly about him, he perceived a man in the distance on
+the border of the woods away from the battle-ground. Instantly he
+turned and ran toward him, and to his surprise discovered that the man
+was none other than Friend Nathan Brown.
+
+"Come, Nathan! come! Be quick! Lieutenant Gordon's over here by the
+barn. He's terribly wounded and may die any moment. Come and help me
+with him!"
+
+The Quaker instantly responded, and without explaining how it had
+happened that he should be discovered so near a scene to which in spirit
+as well as in practice he was strongly opposed, ran by the side of the
+eager lad to the place where the wounded man had fallen.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+TOM COWARD'S PATIENT
+
+
+THE place where young Lieutenant Gordon was lying was in the rear of the
+barn which belonged to the parsonage of the "new church." After the
+bullet had hit him, he had managed to crawl to that secluded place, but
+the sounds of the battle, which was still being waged in the vicinity,
+were not long heard by the wounded officer, for he had soon become
+unconscious, and the roar of the cannon and the shouts of the men were
+all unheeded and unheard.
+
+"Is he dead?" said Nathan in a low voice, as he looked down upon the
+unconscious man.
+
+"No! no!" replied Tom hastily; "or at least he wasn't a minute ago. No,
+he's still alive," he added after a hurried examination. "We must carry
+him away from this place."
+
+"I see no place for thy friend. These sons of Belial are not likely to
+permit thee to depart unnoticed."
+
+Friend Nathan was trembling, and his face betrayed his alarm. And there
+was much to frighten him. Clouds of smoke could be seen not far away,
+and the loud shouts of men and the reports of their guns could be
+distinctly heard. The struggle near the meeting-house was one of the
+most severe in all the battle, and the danger of which the frightened
+Nathan spoke was not unreal. But Tom's fears had departed now, and
+although he never fully understood the cause of the change in his
+feelings, the sight of his suffering friend and his determination to aid
+him had banished all thoughts concerning his own personal safety.
+
+At a distance of a half mile, Tom could see a little farmhouse, and he
+hastily decided that the young lieutenant must be carried there. The
+building was on the border of the plain and on the side opposite to the
+place where the struggle was going on.
+
+There would be danger in the attempt to carry him across the field, but
+thinking only of his friend, Tom said hastily, "We must carry him to
+that farmhouse yonder, Nathan. I don't know who lives there, but whoever
+does won't refuse to receive a wounded man, I know. You take hold of his
+feet, and I'll lift the head and shoulders, and we'll get him there
+somehow. Come, Nathan, we mustn't delay a minute."
+
+"Have it thine own way, Friend Thomas," replied Nathan, as he stooped
+and grasped the legs of the wounded officer.
+
+Tom gently lifted the head of the young lieutenant at the same time, and
+carefully across the field the two men began to move with their burden.
+Their progress necessarily was slow, and the lad's fears were not
+allayed by the evident alarm of his companion. Nathan repeatedly glanced
+behind him, and several times Tom was compelled to speak sharply to
+recall the frightened man to their present task. The shouts and reports
+of the guns were increasing, and Tom's strongest desire was to avoid
+attracting the attention of any of the combatants.
+
+They had safely passed beyond the orchard, and he was just beginning to
+hope that their efforts would be successful, when suddenly Nathan's hat
+was lifted from his head and the sound of a whistling musket-ball was
+heard as it passed above them.
+
+For a moment, the startled Nathan looked down at his hat, and as he
+perceived the hole in it which the bullet had made, he instantly
+dropped his burden, and turning sharply about, started in a swift run
+across the field.
+
+"Come back, Nathan! Come back! Don't leave me here!" pleaded Tom; but
+Nathan did not heed the call.
+
+His pace was a marvelous one for a man of his years, and as he bent low
+over the ground, as if to avoid other bullets which might be coming
+toward him, and sped swiftly forward, under other circumstances Tom
+might have felt inclined to laugh at the ludicrous sight the fleeing man
+of peace presented. But as it was he felt much more inclined to cry than
+to laugh, and, as he realized his own helplessness, he knew not what to
+do. If he had been alone he might have followed Nathan and gained a
+place of safety, but, as he glanced down upon the suffering man, who now
+lay stretched upon the ground, his whole soul rebelled against the
+thought of deserting his friend in a time like that.
+
+What could he do? The desperate lad looked about him hoping to discover
+some one whom he might summon to his aid. In the distance he could see
+the bands of struggling soldiers, and their shouts and shots could be
+clearly heard. But they were all intent upon their own contest, and
+there was no one who would hear or heed him if he should call.
+
+He could not abandon his friend--that much at least was certain; and at
+last he determined to do his utmost to carry the helpless, wounded man
+himself. Placing his arms beneath the shoulders of the unconscious
+lieutenant, and striving to rest the head against his own body, he
+started slowly on, dragging the man with him. His progress was
+necessarily slow, and he was compelled to stop frequently, both for his
+own sake and that of his friend. Still, on and on he persistently made
+his way. The intense heat of the day, his constant fear that life would
+depart from the body he was dragging forward, the sound of the battle
+behind him, all combined to increase his troubles; but not for a moment
+did he think of abandoning his efforts for his friend.
+
+Proceeding slowly, stopping at frequent intervals and then resuming his
+efforts, he steadily drew nearer to the farmhouse he had perceived in
+the distance. How much time had been consumed he could not determine.
+The minutes seemed like hours to the struggling lad. His own danger was
+all forgotten for the time, and the one purpose in his mind was to
+carry Lieutenant Gordon to some place of safety, where it should be
+possible to do something for the relief of the desperately wounded man.
+
+At last, only one more lot remained to be crossed, and with renewed hope
+Tom was about to lift his burden, which he had dropped for one of his
+brief rests, when he suddenly discovered a man running toward him.
+Startled and alarmed by the sight he quickly perceived that the
+approaching man was Friend Nathan, who, hatless and with a dripping
+face, was soon by his side.
+
+"Thou hast put me to shame, Friend Thomas," said Nathan soberly. "Thou
+art a better man than I, as well as a braver. I know not why it was, but
+when my hat was lifted from my head, and I perceived that hole the
+bullet had made, I lost my self-control. My teaching has been that of
+peace and I am poorly prepared for the contests of war. I will give thee
+no cause to complain now."
+
+"Take hold, then," said Tom quickly. "We must get the lieutenant out of
+this heat, or there'll be no hope for him."
+
+Nathan eagerly responded, and tenderly lifting the wounded man they
+proceeded across the lot.
+
+When they halted for their first rest, Nathan said, "I have a word to
+say to thee, Friend Thomas. What did Washington say to thee when he
+heard thy demand for a recompense for the beast I let thee have?"
+
+"Say? He didn't say anything, because I didn't say anything to him. You
+don't suppose he hadn't anything more to do than to talk with a boy like
+me about your old, broken-winded razor-back, do you? I don't even know
+what has become of the beast. I know I'm glad I don't have to ride it
+any more."
+
+"'Tis well, Friend Thomas," replied Nathan, although Tom thought he
+discovered a trace of disappointment in the expression upon his face.
+"'Tis well, and I would not have it otherwise. I have been humiliated by
+my weakness in deserting thee, a mere lad, at such a time as this. I
+would like also to restore to you the half-joe you paid me for my
+beast." And as Nathan spoke, he drew the coin from his pocket and held
+it forth for Tom to take.
+
+"I don't want your money," said the lad quickly. "Take hold of the
+lieutenant again, and this time we'll not stop before we come to the
+house."
+
+Once more they tenderly took up their burden, and slowly advancing, soon
+approached the house. In the doorway a man and a young woman, evidently
+his daughter, were standing, watching the movements of the approaching
+men with a curiosity which the noise of the battle in the distance could
+not entirely dispel.
+
+Tom's heart was lighter when he recognized the man as Jonathan Cook and
+the young woman as his daughter Mary.
+
+"We've brought this man here," said Tom quickly, "to find a
+resting-place for him. It's Lieutenant Gordon, and he's terribly
+wounded. Will you let us put him in one of your beds?"
+
+"We will that," said Mr. Cook. "We've got one poor fellow here now, and
+will do all we can for another, too. Take him right in here," he added,
+leading the way to a bedroom adjoining the living-room on the ground
+floor.
+
+Tom and Nathan eagerly followed him, and in a brief time had placed the
+suffering man on the high bed. Although the lad was almost exhausted by
+his efforts, with Nathan's aid he soon removed the clothing of the
+young officer, and then Mary came and bathed his bleeding face, and with
+many expressions of sympathy listened to the story the weary boy had to
+tell.
+
+"I don't suppose it's been wise or safe for us to stay here," said Mary,
+"but we just couldn't leave the old place until we had to. We've been
+keeping watch all day long, and if the redcoats come this way we shall
+have to go. It's been a good thing we've stayed, though, for Captain
+Nealey is upstairs and he's almost as badly wounded as this poor man is.
+Oh, it's horrible, horrible!"
+
+But intense as Mary's feelings were, they did not prevent her from
+bestowing a very tender care upon the unconscious young lieutenant, and
+as soon as Tom was satisfied that his friend was receiving better
+nursing than he could give, the lad went out of the room.
+
+He discovered Nathan bathing his face and hands near the water-barrel,
+which stood beneath the corner of the eaves, and after he had followed
+his example, he began to be sensible of his own feeling of exhaustion.
+
+"Now, Friend Thomas, thee must lie down and get some sleep," said
+Nathan. "I will assist Mary in her care of thy friend, and I insist
+that my words he obeyed. The heavy task has been thine, and my own
+cowardice has added to thy burdens, so that now it is thy turn to rest."
+
+The tired lad was easily persuaded, and after again going into the room
+in which the unconscious lieutenant was lying, he followed Mr. Cook up
+the stairs to a room above, and soon threw himself heavily upon the bed
+and fell into a deep sleep.
+
+It was dark when he awoke, and at first it was almost impossible for him
+to recall the events of the day. They soon returned, however, and
+hastily arising, he made his way down the stairs and entered the
+living-room, where he discovered Nathan seated in one of the large
+wooden chairs. The moonlight came in through the open windows, and as
+Nathan perceived the lad, he said,--
+
+"And did sleep come to thee, Friend Thomas?"
+
+"Yes. I'm rested now. How's the lieutenant?"
+
+"There has been no change. Mary comes every hour and bathes his face in
+cool water from the well, but he does not open his eyes."
+
+"Is the battle ended? I don't hear any guns."
+
+"I know not. Since sunset all has been quiet, and it is now midnight."
+
+"I'll watch now, and you go upstairs and get some sleep."
+
+"Nay. I ought not to rest after my cowardice."
+
+"Never mind that. You will do all the more if you rest awhile now."
+
+Nathan was soon persuaded, and Tom took his place as watch. He could
+hear the troubled breathing of the suffering man, but it was the only
+sound to be heard. Outside the house all was silent, and as the slow
+hours passed, the only break which came was the occasional visit of Mary
+to bathe the face of the sufferer.
+
+At daybreak, Mr. Cook brought the news of the retreat of the British,
+and great was the rejoicing in the old farmhouse when it was learned
+that at least the Americans had not suffered defeat in the battle of the
+preceding day.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon was still living, although no signs of improvement in
+his condition could be discovered. Tom speedily decided that, as he was
+not enrolled in the army, there was nothing to prevent him from
+remaining and caring for his friend. Nathan also declared that he would
+return to his aid as soon as he had gone home and explained to Rachel
+the necessity for a further absence, and the lad did not protest, for he
+thought he understood the motive which prompted the action.
+
+During the day, Mr. Cook brought the reports of the battle, the hundred
+prisoners taken, the number of the dead and wounded, and the measures
+which were being taken in the scattered farmhouses and the old
+Court-House for the care of the sufferers.
+
+Tom did not leave the house. His one thought now was of his wounded
+friend, and all that loving hearts and gentle hands could do was
+bestowed upon the suffering soldier, who as yet had not shown that he
+was aware of what was going on about him.
+
+The long day passed and the dreary night followed, but still Tom and
+Mary cared for the sufferer. Captain Nealey was said to be improving
+rapidly, but no change as yet had come in the condition of the young
+lieutenant.
+
+It was the morning of the second day, and in the early light Tom had
+gone out to the water-barrel again to bathe his face and hands. His
+heart was heavy, for apparently Lieutenant Gordon was worse, and all
+the efforts of the lad and Mary had produced no improvement in his
+condition.
+
+As Tom started to enter the house he halted upon the doorstep and looked
+up the road. A heavy farm wagon drawn by two horses was approaching, and
+as it came nearer the lad suddenly started as he thought he recognized
+the team. Surely those were Benzeor Osburn's horses. A moment later his
+suspicions were confirmed, and he knew that the lumbering wagon was his
+foster-father's.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+AMONG THE PINES
+
+
+TOM'S surprise was still further increased when he recognized one of the
+men on the seat as Little Peter, and by his side a sergeant, who was
+driving. It was Little Peter's condition, however, which quickly drew
+all of Tom's attention, for the lad was carrying one arm in a sling,
+one of his eyes was discolored, and the marks of suffering were plainly
+to be seen on his face.
+
+Tom quickly ran out into the road, and as his friend recognized him, at
+a word from him the horses stopped, and the two boys looked at each
+other for a moment as if each was trying to understand how it was that
+they both were there.
+
+"What's the matter? Were you in the battle?" said Tom, who was the first
+to speak.
+
+"No, that is, I wasn't in the battle by the Court-House. I met Fenton
+three days ago up by the old mill, and these are a few tokens of his
+regard which he left with me," said Little Peter, slightly moving his
+wounded arm as he spoke.
+
+As Tom still looked blankly at him, the lad continued, "I suppose Fenton
+thought he left me dead, and it's likely I should have died if Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote hadn't found me. They took me up and carried
+me over to Benzeor's, though I didn't know anything about it at the
+time. Sarah and her mother took such good care of me that I'm all right
+now, or at least I'm a good deal better."
+
+"You don't look as if you ought to be here," replied Tom. "You say
+Barzilla and Jacob found you and took you over to Benzeor's? I don't
+understand."
+
+"They're all right; I understand just how it is now."
+
+"What, Benzeor all right?"
+
+"No, Barzilla and Jacob. I know all about Benzeor, too," he added in a
+low voice.
+
+"Where is he?"
+
+"He hasn't been seen or heard from in four days. I don't think he'll
+come home again very soon. Tom, Sarah wanted me to tell you, if I saw
+you, that you were to come home just as soon as you could. I think she
+wants to explain something to you," he added, noting Tom's expression of
+surprise. "Since she's found out about Benzeor she feels all broken up,
+and wants you to come home."
+
+"Then she knows about Benzeor, does she?" inquired Tom thoughtfully.
+
+"Yes, and so do I. You'll go, won't you?"
+
+"I can't now; perhaps I will after a while," and Tom went on to explain
+the circumstances which seemed to make his return to Benzeor's
+impossible for a time.
+
+"But how does it happen that you are here so early in the morning, and
+with Benzeor's team? You're almost the last person I expected to see."
+
+"Oh, the way of it is like this. Barzilla and Jacob and some of the
+Whigs have been on the track of Fenton for several days now. We've got
+word that he's down in the pines, about two miles below Blue Ball.
+Several parties are out after him, for they've made up their minds to
+rid Old Monmouth of the outlaw, if such a thing can be done. Well,
+Barzilla came up to Benzeor's yesterday, and when he found I was all
+right again, he suggested that Ted and I report the matter to some of
+the officers in the American army, and get a detachment to go down
+there, so that's what we've done, you see."
+
+"No, I don't see," replied Tom, looking about for the detachment of
+soldiers of which Little Peter had spoken. "Ted? Ted who?"
+
+"Ted Wilson, if you please," said that worthy, suddenly rising from
+beneath the straw with which the wagon-box was apparently filled. "I'm
+the Ted what Little Peter means. Yes, sir, I'm on the lookout for those
+fellows that go around hangin' Sallies. She's my wife, ye know."
+
+Startled as Tom was by the unexpected appearance of the mighty Ted, he
+nevertheless was compelled to laugh, as the huge man stood before him
+striving to shake himself free from the bits of straw which covered his
+face, and shaking his fist at imaginary Fentons, who went about engaged
+in the detestable occupation of "hanging Sallies."
+
+"We saw General Lee yesterday, but he had so much trouble of his own
+that he couldn't listen much to ours," explained Little Peter, "but he
+managed to give us a sergeant and two men. The sergeant here is driving,
+and the men are with Ted under the straw."
+
+Tom's first thought was to inquire concerning the trouble of General
+Lee, which Little Peter referred to, but Ted interrupted his question by
+declaring, "Yes, sir, I've got two companions in my misery, cooped up
+here under the straw. I don't see why they don't let us sit up straight
+like men; but no, they must cover us all over with straw, and then put
+two or three barrels in the wagon-box too. 'Tisn't my way o' doin'
+things, for I'd take Jesh and go straight down to the pines and hang
+Fenton on the first tree I found. That's the way I'd do it. But I
+suppose I'll have to obey orders."
+
+"That's what you will," said the sergeant, who had been manifesting
+signs of impatience for several minutes. "We mustn't stand here in the
+road talking all day. Lie down, Ted, and we'll cover you up again."
+
+Reluctantly the huge man consented, and was soon hidden from sight by
+the straw which was thrown over him. The barrels were again arranged to
+present the appearance of an ordinary load, and then the sergeant,
+picking up the reins which were lying loose in his hands, spoke to the
+horses and started down the road.
+
+Little Peter turned and watched Tom, who had remained by the roadside,
+gazing eagerly after the departing wagon, and when at last he could see
+him no longer, once more gave all his thought to the dangerous
+expedition on which he had started with his companions.
+
+Benzeor's horses were in much better condition than those of his
+neighbors, for reasons that are apparent now to all our readers, and
+they maintained so steady a pace that by noontime the party had entered
+within the borders of the pines.
+
+The road here became rough and heavy, and the progress, as a
+consequence, was correspondingly slow. The tall stately trees, the
+whisperings of the wind, the silence of the great forest, and above all,
+the knowledge that they had entered upon the most dangerous portion of
+their journey, made all the men in the wagon anxious and watchful. Not a
+word was spoken now, even Ted having ceased to complain of his narrow
+quarters, and having no remarks to make concerning the outlaws, whose
+disposition led them to go about the country attacking defenseless men
+and "hanging Sallies."
+
+Every tree might conceal an enemy, and at any moment the discharge of a
+gun might indicate that their presence had been discovered. The
+habitations of men had been left behind them soon after they had entered
+the sombre forests, and the few rude little shanties near the border,
+occupied by negroes and people whose reputation in Old Monmouth was not
+of the best, had all been passed. The vegetation was scanty, and long
+barren stretches of sand could be seen on every side. The sunlight only
+penetrated the gloom in places, and its presence served to increase the
+dark and sombre appearance of the unbroken forest.
+
+Little Peter maintained a careful watch upon one side as they advanced,
+and the sergeant watched the other, but they seldom spoke now, and then
+only in whispers. The full sense of the danger of entering a region,
+known to be used by the pine robbers as their headquarters, was
+appreciated as it had not been when they started. They had no means of
+knowing how many men Fenton might have with him, and hard as the outlaws
+were against the defenseless people of Old Monmouth, doubtless they
+would display the honor which it is said thieves maintain toward one
+another, and if others should be within hailing distance when Fenton was
+attacked they would all quickly rally to his assistance.
+
+And the resistance which Fenton himself would be likely to make was not
+forgotten. The vision of him, as he suddenly appeared to Little Peter on
+that lonely road to the old mill a few days previous to this time, came
+up before the lad now. His big and burly frame, his bared and powerful
+arms, the brutal and merciless expression upon his evil face, were all
+seen again, and the lad shuddered as he recalled his experiences with
+him.
+
+"What's wrong?" whispered the sergeant quickly. "See anything?"
+
+"Not yet."
+
+Little Peter had not been in the region since the breaking out of the
+war, although before that time he and Tom had made frequent visits
+there. Still, he recognized the locality, and knew the place to which
+Barzilla had reported that Fenton had gone. It was a rude log house,
+built of the pine-trees, and could not be more than two miles in advance
+of them.
+
+The horses were toiling now as they dragged the heavy wagon through the
+deep sand. Fish-hawks had their nests in the tops of the lofty trees,
+and occasionally Peter obtained a glimpse of the great birds as they
+sailed in the air far above him. A brown rabbit now and then came forth
+from his burrow, and after eying the intruders a moment, would go
+bounding away into the thickets, or else dart swiftly back into his
+underground home. The note of a wood-thrush now and again broke in upon
+the stillness with its clear, sweet whistle, and the watchful men would
+glance quickly about them, almost thinking that the sound was the call
+of the pine robbers to one another.
+
+Little Peter's fear and the pain he was suffering from his recent
+encounter with Fenton made his face pale, and as the sergeant again
+turned to him and marked his appearance, he said, "'T was too bad, my
+lad, that you had to come."
+
+"I knew the way. I had to come and show you."
+
+"Yes, yes. I know it, but it's hard, for all that."
+
+"We're almost there now. The place can't be more than a quarter of a
+mile farther on."
+
+The sergeant did not reply, but turned quickly at the words, and peered
+keenly into the forest before him. No one could be seen, and the tall
+trees guarded well their secret. The toiling horses were pulling
+steadily on their load, and they, at least, felt no alarm; but Little
+Peter and his companion were anxious now, and were keeping their eyes
+steadily fixed upon the road before them.
+
+"There! That's the place!" whispered the lad excitedly, as he obtained a
+glimpse of a little clearing not far in advance of them.
+
+The sergeant did not reply, but he tightened his grasp upon the reins,
+and glanced down at the gun which he had placed within easy reach.
+Little Peter's excitement had become intense, and he was peering eagerly
+ahead of him, while his breathing was quick and hard. They would soon
+know what the result of the expedition was to be.
+
+The heavy wagon came out into the clearing, and drew near to the one
+small house, which was standing within it. The house was of logs, and
+corresponded exactly to the description which Barzilla had given of it.
+As yet, no human being had been seen, and the sergeant was just about to
+declare that the place was not inhabited when the door was suddenly
+opened and a man stepped forth to view. Evidently he had heard the
+sounds of the approaching wagon, and had come out to investigate.
+
+He was a tall, broad-shouldered, powerful-appearing man. He was clad in
+a pair of rough trousers and high boots, which looked as if they might
+have belonged to some Hessian dragoon at one time, and the red flannel
+shirt which partially covered his chest could not entirely conceal the
+great bunches of muscle there. In one hand he grasped a pistol, and the
+expression upon his face might well have caused a man with a much
+stouter heart than Little Peter had to tremble.
+
+The sergeant glanced inquiringly at the lad by his side, and Little
+Peter nodded his head in reply to the unspoken question. The man was
+Fenton himself,--the one who had robbed the widows and the fatherless,
+had made the midnight attacks upon the defenseless people of Old
+Monmouth, had hanged trembling women from the limbs of trees, and
+tortured his helpless victims into revealing the places where their
+scanty savings had been concealed. He had been the leader of bands as
+desperate and wicked as himself, and the suffering and woe which the
+good people of the surrounding region had experienced at his hands can
+never be told. And now the man himself stood waiting for the wagon, in
+which were Little Peter, himself a victim of the pine robbers' cruelty,
+and his companions, to approach.
+
+"Hold on!" called Fenton. "You're movin' too fast. What ye doin' here?"
+
+The sergeant stopped his horses, and as Fenton approached and stood near
+the wheel, he said, "We've come down here to look for a man we want to
+find."
+
+"I reckon I'll do as well as any other. Look at me! Ye're not goin' any
+farther, ye might as well understand that now as any time. Got a bottle
+with ye?"
+
+The sergeant drew forth a bottle of brandy and handed it to the outlaw.
+Fenton took it, and raised one foot upon the hub of the wheel. As he
+lifted the bottle to his lips, his eyes fell upon Little Peter, who had
+been endeavoring to conceal himself behind his companion.
+
+Instantly recognizing the lad, he shouted, "You here? You? I thought I
+left ye dead up by the mill the other day! You rascal! One whipping
+wasn't enough, was it? I'll give ye what ye deserve now!"
+
+Fenton reached back with one hand to grasp the pistol he had thrust into
+his pocket when he had taken the bottle. Quickly the sergeant kicked the
+foot of Ted Wilson under the straw, and instantly the men arose, and
+before Fenton could act, had brought their guns to their shoulders and
+the reports rang out together.
+
+The pine robber pitched heavily forward, and lay dead upon the sand. Oh,
+it was horrible, awful! A sensation of sickness, of faintness, swept
+over Little Peter as he looked down upon the face of the dead outlaw.
+
+"What's that? What's that?" said Ted quickly.
+
+It was the sound of a gun not far away. It might be the answer of other
+bands of pine robbers to the volley which had just been fired; and
+hurriedly throwing the body of Fenton into the wagon, the sergeant
+turned his horses about and started swiftly back up the road.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+CONCLUSION
+
+
+IN spite of the heavy sand the horses were driven swiftly, until their
+heaving sides and dripping flanks compelled their driver to give them a
+much-needed rest. Ted Wilson and one of the soldiers then leaped lightly
+to the ground and ran into the woods on either side of the road to
+ascertain whether they were pursued or not.
+
+As the silence of the great forest was unbroken they speedily returned,
+and the flight was resumed. No one was concealed beneath the straw in
+the wagon-box now, and every one stood waiting and ready to share in the
+defense which at any moment might become necessary.
+
+On past the tall pine-trees, on through the heavy sandy road, rushed the
+returning party, and at last, when they obtained a glimpse of the open
+country, they breathed a sigh of relief as they realized that the danger
+of immediate pursuit was gone. It was not until nearly a year after
+this time that they learned that the gun they had heard had been
+discharged by De Bow, the desperate leader of another band of outlaws as
+evil in every way as those whom the detested Fenton had himself led.
+
+It was near the close of the day when the party, of which Little Peter
+was a member, drove up to Monmouth Court-House. Carelessly, almost
+brutally, the sergeant and one of his companions seized the body of the
+dead outlaw, and flinging it from the wagon into one of the trenches the
+soldiers had made, shouted, "Here's a cordial for your tories and wood
+robbers!"
+
+Little Peter had no share in the rejoicing which followed when it was
+known that the pine robber was no more. It was true, he knew Fenton had
+richly deserved his fate, and that no more would the defenseless people
+of Old Monmouth suffer from the evil deeds of his marauding band. He,
+too, had known something of Fenton's wickedness, for he was motherless,
+homeless, and almost fatherless because of him, and his own body for
+many days bore the traces of his meeting with him on his return from the
+mill; but in spite of all that, his heart was sick whenever he thought
+of the dead face he had seen looking up at him from the wagon-box, and
+the brutal rejoicings of the men who had shot him near his abode among
+the pines.
+
+On the following day Tom Coward returned to Benzeor's house for a brief
+visit, reporting a very decided improvement in the condition of young
+Lieutenant Gordon. A long interview between Tom and Sarah followed, and
+as the troubled girl explained to the lad what she had learned
+concerning the evil deeds of her own father, and begged him to return
+and aid her in caring for the family in the presence of such dangers and
+perplexities, Tom could not find it in his heart to refuse. The kindness
+bestowed upon him in the home, and the obligations to repay as best he
+could the care he himself had received there, were too strong to be
+ignored, and greatly to the joy of Sarah and her mother he yielded to
+their urgent pleas. He had not yet enlisted in the army, and so was free
+to decide the question for himself.
+
+He was aided in making the decision by the fact that Little Peter was
+also to remain. His own home had been destroyed, and as there was no
+place to which he could take his little brothers and sisters, there was
+every reason why he should accept the invitation and increase the
+defenses of the household.
+
+It was not considered probable that Benzeor would return, nor was it
+known what had become of the man, who had gradually and yet steadily
+been drawn into the power of the pine robbers, until at last he was
+considered by them all as one of themselves, and indeed he was. Neither
+the boys nor Sarah knew then whither he had gone. Tom thought he might
+have been killed in the battle, and it was not until more than a year
+had passed that word came from the missing Benzeor; but where he had
+been and what he had been doing do not belong to this story.
+
+On the day following the great battle of Monmouth, General Lee had, to a
+certain extent, recovered from his chagrin at the public rebuke General
+Washington had administered to him, and in his arrogance, and as a
+relief to his feeling of mortification, he wrote a childish letter to
+the commander, demanding an apology for the words he had spoken in the
+presence of the soldiers.
+
+Washington's reply to Lee's letter was as follows:--
+
+"SIR,--I received your letter, expressed, as I conceive, in terms highly
+improper. I am not conscious of making use of any very singular
+expressions, at the time of meeting you, as you intimate. What I
+recollect to have said was dictated by duty and warranted by the
+occasion. As soon as circumstances will permit, you shall have an
+opportunity of justifying yourself to the army, to Congress, to America,
+and to the world in general; or of convincing them that you were guilty
+of a breach of orders, and of misbehavior before the enemy on the 28th
+instant, in not attacking them as you had been directed, and in making
+an unnecessary, disorderly, and shameful retreat."
+
+Lee's reply to this letter, as impudent as it was childish, certainly
+did not tend to elevate him in the estimation of the men of his own
+time, or of ours. His letter was as follows: "You cannot afford me
+greater pleasure than in giving me the opportunity of showing to America
+the sufficiency of her respective servants. I trust that temporary power
+of office, and the tinsel dignity attending it, will not be able, by all
+the mists they can raise, to obfuscate the bright rays of truth."
+
+Washington's reply to this insulting letter was to arrest Lee. The
+traitor was at once court-martialed and charged with disobedience of
+orders, misbehavior on the field, making a disgraceful retreat, and also
+with gross disrespect to his commander-in-chief. The trial lasted more
+than a month, and the result was that Lee was suspended for the term of
+one year. If strict justice had been measured out to the man, doubtless
+he would not have escaped with so light a sentence; but Washington was
+merciful, and although Lee did not appreciate the kindness shown him, he
+owed his life to the man whose heart and mind were so much greater than
+his own.
+
+General Washington did not long delay in Old Monmouth after the battle.
+The British army had gained New York, and so the American commander
+moved to the Hudson, and on the 20th of July went into camp at White
+Plains, having left some of the militia to look well to the needs of the
+country in which the great battle had been fought.
+
+And Monmouth was a great battle. Not only did the men struggle with a
+determination such as has been seldom displayed, but the results of the
+engagement itself were also marked and strong. While the two armies,
+after Washington had gone to the Hudson and Clinton to New York,
+occupied much the same relative positions as in the latter part of '76,
+the motives which controlled each were exactly reversed. The Americans
+now became the aggressors, and the British were compelled to defend
+themselves.
+
+All this was intensified by the action of France. Benjamin Franklin had
+succeeded in arranging a treaty between that land and ours. France was
+to send a fleet of sixteen war vessels under D'Estaing to our shores,
+and also an army of four thousand men. It was the coming of this fleet
+which, as we know, caused the British to depart from Philadelphia and
+hasten to the defense of New York, which place they thought would be
+first attacked. The march of the redcoats and Hessians across New Jersey
+gave Washington an opportunity to pursue them, and while he failed in
+accomplishing all that he hoped, and much that he might have done had it
+not been for the treacherous actions of Lee, still he virtually had won
+a victory. He compelled the British to retreat with great losses, he
+strengthened his own position, he silenced his enemies in Congress, and,
+above all, he aroused a new feeling of hope and determination in the
+hearts of the struggling Americans.
+
+The British very promptly declared war against France, and then coolly
+invited the Americans to join them, promising all that the colonists had
+asked three years before this time. The offer had come too late,
+however, for now the colonies had become States, and independence had
+been declared, and independence the new nation would have. So the war
+was continued, but the part which the new allies took and the further
+struggles of the determined Americans belong to another story.
+
+It only remains to refer briefly to the experiences of our friends,
+whose fortunes we have followed in the course of this book.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon at last recovered from his wound. Tom Coward divided
+his time between caring for his friend and the labor on Benzeor's farm.
+In the former task he was aided by Friend Nathan Brown until such a time
+as the young lieutenant could be removed to his own home.
+
+Friend Nathan had been unable to remain away from the battle of
+Monmouth, and while both his feelings and professions had prevented him
+from entering into the struggle, still his interest had been so intense
+that he had started from his home to the scene of the struggle. There he
+met Tom, and the part he then took in caring for the wounded young
+officer we already know.
+
+Neither Tom nor Little Peter was idle. There was much work to be done on
+both farms, and the lads aided each other. The crop on the ten-acre lot
+was successfully grown and harvested, and the immediate problem of food
+in Benzeor's household was in a measure solved.
+
+Indian John was never seen by our boys again. Whether he had been slain
+by the British or the pine robbers, or had departed from the homes of
+his ancestors for a region into which the redcoats and buffcoats did not
+enter, was never known. Both Tom and Little Peter were inclined to the
+latter conclusion, however, and their opinion was strengthened by the
+fact that "Charlie" Moluss, and his wife Bathsheba, and her sister
+"Suke" were never seen or heard from again.
+
+Several times the boys made their way into Indian John's cave by the
+brook, but they never discovered any signs of their friend. He had
+forever disappeared, but his stories concerning the origin of the Jersey
+mosquitoes, his interpretations of the roar of the ocean and the calls
+of the sea-birds, and above all the assistance he had rendered Little
+Peter in the trying days of '78 were never forgotten.
+
+Weeks had passed before Little Peter positively learned that Benzeor's
+statement concerning his father had been correct, but at last he
+received definite information that he was a prisoner in New York. What
+that meant to the troubled lad, few of us to-day can understand. The
+sufferings on board the prison-ships and in the prison-houses of New
+York almost baffle description; but we may be sure of one thing, and
+that is that Little Peter did not sit idly down, nor rest content to
+leave his father where he was without making some efforts in his behalf.
+But that, too, belongs to another record.
+
+Barzilla Giberson and Jacob Vannote after the death of Fenton did not
+find it necessary to play a double part. They believed that their
+efforts to run the pine robbers to cover had been successful, and that
+now they could boldly and openly take their stand on the side of the
+patriots. And take that stand they did, and their services in the New
+Jersey militia are known in all the region of Old Monmouth.
+
+Ted Wilson, with Jeshurun "waxen fatter" and consequently still more
+inclined to kick, returned to his home after the death of Fenton. He
+found Sallie and the babies safe at the Dennises, but all of the mighty
+Ted's former indifference as to his rulers had departed. The taste of
+the struggle he had had seemed only to whet his appetite for more, and
+not many days had passed before Ted and Jeshurun once more started forth
+in quest of service and adventure.
+
+Sarah Osburn labored faithfully and cheerfully for the welfare of her
+enlarged household, and the boys did not fail to appreciate her
+kindness. Tom thought he understood the motive which prompted much of
+her care for Little Peter's younger brothers and sisters, but throughout
+the long absence of Benzeor he never directly or indirectly referred to
+it.
+
+There was a brief lull in the outrages and attacks of the pine robbers
+after the death of Fenton, but it was very brief. Stephen Burke (or
+Stephen Emmons as he was sometimes called), Stephen West, Ezekiel
+Williams, Jonathan West, Richard Bird, Davenport, De Bow, and others
+were yet living, and as each was the leader of a band as desperate as
+himself, and as all were as reckless and brave as Fenton had been, in a
+brief time the suffering people of Old Monmouth found that their
+troubles were by no means ended.
+
+Redcoat and buffcoat were again to contend within their borders,
+salt-works and houses were to be burned, gunboats were to anchor off her
+shore and their crews were to engage in conflicts with the patriots;
+whigs and tories were not yet reconciled, the pine robbers were not yet
+subdued. Five long and terrible years of the struggle of the Revolution
+were yet to come, and the sands of Old Monmouth were again and again to
+be dyed by the blood of fallen men.
+
+The waves which came creeping, crawling up the long sandy shore, the
+tall pine-trees whose tops whispered together as they bent beneath the
+summer winds and winter storms, the fertile plains and noble forests of
+oak and chestnut, were unchanged; but the struggling men and women of
+Old Monmouth were yet to endure the bitter hardships and fierce
+contests, which the closing days of the Revolution brought to them in
+greater numbers than to almost any other people of our land.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Transcriber's Notes:
+
+Obvious punctuation errors repaired.
+
+Page 260, "Webberley" changed to "Webberly" (And Webberly had taught)
+
+Page 404, "did't" changed to "didn't" (didn't know anything)
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+***** This file should be named 34864-8.txt or 34864-8.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/3/4/8/6/34864/
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/34864-8.zip b/34864-8.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b46c04b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-8.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h.zip b/34864-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48670e2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/34864-h.htm b/34864-h/34864-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e82a267
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/34864-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,13825 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
+ <head>
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=iso-8859-1" />
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
+ <title>
+ The Project Gutenberg eBook of The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson.
+ </title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+
+ p {margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ text-indent: 1.25em;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+ }
+ img {border: 0;}
+ .tnote {border: dashed 1px; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; padding-bottom: .5em; padding-top: .5em;
+ padding-left: .5em; padding-right: .5em;}
+ ins {text-decoration:none; border-bottom: thin dotted gray;}
+ h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+ }
+ hr { margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ clear: both;
+ }
+
+ table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
+
+ body{margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ }
+
+ .pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute;
+ left: 92%;
+ font-size: smaller;
+ text-align: right;
+ } /* page numbers */
+ .copyright {text-align: center; font-size: 70%;}
+
+ .small {font-size: 70%;}
+ .big {font-size: 110%;}
+ .author {font-size: 120%; text-align: center;}
+ .center {text-align: center;}
+ .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+ .chaptertitle {text-align: center; font-size: 110%; font-weight: bold;}
+
+ .caption {font-weight: bold; font-size: 90%;}
+
+ .figcenter {margin: auto; text-align: center;}
+
+ .figleft {float: left; clear: left; margin-left: 0; margin-bottom: 1em; margin-top:
+ 1em; margin-right: 1em; padding: 0; text-align: center;}
+
+ .figright {float: right; clear: right; margin-left: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em;
+ margin-top: 1em; margin-right: 0; padding: 0; text-align: center;}
+
+ .unindent {margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+ }
+ .right {text-align: right;}
+ .poem {margin-left: 30%; text-align: left;}
+ .poem2 {margin-left: 15%; text-align: left;}
+ .footnotes {border: dashed 1px;}
+ .footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 0.9em;}
+ .fnanchor {vertical-align:baseline;
+ position: relative;
+ bottom: 0.33em;
+ font-size: .8em;
+ text-decoration: none;}
+ .hang1 {text-indent: -3em; margin-left: 3em;}
+
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+
+
+<pre>
+
+Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: The Boys of Old Monmouth
+ A Story of Washington's Campaign in New Jersey in 1778
+
+Author: Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+Release Date: January 6, 2011 [EBook #34864]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 316px;">
+<img src="images/coverpage.jpg" width="316" height="500" alt="Cover" title="" />
+</div>
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 309px;">
+<img src="images/illus002.jpg" width="309" height="500" alt="&quot;WHAT ABOUT THE BOY?&quot; (page 13)" title="" />
+<span class="caption">&quot;WHAT ABOUT THE BOY?&quot; (<a href="#Page_13">page 13</a>)</span>
+</div>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<h1>THE BOYS OF OLD<br />
+MONMOUTH</h1>
+
+<h2>A Story of Washington's Campaign
+in New Jersey in 1778</h2>
+
+<div class='center'>BY</div>
+<div class='author'>EVERETT T. TOMLINSON</div>
+
+<div class='center'><i>Author of "Washington's Young Aids," "Guarding the Border,"<br />
+"The Boys with Old Hickory," "Ward Hill<br />
+at Weston," etc., etc.</i><br /><br /><br /><br /></div>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 157px;">
+<img src="images/emblem.png" width="157" height="200" alt="The Riverside Press" title="" />
+</div>
+
+<div class='center'><br /><br /><br />BOSTON AND NEW YORK<br />
+HOUGHTON MIFFLIN COMPANY<br />
+The Riverside Press, Cambridge</div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<div class='copyright'>
+COPYRIGHT, 1898, BY EVERETT T. TOMLINSON<br />
+ALL RIGHTS RESERVED<br />
+</div>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>CONTENTS</h2>
+
+
+
+
+<div class='center'>
+<table border="0" cellpadding="0" cellspacing="0" summary="contents">
+<tr><td align='left' colspan='2'><span class='small'>CHAPTER</span></td><td align='right'><span class='small'>PAGE</span></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>I.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Old Monmouth</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>II.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Tom Investigates</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_15">15</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>III.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Meeting on the River</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_27">27</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>IV.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Benzeor's Visitor</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>V.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Messenger</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_53">53</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>VI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">In the Ten-Acre Lot</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_67">67</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>VII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Parting of the Ways</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_82">82</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>VIII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Indian John</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_96">96</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>IX.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Young Lieutenant</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>X.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Story of the Mischianza</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_126">126</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">To Refugee Town</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_141">141</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Bathsheba's Feast</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_156">156</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XIII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">With the Redcoats</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_169">169</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XIV.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Way to Cranberry</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_182">182</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XV.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Boat on the Bar</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_195">195</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XVI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Ted Wilson's Victim</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_208">208</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XVII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">A Fruitless Chase</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_221">221</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XVIII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">A Rare Beast</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_233">233</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XIX.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Release of Benzeor</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_246">246</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XX.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Fleet of Barges</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_259">259</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Ride with the Lieutenant</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_272">272</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">A Soldier Woman</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_286">286</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXIII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">An Interrupted Journey</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_298">298</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXIV.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Abode of Indian John</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_310">310</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXV.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Beginning of the Great Fight</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_323">323</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXVI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Battle of Monmouth</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_336">336</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXVII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Return to Benzeor's House</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_349">349</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXVIII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">The Ride to the Mill</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_364">364</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXIX.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">After the Battle</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_377">377</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXX.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Tom Coward's Patient</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_390">390</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXXI.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Among the Pines</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_403">403</a></td></tr>
+<tr><td align='right'>XXXII.&nbsp;</td><td align='left'><span class="smcap">Conclusion</span></td><td align='right'><a href="#Page_416">416</a></td></tr>
+</table></div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[1]</a></span></p>
+<h2>THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH</h2>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>CHAPTER I</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>OLD MONMOUTH</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Old</span> Monmouth is an expression dear to
+the heart of every native-born Jerseyman.
+The occasional visitor seeking health among
+its whispering pines, or relaxation in the sultry
+summer days along its shore, where the roll
+of the breakers and the boundless sweep of
+the ocean combine to form one of the most
+sublime marine views on all the Atlantic seaboard,
+may admire the fertile farmlands and
+prosperous villages as much as the man to the
+manor born, but he never speaks of "Old"
+Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>Nor will he fully understand what the purebred
+Jerseyman means when he uses the term,
+for to the stranger the word will smack of
+length of days, and of the venerable position
+which Monmouth holds among the counties
+of the State.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[2]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Monmouth is old, it is true, and was among
+the first of the portions of New Jersey to be
+settled by the Woapsiel Lennape, the name
+which the Indians first gave to the white
+people from across the sea, or by the Schwonnack,&mdash;"the
+salt people,"&mdash;as the Delawares
+afterwards called them. But the true
+Jerseyman is not thinking alone of the age
+of Monmouth when he uses the word "Old."
+To him it is a term of affection also, used it
+may be as schoolboys or college mates use it
+when they address one another as "old fellow,"
+though but a few years may have passed
+over their heads.</p>
+
+<p>The new-comer or the stranger may speak
+of Fair Monmouth, and think he is giving
+all the honor due to the beautiful region, but
+his failure to use the proper adjective will at
+once betray his foreign birth and his ignorance
+of the position which the county holds
+in the affections of all true Jerseymen.</p>
+
+<p>Still, Monmouth is old in the sense in
+which the summer visitor uses the word.
+Here and there in the county an antiquated
+house is standing to-day, which if it were
+endowed with the power of speech could tell
+of stirring sights it had seen more than a
+century ago. Redcoats, fleeing from the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[3]</a></span>
+wrath of the angry Washington and his Jersey
+Blues, marched swiftly past on their way
+to the Highlands and the refuge of New
+York. Fierce contests between neighbors,
+who had taken opposite sides in the struggle
+of the colonies for freedom from the yoke of
+the mother country, or step-mother country,
+as some not inappropriately termed her in
+these days, occurred in the presence of these
+ancient dwelling-places, and sometimes within
+their very walls. Many, too, would be the
+stories of the deeds of tories, and refugees,
+and pine robbers contending with stanch and
+sturdy whigs. Up the many winding streams,
+boat-loads of sailors made their way from the
+gunboat or privateer anchored off the shore,
+to burn the salt works of the hardy pioneers,
+or lay waste their lands as they searched for
+plunder or for forage.</p>
+
+<p>The forked trees along the shore, in whose
+branches the lookouts were concealed as they
+swept the ocean for miles watching for the
+appearance of the hostile boat, were standing
+until recent years. In their last days broken,
+it is true, and almost destroyed by the winter
+storms and their weight of long years, still
+they stood as the few remaining tokens of
+that century when our fathers contended for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[4]</a></span>
+"their lives, their fortunes, and their sacred
+honor." At last the pathos and weakness of
+old age prevailed, and to-day there remains
+scarcely a vestige of those ancient landmarks.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps if the boys and girls of New Jersey
+had been as mindful of those old trees as the
+Cambridge lads and lassies have been of the
+spreading elm beneath whose branches the
+noble-hearted Washington assumed the command
+of the little American army, some of
+them might still be standing; but as it is,
+the most of them have crumbled and fallen
+and disappeared as completely as have the
+men who sought the shelter of their branches
+in the trying times of '78.</p>
+
+<p>So, too, for many years stood the famous
+tree from whose limbs the noble patriot, Captain
+Huddy, was hanged,&mdash;as dastardly a
+deed as was committed by either side in that
+struggle which tried the souls of our fathers.
+But the trees are gone, and only a few quaint
+houses and venerable landmarks and heirlooms
+remain of those things which witnessed
+the contests, and deeds high or base, of that
+far-away time.</p>
+
+<p>The lofty monument on the old battle-ground
+of Monmouth is surmounted by the
+figure of a man whose face is shaded by his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[5]</a></span>
+hand, as if he were still striving to obtain a
+glimpse of the redcoats in the darkness as
+they hastened to gain the Highlands and the
+refuge of the waiting boats which were to
+bear them away to the safety of the great
+city. But it is itself essentially modern, and
+only in its brief records, carved by patriotic
+hands upon its sides, and in its figure of the
+granite soldier standing upon its summit, does
+its suggestiveness lie. It looks down upon a
+thriving village and out upon the lands of
+thrifty and prosperous farmers, and there is
+nothing in all the vision to remind one that
+the soil was ever stained by the blood of soldiers
+clad in uniforms of scarlet, or of buff
+and blue.</p>
+
+<p>And yet, as fierce a struggle as our country
+ever knew occurred within the region.
+Women toiled in the fields while their husbands
+and sons fought, or even gave up their
+lives to drive away their oppressors. Yes,
+even in the battles some of the women found
+places, and Captain Molly Pitcher was only
+one among many who had a share in the
+actual struggle of the Revolution. Houses
+were doubly barred at night against the attacks
+of prowling bands of refugees or pine
+robbers, and many times were defended by<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[6]</a></span>
+the patriotic women themselves. Spies crept
+in among them, and evil men who owned no
+allegiance to either side seized the opportunity
+to prey alike upon friend and foe. At times
+it almost seemed as if the words spoken many
+centuries ago were then fulfilled, and that "a
+man was set at variance against his father,
+and the daughter against her mother, and the
+daughter-in-law against her mother-in-law, and
+that a man's foes were they of his own household."</p>
+
+<p>But with all the suffering and bloodshed
+there were many heroes and heroines, and
+even the boys and girls were not without a
+share in the struggles of the times which
+tried men's souls. The houses in which they
+dwelt may have disappeared and given place
+to far more imposing structures; their very
+names may no longer be recalled; but, after
+all, they displayed many qualities which the
+world ought not willingly to permit to die,
+and the heritage which they have bequeathed
+to us will lose nothing of its value if we go
+back in our thoughts and strive to comprehend
+more clearly the price which our fathers
+paid for the land we love.</p>
+
+<p>In the early summer of 1778, while the
+feelings of the Monmouth people had been<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[7]</a></span>
+deeply stirred,&mdash;and indeed the patriots of
+the county had been among the foremost to
+pass resolutions and be enrolled among the
+defenders of the new nation,&mdash;there had not
+as yet come the intense excitement which
+followed the advance of General Clinton's
+army from Philadelphia. The long winter at
+Valley Forge had at last come to an end, and
+when the British moved out from the city,&mdash;for
+holding it longer seemed to be useless,&mdash;Washington
+had led his troops into the town
+almost as soon as the enemy departed. Nor
+was that all, for he quickly decided to follow
+after the departing general, and overtake and
+give him battle before Clinton could lead his
+men across the Jerseys.</p>
+
+<p>The American commander knew that his
+own forces numbered nearly as many as those
+the British general had; and as, in spite of
+the dreadful sufferings of the winter, his men
+were in far better condition than they had ever
+been before,&mdash;thanks to the tireless energy
+of Baron Steuben,&mdash;he resolved to depart
+from Philadelphia and follow after the British.</p>
+
+<p>Clinton had sent the recently enrolled tories
+to New York by water, and as there were
+some three thousand of these alone, he soon
+decided that his troops must go by land.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[8]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, the journey was begun, but
+the Continentals, going a little farther to the
+north than the line of Clinton's march, planned
+to gain a position in advance of the enemy by
+the rapidity of their movements, and then,
+turning about in their course, fall upon the
+redcoats face to face and offer them battle in
+some advantageous place.</p>
+
+<p>The baggage wagons of Clinton stretched
+out in a long line of twelve miles as they followed
+after the army, and in other ways the
+British leader was somewhat embarrassed.
+Consequently, when he learned of Washington's
+plan, he quickly decided to change
+the direction of his march, and, by passing
+through "Old Monmouth," lead his army to
+the Navesink Highlands and there have them
+all embark for New York.</p>
+
+<p>Washington had first offered the command
+of his advance forces to young Lafayette, but
+he was somewhat perplexed by the return of
+General Lee to his army, and knew not just
+what to do.</p>
+
+<p>Lee had been captured a little more than a
+year before this time, through his own carelessness,
+near Morristown, and we may be sure
+that Washington was not greatly troubled by
+the loss. Lee had steadily opposed him, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[9]</a></span>
+was plotting to secure his position for himself.
+However, the British general Prescott,
+whose capture by the Americans had been
+effected in a manner not unlike that in
+which Lee himself had been taken, had been
+exchanged, and Lee once more returned to
+the American army.</p>
+
+<p>He was still the same Lee, sensitive, jealous,
+and suspected of being in league with
+Howe, who recently had sailed away for England
+to explain to Parliament the causes of
+his failures in the preceding year.</p>
+
+<p>Much as he disliked to make the change,
+Lee's return compelled Washington to recognize
+his presence, and after some tactful efforts
+he removed Lafayette and gave Lee his position
+as leader of the advanced forces. Lee
+had bitterly opposed the project of following
+Clinton, and steadily objected to the march
+across the Jerseys.</p>
+
+<p>Washington, however, was firm in his determination,
+and the march was soon begun;
+but the lack of confidence which he felt in
+General Lee must have sadly increased the
+troubles of the great commander, already
+beset by perils of so many kinds. Whether
+he was mistaken in his estimate of the man,
+we shall learn in the course of this story.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[10]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Such then was the general condition of affairs
+as the summer of 1778 drew on. Those
+of the people of Old Monmouth who were at
+home heard occasional rumors of the advance
+of the two armies, but few of them had any
+thought of the stirring scenes which were to
+be enacted in their midst before the summer
+was ended.</p>
+
+<p>It was now late in June. The summer had
+been unusually warm, and the men and boys,
+as well as the women, who were at home had
+labored busily in the fields, in the hope of an
+early as well as an abundant harvest. For
+those who cared to avail themselves of them,
+the markets in New York provided a ready
+place for the sale of their produce, and not
+only the tories, but some of the men whose
+sympathies as yet had not led them openly to
+declare their preferences for either side, or
+who perhaps cared more for the prices they
+were likely to receive in New York for the
+results of their labors than they did for liberty
+or any such abstract quality, were not
+averse to loading up the boats, which many
+of the farmers near the shore owned, and
+sailing away for the city.</p>
+
+<p>Down the lower bay one such boat was
+swiftly making its way one afternoon in June,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[11]</a></span>
+1778. On board were four men, three of
+whom evidently were in middle life, but the
+fourth was a sturdy lad about seventeen years
+of age, and it was plain that he was not in
+full sympathy with his companions. He took
+but little part in the conversation, and the
+expression upon his face frequently betrayed
+the feelings in his heart. The three men
+with him apparently did not give him much
+thought or attention, and evidently were too
+well satisfied with the results of their expedition
+to waste any time in questioning the lad
+as to the cause of his silence.</p>
+
+<p>"There's the old tree now," said one of
+the men as they came within sight of the
+landmark. "If nothing has gone wrong,
+we'll soon be in the Navesink."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and back at work again," grumbled
+another. "For my part I think Fenton and
+Davenport and the rest of the pine robbers
+have the easiest time of all. They swoop
+down upon some whig farmer, and all they
+have to do is to take what he has worked
+out. I don't see why it isn't all fair enough
+in war."</p>
+
+<p>"If it wasn't for that skull of Fagan, with
+that pipe stuck in its mouth, nailed up on the
+tree over there beyond the Court House, I'd<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[12]</a></span>
+go in myself," said the first speaker. "The
+grin on it is almost more than I can bear."</p>
+
+<p>"That'll do to frighten women and children
+with," said the third man, who had been
+silent for a time. "Fagan got a little too
+bold, that was the trouble with him. He
+carried it a little too far. I happen to know
+that there are some men who know enough
+to put a finger in, and not get it burned
+either."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps you've done a little yourself in
+that line, Benzeor Osburn?" queried the last
+speaker. "I've thought sometimes you could
+tell some tales if you wanted to."</p>
+
+<p>"And who knows but I might?" replied
+Benzeor. "I may be able to keep my place
+from being confiscated and sold, the way my
+brother's was two years ago, but that may not
+mean either that I don't know what's to my
+own advantage when I see it. You'd do the
+same, wouldn't you, Jacob Vannote?"</p>
+
+<p>"That I would," replied Jacob, "and so
+would Barzilla Giberson here, too. All we
+want is that some good man like you, Benzeor,
+should tell us how to do it."</p>
+
+<p>"I can tell you," said Benzeor quietly.
+"I've made up my mind that I've held off
+just as long as I am going to. I'm going in,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[13]</a></span>
+and if you have a mind to join, I'll let you
+in, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Tell us about it," said Jacob eagerly.
+"What about the boy?" he added in a low
+voice, glancing toward the fourth member of
+the party as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"What? Tom Coward? He's a coward
+by name as well as by nature. You haven't
+anything to fear from him. He's been in my
+home since he was five year old. He won't
+make any trouble."</p>
+
+<p>Nevertheless, the speaker lowered his voice,
+and for a long time the trio conversed eagerly
+upon the new topic. So intent were they that
+not one of them noted the flush upon the
+lad's face at the brutal reference to him, nor
+saw the look of determination which came a
+little later in its place.</p>
+
+<p>Apparently Tom was not giving any attention
+to the men with him in the swift sailing
+boat. He retained his seat near the bow, and
+seemed to be interested only in the waves
+before him. A brisk wind was blowing, and
+the waters betrayed the tokens of a coming
+storm.</p>
+
+<p>The boat was pitching more and more as it
+sped on, and Tom watched the rolling waves,
+many of them capped with white and rising<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[14]</a></span>
+steadily higher and higher. The darker hues
+gave place to a lighter green as they rose, and
+the increasing roughness seemed to reflect
+somewhat the feelings in his own heart.</p>
+
+<p>Far away in the distance stretched the long
+sandy beach of the Hook, becoming more and
+more distinct as the boat drew nearer. The
+gulls were flying low, and the weird cries of
+the sea-birds were heard on every side.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly Tom stood upright, and, after
+gazing intently for a moment at some object
+on the shore, turned to his companions and
+said,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Some one's up in the tree, and the signal's
+out, too."</p>
+
+<p>The men instantly ceased from their conversation,
+and peered intently at the tree in the
+distance.</p>
+
+<p>Evidently the sight was not altogether
+pleasing, for with an exclamation of anger
+Benzeor Osburn, who was holding the tiller,
+quickly changed the course of the boat, and
+started back in the direction from which they
+had come.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[15]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER II</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>TOM INVESTIGATES</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">There</span> were many exclamations of impatience
+heard in the boat as Benzeor changed
+her course, and the helmsman himself appeared
+to be the most impatient of all. A
+drizzling rain was now falling and there were
+many signs apparent that a stormy night was
+approaching.</p>
+
+<p>"I wish I knew just what the warning was
+for," muttered Benzeor. "Fine night this,
+to be prowling around the bay in!"</p>
+
+<p>"There was no mistake about the sign,
+though," replied Jacob. "There's something
+wrong, or we shouldn't have seen the white
+flag. That means there's something going
+on up the Navesink."</p>
+
+<p>"All the more reason for going home
+then!" said Benzeor. "Who was on the
+lookout to-day? Does any one know?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, 't was Peter Van Mater," said Tom,
+who up to this time had taken no part in the
+conversation. "He told me yesterday that
+he was to be in the tree to-day."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[16]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"What! Little Peter?" demanded Benzeor
+quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," replied Tom. "I saw him out by
+their cornfield yesterday. He was there driving
+away the crows and blackbirds."</p>
+
+<p>"Little" Peter was so called to distinguish
+him from his father who bore the same name;
+and although his son, a well-grown young
+fellow of eighteen, towered more than a half
+head above "Big" Peter now, the distinctive
+names given several years before this time still
+clung to them both.</p>
+
+<p>The Van Mater place joined the Osburn
+farm, and for years Tom and Little Peter had
+been the best of friends. On those rare occasions
+when a brief break in the arduous labors
+on the farms had come, together they had
+gone crabbing, or had sailed down to Barnegat,
+where the sea-fowl gathered in great
+flocks when the proper seasons came.</p>
+
+<p>Tom's heart had gone out to Little Peter
+as it had not to any other person. Peter's
+round face shone with an expression of good
+nature which nothing but the mention of a
+tory or a pine robber seemed to be able to
+ruffle. A reference to either of them never
+failed to arouse the dormant anger of the
+lad, and with all the intensity of his quiet<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[17]</a></span>
+and strong nature he hated both. For the
+Van Maters, even to the mother and the
+girls, were patriots of the strongest kind, and
+now Big Peter was away in Washington's
+army and had left his eldest son and namesake
+to protect the family and manage the
+farm in his absence.</p>
+
+<p>And Little Peter had accepted the task with
+an outward assent that deceived even his own
+father. Only to Tom had he mentioned his
+true feelings, and expressed his determination
+to buy up his time, so that he, too, might be
+enrolled in the patriot army.</p>
+
+<p>Tom Coward well knew that the words
+expressed Little Peter's feelings and desires
+rather than his purpose, for he was satisfied
+that nothing would induce his friend to desert
+his mother and the children in their
+time of need. But he had fully sympathized
+with Peter in his desire to buy up his time,
+and there were special reasons why the words
+meant much more to him than they did to his
+friend.</p>
+
+<p>About a decade before this time, when one
+of the numerous "September gales" was
+raging along the Jersey shore, a great crowd
+had assembled on the beach watching the
+efforts of a schooner they could see, about<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[18]</a></span>
+a mile out on the ocean, to weather the storm.
+All day long the crowd had remained there,
+powerless to aid the stricken people on board
+the storm-tossed boat, for this was long before
+the time of the life-saving crews and
+their noble work along the coast.</p>
+
+<p>Late in the afternoon on that eventful day,
+when the storm had abated somewhat, although
+the waves, like moving mountains of
+water, still came thundering in upon the beach,
+a boat had been manned and started forth to
+the aid of the people in their peril; but before
+the brave band could gain the schooner, she
+had foundered and gone to the bottom.</p>
+
+<p>The men who had gone forth to the rescue
+had been about to return to the shore, when
+they thought they saw something floating
+over the boisterous waves toward them. When
+a second glance was obtained they started
+swiftly toward the object, and, as they drew
+near, saw a huge cotton bale with a woman
+and a little lad strapped upon it. At last,
+after some desperate efforts, the bodies were
+rescued, but that of the woman was lifeless
+and that of the lad was nearly so.</p>
+
+<p>The rough men had brought both ashore,
+and, after some labor on the part of the women
+in the assembly, the lad had been restored,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[19]</a></span>
+but the woman was beyond all earthly
+aid. Upon some of the clothing of the rescued
+boy the name Coward had been found,
+and "Tom" was improvised, for that would
+do as well as any other for the name of a
+stranger lad whose home and parents were to
+be, as the people of Old Monmouth thought,
+forever wrapped in mystery.</p>
+
+<p>Tom Coward had been the sole survivor of
+the wreck. For days some portions of the
+ill-fated schooner and its cargo were washed
+ashore, but no clue was ever found as to her
+name or destination.</p>
+
+<p>What to do with the rescued lad then
+became the perplexing problem among the
+simple folk of Monmouth, and it was at last
+solved by "binding him out" to Benzeor Osburn,
+which simply meant that Tom was to
+live with the man who had taken him until
+he was twenty-one years of age, and in return
+for the home he received he was to give his
+labor and life until that eventful day should
+arrive when he, too, would become a man.</p>
+
+<p>The lad had gone, for he had no voice in
+the matter, and all the home he had ever
+known had been with Benzeor and his family.
+Only a faint recollection of the wreck remained
+in his mind, but he had heard the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[20]</a></span>
+story many times and thought much over it
+in secret. Often had he visited the unmarked
+grave in the churchyard, where he was informed
+that all that was mortal of his mother
+lay resting. But her name and face were both
+alike unknown to him. In his dreams, or when
+he had been working alone in some of the distant
+fields, it would almost seem to him that
+something of another existence would rise
+before him, or that he could almost see the
+face of a gracious woman bending low over
+him whom he could call "mother."</p>
+
+<p>Who he might be he could not determine.
+Who he was, was a matter much more easily
+settled, for all knew him as the "bound
+boy" of Benzeor Osburn; and while some
+of the country people might occasionally think
+of him as the little lad, who years before had
+been rescued from a sinking schooner, they
+seldom referred to it, and the past had been
+crowded out by the present. But Tom Coward
+had not entirely forgotten.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor had received him into his home
+the more readily because, as he expressed it,
+"all of his boys had been born girls," and he
+felt the need of the aid and presence of a boy
+about the place. And Benzeor in his way had
+not been unkind to the stranger lad, or at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[21]</a></span>
+least not intentionally so, but the labor on the
+farms in those days had been severe, and he
+was a man to whom money had been the one
+thing needful. He did not spare himself, and
+certainly he had no thought of sparing those
+who were dependent upon him; and, as a
+natural consequence, neither the girls nor Tom,
+and much less the overworked, spiritless little
+mother of the family, found much to relieve
+the monotonous round of labor on the farm.</p>
+
+<p>At first, Tom had not complained and had
+accepted all as a matter of course, but of late
+his heart had rebelled against his lot more
+and more. It was not that he did not appreciate
+the rough kindness which was extended to
+him, especially by the patient, uncomplaining
+mother and the two girls, Sarah and Mercy,
+who were nearest his own age. But certain
+undefined longings kept rising in his soul, he
+knew not how, and the increasing eagerness
+of Benzeor "to make his place pay" had apparently
+driven all else from the mind of his
+foster father.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps more than any of these things,
+his interviews with his friend Little Peter
+had stirred his soul, for Peter had longings,
+too, and, as has been said, had even declared
+his intention "to buy up his own time." That<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[22]</a></span>
+he was a son in his own home, and was surrounded
+by the love of father and mother, had
+not made the purpose in Peter's heart appear
+in the least strange or unusual, for the custom
+was not unknown among those sturdy forefathers
+of ours. When they had cared for a
+boy in his infancy and helpless years, it was
+considered as no more than a just return that
+the years of early manhood, which would naturally
+be of value to the fathers in their labors
+on the farms, should belong not to the son
+but to the father. So whenever a well-grown
+boy felt that he would like to start in for
+himself, it was not unusual for him to offer,
+or to promise to pay as soon as he could earn
+the money, the amount which was considered
+as a fair equivalent for the value of his services
+in the few years before he became "of
+age," and could enter upon his own career.</p>
+
+<p>In those days the obligation of the child to
+his father was emphasized. In our own time
+the obligation of the father to his child is
+considered the more important, and all that
+love and devotion can offer are laid at the
+feet of the children.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps justice lies somewhere between
+these two extremes, and no one of us desires
+to return to the harsher methods of those<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[23]</a></span>
+earlier years; but certainly the children who
+are so fortunate as to be born in these more
+fortunate times have some need of recalling
+the words of one who, long before the trying
+days of the Revolution, exhorted all to "honor
+their fathers and mothers."</p>
+
+<p>Be that as it may, Tom Coward thought
+much and long over his friend Peter's project,
+and even went so far at one time as
+to hint to Benzeor that he would not be
+averse to entering into some such arrangement
+with him. But Benzeor's indignation,
+and the grief with which Sarah heard of the
+proposal, had silenced him, and he had not
+referred to the matter again.</p>
+
+<p>None the less, however, did it remain in
+his thoughts, and of late the suspicion with
+which he had come to regard many of Benzeor's
+actions had increased his feeling of discontent,
+for Tom's sympathies were all with
+the colonies in their struggle.</p>
+
+<p>Many a time had he and Peter talked over
+the matter, and the eagerness of one to serve
+in the army was fully shared by the other.
+But Benzeor's patriotism seemed all to be
+dormant, and as the troubles increased, his
+zeal to make money steadily increased also.
+At times he would be absent from home for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[24]</a></span>
+days together, and more than once Tom had
+been awakened in the night by the sound
+of strange voices heard in conversation with
+Benzeor in the room beneath that in which
+he was sleeping.</p>
+
+<p>Thoughts of all these things had been in
+Tom's mind throughout that voyage to New
+York, and they, as well as his youthfulness,
+served to explain the silence he had maintained
+since he had set sail. He had known,
+however, that Peter was to serve as the lookout
+that day, and when he volunteered the
+information it was the first time he had spoken
+aloud for a half hour.</p>
+
+<p>The rain now was steadily increasing, and
+the uneasiness of the men on board the little
+boat became more marked. They were far
+from the tree by this time, and no one appeared
+to know just what plan to follow.</p>
+
+<p>"If I was alone, I'd take all the risks,"
+said Benzeor at last.</p>
+
+<p>"You needn't stop on our account," replied
+Jacob. "I don't believe there's much
+danger in starting up the river, any way, for
+my part. Little Peter may not have seen
+anything to amount to much. If you want
+to chance it, go ahead."</p>
+
+<p>"We don't just know what's ahead of us,"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[25]</a></span>
+said Barzilla uneasily. "It may be nothing,
+and then again it may not be. I wish there
+was some way of finding out before we risk
+too much."</p>
+
+<p>"Why not land farther down the shore and
+let Tom go up and see?" said Jacob. "If
+Little Peter's gone, it will mean the danger's
+gone, too, and if he hasn't, why Tom here
+can find out for us and report; though for
+my part I'm not afraid to go up the river as
+it is. It's too dark for any one to see us, or
+it will be soon."</p>
+
+<p>"That's a good suggestion," said Benzeor
+quickly, as he brought the boat about.
+"We'll land down the shore and let Tom go
+up for us. You're not too much of a 'coward'
+to do that, are you Tom?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'll go," said Tom quietly, although his
+cheeks flushed with anger at Benzeor's antiquated
+and brutal pun. He had heard it
+many times, but never without feeling angry,
+although he well knew that Benzeor spoke the
+words lightly.</p>
+
+<p>With the change in the course the wind
+seemed to increase. The spray was dashed
+into their faces, and the men were soon
+drenched. The sail had been shortened, but
+the little boat dashed ahead with ever increasing
+speed.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[26]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"It's a rough night outside," said Benzeor,
+when at last he gained the desired point
+on the shore. "It's lucky for us we're inside
+the Hook. Now then, Tom!" he added.
+"Bestir yourself, lad, and come back soon."</p>
+
+<p>Tom leaped ashore and ran swiftly along
+the beach toward the tree. He was familiar
+with its location and knew that he could find
+it in the darkest night. The rain beat upon
+him and the darkness momentarily increased,
+but the wind was with him, and in a brief
+time he recognized the dim outlines of the
+tree.</p>
+
+<p>Then ceasing to run, he began to approach
+more cautiously. He was not positive that
+Peter was there now, for some one might
+have taken his place. Certainly caution was
+the better part in any event.</p>
+
+<p>He stopped and whistled the half dozen
+notes which he and Peter used as a call. He
+waited a moment, but as no answer was heard
+he advanced a little nearer and whistled
+again.</p>
+
+<p>"That you, Tom?" came from some one
+in the tree.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," replied Tom.</p>
+
+<p>In a moment Peter dropped from his position,
+and began to explain to his friend the
+cause of the display of the signal of danger.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[27]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER III</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE MEETING ON THE RIVER</div>
+
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">I've</span> been here since noon," began Peter,
+"but it seems more like a whole day to me.
+I've listened to the calls of the sea-birds and
+heard the roar of the storm which I knew
+was coming, till it almost seemed to me I
+couldn't bear it any longer. I'm glad you've
+come, for I've got a chance to stretch now,
+and the sound of a voice will help to quiet
+my nerves again."</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't know you had any nerves," replied
+Tom. "But we can't stand here in this
+storm talking about such things. Benzeor
+sent me over to find out what you meant by
+hanging out the white flag. You haven't
+seen anything suspicious, have you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I have that," said Peter eagerly. "I was
+beginning to think that my coming here was
+all a piece of foolishness, when along about
+four o'clock&mdash;leastwise I should think it was
+about that time, though I didn't have any
+dial anywhere about to mark the time for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[28]</a></span>
+me&mdash;what should I see but a whaleboat making
+for the river? You had better believe I
+forgot all about the time and everything else
+but the boat then, for I didn't know but
+some more of the Greens were coming up the
+Navesink on another trip such as they made
+the other day."</p>
+
+<p>Peter referred to an expedition which a
+band of several hundred tories from New Jersey,
+commonly known as the "Greens," had
+made a few weeks before this time. They
+had set forth from New York and had made
+a visit to some of their former neighbors and
+friends, and the tokens of their affection
+which they had left behind them had chiefly
+consisted of the ashes of burned homes and
+empty barns. The raid had been a cruel
+one, and its object apparently was more for
+devastation than for plunder, and many of
+the good people of Red Bank and Middletown
+and the adjoining towns had good cause
+to remember it so long as they lived. The
+numbers of the invaders had rendered them
+safe from all attacks, and the wanton destruction
+they wrought before they returned to
+New York had been the chief reason for keeping
+a watch stationed in the old tree every
+day since their visit. And Peter had received<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[29]</a></span>
+strict orders not to depart from his place of
+observation, if he saw anything suspicious,
+until he was satisfied that all danger was
+past. And Peter was faithful, that was well
+known, or he would not have been selected
+for the duty that day.</p>
+
+<p>"Well," resumed Peter, "I watched the
+boat till it went out of sight up the river.
+There were seven men on board of her, six
+of 'em pulling at the oars and the seventh
+steering. No more boats followed her, and
+I shouldn't have been suspicious if I hadn't
+thought I recognized the man who was steering."</p>
+
+<p>"Who was he?"</p>
+
+<p>"He looked to me a good deal like Fenton."</p>
+
+<p>"What? The pine robber?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, though of course I may have been
+mistaken. I never saw him but once and that
+was when he was a blacksmith over by the
+Court House before the war. My father had
+sent me over there to have one of the horses
+shod at his shop. I don't know that I should
+have remembered him if it hadn't been for
+something he did that day. I saw him take a
+half-inch bar of iron and bend it almost double
+with his hands. That made a great impression<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[30]</a></span>
+upon me, for I didn't believe there was another
+man in the colony who could do that."</p>
+
+<p>"Probably not," replied Tom. "But what
+made you think this was one of Fenton's
+whaleboats?"</p>
+
+<p>"Nothing but Fenton himself. Of course
+I've heard of the stories of what he's been
+doing since he became a pine robber. His
+gang is one of the worst, you know, and the
+minute I set my two eyes on him I suspected
+it was Fenton himself."</p>
+
+<p>"Why didn't you get word up the river as
+soon as you saw him?"</p>
+
+<p>"They've got watchers farther up, and
+that's their business. Besides, I didn't care
+to have him double me up the way he did that
+iron bar. Then, my business was to stay
+here and give the warning to anybody that
+might be going up the stream, you see.
+That's why I waved the flag when I saw you
+coming."</p>
+
+<p>"And they haven't come back yet?" inquired
+Tom eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>"No. That's what I'm waiting for. There
+isn't any fun in hanging out here in the wet,
+I can tell you. Just as soon as I can see that
+whaleboat coming out into the bay again
+I'm done."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[31]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"All right, Peter, I'll go right back and
+report to Benzeor. Maybe he'll take you on
+board and carry you home."</p>
+
+<p>"Not unless I see the whaleboat again,"
+said Peter doggedly as he prepared to climb
+to his seat in the tree again.</p>
+
+<p>Tom hurriedly departed and started to return
+with his message to the waiting Benzeor
+and his men, who he knew would be becoming
+impatient by this time. As he ran along
+the beach the storm smote him full in the
+face, but in spite of the driving rain the night
+was not very dark. The moon was near the
+full and gave sufficient light to enable him to
+see far out over the tossing waters. He could
+even discern the outlines of the little boat far
+up the shore, and as he ran swiftly forward
+he was thinking of the report he was to make
+to the waiting Benzeor, and his thoughts were
+not entirely pleasing.</p>
+
+<p>Fenton's deeds had become notorious in
+Old Monmouth. At the head of his brutal
+band, composed of men as desperate and
+reckless as he, he had pillaged and plundered
+throughout the county during the preceding
+year, and up to this time no one had been
+found strong enough to put a stop to his evil
+deeds. Any unprotected farmhouse was liable<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[32]</a></span>
+to receive one of his visits, and such a visit
+was seldom made without profit to the outlaws,
+for such in fact they were, and with
+their ill-gotten gains they hastened away to
+store them in their hiding-places among the
+pines.</p>
+
+<p>Nor was Fenton's band the only one which
+had its headquarters in that lonely and unfrequented
+region known in Old Monmouth as
+the "Pines." West, Disbrow, Fagan, Davenport,
+and many others of the lawless men,
+had engaged in similar occupations, and all
+had their hiding-places in the same wild spot,
+and in a measure protected and aided one
+another.</p>
+
+<p>Up to this time Fagan had been the only
+one to suffer the well-deserved penalty of his
+crimes, and in the preceding winter a band of
+two hundred of the desperate patriots had assembled
+and driven the famous, or rather infamous,
+outlaw to bay. At last he had been
+taken, and the infuriated men, mindful not
+only of the sufferings of their own families at
+his hands, but also of their possible future
+sufferings as well, had measured out a stern
+justice to the man, and with their own hands
+had hanged him from the long limb of a tree
+which stood by the side of the road which led<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[33]</a></span>
+from Monmouth Court House<a name="FNanchor_1_1" id="FNanchor_1_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a> to Trenton.
+Afterwards some of the patriots who had suffered
+most from his evil deeds had severed the
+skull from the body and nailed it to the tree,
+and then, placing the pipe between the grinning
+jaws, had left the uncanny sight as a
+warning to all who might be disposed to follow
+in the footsteps of the outlaw.</p>
+
+<p>For a few weeks the suffering patriots
+found relief, but only for a few weeks.</p>
+
+<p>Despite the terrible warning, the other
+bands of pine robbers soon renewed their labors,
+and now in the early summer of '78 the
+region was suffering more from the marauding
+bands than ever had been known before.</p>
+
+<p>It was all a part of the horrors of war.
+Sometimes, when we read of the brave deeds
+which have made famous some of the men
+who had a share in the struggle, we are prone
+to think only of the heroism displayed. And
+there was many a true hero in that and in
+every other war which our country has waged.
+We are never to forget that; but there was
+another side which has, to a large extent,
+passed from the memory of the present generation.
+The loss of property and of life,
+the sufferings of the women and children in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[34]</a></span>
+the lonely homes, the barbarity and cruelty
+of evil men who, freed from the restraint of
+law in a time when the worst passions of men
+were aroused, gave free rein to their avarice
+and all that was bad in them, have frequently
+been ignored or forgotten. The glory of war
+or the pride in true heroism cannot entirely
+atone for the sufferings that were only too
+common in the scattered homes or lonely
+places.</p>
+
+<p>And Fenton's band was one of the worst.
+From their strongholds among the pines, into
+which few men had the hardihood to enter,
+they would set forth on horseback some dark
+night, and the tale they might have told upon
+their return was ever one of blood and sorrow.
+People tortured until in their agony they were
+compelled to yield up their scanty savings,
+raids upon the flocks and herds already becoming
+far too small for the necessities of
+their owners, burning houses, and men and
+women deliberately shot by the outlaws, were
+only a few among the many results of their
+raids.</p>
+
+<p>Not the least of the evils was the knowledge
+that among the people of Monmouth
+there were some who, while they might not
+openly be known as members of the bands,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[35]</a></span>
+still gave the desired information to the leaders
+as to the places where possessions were
+secreted, or of the times when the patriots
+were aroused and it was best for the "Barons
+of the Pines," as some termed them, to remain
+in hiding among the tall dark trees. Professedly,
+the outlaws acknowledged no allegiance
+to either side in the struggle, but somehow
+it had come to pass that a stanch whig was
+liable to suffer far more from their depredations
+than his tory neighbor, and as a natural
+consequence the feeling between neighbors
+and those who had been friends was becoming
+more and more strained and bitter.</p>
+
+<p>Thoughts of these things were passing
+rapidly through Tom's mind as he ran swiftly
+on through the storm to rejoin his companions.
+Fenton? Yes, he had heard of him too
+many times not to recognize his name and to
+feel well assured that a visit from him in such
+a night could promise little good for any of
+the patriots dwelling near the Navesink.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what is it, Tom?" said Benzeor,
+as the panting lad rejoined them. "Is it
+Little Peter on the lookout? He must have
+seen a ghost to have warned us to stay out
+here in the bay in such a night as this. I'm
+wet to the skin."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[36]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"It's Fenton," replied Tom huskily, for he
+had not yet recovered his breath. "Peter
+said he saw him and six of his men go up
+the Navesink about four o'clock."</p>
+
+<p>"Fenton?" said Jacob quickly. "Then
+we're in for a night of it. We don't want
+to fall into the hands of that pine robber
+when our pockets are as well lined as they
+are to-night."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not so sure about that," replied Benzeor
+slowly. "There's ten chances to one
+that they won't come back before morning,
+and if they do they won't be likely to find us
+in such a storm as this."</p>
+
+<p>As he spoke a fresh gust swept the rain
+directly into their faces. The storm certainly
+was increasing, and the prospect of spending
+a night in the bay was dreary enough to
+cause the most stout-hearted to hesitate. And
+it may have been that other thoughts than
+that of the storm influenced Benzeor.</p>
+
+<p>At any rate he gruffly responded, "You
+can do as you please, but I'm going up the
+Navesink. If you're afraid, you can stay
+here or start out across the country on foot.
+You'll have to speak quick if you go with
+me, for I'm off."</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor turned and grasped the bow of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[37]</a></span>
+his boat to push her off the beach upon which
+she had grounded. Before he had succeeded,
+however, Jacob spoke up quickly and said,
+"We're with you, Benzeor. If you can stand
+it, we can."</p>
+
+<p>"Get aboard then, every one of you!"
+said Benzeor gruffly.</p>
+
+<p>Tom and Barzilla quickly took their places
+in the stern, while Benzeor, with the aid of
+Jacob, soon sent the boat out from the shore.</p>
+
+<p>The sail was soon rigged and shortened,
+and the little party then started for the narrow
+mouth of the Navesink. The boat rolled
+and pitched in the storm, but Benzeor had
+her well in hand, and soon steered into the
+more quiet waters of the river. Tom could
+see the tree as they passed, and was positive
+that Peter could also see them, but no hail
+was given, and the point was soon left far
+behind them.</p>
+
+<p>Then up the narrower waters of the river
+the boat sped on in her course, but not a
+word was spoken by any of those on board.
+The storm was still raging and Benzeor's
+attention was largely occupied in managing
+his craft, and the others were busied with
+thoughts which perhaps they did not care to
+express.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[38]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Tom was decidedly anxious. A meeting
+with Fenton and his band was something of
+which he was fearful, and as they sped on his
+fears increased each moment. Benzeor's apparent
+indifference had not deceived him, and
+deep in his heart there was a lurking suspicion
+that perhaps he might be able to account for
+it, if he felt so disposed.</p>
+
+<p>However, he too was silent, and a half hour
+had passed and as yet no signs of danger had
+appeared. Benzeor was steering as close inshore
+as the wind permitted, and Tom was
+beginning to hope that they would succeed
+in making their way up the river without
+being discovered.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly Jacob, who was seated in the bow
+and was keeping a constant lookout ahead,
+shouted, "Port! Port your helm, Benzeor!
+Quick! Quick!"</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor instantly heeded the warning, but
+his quick movement barely served to enable
+them to pass a boat which loomed up in the
+darkness. It was a whaleboat, and with a
+sinking heart Tom saw that there were six
+men rowing, while a seventh was seated in the
+stern and was serving as helmsman.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly Peter's words flashed into his
+mind, and he knew that they had barely<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[39]</a></span>
+escaped a collision with the very boat which
+the lookout had discovered making its way
+up the Navesink late in the afternoon. The
+party could be none other than that of Fenton
+and his outlaw band.</p>
+
+<div class="footnotes"><h3>FOOTNOTE:</h3>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_1_1" id="Footnote_1_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_1_1"><span class="label">[1]</span></a> Freehold.</p></div>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[40]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER IV</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>BENZEOR'S VISITOR</div>
+
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">Hold</span> on there! Hold on, I say! Stop,
+or we'll shoot!"</p>
+
+<p>The words were shouted by some one in
+the whaleboat, and Benzeor evidently was
+about to heed the sharp command. He
+quickly changed the course of the boat, and
+as the shortened sail flapped in the wind as
+the little craft came about, the whaleboat
+came alongside and some one reached forth
+with a boat-hook, and the progress was instantly
+stayed.</p>
+
+<p>Tom's heart was beating rapidly in his excitement.
+A wild impulse to leap into the
+river seized him, but before he could leave
+his position in the bow, two of the other
+crew clambered on board, and he knew that
+an attempt to escape would now be useless.
+Doubtless the men were armed, and the darkness
+was not deep enough to conceal him
+from their sight. His only hope now depended
+upon the actions of the men and the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[41]</a></span>
+course which Benzeor should decide to follow.</p>
+
+<p>The sail was instantly lowered in obedience
+to the sharp command of the men who had
+boarded the boat, and, in great fear, the lad
+waited for the purpose of their captors to be
+declared. He drew back in his position in
+the bow, hoping to escape the notice of all
+on board, as he saw that Benzeor had arisen
+from his seat and stood facing the men.</p>
+
+<p>"Who are you? What ye out in a night
+like this for? Whose boat is this?" exclaimed
+the one who appeared to be the
+leader.</p>
+
+<p>"Is that you, Fenton?" replied Benzeor
+in a low voice.</p>
+
+<p>"Ho, it's Benzeor Osburn!" exclaimed
+the man, peering intently into the face before
+him as he spoke. "I thought it was strange
+we didn't find you in your house. We waited
+an hour as we agreed to, but when you didn't
+put in an appearance, we thought we'd start
+back. Where ye been, Benzeor? What's
+up now?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'd been back home in time if it hadn't
+been for the storm and an alarm we had back
+in the bay. I think ye'd better go back
+with me now, Fenton. I've got some facts<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[42]</a></span>
+that may interest you, and we can't talk them
+over here."</p>
+
+<p>"Who are these men with you?" inquired
+Fenton suspiciously.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, they're all right. I'll vouch for
+them, every one," replied Benzeor. "You
+haven't anything to fear from any of my
+friends. Come up to my house and I'll tell
+ye all about it."</p>
+
+<p>Fenton hesitated a moment before he replied,
+and Tom peered intently at the man of
+whom he had already heard so many tales.
+He could see his great form, although he
+could not distinguish the features of his face
+in the darkness. His deep voice and gruff
+manner had not tended to allay the lad's fears,
+and now Benzeor's words and actions filled
+his heart with a new alarm. Was Benzeor
+about to cast in his lot with Fenton? His
+words betrayed the fact of their previous
+acquaintance, and all the recent suspicious
+actions of his foster father came back to him.
+No one in the party had yet spoken, except
+Benzeor and Fenton, but the recent conversation
+on board the boat, much of which Tom
+had overheard, convinced the troubled lad
+that no very strong protest would be made
+against any proposal that Benzeor might feel
+disposed to make.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[43]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I'm rather of the opinion," said Fenton
+roughly, "that it's about time you went
+home with me. I don't know who these
+fellows on board here are, and I don't care.
+You're the one I'm after, Benzeor, and it
+seems to me the time's come for you to join
+us or quit. You've been shilly-shallying
+long enough."</p>
+
+<p>"Hush! Don't speak so loud!" replied
+Benzeor anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>Fenton laughed outright at Benzeor's evident
+alarm, and, turning to his companions
+in the whaleboat, said, "I think we'd better
+take the boat along with us. We can land
+this crew anywhere along the shore, or we
+can sink 'em in the river, just which you
+please. It's too much of a storm for us to
+be hanging around here on the Navesink."</p>
+
+<p>"Fenton," said Benzeor, rising and stepping
+up to the side of the outlaw, "you'd
+better do as I say. I've got something to
+tell ye, and it's worth hearing, too."</p>
+
+<p>A low conversation followed between the
+two men which Tom, with all his efforts, was
+not able to hear. The result of it, however,
+quickly became apparent when Fenton turned
+to his companions and said, "It's all right,
+boys. You go on without me, and I'll join<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[44]</a></span>
+you to-morrow. I'm going up to Benzeor's
+now."</p>
+
+<p>The boat-hook was quickly withdrawn at
+his command, and the sound of the oars of
+the departing boat soon ceased to be heard.</p>
+
+<p>The sail of Benzeor's boat was then hoisted
+again, and once more the little party, increased
+now by the addition of Fenton, began
+to make their way up the Navesink. Though
+the rain was steadily falling, the wind was
+favoring, and the boat, handled by the skillful
+Benzeor, held steadily to its way. The low
+shores could be seen in the distance on either
+side, and an occasional light betrayed the
+location of some lonely farmhouse, whose
+occupants in the confidence begotten of the
+storm had ventured to sit up till a later hour
+than was customary in those days.</p>
+
+<p>Not a word was spoken on board the boat,
+and Fenton had taken a position near Tom
+from which he did not move. All were
+drenched, but a summer rain was something
+which none of them minded in such a time
+as that.</p>
+
+<p>When an hour had passed, Benzeor ran
+his boat closer inshore and in a few moments
+landed. Then turning to his companions he
+said, "Come over to my house to-morrow,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[45]</a></span>
+Jacob, and I'll give you and Barzilla your
+shares of the money."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll go with you now," replied Jacob,
+evidently not desiring to put off the day of
+reckoning too long, a desire in which Barzilla
+also shared.</p>
+
+<p>"No, I can't fix it up to-night. You can
+take the bag, though, if you want to, and
+bring me my share to-morrow."</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor's confidence in his fellows served
+the desired purpose, and Jacob and Barzilla
+speedily departed, taking with them the little
+bag of gold which had been received as the
+price of the produce they had taken to New
+York.</p>
+
+<p>"Tom, you look out for the boat," called
+Benzeor, as he and Fenton started towards
+the little house whose outlines could be discerned
+in the distance.</p>
+
+<p>Tom obeyed, and as he worked over the
+little boat, looking well to all the details, his
+thoughts were far more busy than his hands.
+The changes which he had noted in Benzeor
+of late seemed almost to have reached their
+climax. Was the man intending now to go
+with Fenton? All his recent absences from
+home came up before the lad's mind, and the
+strange visitors he had received there of late<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[46]</a></span>
+were not forgotten. What was it Benzeor
+was planning to do? He was not much like
+the man he had been a few years before
+this time, and as Tom thought over all the
+changes, he was troubled more and more.</p>
+
+<p>He knew that Sarah had not been unaware
+of what was going on, for many a time had
+they talked it all over together. Sarah had
+remained a steadfast champion of her father,
+but Tom had not failed to see that she was
+none the less troubled by his strange actions.
+His grasping disposition had become more
+and more apparent of late, and while he had
+never in the presence of his family referred
+to anything he had in his mind to do against
+the patriots, his very silence in such times
+was more threatening than any words he could
+utter. But Sarah had steadily refused to
+believe that her father would desert the cause
+for which at the outbreak of the war he had
+professed the most ardent attachment; still,
+it was impossible for her not to discover, what
+Tom for a long time had seen, that he was
+strangely silent of late.</p>
+
+<p>The change in Benzeor Osburn had been
+so gradual as to deceive many of his friends
+and neighbors. All had known his "closeness,"
+as the country people termed his love<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[47]</a></span>
+of money, but few of them had thought it
+would ever lead him into the position in
+which the man at that time really stood.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor in '76 had been among the loudest
+in his expressions of loyalty to the cause
+of the colonies, and had been foremost in
+blaming his own brother for his "toryism."
+His brother's property had been confiscated,
+but Benzeor's had been left unmolested, so
+confident had all the whigs been in the sincerity
+of his expressions. And at the time
+Benzeor had meant what he said, and said
+what he meant. But never for a moment
+had he dreamed that the struggle would be
+such a long-continued one as it had proved
+to be, nor had he thought that patriotism
+would affect his own possessions. All that
+would be done would be to make a strong
+protest against the unjust taxation, for Benzeor
+had hated taxes as he did few things in
+this world, and then a compromise would be
+effected, which would permit the colonists to
+go on with their occupations, and the mother
+country would soon see that it was not to her
+own advantage to drive her rebellious children
+too far.</p>
+
+<p>The first shock had come to him when the
+Continental Congress had declared the country<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[48]</a></span>
+to be a free and independent nation.
+That was going too far, Benzeor thought,
+and so he freely expressed himself; but still
+hoping that a compromise of some kind would
+be made, and that his own possessions would
+not be disturbed, he had uttered no further
+protests, though his voice ceased to be heard
+in favor of the rebellion.</p>
+
+<p>As further events betrayed the weakness of
+the patriot cause, and he had found that
+patriotism was likely to prove a somewhat
+expensive virtue, his feelings had undergone
+a still more decided change. At first
+he had entered into one or two secret projects
+by which he had succeeded in enriching
+his own pockets, and the success had so affected
+him that as his patriotism decreased
+his hopes of gains correspondingly increased;
+and soon from deeds for which he tried to
+justify himself, he had been gradually drawn
+into others which even his own seared conscience
+proclaimed to be wrong. In some of
+the latter he had come into contact with the
+outlaws of Fenton's class, and his association
+with them had soon banished the feeling of
+disgust he had formerly cherished for them,
+until it had even come to pass that Fenton
+himself was a not unwelcome guest in his
+own home.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[49]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>At first the visits had been made secretly,
+and the promises of rich harvests to be reaped,
+as the result of their evil deeds, had appealed
+to Benzeor more strongly than even he himself
+was aware. The lawless times, the constant
+turmoils, the bitterness between those
+who had recently been the warmest of friends,
+the ease with which raids were made, and the
+apparent impossibility of detection, had all
+combined to arouse the avaricious Benzeor
+more and more; and now not very much was
+needed to draw him still farther within the
+toils of Fenton and his band.</p>
+
+<p>Not all of these things were apparent to
+Tom when at last he left the boat and started
+towards the house, but he had seen sufficient
+to make him suspicious of Benzeor, and he
+was as perplexed as he was troubled. All
+his own feelings had gone out more and more
+to the patriot cause, and more than once had
+he been sadly tempted to depart from his
+home without waiting for the formality of
+buying up his time, and he had even gone so
+far as to suggest to Sarah several times what
+he had it in his mind to do. Sarah's grief,
+however, and the confidence which she still
+professed to feel in her father, as well as the
+dislike in his own heart to do anything which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[50]</a></span>
+bore any resemblance to stealing,&mdash;for so the
+troubled lad regarded the taking of time
+which did not really belong to him as the
+bound boy of Benzeor Osburn,&mdash;had hitherto
+held him back. How long such feelings
+would continue to sway him Tom could not
+decide when at last he lifted the latch and
+entered the kitchen.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor and his guest were seated before
+the fire which had been started in the wide
+and open fireplace, and were drying their wet
+clothing as they conversed eagerly together.</p>
+
+<p>As Tom came in, Benzeor glanced up
+hastily and said, "You can go to bed, Tom.
+You must be wet and tired, and there is a lot
+of work to be done to-morrow." Benzeor's
+voice was not unkind, but Tom did not fail
+to see that his presence was not desired. He
+quickly lighted a candle with a splinter which
+he thrust into the fire and held until it was
+in a flame, and then went up the low stairway
+to his room directly over the kitchen in which
+the men were seated.</p>
+
+<p>As he entered the room he noted the
+gleam which came through the open space
+near the rude chimney, and, placing the candle
+on the low table, he advanced and peered
+down at the men. He could see both plainly,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[51]</a></span>
+and, after observing them for a moment, he
+was about to turn away and take off his dripping
+clothing, when he suddenly stopped.
+He had overheard a word which caused his
+heart to beat much more rapidly, and in a
+moment he was upon his knees striving to
+hear what more would be said.</p>
+
+<p>He remained in the same position for an
+hour, and at last arose only when Fenton
+opened the door and went out into the darkness.
+Then Benzeor closed and barred the
+door, and started directly up the stairway.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly Tom blew out his candle and
+leaped into bed, all wet and muddy as he was,
+and drew the bedclothes close up around his
+face.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor came slowly on and then stopped
+before the door of Tom's room. The lad
+was trembling in his excitement, for he well
+knew that if the man should enter and discover
+that he had not removed his clothing
+before going to bed, his suspicions would
+at once be aroused. And above all things
+Benzeor's suspicion at that time was what
+Tom most desired to lull.</p>
+
+<p>There were wild thoughts in Tom's mind of
+leaping from the bed and, rushing past the
+man, making a break for the outside. Perhaps<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[52]</a></span>
+the man might not enter, however, and,
+trembling with fear and excitement, Tom
+waited.</p>
+
+<p>It seemed to him that a long time had
+elapsed, and still no sound outside the door
+could be heard. Had Benzeor gone on? The
+light of his candle which still shone through
+the cracks disproved that. What could he
+then be doing?</p>
+
+<p>Tom tried to conjecture what must be
+going on on the stairway, but the silence was
+still unbroken. The minutes were like hours
+to the frightened lad. It seemed to him as
+if the beatings of his heart must be heard
+throughout the house.</p>
+
+<p>His suspense was soon ended&mdash;when Benzeor
+lifted the latch and Tom felt the light
+of the candle streaming in full upon his face.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[53]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER V</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE MESSENGER</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">For</span> a moment Tom closed his eyes and
+waited for the words which he expected and
+feared to hear. His body was trembling and
+all his strength was required to prevent his
+teeth from chattering. If Benzeor should
+enter the room Tom knew that at once his
+predicament would be discovered, and in the
+present state of his foster father's feelings he
+was aware that he could expect no mercy at
+his hands.</p>
+
+<p>He heard no footstep, but he felt that the
+light of the candle was still shining upon his
+face and knew that Benzeor had not departed.
+At last, unable to bear the suspense longer, he
+opened his eyes, for he felt that he must see
+what was going on in the room. There stood
+Benzeor in the doorway holding the candle
+with one hand, and intently regarding the
+apparently sleeping boy before him.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll be down directly," said Tom drowsily,
+as if he were just awaking. "I didn't know<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[54]</a></span>
+it was time to get up. I'll be with you in a
+minute."</p>
+
+<p>"It isn't time to get up," replied Benzeor
+slowly. "I'm just going to bed. I stopped
+to see if you were all right. Have you been
+asleep long?"</p>
+
+<p>"I&mdash;I don't know. Is there anything
+wrong?" Tom still kept the bedclothes drawn
+tightly about his face, and although he was
+feigning that he had been sleeping, he was in
+a state of terror. If Benzeor should approach
+the bed he well knew what would follow.</p>
+
+<p>"No, there's nothing wrong," replied Benzeor.
+"I just wanted to see if you were all
+right. It's been a hard trip, and there's
+much work to be done to-morrow."</p>
+
+<p>Tom closed his eyes and did not continue
+the conversation, hoping that the man would
+feel satisfied and leave him to himself. Nor
+was he disappointed, for Benzeor soon withdrew
+and closed the door behind him.</p>
+
+<p>Tom could hear him as he stumbled about
+in the adjoining room, preparing for bed.
+Frightened as the lad had been, he had not
+failed to notice the expression upon Benzeor's
+face. It seemed to him that fear and recklessness
+were combined there, and that in the
+recent decision which the man had made, he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[55]</a></span>
+had bidden farewell to everything good in
+his nature.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor had not been without his good
+qualities. Even then, in spite of his alarm,
+Tom recalled his rough kindnesses, and
+thought how much better in many ways his
+foster father had treated him than had some
+of the true fathers treated their own sons, for
+the times were rough and the one thing which
+was demanded of all the growing boys was
+implicit obedience to their elders. And this
+obedience had been ofttimes compelled by no
+gentle means. The use of the strap upon
+boys who were as large as their fathers was
+not unknown, and no one ever thought of
+resenting the harsh treatment. But Benzeor
+had seldom struck him. Tom almost wished
+that he had, for it would make the carrying
+out of the project he had already formed
+much easier.</p>
+
+<p>Then, too, all the kindness he had received
+at the hands of Benzeor's wife and
+of the girls came back to him. It was true
+that this had been largely of a negative character,
+but in times like these through which
+the troubled lad was then passing, even that
+was not forgotten. He had toiled early and
+late, and knew that he had given more than<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[56]</a></span>
+a full equivalent for the scanty food and
+rough clothing he had received. But after
+all, Benzeor's home had been all the home he
+had ever known, and he was not unmindful
+of the benefits he had received.</p>
+
+<p>His soul now, however, was in a state of
+turmoil. The words he had overheard had
+proved conclusively that Benzeor was a
+changed man, and as Tom thought of the
+project which Fenton had presented, and into
+which his foster father had entered with apparent
+eagerness, his own indignation increased.
+The long waiting was past now,
+and the time for action, the time of which he
+had dreamed and thought so much of late,
+had come at last.</p>
+
+<p>He removed the bed-clothing and sat up
+on the side of the bed, listening intently.
+Benzeor had ceased to move about in his
+room, and the sounds which now came indicated
+clearly that he was asleep. Against
+the little window the rain was still beating,
+and the darkness was so intense in the room
+that Tom could not distinguish any object.</p>
+
+<p>For several minutes he continued in his
+position, undecided whether he had better
+make the attempt to depart from the house
+by the way of the stairs, or through the window<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[57]</a></span>
+in his room. If he should select the
+former, the stairs would be sure to creak
+under his feet; and then, too, there would be
+the bars which must be drawn from the door.
+There were too many possibilities of detection
+to make that method of departure the
+desirable one.</p>
+
+<p>If he should go through the window, all
+he would have to do would be to drop upon
+the woodpile directly beneath,&mdash;a pile which
+Tom knew was there, for he himself had
+drawn and cut the wood only a few days before
+this time. He decided to use the window.</p>
+
+<p>Stepping slowly and carefully, he approached
+and quietly raised the sash. As he
+looked out into the night, the farm buildings
+could be seen, and yonder was the road he
+was to seek.</p>
+
+<p>Hesitating no longer, the resolute boy
+crawled through the open window, and then,
+clinging for a moment to the sash with his
+hands, dropped upon the woodpile below.
+There was a noise as the wood rolled from
+under him, but, quickly rising, he ran to the
+long lane which led out to the road, and
+then stopped to learn whether his departure
+had been discovered or not.</p>
+
+<p>The silence was unbroken. The outlines<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[58]</a></span>
+of the rude little house stood out in the darkness,
+the rain was falling steadily, and the
+heavy clouds hung low over the earth. Not
+even the dog had been disturbed, and with a
+lighter heart Tom turned and ran down the
+lane and was soon in the road.</p>
+
+<p>The mud was now thick and heavy, and
+he found his progress difficult. But as he
+had not far to go, he ran steadily on, and
+soon came within sight of Little Peter's house.
+There was no light to be seen within it, and
+he was not at all certain that his friend had
+returned.</p>
+
+<p>He approached and stood beneath the window
+of the boy's room, which, like his own,
+was over the kitchen. Then he gave the low
+whistle which they both had used as a "call."
+At first there was no response, and when he
+had given it two or three times he concluded
+that his friend had not returned from his
+work as the lookout in the tree by the mouth
+of the Navesink. Nothing then remained to
+be done but to rouse the family, for Tom was
+determined, and was well aware that what he
+planned to do must be done quickly.</p>
+
+<p>Approaching the kitchen door he rapped
+loudly upon it. Twice had he repeated the
+summons before a window was raised, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[59]</a></span>
+some one looking out upon him called,
+"Who's there? Is that you, Peter?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, it's not Peter. It's Tom Coward,
+and I want to get in. I've got something to
+tell you."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll be down in a moment," said Peter's
+mother, for Tom had recognized the voice as
+her's.</p>
+
+<p>Tom soon heard the heavy bars withdrawn,
+and in a brief time the door was opened,
+and then closed and carefully barred behind
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"What's wrong, Tom?" inquired the
+woman anxiously. "Has anything happened
+to Peter?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think so," replied Tom. "He
+was all right when I left him a few hours
+ago down by the Hook. But what I want to
+know now is whether you've had any word
+from his father?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not a word, except that it's reported the
+army's on the march again. Why do you
+ask?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know that I ought to tell you,"
+replied Tom hesitatingly, "but the truth of
+the matter is that I happened to hear that he
+was coming home."</p>
+
+<p>"You've heard something more than that,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[60]</a></span>
+Tom Coward," said the woman now thoroughly
+alarmed. "I know you've heard
+more, or you wouldn't have come over here
+at this time of night and in such a storm.
+What is it? What is it?"</p>
+
+<p>Tom perceived that he had gone too far to
+retreat now, and so he began his story. He
+did not go into all the details, for as yet he
+did not desire to implicate Benzeor, at least
+in the eyes of all his neighbors.</p>
+
+<p>"The way of it is this," began Tom hesitatingly.
+"I happened to be to-night where
+I overheard the talk between two men, and
+one of 'em was Fenton, the pine robber."</p>
+
+<p>Tom could perceive the expression of alarm
+which swept over the face of the woman, who
+was still standing before him. Apparently
+ignoring it, however, he went on. "It seems
+that both of the armies are on the march
+across Jersey, and that Washington has halted
+over by Hopewell. Somehow, Fenton had
+got word that your husband was coming
+home for a day, and he's fixed up a plan to
+trap and take him."</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't heard a word," said the woman
+slowly. "When was he coming?"</p>
+
+<p>"To-morrow."</p>
+
+<p>"And Fenton knows of it?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[61]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes. And he knows something more,
+too, or at least he pretends to. I heard him
+say that you had some money hidden in an
+old sock, which you'd stored away in the
+garret."</p>
+
+<p>Tom saw the woman start at his words,
+and knew then that Fenton's statement had
+been correct, although he could not conjecture
+how the pine robber had received his
+information. Little Peter's mother was a
+resolute woman, but even the stoutest heart
+might well be alarmed to hear that Fenton
+was aware of such possessions.</p>
+
+<p>"Have you any idea when Little Peter
+will come home?"</p>
+
+<p>"No. It's too bad to keep him out in
+such a night. And we need him here now."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll wait till he comes," said Tom quietly.
+"There's no danger to-night, but I want to
+see him, and I don't think you'll object to
+my staying, will you?"</p>
+
+<p>"No," said the woman eagerly. "Oh,
+what times these are! My husband has been
+in the army more than a year, and the end
+hasn't come yet. What will become of us?
+What shall we do? Tom," she added suddenly,
+"what was Fenton going to do with
+him if he caught him?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[62]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Take him and send him to New York.
+You know there's a reward for every prisoner
+taken. But he hasn't got him yet."</p>
+
+<p>"No, that's so; and what's more he won't
+either, if it can be prevented. Have you told
+Benzeor about it? Hark! There's some
+one at the door now!"</p>
+
+<p>The woman was not mistaken, for a low
+tapping on the kitchen door could be distinctly
+heard. For a moment neither spoke,
+but they could not conceal their fears from
+each other. Just then a stronger gust of
+wind drove the rain with added force against
+the windows. The sound of the storm seemed
+to increase the fear of those within the house.
+Perhaps Fenton himself had even then come;
+or, as was more probable, Tom thought, his
+own departure had been discovered, and Benzeor
+had come for him. As between the two,
+Tom decidedly preferred to meet Fenton at
+that time.</p>
+
+<p>Again the low rapping was heard, and
+Tom knew that some response must be made.
+"I'll open the door. Maybe it's Little
+Peter come back," he whispered.</p>
+
+<p>"No, it isn't Peter. He wouldn't come
+in that way."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll find out who it is," replied Tom<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[63]</a></span>
+more resolutely, although his heart was oppressed
+by a great fear. His hands were
+trembling, and he almost expected that the
+moment he drew back the bars a rush against
+the door would be made.</p>
+
+<p>"You stand ready to push against the
+door," he said as he grasped the bar. Slowly
+he drew it back, and standing away from the
+slight opening called out, "Who's there?"</p>
+
+<p>No reply was heard, and the wind which
+swept through the open space quickly extinguished
+the candle, leaving them both in
+total darkness. For a moment Tom thought
+they were being attacked, and he instantly
+slammed the door back, and shot the bar into
+its place.</p>
+
+<p>The rapping upon the door was quickly
+repeated, and the voice of some one outside
+could be heard. "Don't light the candle
+again," whispered Tom. "It'll let them see
+what's inside here. Who's out there?"
+he called in louder tones. "Who's there?
+You'll have to tell who you are, or we shan't
+let you in. Who is it?"</p>
+
+<p>Another rap was the only reply, and Tom
+was almost decided not to heed the summons
+longer, but to leave the callers, whoever they
+might be, out there in the storm.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[64]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I'll go upstairs and look out of the window,"
+whispered Peter's mother; and, creeping
+softly out of the room, she soon made
+her way up the stairway to the room overhead
+from which she had replied to Tom's
+own summons a few minutes before.</p>
+
+<p>Tom waited and listened. The rapping
+was not repeated, and no sound could be
+heard outside the door. What could it all
+mean? Had the marauders gone around to
+some of the windows? These were barred by
+heavy inside shutters, and no light could be
+seen to reveal the presence of any one. The
+darkness in the room was intense, and Tom
+almost thought he could feel it. He was
+breathing hard in his excitement, but he had
+not left his position by the door.</p>
+
+<p>Soon he heard the sound of the woman
+returning down the stairway. He waited
+breathlessly, and she soon rejoined him.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't see but one man," she whispered.
+"He's right there in front of the door."</p>
+
+<p>"Is it Benzeor?"</p>
+
+<p>"I couldn't see. You'd better open
+the door and let him in. We can handle
+one."</p>
+
+<p>Tom did not feel so positive about that,
+but bidding her light the candle, he again<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[65]</a></span>
+drew back the bar. "Come in! Come in!
+Quick!" he called.</p>
+
+<p>Some one pushed past him, and the door
+was instantly closed and barred again.</p>
+
+<p>The candle was not yet lighted, and in the
+darkness he felt as if some one were about to
+grasp him. He could almost feel hands upon
+him now. He stepped farther back from
+the door, and waited in breathless suspense
+for the candle to be lighted.</p>
+
+<p>After several attempts, the woman succeeded
+in igniting a splinter from the embers
+in the ashes on the fireplace, and the beams
+of the lighted candle quickly dispelled the
+darkness.</p>
+
+<p>"It's Indian John!" said Tom with a
+great sigh of relief as he saw the man before
+him.</p>
+
+<p>The visitor was a strange appearing being,
+clad in the leggings and moccasins of his race,
+while over his shoulders he wore a faded coat
+which once had done duty for some Continental
+soldier. His dark eyes burned as if
+they had caught a reflection from the sputtering
+candle, but with a countenance unmoved
+he gazed quietly at his companions in the
+room.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, John, what a fright you gave us!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[66]</a></span>
+said the woman at last. "What brings you
+here on a night like this?"</p>
+
+<p>The Indian made no reply, save to draw a
+letter from the pocket of the dripping, faded
+coat, and quietly held it forth to the woman.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[67]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER VI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>IN THE TEN-ACRE LOT</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Little</span> Peter's mother instantly grasped
+the letter, and seating herself by the table,
+and drawing the candle nearer, at once began
+to read. Tom watched her eagerly, but she
+did not speak, and the expression upon her
+face did not betray any of the emotions in
+her heart.</p>
+
+<p>The Indian still stood motionless in the
+position he had taken when he first entered
+the room, and except for the occasional turning
+of his dark eyes from the boy to the
+woman, so far as appearances went he might
+have been a statue. The rain still dashed
+against the windows, and the sounds of the
+wind outside showed that the storm was
+unabated. The flickering candle served to
+intensify the darkness, and the alarm which
+Tom had felt had not entirely departed.</p>
+
+<p>The woman read the letter all through
+carefully, and then, without a word of explanation,
+began to read it again. Tom hardly<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[68]</a></span>
+knew what to do. He had given her his
+warning, and whether she would care for his
+further services he could not determine. He
+did not feel like interrupting her, and yet he
+feared that his presence now might not be
+altogether welcome, for he had no means of
+knowing what the message was, or who had
+sent it.</p>
+
+<p>His uncertainty was quickly dispelled, however,
+as the woman laid the letter upon the
+table, and turning to him said, "You were
+right, Tom. Peter is coming home; but how
+you found it out, I cannot even guess."</p>
+
+<p>Tom did not feel at liberty to enlighten
+her upon the subject beyond what he had
+told her already, for he was sadly troubled
+about Benzeor and his relations with Fenton.
+Doubtless Benzeor was implicated, but matters
+had not yet gone so far that he felt he
+was at liberty to betray his foster father to
+the neighbors.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," resumed the woman, "Peter is
+coming home, but only for a day or two."</p>
+
+<p>"Where is he? What does he say of the
+army?" inquired Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"Washington is at Hopewell, as you said,
+Tom. When he found out that Clinton
+really intended to march across Jersey, he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[69]</a></span>
+detached General Maxwell's brigade and some
+of the militia to obstruct and bother the British,
+and Peter was in the militia, you know.
+They were to keep close to the redcoats, and
+by their skirmishes keep them from going
+too fast, and so give Washington a chance to
+pass them, and then, when the place he wanted
+was found, turn about and fight. When
+the army crossed the Delaware at Coryell's
+Ferry, Washington sent Colonel Morgan with
+six hundred of the riflemen to reinforce Maxwell,
+and with the rest of his men he set out
+to march toward Princeton."</p>
+
+<p>"I thought you said he was at Hopewell
+now," said Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"So he is, Peter writes, but Hopewell isn't
+but a few miles from Princeton, you know,
+and he decided to stop there and give his
+army a good rest. Peter writes that all the
+men now think that Clinton is marching so
+slowly on purpose, and that his plan is to let
+the Americans go on into the lower country
+and then gain the right of our army by a
+quick march and get possession of the higher
+ground on the right of our men. Peter
+writes that that is what all the Continentals
+think Clinton is trying to do, and so General
+Washington has halted at Hopewell. That's<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[70]</a></span>
+only five miles from Princeton, you see, and
+he is going to stay there a few days so that
+he can give his men a good rest before any
+engagement takes place; and he can find out
+what Clinton's plans are, too."</p>
+
+<p>"And while the army is waiting there, Big
+Peter thinks he'll run up home for a day,
+does he?" said Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's just it. He's sent me word
+of his coming by Indian John, here. But
+you must have been delayed John," she said,
+turning to the Indian as she spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"Heap wet," said the Indian quietly.</p>
+
+<p>"When does he say he expects to be
+here?" inquired Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"To-morrow; no, to-day, for it must be
+long past midnight now. I shouldn't be
+surprised to see him any time."</p>
+
+<p>"Well I've given you my message, and
+you'll know what to do now. I think perhaps
+I'd better be going back home, that is,
+unless there's something you think I can do
+to help you."</p>
+
+<p>"No, there's nothing more now, Tom.
+Little Peter will soon be here, and with him
+and Indian John in the house, I don't think
+we shall have much to fear. It was good of
+you to come, Tom. I shall never forget you,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[71]</a></span>
+and I know that Peter will not, either. I am
+sadly troubled, but I think it will be all
+right."</p>
+
+<p>"Good-night, then," said Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"Good-night, and thank you again for all
+your trouble and kindness."</p>
+
+<p>Tom drew back the bar, and, opening the
+door, passed out into the night, little dreaming
+that he had looked upon the face of
+Little Peter's mother for the last time.</p>
+
+<p>As he ran along the lonesome road, he
+could see that the clouds were breaking, and
+in low masses were swept by the wind across
+the sky. The rain had almost ceased now,
+but the air was damp and heavy and strangely
+oppressive. Perhaps it was the oppressiveness
+which affected Tom more than the excitement
+through which he had just passed,
+for the lad was much depressed as he came
+nearer to Benzeor's house. All the conversation
+he had overheard between the men came
+back to him, and he almost wished that he
+had not left Peter's mother alone with Indian
+John and the children. His feeling of obligation
+to Benzeor had mostly departed now,
+and as he recalled the plots of his foster
+father his heart was hot within him. He
+even thought of going over to the Court<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[72]</a></span>
+House and reporting the matter to Sheriff
+Forman that very night; but the hope that
+Benzeor still might not join Fenton in the
+evil project they had formed deterred him,
+and as he just then obtained a glimpse of the
+house which for more than ten years had
+been the only home he had ever known, his
+mind was recalled to his own immediate plans.
+At least he had given Peter's mother the
+warning, and if Fenton's band should make
+the proposed visit, in any event she would be
+prepared to receive them.</p>
+
+<p>At first Tom thought he would not return
+to his room, but would pass the night in the
+barn; still the fear that Benzeor might discover
+his absence, and be led to suspect
+its cause, quickly presented itself, and the
+troubled lad decided to go back to his accustomed
+place.</p>
+
+<p>Carefully he climbed up on the woodpile,
+and grasping the sill drew himself up and
+passed through the open window. He stood
+for a moment in the room and listened intently.
+Not a sound could be heard, and
+even the long drawn-out snores with which
+Benzeor had been wont to proclaim to the
+household the fact that he had entered the
+land of dreams were silent now. He waited<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[73]</a></span>
+several moments, and as the silence was still
+unbroken he proceeded carefully to remove
+his wet clothing, and climbed into his high
+bed.</p>
+
+<p>For the first time then he realized how
+thoroughly tired he was. The bed had never
+been more grateful to him, and a heavy sigh
+of relief escaped his lips. He heard the
+crowing of the cocks and knew that the
+morning could not be far away now.</p>
+
+<p>Not even the exciting events of the day,
+or the treacherous project of Benzeor, or his
+anxiety for the safety of Little Peter's father,
+now availed to keep the wearied lad awake.</p>
+
+<p>How long he slept he did not know, but it
+was broad daylight when he opened his eyes.
+Some one was pounding upon his door, and
+with a confused thought that Fenton was
+besieging the house, or that Washington had
+begun an attack upon Clinton's forces, he
+quickly sat up in the bed and listened.</p>
+
+<p>The summons was repeated, and Tom at
+once realized where he was and what was
+expected of him. There was no mistaking
+Benzeor's rude method of proclaiming the
+presence of the morning, and if he had had
+any doubts, they would have been quickly
+dispelled by the words which followed.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[74]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Come, Tom, get up! It's high time we
+were at work again!"</p>
+
+<p>"I'll be down in a minute," replied Tom
+as he leaped out of bed and hastily dressed.</p>
+
+<p>While he was engaged in that occupation
+he tried desperately to collect his thoughts
+and think of some way out of the troubles
+which he feared were sure to come that day.
+Should he tell Benzeor plainly that he could
+no longer remain under his roof? Ought he
+to tell him what he had overheard the night
+before? Had the time come for him to declare
+himself and to take the open stand
+which he had for a long time secretly planned
+to do? Thoughts of Sarah and the toiling,
+careworn little mother of the household presented
+themselves before his troubled mind,
+and the longer he thought, the more perplexed
+he became.</p>
+
+<p>The problem was not solved when he passed
+down the stairs and went out of the house to
+the barrel which stood beneath the corner of
+the eaves. He took the rude wooden bowl
+and filled it with water, and desperately tried
+to arrive at some conclusion as he bathed his
+flushed face.</p>
+
+<p>The family were already seated at the
+breakfast-table, and the sounds of Benzeor's<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[75]</a></span>
+gruff voice could be distinctly heard through
+the open windows. The hens with their
+broods were moving about the yard, and the
+dog came and rubbed against his leg as the
+lad dried his face and hands on the rough
+towel that was hanging near the water barrel.
+The storm had passed, and the summer sun
+was shining clear and strong now.</p>
+
+<p>As he lifted his eyes and looked out over
+Benzeor's fertile lands, only a vision of peace
+and restfulness could be seen on every side.
+It was all so different from the storm which
+was in his own soul that Tom almost groaned
+aloud as he turned to enter the kitchen and
+take his accustomed place at the table.</p>
+
+<p>As he entered the room, Benzeor said,
+"You're late this morning, lad, but I thought
+I would let you sleep, you had such a hard
+day of it yesterday. But there's no trip to
+New York this morning, and not likely to be
+one again soon."</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor's manner was not unkind, and as
+Tom glanced at him he wondered whether
+the man was in any wise suspicious of him
+or not. Apparently he was not, but without
+making any reply Tom seated himself and
+quietly decided to wait until they were alone
+before he spoke of what was in his mind.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[76]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Tom," said Benzeor after a brief silence,
+"I want you to go over to the ten-acre lot
+to-day. The ground's wet, but the corn
+there needs hoeing, and we can't wait."</p>
+
+<p>The "ten-acre lot" was on the border of
+Benzeor's possessions, and was nearly a mile
+distant from the house. On all sides it was
+bordered by woods, and was as lonely a place
+as could be found in all the region.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you going, too?" inquired Tom,
+with an apparent indifference he was far
+from feeling.</p>
+
+<p>"No. I've got to go in another direction
+to-day. I may not be back at night either,
+though I can't say as to that. You'd better
+take your dinner, too, Tom, and I'll leave
+one of the muskets for you. You can load
+it up with bird-shot and keep the blackbirds
+and crows away. They're raising the mischief
+this year, and corn's going to be worth
+money this fall, if I'm not greatly mistaken."</p>
+
+<p>Tom made no reply, although his heart
+was beating a little more rapidly than usual.
+Benzeor's absence from home promised little
+good, and the words which he had overheard
+the night before came back now with redoubled
+force. Where was Benzeor going?
+And why did he send him to work in the distant<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[77]</a></span>
+field, when he was positive that some of
+the corn nearer the house was in far greater
+need of hoeing than that in the ten-acre lot?</p>
+
+<p>However, he did not voice his questions,
+and immediately after the breakfast was over
+Benzeor mounted his horse and departed up
+the road, going in the opposite direction to
+that which led to Little Peter's house.</p>
+
+<p>Tom went up into the unfinished room in
+which Benzeor kept his guns and ammunition,
+but instead of taking the musket to
+which the man had referred, he selected a
+rifle, and loaded it with a ball instead of the
+bird-shot as Benzeor had directed. Just why
+he did this Tom could not have explained
+even to himself, but somehow there was the
+feeling in his heart that he might need to be
+prepared to deal with larger game that day
+than the thieving blackbirds or the noisy
+crows.</p>
+
+<p>"I've got your dinner all ready, Tom,"
+said Sarah, as the boy came back with his
+gun into the kitchen. "Why, you've got
+the rifle!" she added in surprise, as she
+noted the weapon he had in his hands.
+"There's nothing wrong, is there?" she said
+anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"I hope not. I don't know. I thought<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[78]</a></span>
+I'd take this gun," replied Tom in some confusion.</p>
+
+<p>Sarah said nothing more, but Tom knew
+from her manner that she was alarmed. He
+would have been glad to quiet her fears,
+but the anxiety in his own heart rendered
+him somewhat embarrassed, and without saying
+anything more he shouldered his gun,
+and picking up the little pail, or "blicky," as
+the country people termed it, having adopted
+the Dutch word whether they themselves
+were Dutch or not, he set forth on his walk
+to the distant ten-acre lot.</p>
+
+<p>He stopped in the barn long enough to
+select a hoe, and then with the added implement
+resumed his journey across the fields.
+When he came to the borders of the woods
+through which he was to pass, he turned and
+looked back at the house.</p>
+
+<p>Sarah was still standing in the doorway,
+and as she saw Tom stop she waved at him
+the sunbonnet which she was holding in one
+hand by the strings. Tom waved his "blicky"
+by way of a return, and then entered the
+woods, which shut out the view of all that
+lay behind him.</p>
+
+<p>The birds were flitting about in the trees
+and filling the air with their songs. The<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[79]</a></span>
+squirrels darted along the branches, stopping
+only occasionally to chatter at the intruder.
+High over all he could see a fish-hawk and
+his mate circling in the air, and Tom knew
+that their nest was not far away, and doubtless
+they were watching him to see that he
+did no harm to their little ones, which by this
+time must be well grown.</p>
+
+<p>As he came near to a marshy little pond
+which lay in the centre of an open place in
+the woods, he stopped for a moment when he
+heard the angry notes of a ground thrush
+near by. He soon saw that the bird was
+engaged in a fierce contest with a water
+snake which had crawled up the bank and
+doubtless had been endeavoring to make his
+breakfast upon the fledgelings in the nest he
+had discovered.</p>
+
+<p>Tom watched the contest for a moment,
+and then advanced to the aid of the bird,
+which was beating the ground with her wings,
+and occasionally darting swiftly at her foe.
+His approach was instantly seen by the snake,
+which quickly abandoned the contest, and,
+squirming down the bank, slid into the stagnant
+water; but Tom could still see the head
+which was lifted above the water, and the
+glittering little eyes were intently watching<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[80]</a></span>
+his movements, although the rest of the long
+slimy body was concealed in the pond.</p>
+
+<p>"That's just like Benzeor," said Tom
+aloud, as he dropped his pail, and picking up
+a stone threw it savagely at the head he
+could see a few yards out from the bank.</p>
+
+<p>The head instantly disappeared, and Tom
+turned to watch the bird, which now was
+hopping about in the bushes, uttering harsh
+little notes of relief.</p>
+
+<p>"You're all right now, old lady," said
+Tom. "Go back and tend to your babies.
+I only wish I could serve every crawling
+thing the way I served your enemy."</p>
+
+<p>He soon arrived at the end of his journey,
+and, placing his gun within easy reach, began
+his task for the day. Why he had put off
+his conversation with Benzeor he could not
+explain. But the energy with which he began
+his work served to afford a measure of
+relief for his pent-up feelings, and when the
+noon hour at last came he had done far more
+work than a morning often witnessed.</p>
+
+<p>Once he had stopped suddenly when he
+thought he heard the report of a gun in the
+distance. The sound had twice been repeated,
+but it seemed to be muffled and far away,
+and as he resumed his labor he tried to persuade<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[81]</a></span>
+himself that it was only Little Peter
+firing at the blackbirds or the thieving crows.</p>
+
+<p>The reports had made him anxious, however,
+and when he had stopped for dinner he
+had kept his gun near him all the time. The
+silence served to increase his feeling of loneliness.
+On every side stood the forests; and
+the great trees, which had never as yet felt
+the stroke of the axe, were companions without
+sympathy.</p>
+
+<p>With a feeling of desperation Tom soon
+resumed his labors. The sun passed over
+his head and began to sink below the tops of
+the taller trees. He had stopped for a moment
+to wipe his dripping face and gain a
+brief rest, when he was startled by the sight
+of some one emerging from the forest.</p>
+
+<p>He gazed for a moment intently at the new-comer,
+and soon recognized Sarah. What
+was the trouble? Her dress had been torn by
+the bushes, her hair had become loose and
+was streaming down her back. But her disheveled
+appearance was not the worst, for as
+Tom dropped his hoe and ran across the lot
+to meet her, he saw that her eyes were filled
+with an expression of terror, and her face
+betrayed the wild alarm which seemed to
+possess the swiftly running girl.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[82]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER VII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE PARTING OF THE WAYS</div>
+
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">What's</span> wrong, Sarah? What is it?
+What is it?" said Tom excitedly, as he drew
+near the almost breathless girl. "Has anything
+happened at the house?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Tom!" was all that Sarah at first
+could say. The reaction from her excitement
+and the swift pace at which she had been
+running had come, and the frightened girl
+burst into a flood of tears.</p>
+
+<p>Tom looked on in helpless amazement.
+Sarah was usually such a strong and self-contained
+girl that her present distress was all
+the more perplexing. He looked at her a
+moment, feeling how utterly unable he was
+to comprehend the state of her feelings and
+how helpless he was to aid or comfort her.
+Benzeor might be faced; and even Fenton, in
+spite of the fear with which Tom regarded
+him, might be met; but a weeping girl was
+entirely outside the realm of all his previous
+experiences, and he stood leaning upon his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[83]</a></span>
+gun, eager to do something to aid Sarah, and
+feeling a deep sympathy for her as he silently
+watched her.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps his silence was the very best aid
+he could offer, for in a brief time the resolute
+Sarah gained control of herself, and lifting
+her tear-stained face to that of the troubled
+lad by her side she said, "Oh Tom, they've
+killed Little Peter's mother!"</p>
+
+<p>"What!" exclaimed Tom in amazement.
+"Killed her? You can't mean it! Who
+killed her?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, they shot her, and have carried off
+his father, too."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't understand, Sarah," said Tom
+more quietly. "Tell me about it."</p>
+
+<p>"Little Peter came over to our house just
+a little while ago to leave the children, and
+he told us all about it. It seems, he was the
+lookout yesterday down by the Hook and
+didn't get home till it was almost light this
+morning.</p>
+
+<p>"He said he went up to his room and laid
+down upon his bed, and must have gone
+to sleep, but he was waked up by the sound
+of the voices of men in the house. He
+jumped out of bed and listened, and pretty
+soon he heard one of them tell his mother<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[84]</a></span>
+that she must hand over the money she had
+hidden in a stocking up in the garret, and
+tell where his father was.</p>
+
+<p>"She refused to do either, and then Little
+Peter hurriedly dressed and ran down the
+stairs, but some of the men just grabbed him
+and held him fast so that he couldn't do
+anything to help his mother. He said the
+men all had masks on their faces except
+Fenton, for he thinks it was Fenton's band
+that did the work, and he was sure he recognized
+the blacksmith."</p>
+
+<p>"No doubt about that!" exclaimed Tom.
+"What did they do then?"</p>
+
+<p>"They held his mother while some of them
+ran up into the garret, and pretty soon one
+of them came back with the stocking. They
+made quite a time over that, and Little Peter
+thought they wouldn't do anything more,
+but it seems they didn't find as much money
+in the stocking as they expected. Little
+Peter explained it to me by saying that his
+mother had divided it, and had hidden a part
+in the garden back of the house and left only
+a part in the stocking.</p>
+
+<p>"For a little time they didn't suspect that,
+but wanted to know where her husband was.
+Of course she didn't tell them. How could<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[85]</a></span>
+she, when he wasn't there? Well, they
+searched the place high and low. They tore
+open the feather beds, and broke down the
+walls in two or three places, but they couldn't
+find Peter. Then they went out into the
+barns and searched them, but not a trace of
+him could they find. They must have been
+pretty angry by that time, for when they
+came back to the house they told her they
+knew there must be more money than they
+had found in the stocking, and she must tell
+them where it was.</p>
+
+<p>"Just then one of the children called out
+that she knew where it was for she had seen
+her mother dig a hole in the ground and put
+a bag of money in it. Two of the men then
+took the child out into the garden and tried
+to make her show them the place where the
+money was, but she must either have forgotten
+or else did not know, for the men came
+back into the house more angry than before,
+and told her mother that she must go with
+them and show them the place.</p>
+
+<p>"Of course she refused, and then Fenton
+raised his gun and told her he'd give her till
+he could count five, to tell. She didn't say
+a word, and when the blacksmith had counted
+four he stopped a minute to give her a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[86]</a></span>
+chance to speak. He waited, and as she only
+shook her head the outlaw pulled the trigger
+and shot her in the breast."</p>
+
+<p>"And killed her?" inquired Tom in a low
+voice.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, killed her. The bullet must have
+struck her heart, for Little Peter said she fell
+dead. They threw the body on the bed and
+then they turned upon Little Peter. He said
+he thought his turn had come then, but at
+that very minute the guard they had stationed
+down by the road came running into the
+house, and going up to Fenton whispered
+something in his ear.</p>
+
+<p>"Little Peter didn't know what it was, he
+said, but in a minute Fenton turned to his
+men and gave them some directions, and they
+all stopped and went out of the house, that
+is, all except two, who were looking after
+Little Peter and the children.</p>
+
+<p>"In almost no time Little Peter heard
+some one coming up the lane on horseback
+and stop right before the kitchen door. He
+heard him jump off from the horse, and after
+a pause of a minute the men all made a rush
+out of the house. Pretty soon they came
+back, and Little Peter saw that his own father
+was a prisoner in their hands.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[87]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"He said his father took on fearfully when
+he saw his wife dead, and what the men had
+been doing, but in a minute they bound him
+hand and foot, and put a gag in his mouth,
+and then he was as helpless as a baby in their
+hands.</p>
+
+<p>"Little Peter said he didn't know what
+was coming next. He thought they'd torture
+him or his father into telling where the money
+was, or would set fire to the house; but before
+they could do anything the guard came
+running into the house again and called out
+that some one was coming.</p>
+
+<p>"They only stopped long enough to tie
+Little Peter to the post of the very bed on
+which his mother was lying dead, and then
+they made a break out of the house and took
+their horses and were off down the lane in no
+time."</p>
+
+<p>"How did you hear about it? How did
+Little Peter get away?" said Tom slowly.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, in a few minutes Indian John came
+into the house, and he set Little Peter free.
+'Twas lucky for him that he did, for Fenton
+might have come back, you see."</p>
+
+<p>"And Little Peter came over to your house
+with the children, then?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, he brought them all over, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[88]</a></span>
+they're at our house now. But, oh Tom, it's
+dreadful! dreadful! I'm so afraid they'll
+come to our place next, and so I ran out here
+to get you. Come Tom! Come right away!
+They may be there now!"</p>
+
+<p>Tom hesitated, not knowing just what to
+do. He was only a boy, and knew that alone
+he could do nothing against Fenton and his
+band. But the appeal of Sarah and the unprotected
+condition of the children and her
+mother moved him strongly, and his first impulse
+was to return with the frightened girl.</p>
+
+<p>"Sarah," said he abruptly, "where is your
+father?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, you know he went away this morning,
+and he hasn't come back yet. He said
+he might not be back before to-morrow morning.
+We're all alone, Tom, and you must
+come right away. Oh, it's awful!" And
+Sarah buried her face in her hands again as
+she spoke.</p>
+
+<p>It was almost upon Tom's lips to tell her
+what he knew of Benzeor. But the misery
+of the weeping girl before him was even
+stronger than the impression produced by the
+sad tale she had just related, and he could
+not quite bring himself up to the point of
+telling her what he suspected,&mdash;that her own<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[89]</a></span>
+father had been connected with the attack
+upon Little Peter's home. But he had decided
+now as to the course of action he must
+follow.</p>
+
+<p>"Sarah," said he gently, "there isn't the
+least danger in the world that your house will
+be attacked. I can't tell you how I know,
+but I know it's so."</p>
+
+<p>"But we're all alone, Tom! I don't
+know what you mean! We're as likely to be
+attacked as any one. You must go back
+with me! We must go right away, for they
+may be there now! Poor mother, she was so
+frightened that she didn't want me to leave
+and come over here for you! Come! We
+must go right back now!"</p>
+
+<p>"Sarah, I'm never going into that house
+again. You can tell your father that I've
+slept for the last time under his roof."</p>
+
+<p>"Not going back with me?" said Sarah
+aghast, and looking up in surprise as she
+spoke. "Not going back?" she repeated,
+as if she did not fully understand what Tom
+had said.</p>
+
+<p>"No, I'm not going back," said Tom
+firmly. "You know I've been thinking a
+good while of leaving, and after what you've
+just told me I know the time has come."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[90]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The color slowly faded from Sarah's face
+and a different expression came into her eyes.
+Even her alarm was apparently forgotten for
+the moment, and as Tom looked at her, her
+eyes seemed to snap and a sneer replaced the
+look of sorrow.</p>
+
+<p>"Tom Coward, you're afraid!" she said;
+"that's what's the trouble with you. You're
+afraid, that's what you are! You'd rather
+leave mother and me alone there with the
+children than run any risks of meeting the
+blacksmith! I wouldn't have believed it,
+but my father was right. You're a coward
+by nature as well as by name."</p>
+
+<p>"Sarah"&mdash;began Tom, his face flushing
+at the words of the angry girl.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't 'Sarah' me! I know you now!
+I never could have believed it, never! But
+I've heard you with my own ears, and now I
+know it's true! You're afraid! You're a
+coward, that's just what you are! Oh, you're
+well named, you are! Very well, sir, it shall
+be as you say. Perhaps we shall be better
+off without you than we would with you, for
+it would only make another child for us to
+look after if you should come back! I'll go
+back home and face Fenton and every one
+of his band myself! I'm afraid, but I'm no
+coward!"</p>
+
+<div class="figleft" style="width: 304px;">
+<img src="images/illus097.jpg" width="304" height="500" alt="&quot;TOM COWARD, YOU&#39;RE AFRAID!&quot;" title="" />
+<span class="caption">&quot;TOM COWARD, YOU&#39;RE AFRAID!&quot;</span>
+</div><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[91]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Turning abruptly away, after giving Tom
+a glance which he never forgot, she started
+resolutely and swiftly back along the pathway
+which she had followed in her flight to
+the ten-acre lot.</p>
+
+<p>Tom looked after her in helpless amazement.
+Never before had he heard such an
+outburst from the gentle and even-tempered
+Sarah, who had been the leading spirit in
+Benzeor's household. The children had gone
+to her with their troubles rather than to their
+mother, and Sarah had never failed to have a
+word of comfort or of help for every one.
+Even Benzeor himself had come to depend
+upon her judgment in many of his affairs,
+and she had been as patient and gentle with
+him as she had been with the troubled little
+ones.</p>
+
+<p>And to Tom she had been the one true
+friend he had ever known. Somehow she
+had always understood him, and from the
+days of their early childhood it had always
+been a matter of pride to him that he was her
+acknowledged champion and protector. Many
+a time, when he was a sturdy little lad, had he
+taken her part against the tormenting boys
+in the school. For her he had carved quaint
+and strange looking dolls out of horse-chestnuts,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[92]</a></span>
+and the childish Sarah had never failed
+to receive them with many expressions of
+pleasure, and had lavished a wealth of affection
+upon them which was almost as pleasing
+to Tom as to the little mother herself. For
+her he had gathered the chestnuts in the
+autumn and the bright colored flowers in the
+springtime; and when, with the passing of
+the years, there had come to them both new
+feelings and new interests, he still had shared
+with her all those dimly perceived ambitions
+and longings which are ever present in the
+boyish heart when it arrives at that position
+where it can look out upon the time when the
+boy is to become a man.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps Tom had enjoyed her sympathy
+and interest the more because of the loneliness
+of his own position. But Sarah never
+by word or act had caused him to feel that
+he was only Benzeor Osburn's "bound boy,"
+and not truly one of the household.</p>
+
+<p>Tom was thinking of some of these things
+as he watched the departing girl, and, forgetting
+for the moment all the anger and shame
+which her last words had aroused, he called
+aloud after her.</p>
+
+<p>"Sarah! Sarah!" he shouted. "Wait a
+minute! Come back! Come back!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[93]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Sarah apparently did not hear him, or heed
+him if she heard, and without once turning
+her head or looking behind her soon disappeared
+in the forest.</p>
+
+<p>An impulse to follow her seized Tom, and
+he even ran a few steps after her, but quickly
+stopped. How could he explain himself to
+her without informing upon Benzeor? And
+then her sorrow would be harder for him to
+bear than her present anger, hard as that was.
+No; all he could do was to remain silent for
+the time, and trust that in the future some
+explanation might be made which should set
+him aright once more in the estimation of
+the best friend the homeless boy had ever
+known.</p>
+
+<p>The departure of Sarah left him face to
+face with the perplexing problem of what
+he was now to do. To return to Benzeor's
+house was impossible; but where should he
+go?</p>
+
+<p>Tom stood for several minutes in deep
+thought. There was no home which would
+now be open to him except Little Peter's,
+and that had been wrecked by the dreadful
+deeds of Fenton and his followers. Washington's
+army he had heard was at Hopewell,
+and that was at least forty miles away. It<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[94]</a></span>
+was to the army he had ultimately hoped to
+go, and perhaps the present was the very
+time to which he had been looking forward
+so long.</p>
+
+<p>The longer he thought about it the more
+strongly was he impressed with the conviction
+that his best plan would be to try to make
+his way to Hopewell, or to the place to which
+the army might have moved by this time.
+It was true he was without provisions, and
+he knew of no place in which he would be
+likely to obtain any, or in which he might
+find a resting-place for a night. Of the long
+journey he thought but little, for a walk
+even of forty miles had no terrors for him.</p>
+
+<p>Tom decided to start for Washington's
+army, but first he must stop at Little Peter's
+and learn what his friend's plans were to be,
+and offer him such aid as it lay within his
+power to give.</p>
+
+<p>The decision once made, Tom picked up
+his rifle, which now he somehow had come
+to regard as his own property, and started
+through the forest toward the distant road.</p>
+
+<p>When at last he gained it and started
+towards Little Peter's home, he was startled
+as he saw some one running down the road,
+and his first impulse was to conceal himself<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[95]</a></span>
+in the forest and wait for the stranger to pass;
+but his fears were relieved when he recognized
+the long lope of the runner, and then
+knew that his old friend Indian John was
+approaching.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[96]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER VIII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>INDIAN JOHN</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Indian John</span> had for years been a frequent
+visitor in the home of Benzeor, as he had in
+many of the other homes of the region. He
+was an old man now,&mdash;how old no one knew,
+perhaps not even Indian John himself,&mdash;but
+he had lingered about old Monmouth long
+after the Schwonnack had taken possession
+of the lands and his own tribe had gradually
+relinquished their homes and mostly withdrawn
+from the region.</p>
+
+<p>For months together he would disappear,
+and no one would know whither he had
+gone, although it was thought that he was
+on a visit to some of his kindred, who had
+withdrawn farther into the interior of the
+country; but he would soon return and resume
+his wandering life. At such times,
+Indian John would be restless and uneasy.
+Perhaps then he realized more fully the loss
+of the homes of his ancestors, and his heart
+would be filled with thoughts he never<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[97]</a></span>
+uttered. He continued to be friendly with
+the settlers, and though he never refused to
+accept the food which almost every housewife
+was willing to give him, he had never been
+willing to pass a night under a roof. It was
+commonly reported that he used a cave in
+the woods not far away as his abode, but he
+never had welcomed any one there, nor had
+any one ever seen the aged Indian in the
+place. Still the report was believed, and
+"Indian John's cave" was a well-known
+name among the boys of Old Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>Between Tom and the lonely warrior there
+had been a very strong feeling of sympathy,
+although not even Tom himself was able to
+explain it. It had come about, however, as
+the result of an accidental meeting between
+them a few years previous to this time.
+Tom had gone down to the shore one day
+when a storm had been raging, and the
+great breakers had been rolling in upon the
+beach.</p>
+
+<p>As the lad had walked on over the sand,
+he had been surprised to see the figure of a
+man in the distance, standing motionless, and
+evidently watching the tumult of the angry
+waters. He had not changed from his position
+as Tom approached, and the lad did not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[98]</a></span>
+know that his presence was even recognized
+by the Indian, who seemed to be absorbed in
+his reflections as he looked out over the tossing
+waves.</p>
+
+<p>Tom had gone on and at last touched the
+Indian upon the shoulder. Indian John had
+then slowly turned his head, and Tom knew
+that his presence had been perceived, but for
+a moment neither had spoken.</p>
+
+<p>Then the aged warrior, with a gesture
+toward the ocean, had said, "Boy no home.
+Warrior no home. Brothers."</p>
+
+<p>It was the first time Tom had known that
+Indian John was aware of his own early history,
+and his heart had been deeply touched
+by the sympathy of the red man.</p>
+
+<p>"Boy no home. Warrior no home. Both
+like waves. Driven here. Driven there. No
+rest. No home. Storm there. Storm here,"
+said the Indian laying his hand upon his
+bosom as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>From that time, although Indian John
+never referred to his loneliness again, a
+strong bond of sympathy had existed between
+the two, and every time Tom had seen the
+old man, he thought of his quiet eloquence in
+the presence of that storm which they both
+had witnessed from the shore.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[99]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>And Indian John had been kind and
+thoughtful to all the white children of the
+region. He had made bows for the boys,
+and taught them their use, and as their skill
+had increased, his pride was as marked,
+although it had not been as demonstrative,
+as that of the youthful warriors themselves.
+He had taught them how to make and set
+their traps for the foxes and the rabbits,
+and how to catch the eels in the river. Apparently
+his happiest hours had been those
+which he passed with his young companions.</p>
+
+<p>Highly as the boys had prized the lessons
+he had given them, still more did they prize
+the marvelous tales which Indian John could
+tell. To them he told what the waves were
+saying when they came rolling in upon the
+sandy shore. He knew what the tall trees
+were whispering when the wind swept through
+their branches and brought the leaves into
+contact with one another. The hoarse calls
+of the wild geese, when they passed high
+overhead on their long journeys in the spring
+and autumn, were all known to Indian John,
+and the screams of the eagles and the fish-hawks
+were all in a language which he
+clearly understood.</p>
+
+<p>He knew, also, all the tales his fathers had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[100]</a></span>
+told him of the first appearance of the Woapsiel
+Lennape in Old Monmouth, when, in
+the spring of 1524, John de Verrazano, in his
+good ship The Dolphin, had entered Sandy
+Hook, and had soon after written a long
+letter to King Francis the First of France,
+and had given a full account of the marvelous
+adventures which had befallen him, and
+the no less marvelous country he had discovered.
+He had heard, also, of the visit, in
+the summer of 1609, which Sir Henry Hudson
+had made in The Half Moon, and how
+that one of his crew had fallen as the first
+victim of the rage of the Indians at the
+invasion of their lands.</p>
+
+<p>The tale which Tom had always enjoyed
+most, however, was that of the origin of the
+troublesome little pests which, in the warm
+days of the summer, were the torment of the
+people, for Jersey mosquitoes were not unknown
+in those far-off times of the Revolution.</p>
+
+<p>It seemed that ages before this time, indeed
+away back in the days before John de
+Verrazano or Henry Hudson had come, or
+even the memory of the oldest warriors could
+run, the Great Spirit had permitted two huge
+monsters to appear and prey upon the red<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[101]</a></span>
+men of Monmouth as a penalty for some
+crime they had committed, a crime the nature
+of which Indian John did not know, or, if he
+knew, he never explained.</p>
+
+<p>In size these monsters were larger than
+any house. They had long slender legs
+which held their huge bodies higher in the
+air than the tallest trees could have done.
+They also had immense wings, which, although
+they were as fine in texture as the finest silk,
+were so large and strong that when the huge
+monsters used them they created such a
+breeze that even the strongest trees of the
+forest fell before them.</p>
+
+<p>Their most distinguishing characteristic,
+however, was an immense "bill," which was
+as long as the tallest pine-tree and as sharp
+and delicate in its point as that of the smallest
+needle. With this they wrought incalculable
+destruction and suffering among the
+helpless people. The largest man served
+only as a single "bite," and the bodies of
+little children seemed only to whet the appetite
+of these savage monsters.</p>
+
+<p>The helpless warriors knew not what to do.
+They sacrificed, and prayed, and besought the
+Great Spirit to free them from their tormentors,
+but all was without avail. Their prayers<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[102]</a></span>
+were unanswered, and the Great Spirit was
+not appeased.</p>
+
+<p>No man could describe the destruction
+wrought by the huge tormentors. Whole
+tribes disappeared before them, and it soon
+came to pass that the warriors dared not
+venture forth in search of food for their
+starving little ones, who were kept concealed
+in dens and caves of the earth. Watchers
+were stationed to give warning of the approach
+of the monsters, for their great bodies
+cast shadows upon the earth like those of
+the low-passing clouds on a summer day,
+and long before they appeared in the sky the
+cry of the watchman sent all within the sound
+of his voice to their places of refuge under
+the ground. Not even then were they always
+safe, for the monsters could bore into the
+ground with their bills, and often brought to
+the surface the body of a man, who struggled
+and kicked much after the fashion of a frog
+impaled on the beak of some long-legged
+heron. The torments of the people increased.
+The women neglected their fields, and the
+warriors remained in their hiding-places, while
+the frightened children cried for food.</p>
+
+<p>At last, rendered desperate by their sufferings,
+the warriors of the entire region banded<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[103]</a></span>
+themselves together, and one day fell upon
+the monsters as they were lying asleep in a
+valley which their immense bodies almost
+filled.</p>
+
+<p>The carnage was frightful to behold. All
+day long the contest was waged, and the multitudes
+of men that fell could not be counted
+up for numbers. But at last the red men
+were victorious, and when the few remaining
+warriors left the field of battle, their enemies
+lay stretched upon the valley, dead.</p>
+
+<p>Great was the rejoicing among the people.
+They came forth from their hiding-places,
+and their feastings and songs of victory were
+continued for two entire days. The land
+was freed from its tormentors, and peace and
+prosperity would now return, or so at least
+they thought.</p>
+
+<p>Great was the astonishment and sorrow of
+Indian John's forefathers when, upon the
+third day, they discovered that their troubles
+were not ended. As decay had begun to
+work upon the dead bodies of the mammoth
+mosquitoes, little particles became loosened,
+and as they were lifted into the air by the
+summer wind, each tiny and separate atom
+became endowed with life and received a
+body in shape exactly like that of the huge<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[104]</a></span>
+monsters themselves, only they were exceedingly
+small in size. Day after day clouds of
+these tiny torments were borne away by the
+breezes from the valley of the dead, and,
+filled with a burning desire to avenge the
+death of their parents, they fell upon the
+unprotected people.</p>
+
+<p>From these there had been no relief.
+The camp-fires of the warriors did not avail,
+and although the men went valiantly forth to
+give them battle, their efforts were all futile,
+and from that day until the present time the
+Jersey mosquito has remained a foe to the
+red man and the white, and ever consumed
+by the one purpose, to avenge the death of
+the parents, who had fallen years ago in their
+battle with the red-skinned warriors of Old
+Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>To Indian John this story of the origin of
+the pests of New Jersey had been eminently
+satisfactory, and never by word or deed had
+he shown that he had the slightest doubt of
+the accuracy of the tradition which had come
+down to him through many generations.
+Tom at first had received the account with
+all the implicit faith of an ardent admirer of
+Indian John, and his first rude shock had
+come when Benzeor had laughed aloud upon<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[105]</a></span>
+his relating the story with all seriousness one
+morning at the breakfast-table. With the
+passing of the years other doubts as to the
+entire reliability of some of Indian John's
+stories had crept into his mind. Alas that it
+should be so with us all! But his strong
+regard for the old warrior had never ceased,
+and Tom's heart was glad that morning when
+he recognized the new-comer as his long-time
+friend.</p>
+
+<p>"Where have you been, John?" he said,
+as the Indian approached.</p>
+
+<p>"See Peter."</p>
+
+<p>"Have you seen him?" said Tom eagerly.
+"Where is he? Has he got away?"</p>
+
+<p>"How?" replied the Indian quickly; and
+Tom at once perceived from the expression
+upon his face that he was aware of some but
+not of all the recent events in Peter's home.</p>
+
+<p>As he related the story which Sarah had
+told him, Indian John made no reply, although
+his eyes seemed to blaze as he listened to
+Tom's words. He then explained that he
+had left the house soon after Tom had departed
+on the preceding night, to intercept
+Big Peter on the road and give to him the
+warning which his wife had bidden him to
+carry. But Peter must have returned by a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[106]</a></span>
+different route from that which he had been
+expected to use, and as a natural result Indian
+John had not seen him, the warning word
+had not been given, and Big Peter had returned
+to learn of the sad death of his wife
+and to be carried away a prisoner by Fenton
+and his brutal band.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know just what to do now,
+John," said Tom. "I want to go and join
+the army. You have been there, and perhaps
+you would like to go back with me."</p>
+
+<p>Indian John had been with the soldiers in
+Washington's army, but he made no reply to
+Tom's words, and indeed the lad was not
+certain that he had heard, for he stood looking
+upon the ground and evidently was thinking
+deeply.</p>
+
+<p>"Where Little Peter now?" said the Indian
+abruptly, looking up at Tom as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know. Fenton didn't take him
+with him, though I don't know why he
+didn't."</p>
+
+<p>"Little Peter home," said the Indian decidedly.
+"Go see Little Peter."</p>
+
+<p>Tom hesitated. He, too, had longed to
+go to his friend, not only to express his sympathy
+but also to learn what his plans were
+to be, for he knew that Little Peter would<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[107]</a></span>
+not remain in his home now. Indeed, he
+could not, if he would, after such a scene as
+that which he had witnessed there. But
+Tom's mind was filled with thoughts of Benzeor,
+and a meeting with him certainly was
+not very desirable at that time.</p>
+
+<p>"Go see Little Peter," said the Indian
+again, starting on up the road as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"All right, I'll go with you," replied Tom,
+as he joined his companion.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter's house was not far away, and
+he would not lose much time in going there.
+It was almost night now, and if his friend
+should be at home they might be able to
+devise some plan by which they could act
+together. Besides all that, Tom was more
+than glad to have an opportunity to express
+his sympathy for his friend in his sorrow.</p>
+
+<p>They soon came within sight of the house,
+and both stopped when they saw a little
+group of people near the garden. Tom knew
+at once what their presence meant, for they
+were near the spot where two of the members
+of the family had been buried. He had seen
+the rude wooden headstones which marked
+their graves many times before this.</p>
+
+<p>The few neighbors who had assembled to
+perform the last rites for Little Peter's mother<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[108]</a></span>
+had just returned to the house as Tom and
+Indian John approached. Tom at once went
+to his friend, and the warm grasp of the hand
+was all he could give. Not one of the children
+save Little Peter was there, and the hurried
+duties had been hastily performed by
+kind, though rough hands.</p>
+
+<p>The two boys withdrew from the house, and
+after an awkward silence Tom said in a low
+voice, "What are you going to do now?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going to leave the children at Benzeor's
+house. He has been very kind, or
+rather Sarah has, Tom. And then I'm going
+to start for Refugee Town; I think father
+may be there."</p>
+
+<p>"Refugee Town?" said Tom in surprise.
+"Do you think that will be safe?"</p>
+
+<p>Tom well knew the place. It was a spot
+on the outer beach of the Hook, where some
+of the more desperate refugees, tories and
+negroes, had assembled. A few huts and
+tents served as their dwelling-places, and the
+men were supposed to be in league with the
+men on board the boats which the British had
+stationed near by, for a part of Howe's fleet
+was already anchored there, waiting for the
+coming of Clinton's men. Clinton's original
+plan had been to march across Jersey to New<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[109]</a></span>
+Brunswick, there embark his men on the Raritan,
+and sail away for New York; but the
+rapid march of Washington had caused him
+to abandon the project, and word had been
+sent for the fleet to be ready for him when
+he should arrive at the Highlands.</p>
+
+<p>Refugee Town had become a familiar name
+within the past few weeks.</p>
+
+<p>"No, it isn't safe exactly, but I've got to
+do something for father. If he's taken to
+New York and shut up in the sugar-house
+I'll go with him; and if he's still there at
+the Town I may be able to do something,
+though I don't know what," said Little Peter
+sadly.</p>
+
+<p>"But there are the children," protested
+Tom. "What'll become of them?"</p>
+
+<p>"They're at Benzeor's, and they'll be all
+right. You'll help look after them, won't
+you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I've left Benzeor's."</p>
+
+<p>"Left Benzeor's? What for?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going to join the army. It's time I
+was doing my share."</p>
+
+<p>Tom gave no other reason. He knew the
+children would be safe at Benzeor's, and with
+what Little Peter then had it in his mind to
+do it would perhaps be unwise to tell him<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[110]</a></span>
+all he knew. However, he intended to tell
+him all, and that soon.</p>
+
+<p>"Going to join the army?" repeated Little
+Peter, as if he did not comprehend the words.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; you know I've been thinking of it
+a long time, and now that they're on the
+march, and coming this way, I've made up
+my mind that my turn has come. I didn't
+know but you would want to go, too, now."</p>
+
+<p>"I'd like to, but I can't. I've got this
+other matter on hand. Come into the house,
+Tom, and spend the night with me. You
+can start in the morning as well as now, and
+besides it's almost dark. You can't go in
+the night."</p>
+
+<p>Tom hesitated, but finally consented, and
+with his friend went into the house which so
+recently had been the scene of the greatest
+sorrow which had ever entered Little Peter's
+life.</p>
+
+<p>Indian John followed them, but after his
+custom refused to remain, although he promised
+to return early in the morning. One of
+the women of the neighborhood had stayed
+to look after Little Peter's immediate wants,
+but as soon as her duties were done she departed
+for her own home with an eagerness
+she could not entirely conceal. And Tom did<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[111]</a></span>
+not blame her, for he himself was not without
+fear when at last Little Peter closed the
+doors for the night, and, after having slipped
+the heavy bars into their places, the two boys
+sought their bed in the low room over the
+kitchen.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[112]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER IX</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE YOUNG LIEUTENANT</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">It</span> was long before daylight when the boys
+were stirring on the morning which followed
+the events recorded in the preceding chapter.
+No one had disturbed them, and with the
+return of the day their courage was somewhat
+revived. Tom, however, had decided to start
+at once for the army, which he knew from
+Indian John's words was not many miles
+away. He was thoroughly familiar with all
+the roads in the county, for he had ridden
+over them many times in company with Benzeor,
+or when he had been sent on errands to
+the more remote regions by his foster father,
+and consequently had no fears of losing his
+way.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter did not urge his friend to
+accompany him on his expedition to Refugee
+Town, for he was aware of the perils that
+were likely to beset him on his journey. He
+would not listen to any of the protests of
+Tom, for he was fully determined to learn<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[113]</a></span>
+what had become of his father, and even
+share his experiences if the occasion demanded.
+And Tom could not find it in his
+heart to blame Little Peter, hopeless as he
+considered all his efforts likely to be. Perhaps
+he would do the same thing if his own
+father had been carried away by the pine
+robbers, and he found himself conjecturing
+how it was a boy would feel in such circumstances
+as those in which his friend had been
+placed. The feeling was one of which he
+knew nothing by experience, and his own
+loneliness seemed to press upon him with a
+heavier weight.</p>
+
+<p>However, he still said nothing to Little
+Peter concerning Benzeor's recent actions,
+for he was well assured that his friend's
+younger brothers and sisters could be in no
+place where they would so easily escape all
+further troubles for the present as in his
+foster father's house; and then all of Little
+Peter's plans would be changed at once if he
+knew the part which his neighbor had taken
+in the tragedy which had recently occurred.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps Indian John will go with me,"
+said Little Peter. "He'll be a great help if
+he'll go."</p>
+
+<p>"That he will," replied Tom, "and I'm<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[114]</a></span>
+sure he'll be glad to go with you. I should
+like to go myself."</p>
+
+<p>"That's all right, Tom; I know you would,
+but you couldn't do any good, and might
+only get into trouble yourself. Perhaps I'll
+be with you in a day or two, if I don't hear
+anything about my father down by Refugee
+Town,&mdash;that is, if Benzeor is willing for the
+children to stay in his house. I'll have to
+look after them, you see, for it's likely I'll
+have to be father and mother, as well as big
+brother, now," he added sadly.</p>
+
+<p>"I know, I know," said Tom; "but I'm
+hoping you'll have good luck, and if the
+army really is coming here, it may be that
+you'll get some help from the Continentals if
+you need it then. Good-by, Peter."</p>
+
+<p>"Good-by, Tom," replied his friend.</p>
+
+<p>Tom placed some bread in his pockets, and
+then started forth on his journey. Somewhere
+off towards Hopewell the American
+army must be, according to all the reports
+which had come, and to that place he must
+make his way. The time for which he had
+been waiting at last had come, and with a
+lighter heart than he had known for days the
+lad began his journey.</p>
+
+<p>The summer morning was clear and warm.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[115]</a></span>
+The birds were flitting about in the trees and
+filling the air with their songs. In spite of
+the heat, there was a delicious freshness in
+the early morning air, and as he walked rapidly
+forward he soon came to feel a sense of
+exhilaration which not even the loss and grief
+of his boy friend could entirely banish.</p>
+
+<p>By the time the sun rose red and full
+in the east, he had placed several miles between
+him and Little Peter's home, but with
+unabated zeal he steadily pushed onward,
+resolved to make the best possible use of the
+early hours before the more intense heat of
+the day should come.</p>
+
+<p>By the middle of the forenoon more than
+ten miles had been left behind him, but he
+was beginning to feel the effects of his exertions.
+His face was flushed and streaming
+with perspiration. The rough road was hot
+and dusty, for only a single day had been required
+to dry out all the vestiges of the recent
+storm. He was beginning to feel somewhat
+tired, and was about to stop for a brief rest
+by the roadside, when he saw some one approaching
+on horseback.</p>
+
+<p>He quickly drew back among the trees
+which grew close to the road, thereby hoping
+to escape all notice by the stranger; but his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[116]</a></span>
+plan was quickly changed when he discovered,
+as the horseman came nearer, that he was clad
+in the uniform of the Continental army. His
+relief was greater when he recognized the
+man as the son of one of Benzeor's neighbors,
+who more than a year before this time
+had enlisted and had passed the preceding
+winter in Valley Forge.</p>
+
+<p>He quickly resolved to hail the man as he
+passed, and accordingly stepped out into the
+road and waved his arms as a signal for
+the horseman to stop. The man quickly
+heeded, and as he drew the rein and checked
+his horse he peered down at the lad by the
+roadside, and Tom's fears were instantly relieved
+when he perceived that he had been
+recognized.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, Tom Coward, what are you doing
+here? Nothing wrong over home, is there?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, there is;" and Tom at once proceeded
+to give young Lieutenant Gordon an
+account of all that had occurred in the past
+three days.</p>
+
+<p>"That's bad," said the lieutenant slowly,
+patting his horse's dripping neck as he spoke.
+"That's bad. I wish I could take a company
+and go over there this minute. I can't,
+though; it's out of the question. But the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[117]</a></span>
+army will be here shortly now, and there
+may be a chance to give these pine robbers
+a dose then. Where are you going now,
+Tom?"</p>
+
+<p>"I thought I'd start for the army," replied
+Tom. "I've no other place to go to, and
+I've been waiting to join it a long time."</p>
+
+<p>The lieutenant smiled at the lad's words as
+he replied, "That's all right. You're a
+well-grown fellow, and I doubt not they'll
+find a place somewhere for you in the Jersey
+militia. There are younger fellows than you
+there."</p>
+
+<p>"So I hear," replied Tom eagerly. "Indian
+John told me the army was over by
+Hopewell, and had halted there, so I thought
+I'd put straight for that place."</p>
+
+<p>"There isn't very much of the militia
+there now," said the lieutenant. "They're
+mostly regulars at Hopewell, and I doubt not
+have started from there before this."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are the militia then?" said Tom
+quickly. "I've got a rifle here, and if I'm
+to join them I want to know where they
+are."</p>
+
+<p>"That would be a little difficult to say just
+at present, my lad," replied the lieutenant,
+assuming a more fatherly air than the difference<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[118]</a></span>
+between their years would seem to warrant.
+"That would be a little difficult to
+say."</p>
+
+<p>As Tom plainly showed his disappointment,
+the young officer continued: "You
+see it's this way, Tom. It was early in the
+morning of the 18th when the last of General
+Clinton's forces marched out of the city
+of Philadelphia. They went by the way
+of Gloucester Point, about three miles below
+Camden, and then the entire force,
+with Knyphausen and his Hessians in advance,
+marched over to Haddonfield and
+halted there. We had means up at Valley
+Forge of finding out what was going on, and
+before they were fairly out of Philadelphia
+some of our scouting parties and light horse
+were in the city, and they gathered in about
+sixty or seventy prisoners and were back
+again at the Forge with the men and the
+news. By three o'clock that same day General
+Lee's division had started, and by five
+o'clock General Wayne's had gone, too.
+They lost no time over there, I can tell you."</p>
+
+<p>"But I don't understand," said Tom.
+"Where are the militia, and what are you
+doing here?"</p>
+
+<p>"That's what I'm explaining to you,"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[119]</a></span>
+replied the lieutenant. "Well, at five o'clock
+the next morning,&mdash;that was the 19th of
+June, you know,&mdash;Washington had the
+rest of the army on the march for Coryell's
+Ferry; but the roads were so heavy&mdash;for
+we've been having some great rains this
+month&mdash;that the divisions which had been
+sent out didn't cross the Delaware until
+Saturday morning, and the main body till
+Monday. And all this time the British
+were mighty careful, let me tell you. They
+thought Washington was after their baggage-wagons
+and stores, you see. Clinton and his
+main body moved out of Haddonfield on
+Friday, but he left Knyphausen and his
+Dutch butchers, as well as two brigades of
+the regulars behind him, while he marched
+eight miles up to Evesham and went into
+camp there. He wanted to keep his train of
+baggage-wagons well protected, you see, for
+the militia were doing all sorts of mischief.
+You wanted to know where they were. Well,
+that's where they were."</p>
+
+<p>"They're away down at Haddonfield,
+then, are they?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, no. But they'd been sent out to
+bother the British, you see, and try to hold
+them back by skirmishes and a few such<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[120]</a></span>
+gentle deeds. They were tearing up bridges
+and firing at the regulars from the woods,
+and doing all sorts of things. Why, when
+Clinton was marching from Haddonfield to
+Evesham, General Leslie, who was in command
+of his advanced guard, fell in with a
+party of these very militia I'm telling you
+about. Leslie hid some of his men in a rye-field,
+and they saw Captain Jonathan Beesley.
+He was a captain in the Cumberland County
+militia, you know, and had been in the army
+two years,&mdash;yes, and he was one of the best
+men we ever had, too, let me tell you. Well,
+Leslie's men saw Beesley and a couple of his
+officers reconnoitring in advance of their
+companies, and they fired on them. Captain
+Beesley was wounded, and of course they took
+him prisoner and carried him with them into
+camp. They tried to get him to own up
+what Washington's plans were, but Captain
+Beesley just stopped them by saying they
+wouldn't get a word out of him. And they
+didn't; but the next day the poor fellow died
+from his wounds. They'd taken him into
+Hinchman Haines's house, you see, and that
+was where he died. I understand that they
+buried him there with the honors of war, and
+I understand, too, that they've given permission<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[121]</a></span>
+for the body to be taken up and placed
+in the Friends' burying-ground down at Haddonfield.
+It may have been done before this,
+for all that I know. Captain Beesley was a
+good man. The redcoats couldn't do too
+much for him."</p>
+
+<p>"But where are the militia now? That's
+what I want to know."</p>
+
+<p>"And that's what I'm trying to tell you.
+This is too hot to be standing out here in
+the road. Let's go into the shade. I've got
+time enough, and it may be a bit safer there,
+too."</p>
+
+<p>The lieutenant led his horse a short distance
+into the woods, and, slipping the bridle-rein
+over his head, he permitted him to graze,
+while he himself resumed his story.</p>
+
+<p>"At four o'clock the next morning,&mdash;that
+was Saturday, the 20th,&mdash;Clinton took up the
+line of march, but he only went seven miles,
+as far as Mount Holly, and there he halted
+till Monday. On Sunday, Knyphausen joined
+him, having marched by the way of Moorestown.
+The next morning they all marched
+on to Black Horse and halted again, but at
+five o'clock Tuesday morning they were up
+and at it once more. They divided their
+forces there a bit, Leslie going by the way<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[122]</a></span>
+of Bordentown, Clinton keeping on along the
+road to Crosswicks, while Grant and the
+Dutch butchers brought up the rear and
+served as a kind of guard for the baggage-train.
+All this was only yesterday, the 23d,
+you see."</p>
+
+<p>"But where are the militia now?" protested
+Tom. "They are the ones I want to
+join, not the British. You keep telling me
+about them. What I want is the other side."</p>
+
+<p>"Listen, then, and you shall hear. Yesterday
+General Dickinson, with the Jersey militia,
+was right there in Bordentown."</p>
+
+<p>"What! when the British came up?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, when the British came up, that is,
+when Leslie's division did. Not all of the
+militia were there, though. A good many
+had been withdrawn and posted where they
+could do the most good. There weren't very
+many left in Bordentown, but when they found
+out that Leslie was almost upon them, they
+made up their minds in very short order that
+the climate there was not the best in the world,
+so they cleared out and left. But before they
+went they left a few slight tokens of their
+regard. They pulled up the planks of the
+bridge there over Crosswicks Creek, and
+raised the draw so that Leslie had to find<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[123]</a></span>
+another crossing-place. Before they did that
+they tried to fix up the bridge, but they were
+fired upon, and I understand that four were
+killed and quite a large number were wounded.</p>
+
+<p>"Clinton, too, wasn't finding his road all
+covered over with roses either. About five
+hundred of our men met him as he came up
+nearer to Crosswicks, and they thought they
+were ready, but they weren't anything of the
+kind. They had cut down a lot of trees and
+stretched them across the road, but that didn't
+stop the British. They came on just as if
+they didn't mind marching over such little
+things as trees, and there was a little skirmish
+there, and two or three of the redcoats were
+killed. One of their officers was shot and they
+took him up to a house near by, and left him
+there. Of course the Americans couldn't
+stand there long, but they didn't run very
+far.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, the British divisions joined then
+and started on again. They came to another
+bridge and our men had it all fixed so that
+they could just let it fall by one or two
+strokes of an axe. They had one or two
+little cannons there, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Who did? The British?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, our men. You know Sam Clevenger,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[124]</a></span>
+don't you? Well, he stood there on the
+bridge with his axe in his hands when the
+British came in sight. He'd cut the sleepers
+almost through, and when he saw the redcoats
+coming, he lifted his axe, and the third
+time he struck down went the bridge and all.
+Then Clevenger started to run, but the British
+fired at him and he fell dead. They'd
+shot him in the back of the head. Our men
+then fired their cannon once or twice, but all
+they hit was the Friends' meeting-house. Of
+course the British didn't mind that, and then
+our men pulled back and left. That was
+only yesterday. I shouldn't be surprised if
+the British were over here by Allentown or
+Imlaystown now, or it may be both."</p>
+
+<p>"What! not more than ten or fifteen miles
+away?" said Tom excitedly.</p>
+
+<p>"That's what I say. And they'll be
+nearer, too, before they're farther off, let me
+tell you."</p>
+
+<p>"Why? How? What do you mean?"</p>
+
+<p>"They'll never go to Brunswick or Amboy,
+for Washington's right in front of
+them, and ready to head them off. They'll
+just have to come this way or go back, and
+that they won't do, for 'Britons never retrograde.'
+That's one of their pet words, you<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[125]</a></span>
+know. Isn't that what John Burgoyne said,
+too?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know anything about that," said
+Tom. "Then General Washington has been
+using a part of the militia and a part of the
+regulars to bother Clinton and keep him from
+getting to Brunswick or Amboy, has he?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's just it."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I shan't have very far to go, then,
+to join them now."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, you're not going to join them.
+You're coming with me. You're just such
+a lad as I have been looking for, and you
+can help me, if I'm not greatly mistaken."</p>
+
+<p>As Tom made no reply except to look up
+in surprise, the young officer at once began
+to explain to him the nature of the task to
+which he had referred.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[126]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER X</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE STORY OF THE MISCHIANZA</div>
+
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">I've</span> been sent out, as a good many
+others have been, to look up the bridges over
+the creeks" (the young officer called them
+"runs," as many of the Jerseymen did then,
+and still do for the matter of that) "and find
+out the lay of the land. As I happened to
+be born in Old Monmouth, and lived here
+till I was a man grown, it was naturally
+thought I'd be pretty well informed, so you
+see I was selected for this special work. I
+don't know that I object to it, but I'd rather
+be back with my men."</p>
+
+<p>"And that's what you've been doing, is
+it?" said Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I've been in that work ever since
+the British started out from Philadelphia.
+I've kept just a little ahead of the men all
+the way, and have gone back every night to
+report, and then the next day they'd follow
+all my plans. You see I've got a map of
+every road in the county here," and as he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[127]</a></span>
+spoke the young lieutenant drew from his
+pocket a paper on which had been traced
+every road and every little stream in the
+region, while the places where bridges were
+to be found were indicated by red marks.</p>
+
+<p>"Whew!" he added, throwing back his
+coat. "Isn't it warm! I don't believe
+there's been a summer like this in years.
+We've had showers and thunder-storms
+almost every day. The air now feels as if
+we'd get another one pretty soon, too."</p>
+
+<p>The air was exceedingly sultry, and a
+strange stillness seemed to be resting over all.
+Not a leaf was stirring, and as Tom looked
+up through the tops of the trees the bright
+blue of the sky appeared to be more intense
+than ever he had seen it before. Here and
+there separate masses of heavy clouds could
+be seen, which, with the sunlight streaming
+through them, glistened almost like silver.
+He knew the signs well. There was the
+appearance of a coming shower.</p>
+
+<p>"It's too hot to go on," said the young
+lieutenant. "I'm almost afraid to take my
+horse out in such heat. I've got the most
+of my work for the day done, though, and I
+thought that perhaps you might be able to
+help me out, Tom. You must know every<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[128]</a></span>
+bridge in this part of the country. Now you
+go over this map with me, and tell me if the
+places are marked right. I've been gone so
+long I'm not sure of myself, but you ought
+to know. It'll save me a trip in this broiling
+sun, if you can help me."</p>
+
+<p>Tom took the map and looked over it carefully.
+He was thoroughly familiar with the
+roads and streams, as the lieutenant had intimated,
+and in a brief time he had given him
+all the information he possessed.</p>
+
+<p>"There," said the lieutenant at last, folding
+the paper and restoring it to his pocket
+again, "that helps me out. I'd been over
+most of the way, and the two or three places
+you have told me about finishes the whole
+thing. I'm ready to go back and report. I
+think I'll take a bite, though, before I start,
+and wait and see what the weather is likely
+to be."</p>
+
+<p>Going to his saddle-bags the young officer
+brought out the dinner which he carried with
+him. "Sometimes I stop at some farmhouse
+and get something to eat," he explained,
+"but it isn't always safe to trust to that, you
+see, so I always go provided. I want you to
+join me, Tom. It'll seem almost like old
+times."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[129]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The horse had been tied to one of the trees,
+and, as the lieutenant seated himself upon
+the ground, Tom gladly joined him. He
+was tired and hungry, and the piece of bread
+which he had in his own pocket would keep,
+and, as he was aware that he might find
+further use for it, he was the more willing to
+accept the invitation which had been given
+him. For a few minutes neither spoke, for
+they both seemed to be intent upon the
+immediate duty.</p>
+
+<p>As soon, however, as the first pangs of his
+hunger were relieved Tom said, "I never
+understood just why it was that the British
+left Philadelphia. They'd been there all
+winter, and after holding the city so long I
+never could understand why it was that they
+abandoned it without even a skirmish. What
+did they do it for?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, the way of it was this," replied the
+lieutenant, taking an unusually large bite of
+the bread he was holding in his hand, as he
+spoke. "You see, we'd been trying for a
+long time to get up some kind of a treaty
+with France. Ben Franklin, and I don't
+know who all, had been over there trying to
+work it up, and at last the Frenchmen agreed.
+Our Congress ratified the treaty on the 4th<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[130]</a></span>
+of last May, and that completely changed the
+plans of the redcoats."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't see just how that could do it,"
+replied Tom, somewhat puzzled.</p>
+
+<p>"Why it really means a declaration of war
+by the French against the British. I don't
+believe the Frenchmen care very much for
+us, barring young Lafayette and a few others
+of his kind, but they hate the British, and
+took this way to get even with them. It's
+expected that they'll send a fleet over here,
+and of course the redcoats have got to be
+ready to meet it,&mdash;that is, if they can. Well,
+Philadelphia doesn't amount to very much
+any way in war times. It isn't very easy
+to get into it, so the British there thought
+they'd better get out and go over to New
+York, which was a good deal more likely to
+be threatened by the French fleets. That's
+the cause of the change, my lad."</p>
+
+<p>"I should think the redcoats would feel
+like giving up, now that the French are
+going to join us."</p>
+
+<p>The young officer laughed as he replied:
+"That's just where you're mistaken, my
+young friend. They don't feel that way
+after they've sent so many armies over here
+and have spent so much money in discovering<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[131]</a></span>
+us, you see. And then, too, they don't object
+to getting a few taxes and such like
+things out of us, either. I've a dim suspicion
+that the Frenchmen may have just a
+bit of a dream that they may get back some
+of the country that dropped out of their
+hands during the French and Indian war.
+But, however that may be, we're glad to
+have their help now, for we need it badly
+enough, and will have to let the future take
+care of itself."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't see that any one can blame the
+British for wanting to hold on to us. They
+have spent a lot of money, and lots of their
+soldiers have been killed in the wars with the
+Indians and the Frenchmen."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh no, we don't blame them," laughed
+the lieutenant. "We don't blame them.
+It's all natural enough for them to want to
+hold on to us, but how about ourselves?
+What about the Stamp Act and the tea tax?
+What about all their oppression and the way
+they've treated us? They seem to forget
+that we're men of like passions with themselves.
+Oh, it's all natural enough for them
+to want to keep a good hold on us, but it's
+just as natural for us to object to being held
+on to. And, Tom, such things as have happened<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[132]</a></span>
+lately, too! Why, this story about
+Little Peter's mother is only one of a thousand
+here in Jersey. I've been pretty much
+all over the colony&mdash;the state, I mean&mdash;and
+it's the same story everywhere. It's just
+plundering, and robbing, and worse. And
+then to bring over here those Dutch butchers,&mdash;that's
+the worst of it all! To think of
+hiring those butchers! Why, it just makes
+my blood boil to think of it! And against
+us, too, who are their own blood relatives!
+That's more than human nature can stand!"</p>
+
+<p>Tom felt the contagion of the young lieutenant's
+enthusiasm, but he made no reply,
+and his companion continued, "The redcoats
+had a great time when they cleared out
+of Philadelphia. I was there and saw it
+myself."</p>
+
+<p>"You were there? I thought you were
+up at Valley Forge all winter!"</p>
+
+<p>"So I was, when I wasn't in Philadelphia.
+I had to go there sometimes, but I never
+wore my uniform then. Oh no, I didn't
+think it was very becoming to my peculiar
+style of beauty, so I always left it behind
+me."</p>
+
+<p>"What were you, a spy?"</p>
+
+<p>"That isn't what we call it," replied the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[133]</a></span>
+young officer, lowering his voice and glancing
+quickly about him at Tom's words, "Never
+mind what I was, but I was there and that's
+enough. I'm telling you now about the
+time the redcoats had when Sir William Howe
+gave over the command to Sir Henry Clinton.
+His officers got it up as a kind of a farewell,
+you see. They called it the Mischianza."</p>
+
+<p>"What's that? I don't understand."</p>
+
+<p>"What, the Mischianza? Oh, that's an
+Italian word, and means a 'mix up' or a
+'medley,' or some such thing; I don't know
+just what. But I'm telling you now what
+it was, and what they did. It commenced
+with a kind of a regatta which they'd arranged
+in three divisions. Up the river in
+front came the Ferret galley, and on board
+were some of the general officers and their
+ladies. Then came the Centre galley,&mdash;that
+was called the Hussar,&mdash;and carried both the
+Howes and Clinton and their suites, along
+with a lot of ladies. Behind came the Cornwallis
+galley, in which were Knyphausen and
+some of the British generals, and, of course, a
+lot of ladies.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, they looked fine, I can tell you,
+for I was in the crowd which watched the
+affair from the shore, and I saw every bit of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[134]</a></span>
+it. On each quarter of the galleys there
+were five flatboats, all lined with green, and
+having lots of people on board. Then, in
+front of the galleys, were three more flatboats,
+and a band of music was on board of each,
+and they could play, too, let me tell you, if
+they were redcoats. Six rowed along each
+flank, and they were all dressed up in bright
+colors, and so were the ships and the transport
+boats, which made a line all the way
+down to the city. All the wharves were
+crowded and the people were just wild. The
+boats started out from Knight's wharf&mdash;that's
+away up in the northern part of the
+city, you know&mdash;and rowed all the way
+down to Market wharf. There they rested
+on their oars, the bands played 'God save the
+King,' the people shouted and sang, and I
+couldn't help feeling something of the excitement,
+though I hate the very sight of a
+redcoat.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, they landed at the Old Fort, and
+the bands were still playing, and the Roebuck
+fired seventeen guns and then the Vigilant
+fired seventeen more. The grenadiers had
+been drawn up in a double file on shore, and
+the company then marched up between the
+lines. They had horsemen there, too, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[135]</a></span>
+what with the bright dresses of the ladies
+and the bright favors of blue and white ribbons
+on the breasts of the managers, who
+moved in front of the procession, and the
+uniforms and all, it was a great sight. I
+should have thought Lord Howe would almost
+have been sorry he was going to leave.</p>
+
+<p>"The avenue led up to a big lawn, which
+was all fixed up with arches and rows of
+benches, rising one above another, where the
+ladies were to be seated; and then they had
+some tilts and tournaments, something as they
+used to have in old England. There were
+young ladies there, too, lots of them, and they
+were all dressed up in Turkish costumes, and
+such like.</p>
+
+<p>"Pretty soon the trumpets sounded, and
+then a band of knights, dressed in red and
+white silk, on horses all decked out in the
+same colors, advanced. Lord Cathcart was
+the chief, and he had squires to carry his
+lances and others to carry his shield, and two
+black slaves with silver clasps on their bare
+necks and arms held his stirrups. The band
+then marched around the square and saluted
+the ladies, and then the herald, after a great
+flourish of trumpets, declared the ladies of
+the Blended Rose were ahead of all others.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[136]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"When the challenge had been given the
+third time, some other heralds and a trumpeter
+came in, along with a lot of knights
+dressed up in black and orange, and after
+going through a lot of motions and the bands
+had played, the herald proclaimed that the
+Knights of the Burning Mountain were prepared
+to contest the claim of the others.
+Then the gauntlet was thrown down and
+picked up, and the encounter began.</p>
+
+<p>"After they had met four times, the two
+leaders, Lord Cathcart and Captain Watson,
+advanced and began a contest between themselves.
+After they had kept it up a little
+while, the marshal of the field rushed in between
+them, and declared the ladies were all
+right on either side, and commanded the men
+to stop. Then bands filed off in different
+directions, playing lively tunes and saluting
+the ladies as they marched.</p>
+
+<p>"Then the whole company marched through
+great arches to the garden, and then up into
+the hall, which had been painted up to resemble
+Sienna marble. They had a faro table
+in that room and one great cornucopia all filled
+with flowers and fruit, and another one empty.
+Then they went to the ballroom, which was
+all painted in pale blue, and there were festoons<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[137]</a></span>
+of flowers, and I don't know what all.
+I never saw anything like it before. There
+were eighty-five big mirrors in the room, and
+they were all fixed out with ribbons and flowers,
+and as they sent back the light from the
+branches of waxlights, it made the room look
+bright enough, I can tell you. On that
+same floor they had four drawing-rooms,
+where they got their refreshments, and these
+rooms were all decorated and lighted up, too.</p>
+
+<p>"They kept up the dancing till ten, and
+then the fireworks began and the windows
+were all thrown open. I remember that the
+first of the fireworks was a great bouquet of
+rockets,&mdash;but that was only one, and they
+kept it up till twelve o'clock.</p>
+
+<p>"When midnight came, the great folding
+doors, which had been all covered over with
+flowers so that no one knew they were there,
+were thrown open, and there was a great
+room all decorated and lighted up, most too
+wonderful to tell about; and there, too, was
+a great table, which they said had twelve
+hundred dishes on it&mdash;just think of that,
+will you?&mdash;and four hundred and thirty
+people could sit down to the table at the same
+time.</p>
+
+<p>"They had supper then, and when they<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[138]</a></span>
+had finished that part of the programme the
+herald and trumpeters entered and proclaimed
+the health of the king and the royal family.
+Of course all the people there responded, and
+then there was a toast for the knights, and
+the ladies, and lots of others, and there was
+a great flourish of trumpets as each toast was
+announced.</p>
+
+<p>"Then they all went back to the ballroom
+and began to dance again. They kept it up
+till four o'clock, and I don't know how much
+later, for I left then."</p>
+
+<p>"And you saw it all?" said Tom slowly.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, almost every bit of it; 'twas a great
+sight, too. The like of it has never been
+seen before on this side of the water, and
+never will be again, I'm thinking. By the
+way, Tom, I heard a man there called by your
+name. It was Captain Coward, I think&mdash;though
+it may have been colonel or judge; I
+don't just recollect."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm sorry for him."</p>
+
+<p>"You needn't be. Just show that the
+name's of no account. But I've got to
+start now. I wish I could take you with me,
+but I can't. I'll see you soon, though, so
+good luck to you till we meet again."</p>
+
+<p>"But it's raining," said Tom quickly, as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[139]</a></span>
+the patter of the falling drops could be heard
+on the leaves.</p>
+
+<p>"Can't stop for that; I'm due at five
+o'clock, rain or no rain. Good-by to you,
+Tom, and thank you for your help. You've
+saved me a hard ride in such a day as this!"</p>
+
+<p>The young lieutenant was gone, and Tom
+waited for the shower to pass. The rain continued
+only a few minutes, but left the air
+still more sultry than it had been before, and
+walking became much more difficult.</p>
+
+<p>However, Tom started on as soon as the
+rain ceased, and kept steadily to his work
+until the sun was low in the heavens. His
+thoughts had been withdrawn, in a measure,
+from the camp at Hopewell, and he was thinking
+of the description which the young lieutenant
+had given of the Mischianza, and the
+brilliant scene which it must have presented.
+What could the poor and desperate Continentals
+do against men who had feasts like
+that? And Captain, or Colonel, Coward,
+who was he? Tom found himself thinking
+of the man, and wondering how he came to
+have the name.</p>
+
+<p>He turned the bend in the road and saw
+a band of soldiers marching directly toward
+him, and not far away. Startled by the sight,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[140]</a></span>
+he stopped a moment and gazed intently at
+them, striving to discover whether they wore
+red coats or buff; but they were covered with
+dust and he could not decide.</p>
+
+<p>He quickly realized that he must act, and
+he had just turned about, prepared to run
+back in the road, when he heard several shots
+fired at the approaching men from the woods
+by the roadside.</p>
+
+<p>The band instantly halted and prepared
+to defend themselves. Without waiting to
+watch the contest, he once more turned to
+run, when he obtained a glimpse of men behind
+him, partially concealed among the trees
+and standing with their guns raised to their
+shoulders, and with their attention fixed upon
+the advancing soldiers.</p>
+
+<p>Were the men friends or foes? Tom
+could not determine; and, trembling with fear
+and excitement, he stopped. He was between
+the opposing bands, while off on his right it
+was evident that other men were concealed.
+Thoughts of the Mischianza and of the captain
+with the unfortunate name were all gone
+now. He could not advance; he dared not
+retreat.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[141]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>TO REFUGEE TOWN</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">When</span> Little Peter re&euml;ntered the lonely
+house after his friend Tom departed, the full
+sense of his own sorrow for the first time
+swept over him. Up to this time the necessity
+of action had prevented him from fully
+realizing his loss. The death of his mother,
+the capture of his father, the provision he
+was compelled to make at once for his
+younger brothers and sisters, had so absorbed
+his thoughts that he had had but little time
+to dwell upon his own sorrow.</p>
+
+<p>With the departure of Tom, however, there
+came the reaction, and for a few moments
+the heartbroken lad was almost overcome.
+The very silence was oppressive. The only
+sound he could hear was the loud and regular
+ticking of the tall clock which stood in
+one corner of the kitchen. How proud his
+mother had always felt of that ancient timepiece!
+Many a time had she told him of its
+history and the pride with which she had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[142]</a></span>
+received it from her own father, when as a
+young bride she had first entered the new
+house which henceforth was to be hers. To
+Peter, it almost seemed as if the stately clock
+had been a member of the family, and its
+voice was almost human to him. On the
+summer afternoons, when he was a little
+fellow and his mother had been busied in
+her household duties, he had often stretched
+himself upon the sanded floor, and, resting his
+face upon his hands, with eager eyes had gazed
+up into the face of the old timepiece and
+listened to the swing of its long pendulum,
+which for him had had a language all its own.</p>
+
+<p>And now in the light of the early morning
+the old clock still stood in the corner and
+regularly ticked off the passing hours, as if
+it were unmindful of all the sad scenes to
+which it had recently been a witness. And yet
+to Peter it almost seemed, too, as if there was
+a tone of sadness after all in the monotonous
+tickings that day. Perhaps the old clock
+was striving to express its sympathy for the
+sorrowing boy, but not even its sympathy
+must be permitted to interfere with its duty
+in marking the passage of the swiftly flying
+minutes.</p>
+
+<p>The few antiquated chairs were standing<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[143]</a></span>
+just as they had stood when his mother had
+been there. The brass-rimmed mirror, the
+one ornament of the room, which hung over
+the low mantelpiece, reflected the scene before
+it, but in all the picture one figure was
+wanting and would be forevermore. Overcome
+by the full knowledge of his loss, Little
+Peter bowed his head upon his hands and
+leaned low upon the table, and burst into a
+flood of tears&mdash;the first he had shed since
+the sad event had occurred. Indian John was
+forgotten, the few chores about the place
+were ignored, and for a time the heartbroken
+lad gave way to his sorrow for the loss of
+his mother, upon whose face he never was to
+look again.</p>
+
+<p>How long he remained in that attitude he
+did not know, but he was recalled to the
+necessities of the present by the sound of
+footsteps outside the door. His first thought
+was that Indian John had returned, and he
+hastily rose to greet him; but quickly he perceived
+that the new-comer was not his Indian
+friend, but Barzilla Giberson, one of his nearest
+neighbors. If Little Peter had looked
+carefully into his neighbor's face, he would
+doubtless have noticed that the man was evidently
+somewhat troubled, and apparently was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[144]</a></span>
+not overjoyed at the prospect of an interview;
+but the lad was too busied with his
+own thoughts and sorrows to bestow a critical
+examination upon a neighbor's countenance,
+and Barzilla's evident uneasiness, therefore,
+was all passed by unnoticed.</p>
+
+<p>"Good-morrow to you, Little Peter," said
+Barzilla. "The women folks wanted me to
+come over and say to you that you were welcome
+to make your home with them, if you so
+chose."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you, Barzilla," replied Peter. "If
+I were going to stay here I should be glad to
+do that, but I'm going away this morning."</p>
+
+<p>"Sho! Ye don't say so! Where ye goin',
+if I may be so bold as to ask?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going to look up my father."</p>
+
+<p>"Where ye goin' to look him up?" said
+Barzilla, somewhat uneasily.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going down to Refugee Town first.
+I don't know what I'll do if I don't find him
+there."</p>
+
+<p>"Ye won't find him there," said Barzilla
+quickly. "In course I don't know where he
+is," he hastily added, "but I don't b'lieve
+ye'll find him there; and, besides, that's no
+place for a lad like you to go to alone, for I
+take it ye're goin' alone?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[145]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I'm going alone," replied Peter, to
+whom Barzilla's anxiety was not apparent.</p>
+
+<p>"In course it isn't for me to say what ye
+shall do and what ye shan't, but I don't
+believe a trip there will do ye any good.
+Ye've got to remember that other folks has
+suffered, too. Yer marm isn't the only one
+that's been shot, and yer pop isn't the only
+man that's been carried off by the British."</p>
+
+<p>"It wasn't the British that carried my
+father away," said Peter quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"'Twan't the British? Who was it then,
+I'd like to know?"</p>
+
+<p>"'Twas Fenton and his band, that's who
+it was."</p>
+
+<p>"Sho! I can't believe that! I reckon
+ye're mistaken, Peter. It must 'a' been the
+redcoats."</p>
+
+<p>"It was Fenton," repeated Peter decidedly.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't b'lieve it," said Barzilla, rising as
+he spoke. "I can't b'lieve it. However,
+Peter, we'll look after yer place. The women
+folks or I will do the chores for ye, while
+ye're gone. It's only neighborly, ye know,
+and what's friends good for if they can't
+help in a time like this?"</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you," said Peter quietly. "There
+isn't much to be done, but if you'll look<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[146]</a></span>
+after what there is, I shall be glad. The
+children are at Benzeor's house, you know."</p>
+
+<p>"So I hear. So I hear. Well, they're in
+good hands; ye can rest easy about that.
+Well, I must be a-goin'. Ye still think ye'd
+better go down to Refugee Town, do ye?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, good luck to ye. Good luck to ye.
+We'll look after the place," called Barzilla as
+he departed.</p>
+
+<p>If Peter had gone to the door, he would
+have discovered that Barzilla had not departed
+to go to his own house, but that after he had
+entered the road he had turned quickly and
+started in the direction in which the Navesink
+lay. But as Peter did not rise from his seat,
+he missed all that, and, besides, in all probability
+he would only have been puzzled by
+his neighbor's actions and unable to account
+for the haste with which he had made the
+change.</p>
+
+<p>Peter prepared his breakfast, and then
+waited for the coming of Indian John. The
+minutes passed, but the Indian did not put
+in an appearance, and the lad began to suspect
+that he would not return. At last, when
+the sun had appeared, his suspicions passed
+into certainty, and, resolving to wait for him<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[147]</a></span>
+no longer, he closed the house and started
+resolutely on the path which led down to the
+bank of the Navesink, where he kept his little
+skiff concealed.</p>
+
+<p>He soon arrived at the familiar place, and,
+after taking his oars from their hiding-place
+on the bank, pushed the little boat out into
+the stream and began to row. The heat of
+the morning soon began to make itself felt,
+but Peter did not cease from his labors. He
+was thinking of his father and where he
+might then be. He was hoping that he would
+be retained and sent to New York as a prisoner,
+for Little Peter was well aware of the
+value of the reward which was offered for
+every prisoner taken; but Fenton, eager as
+he was for money, was not likely to incur
+any unnecessary risk for himself by keeping
+any one near him who might prove to be a
+source of danger. And Little Peter knew
+that his father, especially after the recent
+events, was not likely to be quiet. Of what
+might then occur, the lad hardly dared to
+think. He only knew that what he was to
+do must be done quickly, if it was to avail,
+and he rowed on and on without once stopping
+for rest.</p>
+
+<p>He had covered about half the distance<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[148]</a></span>
+he was to go, when he heard a hail from
+down the river. Hastily turning about at
+the unexpected summons, he saw a little cat-boat
+slowly coming up the river, and now not
+many yards away.</p>
+
+<p>"It's Benzeor Osburn," said Peter to himself,
+as he obtained a glimpse of the man at
+the helm. "But who's that with him? It's
+Jacob Van Note. Yes, and that's Barzilla
+Giberson, too. What in the world"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>His meditations were interrupted by Benzeor's
+hail, "Where ye bound this mornin',
+Little Peter? There's to be no lookout to-day,
+is there?"</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't heard of any," replied Peter,
+looking at Barzilla and striving to understand
+how it was that the man who had so recently
+left his house could now be with Benzeor
+sailing up the Navesink.</p>
+
+<p>"I came down here after I left you," said
+Barzilla, as if he felt that he must reply to
+the question expressed in Peter's manner,
+"and I fell in with Benzeor, so I stopped and
+came back to tell him all about the doin's
+that have been goin' on since he went away.
+Benzeor's been gone from home two days
+and more, ye know."</p>
+
+<p>"Has he?" replied Peter. "No. I didn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[149]</a></span>
+know. Benzeor, the children are at your
+house. Sarah said I could leave them there
+and she'd look after them. If it isn't all
+right, I'll take them away as soon as I come
+back."</p>
+
+<p>"It's all right. In course it's all right.
+Barzilla here has been tellin' me about your
+troubles. It's hard, Peter, but then ye know
+that lots of people have been served the
+same way. 'Misery loves company,' ye
+know."</p>
+
+<p>As Peter made no reply, Benzeor quickly
+began to talk again, too quickly the lad
+might have perceived, if he had not been so
+filled with his own thoughts that all else
+seemed to escape his observation. "Barzilla
+tells me as how ye're goin' down to Refugee
+Town to look up yer pop. Is that so?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I'm tellin' ye it won't do any good.
+He isn't there&mdash;leastwise, that is, I don't
+believe he's there. In course I don't know
+anything about it, but it stands to reason he
+isn't. Ye'd better let me take yer skiff in
+tow, as I've done with Barzilla's, and come
+along back with us."</p>
+
+<p>"I think I'll go on. If I don't find him
+there I can report to Captain Dennis. Perhaps<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[150]</a></span>
+he'll be able to help me a bit, if it's
+not too late."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Dennis was in command of the
+local militia, and he and his men already had
+had several skirmishes with the pine robbers.
+Indeed, the militia had been enrolled with
+the very purpose of protecting the scattered
+homes from the inroads of the outlaws and
+refugees. Thus far, however, their efforts
+had not met with a very marked success.</p>
+
+<p>Peter did not observe the scowl which
+crept over Benzeor's face at the mention of
+the name of Captain Dennis. "Have it
+your own way then," said the man gruffly.
+"They say there's no fool like an old fool,
+but for downright foolishness give me the
+young fool every time. I'm tellin' ye that
+ye won't find yer pop down at Refugee Town,
+but ye'll have to find it out for yerself, I
+suppose."</p>
+
+<p>Surprised as Peter was at the abrupt change
+in Benzeor's manner, his own purpose was
+not changed, and without replying he picked
+up his oars and began to row again. He
+could see the men in earnest conversation as
+he drew away from them, but it had not yet
+entered his thoughts that anything could be
+wrong with them. He was puzzled to account<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[151]</a></span>
+for Barzilla's unexpected presence, but
+his offer to look after his home in his absence
+was still fresh in his mind, and left no room
+for suspicion.</p>
+
+<p>As for Benzeor, Little Peter knew that he
+was considered as a strange man,&mdash;"odd,"
+the country people termed it,&mdash;and he gave
+little heed to him or his words. His one
+purpose now was to go to Refugee Town.
+He had but little fear of meeting the men
+who had assembled there, although he knew
+they were all desperate and reckless. They
+would not harm him, he thought, and it was
+possible that he might find his father there,
+or learn of his whereabouts. Just what he
+would do if he should find him, he did not
+know. In any event, he would be with him
+again, and if he was to be sent as a prisoner
+to the sugar-house in New York, or to the
+Whitby or the Jersey, at least his captivity
+might be shared.</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, Little Peter rowed steadily
+forward and in the course of an hour arrived
+at the mouth of the Navesink. Then he
+landed and hauled his skiff up on the shore,
+striving to conceal it among the bushes which
+grew there. It was only a mile now across
+the sandy strip to the shore of the ocean, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[152]</a></span>
+the lad began to walk rapidly. Refugee
+Town was not far away, and the end of his
+journey would soon be gained.</p>
+
+<p>The heat of the sun was now intense.
+Across the sands he could see eddies in the
+heated air, and he felt as if he were breathing
+the blasts from an oven. His face was
+streaming with perspiration, while the touch
+of the sand beneath his feet seemed almost as
+if it would blister them.</p>
+
+<p>He soon arrived at a place from which he
+could look out upon the ocean, and it was
+with a sigh of relief he felt its first cool
+breath upon his face. Refugee Town now
+was not far away, so he began to run.</p>
+
+<p>He stopped as he saw two gunboats riding
+at anchor about a quarter of a mile out from
+the shore. What could it all mean? They
+were British vessels, their flags disclosed that;
+but what was their purpose in casting their
+anchors there?</p>
+
+<p>He was upon the beach now, and stopped
+for a moment to gaze at the graceful vessels.
+He thought he could almost make out the
+figures of the sailors on the deck. And a
+little boat was just approaching the larger
+of the gunboats. Doubtless it had been
+ashore and was now returning.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[153]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"How!"</p>
+
+<p>Peter turned suddenly as he heard the
+exclamation, and saw Indian John standing
+before him. His alarm subsided as he recognized
+his friend, and he said reprovingly, "I
+thought you were going to go with me this
+morning, John. Why didn't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"John been. Go to 'Gee Town. No fader
+there."</p>
+
+<p>"What, my father isn't there? Are you
+sure, John?"</p>
+
+<p>The Indian made no reply, evidently considering
+his first words sufficient. He was
+gazing intently at the boats in the distance,
+and Little Peter almost unconsciously turned
+and followed his look. At first he could discover
+nothing to indicate what had interested
+his companion; but he soon saw that the
+little boat, which he had thought was returning
+to the gunboat, was coming to the shore.
+Startled by the sight, he was about to inquire
+of John whether he knew anything concerning
+the vessels, when he heard a shout.</p>
+
+<p>At a distance of a hundred yards up the
+beach he saw a motley crowd approaching.
+Negroes and poorly clad men were among
+them, and the appearance of all revealed that
+they were doubtless from Refugee Town.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[154]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Their own presence was discovered at the
+same time, and a shout greeted them.</p>
+
+<p>"Come!" said Indian John quickly; and
+in an instant Little Peter obeyed, and both
+were running swiftly over the sand along the
+beach.</p>
+<div class="figright" style="width: 304px;">
+<img src="images/illus163.jpg" width="304" height="500" alt="&quot;THEY&#39;RE AFTER US, JOHN!&quot;" title="" />
+<span class="caption">&quot;THEY&#39;RE AFTER US, JOHN!&quot;</span>
+</div>
+<p>Their flight was greeted by another shout
+from the men behind them, and one or two
+guns were discharged, but the bullets passed
+harmlessly over the heads of the fugitives.
+One glance, however, showed Peter that some
+of the men had started in pursuit.</p>
+
+<p>"They're after us, John!" he said in a
+low voice to his companion.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly increasing their efforts, they sped
+swiftly on in their flight, but the shouts,
+which were now redoubled, betrayed that the
+pursuit had not been abandoned. On and
+on ran pursuers and pursued, while at intervals
+a gun was discharged and the calls and
+shouts could be distinctly heard.</p>
+
+
+
+<p>For a half mile the flight had continued,
+and Peter was beginning to feel that he could
+go no farther. The hot air of the summer
+morning, the burning sand beneath his feet,
+as well as the weariness arising from his previous
+exertions, combined to sap his strength.
+His breath was coming in gasps now, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[155]</a></span>
+down his face the perspiration was pouring
+in streams. He felt that he could go no
+farther.</p>
+
+<p>Another glance behind him showed that
+the men had not abandoned the pursuit. A
+half dozen of them were still running swiftly
+along the beach, and to Little Peter it seemed
+as if they were gaining upon him.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[156]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>BATHSHEBA'S FEAST</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Indian John</span> had been slightly changing
+the direction in which they were running,
+although Little Peter had not perceived the
+change. At first they had kept close to
+the water's edge, and at times the creeping
+tide had rolled up to their feet. As his companion
+had gradually drawn closer to the
+higher ridge which extended somewhat farther
+back from the beach, Peter had thought
+nothing of the slight divergence, except that
+the Indian was desirous of keeping a little
+farther from the water.</p>
+
+<p>Along this ridge in advance of him, Peter
+saw that thick bushes and stunted trees were
+growing, and he thought of the possibility of
+finding some hiding-place there; but he was
+hardly prepared for the change which Indian
+John then made. They had just passed a
+bend in the ridge which shut out the view
+of their pursuers, and come to a little gully
+which the winter storms had in the course of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[157]</a></span>
+many years cut deep into the bank. Here
+Indian John turned sharply, and, bidding his
+companion follow him, turned directly into
+the woods, which extended from the shore
+far back into the adjoining country.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter instantly followed, but they
+had not gone many yards before they came
+suddenly upon a wigwam in the midst of the
+forest. Indian John stopped, and, after a
+few hurried words with the Indian who was
+standing near and who had silently watched
+the approaching fugitives, beckoned for Peter
+to follow him, and both entered the conical
+shaped dwelling and threw themselves upon
+the ground.</p>
+
+<p>The lad was so thankful for the respite,
+and was so nearly exhausted by his efforts,
+that for a time he said nothing, being only
+too glad of an opportunity to rest. Every
+moment he expected to hear the voices of their
+pursuers, and more than once was on the
+point of starting forth from the hut and
+resuming his flight, so certain was he that
+the men had discovered the hiding-place.</p>
+
+<p>After a time he was positive that he was
+not deceived. He could hear the voices of
+men in conversation with the Indians, and all
+of his fears returned. His companion placed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[158]</a></span>
+his hand upon the arm of the trembling lad,
+and Peter waited, listening intently, and fearful
+every moment that some one would enter
+the hut and summon them to come forth.</p>
+
+<p>The conversation lasted several minutes,
+and then abruptly ceased. Peter could not
+determine whether the strangers had departed
+or not; but he waited anxiously and did not
+speak.</p>
+
+<p>The moments slowly passed and his suspense
+increased. It seemed to him that he
+must escape from the place in which he was
+concealed. The very air was strangely oppressive,
+and the ignorance as to what was
+going on outside the wigwam increased the
+anxiety of the frightened boy.</p>
+
+<p>He did not know where he was, nor who
+were the people whose abode Indian John
+had so unceremoniously entered. No voice
+within or without the hut could now be
+heard, and the silence itself added to his
+alarm.</p>
+
+<p>He could see that Indian John was seated
+upon the ground with his head resting upon
+his knees. He had not moved nor changed
+his position since they had entered. Motionless
+as a statue he remained seated, as if he
+were utterly unmindful of all about him.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[159]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"John!" whispered Little Peter at last.</p>
+
+<p>The Indian raised his head and looked at
+his companion, but did not speak.</p>
+
+<p>"John, don't you think we'd better start
+on again?"</p>
+
+<p>Indian John still made no reply, and his
+head dropped again upon his knees. Peter
+then perceived that his companion intended
+neither to speak nor to depart, and that he
+must wait in silence for him to explain his
+purpose, or to act.</p>
+
+<p>The impatient lad endeavored to possess
+his soul in patience, but as the moments
+passed his anxiety and fear increased. The
+uncertainty, he thought, was even more difficult
+to be borne than was the pursuit itself,
+for action of some kind was then possible,
+while this waiting in silence was almost unbearable.
+Not a sound could now be heard.
+The very birds were silent under the burning
+heat of the noontime, and the grating
+notes of the crickets had ceased.</p>
+
+<p>At last it seemed to him he could bear it
+no longer, and he was about to arise and
+go forth from the hut, regardless of consequences,
+when some one entered and spoke a
+few words in an unknown tongue to Indian
+John.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[160]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Come," said the Indian gently, standing
+erect as he spoke; and Little Peter at once
+followed him out into the open air.</p>
+
+<p>He glanced quickly about him, but no one
+was to be seen except three Indians, one of
+whom was a man, and the others, two women.
+Little Peter instantly recognized them as
+Moluss, or "Charlie" Moluss, as many of the
+whites called him, and his wife and her sister.</p>
+
+<p>The two women were busily engaged in
+preparing the contents of a small iron vessel,
+which was hanging from a stick supported
+by two forked branches, driven into the
+ground, and beneath which a brisk fire was
+burning.</p>
+
+<p>One of the women was feeding the fire,
+while the other was stirring the contents of
+the hanging pot. A savory odor greeted
+Little Peter's nostrils, and as soon as he perceived
+that he was in no immediate danger
+he realized that he was hungry; and, with the
+passing of his alarm, there came an eager
+interest in the occupation of the two women
+before him.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter had seen the trio many times
+before this. They had their home with
+others of their tribe in a little settlement
+several miles back in the interior. This settlement<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[161]</a></span>
+was commonly known as Edgepelick,
+or Edge Pillock, and to it the Indians had
+gradually withdrawn after they had disposed
+of their lands, for the good people of Old
+Monmouth were as scrupulous as their New
+England cousins in not taking the lands from
+the dusky owners without giving a so-called
+equivalent for them.</p>
+
+<p>It is true that this "equivalent" sometimes
+was a barrel of cider, or a piece of bright-colored
+cloth; but perhaps the Indians thought
+that was better than nothing, and as their
+lands were certain to be taken from them,
+even such an equivalent as that which was
+offered was not to be despised, and so they
+had submitted to the unequal exchange. At
+all events, the exchanges had been made, and
+in the summer of 1778, many of the Indian
+families were dwelling in Edge Pillock, and
+there continued to reside until the year 1802,
+when the men who had driven such shrewd
+bargains with them caused them all to be
+removed to Oneida Lake, in the neighboring
+State of New York.</p>
+
+<p>Charlie Moluss, with his wife and her sister,
+had been frequent visitors in Little Peter's
+home, and he knew them almost as well as he
+did Indian John. Somehow, they had not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[162]</a></span>
+been content to abide continuously in Edge
+Pillock, and at least twice each year came
+down to the shore, where they erected a wigwam,
+and while Moluss fished and gathered
+oysters and clams, the women made baskets
+and sold them among the scattered homes of
+the settlers. Doubtless this, then, was their
+annual visit, thought Little Peter, and their
+abiding place had been known to Indian John,
+who had sought its shelter as a place of
+refuge from their pursuers. And Little Peter
+was quite content, at least for the present,
+and his feeling of relief was not diminished
+by the savory odor which now arose from the
+iron vessel.</p>
+
+<p>Charlie Moluss's wife was a strikingly
+handsome Indian woman, and was known as
+Bathsheba, which the irreverent settlers had
+shortened into "Bath," as they had her
+sister's name into "Suke."</p>
+
+<p>Bathsheba was considered as an Indian
+queen, and the respect which the Indians
+showed her was, to a certain extent, shared by
+the white people, especially by the Quakers.
+She was regarded as a highly intelligent
+woman, and the most prominent people of
+the region were always glad to welcome her
+to their homes.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[163]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Little Peter thought of all these things as
+he seated himself upon the ground beside
+the two men, who were, apparently, as deeply
+interested in the occupation of the women as
+was he, himself. The work went steadily on,
+and, while Peter found that his hunger was
+increasing, he nevertheless listened to what
+Indian John told him of Moluss's success in
+turning their pursuers back to their camp at
+Refugee Town. Some of them had followed
+the fugitives as far as the wigwam, but had
+turned away after the Indian had professed
+his inability to give them the information
+they desired, and, doubtless, before this time,
+were safely back in "'Gee Town," as Indian
+John termed their little settlement by the
+Hook.</p>
+
+<p>Just why they had been pursued Indian
+John could not explain, but he had connected
+it in some way with the appearance of the
+boat off the shore, and Little Peter was not
+inclined to differ from his conclusion. He
+was satisfied now that his father was not to
+be found in Refugee Town, and he had decided
+to go farther down the shore to the
+place where he thought he would be likely
+to find Captain Dennis, or some of the local
+militia who had been stationed near to protect<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[164]</a></span>
+the salt works and strive to hold back the
+pine robbers, many of whom had their places
+of concealment not far away.</p>
+
+<p>Just at present, however, the thought of
+his dinner was uppermost in his mind. He
+eagerly watched Bathsheba and her sister in
+their work, and, from their movements, he
+concluded that his waiting time was soon to
+end. One of the women entered the wigwam
+and brought out several small wooden bowls.
+Into these she dipped some of the steaming
+contents of the iron vessel, placing each bowl
+upon the ground when it had been filled.</p>
+
+<p>A word from Bathsheba caused Moluss to
+arise, and, approaching the fire, he took one
+of the bowls in both hands and then seated
+himself upon the ground and proceeded to
+blow with his breath upon the soup, preparatory
+to drinking it.</p>
+
+<p>His example was speedily followed by Indian
+John and Little Peter, who took their bowls
+and seated themselves beside Moluss on the
+ground. An expression of deep satisfaction
+was manifest upon the faces of the two men,
+while the women, apparently proud of their
+success in the culinary art, looked on with
+evident pleasure. Little Peter also raised the
+bowl in his hands and blew upon it.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[165]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Good!" said Moluss, taking a long
+draught. "Good hop! Hop good!"</p>
+
+<p>"Good!" muttered Indian John, following
+his friend's example. "Good hop! Good
+hop!"</p>
+
+<p>"What?" said Little Peter suddenly, placing
+his bowl again on the ground before him
+as he spoke. "What was that you said,
+John?"</p>
+
+<p>"Good! Good hop," replied the Indian,
+with evident satisfaction.</p>
+
+<p>"You don't mean to say that hop-toads
+are in this soup, do you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Um!" replied Indian John, with a grunt
+of pleasure. "Good! Little hop-hop! John
+like um! Good hop! John like um little
+hop-hop!" And, suiting the action to the
+word, he proceeded to take a deeper draught
+of the savory mixture.</p>
+
+<p>All of Little Peter's hunger, however, had
+disappeared. He quickly arose from his seat,
+and, with an expression of disgust upon his
+face, which he could not entirely repress, prepared
+to pass the group and go into the forest.</p>
+
+<p>A loud laugh greeted his action, and as he
+passed Moluss, the Indian held forth his bowl,
+and said, "Peter like um hop-hop? Good!
+Moluss like um hop-hop! John like um hop-hop!<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[166]</a></span>
+Squaw like um hop-hop! All like um
+hop-hop! All like um hop-hop! Peter like
+um, too?"</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter was not to be tempted, and the
+broad grin upon the faces of the women, as
+well as the loud laugh of the men which followed
+him as he turned into the forest, did
+not tend to overcome his feeling of disgust.
+How was it possible that they could be willing
+to eat such filthy creatures as hop-toads?
+Little Peter was all in ignorance of some of
+the dainty viands which, under high-sounding
+names, are served up in our modern restaurants,
+and so, as a matter of course, could
+draw no comparison between the tastes of
+the rude, uncivilized savages and those of the
+more highly cultivated men of our own times.
+Perhaps he would not have compared them
+if he had been possessed of the prophet's
+foresight. He knew, however, that his own
+hunger had disappeared, and as he walked on
+he found many excuses for his uncivilized
+friends. They were welcome to their own
+customs, but they must not expect him to join
+them in their feasts.</p>
+
+<p>He had gone so far from the wigwam by
+this time that he thought the repast, which
+had so highly delighted his friends, would<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[167]</a></span>
+be ended by the time he could walk back.
+Accordingly, he reversed his steps, but as he
+walked on his own pressing problem returned
+in full force.</p>
+
+<p>His father was not to be found in Refugee
+Town, of that he felt certain; for, while Indian
+John had not said much, he knew him
+so well that he was satisfied he had known
+whereof he had spoken.</p>
+
+<p>Where, then, could he be? It was currently
+reported that Fenton's band had a
+place in the lower part of the county, to
+which they carried their booty and from which
+they started forth on their raids. It was just
+possible that his father had been taken there
+by the outlaws in their flight, but he would
+not long be retained there. Fenton knew
+what American prisoners were worth in the
+New York market, and, doubtless, he would
+find some means by which he could send him
+there. And the pine robber would act soon,
+too, for with the approach of the armies, there
+would be many opportunities for his own special
+work, and he would not long be hampered
+by the presence of a single prisoner, whose
+value would be slight compared with that of
+the plunder he might secure.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter decided that what he was to do<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[168]</a></span>
+he must do quickly. He would start at once
+for the place where Captain Dennis's men
+were said to be, and place the entire matter
+in their hands. The captain was a man whose
+bravery was well known in Old Monmouth,
+and he was ever ready to aid the scattered
+settlers.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Dennis would surely help him, too,
+Peter thought, and, with his heart somewhat
+lightened, he began to walk more rapidly.
+He would return to the wigwam and inform
+Indian John of his decision. If John would
+go with him, he would be glad of his aid,
+but, whether he went or not, the lad felt that
+his own problem was, in a measure, already
+solved.</p>
+
+<p>"Little Peter, is that you?"</p>
+
+<p>The startled lad looked up quickly at the
+unexpected summons, and saw, standing directly
+in his pathway, nine men. Each had a
+musket in his hands, but they wore no uniforms,
+and for a moment Little Peter could
+not determine whether they were friends or
+foes.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[169]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>WITH THE REDCOATS</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> fear in Tom Coward's heart, when he
+discovered that he was between the lines of
+the soldiers, made him almost desperate. The
+men before him already had raised their guns,
+and at any moment he expected to hear their
+report. When he had glanced behind him
+he had seen that the men there were also prepared
+to shoot, and he was in a position where
+he was likely to receive the discharges of both
+sides.</p>
+
+<p>Along by the side of the road was a deep
+ditch, which had been worn by the spring
+floods. Just at present there was no water
+in it, and Tom instantly threw himself upon
+the ground, and, still grasping his gun, rolled
+toward the place. As he slipped over the
+side he heard the discharge of the guns, and
+his heart almost stood still in his terror. The
+bullets, however, had all gone over his head,
+and the lad was unharmed, although he was
+so frightened that even the thoughts of his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[170]</a></span>
+own personal safety were almost driven from
+his mind.</p>
+
+<p>Shouts and calls followed the discharge of
+the guns, and then there was a rush of men
+past the place in which he was lying. From
+the direction from which the men had come,
+Tom concluded that those who were behind
+him had fled, and that the others were in
+swift pursuit of them. He did not dare to
+raise his head, nor try to obtain a glimpse of
+the combatants, but lay still in his hiding-place,
+hoping that in the excitement his presence
+would not be discovered. The shouts
+continued, but as they sounded farther and
+farther away, the trembling lad concluded
+that pursuers and pursued must have turned
+the bend in the road. If they kept on, he
+would soon be able to crawl forth from the
+ditch, he thought, and in the woods would
+find some place in which he might remain
+until all the immediate danger had passed.</p>
+
+<p>Still, he did not yet dare to leave his
+hiding-place, and, as the moments passed,
+his own fears and anxiety were not allayed.
+His face and hands were covered with the
+mud which had clung to them when he had
+slid into the ditch. The mosquitoes gathered
+about him, and, do what he would, he could<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[171]</a></span>
+not drive off the tormenting little pests. The
+sultriness which had followed the brief storm
+was almost unbearable, and Tom felt as if he
+could not have selected a worse place in which
+to conceal himself. There had not been
+much of any "selecting" about it, he grimly
+thought, for he had crawled into the first
+shelter that presented itself. A place in the
+muddy ditch was to be preferred to one in
+the middle of the road, and between two contending
+bands of soldiers. Here the bullets
+were not likely to find him, at least for the
+present, and his only hope depended upon
+the possibility of his presence not having
+been heeded. Perhaps the soldiers in either
+band had been so intent upon watching what
+the others would do, that a frightened lad
+between their lines would not be discovered.</p>
+
+<p>This hope was not strong enough to induce
+him to leave his shelter, and he decided
+to remain in the ditch until he was satisfied
+that all danger was past. The moments
+dragged on, and the silence which had followed
+the brief contest was unbroken. The
+heat was becoming more and more intense,
+and Tom felt that he could not remain much
+longer in his present position. Still, he
+waited and listened, but the sound of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[172]</a></span>
+cawing crows was all that he could hear. He
+counted off the minutes, and when what he
+judged must be an hour had passed, he concluded
+to remain there no longer. The men
+had not been heard in all that time, and
+doubtless must have disappeared from the
+immediate vicinity.</p>
+
+<p>The sight of the men had shown Tom that
+he was nearer the army than he had supposed.
+For a moment the thought of his
+former eager desire to join it came into his
+mind, and when he contrasted his feelings
+then with those he now had, his present position
+seemed almost ludicrous. Bespattered
+with mud, hiding in a ditch by the roadside,
+in constant fear of the return of the men,
+he certainly did not present the appearance
+of a very brave young soldier. Even Tom
+smiled as he thought of all this, but he was
+wiser than he had been a few days before
+this time, and the sound of guns was not
+exactly like that of which he had dreamed.</p>
+
+<p>Tom Coward was not lacking in bravery,
+however, but the position in which he had
+found himself certainly was a trying one,
+and perhaps the boldest of us might have
+done no better had we been caught in his
+predicament.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[173]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The time had now come, he thought, when
+it must be safe for him to venture out upon
+the road again, and, grasping his gun, he
+prepared to climb out of the ditch, when he
+suddenly paused as he thought he heard the
+sound of voices once more.</p>
+
+<p>Yes, there could be no mistake about it;
+the men were approaching from the direction
+in which both bands had disappeared.</p>
+
+<p>He crouched lower and waited for them to
+pass. If they were foes, it certainly would
+be wiser, as well as safer, for him not to
+attract their attention; and if they were
+friends he was hardly in a condition to present
+himself before them.</p>
+
+<p>The men were coming nearer, and were
+almost opposite his hiding-place now. The
+lad's excitement returned, and he leaned
+harder against the muddy bank. It seemed
+to him as if the loud beatings of his heart
+would betray him.</p>
+
+<p>The band had halted, and were within a
+few feet of the ditch. What could it mean?
+Had his hiding-place been discovered? He
+crouched still lower, and did not once look
+up. He clutched his gun in his hands as if
+he thought he could lean upon that. The
+suspense was intense, and almost unbearable.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[174]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Hello! Here's some one in the ditch!"</p>
+
+<p>Tom's heart sank, and, as he glanced
+hastily upward, he saw a redcoated soldier
+peering down at him. The end had come,
+and all his efforts to conceal himself had
+been in vain.</p>
+
+<p>"The fellow's alive," exclaimed the soldier
+in surprise. "Come up out of that and give
+an account of yourself!"</p>
+
+<p>Tom obeyed, and, crawling up the bank,
+stood facing the men. There were thirty-five
+or forty of them, and, as he saw that
+they were clad in the British uniform, he
+realized that he was in the presence of the
+enemy. The suspense, at least, was ended
+now, and, as he glanced at the soldiers, in
+spite of the fact that he was well aware of
+his danger, much of his alarm had disappeared,
+for Tom Coward was not unlike
+others in being stronger to face the actual
+condition than the uncertainty which is connected
+with the approach of perils.</p>
+
+<p>The men glanced curiously at him a moment
+and then burst into a loud laugh. The
+troubled boy at first could not discover the
+cause of their merriment, but as he glanced
+at his hands and saw that they were covered
+with the mud which was not yet dry, he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[175]</a></span>
+realized that doubtless his face and clothing
+were in the same condition. And Tom's
+appearance was not very prepossessing at that
+moment. His hat was gone, his face was so
+completely covered with mud that any one
+would have had difficulty in deciding whether
+he was white or black, and his bearing was
+far from being bold.</p>
+
+<p>The laughter of the men continued until
+an officer approached and said, "Who are
+you? What were you hiding for?"</p>
+
+<p>Tom hesitated a moment, and then replied,
+"I was trying to keep out of the way of your
+bullets."</p>
+
+<p>Again the soldiers laughed, and the officer
+said, "You didn't differ very much from the
+other fellows in the band, although they took
+to the woods and you to the ditch."</p>
+
+<p>"What band?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, those men of Dickinson's we've
+just driven away. You don't mean to say
+that you didn't belong to them?"</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't belong to any band," said Tom
+slowly. "I was just coming across the country,
+and when I stepped out into the road I
+found I was right between you and the other
+fellows. I crawled into the ditch, for I was
+afraid that both of you would hit me."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[176]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Quite right, my lad, quite right. But
+how does it happen that you carry a rifle?
+The most of the Yankees are glad enough
+to get muskets, and here you are traveling
+round the country with a rifle. I'm afraid
+your story won't do, my lad. We'll have to
+take you along with us, and let you tell your
+story to the colonel."</p>
+
+<p>Tom perceived that any further protest on
+his part would be useless, and, as the word
+to advance was at once given, he obediently
+took his place in the ranks and marched on
+with the men.</p>
+
+<p>The heat was so intense that they were
+compelled to halt frequently for rests. A
+few of the men evidently were Hessians, and
+their high jack-boots, their heavy fur hats, as
+well as the short broadswords they carried, in
+addition to the short guns or carbines which
+were slung over their shoulders, seemed sadly
+out of place under the burning heat of the
+summer day. Tom did not know how the
+British officers had protested against the customs
+of their allies, so unsuitable in the country
+in which they were fighting; but the
+men from Hesse were obstinate, and, firmly
+believing that the equipment which had been
+good enough for them in the old country<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[177]</a></span>
+would certainly be good enough in the new,
+clung to the uncomfortable garments and
+unwieldy arms, unmindful alike of the jeers
+of their comrades in arms and the danger
+they incurred by the use of them.</p>
+
+<p>In the course of two hours the band arrived
+at a little camp in command of a man whom
+the leader addressed as Colonel Simcoe. Tom
+was at once summoned by him and taken into
+the presence of the colonel, or lieutenant-colonel,
+as he then really was.</p>
+
+<p>"What have you here?" inquired the
+colonel, glancing at Tom as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"We picked this fellow out of a ditch
+back here. We had a little brush with a
+band of Dickinson's men, but they didn't
+wait for us. We chased them a mile or two
+up the road; but the day was so warm, and
+as the rebels took to the woods, we soon gave
+it up and came back. We found this fellow
+on our return. He claims he doesn't belong
+to the rebels; but as we found that he carried
+a rifle, we thought best to bring him
+into camp with us. We didn't know but
+he might be able to give you some of the
+information you wanted just now."</p>
+
+<p>"You did right, lieutenant. I'll talk with
+him later. Now tell me what you learned.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[178]</a></span>
+Did you hear anything more about Washington?
+How are the roads and the bridges?"</p>
+
+<p>"The rebels have been tearing up the
+bridges, and Dickinson has a good many of
+the militia scattered along in the woods. I
+rather suspect they are planning to serve us
+as the countrymen served Lord Percy up at
+Lexington."</p>
+
+<p>"I fancy we shall be able to put a stop to
+that, though your report is much like that
+which I have found out myself. Did you
+hear anything more of Washington?"</p>
+
+<p>"I couldn't get a word out of anybody.
+I don't believe he's moved from the position
+he held yesterday, though."</p>
+
+<p>For several minutes the men conversed, and
+when at last the younger officer departed,
+Colonel Simcoe turned to Tom and said,
+"Now, my lad, I'll listen to your story."</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't any story," replied Tom. "I
+was coming through the woods back here, and
+when I stepped out into the road I found myself
+right between the two bands, and as I was
+afraid I'd be caught by the fire of both of
+them, I crawled into the ditch to be out of
+the way. That's why I'm covered with this
+dirt," he added apologetically.</p>
+
+<p>"You don't need any one to confirm your<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[179]</a></span>
+words as to that," said the colonel, smiling
+slightly, as he spoke, at Tom's appearance.
+"Now what I want to know is who you are
+and what you were doing with a rifle? Few
+people here carry rifles, I find."</p>
+
+<p>Tom hesitated a moment, not knowing just
+what to say in reply to the question. The
+colonel was watching him intently, and the
+lad felt that he must say something. "I live
+back here," he said at last. "I've lived in
+Old Monmouth all my life. I'd started out
+from home to go to&mdash;to&mdash;to some of my
+friends, and, as I told you, I got caught between
+the lines."</p>
+
+<p>"How about the rifle?"</p>
+
+<p>"My father had the other guns and I had
+to take that. The last thing he told me was
+to take a gun and scare the blackbirds and
+crows from the ten-acre lot."</p>
+
+<p>"Is your father a loyalist?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"That's good; and now if you can answer
+my questions, perhaps I'll be inclined to let
+you go. You say you've lived here all your
+life. Do you know all the roads and bridges?
+Could you find your way anywhere in the
+county?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir; I think I could."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[180]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Tell me about the bridges. Have many
+of them been torn up?"</p>
+
+<p>Tom did not know, but he thought of his
+meeting with young Lieutenant Gordon that
+morning, and boldly answered, "Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>"How does it happen that your good
+father and the other loyalists permit that?"</p>
+
+<p>"My father's not at home, and there are
+too many of the pa&mdash;of the rebels."</p>
+
+<p>"I thought you told me your father sent
+you out with your gun," said the colonel
+quickly. "How is that? How could he
+send you if he wasn't at home?"</p>
+
+<p>"He sent me before he left," replied Tom,
+his voice trembling in spite of his efforts to
+control it.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know where Washington is?"
+inquired the colonel abruptly.</p>
+
+<p>"I hear he's up by Hopewell. I don't
+know." Tom might have added that he
+would be glad to learn, but his wish was not
+expressed.</p>
+
+<p>"That's right. He <i>is</i> at Hopewell. Is
+there any talk about his plans? Have you
+heard of any rumors among the rebels as to
+what he plans to do?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir. I hear he is planning to fall on
+Clinton's baggage train."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[181]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Sir Henry Clinton, you mean, I suppose,"
+said the colonel sharply. "Do you think
+you could find your way from here to Cranberry?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know every road?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, then, I shall expect you to go
+with a party to-night and show them the
+way."</p>
+
+<p>"But," protested Tom, "I thought you
+said I could go if I answered your questions."</p>
+
+<p>"You'll have to stay now. Your father's
+a good loyalist, you say, and he'll not object
+to his son's remaining here for a day or
+two and serving as a guide. I'll see that
+you have some supper and are ready to start
+before it's dark."</p>
+
+<p>Tom left the colonel's presence, and with
+a heavy heart turned to look about the little
+camp.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[182]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIV</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE WAY TO CRANBERRY</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">It</span> was late in the evening when Tom
+started from Colonel Simcoe's camp in company
+with the lieutenant, whose name he had
+learned was Ward, and the band of six men.
+A hearty supper had greatly refreshed the
+weary lad, and although he was aware that
+his companions were not without suspicions
+of him, he still had hopes that he would be
+able to convince them of his knowledge of
+the country roads, and then could leave them.
+His efforts to convince the colonel that he
+was merely a country lad, who had taken no
+part in the hostilities, had not been without a
+measure of success, and if they met with no
+mishap on the road, doubtless they would be
+willing for him to depart.</p>
+
+<p>As to leading the little band into Cranberry,
+Tom had not the slightest objection to
+that, for it would be going directly toward
+the place where Washington's army lay, and
+every step was one nearer the men whom he
+was most eager to join.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[183]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The entire party were mounted, and a
+horse was also provided for Tom. To be
+sure, the steed was not a remarkable one, yet,
+as the lad looked him over before he mounted,
+he was satisfied that riding would be much
+easier than walking, and of walking Tom had
+had sufficient, he thought, on that hot June
+morning.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, my lad," said Lieutenant Ward, as
+the party prepared to move, "if you do well
+by us this night, I have two half joes for
+you in my pocket. On the other hand, if you
+fail us, or try to lead us into any trap, you
+shall have a good taste of the lead my men
+carry, or know how it feels to dance at one
+end of a rope with your feet a good yard
+from the ground. You hear what I'm saying,
+don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir," Tom replied. "I can lead you
+straight to Cranberry, but of course I can't
+tell what men we shall meet on the way. All
+I know is that General Dickinson has men out,
+just as you have."</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind your 'General' Dickinson.
+I only wish we might have the good fortune
+to meet the rebel himself. You show us the
+way and we'll look after any of his men we
+may fall in with. All we want of you is to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[184]</a></span>
+show us the way. They won't be likely to
+be out on the road in the night."</p>
+
+<p>Tom by no means felt so positive concerning
+that as the lieutenant did, but the word
+to start was then given, and mounting his
+horse he departed from the camp with the
+men.</p>
+
+<p>The moon was now full and hung low in
+the heavens like a great ball of fire. The
+frogs in the swamps were croaking loudly as
+the men rode past. The air of the summer
+night was almost motionless, and the heat
+of the day had only slightly decreased with
+the coming of the darkness. In all his life
+in Jersey, Tom had never known a hotter
+"spell"&mdash;as the natives termed it&mdash;than
+they had experienced during the past few
+days. A Hessian was riding beside him, and
+Tom could not understand how it was that he
+still insisted upon wearing the heavy fur hat
+in such weather.</p>
+
+<p>So intensely warm was the night that the
+band were compelled to halt at frequent
+intervals to rest their dripping steeds. The
+occasional breeze was like the hot breath from
+an oven, and, in spite of the fact that he was
+riding, Tom's face was wet with perspiration.
+The progress was necessarily slow, but the lad<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[185]</a></span>
+soon came to Doctor's Creek, and as they
+found the bridge across that stream intact,
+the lieutenant was pleased and warmly praised
+the young guide.</p>
+
+<p>The Assanpink Creek was crossed not long
+afterwards, and as the bridge across that also
+was still standing, the elation of the leader
+was visibly increased and he ordered the men
+to halt for another rest. Some without removing
+their clothing waded into the stream,
+which was narrow and shallow where they were,
+and led their horses in after them. The heaving
+sides of the poor beasts were wet with
+sweat and foam, and the men themselves
+seemed to be but little better. Tom thought
+he had never suffered more from the heat.</p>
+
+<p>After a rest of a half hour the men resumed
+their journey. Thus far no one had been
+met on the road, and the confidence of the
+band was steadily increasing, in spite of the
+fact that they were approaching the region in
+which the American army was supposed to be.</p>
+
+<p>Five miles farther on they came to Rocky
+Branch and the bridge over this stream was
+as strong and safe as those they had left
+behind them.</p>
+
+<p>"The half joes are likely to be yours, my
+boy," said the lieutenant.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[186]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Tom made no reply, for he was thinking
+that something beside safe bridges might be
+discovered before they arrived at their destination.
+Only one more stream remained to
+be crossed, and then they would be in Cranberry.
+Just where they were then to go, or
+what was to be done, Tom did not know.
+Not a word had been spoken to him concerning
+the object of the expedition, and all that
+he was expected to do was to lead the band
+to Cranberry.</p>
+
+<p>"How much farther have we to go, my
+boy?" inquired the leader.</p>
+
+<p>"That depends upon the place you've
+started for," replied Tom. "We shall be in
+Cranberry after we've gone about ten miles
+farther, but it covers a good many miles.
+The township is a big one."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll decide that after we get there.
+Have we any more streams to cross?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes. The Millstone river isn't very far
+away now."</p>
+
+<p>The rests had become so frequent that
+morning could not be far away, Tom thought.
+With the appearance of the sun their dangers
+were likely to be increased, but he made no
+mention of the fears in his heart, and the
+band soon started on again.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[187]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>When they arrived at the Millstone, the
+first break in the success of the expedition
+was found, for the bridge was down. This
+plainly showed that the Americans were not
+far distant now, and as the lieutenant drew
+rein on his horse, he said,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"This means that Sir Henry will find difficulty
+in getting his baggage train across here.
+Do you know whether the stream can be
+forded?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," replied Tom, pointing as he spoke
+to a place a little farther down the stream.
+"We can wade our horses across there."</p>
+
+<p>"But can the baggage wagons be driven
+through?"</p>
+
+<p>"That I cannot say. I think not."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll soon find out," said the lieutenant,
+leading the way to the ford.</p>
+
+<p>The men all followed him, but as the
+water came well up to their horses' flanks, it
+was at once evident that Clinton would find
+great difficulty in getting his baggage train
+across. The party halted near the bank
+after they had crossed the stream, and the
+lieutenant had an earnest conversation with
+one of his men.</p>
+
+<p>Tom could not hear their words, but he
+had no doubt that they were discussing the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[188]</a></span>
+possibilities of Clinton's march by the way
+they had come that night.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll go on a bit farther," said the
+lieutenant at last, and the men obediently
+mounted and followed their leader.</p>
+
+<p>The gray of the dawn had just appeared
+in the east, and the air was filled with the
+songs of the birds. They were now in the
+township of Cranberry, and the end of their
+journey could not be far away, Tom thought,
+although he did not know what that end was
+to be. Thus far they had come without
+trouble, but with the coming of the morning,
+and their proximity to the American army,
+their difficulties were likely soon to be increased.</p>
+
+<p>The men were silent as they rode slowly
+forward, and were keeping a constant watch
+on every side. The sun by this time had
+made its appearance, and the day gave promise
+of being even warmer than the preceding
+one. Before them they could see two rude
+little houses on opposite sides of the road
+and at the end of lanes which led back from
+the roadside. The one on the left Tom instantly
+recognized as the abode of a Quaker
+named Nathan Brown, or "Friend Nathan,"
+as his neighbors called him. Many a time had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[189]</a></span>
+Tom been there, and even then he recalled
+many of the quaint expressions of the gentle
+man who had steadily opposed all the hostilities,
+in accordance with his creed which
+forbade even the resistance to tyrants.</p>
+
+<p>As the lieutenant saw the two houses he
+drew the rein on his horse, and the party
+halted.</p>
+
+<p>"It's time we had some breakfast," he
+said. "I am wondering whether we can't
+find something here in these houses. Do you
+know anything about them, my lad?"</p>
+
+<p>"I know the man that lives in the house
+on the left. He is a Quaker," replied Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"All the better for us. I think I'll let
+you go up to his house, and I'll send a man
+up to the other. The rest of us had better
+stay here and keep watch, for there may be
+some prowling rebels around here, for all that
+we may know."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll go," said Tom quickly. "But I can
+leave you then, can't I? We're in Cranberry
+now and all you wanted of me was
+to lead you there."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, if you wish," replied the lieutenant.
+"You've done well, but you'd do better
+still to go back with us. The rebels are
+not far away, and you may get into trouble.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[190]</a></span>
+You must do as you like, though," he added.
+"You've earned your pay," and he drew the
+two half joes from his pocket and handed
+them to Tom.</p>
+
+<p>The lad received the money, no small
+amount to him, and, after thanking the lieutenant,
+started quickly up the lane which led
+to Nathan's house. As he glanced behind
+him, he perceived that one of the men had
+started towards the other house, while all the
+others had dismounted and were still in the
+road, although they evidently were keeping a
+careful watch.</p>
+
+<p>When Tom drew near the house he saw
+the Quaker standing in the doorway. His
+broad-brimmed hat and the peaceful expression
+upon his face were in marked contrast to
+the warlike men he had just left behind him
+in the road.</p>
+
+<p>"How now?" said Nathan, as he perceived
+who the approaching man was. "Thee
+travels early, Friend Thomas; I trust all is
+well at thy house."</p>
+
+<p>Tom quickly dismounted, and in a few
+words explained how it was that he happened
+to be there, and what the purpose of his visit
+was.</p>
+
+<p>"Thee doesn't say so!" said Nathan in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[191]</a></span>
+surprise. "And the redcoats even now are at
+my door and seek refreshment?"</p>
+
+<p>"They are out in the road. They want
+some breakfast, and I think they'll pay you
+for it."</p>
+
+<p>"Friend Thomas, I think I can trust thee.
+I have known thee since thou wert a little
+lad. Ah, these are sad times for men of
+peace! The sons of Belial are on all sides.
+Verily, these days are days of wrath."</p>
+
+<p>Tom was puzzled by Nathan's manner and
+made no reply. The man turned quickly into
+the house and soon returned with a well-filled
+stocking in his hands. Tom instantly surmised
+what the stocking contained, for he was
+well aware of the banking purposes to which
+that article of clothing was turned in many
+of the homes.</p>
+
+<p>"Come with me, Friend Thomas," said
+Nathan, grasping a hoe as he spoke and leading
+the way into his garden. There he dug
+a hole, and, placing his "bank" within it,
+covered it again with the earth.</p>
+
+<p>"But Nathan," protested Tom, "if these
+men search your place for money they'll find
+this spot, and it'll show at once you've hidden
+something there. The earth is all fresh
+and moist here, and it's dry all around it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[192]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yea, thou speakest truly, Friend Thomas,
+but I have a thought by which I may yet
+outwit these men of war. Tarry here till I
+return."</p>
+
+<p>The Quaker instantly turned and again entered
+the house. In a moment he appeared,
+bearing a large bowl in each hand. One contained
+water, which he poured over the place
+where his money was concealed, and the other
+was filled with corn. He quickly scattered
+the corn over the wet ground, and then,
+turning towards the barn, called, "Chick!
+Chick! Chick! Come, chick! Come,
+chick!"</p>
+
+<p>Instantly there was a fluttering within the
+barns, the doors to which were wide open,
+and the hens came running from every direction.</p>
+
+<p>Nathan's face took on a meaning smile as
+he watched his flock hastening toward him
+for their breakfast, and then, turning to Tom,
+he said, "Is it plain to thee, Friend Thomas,
+that it is still possible for a man of peace to
+outwit these sons of Belial? Now go and
+tell thy companions that such food as I have
+shall be set before them."</p>
+
+<p>Tom laughed at the trick of the Quaker,
+and then ran back to his horse, and, mounting,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[193]</a></span>
+started towards his recent companions,
+whom he could see still waiting in the road.
+Doubtless they were becoming impatient by
+this time, and, without waiting to go all the
+way back to the road, he stopped at a distance
+and called to them, beckoning with his
+hand for them to come, as he shouted.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as he perceived that the lieutenant
+heard him, he turned about and once more
+rode back to Nathan's house. He then dismounted
+and tied his horse to a post which
+stood near to the kitchen door.</p>
+
+<p>As he glanced up he saw that the leader
+was riding alone up the lane and now was
+near the house. Just then he heard the
+sound of a horse behind him, and, turning
+quickly about, saw young Lieutenant Gordon
+dash past him on horseback.</p>
+
+<p>Amazed by the sudden and unexpected
+appearance of his friend, he stood still and
+watched him as he rode swiftly up the lane
+directly toward the approaching men. Gordon
+was leaning low on his horse's neck, and
+Tom could see that he was grasping a pistol
+in his right hand.</p>
+
+<p>Before the startled lad could fairly realize
+what was occurring, he saw the young lieutenant
+raise his weapon and aim it at the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[194]</a></span>
+approaching horseman. He waited for the
+report, but none came. Again Gordon raised
+his pistol, and once more it flashed without a
+report.</p>
+
+<p>His heart almost stopped when he perceived
+that the other members of the band had now
+entered the lane and were riding towards
+their leader, although as yet they were far
+behind him. The young lieutenant had also
+discovered them, and, instantly turning his
+horse about, dashed back up the lane, with
+the British lieutenant in swift pursuit.</p>
+
+<p>Unmindful of Tom, they swept past him,
+and Gordon turned the corner of the barn.
+Twice around the barn the men raced their
+horses, and then Gordon turned his horse into
+the open doorway and dashed through to the
+other side.</p>
+
+<p>After him followed the leader of the British
+band in desperate pursuit, and then, as Tom
+glanced up, he saw his recent companions
+come shouting and hallooing into the yard
+which was between the barn and Friend
+Nathan's little house.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[195]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XV</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE BOAT ON THE BAR</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">When</span> Little Peter discovered the presence
+of the men before him, his first impulse had
+been to turn and make a dash into the woods;
+but the call which he heard quickly changed
+all that. As one after another of the band
+appeared, he recognized some of them as men
+who had been enrolled in the local militia,
+and his alarm for a moment subsided.</p>
+
+<p>The one who had addressed him he remembered
+as a young man not much older than
+himself, who had all the summer been away
+from his home, busied with his friends and
+neighbors in protecting the salt works along
+the shore, and striving to hold back the outlaws
+from their raids in the county.</p>
+
+<p>The salt works were of especial value at
+this time, as some of them were owned by the
+government and aided in increasing the scanty
+revenues of the poverty-stricken country.
+Several of them already had been burned by
+tories or bands of sailors, who had landed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[196]</a></span>
+from some of the gunboats which had come
+to anchor off the shore for the purpose of
+inflicting such damage as lay within their
+power upon the adjacent region.</p>
+
+<p>"What are you doing here, Peter?" repeated
+the lad who had first spoken.</p>
+
+<p>As Little Peter now recognized the men
+before him as friends, he quickly related to
+them the story of the sad misfortunes which
+had come upon his home; and the many expressions
+of anger and sympathy which his
+words called forth were not unwelcome, we
+may be assured, to the troubled boy.</p>
+
+<p>When his brief story was told, the young
+man who had hailed him said, "We're on an
+errand that may fit into your feelings a bit.
+We're short one man, too. Don't you want
+to join us?"</p>
+
+<p>"What are you trying to do?"</p>
+
+<p>"We've just had word that a boat is
+aground off here on the bar, and we're going
+to see if we can't get her. We've got a
+whaleboat down here on the shore, and we're
+going to put out in her and see if we can't
+pull the other boat off and bring her in with
+us."</p>
+
+<p>"But there are a couple of gunboats not
+more than three quarters of a mile out," protested<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[197]</a></span>
+Peter. "You can't do anything while
+they are there."</p>
+
+<p>"We can try," said the man who was acting
+as the leader. "We're one man short,
+as Lyman here has just said, and if you feel
+inclined to join us we shall be glad to have
+you."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter hesitated. It was not alone
+the danger of the enterprise which troubled
+him. He was thinking of his father and his
+own purpose to discover whether he had been
+sent to New York or not.</p>
+
+<p>When he explained the cause of his perplexity,
+the leader said, "That's all right,
+Peter. We're going down to Tom's River
+just as soon as we've taken this boat out
+here. You see, our watch told us the boat is
+loaded with supplies, and, if we can get her,
+we're going to do a double deed, for we'll
+keep the others from having them, and we'll
+make good use of the stuff ourselves. Now,
+if you'll go along with us, you'll make another
+oar for us, and we'll be all the more
+likely to succeed. Then you can go with us
+down to Tom's River, and poor company will
+be better than none in times like these."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll go," said Little Peter quickly, and
+the march was at once resumed.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[198]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>As they approached the wigwam, where
+Peter had left his Indian friends, he stopped
+for a moment to explain to Indian John the
+cause of the change in his plans.</p>
+
+<p>John listened quietly until the lad had finished,
+and then said, "Me see um again."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter did not understand just what
+the Indian meant by his words, but he did
+not wait to inquire, for his friends were already
+in advance of him, and he hastened to
+rejoin them.</p>
+
+<p>No one spoke as they silently walked on
+to the shore, but when they had gained the
+bluff, Lyman suddenly said, "There! Look
+there, will you? The word was all right.
+The boat's aground out there on the bar."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter instantly recognized the boat
+as the one which he had seen approaching
+from the gunboats, and for which the band
+of men from Refugee Town had evidently
+been waiting. Doubtless they had mistaken
+him and Indian John for members of the
+neighboring militia, and the cause of their
+pursuit was now explained.</p>
+
+<p>The men did not hesitate now, but going
+to a place a little farther up the shore, they
+hastily removed a pile of brush and drew
+forth the long whaleboat which they had concealed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[199]</a></span>
+beneath it. The boat was not heavy,
+and, lifting it in their arms, they bore it
+down to the water's edge.</p>
+
+<p>Then grasping its sides, they ran with it
+into the water, and, at the word from the
+leader, scrambled on board. In a moment
+they were all seated, the long oars were
+drawn forth, and the men gave way with a
+will.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter was in the bow, next to his
+friend Lyman. The excitement now for a
+time banished from his mind the thoughts
+of his sorrow, and even the search for his
+father was for the moment forgotten.</p>
+
+<p>About three-quarters of a mile out at sea
+were the two gunboats riding at anchor, and
+resting as gracefully upon the water as if
+they had been birds. Directly before them
+was the supply boat, about a quarter of a mile
+from the shore, and not more than that distance
+in advance. They could see that four
+men were on board, and they were still striving
+desperately to push her off from the bar
+on which she had grounded.</p>
+
+<p>Not a word was spoken on the whaleboat
+now, and the men were all rowing with long
+and steady strokes. The ocean was unusually
+calm, but every lift of the heavy groundswell<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[200]</a></span>
+disclosed to them more clearly the outlines
+of the boat they were seeking. Their
+purpose had not yet been discovered by the
+men on the other boat, or if it had been discovered
+no token was displayed. It was more
+than possible that they were regarded as
+friends coming to the aid of the unlucky boat.</p>
+
+<p>In this manner several minutes passed, the
+whaleboat, meanwhile, making rapid progress
+over the water, driven forward by the efforts
+of the determined men. The long, sandy
+shore stretched away in the distance, the
+masses of clouds in the sky seemed to be
+lined with silver as the rays of the sun shone
+through them, and not a sound could be
+heard except the heavy breathing of the men
+and the regular clicks of the oars in the row-locks.</p>
+
+<p>In spite of the peacefulness of the scene,
+however, all the men in the whaleboat fully
+realized the desperate nature of their undertaking,
+and the likelihood that in a moment
+everything might be changed. Still, there
+were no evidences of action on the gunboats,
+and the men on the grounded boat betrayed
+no signs of alarm.</p>
+
+<p>"There are some men on the shore up
+yonder," said the leader, as he saw a group<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[201]</a></span>
+standing on the beach directly opposite the
+boat they were seeking. "They don't seem
+to be able to help them," he added. "I don't
+believe we've anything to fear from them.
+Give way, men! Give way!"</p>
+
+<p>The band responded with a will, and the
+whaleboat darted forward with increasing
+speed. The other boat lay only a few yards
+away, and the end had almost come. The
+excitement on board was intense now, and,
+although no one spoke, the expression on
+every face betrayed the feelings of the men.
+They could see that the others were watching
+them, but still they manifested no alarm at
+the approach of the whaleboat.</p>
+
+<p>As the latter ran in alongside, and the men
+quickly backed water, one of the sailors on
+the stranded boat&mdash;for such their uniforms
+disclosed them to be&mdash;called out, "You're
+just in time, men! We thought we'd never
+get this tub off the bar. The tide's coming
+in, but we're stuck fast."</p>
+
+<p>"That's just what we came for," replied
+the leader, as he threw a rope to the other
+boat. "Now make fast and we'll yank you
+off before you know it."</p>
+
+<p>One of the sailors caught the rope and
+made it fast, but evidently a change came<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[202]</a></span>
+over his feelings then, for, glancing suspiciously
+at the men before him, the one who
+had acted as the leader said, "You're from
+Refugee Town, aren't you? You're strangers
+to me, but I take it for granted you're
+all right!"</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir; we're militia from Old Monmouth.
+We've come out here to get you
+and your boat, too. Here, none of that!"
+he quickly added, as he saw the men turn to
+grasp their guns. "We'll send you to the
+bottom before you can tell your names if you
+try any of your games on us."</p>
+
+<p>At his command the men in the whaleboat
+quickly covered the others with their guns.
+For a moment the silence was unbroken.
+The advantage for the present was very decidedly
+with the attacking party. Not only
+did they outnumber the others, but they were
+also in a condition to act, and act quickly.
+The situation, however, could not long remain
+as it was. The gunboats were not more
+than a half mile away, and, doubtless, assistance
+would be sent as soon as the predicament
+of the men should be discovered.</p>
+
+<p>Then, too, there were the men on the shore
+to be reckoned with. Apparently, they had
+no boat with which they could come to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[203]</a></span>
+rescue of the luckless sailors, but they might
+soon obtain one, for Refugee Town was not
+far away. Why they had not already gone
+there was not apparent. Perhaps they were
+trusting to the aid of the rising tide and the
+efforts of the men.</p>
+
+<p>"Pass over your guns!" said the leader
+on the whaleboat.</p>
+
+<p>The men obeyed, and silently picked up
+and handed their guns to the attacking party.</p>
+
+<p>"Now we'll see what can be done," said
+the leader, after he had deposited the weapons
+on the bottom of the whaleboat. "These
+fellows are harmless now, and we'll take our
+oars and see if we can't pull them off from
+the bar."</p>
+
+<p>His men grasped their oars and began to
+row. The rope tightened, the boat started a
+little, but still stuck fast to the bottom. Again
+the men pulled desperately, but with all their
+efforts they could not move the grounded
+boat.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm afraid we'll have to cast overboard
+a part of the load," said the leader, when the
+third effort proved as futile as its predecessors.</p>
+
+<p>He arose from his seat and grasped the
+rope to pull the whaleboat nearer, when the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[204]</a></span>
+four men before him suddenly united in a
+loud shout, and, leaping from their seats,
+together grasped some other guns which had
+been concealed beneath the sailcloth, and,
+turning about before their captors could recover
+from their surprise, stood aiming their
+weapons directly at their faces.</p>
+
+<p>"It's our turn," laughed one of the men.
+"You'll hand over your own guns now!"</p>
+
+<p>No one in the whaleboat moved from his
+position. The leader still stood, leaning over
+the side and grasping the rope with his hands.
+Every one had been so startled by the unexpected
+summons that he seemed almost incapable
+of action.</p>
+
+<p>"Come, be quick about it!" said the sailor,
+as the men still did not move.</p>
+
+<p>A faint sound of a shout now could be
+heard from the shore, and the movements of
+the men there, as they ran about the beach,
+betrayed the fact that they were aware that
+something was wrong. In the distance, Little
+Peter could see that two barges filled with
+men were starting forth from the gunboats.
+The situation was becoming rapidly worse,
+critical as it then was.</p>
+
+<p>"Their guns aren't loaded, men!" called
+the leader suddenly. "They can't harm us."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[205]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Still his men did not respond. For an instant
+no one moved, while their fear was
+plainly evident from the expressions upon
+their faces. No one knew whether the leader's
+words were true or not, and in breathless
+suspense they waited, fearing every moment
+to hear the reports of the guns in the other
+boat.</p>
+
+<p>As the men did not fire, the leader quickly
+shouted again, "They're not loaded, I tell
+you! They can't hurt us! Don't pay any
+attention to them!"</p>
+
+<p>His words instantly served to arouse his
+companions, for they now knew that if the
+guns had been loaded they would have been
+discharged before this.</p>
+
+<p>The sight of the barges which had started
+forth from the gunboats, and the increasing
+confusion of the men on the shore, combined
+to render the attacking party desperate now.
+Whatever they were to do they must do
+quickly.</p>
+
+<p>The leader called to his companions to
+cover the others with their guns, and, drawing
+the whaleboat close up, said: "The
+boat's loaded with guns and powder! That's
+just what we want. Now you take your oars
+and push while my men row," he added,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[206]</a></span>
+speaking to the sailors. "The first one of
+you that draws back will get a dose of lead.
+Now! Quick! Do as I tell you!"</p>
+
+<p>The men sullenly laid down the empty
+guns, and, picking up their oars, began to
+push against the sandy bottom. The men
+in the whaleboat were rowing desperately,
+and soon could feel that the other boat had
+started.</p>
+
+<p>It was not yet free, however, and the leader
+called again to the sailors, "Harder, men,
+harder! You aren't half pushing. That's
+right! Harder yet! Harder, I say! We'll
+be out of this in a minute. Give way, men!
+You aren't asleep, are you? Pull! Pull!"</p>
+
+<p>In his eagerness, the leader laid down his
+gun, and, hastily grasping an oar, began
+to pull with his companions. Slowly the
+grounded boat responded to their efforts.
+Inch by inch it slipped from the bar, but was
+not yet free.</p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, the confusion on the shore was
+increasing. The men were running up and
+down the beach, waving their arms and shouting.
+The two barges were coming swiftly
+from the gunboats, and if the loaded boat
+was not soon dragged from the bar, it would
+once more be in the possession of the enemy.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[207]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>They were still working desperately. The
+perspiration stood out in great drops upon
+their faces. They braced their feet against
+the seats in front of them and put forth all
+their strength. The moments seemed like
+hours to the struggling men, but the loaded
+boat was slow to respond to their efforts. It
+was steadily yielding, however, and at last
+they saw the boat slide from the bar and rest
+easily upon the open water.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[208]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XVI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>TED WILSON'S VICTIM</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">A shout</span> arose from the eager crew as they
+perceived the success which had crowned their
+desperate efforts, but an answering shout from
+the men in the two approaching barges
+quickly recalled them to the necessity for
+further and immediate action. Why it was
+that the guns of the gunboats had remained
+silent they could not understand, but there
+was no time now for investigations. It was
+sufficient that they had not been molested
+thus far; and as the leader at once gave the
+command for them to resume their labors
+with their oars, the men at once responded
+and gave way together, the supply boat still
+being towed.</p>
+
+<p>The whaleboat had been built for speed,
+and was long, narrow, and light. Had it
+not been for the laden supply boat, which as
+yet they were not willing to abandon, they
+would easily and speedily have drawn away
+from the pursuing barges. As it was, they<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[209]</a></span>
+swept forward swiftly, and apparently were
+almost holding their own in the race.</p>
+
+<p>For several minutes the desperate efforts of
+the men continued. The heavy clouds had
+gathered in the sky, and the blaze of the sun
+had disappeared. The air was sultry and oppressive,
+and the unusual calm which rested
+over the waters indicated that the storm which
+had been threatening was fast approaching.
+No one glanced at the heavens, however, the
+set and streaming faces indicating that the
+immediate task in hand was sufficient of itself
+to occupy all their thoughts.</p>
+
+<p>On and on rowed the men, and on and
+on swept the pursuing barges. Less than
+a quarter of a mile lay between them, and,
+heavily laden as the supply boat was, it
+materially decreased the speed which otherwise
+the whaleboat might have made. The
+moments passed, but the efforts were not
+relaxed. Together, the long oars struck the
+water, and the bodies of the men swayed back
+and forth as if they were controlled by a
+common impulse. The distance between the
+boats was not materially changed, although if
+any change was to be seen it was in favor of
+the barges.</p>
+
+<p>"This will never do," said the leader at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[210]</a></span>
+last, letting his oar go, and rising in his seat
+as he spoke. "Here, you men," he added,
+grasping his gun and facing the prisoners in
+the other boat as he spoke, "it's time for
+you to work your passage. Take those oars
+and pull your prettiest! Four oars are better
+than one, and I can do more with a gun than
+I can by pulling. Take your oars, every one
+of you, and the first one to drop will be fired
+on!"</p>
+
+<p>The four men in the supply boat sullenly
+obeyed, and the increased impulse of their
+efforts at once became manifest. The leader
+stood in the stern of the whaleboat facing
+the prisoners, and watchful of their every
+movement. His words of encouragement
+served to inspire his companions, and for a
+time it appeared as if they were gaining upon
+their pursuers.</p>
+
+<p>Still, the distance between them did not
+materially increase, and such efforts as the
+men were then making could not be long
+maintained. Indeed, signs of distress were
+already becoming apparent, and Little Peter
+felt every time he drew in his oar as if he
+had not strength enough left to pull another
+stroke. His face betrayed the pain he was
+suffering, but his condition was not much<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[211]</a></span>
+worse than that of some of the other men
+with him in the boat.</p>
+
+<p>The exciting contest could not be continued
+much longer, and as the leader glanced
+about the boat he almost decided to cut the
+rope which held the supply boat, and, leaving
+that behind, seek safety in flight.</p>
+
+<p>He had drawn his knife from his pocket,
+and was standing ready to free them from
+their heavy load, when the rain began to fall.
+In a moment the wind swept down upon
+them, and the storm was at hand.</p>
+
+<p>Prom the first of the pursuing barges
+came a shot, but no damage was done, and
+the leader muttered, "That's all right. It's
+a farewell salute you're giving us. You
+might as well say good-by to us, for I take it
+you'll never see us again."</p>
+
+<p>The waves were now rising, and the rain
+was falling in torrents. Between them and
+the shore it almost seemed as if a cloud
+intervened, so heavy was the downpour. The
+voice of the leader could hardly be heard by
+his men. The deep-toned thunder sounded
+almost continuously, and the darting lightning
+appeared to be all about them. In
+escaping from one peril they had encountered
+another.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[212]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The barges could now no longer be seen,
+and, with the passing of the fear of pursuit,
+the men gave all their attention to their
+efforts to keep the whaleboat out of the
+trough of the rolling waves. Still, the supply
+boat was not cut loose, for the determined
+men were resolved to hold to that so long as
+it lay within their power to do so.</p>
+
+<p>For a half hour the shower continued, and
+although much water was shipped, and the
+men were compelled to bail the boats, they
+behaved well. When at last the storm had
+passed and the low mutterings of the thunder
+sounded far out to sea, they all looked keenly
+behind them to discover the whereabouts of
+their pursuers.</p>
+
+<p>Neither of the barges was to be seen.
+Doubtless, with the approach of the shower,
+they had both put back to the gunboats for
+safety. The whaleboat had weathered the
+storm, and the supply boat was still safely in
+tow.</p>
+
+<p>Drenched though the men were, new
+strength seemed to come with the knowledge
+that they were no longer being pursued, and
+then, relieved of their fear, they continued
+on their way down the shore.</p>
+
+<p>They frequently stopped for rest and to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[213]</a></span>
+scan the waters behind them, but no boat
+could anywhere be seen. Nor was any one
+to be discerned upon the beach. Doubtless
+the men from Refugee Town had fled for
+safety and shelter, or, as the leader grimly
+said, "They were afraid of being wet, for
+water was something to which all the men
+assembled there were strongly opposed."</p>
+
+<p>For mile after mile they held steadily to
+their course, even their excitement apparently
+having mostly disappeared. The supply boat
+contained guns and ammunition, and if there
+was anything of which the militia stood in
+need, it was of that very commodity.</p>
+
+<p>At first it was thought that they would
+put in at the entrance to Shark River, but it
+was soon decided to continue on their way
+until they should come to Manasquan Inlet,
+and then go up the river to a place where
+some of their friends were to be found. To
+gain Tom's River they would be compelled to
+keep on to Barnegat Inlet, and then retrace
+their way up Barnegat Bay, to the place
+where the river entered; and as that would
+require a voyage of thirty miles more, no one
+regretted the change in the plan.</p>
+
+<p>They were all nearly worn out by their
+exertions, and no one knew what British<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[214]</a></span>
+vessel might be met before they could gain
+the shelter of Tom's River.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter, in spite of his eagerness to go
+on to the place where he hoped to learn something
+concerning his father, was so weary
+from the work of the day, and as he had not
+tasted food since early that morning, he rejoiced
+with the others when at last the boats
+turned into Manasquan Inlet and began to
+make their way up the little stream.</p>
+
+<p>The sun was now low in the western sky,
+and the night would soon be upon them.
+The shadows already were lengthening when
+the two boats passed out of the inlet into
+the waters of the river. The leader, however,
+had not yet given the word to rest on their
+oars, and Little Peter did not know where
+they were to pass the night.</p>
+
+<p>The whaleboat kept steadily on in its course,
+and the wearied men were still pulling at the
+oars. The river was becoming narrower now,
+and more than one was hoping that the word
+would soon be given for them to land.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly, the leader called to his men,
+and, standing erect, pointed excitedly to a
+place on the shore not far in advance of them.
+His companions quickly looked in that direction
+and saw on the little point of land, around<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[215]</a></span>
+which the river swept in its course, two men
+standing in the water. But what was it they
+were doing? One of them was holding the
+other and frequently forcing his head beneath
+the surface of the river. He would hold
+him in that position for a moment and then
+lift him upon his feet again, and shake him,
+much as a dog might have done with a
+rabbit. Apparently neither had observed the
+approaching boats, nor had either uttered a
+sound which the men in the whaleboat could
+hear.</p>
+
+<p>"The fellow's drowning him!" said the
+leader excitedly. "He's drowning him. Give
+way, men, and we'll lend a hand."</p>
+
+<p>The men, no less excited than their leader,
+instantly responded, and the boats dashed
+rapidly forward. The eyes of all were fixed
+upon the two men before them, and the leader
+shouted and called; but apparently, unmindful
+of their approach, the strange actions
+continued. The larger of the two men again
+and again forced the head of his companion
+under the water, and then would lift him up
+and repeat the shaking. So thoroughly intent
+was he upon his strange occupation, that he
+did not once heed the hail, or even glance
+toward the whaleboat.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[216]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Nearer and nearer swept the boats, and
+finally, when they were almost upon him, the
+man ceased his efforts and glanced coolly up
+at the approaching men, still, however, retaining
+his grasp on his victim, who apparently
+was helpless in his hands.</p>
+
+<p>A startled exclamation escaped Little Peter's
+lips when he saw that the smaller of the men
+was none other than his own neighbor, Benzeor
+Osburn. "Help him! Help him!" he
+said excitedly to the leader. "It's Benzeor!
+It's Benzeor Osburn! He's my neighbor!
+He's being drowned! He'll be killed!"</p>
+
+<p>"Be still!" said the leader roughly. "It's
+Ted Wilson that's got him. Ted knows what
+he's doing. What's the trouble, Ted?
+What's gone wrong?" he added quickly,
+addressing the man who still held Benzeor
+tightly in his grasp.</p>
+
+<p>The huge man slowly turned his head as
+he heard himself addressed, and Little Peter
+thought he never before had seen such an
+expression of rage upon any human countenance.
+His great muscular arms were bare,
+and his entire body seemed to express the
+marvelous strength he possessed. Benzeor
+was not struggling, and indeed there seemed
+to be but little hope of protecting himself<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[217]</a></span>
+from the powerful man whose prisoner he
+was.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter could see that, although Benzeor
+was almost breathless, he had recognized
+him, but he made no effort to speak and
+scarcely glanced at the men before him.</p>
+
+<p>"What's wrong, Ted?" repeated the
+leader. "What's the matter with the man?"</p>
+
+<p>"The matter isn't with the man, it's with
+me," said Ted slowly, speaking in a deep,
+gruff voice, which betrayed the strong feeling
+under which he labored.</p>
+
+<p>"You're not going to drown him, are
+you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Naw&mdash;though the snake deserves it.
+Drownin' is too good for such as he!"</p>
+
+<p>Ted had not moved from his position, and
+still was standing up to his waist in the water.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell us about it. Maybe we can help
+you a bit."</p>
+
+<p>"Naw, ye can't help any. It's my business.
+I don't mind tellin' ye how it came
+about, though. This forenoon I sold some
+corn and stuff up here at the mill, and got
+my pay in coin, too. Well, this fellow was
+there and he saw me get paid off, and I half
+suspected the reptile from the way he looked
+at me when he saw me take the money. Here<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[218]</a></span>
+you!" he quickly added, as Benzeor struggled
+slightly. "Ye want some more, do ye?
+Well, I'll give ye all ye want and all ye need,
+too," and again he thrust the helpless Benzeor's
+head beneath the water.</p>
+
+<p>"Let him up. You'll drown him!" said
+the leader, when Ted had held his victim
+several seconds under the water.</p>
+
+<p>"It's no more than he deserves," replied
+the huge man, nevertheless lifting his victim
+and shaking him again. "Now will ye keep
+still?"</p>
+
+<p>As Benzeor was unable to reply, Ted again
+turned to the men in the boat and said, "Well,
+I took that money home and gave it to Sallie.
+She's my wife, ye know, and I always gives
+her what money I get, not that it's ever very
+much, though. I didn't ferget the eyes o'
+this fellow, however, and I told Sallie,&mdash;she's
+my wife, ye know, and as likely a woman as
+there is in Old Monmouth, if I do say it as
+ought not to,&mdash;I told her to keep a good
+lookout for the pine robbers, fer I had a kind
+of a suspicion this here reptile might know
+where they was, and might get word to 'em,
+too.</p>
+
+<p>"I took my axe and went off down into
+my swamp-lot to cut some wood, and left<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[219]</a></span>
+Sallie up in the house. Sallie's my wife, ye
+know. I felt uneasy like all the time, but
+I worked on for three hours or more, but
+I kept a-gettin' uneasier and uneasier, and,
+finally, I just couldn't stand it any longer
+and put straight fer the house.</p>
+
+<p>"'Twas mighty lucky I did, too, I'm
+tellin' you, fer when I came in sight o' the
+house,&mdash;ye can see it up there now," and
+Ted pointed to his home, a short distance up
+the bank, giving the unfortunate Benzeor an
+additional shake as he did so,&mdash;"I see somethin'
+was wrong. There was three or four
+men a-standin' out by the big maple in front
+o' my house, and the minit I looked I see
+what they was up to. Somebody was a
+hangin' from a bedcord they'd threw over a
+limb o' that very maple-tree.</p>
+
+<p>"Mebbe ye know how I felt when I see it
+was my Sallie; she's my wife, ye know.
+They was a-drawin' her up and then lettin'
+her down, and I knew then they was tryin'
+to make her own up where that money was.
+I had my axe in my hands, and when I see
+what they was up to, I didn't wait very long,
+I'm tellin' ye. I cut Sallie loose,&mdash;she
+wasn't very much hurt; she's my wife, ye
+know,&mdash;and then I took after the rascals.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[220]</a></span>
+They scattered in every direction, but this
+vermin started for the river and I after him."</p>
+
+<p>"You got him, I see."</p>
+
+<p>"Did I get him? Let him answer for
+hisself."</p>
+
+<p>And the angry Ted again shook the helpless
+Benzeor until the men wondered that his
+trembling limbs still held together.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[221]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<h2>CHAPTER XVII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>A FRUITLESS CHASE</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> surprise of Tom Coward was not diminished
+as the novel race continued. Twice
+through the open doors of the barn dashed
+the two riders, their horses' hoofs slipping on
+the rough floor and almost throwing the men
+from their seats. Both continued to maintain
+their positions, however, and would no
+sooner disappear from Tom's sight than they
+would be seen coming around the corner of
+the barn again, the young American lieutenant
+still in advance and the British officer in
+close pursuit.</p>
+
+<p>Friend Nathan was standing in the doorway
+of his house, and, in spite of his peaceful
+professions, there was an eager expression
+upon his face which betrayed the fact that
+he was not an uninterested observer of the
+strange contest. Tom had not moved from
+his position, and his excitement had almost
+deprived him of the power of speech.</p>
+
+<p>Again through the open doorways of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[222]</a></span>
+barn the riders had urged their swiftly running
+horses, but as yet their relative positions
+had remained unchanged. The British officer
+was leaning forward on his horse's neck
+and endeavoring to grasp the bridle of the
+young lieutenant's horse, but the quick movements
+of the latter had prevented him, and
+the mad race continued.</p>
+
+<p>As Lieutenant Gordon dashed around the
+corner of the barn, and for the fourth time
+prepared to enter the open door, Tom saw
+that the other members of the band were just
+entering the yard. The excited lad could
+not longer remain silent. His friend was
+beset by new perils and must be warned.</p>
+
+<p>"Look out! Look out!" shouted Tom.</p>
+
+<p>Young Gordon looked up and for the first
+time beheld the increase in the number of his
+enemies. Without hesitating a moment, he
+turned his horse toward the low fence and
+cleared it at a bound. Then, directly across
+the open lot toward the woods in the distance
+he urged his trusty steed, and almost before
+the men in the yard perceived what had
+occurred, he had placed a considerable distance
+between him and the barn.</p>
+
+<p>The confusion, however, lasted but a moment,
+for, with a shout, several of the men<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[223]</a></span>
+urged their horses forward, and, leaping the
+low fence, renewed the pursuit. Those who
+did not follow raised their guns and discharged
+them at the fleeing officer; but
+either his movements were too swift, or their
+excitement prevented them from taking careful
+aim, for the bullets went wide of their
+mark, and in a very brief time the young
+lieutenant disappeared within the woods, and
+soon after his pursuers followed him.</p>
+
+<p>"Thee didn't seem to catch him," said
+Nathan blandly to the men who remained in
+the yard.</p>
+
+<p>"They'll get him. They'll get him,"
+replied the leader. "They'll soon run him
+down, never you fear. But he's a bold fellow,
+there's no mistake about that. What
+did you call out to him for?" he added,
+turning sharply to Tom.</p>
+
+<p>"Did I call out to him?" replied Tom.
+"I don't just know what I did, I was so
+excited. I thought you had him."</p>
+
+<p>"So I would, if it hadn't been for the
+barn floor."</p>
+
+<p>Tom thought the barn floor was perhaps
+as much of a disadvantage to the pursued as
+to the pursuer, but he discreetly held his
+peace and said no more.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[224]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Now, old man, you can get us some
+breakfast. My men will be back here in no
+time with the young rebel, and will have all
+the better appetite because of their morning's
+work. You can feed us all, can't you?"
+said the officer.</p>
+
+<p>"I have spoken to Rachel. Doubtless she
+will do her best for thee."</p>
+
+<p>The men at once proceeded to place their
+horses in the barn and serve them freely
+from the Quaker's store. Then they entered
+the house and seated themselves at the table
+which Rachel had spread for them, although
+they first stationed one of their companions
+as guard.</p>
+
+<p>For a time no one spoke, so busied were
+they in their occupation, and Tom Coward
+was not one whit behind any of them. He
+was tired and hungry, and the breakfast
+was doubly welcome to him. Rachel moved
+quietly about the room, her drab dress and
+broad white collar being in marked contrast
+to the brilliant uniforms of her self-invited
+guests.</p>
+
+<p>"Old man," said the officer at last, "I
+wish you'd tell me how it happened that that
+young rebel was here on your place. You
+weren't sheltering him, were you?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[225]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Nay," replied Nathan. "In times like
+these, Friends are not prone to shelter any
+soldiers. Our guests are only those who
+come without any bidding of ours."</p>
+
+<p>"Ha! ha!" laughed the officer. "I fancy
+you mean that as a reproach for us. Well,
+we'll pay you for our breakfast, never you
+fear about that. Your scruples don't carry
+you so far that you object to receiving a
+return in good yellow or white metal, do
+they?"</p>
+
+<p>"The laborer is ever worthy of his hire.
+I shall be thankful for any equivalent it may
+seem good unto thee to bestow upon me."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right, that's right. Trust a
+broad brim for that every time. I'm not
+complaining, old man, I'm not complaining.
+You don't happen to know just where the
+rebel army is at present, do you?"</p>
+
+<p>"It is reported that Washington is on the
+march for this very place. Even now he
+may be approaching."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know that?" inquired the officer
+in a lower tone.</p>
+
+<p>"Nay. I know nothing of their movements.
+It is all of the current report I am
+speaking to thee. I fear me that a man of
+peace is likely to suffer double ills between<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[226]</a></span>
+the two armies, for it is also reported that
+the British and their Hessian companions are
+also likely to march through this very region."</p>
+
+<p>If the officer had glanced at the old
+Quaker he would have discovered that there
+was a very keen expression upon his face as
+he ventured the last supposition. But as he
+did not look up it was all lost upon him, and
+perhaps if he had seen it, he would not have
+understood its meaning, since his host was
+ostensibly a man of peace.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not so sure of that," said the officer
+quietly. "We've come to look over the
+land and report to Colonel Simcoe. What
+makes you think the rebels are near here,
+and are likely to march this way?"</p>
+
+<p>"I will tell thee truly. The young man
+whom your companions are pursuing slept
+last night in my barn. He informed me
+frankly that Washington was to pass this
+way"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"And fall on our army?" broke in the
+officer eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>"That is the natural inference for thee to
+draw. It's a sad day for the Friends. They
+are ground between the upper and the nether
+millstones, for I understood thee to say that
+the British also were to come hither."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[227]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"You can understand what you please,"
+replied the leader gruffly. "You've given
+me the information I most desire and Colonel
+Simcoe would be glad to reward you for it,
+but being, as you are, a man of peace, of
+course you wouldn't be willing to take anything
+from a man whose occupation is blood
+letting. Hello! here's the guard!" he added,
+rising abruptly from the table as he spoke.
+"What's wrong?"</p>
+
+<p>"Nothing," replied the guard, "except
+that our men are returning from the woods."</p>
+
+<p>"And did they catch the young rebel?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, or at least he's not with them now."</p>
+
+<p>All hurriedly left the table and rushed out
+into the yard, Tom also going with them.
+The men could be seen returning across the
+lot, but it was at once evident that the young
+lieutenant was not with them.</p>
+
+<p>"What's the trouble? How was it that
+you let the slippery little rebel get away from
+you?" demanded the leader, as the soldiers
+once more entered the yard.</p>
+
+<p>"Simply because he could ride faster than
+we could," replied one of the band in a surly
+tone. "His horse was fresh and ours had
+been out all night."</p>
+
+<p>The officer was angry, but, after a few<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[228]</a></span>
+sharp words to his men, he bade them enter
+the kitchen and get their breakfast.</p>
+
+<p>"Did thee find him?" inquired Nathan.</p>
+
+<p>"No, we didn't find him. I'd chase him
+right into camp if it wasn't that I must
+hurry back to the colonel with the word
+you've given me. You're sure about what
+you told me?"</p>
+
+<p>"What did I tell thee?" inquired Nathan
+blandly.</p>
+
+<p>"About the march of the rebels," replied
+the officer angrily. "I half believe you're
+in league with them yourself, in spite of all
+your whining words. If I thought you were
+I'd leave your body for the crows to pick."</p>
+
+<p>"And is that the method which seemeth to
+thee to prove thou art right, and that I am no
+man of peace?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, never mind, old man, never mind my
+words. Perhaps I'm a little too hard with
+you. This young rebel's getting away from
+us has put me out of temper. What I want
+to know is whether you believe what you
+said about the rebels coming through Cranberry."</p>
+
+<p>"I have given thee the words as they were
+given me. I am not in the councils of the
+'rebels,' as it seemeth good to thee to call<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[229]</a></span>
+them, and cannot say more. It is for thee to
+judge, not me, who am a man of peace and
+not familiar with the ways of warlike men."</p>
+
+<p>By this time the men had finished their
+breakfast, and a hurried consultation followed.
+The decision at which they arrived was soon
+apparent when the leader approached Nathan,
+and, holding forth some silver in his hand,
+said, "There, take that for the breakfast
+you've given us."</p>
+
+<p>"I thank thee," replied Nathan, accepting
+the money.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you going back with us, lad?" said
+the officer, turning to Tom as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"No. You said all you wanted of me
+was to point out the way to Cranberry."</p>
+
+<p>"So I did, but if this old man speaks the
+truth,&mdash;and I'm inclined to think he does,&mdash;you'll
+be better off with us than you will be
+to stay behind when the rebels are coming.
+You'll have a good horse to ride, too; you
+must not forget that."</p>
+
+<p>"I think I'll stay. I'm not afraid of the
+rebels, and can find my way all right." Tom's
+heart was beating rapidly, and the fear that
+permission for him to remain would not be
+granted was uppermost in his thoughts.</p>
+
+<p>"Have it your own way, lad, have it your<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[230]</a></span>
+own way. I only spoke what I thought was
+for your own best good."</p>
+
+<p>He gave a few orders to his men, and in a
+brief time the band departed, riding swiftly
+up the road and soon disappearing from
+sight.</p>
+
+<p>"This was not a bad morning's work,
+Friend Thomas," said Nathan, when at last
+the men were gone, jingling the silver in his
+pocket as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"It was a good deal better than I ever
+expected to have," replied Tom.</p>
+
+<p>Neither of them realized, however, the full
+consequences, for Nathan's words, in addition
+to what the officer had already discovered,
+caused him to return in all haste with
+the information he had received to Colonel
+Simcoe. That officer, upon receiving the
+word, which was corroborated by other discoveries
+he had made, at once reported to
+Sir Henry Clinton, and an immediate change
+in the plans of the British was made. The
+advance to the Raritan was speedily abandoned,
+the route to the Highlands was at
+once chosen, and it was decided that the
+army should march by the way of Monmouth
+Court House. The battle of Monmouth,
+which soon followed, thus became possible,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[231]</a></span>
+and that, with all its consequences to the
+struggling patriots, turned upon the information
+which Colonel Simcoe had received, and
+which he speedily carried to his commander.</p>
+
+<p>Upon such slight events do those which we
+sometimes call the greater ones turn. Perhaps
+as we grow older and wiser we shall
+come to perceive more clearly the true relation
+which the so-called little things of life bear
+to the greater ones. A very wise man once
+declared that "he who was faithful in the
+little affairs of life was very greatly faithful."
+In any event, we have partially learned the
+lesson that it is a test of true greatness to be
+able to do little things well, and that the
+very best evidence of a man's being able to
+do the greater things is that he is willing to
+do the smaller ones, as they come to him,
+faithfully and honestly.</p>
+
+<p>However, neither Nathan nor Tom was
+moralizing after this fashion when they entered
+the house after watching the departure
+of the British soldiers. Tom then related all
+his recent experiences to Nathan, not omitting
+the story of Benzeor's misdeeds.</p>
+
+<p>The old Quaker listened attentively, and it
+was apparent from his frequent expressions of
+anger that his interest in the success of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[232]</a></span>
+Continentals was not entirely banished by his
+peaceful professions.</p>
+
+<p>"What thee needs now, friend Thomas,"
+he said, when at last the lad's story was
+ended, "is a good rest. Rachel has a bed
+ready for thee."</p>
+
+<p>Tom followed his friend to the room upstairs,
+and soon stretched himself upon the
+bed. How grateful it seemed to the weary
+lad! For a moment he gazed at the four
+high posts, but soon everything was forgotten
+and he was asleep.</p>
+
+<p>How long he slept he did not know, but he
+was awakened by Nathan, who called to him
+and said, "Friend Thomas, there is some one
+below who desires to see thee."</p>
+
+<p>Tom leaped from the bed and followed the
+Quaker down the stairs, wondering who it
+was that wished to see him. There were
+confused thoughts in his mind of the British
+officer and Benzeor, but he was not in the
+least prepared for the sight upon which he
+looked when he entered the room.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[233]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XVIII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>A RARE BEAST</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">It</span> is necessary now for us to turn and follow
+some of the movements of that army
+which Tom Coward was so eager to join.</p>
+
+<p>Sir Henry Clinton fully understood that
+he had little to gain from an engagement
+with Washington's army at this time. The
+Americans were not holding any position
+which he desired to gain, their stores and
+equipments were of slight value, and if
+Washington should be defeated, the result
+would be that his men would simply be scattered
+in the surrounding region, where they
+would still be free to carry on their straggling
+methods of warfare, and harass the British
+by falling upon their baggage trains and
+shooting at the men as they marched along
+the country roads.</p>
+
+<p>On the other hand, Clinton's stores were
+numerous and of no little value. The loss of
+them would be a serious blow to the redcoats,
+while the possession of them by the Continentals<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[234]</a></span>
+would put new life into the cause
+of the poorly equipped patriots. And above
+all of these things, the danger which now
+threatened from the approach of a French
+fleet led the British commander to hasten
+forward to the defense of New York, which
+he feared was likely to be the first place to
+be attacked by the allies of the colonies.</p>
+
+<p>The very motives which caused Sir Henry
+to wish to avoid an engagement were those
+which appealed most strongly to Washington
+to enter into one. He had but little to lose
+and much to gain. A defeat for the British
+would mean a weakening of the defense of
+New York, and the long train of baggage
+wagons was a most tempting prize. The possession
+of those stores would replenish the
+scanty supplies of the Americans; and, as we
+know, Washington had eagerly pushed his
+army forward, hoping to gain a position in
+advance of the British and fall upon them in
+some advantageous position which he himself
+could select.</p>
+
+<p>The main body had advanced as far as
+Hopewell, as we have already learned in the
+course of this story, but there had halted for
+a brief time. The weather had been unusually
+trying, and as a consequence the men<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[235]</a></span>
+were suffering intensely. Even the "oldest
+inhabitants" had never known such a summer.
+The thermometer had climbed well up
+into the nineties and then had stayed there.
+The frequent thunder showers apparently did
+not cool the air and afforded no relief, as the
+sultriness seemed to be increased by each
+one. The roads had become heavy and well-nigh
+impassable in places, and when at last
+the men had marched to the plains of Hopewell,
+Washington wisely halted to give them
+their much needed rest.</p>
+
+<p>Another matter led the great commander
+to remain there for a time. He had now
+gained a position which offered him a considerable
+advantage, and he wished to call a
+council of his officers to consult concerning
+his further movements.</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, the second of the councils
+since the army had departed from Philadelphia
+was then called, and the one question
+in the mind of the commander was this:
+"Will it be advisable to hazard a general
+engagement?"</p>
+
+<p>General Charles Lee, who was second in
+command, and was by some even then suspected
+of being in secret league with Howe,
+was present, and his voice was soon heard.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[236]</a></span>
+Lee was a Welshman, brilliant in certain
+ways, and had seen much service in the
+armies of Europe. Many had preferred him
+to Washington as the commander-in-chief of
+the American armies, and Lee himself was
+not averse to the idea. He affected to regard
+Washington with contempt, looking upon
+him as a man who lacked military training
+and of but little ability. His jealousy
+already had been the cause of many serious
+troubles, and at the present time, in spite of
+the fact that he had been exchanged for the
+British general Prescott, captured in a manner
+not unlike that in which Lee himself had
+been taken in a previous winter at Morristown,
+he apparently was unmindful of all the
+regard bestowed upon him, and was not unwilling
+to see Washington make some mistakes
+which would bring upon the leader the anger
+of his fellows, and perhaps open the way for
+Lee to gain his position. This view of the
+case is certainly to be preferred to that which
+marked him simply as a traitor and in league
+with the enemy, although in all likelihood
+both, in a measure, were correct. Probably
+Washington understood the man thoroughly
+at the time, and we may be certain that his
+troubles were not decreased by his knowledge.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[237]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Lee was possessed of a strikingly ugly
+face, and his plain features were the cause of
+many rude jests among the soldiers who were
+opposed to him. But whatever his lacks in
+personal beauty or moral character may have
+been, he at least had a most persuasive tongue.
+His eager and impulsive manner, his commonly
+accredited ability, and his foreign
+training, which had great influence among
+many of his ruder and unpolished companions,
+caused some of the men about him
+to become ready listeners to what he had to
+say.</p>
+
+<p>In the council which Washington called at
+Hopewell, Lee exerted himself to the utmost
+to oppose the proposition to enter into an
+engagement with the advancing British. So
+persuasive were his words that the majority
+of the officers voted with him that it would
+not be advisable to detach more than fifteen
+hundred men from the main body to harass
+the enemy on their flank and rear, while the
+remainder of the army should preserve their
+present position relative to the British, and
+be governed by circumstances.</p>
+
+<p>Just what Lee's motive was is not fully
+apparent. Whether he wished to avoid a
+battle or simply desired to cause Washington<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[238]</a></span>
+to fail in taking advantage of the favorable
+opportunity, which Lee himself must have
+seen had presented itself, is not clearly known.
+It may have been a combination of both
+wishes.</p>
+
+<p>General Wayne bitterly opposed the proposition
+of Lee, and generals such as Greene,
+Lafayette, Steuben, and others, expressed
+themselves as being decidedly of the opinion
+that, at the very least, twenty-five hundred
+men should be detached from the main body
+and sent forward to carry out Washington's
+plan.</p>
+
+<p>Lee's motion, however, prevailed; but while
+Washington seemingly consented to the decision
+of the council, we can now see, as we
+look backward, that his own purpose was not
+changed. Perhaps he was strengthened in
+his opinion by the words of General Wayne
+and General Greene, spoken after the breaking
+up of the assembly, for we know that
+they then expressed themselves very freely to
+their leader.</p>
+
+<p>Apparently yielding to the expressed wishes
+of the majority, Washington dispatched General
+Scott with fifteen hundred men "to
+gall the enemy's left flank and rear," as he
+expressed it in the letters he wrote that day<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[239]</a></span>
+to General Dickinson and the president of
+the Continental Congress; and on the following
+day advanced with his army to Kingston,
+and halted there on the very day when
+Tom Coward arrived at the house of Friend
+Nathan Brown in Cranberry.</p>
+
+<p>As Tom came down the stairs and entered
+the room below, his surprise was great when
+he saw young Lieutenant Gordon standing
+before him. "Where&mdash;where did you come
+from?" said the astonished boy. "I thought
+they chased you out into the woods!"</p>
+
+<p>"So they did. So they did," laughed the
+young officer; "but that doesn't mean that
+I was bound to stay there, does it? I had
+spent the night with Friend Nathan here, and
+I had such a good time I almost decided to
+come back for another. And then, too, I
+left a lad here whose face haunted me, he
+looked so scared and white."</p>
+
+<p>"I was scared," said Tom, "for I thought
+they'd got you. How in the world did you
+ever manage to get away from them?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I've learned by experience," replied
+the lieutenant, laughing. "This was about
+the closest call I ever had, and once there,
+when my horse slipped on the barn floor, I
+thought I was done for; but it's all come<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[240]</a></span>
+out right, you see. When I once got into the
+woods I knew I was all right, and I didn't
+have to go very far, either. About noon I
+thought I'd venture back and see what had
+become of Friend Nathan and Tom Coward,
+for I didn't believe those redcoats would stay
+here very long after they found out that our
+army is over here by Kingston."</p>
+
+<p>"Kingston?" said Tom quickly. "Kingston?
+Why, that's only ten miles from
+here!"</p>
+
+<p>"Correct, my son; correct. They'll be
+nearer yet, very soon."</p>
+
+<p>Tom was excited in a moment, and eagerly
+began to ask many questions. The young
+lieutenant replied to them all, and then said
+to the Quaker, who had remained silent during
+the conversation, "And now, Friend
+Nathan, you feel sure that those redcoats will
+carry the word back to Clinton that we've
+turned out of our way to meet them, do you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Verily, I do," replied Nathan. "It was
+for the very purpose of learning the plans of
+Washington that they dared to venture as
+far as this. I endeavored to learn from the
+soldier what effect he thought his report
+would have upon the British leader, but he
+did not speak in many words. Doubtless he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[241]</a></span>
+considered them valueless to a man of peace.
+But thy surmise is correct, I doubt not."</p>
+
+<p>"Then the sooner we put out of this the
+better, Tom; that is, if you're still of the
+same mind you were day before yesterday."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm ready to go," replied Tom eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>The thought of the American army being
+only ten miles away aroused all his enthusiasm
+once more. He knew nothing of camp life,
+and the hardships were not in his thoughts.
+He knew that he had no place to which he
+could go, and now that he had left Benzeor's
+home he felt like an outcast. Besides, he
+had dreamed of joining the army, and, now
+that at last the longed-for day had arrived,
+all his curiosity and eagerness returned in full
+measure.</p>
+
+<p>"But I haven't any horse and you're
+mounted," he added. "I don't see how I
+can go with you. You can't wait for me to
+trudge along on foot."</p>
+
+<p>"That is something of a poser," replied the
+lieutenant. "No, it's a fact I can't waste
+much time on the road with such news as I
+have to carry back to camp. Perhaps my
+horse will carry double part of the way."</p>
+
+<p>"I have a beast I might let thee have,"
+said Nathan.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[242]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"That's the way to talk!" said the lieutenant
+eagerly. "Where is this horse of
+yours?"</p>
+
+<p>"It is out in the back lot in the woods.
+My heart was filled with fears of the war
+men, and I dared not to leave any of my
+property within their sight."</p>
+
+<p>As Nathan still hesitated, the lieutenant
+said quickly, "Hurry up, Nathan! Get your
+horse and let us start. We've no time to
+lose."</p>
+
+<p>"Thou knowest that I am a man of peace,"
+said the Quaker slowly. "It is not for me to
+waste my property in this wicked war."</p>
+
+<p>"That's the way the wind blows, is it?"
+laughed the lieutenant. "Well, I don't know
+that I can promise you very much, but I'll
+do what I can for you after I get back to
+camp. But I'll tell you what, Nathan, you'll
+not be the loser to give up the horse to us,
+and with a good grace, too. Both of the
+armies are likely to pass this way, and you
+won't have much left on your place, I can
+tell you. Now, if you give it up you may
+get something for it, and then, too, you'll
+have the credit of doing something for your
+country."</p>
+
+<p>"What did the war men give thee, Friend<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[243]</a></span>
+Thomas? Did I not hear thee say that the
+war men rewarded thee for thy services?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," said Tom quickly, drawing the two
+half joes forth from his pocket as he spoke.
+"Here they are. You can have them and
+welcome."</p>
+
+<p>"The beast is not what would be considered
+a valuable one, Friend Thomas, and
+yet he is still capable of rendering some service
+to me. I will take one of thy half joes
+and leave the other with thee. Then thou
+canst see that I am suitably repaid after thou
+hast joined thy comrades in the war."</p>
+
+<p>The young lieutenant slyly winked at Tom
+as the lad handed the man one of his half
+joes, and then said, "Hurry up, Nathan!
+We've got to start soon, and ought to be off
+now. We'll do the best we can for you, as
+we said. You're going to give us something
+to eat, aren't you, before we go?"</p>
+
+<p>"It shall be according to thy desire.
+Rachel, if thou hast some milk and a small
+portion of corn bread, set it before these
+guests whilst I am gone for my beast."</p>
+
+<p>The old man departed, and his wife carried
+out his request. The lieutenant and Tom at
+once seated themselves at the table and hastily
+ate the food she set before them, for neither<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[244]</a></span>
+knew when another opportunity might be
+found. In the ten miles which lay between
+them and the army of Washington many adventures
+might be awaiting them, and it was
+only the part of wisdom to make the most of
+the present.</p>
+
+<p>"I have thy beast for thee," said Nathan,
+soon afterwards entering the room. "He is
+not what might be called by thee a swift
+beast, but he is still possessed of some excellent
+qualities. Thou hast promised to see
+that I am further rewarded for my gift."</p>
+
+<p>Tom and the lieutenant hastened out of
+the room to examine Nathan's "gift," and, as
+they saw the horse which he had tied to the
+post, they both stopped in surprise and the
+lieutenant broke into a loud laugh.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Friend Nathan," said he, adopting
+the Quaker's style of speech, "thou art a
+friend indeed! Dost thou call that thing a
+'beast'? Thou hast cheated the lad woefully.
+A good half joe for that scarecrow?
+Thou oughtest to reward Thomas for riding
+him, for I am of the opinion that I shall be
+compelled to carry him into camp in two
+pieces if he mounts that 'razorback.' Oh,
+Nathan, Nathan! Who would have believed
+it of thee?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[245]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The horse was old and gaunt. A spavin
+was apparent in one leg, while on another
+was a great ringbone. One eye betrayed its
+blindness, and, altogether, the poor animal
+presented a most woe-begone and helpless
+appearance.</p>
+
+<p>"He hath not beauty, as I told thee," said
+Nathan soberly. "But he is of value to me,
+and thou hast promised to see that I am suitably
+rewarded."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Tom! Tom!" laughed the lieutenant.
+"What a sight you'll be on the back
+of that bunch of bones! There's no help
+for it, though. Come on and we'll see what
+the poor 'beast' can do!"</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[246]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIX</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE RELEASE OF BENZEOR</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Benzeor's</span> plight was a sad one, but as he
+gazed about him in his helplessness the only
+face upon which he could discover any traces
+of sympathy or compassion was that of Little
+Peter. The lad had had no suspicion of his
+neighbor, and was ignorant, as we know, of
+the part which Benzeor had taken in the
+attack on his father's house. Even now it
+was difficult for him to believe that Ted had
+spoken truly. He must have been mistaken,
+Peter thought, as he recalled the kindness of
+Sarah and Benzeor's wife in permitting the
+children to find a shelter in their home.</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps the perplexed lad's face betrayed
+his feelings, for just at that moment Benzeor
+looked up and said,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"There! That boy knows me!" and he
+pointed at Little Peter as he spoke. "He
+knows all about me, for he's a neighbor of
+mine. I tell you there's been a mistake.
+I'm not the man you're"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[247]</a></span>&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor's words were suddenly interrupted
+by Ted, who thrust his head again under the
+water, and when he lifted him out once more
+the prisoner was sputtering and gasping for
+breath.</p>
+
+<p>"Made a mistake, did I?" exclaimed the
+angry giant. "Well, mebbe I did, but I
+reckon the biggest one was in not keepin'
+you under the river all the time. Runnin'
+round here prowlin' on defenseless women
+folks and tryin' to steal what little money
+they've got left! Drownin' 's too good for
+such as you!" And, unable to restrain himself,
+the angry man again shook his helpless
+victim till it seemed as if the little breath Benzeor
+retained must be driven from his body.</p>
+
+<p>"I&mdash;I&mdash;I'm telling you the truth,"
+gasped Benzeor when he had recovered sufficiently
+to be able to speak again. "Won't
+you help me? Won't you save me from this&mdash;this&mdash;man?"
+he pleaded, turning to the
+men in the whaleboat. "That&mdash;that boy
+there knows me, and he'll tell you I&mdash;I&mdash;I'm
+all right. Won't you, Little Peter?
+Please! Please, tell them!"</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know him?" said the leader to
+Little Peter.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," replied the lad quietly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[248]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Ye don't know any good of him, do ye?"
+said Ted, interrupting, and tightening his
+grasp upon the collar of his victim as he
+spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"He is a neighbor of mine, as he said. I
+never knew any bad of him. And his wife
+and girl are taking care of the children. I
+know that." Little Peter was perplexed, and
+his suspicions had been aroused by the discovery
+of his neighbor in his present predicament,
+but the recollection of Sarah's kindness
+moved him to refer to their recent actions, in
+the hope that he might aid her father.</p>
+
+<p>"Ho! ho! ho!" laughed Ted. "Then
+his wife takes care of her children, does she?
+She must be a wonderful woman to do that.
+Well, let her take care of her brats, and I'll
+take care of her man, and good care, too!"</p>
+
+<p>As Ted acted as if he were about to renew
+his attentions, the leader hastily said, "The
+lad doesn't mean this fellow's children, but
+his own little brothers and sisters," and in a
+few words he related the story of the attack
+on Little Peter's home, and the sad loss
+which had occurred there.</p>
+
+<p>"Ye don't say so!" said Ted, bestowing a
+glance of sympathy upon the boy. "That's
+bad! It is indeed! And ye say this fellow<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[249]</a></span>
+has taken yer little brothers and sisters into
+his place?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," said Peter eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, all I can say is that I'd about as
+soon put a hawk to look after chickens, if it
+was my doin's."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," said Benzeor quickly, striving to
+take advantage of the impression which Little
+Peter's words had momentarily created.
+"Yes, the children are all at my house, and
+being well looked after, too. That doesn't
+look very much, does it, as if I was a bad
+man? I tell you there's been a mistake!
+There's been a mistake! I didn't have
+anything to do with the attack on this man's
+place. Help me! Help me!" he hastily cried
+out, as Ted acted as if he were about to repeat
+his former actions.</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on a minute, Ted. Perhaps the
+man's got something more to say," said the
+leader.</p>
+
+<p>"I am a-holdin' on. Can't ye see that?"
+replied Ted grimly, once more tightening his
+grasp upon the unfortunate Benzeor's collar.</p>
+
+<p>"I have got something to say. Something
+you want to hear, too," said Benzeor eagerly,
+and appealing to the leader in the whaleboat
+as he spoke.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[250]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Say it," said Ted gruffly.</p>
+
+<p>"The British are going to make an attack
+on the ship down in the bay."</p>
+
+<p>"What's that you say?" said the leader
+quickly. "Do you mean on the Washington?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, yes, that's just what I mean. There
+are a couple of gunboats off the shore here
+now, and they're going to land some men
+and get her back again."</p>
+
+<p>"There are two boats off the shore, Ted.
+I happen to know that, for this very craft
+we've got along with us we took from them
+this afternoon," said the leader. And he
+briefly related the story of the capture.</p>
+
+<p>"There, ye see I'm right!" said Benzeor,
+eager to follow up the impression his words
+and those of the leader had created. "Now
+if you'll help me out of the clutches of"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Keep still, you!" interrupted Ted angrily.
+"It'll be time enough for you to
+talk when I let go on ye. I reckon nobody
+is a-goin' to take you out o' my clutches till
+I get good and ready to let ye go. Now
+then, stand up straight and speak yer piece
+like a little man! How did ye happen to
+know the British was a-goin' to make an
+attack on the Washington?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[251]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I heard one of the men up by your house
+say so."</p>
+
+<p>"I thought ye didn't have anything to do
+with that attack on poor Sallie! She's my
+wife, I'd have ye know. I thought you was
+a-sayin' you wasn't there, and all the time I
+see ye, and chased ye right out o' my yard,
+clear down to the river! And now ye say
+ye heard one of the men there tell about the
+plan the British have on deck to get the
+Washington back again!"</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't say I wasn't there," pleaded
+Benzeor. "All I said was that I didn't
+have anything to do with it, and I didn't."</p>
+
+<p>"Ye"&mdash;began Ted, all his anger instantly
+returning.</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on, Ted! Hold on! Let's hear
+what the man has to say," exclaimed the
+leader.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll hold on, never ye fret yerself about
+that!" replied Ted, still retaining a firm
+grasp on his victim, but nevertheless abandoning
+the action he had evidently had in mind.</p>
+
+<p>"I was there, I'm not denying that,"
+pleaded Benzeor; "but I didn't have a gun
+in my hands, and I didn't touch the rope
+either. I fell in with the men and they
+made me go with them. I just couldn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[252]</a></span>
+help myself. And it was while I was there
+I heard 'em talking about the plan to take
+the Love&mdash;I mean the Washington," he
+hastily added. "They're going to take her
+in the morning."</p>
+
+<p>"You mean they're going to try to take
+her," said the leader.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's what I mean; they're going
+to try to take her."</p>
+
+<p>"The reptile may be tellin' the truth,"
+said Ted soberly. "I had some o' the best
+o' the Washington's cargo myself. Ye know
+they brought about all that was aboard o' her
+up to Manasquan, and sold it here, or leastwise
+Marshal John Stokes sold it for 'em. I
+happen to know about that, and the vermin
+here may be tellin' the truth. Sometimes he
+does it by mistake, I suppose."</p>
+
+<p>A few weeks prior to this time the British
+ship Love and Unity ran ashore near Tom's
+River. There were those among the people
+of the region who wagged their heads and
+winked slyly whenever they referred to the
+misfortune of the vessel, for it was a prevailing
+impression there that the pilot had not
+been especially favorable to the British, and
+more by design than by accident had grounded
+the vessel near the shore.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[253]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Be that as it may, the militia had quickly
+rallied, and as most of the men were as much
+at home upon the water as they were upon
+the land, they seized the unfortunate Love
+and Unity, and brought her safely into port
+as a prize.</p>
+
+<p>The cargo was considered a very valuable
+one, consisting, as it did, chiefly of sugar and
+various liquors highly prized by the men of
+those days, and, after being duly advertised,
+was sold by John Stokes at Manasquan.</p>
+
+<p>The Love and Unity was renamed the
+Washington, and at this time was lying at
+anchor near the mouth of Tom's River,
+within the shelter of Barnegat Bay. As
+most of the men in the whaleboat, as well as
+the mighty Ted himself, were familiar with
+these facts, the words of Benzeor naturally
+created a far deeper impression than they
+might otherwise have done.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll tell ye what," said Ted suddenly,
+turning Benzeor about so that he could look
+directly into his face as he spoke, "ye seem
+so well posted I've half a mind to let ye go."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm telling you just exactly what I
+heard," said Benzeor, his hope of escape
+instantly increasing. "That's what I heard
+the men say."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[254]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"And it was in the mornin' when they
+was goin' to come?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I'm a-goin' to let you off. Hold
+on a minit," he added as Benzeor strove to
+free himself. "I haven't finished yet. I'm
+thinkin' of lettin' ye go on one condition."</p>
+
+<p>"What's that?" said Benzeor eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm comin' to that pretty quick. I'm
+pretty comfortable here, so to speak, and
+don't appear to be in such a hurry as
+you." As the two men were still standing
+in the water, and Benzeor's teeth were chattering
+from cold or fear, the words of the
+huge man were perhaps not fully appreciated
+by his prisoner. "Ye appear to be so happy
+over yer information&mdash;though fer my part I
+don't see what ye held it back till this time
+fer&mdash;that I'm a-goin' to give ye a treat. I'm
+a-goin' to let ye go, yes, I am; ye needn't be
+scart about that. Ye're goin', and I'll tell ye
+where ye're goin', too. Ye're goin, to join
+the crew o' this whaleboat and go down and
+help them defend the Washington against
+her enemies. That's the condition I'm
+placin' on ye, and that's what I'm goin' to
+do with ye."</p>
+
+<p>And the powerful man picked Benzeor up<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[255]</a></span>
+in his arms and placed him in the whaleboat
+next to Peter, who, we may be sure, had not
+been an uninterested observer of all that had
+occurred.</p>
+
+<p>"There ye be," said Ted, breaking forth
+into a loud laugh as he saw the dripping
+Benzeor hastily take his seat and glance
+apprehensively toward him. "Now, then,"
+he added, turning to the leader, and still
+remaining in the water, which came well up
+to his shoulders as he placed his hand on
+the side of the supply boat, "if ye want me
+to, I'll take charge o' yer prize. You'll be
+puttin' straight fer Tom's River, I doubt
+not, and ye won't want to be bothered by an
+extra craft. I'll hide her in a good place up
+the shore, and likely enough I may come
+down to the bay myself in the night. Ye'll
+be settin' up a-waitin' fer me, won't ye?"
+he added, speaking to Benzeor.</p>
+
+<p>As that individual made no reply, Ted
+again began to converse with the leader of
+the band, and in a few minutes all the details
+were arranged. The captured boat was to
+be left in his charge, and soon the whaleboat
+started down the river toward the ocean.</p>
+
+<p>The sun had now disappeared from sight,
+but the approach of night was all the more<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[256]</a></span>
+favorable for the plans of the men. When
+once they were out on the ocean, they hoisted
+a sail and sped rapidly down the coast.</p>
+
+<p>A sail of a little more than twenty miles
+brought them to Barnegat Inlet, and as they
+entered the bay it was decided to make use
+of the oars again. It was almost midnight
+when at last they saw the Washington at
+anchor in Tom's River, and their hail was
+quickly answered.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter was so thoroughly wearied by
+the labors of the long day that he was rejoiced
+to be told that he could turn in for
+the night. Benzeor was to have a hammock
+near him, and, tired as the lad was, he eagerly
+began to ply the man with questions when
+they had withdrawn from their fellows.</p>
+
+<p>"Benzeor, I came down here to find out
+about father. I suppose you know he was
+taken by Fenton's gang and that my mother
+was shot?"</p>
+
+<p>"I heard about it."</p>
+
+<p>"It was terrible, Benzeor. I don't know
+what I should have done if Sarah hadn't
+taken the children. 'Twas good of her, and
+of you, too, for you know all about it, I see.
+I shan't forget it very soon."</p>
+
+<p>As Benzeor made no reply, Peter continued:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[257]</a></span>
+"I don't know just what to do to find
+out about father. The pine robbers have
+their quarters down here, I'm told, and I
+thought I'd tell Captain Dennis about it and
+perhaps he would send out a party to search
+for him. I didn't know just what to make of
+your being here at first, but I see you have
+had trouble with them, too. That was mean
+of Ted to treat you as he did when you said
+the pine robbers made you go with them.
+Was it Fenton's band that got hold of
+you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; that is, I don't think so. I'm not
+just sure who they were."</p>
+
+<p>"Couldn't have been Fenton then, for
+you know him when you see him, I'm sure.
+Benzeor, don't you think I'd better report
+the capture of my father to Captain Dennis
+and ask him if he won't send out a searching
+party?"</p>
+
+<p>"No," said Benzeor slowly. "I don't
+think that will do any good."</p>
+
+<p>"Why not? What else can I do?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, the fact is," said Benzeor, "I
+heard those men talking about your father,
+too."</p>
+
+<p>"Did you?" said Peter eagerly, sitting up
+in his hammock as he spoke. He could not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[258]</a></span>
+see his companion's face in the darkness, and
+perhaps it was as well for the troubled lad
+that he could not, for he would have seen
+little to comfort him expressed upon it.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I heard 'em. There's no use in
+your reporting it to Captain Dennis or to
+any one else."</p>
+
+<p>"Why not? Why not? They haven't
+shot him, have they?"</p>
+
+<p>"No. He's been sent to New York."</p>
+
+<p>Peter said no more. The thick darkness
+seemed like that within his own soul. All
+his efforts had been worse than useless, and
+the troubled boy knew not what next to do.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[259]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XX</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE FLEET OF BARGES</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> present visit was by no means the
+first which Little Peter had made to Barnegat
+Bay and the vicinity of Tom's River. Before
+the outbreaking of the war he had occasionally
+gone there with Webberly West, the
+most noted hunter of deer and wolves in all
+the region. Great had been the pride of
+Little Peter when he had returned home with
+his first deer, some four or five years before
+this time; and, as he lay in his hammock
+that night, again and again his thoughts
+wandered from his present difficulties to the
+days when he had tramped through the
+region with the venerable hunter Webberly.</p>
+
+<p>The old man had died just before the war
+began, but many of his quaint expressions
+and kindly acts remained in Little Peter's
+memory. He it was who had taught him how
+to dig the pits and cover them over with
+brush, and place the tempting pieces of meat
+as a decoy for the prowling wolves. Little<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[260]</a></span>
+Peter could never forget the first time success
+had crowned his efforts, and he had looked
+down upon the eyes of the wolf which had
+fallen into the pit. He could feel the thrill
+of that excitement even now.</p>
+
+<p>And <ins title="Transcriber's Note: original reads 'Webberley'">Webberly</ins> had taught him also how
+to catch the great snapping turtles which
+abounded in the streams. Sometimes turtles
+were taken which weighed fully thirty pounds
+each. What savage creatures they were! and
+yet the old hunter had handled them as if
+he had known no fear. A constant war was
+waged upon these creatures by the settlers
+for two reasons, one of which was that they
+were highly valued as an article of food.
+The captive would be thrown into a barrel
+and for a few days fed upon the refuse from
+the tables, to which perhaps at times more
+substantial food would be added, and then
+when the turtles had gained the proper degree
+of plumpness, a feast would be made to
+which friends and neighbors were not infrequently
+invited. The eggs of the turtles
+also were highly valued; and so plentiful
+were they in the warm sand along the shore
+that a bushel-basket was frequently filled with
+them after a brief search. It was true the
+foxes were as eager as the men to dig out<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[261]</a></span>
+and devour the turtles' eggs, but the supply
+appeared to be almost inexhaustible and there
+were more than enough for all.</p>
+
+<p>Another reason which prompted the settlers
+to prey upon the huge turtles was the fact
+that their ducks suffered from the savage
+creatures. A turtle would seize a duck in
+his claws and tear and devour the bird in an
+incredibly short time. Naturally, the owners
+of the ducks objected to the methods of the
+turtles, and a constant warfare was the result.</p>
+
+<p>Peter had occasionally gone down to
+Barnegat with Indian John also. The Indian
+always seemed to know just where the
+clams could be found in greatest abundance,
+and he knew as well just how they ought to
+be cooked. He would dig a hole in the sand
+and then fill it with wood, to which he would
+set fire. Then the clams would be poured
+into the place and covered over with seaweed
+and brush. When a sufficient time had
+passed, the brush and seaweed would be
+raked out, and the cooked clams were considered
+as a great luxury. This custom of the
+Indians was bequeathed to the whites, and
+their method of cooking the clams remains
+in some portions of the land until this day.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[262]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Between the thoughts of his own troubles
+and his recollections of former visits to the
+place in which he then was, not much sleep
+came to Little Peter that night. The knowledge
+that his father had been sent to New
+York&mdash;for the troubled lad did not think of
+doubting Benzeor's words&mdash;and the prospect
+of an attack upon the Washington on the
+following morning were both sources of deep
+anxiety to the sadly troubled boy. Only four
+men were on board when the whaleboat had
+returned; and while the addition of the ten
+men she brought, or eleven if Benzeor was
+to be included in the list of the Washington's
+defenders, materially increased her strength,
+still, the prospect of a strong defense was
+not very bright, and if the truth was known
+Little Peter was not the only one on board
+who passed a sleepless night.</p>
+
+<p>In addition to all this, the lad was sorely
+troubled as to his own future movements.
+With his father a prisoner in New York and
+the children quartered for the present at Benzeor's,
+Little Peter could not determine what
+was best for him to do. To go to the city
+and seek to aid his father there would be
+worse than useless now; nor was he able to
+provide for his younger brothers and sisters.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[263]</a></span>
+The problem had not been solved when at
+last he fell into a troubled sleep, from which
+he was awakened by the sound of men moving
+about on deck.</p>
+
+<p>Hastily arising, and noting that Benzeor
+already was astir, he soon made his way up
+to his companions. The sun was well up in
+the eastern sky, and the men were preparing
+for such a defense as might be made against
+any attempt to retake the boat.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter found that the most of the
+men did not believe that any such attempt
+would be made; and the suspicion with which
+they regarded Benzeor increased the feeling
+of sympathy which the lad felt for him, for
+to him it seemed as if his neighbor had been
+most unjustly treated, not only by the powerful
+Ted, but by the men of the whaleboat as
+well. He thought he had abundant cause for
+believing in Benzeor's honesty, for had he
+not received his own little brothers and sisters
+into his home? Surely, a man who would do
+that could not be bad, and his indignation
+against his recent companions increased as
+he noticed their ill-concealed dislike for his
+neighbor.</p>
+
+<p>The men all had breakfast on board; and
+while a constant watch was maintained, nothing<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[264]</a></span>
+as yet had been seen to arouse their
+suspicion that an attack was likely to be
+made. Even Little Peter was beginning to
+think that either Benzeor had been mistaken
+or that the British had changed their plans,
+and that nothing would be done that morning.
+He was about to approach the leader
+and explain to him the necessity for his own
+departure, when he was startled by a cry
+from the watch.</p>
+
+<p>Looking out over the bay, Little Peter
+could see a number of barges approaching.
+Startled by the sight, he counted the boats
+until he could distinctly make out eight of
+them. Doubtless there were eight or ten
+men in each boat, and altogether there must
+be at least seventy in the approaching party.</p>
+
+<p>The excitement on board the Washington
+at once became intense. The men stood together
+on the deck watching the little fleet on
+the bay. The only means by which they
+could defend themselves were their muskets,
+and it was soon discovered that these would
+not avail much against the enemy, for with
+the aid of a glass it was discovered that in
+the bow of one of the approaching boats a
+small cannon had been mounted.</p>
+
+<p>A hurried consultation was held by the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[265]</a></span>
+men on board, to which neither Little Peter
+nor Benzeor was invited; the former because
+he was considered too young to be of much
+account, and the latter because no one trusted
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"They'll get this craft now," said Benzeor,
+approaching the place where the lad was
+standing. "Perhaps these fellows will believe
+me another time."</p>
+
+<p>There was a tone of exultation in Benzeor's
+voice that startled Little Peter, and turning
+quickly about he said, "You did speak truly,
+Benzeor. I wish I were out of this. We
+stand no chance at all."</p>
+
+<p>"You needn't be alarmed. There won't
+be any fighting done. You took my part
+yesterday, and I'll not see you suffer now.
+I'll fix you out all right."</p>
+
+<p>"You'll fix me out? I don't see what
+you can do. We ought to leave the ship this
+minute. I don't see what we're waiting
+for." Little Peter spoke anxiously and was
+at no pains to conceal the alarm he felt.</p>
+
+<p>"I hope they won't run," said Benzeor
+quietly. His air of confidence was confusing;
+but as yet Little Peter was not suspicious of
+his neighbor.</p>
+
+<p>"They don't act as if they were going to,"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[266]</a></span>
+said the lad quickly, as the assembly of the
+men broke up and all began to rush about
+the deck.</p>
+
+<p>"Come, my lad! come!" said the leader.
+"Lend a hand here! And you, too," he
+added to Benzeor; "bestir yourself."</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor's face fell, but he was in no position
+to refuse to obey. Such defenses as the
+Washington possessed were rolled together
+behind the rail, and it was at once evident
+that the men were not planning to give up
+the ship without a struggle.</p>
+
+<p>The long whaleboat was placed in readiness
+to receive them, in case flight became necessary,
+and then the men waited for the approach
+of the attacking party.</p>
+
+<p>The boats came steadily on, keeping well
+together. Little Peter found himself sharing
+in the excitement, but as the outlines of the
+men became more distinct his fears increased.
+What could be done against so many, for
+it was now seen that there were more men in
+the barges than at first had been estimated.
+The boats were spread out in a semicircle,
+but they were all converging toward the
+Washington, and plainly would begin the
+attack together. There were more of those
+small cannon also than at first had been<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[267]</a></span>
+seen; and as the boats came nearer and
+nearer, it was discovered that a man was
+standing near each and ready to fire at
+the word of command.</p>
+
+<p>The faces of the men on board the Washington
+were all pale now, and not a word
+had been spoken for several minutes. Each
+man was intent upon the movements of the
+men in the barges, and did not turn away
+from the sight before him. Benzeor was the
+sole exception, and Little Peter could not
+understand the meaning of the half exultant
+smile upon his face. For himself, he was too
+badly frightened to speak, and the evident
+fear manifested by his companions did not
+tend to allay his own.</p>
+
+<p>The waters in the mouth of the river
+spread out almost as smooth as glass. The
+rays of the morning sun were reflected from
+the surface of the water and made it sparkle
+like silver. The occasional call of some seabird
+or the flight of the low flying gulls
+were all that broke in upon the silence, but
+no one heeded them. It was that slow moving
+but steadily approaching fleet of barges
+that held the attention of all.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter wondered why the command
+to shoot was not given, for the boats were all<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[268]</a></span>
+within range now. His own hands were
+trembling in his excitement, but he was eager
+to act. At one moment he longed to leap
+overboard and try to swim to the shore, and
+then again he would feel as if he must do
+something to check the approach of those
+men in the barges.</p>
+
+<p>Not a word had yet been spoken, however.
+The oars of the approaching men could now
+be distinctly seen as they rose and fell together.
+Steadily on and on came the little
+fleet, and now could not be more than two
+hundred yards away. Why did not the men
+on board do something? He felt that the
+time for action had come, but all were standing
+silent and motionless, apparently fascinated
+by the sight before them. The smile
+on Benzeor's face was almost mocking, and
+Little Peter saw him look from the fleet to
+the men on board, almost as if he were exulting
+in their predicament. What could it all
+mean? Why was not something done? Surely
+the time for action had come, but still no
+one spoke.</p>
+
+<p>A hail now came from the approaching fleet,
+and the man who evidently was in command
+stood up in his place. He was still too far
+away for his words to be heard, and again<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[269]</a></span>
+the barges, which had halted for a moment,
+resumed their approach and with an increased
+speed.</p>
+
+<p>"Men," suddenly called the leader of those
+on board the Washington, in a low voice,
+"we must get out of this! We're outnumbered
+seven or eight to one, and it would
+be just murder for us to stay here. Man
+the whaleboat, and we'll put out for the
+shore."</p>
+
+<p>The hopelessness of any defense was so
+apparent that the men instantly responded
+and made a rush for the whaleboat, which
+had been made ready for just such an emergency.
+In a moment the men were on board
+and had grasped their oars preparatory to
+starting for the shore, when Little Peter suddenly
+noticed that Benzeor was not with them.</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on! Hold on a minute!" he called.
+"Benzeor isn't here!"</p>
+
+<p>The leader, who had remained on deck to
+be the last to leave, turned quickly at the
+words and discovered Benzeor striving to
+conceal himself among the defenses which
+had been piled together against the rail.</p>
+
+<p>"Here, you!" he shouted. "Come out of
+that and get aboard! Be quick about it!
+I'll wing you if you don't," he added, raising<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[270]</a></span>
+his gun as he spoke, noticing that his
+call was not likely to be heeded.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor quickly responded, and sullenly
+took his place on board the whaleboat; but
+the men were all too intent upon their escape
+to bestow much attention upon him.</p>
+
+<p>In a moment the leader leaped on board
+and gave the order to give way. The long
+whaleboat darted swiftly forward as the men
+began to pull desperately at their oars. They
+needed no encouragement now, for, with their
+departure from the Washington, their only
+hope of safety lay in a quick passage to the
+shore, which lay about a hundred yards away.</p>
+
+<p>A shout from the men in the barges
+greeted the appearance of the whaleboat as
+it shot out into sight, but the hail was not
+heeded. One of the small cannon was discharged,
+and from one of the barges came a
+volley; but only one man was hit, and the
+whaleboat rapidly increased its speed.</p>
+
+<p>The shore was near now, and the desperate
+men were putting forth all their strength.
+The barges did not pursue, for the sailors
+were intent upon gaining the ship first of all.
+In a few moments the whaleboat grounded,
+and the men leaped out and started quickly
+for the woods which grew close to the shore.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[271]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Little Peter was in the rear, and as he
+turned back to see what would be done by
+the other party, he was astonished to see
+Benzeor turn quickly and start at full speed
+for the whaleboat again. In a moment he
+had leaped on board, and, seizing one of the
+oars, with a strong push sent the boat far
+out upon the river.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[272]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE RIDE WITH THE LIEUTENANT</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Tom Coward</span> followed young Lieutenant
+Gordon as he led the way to the post to
+which Friend Nathan had tied the steed, and
+then stopped and for a moment gazed ruefully
+at the beast. His friend's good-natured
+laugh broke forth again as he beheld Tom's
+evident hesitancy about mounting to the back
+of the animal; and surely to a boy who had
+been accustomed to ride the colts in Benzeor's
+pastures without saddle or bridle, and dash
+about the lots in sheer delight at the antics
+and efforts of the unbroken steeds to dislodge
+their rider, there was not much to inspire or
+impress him in the sight of the broken-winded
+beast which Nathan had provided. Even the
+horse himself appeared to be conscious of his
+degradation, and stood motionless and with
+hanging head, as if he, too, would protest
+against any warlike efforts on his part.</p>
+
+<p>"I've only one request to make, Nathan,"
+said the lieutenant. "I'm sure you will not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[273]</a></span>
+object to it, but I think I'd better make it
+before we start."</p>
+
+<p>"What is thy request?" said the Quaker.</p>
+
+<p>"If General Washington once sees that
+horse, he'll want it for himself. You'll not
+object, will you, to his use of it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Nay. I think not that George Washington
+will care for this beast of mine," protested
+Nathan soberly, and apparently not
+suspecting that the young officer was poking
+fun at him. "Still, he may be able to make
+him of some use. Thee will not forget to
+see that I am suitably rewarded?"</p>
+
+<p>"Never fear as to that, though I doubt not
+my friend Tom here will be of the opinion
+that you ought to pay him handsomely for
+the pain he will suffer after he has ridden
+your beast a few miles. That is, if the horse
+can go as far as that."</p>
+
+<p>"Thy heart may rest easy as to that. He
+may limp when he first starts, but as soon as
+his joints are warmed he will do thy service."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll warm his joints, then," laughed
+the lieutenant. "You might be warming
+him up now, Tom," he added, turning to his
+companion, "while I'm getting my horse
+ready. He's in the barn, and I'll join you
+in a minute or two."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_274" id="Page_274">[274]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>In a brief time the officer returned, but
+his steed was showing the evidences of his
+recent hard work, and Nathan's eyes twinkled
+with satisfaction at the sight, for his own
+horse, perhaps, might not then be at such a
+disadvantage, and the prospect of a "suitable"
+reward became more promising.</p>
+
+<p>The young men quickly mounted, and,
+after thanking their host in a substantial
+manner for his hospitality, started down the
+long lane which led to the road beyond.
+Tom's horse limped painfully and caused no
+little delight to young Gordon, who again
+and again laughed aloud and offered all manner
+of suggestions to the lad concerning the
+impression he would create when the army
+should discover his approach.</p>
+
+<p>At times Tom thought of dismounting
+and, turning the horse loose in the road, strive
+to make his own way on foot; but the creaking
+joints of the poor beast seemed to find
+relief with action, and the young riders had
+not gone far on their way before, to the surprise
+of both, Nathan's steed was proving his
+ability to keep up with the lieutenant's horse,
+which evidently had been overridden and
+was in no condition for a hard ride.</p>
+
+<p>But, with the discovery of the service<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_275" id="Page_275">[275]</a></span>
+which Tom's horse might render, all the
+disposition to regard their journey lightly departed
+from the riders, and the serious nature
+of their undertaking rendered both of them
+silent. The American army could not be far
+distant now, but between them and it all the
+dangers had not disappeared. The visit of the
+British band at the home of Nathan Brown
+had indicated that other parties might be in
+the region on similar errands; but Tom was
+not thinking of these possibilities so much as
+was the young officer who was riding by his
+side.</p>
+
+<p>Tom's meditations were mostly concerning
+the American army. For months his strongest
+desire had been to join it, and now that
+the time had come when his desires were
+likely to be satisfied, he discovered that much
+of his eagerness was gone. Not that he had
+any thought of turning back, but the proximity
+of the two armies clearly indicated that
+a meeting between the forces was not improbable,
+and Tom's thoughts were largely of that.
+The glamour was all gone now, and the serious
+nature of his undertaking was uppermost
+in his mind. The silence also of his companion
+did not tend to allay his fears, but the
+lad did not refer to them, and was doing his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_276" id="Page_276">[276]</a></span>
+utmost to make his horse keep up the pace at
+which he was going.</p>
+
+<p>"Whew! This is a warm morning! Let's
+give our horses a drink and a rest," said the
+lieutenant at last, as he turned into a little
+brook that crossed the road.</p>
+
+<p>Tom followed his example, and the dripping
+horses thrust their heads deep into the water.
+The sun had now appeared and the beams
+fell full on their faces. The air was motionless,
+and even at that early hour was in places
+quivering under the heat of the summer sun.
+The very birds were silent, while high overhead
+the heavens were like brass. On the
+horizon masses of dark clouds were piled, and
+a low, deep rumble startled both the young
+riders.</p>
+
+<p>"Was that a cannon, or was it thunder?"
+inquired Tom quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"Thunder. We may hear the cannon before
+long, though."</p>
+
+<p>"Why don't we start on, then? The
+sooner we gain the army the better. We
+don't want to be caught in here between
+them." Tom spoke anxiously, and his fear
+was as apparent in the expression upon his
+face as in his words.</p>
+
+<p>"We've got to give our horses a bit of a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_277" id="Page_277">[277]</a></span>
+rest. Mine has been going hard all night,
+and yours won't be able to go far in such
+heat as this. We'll have to be careful of
+their strength, or we shall be worse off than
+we are now."</p>
+
+<p>"Have you been out all night? What
+have you been doing?"</p>
+
+<p>"Finding out what Clinton is up to. When
+I was talking with Nathan I knew all the
+time more about it than he did."</p>
+
+<p>"Did you find out?" said Tom eagerly.
+"What are the redcoats doing now?"</p>
+
+<p>"Pretty much the same thing they've been
+doing right along. They're making a change
+in the direction they're going, unless I'm
+greatly mistaken. And then, too, they've
+done something else which doesn't promise
+very well."</p>
+
+<p>"What's that?"</p>
+
+<p>"They've drawn all their stronger forces
+into the rear guard and sent on the Hessians
+with the baggage train in front, for one thing."</p>
+
+<p>"Why do you suppose they have done
+that?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, they've an idea, I fancy, that we're
+going to try to take their supplies. They'll
+find out, though, that we're after men more
+than we are after their baggage wagons.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_278" id="Page_278">[278]</a></span>
+However, that explains the change in the
+direction of their march, if I'm not greatly
+mistaken. They've put the Hessians in front
+and the best men behind."</p>
+
+<p>"I wish they had left the Dutch butchers
+there!" said Tom impulsively. "I hate the
+Hessians. I hate the very name and sight
+of them! Think of it! A lot of men just
+hired to come over here and shoot and kill
+and steal! I wish they had been left where
+they were, that is, if General Washington is
+ready for them!"</p>
+
+<p>"I think you'll find him ready when the
+time comes," remarked the lieutenant quietly.
+"But about the Hessians. I don't like them
+any better than you do, but somehow I can't
+bring myself to feel about it as some of the
+men do. I can't see that they're to be
+blamed for being brought over here, or even
+being engaged in such work as they're doing;
+and I know more about that than you do,
+too. The ones who are the worst are not
+those who have come over here, but those who
+have sent them. Just think of a petty little
+prince, or king, being able to hire out a lot of
+his own subjects to pay off his own debts
+with! These men feel just the same as you
+or I would, I have thought. They have<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_279" id="Page_279">[279]</a></span>
+wives and mothers and children, and yet they
+have to leave them all and come over here
+and be marks for our bullets, whether they
+want to be or not. They just haven't anything
+to say about it. They're told to come
+and come they must, though there won't be
+so many to go back as came over, I'm thinking.
+At least, I'm going to do all I can to
+thin out their ranks, though I feel sorry for
+the poor fellows all of the time."</p>
+
+<p>This was a new way of looking at the hated
+"Dutch butchers," at least it was entirely
+new to Tom Coward. He had heard only
+the expressions of rage among the colonists
+which their coming had aroused, and their
+strange words and brutal acts had never
+received much mercy in the judgment which
+he had heard passed upon them by his acquaintances.</p>
+
+<p>The anger of the patriots, perhaps, was but
+natural; but the employment of the Hessians
+has not furnished the only instance in history
+where the first and most apparent view has
+not always been the most correct one. Indeed,
+it frequently happens that the troubles
+between men, to say nothing of boys, arises
+from a misunderstanding; and it is the part of
+wisdom, as well as of justice, to look below<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_280" id="Page_280">[280]</a></span>
+the surface and try to discover the true conditions.</p>
+
+<p>"Then the British are to be blamed, if
+what you say is true," said Tom, after a brief
+silence. "They are the ones at the bottom
+of it all."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, the British are the ones who are
+most to be blamed. But even there, Tom, if
+I'm correctly informed, it's the leaders and
+not the people. The way I understand it is
+that the rank and file of the common people
+in England are opposed to this war, and
+would put a stop to it in a moment if they
+could."</p>
+
+<p>"If they could?" repeated Tom. "I don't
+understand what you mean."</p>
+
+<p>"Just what I say. The very best people
+in England have, from the very beginning of
+this war, been opposed to the taxes, the use
+of the Indians, and the hiring of these Hessians.
+It's the king and Lord North and
+a few others of the pig-headed fellows who
+are doing it all. Tom, my father and my
+mother both came from England. As far
+back as I can remember they have told me
+stories of our old home and of the friends
+we have over there. Why, do you know
+it's been the dream of my life to go over<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_281" id="Page_281">[281]</a></span>
+there some day, and meet some of my cousins
+and see the place where my father and mother
+were born."</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't know you were a tory," said
+Tom slowly.</p>
+
+<p>"Tory? I haven't a drop of tory blood
+in my veins, and hope I never shall have."</p>
+
+<p>"But&mdash;but&mdash;you talk like one."</p>
+
+<p>"Is it tory talk for me to say I don't blame
+the Hessians for coming over here, but those
+who hired them and sent them? Is it tory
+talk for me to say I love to think of the place
+where my father and mother were born, and
+that I should be glad to look into the faces
+of those who bear the same name I do, and
+who have some of the same kind of blood in
+their veins? Is it tory talk for me to say
+that I'm proud of what Old England has
+done, or rather of many things she has done,
+from the days of William the Conqueror until
+now? And that belongs to me as much as
+it does to them, for my own grandfather was
+one of the bravest men in the whole British
+army! This war is like one between brothers,
+and it's all the more wicked on that
+account. And it's worse yet, because the
+most of the Englishmen are not in favor of
+it at all."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_282" id="Page_282">[282]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I don't just see why you don't fight with
+the redcoats, instead of against them, then."</p>
+
+<p>"Because this is my home and this is my
+country, and because the king and his court
+aren't fit to govern cannibals, to say nothing
+of men. No, sir, it's just because I do believe
+in all I've said that I'm fighting for
+my country and shall till the war is ended&mdash;which
+I hope will be soon!"</p>
+
+<p>"And would you shoot a redcoat or a
+Dutch butcher?"</p>
+
+<p>"Every time! It was a sad thing that the
+war had to come, but as come it did, it would
+be sadder still not to do everything in our
+power now to carry it through. I'm sorry
+for the Hessians, but I'd shoot every one of
+them if I could do it. I'm sorry for the
+redcoats, and I know they are not to be
+blamed, or at least some of them are not,
+but I'd mow them down now, every one of
+them, as I'd cut the grass in haying-time.
+Fight? Why, my lad, I'm in this war from
+the crown of my head to the sole of my
+foot! And I wouldn't stop till the redcoats
+cry 'enough,' or we drive them right into
+the Atlantic ocean, the way Parson Tennent
+used to tell about the pigs in Gadara being
+chased by the devils right into the sea. Not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_283" id="Page_283">[283]</a></span>
+that I think the ones who are doing the
+chasing are in any way connected with the
+swine drivers in the parson's story," he added,
+laughing lightly as he spoke. "But we must
+be going. Our horses are rested now, and
+we'll be running into a thunder-storm before
+we see the Continentals, if we don't look
+out."</p>
+
+<p>The ride was quickly resumed, but Tom
+Coward was silent and sadly puzzled to account
+for his friend's words. Apparently, he
+was enthusiastic in his devotion to the cause
+of the patriots, but he had never heard any
+one talk in that manner before. His friends
+and neighbors were all hard and bitter, and
+the bitterness seemed to increase as the war
+continued. But here was his friend, fighting
+with all the devotion of his heart, and yet
+not blaming the very men he was trying hard
+to conquer for the part they were taking in
+the war.</p>
+
+<p>It seemed to him all strange, and while he
+was deeply impressed by many of the words
+of the enthusiastic young lieutenant, his own
+feelings were of a very decidedly different
+character. For a half hour they rode forward
+as swiftly as their steeds could carry
+them, but the heavy clouds had meanwhile<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_284" id="Page_284">[284]</a></span>
+been climbing higher in the heavens, and the
+mutterings of the thunder had now become
+deeper and heavier.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll put into that barn ahead there,
+and wait for the storm to pass," said the
+lieutenant, pointing as he spoke to a rude
+barn by the roadside.</p>
+
+<p>As the rain was now falling, Tom was glad
+to follow the advice, and in a few moments
+they approached the open door. They had
+not dismounted when a strangely clad being
+stepped forth from the barn and shouted:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Halt, will yez? I'll be after havin' yez
+give an account of yerselves, that I will."</p>
+
+<p>Tom glanced up in fear and surprise, and
+the sight before him did not tend to allay his
+alarm. The soldier presented a gun, but was
+its bearer a man or woman? A long petticoat
+certainly looked like the garb of a
+woman, but the soldier also was clad in an
+artilleryman's coat, while a cocked hat and
+feathers crowned the head of the strange
+being.</p>
+
+<p>Tall, broad-shouldered, and with a voice
+that was gruff and deep, the strangely clad
+soldier bore but slight resemblance to a woman,
+though the dress certainly seemed to
+proclaim the sex of the speaker.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_285" id="Page_285">[285]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The rain was now falling in torrents and
+Tom was drenched in a moment; but in the
+brief silence which followed the demand of the
+soldier, he could not determine what course
+his companion would decide to follow.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_286" id="Page_286">[286]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>A SOLDIER WOMAN</div>
+
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">Why</span>, Molly, you aren't going to keep
+us out here in the rain, are you?"</p>
+
+<p>Tom looked up in surprise as he heard the
+young lieutenant's words; and while his fears
+were somewhat relieved by the assurance that
+his companion evidently had recognized the
+peculiar being before them, his confusion
+was not diminished by the reply which the
+strangely clad woman quickly made.</p>
+
+<p>"Sure, and it's me bye! It's me beautiful
+bye! Come in, me darlint! What
+for should ye be standin' out there in the
+storm?"</p>
+
+<p>The two dripping young soldiers speedily
+accepted the invitation, and entered the barn,
+leading their horses with them. To their
+surprise they now discovered that several men
+were also in the building, and that other
+horses were stalled in the barn.</p>
+
+<p>The appearance of Tom's horse was greeted
+by a shout of delight, and the person whom<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_287" id="Page_287">[287]</a></span>
+Lieutenant Gordon had addressed as "Molly"
+approached, and, after critically examining
+the poor beast for a moment, said:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"And where in the world did ye be after
+findin' that? It's a pity, it is indade, to be
+after compellin' such poor bastes as that to be
+fightin' the Dootch butchers! Sure, and it's
+the surgeon the poor thing is after needin'."</p>
+
+<p>Molly's hair was of a bright red color, her
+face was covered with freckles, which were
+like great blotches upon the skin, and her
+eyes were so faded as to be almost colorless;
+but her expression was so evidently one of
+good nature that Tom was compelled to join
+in the laugh which her words raised among
+the half dozen men who quickly assembled to
+pass judgment upon the steed which had been
+led into the barn.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, that's something we bought back
+here to carry my friend as far as the army."</p>
+
+<p>"It's lucky, it is, that ye haven't very far
+to go, thin," laughed Molly.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps you're right, Molly," replied
+the lieutenant. "How far back is the army
+now?"</p>
+
+<p>"About a mile, I'm thinkin'."</p>
+
+<p>"What? What's that you say? Only a
+mile from here?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_288" id="Page_288">[288]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"That's what I'm tellin' yez. The army's
+been marchin' in the night; but this rain will
+be after compellin' it to halt right in&mdash;in
+Gooseberry, as I'm told they call it."</p>
+
+<p>"Cranberry," laughed the lieutenant.</p>
+
+<p>"Cranberry or Gooseberry is all one and
+the same thing to me. Now, me bye, ye'll
+be after wantin' some breakfast, I'm thinkin'.
+Jest say the word and I'll be fixin' ye out,
+and have a bit left over for yer poor baste,
+which doesn't look as if he'd been livin' any
+too high of late."</p>
+
+<p>"No, no, Molly," protested the lieutenant
+quickly, and, as Tom thought, with an eagerness
+he could not understand. "We're not
+hungry, for we had some breakfast before we
+started this morning. We did indeed," he
+added, as he noted the woman's apparent
+unbelief. "We're not hungry, but it's kind
+of you to think of us, and we thank you
+just the same as if you had fed us."</p>
+
+<p>In the course of the conversation between
+the young lieutenant and the men in the
+barn, Tom learned that the main body of the
+army was now less than a mile away. The
+little band had been one of the advance
+parties, and the storm had compelled them to
+seek the shelter of the barn by the roadside.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_289" id="Page_289">[289]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, the rain continued to fall, and
+long after the thunder ceased the storm
+showed no signs of abating. The water
+almost covered the road and penetrated the
+roof of the barn, which was far from being
+in a good state of repair. The heavy downpour,
+however, did not seem to cool the air,
+and the men and horses were in a sad plight.
+Just why they should have sought the shelter,
+which virtually was no shelter at all, Tom
+could not understand; but he asked no questions,
+and busied himself in listening to the
+conversation of the men, and watching the
+intrepid Molly, who to all appearances was
+not aware of the fact that she was not as
+much of a true soldier as any of the men.</p>
+
+<p>After a half hour had passed the lieutenant
+approached the boy, who was standing before
+the open door, looking out upon the storm.</p>
+
+<p>"Who is she? What is she?" inquired
+Tom, indicating by a glance of his eyes the
+strange woman whom his friend had addressed
+as "Molly."</p>
+
+<p>"She? Oh, she's the wife of one of the
+cannoneers. She's been in the army for a
+long time. She's from New Jersey, too, I
+understand, though her husband's home is in
+Pennsylvania."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_290" id="Page_290">[290]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I didn't know there were women in the
+army."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh yes, there have always been some.
+Why, even on that expedition of Arnold's
+to Quebec there were several women who
+marched all the way with their husbands, and
+they say they stood the long tramps and the
+cold better than a good many of the men did."</p>
+
+<p>"Why did you call this woman 'Molly'?
+Is that her name?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, in the army, or at least in this army,
+the women have been the ones to bring us
+water on the warm days, and so we call each
+one Molly 'Pitcher.' They've been kept
+busy during this hot spell, too. This woman's
+name I believe is really Molly, though,&mdash;Molly
+McCauley. Then you didn't expect to
+see women with their husbands in the army?"
+laughed the lieutenant, as he noticed that Tom
+was regarding Mistress McCauley curiously.</p>
+
+<p>"No, I didn't. I don't think I like it."</p>
+
+<p>"You'll find all sorts and kinds of people
+in the ranks. Some of the women have been
+worth more than the men. There was one up
+at Fort Clinton. She was very much such a
+looking woman as Captain Molly here, only
+she was a good deal more careless. They
+used to call her 'Dirty Kate,' because she<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_291" id="Page_291">[291]</a></span>
+wasn't always very neat in her personal appearance.
+But she was brave as a lion, and
+such a fighter! Why, she fired the last
+cannon at the British, as they came scrambling
+over the ramparts, which happened to
+be about the same time our men were leaving.
+Well, Kate's husband was a cannoneer, just
+as Molly's here is, and he was holding the
+match in his hand ready to fire the gun when
+he saw the redcoats coming, and the sight
+suddenly reminded him that he had some
+work to do outside the fort which demanded
+his immediate attention. Well, Kate just
+picked up the match her husband had dropped,
+touched off the cannon, and then scampered
+away after the men. She was a brave woman,
+and so is Captain Molly, here. She'd do as
+well as Kate did, if she had the chance, and
+perhaps she will before the end comes. I
+shouldn't want to have her fight me, I can
+tell you!"<a name="FNanchor_2_2" id="FNanchor_2_2"></a><a href="#Footnote_2_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a></p>
+
+<p>Tom turned and looked again at the woman.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_292" id="Page_292">[292]</a></span>
+She stood talking with her husband now, and
+her strange garb served to intensify her
+peculiarities. Her great size and evident
+strength were plainly to be seen, but her face
+beamed with good nature, and her enjoyment
+of the life she was living was indicated by
+her every word and action.</p>
+
+<p>Tom thought of Sarah, and the contrast
+between her gentleness and the rough appearance
+and masculine manners of Captain Molly
+aroused within him a feeling which was not
+altogether in favor of the soldier woman. It
+is true that the name of Sarah is unknown
+to-day, while that of Captain Molly Pitcher
+is recorded in all our school histories; but,
+after all, notoriety may not be the most valuable
+quality in life, and while the names of
+many men and women who lived quiet, faithful,
+honest lives may have been forgotten
+by their descendants, they may not have been
+of the less value to the world because of that
+fact. A good name is sometimes better than
+a notorious one, and an honest man, though
+he may be soon forgotten, may be greater
+than a dishonest man whose name is frequently
+mentioned. Few of us would desire
+to be like Benedict Arnold, although his
+name is a very familiar one to all.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_293" id="Page_293">[293]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I don't see any use in staying here," said
+Tom at last. "It's wet inside the barn, and
+it can't be much worse outside. Why don't
+we start on?"</p>
+
+<p>Now that he was so near to the American
+army, the lad was eager to go forward. All
+his dreams and visions of the forces which
+were fighting against the redcoats came back
+to him, and his impatience to proceed increased
+each moment. Perhaps the sight and
+presence of Captain Molly, as well as the
+account the young lieutenant had given of
+her, had created a still greater desire in Tom's
+heart to quit the place; but, be that as it
+may, he was ready to go, and apparently his
+companion shared in his feeling.</p>
+
+<p>"If you think your horse will stand up for
+a mile, we might do as you say," replied the
+lieutenant. "I think we'll be going on,"
+he added, turning to the men as he spoke.
+"I've some important information to give
+the general, and as I don't see any signs of
+the rain stopping, I think we ought not to
+delay longer. We can't be much worse off
+than we are now."</p>
+
+<p>"Sure, and ye'll not be after goin' out in
+such a storm as this!" protested Molly. "It
+would be a shame to take that poor baste out<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_294" id="Page_294">[294]</a></span>
+into the rain now. He has all he can do to
+stand up in the barn, to say nothin' of havin'
+to be carryin' a load. It's the last drop
+that'll be after breakin' of his back, yez
+know."</p>
+
+<p>The men all laughed at the woman's words,
+but the lieutenant was not to be deterred,
+and accordingly the horses were brought
+forth and the two men speedily mounted.
+Tom's horse was limping painfully when he
+started, and as the lad glanced backward he
+could see Captain Molly standing in the doorway,
+her hands resting upon her hips, and her
+broad, freckled face beaming with delight
+over the sorry spectacle he was well aware
+that he presented.</p>
+
+<p>A feeling of disgust arose in his heart as
+he watched her. Surely she must be lacking
+in all the qualities which he had most honored
+in the women he knew. Coarseness was in
+place of delicacy, boldness instead of modesty,
+and her entire bearing was such that Tom
+never afterwards could hear her name mentioned
+without expressing his disgust. Not
+even the bravery of the deed which Captain
+Molly Pitcher did not many hours after this
+time, and which Tom Coward himself witnessed,
+entirely banished the prejudice which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_295" id="Page_295">[295]</a></span>
+he entertained against the coarse, good-natured,
+manly, unwomanly woman.</p>
+
+<p>The storm had ceased when, after a short
+ride, Tom and his companion first came
+within sight of the American army. All the
+long pent-up hopes of the lad were now about
+to be fulfilled, and for the first time in his
+life he was to look upon the men whose
+names and deeds had long been familiar to
+him. His eagerness brought a smile to his
+companion's face, but while he watched the
+lad he did not speak.</p>
+
+<p>Molly Pitcher had spoken truly, and the
+American army had halted after a brief
+march from Kingston in the preceding night,
+and now were compelled to remain during the
+entire day in Cranberry. Only the advance
+corps had moved forward, and at that time
+were holding a position on the road to Monmouth
+Court House and within five miles of
+the rear of the British.</p>
+
+<p>In spite of his own excitement, and that
+which was apparent among the men in the
+camp when Tom and the lieutenant entered,
+the lad's first feeling was one of keen disappointment.
+Were these the men of whom he
+had heard so much and from whom so much
+was expected? Mud-stained, worn by their<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_296" id="Page_296">[296]</a></span>
+recent exertions, plainly showing the effects
+of the intense heat, many of them without
+uniforms, some hatless and coatless, to the
+vision of Tom Coward they presented far
+more the appearance of a mob than of the
+orderly and well-trained soldiers he had expected
+to see.</p>
+
+<p>The young lieutenant had left him as soon
+as they entered the camp, leading the two
+horses away with him,&mdash;a fact over which
+Tom did not long lament, we may be sure. An
+hour passed before the young officer returned,
+for he was to make a report of all that he
+had learned, and Tom's hopes were not
+strengthened as he watched the men about
+him during his companion's absence.</p>
+
+<p>Lieutenant Gordon noticed the expression
+upon Tom's face when he rejoined him, but,
+attributing it to the fear which he supposed
+the lad felt, he did not refer to it, and in the
+labors which soon followed no opportunity to
+explain was given by either.</p>
+
+<p>General Dickinson, with the New Jersey
+militia, was not with the main body, as we
+already know, and Tom found that he could
+not be assigned to them. Through the lieutenant's
+influence, he was to be retained with
+the main body, and to assist in serving as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_297" id="Page_297">[297]</a></span>
+a guide for the army, an office which Tom
+was well fitted to hold, although it was not
+just in accord with the plans he had formed
+in his own mind.</p>
+
+<p>Reports came into the camp during the
+day which clearly indicated that the advance
+corps was too far away to be properly supported
+at once in the present condition of the
+roads. But on Saturday morning Lafayette,
+with his troops, was ordered to file off by his
+left towards Englishtown, and in the same
+day the main body, under General Washington,
+marched out from Cranberry and encamped
+within three miles of the place.</p>
+
+<p>This brought the two opposing armies
+now within eight miles of each other, while
+General Lee's forces, five thousand strong,
+without Morgan's dragoons or the New Jersey
+militia, were three miles nearer the British.</p>
+
+<p>Such was the condition of affairs on that
+night of Saturday, June 27 (1778), and
+Tom Coward, as well as many of the men
+in Washington's army, slept but little, with
+the knowledge that on the morrow the long
+delayed battle would doubtless be begun.</p>
+
+<div class="footnotes"><h3>FOOTNOTE:</h3>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_2_2" id="Footnote_2_2"></a><a href="#FNanchor_2_2"><span class="label">[2]</span></a> In many of our histories the "Captain Molly" of Monmouth
+has been confounded with "Dirty Kate" of Fort
+Clinton. They were, however, two women,&mdash;not one. Lossing,
+in the first edition of his <i>Field Book of the American
+Revolution</i>, referred to them as if they were identical, but
+the correction was to have been made for his second edition,
+and was in type, but through an oversight was omitted.</p></div>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_298" id="Page_298">[298]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXIII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>AN INTERRUPTED JOURNEY</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> surprise of Little Peter at the unexpected
+action of Benzeor was increased when
+the escaping man seated himself in the whaleboat
+and quickly began to row the long craft
+back toward the Washington.</p>
+
+<p>"Hurrah for the redcoats! Hurrah for
+King George! Hurrah for the British!"
+shouted Benzeor defiantly.</p>
+
+<p>This boldness was as surprising to Peter as
+the sudden departure had been; but, as he
+glanced toward the Washington and saw that
+the attacking party had already boarded her,
+and then realized that he himself had been
+left alone by his recent companions, he was
+quickly recalled to the necessity of action on
+his own part. Without waiting to observe
+the further movements of Benzeor or the
+British, he instantly turned and entered the
+woods; but a quarter of an hour had elapsed
+before he overtook the men, whom he found
+resting by the side of the road which led past
+the home of Ted Wilson.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_299" id="Page_299">[299]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>To this house the entire party now made
+their way, and as Ted listened to the story
+of Benzeor's perfidy, his anger broke forth
+afresh.</p>
+
+<p>"I never ought to have let the rascal go!"
+exclaimed Ted excitedly. "I had him right
+there in the river, and if you hadn't interfered
+with me I'd have fixed him so that he
+never would have betrayed any one again.
+Now the rascal's where he can keep up his
+evil doings."</p>
+
+<p>"He's shown where he stands, any way.
+That's some comfort," said one of the men.</p>
+
+<p>"It may comfort you, but it doesn't me,"
+replied Ted. "I'm a peaceable man, I am,
+and I never cared much about whether it was
+to be the King of England or the Continental
+Congress that ruled over me. I don't see as
+it would make very much difference to me,
+for my part. But when that rascal hangs my
+Sallie up on the limb of a tree,&mdash;Sallie's
+my wife, ye know,&mdash;why, then Benzeor Osburn
+has jest got to look out for himself."</p>
+
+<p>Ted's anger was so evident that Little
+Peter almost had a feeling of sympathy for
+Benzeor, angry as he himself was at the
+treachery his neighbor had displayed.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you going to follow him up, Ted?"
+inquired the leader.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_300" id="Page_300">[300]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Am I goin' to follow him? That's just
+what I'm going to do! I'm goin' to send
+Sallie and the babies over to your house, and
+I'm just goin' to leave my place here,&mdash;they
+can't steal that, any way,&mdash;and follow up
+Benzeor Osburn till I find him. I don't care
+if he runs clear to the other side of the Alleghany
+Mountains,&mdash;I've heard as how there
+was some mountains by that name away out
+west somewhere,&mdash;why, Benzeor'll wake up
+some fine mornin' and find himself a-shakin'
+hands with me. Yes, sir, this land o' ours
+may put up with the Hessians, but it isn't
+big enough to hold such a fellow as Benzeor!
+Hangin' Sallies! I'll put a stop to his fine
+work! Sallie's my wife, ye know!"</p>
+
+<p>"Remember us to him when you meet him,
+Ted," said the leader. "You can charge
+him for the loss of the Washington, too!"</p>
+
+<p>"His door will be free of all chalk scores
+when I'm done with him," said Ted savagely.
+"That's goin' to be my work, clearin' the
+land of pine robbers, just as I once cleared it
+of pine stumps!"</p>
+
+<p>"We must start on now," said the leader.
+"Take your wife and children up to my
+house, Ted. The women can fight together
+against the pine robbers, if they come there."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_301" id="Page_301">[301]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"They won't come there," replied Ted.
+"There'll be fewer of 'em when I've done
+my duty. There'll be no more hangin' Sallies.
+Sallie's my wife, ye know."</p>
+
+<p>"I suspected as much from your words,"
+said the leader. "Are you going with us?"
+he added, turning, as he spoke, to Little Peter.</p>
+
+<p>"No," replied the lad.</p>
+
+<p>"What are you going to do now? You
+can't get your father out of the New York
+prisons. You'd better come with us."</p>
+
+<p>"I can't. I've other work to do."</p>
+
+<p>"Have it your own way, my lad, though I
+think you're making a mistake not to come
+with us."</p>
+
+<p>The band soon departed, leaving Little
+Peter and the huge Ted behind them. There
+was slight likelihood that the men who had
+captured the Washington would venture on
+shore to pursue the fugitives, and the knowledge
+of this fact had made all the parties
+feel comparatively safe.</p>
+
+<p>"What are you goin' to do now?" said
+Ted, when he and Little Peter were left
+alone.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going straight to Benzeor's house.
+After what I have just seen, I'm afraid to
+leave the children there another minute. I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_302" id="Page_302">[302]</a></span>
+never would have thought Benzeor was a
+traitor, never! But he is, there's no doubt
+about it now! I don't know what will become
+of them. I don't know where to turn,
+or what to do."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter then went on to relate the
+story of the sad loss which had occurred in
+his home, Ted listening meanwhile with intense
+interest.</p>
+
+<p>"It's Benzeor's work!" he said excitedly
+when the lad at last stopped. "Yes, sir!
+You mark my words, Benzeor Osburn was at
+the bottom of it all. You'll have to go in
+with me and help rid the land of him! The
+rascal! Goin' round hangin' Sallies and
+shootin' mothers!"</p>
+
+<p>"I've all I want to do to look after my
+little brothers and sisters," said Little Peter
+quietly. "I don't know what I can do with
+them, but I can't leave them at Benzeor's!"</p>
+
+<p>"No more you can't," said Ted. "I'll
+tell you what to do with 'em. Jest bring
+'em all down here and leave 'em with Sallie
+over at the captain's. I think they'll be safe
+enough there."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you; but it's most too far to bring
+them, I'm afraid. It's a good twenty miles
+from here, and we haven't a horse left."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_303" id="Page_303">[303]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I wish I could let ye have one, but all of
+mine are gone too, except one little mule;
+and you'd have to turn him round and make
+him go backward if you wanted to go anywhere,
+he's such an obstinate little beast.
+I'll tell you what I'll do, Peter! Just as
+soon as I've taken Sallie&mdash;she's my wife,
+ye know&mdash;and the babies over to the captain's,
+I'll go with ye and help ye out.
+That's what I'll do for ye."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you again," replied Peter, "but I
+don't think you had better do it. You may
+be needed around here, and I don't know yet
+what I shall do."</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe you're right, Peter, maybe you're
+right. Well, have it your own way. When
+are you goin' to start?"</p>
+
+<p>"Right away."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter at once bade his friend good-by
+and started forth on his long walk. He
+had appreciated the offer of the mighty Ted,
+but there were many reasons why he wished
+to be alone, for a time at least. Benzeor's
+treachery was still so fresh in his mind that
+he knew not what to do, and the excitement
+attending the escape from the Washington
+had not yet disappeared. Then, too, he did
+not know what the angry giant might be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_304" id="Page_304">[304]</a></span>
+moved to do. Ordinarily good-natured and
+easy-going as the powerful man was, when
+once his wrath was aroused there would be
+no limits to what it might lead him into.
+And Little Peter's heart was too heavy, under
+the burden of his recent sorrows and present
+perplexities, to permit the lad to be drawn
+aside from the task which had presented itself
+to him.</p>
+
+<p>He had gone about half the way down the
+long lane which led from Ted's house to the
+road, when he heard some one calling to him.
+Looking quickly behind him, he discovered
+Ted himself running rapidly down the path
+toward him.</p>
+
+<p>Startled by the sight and fearful that some
+new danger had appeared, he stopped, and
+then turned back to meet the man.</p>
+
+<p>"What is it? What is it?" he called.</p>
+
+<p>Ted stopped as the lad called, and, shaking
+one of his great fists in the air, replied,
+"Hangin' Sallies! Hangin' Sallies!"</p>
+
+<p>"What? Have they tried it again?"</p>
+
+<p>"No! Once was enough, I should think,
+when Sallie's my wife, ye know! I just
+wanted to remind ye what the password was.
+It's 'Hangin' Sallies,' that's what it is! Ye
+won't forget it, will ye?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_305" id="Page_305">[305]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No," replied Peter soberly. "I'll try to
+keep it in mind."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right! See that ye do! Hangin'
+Sallies, that's the word. I jest wanted to
+remind ye of it, that was all. Hangin' Sallies!
+Hangin' Sallies!"</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter resumed his journey, but, until
+he passed around the bend in the road, whenever
+he looked behind him he could see the
+mighty Ted standing in the lane, and shaking
+his fist in the air if he perceived that the lad
+beheld him.</p>
+
+<p>What a strange man Ted was, thought
+Little Peter as he walked on. He had known
+him for years, as had most of the people in
+Old Monmouth. His feats in the country
+wrestling matches had made him famous, and
+marvelous were the tales told concerning his
+almost superhuman strength. It had been
+related that Ted one time had lifted a great
+ox bodily from the ground, and Little Peter
+had believed the report. And yet, with it all,
+Ted had always seemed to him like a boy.
+Kind-hearted, ever willing to grant a favor or
+do anything within his power for another, he
+had never before seen him when his wrath
+was kindled. "Hanging Sallies!" Perhaps
+Ted's feelings were only natural when he had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_306" id="Page_306">[306]</a></span>
+discovered the pine robbers in their cruel act.
+Benzeor would not be likely to escape from
+his hands so easily, if the angry man once
+held him in his grasp again.</p>
+
+<p>But Sallie Wilson was still alive, and the
+lad thought Ted's position was far better
+than his own. His mother shot by the pine
+robbers, his father sent away a prisoner, perhaps
+to die of starvation in those dreadful
+prison ships of which so many stories already
+had been told, and his younger brothers and
+sisters homeless and helpless, and all looking
+to him as their sole support. What could he
+do? Surely no one in Old Monmouth had
+suffered more than he, although Old Monmouth
+itself had known more of the evils of
+war than almost any other portion of our land
+in all that fearful struggle of the American
+Revolution.</p>
+
+<p>"How?"</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter's meditations were suddenly
+interrupted by Indian John, who stepped
+forth into the road and greeted him with his
+customary salutation.</p>
+
+<p>"Where did you come from, John? I
+thought you were up in Moluss's wigwam."</p>
+
+<p>"Moluss gone, Bath gone, John gone, too.
+Come to help friend. Find fader?" he suddenly<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_307" id="Page_307">[307]</a></span>
+added, peering keenly, as he spoke, into
+Little Peter's face.</p>
+
+<p>"No; my father has been sent to New
+York."</p>
+
+<p>"Bad. What boy do now?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm going back to Benzeor's to look after
+the children."</p>
+
+<p>The Indian's eyes betrayed the question he
+might have asked, but did not. Indian John
+soon induced his companion to abandon the
+road and follow him through the forests.
+Many a mile was saved in this manner, and,
+under the burning heat of the sun, the shade
+of the great trees was most grateful to the
+sadly troubled lad. There was something
+in the presence of the majestic trees which
+seemed to appeal to Little Peter. He was
+alone and yet not alone with such companions.
+Indian John also seemed to share in his feelings,
+and seldom spoke. For mile after mile
+they continued on their journey, and the
+shadows were lengthening when at last they
+stepped forth into the road, which Peter recognized,
+and then knew that Benzeor's house
+was not far away. The long journey would
+soon be ended now, and fresh hope came to
+the weary lad, as he thought that he would
+see the children again.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_308" id="Page_308">[308]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>What he should do with them, however,
+was a problem still unsolved, and the solution
+apparently was no nearer than when he had
+set forth on his journey from the home of
+Ted Wilson. With all of the anger which
+had come with the discovery of Benzeor's
+treachery, Little Peter could not bring himself
+to believe that either Sarah or her mother
+had any knowledge of his evil deeds. His
+confidence in them was still unbroken, and
+his sole hope was that they might be able
+to suggest some plan by which the children
+could be cared for. As for leaving them at
+Benzeor's, that was impossible; and as the
+lad thought again of the discovery of his
+neighbor's crimes, he quickened his pace,
+and he and his companion began to walk
+more rapidly along the hot and dusty road.
+Not more than two miles remained between
+them and the end of their journey, and, in
+his eagerness, Little Peter almost forgot his
+weariness and constantly urged the Indian
+by his side to increase their speed.</p>
+
+<p>They had been in the road but a few minutes
+when they heard the sound of horsemen
+approaching from behind them. All unsuspicious
+of danger, Little Peter and Indian
+John halted, waiting for the men to pass.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_309" id="Page_309">[309]</a></span>
+There were five of them in the band, and all
+were riding swiftly. Their horses were dripping,
+and with almost every step flung the
+foam from their mouths. Surely something
+must be wrong, to induce men to ride like
+that upon such a warm day, thought Little
+Peter; but his surmises were quickly driven
+from his mind when he recognized Fenton
+and Benzeor in advance of the band.</p>
+
+<p>Startled by the unexpected sight, he hardly
+knew what to do. The men were too near
+for him to hope to escape their notice now;
+and, even while he hesitated, he saw Benzeor
+quickly draw the rein on the horse he was
+riding and leap to the ground.</p>
+
+<p>"Get him! Shoot him! Stop that boy!"
+shouted Benzeor.</p>
+
+<p>Indian John had been keenly watching the
+approaching band, and as he heard the shout
+of the angry man, he touched Peter upon the
+arm, and said, "Come."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter instantly responded, and followed
+his companion as he started swiftly
+across the open lot toward the woods which
+lay beyond it.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_310" id="Page_310">[310]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXIV</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE ABODE OF INDIAN JOHN</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> pursuit of Little Peter and Indian
+John was not long continued, nor was a single
+gun discharged; a fact for which the frightened
+lad was unable to account at the time,
+although on the following morning the cause
+for it was made clear.</p>
+
+<p>Wearied though the lad was by his long
+journey, the shout of Benzeor had provided
+an impulse sufficiently strong to compel him
+to keep up with his companion, who was running
+swiftly toward the shelter of the woods
+which were not far away.</p>
+
+<p>In a brief time the breathless fugitives
+gained its shelter, and then for the first time
+turned and glanced behind them. The men
+had turned back and now could be seen still
+standing by the roadside, near the place
+where Peter and the Indian had started
+across the lot. What they were doing could
+not be discovered; but, without waiting for
+further investigations, the flight was at once<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_311" id="Page_311">[311]</a></span>
+resumed, and, keeping well together, the lad
+and his companion ran swiftly forward, and
+soon the distance between them and the pine
+robbers had been still further increased.</p>
+
+<p>The sunlight had now departed from the
+forest, and the dusk had settled over all. The
+air was close and oppressive, and Peter's dripping
+face betrayed the force of his recent
+exertions and the excitement under which he
+was laboring. Already the night birds had
+made their appearance, and here and there
+among the branches of the lofty trees the
+bats could be seen darting about in quest of
+their evening meal. The very silence served
+to increase the feeling of utter loneliness
+which swept over the weary, heartbroken lad,
+and for a moment it almost seemed to him as
+if any further efforts on his part were as useless
+as they were difficult. Benzeor's anger
+promised little good for the children who had
+been left in his home, and fears for his little
+brothers and sisters were mingled in Little
+Peter's mind with the consciousness of his
+own weariness and the thought of his own
+forlorn condition.</p>
+
+<p>Difficult as the problem doubtless was, he
+knew he must not give way to it, and when
+Indian John indicated in a few moments that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_312" id="Page_312">[312]</a></span>
+the time had come when they must go on, the
+lad resolutely again turned to follow him,
+although he had not the slightest conception
+of the plan which was in his companion's
+mind.</p>
+
+<p>Carefully they walked on through the increasing
+gloom, and within a half hour Little
+Peter heard the sounds of a running brook
+in the distance. He instantly recognized the
+locality, for many a time had he and Tom
+in the springtime followed the course of the
+"run," as the people of Old Monmouth called
+the stream, and the strings of fish which they
+had brought home with them had borne ample
+witness to the success which had crowned
+their efforts.</p>
+
+<p>But none of these things were in Little
+Peter's mind as he followed Indian John,
+who had now turned and was proceeding along
+the bank and making his way up the stream.
+As they walked on, the sound of a waterfall
+began to be more and more distinctly heard,
+and soon they came out into a place from
+which, in the deepening gloom, the falling
+waters could be seen. Into the basin which
+had been formed by the sharp fall of the
+stream, a tall, large tree had fallen years before
+this time. Its broken roots had torn<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_313" id="Page_313">[313]</a></span>
+up the earth, and now stood like a barrier
+on the bank, and Indian John led the way
+directly toward this spot.</p>
+
+<p>As they approached, Peter discovered a
+hole in the rocks, but he was not prepared
+for the action of his companion; for, without
+a word, the Indian dropped upon his hands
+and knees and crawled into the entrance and
+speedily disappeared from sight.</p>
+
+<p>Hesitating only a moment, Little Peter
+soon followed his companion, and after crawling
+along on his hands and knees for a number
+of yards, suddenly beheld a large, open
+space directly before him. Indian John had
+provided a light by this time, for he had been
+willing to follow the customs of his more
+civilized neighbors to the extent of making
+use of candles, and as Peter arose and glanced
+about him, he knew at once that he was in
+the cave which it was reported was the abode
+of the red man.</p>
+
+<p>Frequently as the lad had passed the very
+place into which he had crawled that night,
+it had never occurred to him that it was anything
+more than a hole in the rocks that
+formed the bank of the "run," and his surprise
+was therefore the greater at the sight
+before him. The spot was considerably above<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_314" id="Page_314">[314]</a></span>
+the bed of the stream, and consequently was
+comparatively dry. Straw and dry leaves lay
+scattered about over the floor, and the sheltered
+place apparently was safe from all approach
+or danger.</p>
+
+<p>Indian John at once indicated to his companion
+that he was to pass the night there,
+and the weary lad was glad to accept the
+invitation, and soon stretched himself upon
+the bed of straw. The light of the candle
+was extinguished, and the Indian then speedily
+followed the example of Peter. The sounds
+of the running brook came faintly to the
+ears of the troubled lad, but that was all he
+could hear. The darkness was intense, and
+for a time the fear of other occupants of
+various kinds prevented Peter from sleeping,
+but at last even that was forgotten in the
+dreamless sleep that followed.</p>
+
+<p>When he awoke, Little Peter at first could
+not determine where he was, but as the outlines
+of the cave were seen in the dim light
+which penetrated it, the experiences of the
+preceding day were recalled, and he quickly
+arose. Indian John was not in the cave,
+however, and as the lad now was aware that
+the morning had come, he hastily crawled
+through the passageway that led to the bank.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_315" id="Page_315">[315]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>As he regained the bank, he saw that his
+companion was busily engaged in roasting
+some birds he had shot. The sight was a
+welcome one, for Peter was now aware of
+the fact that he was decidedly hungry, and,
+following his companion's advice, he departed
+in search of some berries to add to the morning
+meal. In the course of a half hour he
+returned with his hat well filled, and, after
+bathing his hands and face in the cool waters
+of the brook, prepared at once to join his
+companion.</p>
+
+<p>For a few minutes neither spoke, but the
+rapid manner in which the roasted birds disappeared
+showed that conversation was not
+uppermost in their minds.</p>
+
+<p>At last, when several of the birds had been
+eaten, and many of the berries had disappeared,
+Indian John turned to his companion
+and said, "Boy want 'hop-hop' now? Plenty
+'hop-hop.' Make um good."</p>
+
+<p>"No, no," replied Peter quickly. "The
+birds are enough. Where did you get them,
+John?"</p>
+
+<p>"Shoot um. Plenty birds; plenty 'hop-hop.'"</p>
+
+<p>"You must have been up early this morning,
+John. I didn't hear you."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_316" id="Page_316">[316]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The Indian made no reply and remained
+silent for several minutes. Then, turning abruptly
+and looking keenly at Peter, he said,
+"What boy do now?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know," replied Little Peter disconsolately.</p>
+
+<p>The words brought him face to face again
+with the problem that must be solved. The
+fresh cool air of the morning, the silence of
+the forest, and, above all, the enjoyment of
+the breakfast which John had provided, made
+him at first wish that he might remain there
+and forget all the troubles that were so near.
+But Peter was not a selfish lad, and knew
+that the motherless children must be provided
+for.</p>
+
+<p>"I was going to Benzeor's," he said after
+a time, "but I don't know what to do now.
+I can't understand what he meant by coming
+back here in broad daylight after what has
+happened. He knows that I know all about
+it, and that was the reason why he wanted
+to catch me last night. I can't go up to his
+house now, and yet I don't dare leave the
+children there, either."</p>
+
+<p>"Boy go," said Indian John quietly.</p>
+
+<p>"But I can't go, John. How can I?
+There were four men with Benzeor, and you<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_317" id="Page_317">[317]</a></span>
+heard what he said. It wouldn't be safe for
+me to go there now. I don't know what to
+do."</p>
+
+<p>"Boy go; Benzeor no there."</p>
+
+<p>"Benzeor not there? How do you know?
+What makes you think that, John?"</p>
+
+<p>"John been there."</p>
+
+<p>"When? This morning?"</p>
+
+<p>The Indian nodded his head, and then
+said, "Man no there. Girl there. Two, t'ree
+little Peters there. Boy go. All safe."</p>
+
+<p>"You don't mean it?" said Peter eagerly,
+and standing erect as he spoke. "Come on,
+then, John; we'll start this minute."</p>
+
+<p>"Boy go; Indian no go."</p>
+
+<p>"Why not? I thought you were going
+with me."</p>
+
+<p>"John no go. John no home, no papoose,
+no notin'. All white man now. All
+gone. Indian no stay. Boy go."</p>
+
+<p>"All right, John; I won't urge you. But
+if you're right, and Benzeor isn't at home,
+you needn't be afraid."</p>
+
+<p>The Indian's eyes snapped at the words,
+but he made no reply, and Little Peter was
+too eager to start now to realize the force of
+his own words. As he departed, he saw his
+recent companion standing on the bank of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_318" id="Page_318">[318]</a></span>
+the brook in an attitude as if he were listening
+to sounds far off in the forest. Perhaps
+if the lad had realized that it was the last
+time he would ever behold the face of Indian
+John, he would have lingered longer; but, as
+it was, his desire to go to Benzeor's house
+and learn of the present condition of the children
+banished all other thoughts from his
+mind, and in a few moments he had started
+toward the road.</p>
+
+<p>He retraced his way across the open lot,
+and as he came within sight of the road he
+suddenly stopped, as he saw a mounted man
+there. Apparently the man was alone, and
+what was strange was the fact that he apparently
+was not moving.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter waited several minutes, but as
+the man still retained his position, and no
+one joined him, he resolved to proceed. Approaching
+cautiously, and ready to run at the
+first appearance of danger, his surprise was
+increased as he beheld the strange manner in
+which the horseman was seated on his beast.
+Instead of sitting with his face toward the
+head of his steed, his position was exactly
+reversed, and to all appearances he either was
+going in a direction opposite to that of his
+horse or else was riding backward.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_319" id="Page_319">[319]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Puzzled to account for the strange attitude,
+Peter also noticed as he approached that the
+beast on which the man was mounted was a
+mule and had stopped in the middle of the
+road. In a moment he recognized the man as
+Ted Wilson, and with a shout he ran forward.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, my lad, what are you doing here?"
+exclaimed Ted, as he beheld the approaching
+boy.</p>
+
+<p>"It's more to the point to ask what you
+are doing here. What are you sitting on
+that mule that way for? What have you
+stopped for? Why don't you go ahead?"</p>
+
+<p>"There are several good reasons," replied
+Ted blandly. "In the first place, if the
+mule won't go, I can't go. Then, if he stops,
+I have to stop, too. As to the reason for my
+being here, why, I'm looking for Benzeor."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know where you expect to find
+him," laughed Peter&mdash;forgetting his own
+anxiety for the moment in the ludicrous sight
+before him.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I got to thinking of it yesterday
+after you left me; and when I'd taken Sallie
+and the babies up to the captain's,&mdash;Sallie's
+my wife, ye know,&mdash;I jest made up my mind
+as how I'd got to look after Benzeor afore
+he did any more damage. Goin' around the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_320" id="Page_320">[320]</a></span>
+country hangin' Sallies! The rascal! Old
+Monmouth never'll be safe till Benzeor
+Osburn has been 'tended to. And if I'm
+not the man to do it, I don't know who is.
+So Jeshurun and I decided to start out last
+night, and we've been travelin' ever since."</p>
+
+<p>"Jeshurun? I don't see anybody with
+you," said Peter, glancing quickly about him
+as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"Ha! ha!" laughed Ted. "Ye're lookin'
+too far afield, young man. This here
+fellow's Jeshurun. Whoa, Jesh! Whoa!"
+he suddenly added, as the mule darted to one
+side and turned several circles in the road
+before his rider could stop him.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir; this is Jeshurun, and a more
+onery little beast never lived. I told ye
+about him yesterday, and how he'd suddenly
+take it into his head to go backwards for a
+bit. That's the reason I ride him this way
+part of the time. He thinks I want to go
+the other way, ye see, and that's how I come
+it over him by jest sittin' the wrong way, too.
+Besides, a good twist of his tail is worth more
+than a bridle sometimes. Instead of controllin'
+him with a bridle, as any decent beast
+would be glad to have me do, I just have to
+steer him by twistin' his tail, same's I use the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_321" id="Page_321">[321]</a></span>
+rudder in my boat, ye see. Whoa there,
+Jesh! Whoa there! What's the matter
+with ye, anyhow? Whoa! Whoa!"</p>
+
+<p>These last remarks of Ted were caused by
+a sudden movement on the part of Jeshurun,
+whose heels were thrown into the air, while
+with his teeth he almost literally bit the dust.
+The mule was small and the feet of his rider
+almost touched the ground, and the antics of
+the pair caused Peter to laugh aloud.</p>
+
+<p>"Where did you get that name for him?"
+he inquired when quiet was restored.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, it came to him jest natural like.
+Two years ago when I bought him, and was
+a-leadin' him home, I got him into the yard
+and then he just began to make his heels fly
+like a pair o' drumsticks. It's likely there
+was some noise made by him or me, I don't
+jest know which, and the first thing I knew,
+Sallie&mdash;she's my wife, ye know&mdash;and a
+whole lot o' folks came a-runnin' out o' the
+house to see what all the rumpus was about.
+They was havin' meetin' in the house, though
+I didn't know anything about that, or I
+wouldn't have argued with the mule as I was
+doin', o' course. Well, sir, if you'd believe
+it, the parson had been a-preachin' about
+somebody in the Old Testament. His text<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_322" id="Page_322">[322]</a></span>
+was: 'But Jeshurun waxed fat and kicked:
+thou art waxen fat, thou art grown thick,
+thou art covered with fatness.' Yes, sir;
+those were his very words. Well, when
+Sallie&mdash;she's my wife, ye know&mdash;set eyes
+on this here beast, she said Jeshurun should
+be his name, and Jeshurun it's been ever
+since. Whoa there! Whoa, I say! What
+ye up to now?"</p>
+
+<p>Perhaps Jeshurun objected to the story, for
+he suddenly whirled about and started swiftly
+up the road. In vain Ted tried to restrain
+him, but after his attempts failed, he turned
+and shouted, "I'll see you farther on!
+Jesh'll get tired o' this."</p>
+
+<p>As Jeshurun and his rider disappeared in a
+cloud of dust, Little Peter quickly recovered
+from his surprise and started briskly after
+them.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_323" id="Page_323">[323]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXV</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE BEGINNING OF THE GREAT FIGHT</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> morning of Sunday, June 28, 1778,
+dawned clear and warm. Not a cloud could
+be seen in the sky, and the air was motionless,
+save in occasional places where it quivered
+under the burning heat of the summer sun.
+By eight o'clock the thermometer already
+had indicated ninety-six degrees, and before
+the day was done it had risen considerably
+above a hundred.</p>
+
+<p>The British forces had now arrived within
+ten or twelve miles of the Heights of Middletown,
+and if once they should succeed in gaining
+that position, all attempts on the part of
+the Americans to attack them would be worse
+than useless, for it was now as well known by
+Washington as it was by Clinton that British
+vessels were lying at anchor off Sandy Hook,
+ready and waiting to receive the advancing
+army and its stores on board, and transport
+all in safety to New York.</p>
+
+<p>Clinton, as we already know, still believed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_324" id="Page_324">[324]</a></span>
+that the Americans were seeking only to capture
+his stores and train of baggage wagons,
+and, therefore, wisely had placed them
+in the care of General Knyphausen and the
+Hessian soldiers, in advance of the place of
+danger, as he supposed, and also of the place
+where the brave leader himself took his stand
+with his men. All of the British grenadiers,
+light infantry, and chasseurs of the line were
+encamped in the strong position that Clinton
+had selected in the parting of the road which
+led from Monmouth Court House to Middletown,
+the right wing extending about a mile
+and a half beyond the court house itself, while
+the left lay stretched for three miles along
+the road from Allentown. Thick woods afforded
+strong protection to the flanks, while
+a swamp extended toward the rear and the
+left, and woods also covered their front. The
+British general had chosen his place wisely,
+and there he waited until that eventful Sunday
+morning.</p>
+
+<p>General Washington was well aware of all
+that was going on, and had determined to
+attack the British the moment they moved
+from the position they then occupied. Late
+on Saturday night, the commander had given
+orders for General Maxwell to send out parties<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_325" id="Page_325">[325]</a></span>
+of observation, who were to watch the British
+and report instantly any signs they might
+discover of an attempt to retreat during the
+night, and to keep up a constant communication
+with himself. General orders had also
+been given Lee to be prepared to attack Clinton's
+forces the moment they should depart
+from their camping-place.</p>
+
+<p>General Lee's treachery or incompetency,
+or both, are well known to-day, and the only
+cause of surprise is that General Washington
+should have given him such discretionary
+orders. The great commander must have
+been fully aware of Lee's true feelings, for
+already he had suffered much from his jealousy
+and his traitorous designs; but perhaps
+the rest of the army did not know what
+Washington himself well knew, and on the
+eve of battle he chose the lesser of the two
+evils, and thought he would suffer less by
+permitting Lee to continue to act, than he
+would from the misunderstanding and confusion
+that might arise if he dealt with the
+man at that time as he justly deserved. At
+all events, his orders were somewhat general,
+and the fact that he had not given specific
+commands is all that remains to-day to be
+quoted in favor of the guilty Lee.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_326" id="Page_326">[326]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>It was about five o'clock in the morning
+when a messenger arrived in Washington's
+camp from General Dickinson&mdash;who, with the
+New Jersey militia, was nearest the enemy's
+lines&mdash;with the information that the front of
+the British line had begun its march toward
+the Heights of Middletown. Instantly Washington's
+army was put in motion, and one of
+his aids was sent in all haste to inform General
+Lee of the movement of the British, and
+to urge him forward to attack them at once
+unless some very strong obstacle should be
+found, and to assure him that the main body
+of the American army would be rushed forward
+to his support.</p>
+
+<p>I am very certain that if my readers could
+somehow have been privileged to witness the
+march of Washington's soldiers, they would
+not have been greatly impressed by the sight.
+Many of them were without uniforms, and
+their flushed and streaming faces under the
+burning heat, while they bore an expression
+of determination, after all would not have
+been very prepossessing in their appearance.
+Numbers of the Continentals had either cast
+aside their coats or rolled them up and
+strapped them across their backs, so that
+entire ranks appeared to be marching to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_327" id="Page_327">[327]</a></span>
+battle in their shirt-sleeves. However, although
+their personal bearing was not made
+more forceful by the absence of coats, their
+personal comfort was decidedly improved;
+and, as we shall soon see, their work in the
+battle was not hindered by their lack of
+bright colored uniforms.</p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, the advanced corps under General
+Lee had moved from Englishtown, and
+was now advancing toward the British. The
+redcoats were also in motion, and the left
+wing had marched more than a mile beyond
+Monmouth Court House when it discovered
+that the American columns had out-flanked
+it on the north. Lee's forces had
+marched along the main road, successfully
+crossing the deep ravines and causeways.
+They had halted frequently to receive reports
+from the scouts and the men in advance as
+to the movements of the British, but these
+reports apparently were somewhat contradictory
+and created some confusion among the
+American ranks.</p>
+
+<p>One of these halts had been made near the
+"new church," which was so called to distinguish
+it from the smaller structure, which
+until 1752 had stood upon the same site.
+This "new church" was of wood, its sides<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_328" id="Page_328">[328]</a></span>
+covered with shingles, and painted white.
+There such famous preachers as Whitefield,
+the missionary Brainerd, Tennent, and others
+had given their messages of peace, but it can
+be safely asserted that in all its long history
+the "old" church or the "new" had never
+seen such a "service" as that which was held
+there on that Sunday morning in June, 1778.
+Before the day was done bullet marks and
+the effect of cannon shot were apparent on
+its walls, and while the roof and even the
+steeple were said to have been covered with
+people on that day, who had assembled to
+watch the battle, probably no other congregation
+in all our land had ever been gathered
+by such summons, or had taken their seats
+on the roof of the building instead of in the
+accustomed place within the walls.</p>
+
+<p>Young General Lafayette, who had command
+of Lee's right, soon passed the Court
+House, and was advancing upon the other end
+of the British line on the south at the same
+time when the left wing was folding about
+Cornwallis on the north; and General Wayne,
+who was in command of the American centre,
+was also pressing strongly forward. Apparently,
+all things were favoring the rugged
+Continentals, and had it not been for Lee's<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_329" id="Page_329">[329]</a></span>
+cowardice or treachery, or both, they would
+have won the battle there and then, before
+Washington could come with the aid of his
+advancing troops.</p>
+
+<p>Some slight minor engagements had already
+occurred, though not one of them was of
+much importance; but now General Wayne
+discovered that most of the British forces
+before him had descended from the high
+ground they had occupied and were advancing
+along the same route, over the plains of
+Monmouth, which the Hessians had followed
+when they departed earlier in the morning.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly the impetuous Wayne sent a messenger
+to General Lee requesting permission
+for his own "troops to be pressed on." No
+such permission was given, however, until it
+was discovered that a band of eight or nine
+hundred of the redcoats had halted, and, turning
+about, appeared to be inviting an attack.
+General Wayne was then ordered to take
+about four hundred men and advance.</p>
+
+<p>Despite the smallness of the number,
+Wayne eagerly obeyed, when the Queen's
+light dragoons were sent back by Clinton to
+check the movement.</p>
+
+<p>So excited was the little band of Americans
+that they instantly formed, and drove<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_330" id="Page_330">[330]</a></span>
+the horsemen back upon a body of foot soldiers
+who had been sent to their aid. A
+much larger body of troops were soon discovered
+to be moving upon General Wayne's
+right, but he immediately opened fire upon
+them with the two pieces of artillery he possessed,
+sent back for reinforcements, and
+gallantly prepared for the battle.</p>
+
+<p>During this time General Lee apparently
+was trying to cut off the force with which
+Wayne was engaged by making a detour and
+falling upon the line of Clinton's march between
+the rear of the main body and that
+detachment.</p>
+
+<p>This action of Lee's, together with those
+which three of the others of the divisions
+of the American forces were making at the
+same time, led Clinton to suppose that his
+baggage train was what the Americans were
+striving to gain. As we already know, this,
+all the time, had been his understanding of
+the purpose of Washington, and now the
+action and movements of the various bodies
+of troops strengthened his suspicion.</p>
+
+<p>The first thing the British commander did
+was to send the Queen's light dragoons against
+Wayne. Then he sent a detachment from
+the men in advance to strengthen his own<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_331" id="Page_331">[331]</a></span>
+right, and next he arranged for the main body,
+of which Lord Cornwallis was in command,
+to form on the plain and prepare to attack
+General Lee and the various divisions which
+were under him at the time.</p>
+
+<p>General Wayne and his brave men were
+now fighting desperately, and to all appearances
+success was about to crown his efforts,
+when he was dumfounded by an order he
+received from Lee to make only a feigned
+attack, and not to press too hard against the
+redcoats in front of him.</p>
+
+<p>Wayne did not know what to make of the
+order. He was chagrined and angry to receive
+such a word at a time when all things seemed
+to favor his determined band. It is said that
+he made use of some very forceful language,
+and even expressed his opinion of his superior
+officer in no very complimentary terms; but
+he was too good a soldier not to obey; and,
+although he could not understand what Lee
+meant by giving him such directions at such
+a time, he held back his men, hoping all the
+time that Lee himself would come up and
+grasp the victory which almost seemed to be
+in his hand.</p>
+
+<p>General Lee had been watching the movements
+of the British, and perceived what<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_332" id="Page_332">[332]</a></span>
+Clinton was trying to do by the actions to
+which we already have referred. Instead of
+meeting them boldly, and permitting his soldiers,
+who were all now eager for the battle,
+to advance, he at once prepared to withdraw
+them from the field.</p>
+
+<p>Young Lafayette had just discovered a
+body of British cavalry advancing toward
+Lee's right, and, quickly riding up to his
+commander, he begged for permission to advance
+and gain their rear, and so cut them
+off from the main body.</p>
+
+<p>"Sir," replied Lee, "you do not know
+British soldiers. We cannot stand against
+them. We shall certainly be driven back at
+first, and we must be cautious."</p>
+
+<p>"It may be so, general," said Lafayette
+quietly, "but British soldiers have been
+beaten, and they may be again. At any rate
+I am disposed to make the trial."</p>
+
+<p>Reluctantly Lee yielded, so far as to permit
+the brave young marquis to wheel his column
+by the right and make an attempt to gain
+the left of the British, but at the same time
+he ordered three regiments to be withdrawn
+from Wayne's command, thereby weakening
+him for reasons which neither Wayne nor any
+one of his men ever understood.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_333" id="Page_333">[333]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>General Lee then rode off to reconnoitre,
+as he afterwards declared, and to his astonishment
+discovered another large body of
+British soldiers marching back on the Middletown
+road toward the Court House. If there
+was one thing more than another which Lee
+apparently disliked at that time, it was the
+sight and presence of men clad in scarlet
+coats, and he instantly gave orders for the
+several corps in his division to retreat, or to
+make a "retrograde movement," as he afterwards
+explained it.</p>
+
+<p>His friends claimed for him, and, indeed,
+Lee afterwards claimed for himself, that he
+had only ordered the right to fall back, and
+had commanded the left, under Scott and
+Maxwell, to advance, and his order was misunderstood;
+and that when Maxwell's men
+perceived the retreat of their comrades on
+the left, they thought all was ended and they
+must save themselves. But, at all events,
+proof of the truthfulness of his statement
+was wanting, and all his men were soon retreating
+toward the "new meeting-house," on
+the roof and steeple of which were assembled
+the people of the congregation.</p>
+
+<p>Few of the men beside Lee himself knew
+why the retreat was made. The soldiers were<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_334" id="Page_334">[334]</a></span>
+angry and were giving vent to their feelings
+in terms which had not been carefully selected.
+General Wayne's men were the only ones
+who had even fired a shot, and the anger
+of Wayne himself was steadily increasing.
+Every soldier felt as if he were being robbed
+of success, which by right belonged to him
+and to his country.</p>
+
+<p>Between the "meeting-house" and the
+parsonage, General Washington, all unaware
+of Lee's disgraceful actions and the retreat of
+the advanced division, met a fifer, who appeared
+to be in great haste to leave the region.</p>
+
+<p>Reining in his horse, the great commander
+ordered the fleeing man to halt, and then said
+sternly:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Who are you? Do you belong to the
+army? Why are you running in this fashion?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am a soldier," replied the trembling
+man, "but all the Continentals are running,
+too."</p>
+
+<p>"It isn't true! It can't be true! I'll
+have you whipped if you dare to mention
+such a thing to another living man!" cried
+the astonished commander.</p>
+
+<p>Nevertheless, he put the spurs to his horse,
+and in a few minutes discovered two or three<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_335" id="Page_335">[335]</a></span>
+other men, who apparently were in as great
+haste to depart as the fifer had been.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly the trembling men halted at his
+sharp command, and again the excited general
+demanded an explanation of their actions.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_336" id="Page_336">[336]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXVI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE BATTLE OF MONMOUTH</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Evidently</span>, the reply which General Washington
+received from the men, who were as
+greatly frightened by the bearing of the commander
+as they had been by the sight of the
+redcoats, did not convince him that they had
+spoken truly. He had not heard any firing,
+except that of a few cannon a considerable
+time before this, and he could not believe
+that the picked men under Lee's command
+had ingloriously retreated without making
+even an attempt to stand against the forces
+of Sir Henry Clinton.</p>
+
+<p>This second report, however, caused Washington
+to send forward two of his trusty
+officers, whom he ordered to ride swiftly in
+the direction of the Court House, and, after
+they should have discovered the true condition
+of affairs, to report instantly to him.</p>
+
+<p>As the two brave men quickly obeyed and
+started their horses into a run, they met on
+the bridge the members of a regiment in a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_337" id="Page_337">[337]</a></span>
+disorderly retreat. A little farther on another
+regiment was discovered, and soon still another
+appeared in sight.</p>
+
+<p>Colonel Ogden, who was in command of
+the last, in a towering passion declared, in
+reply to the question of the officers, that
+Lee's men were indeed retreating and that
+"they were flying from a shadow."</p>
+
+<p>Still hoping that they would find that a
+stand had been made farther back, the two
+officers pushed eagerly forward and soon met
+General Maxwell and his men. That gallant
+officer was also in a state of great anger, and
+not only confirmed the report that Lee was
+retreating, but also added some words of his
+own, expressing his opinion of that officer and
+of the movement in words that would have
+caused the cheeks of the treacherous general
+to tingle, if he had chanced to hear them.</p>
+
+<p>Still hoping against hope, the two aids
+pressed forward and soon met General Lee
+himself. His face at all times was decidedly
+plain, and indeed, as we know, he had the
+reputation of having the "ugliest face in
+America;" but at this time a scowl rested
+upon it which doubtless did not tend to increase
+his beauty, and he sullenly refused to
+reply to the questions of the men.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_338" id="Page_338">[338]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The two officers did not long delay to talk
+to him, but still urged their horses swiftly
+forward, although the straggling, disorderly
+troops now almost filled the road, and their
+worst fears were confirmed each moment.</p>
+
+<p>At last, in the post of danger and nearest
+to the pursuing British, the two officers discovered
+General Wayne and his men. "Mad
+Anthony" was certainly "mad" at that time,
+and while he assured the aids that the retreat
+was genuine and general, at the same time he
+declared that it was absolutely needless. He
+also declared that "Lee had drawn off his
+best men at the very time when he was facing
+a body of British far superior to himself
+in numbers, but that even then the redcoats
+could be beaten if a stand were made against
+them."</p>
+
+<p>There was no time for an extended conversation,
+but, doubtless, the two officers understood
+what the exceedingly vigorous language
+of Mad Anthony Wayne was intended to convey,
+and after receiving the suggestions he
+sent by them to General Washington, and
+assured now that they had discovered the
+worst, they put spurs to their horses and rode
+swiftly back to give the information they had
+received to the great commander.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_339" id="Page_339">[339]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, General Washington himself
+had not been idle, we may be well assured.
+Riding swiftly forward, he met band after
+band of the retreating, disorderly Continentals,
+and heard many expressions of anger and
+disgust, very like to that which had already
+greeted the two officers he had sent forward.</p>
+
+<p>At last, in the rear of the retreating column,
+he met General Wayne and his angry
+men. Hastily summoning Mad Anthony and
+two or three of his officers, the great leader
+told them that he "should depend upon them
+that day to give the enemy a check," and
+quickly directed General Wayne to form his
+men, and, with their two pieces of artillery,
+strive to stop the progress of the redcoats.</p>
+
+<p>It was just at this moment that General
+Lee himself rode up, and the scene which followed
+was one which those who witnessed it
+never forgot. There is no more sublime sight
+in all this world than the towering passion of
+a great man. Not pettiness, not irritability,
+but the just and righteous anger of a noble,
+large-hearted man in the presence of wickedness.</p>
+
+<p>General Washington probably never before
+in all his life had been so angry as he was
+at that time. Thoughts of the cause of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_340" id="Page_340">[340]</a></span>
+country he loved, the lives of thousands of
+brave and devoted patriots, the sight of angry,
+desperate men all about him, the disappointment
+at the loss of what he had confidently
+counted upon, the loss also of that
+for which so many noble men had been sacrificing
+and toiling through many weary days
+and on their long marches, rushed upon him
+like a flood. And before him stood the guilty
+man who alone was to be blamed for it all.
+Small wonder is it that Washington was
+almost beside himself with rage and sorrow.</p>
+
+<p>The name of Benedict Arnold is one that
+is hated to-day by every American schoolboy,
+for, after all, most boys can be trusted to
+hate evil in whatever form it presents itself.
+But the treachery of Benedict Arnold had at
+least the merit of being unmasked and comparatively
+open, for he took his stand boldly
+on the side of the redcoats, whom he at one
+time had fought with a bravery none can
+ever forget. But the memory of Charles Lee
+has not even that redeeming quality, for his
+actions on the field of Monmouth can only
+be explained on the ground of treachery or
+cowardice, and a coward is not very greatly
+to be preferred to a traitor. If both Lee and
+Arnold had fallen in battle, how much better<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_341" id="Page_341">[341]</a></span>
+it would have been for them and their friends,
+for "a good name is to be preferred above
+great riches," and they left neither. Perhaps
+the strange desire which Lee later expressed
+in his will, that his "body should not be
+interred in any church or churchyard, or
+within a mile of any Presbyterian or Baptist
+church," was not entirely out of keeping with
+the man himself.</p>
+
+<p>The conversation between Washington and
+Lee at the time they met on the retreat at
+Monmouth has been variously reported; but
+doubtless the fact that those who heard it
+were as excited as the generals themselves
+may in part account for the differences in the
+reports which have come down to us. We
+may be sure the conversation was not extended
+to the length which some have said it
+was, or that it savored largely of the high-flown
+expressions which have been quoted.</p>
+
+<p>One of the men who was present is reported
+to have said that Washington in his
+sternest manner looked at Lee, and demanded,
+"What is the meaning of all this, sir?"</p>
+
+<p>Dismayed by the terrible appearance of
+the commander-in-chief, and mortified that he
+should be so addressed in the presence of his
+soldiers, the crestfallen general could only
+stammer, "Sir? sir?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_342" id="Page_342">[342]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Again the enraged commander demanded
+the meaning of the retreat, and Lee attempted
+to explain. His orders, he said, had
+been misunderstood, his officers had not
+obeyed his commands, he had not thought it
+wise to attempt to make a stand against the
+British with his detachment; but the angry
+Washington would not stay to listen to the
+lame attempts at explanation, and muttering
+something about a "poltroon," he hastened
+back to the high ground between the meeting-house
+and the bridge, where he quickly formed
+the regiments which were waiting there.</p>
+
+<p>Apparently thinking better of his words,
+he then rode back to General Lee and inquired
+whether he still desired to retain the
+command on that height or not. "If you
+will," he added, "I will return to the main
+body and have it formed on the next height."</p>
+
+<p>As Lee accepted the offer, Washington
+said: "I expect you will take proper means
+for checking the enemy."</p>
+
+<p>"Your orders shall be obeyed," replied
+Lee, "and I shall not be the first to leave
+the ground."</p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, the British general Clinton had
+also been busy. He had ordered back many
+of the troops which the Hessian general<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_343" id="Page_343">[343]</a></span>
+Knyphausen commanded, and was making
+vigorous attempts to compel the Americans
+to keep up the retreat, which Lee had ordered
+with such disastrous results.</p>
+
+<p>The forces under Mad Anthony had rallied
+at the call of their leader, and were bravely
+holding their position near the parsonage.
+The British grenadiers climbed over the
+fence which crossed the lot in front of
+Wayne, but were quickly driven back by
+the angry Continentals.</p>
+
+<p>Again the determined British advanced,
+and again were driven back. Then their
+brave leader, Colonel Monckton, placing himself
+at their head, and calling upon his men
+to follow him, led the charge. But Mad
+Anthony and his men were waiting for them,
+and under their terrible fire the brave colonel
+and many of his men went down as the grass
+falls before the scythe of the mower. Desperate
+was the struggle then for the body of
+the fallen leader. Hand to hand, clubbing
+their muskets, using their bayonets any way,
+every way, the men fought on; but the band
+of sturdy Americans held both the body and
+the place, and as the British fell back it was
+not to attack Mad Anthony's men again
+during that day.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_344" id="Page_344">[344]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Sir Henry Clinton then moved the main
+body of his troops against the left of the
+Americans, where General (Lord) Stirling
+was in command, but the batteries were so
+well handled that there also the redcoats were
+repulsed.</p>
+
+<p>Then they turned toward the American
+right; but that sturdy blacksmith from
+Rhode Island, Nathanael Greene, was there,
+and no better success crowned their desperate
+and determined efforts. And Mad Anthony
+and his men had rushed to the assistance of
+their comrades. When his men perceived
+the nature of the work which was expected
+of them, they prepared for the action after
+their own peculiar manner. As we already
+know, many of them had cast aside their
+coats when they entered the battle, but now
+some of them stopped and deliberately rolled
+up their shirt sleeves. A shout greeted the
+men, when their action was perceived, and
+in a moment their companions had followed
+their example. Then, with cheers and calls,
+the unsoldierly appearing soldiers rushed into
+the fray, and so vigorous was their work that
+soon the redcoats were compelled to retreat
+behind the defile, where the first stand had
+been made in the beginning of the battle.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_345" id="Page_345">[345]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>There they felt secure. On either side lay
+heavy swamps and thick woods, while in front
+of them was a narrow pass, through which
+the Americans must go if they continued the
+attack.</p>
+
+<p>And that was just what General Washington
+determined to do. Carefully he arranged
+for divisions to move upon the right and upon
+the left, while the artillery was to be brought
+up and pour its terrible fire directly into the
+front of the position the British had taken.</p>
+
+<p>The men responded with a will, but before
+the detachments could gain the desired position
+the night had come, and darkness spread
+over the field, wrapping friend and foe alike
+within its folds. Although the eager Americans
+could not then advance, they resolved
+to pass the night in the positions they then
+held, which were very near to the lines of
+the British, and renew the attack as soon as
+the light of the morning came.</p>
+
+<p>Guards were established, and then the entire
+army prepared for the night. The
+exhausted men threw themselves upon the
+ground, many of them lying at full length
+with their arms spread wide and their faces
+resting directly upon the sand. Seldom have
+men been more completely worn out than<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_346" id="Page_346">[346]</a></span>
+were those hardy soldiers on that day of the
+battle of Monmouth. Many had fallen, and
+when their friends examined their bodies for
+the marks of the fatal bullets not a scratch
+could be found.</p>
+
+<p>The beams of the summer sun had accomplished
+what, in many instances, the bullets
+of the enemy had failed to do. All day long
+the sun had hung in the heavens like a great
+red ball of fire. Steadily the heat had risen
+higher and higher, until it had arrived at a
+point which even the "oldest inhabitants"
+could not exaggerate in their stories. The
+tongues of some of the men had swelled so
+that speech became impossible. The poor
+Hessians, condemned to wear their heavy fur
+hats, left many a lifeless body behind them
+which the heat had conquered before the
+desperate Americans could accomplish the
+same result.</p>
+
+<p>For hours that night not a sign of life
+appeared in the American camp. Motionless
+as logs the exhausted soldiers lay stretched
+upon the ground, and the sounds of their
+deep breathing were all that could be heard.
+They had not stopped even to bury their
+dead, so little life did the living men apparently
+retain.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_347" id="Page_347">[347]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Great was the astonishment in the American
+camp when the first faint streaks of
+the dawn appeared on the following morning,
+and it was discovered that not a soldier
+remained in the British camp. Sir Henry
+Clinton had permitted his weary men to rest
+until ten o'clock, and then, in silence, preparations
+were made to join the forces of General
+Knyphausen, who, meanwhile, had marched
+on and gone into camp at Nut Swamp, near
+the Heights of Middletown.</p>
+
+<p>The British soldiers hastily had collected
+their wounded, leaving only forty of the poor
+fellows behind them, and then under the light
+of the moon began their march to the position
+which Knyphausen was holding. So
+wearied were the American soldiers, so heavy
+was their slumber, and so silent were all the
+movements of Clinton's men, that their departure
+was not discovered before the morning
+came, and by that time the redcoats were with
+the Hessians and safe from all danger of an
+attack.</p>
+
+<p>General Washington considered a further
+pursuit as "impracticable and fruitless," and
+greatly to the chagrin of his army no attempt
+was made to push forward. The great battle
+of Monmouth had been fought. The soldiers<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_348" id="Page_348">[348]</a></span>
+hastily prepared to bury their dead, and so
+hurried were their movements that one man
+afterwards declared he had seen the bodies of
+thirteen men cast into one shallow pit which
+had been dug in the sand. Yet the Continentals
+were neither brutal nor indifferent.
+A British army was near them, and desperate
+haste was considered necessary.</p>
+
+<p>The results of the battle, its effect upon
+the redcoats and buffcoats, and those who
+wore no coats at all, and the parts which Tom
+Coward and certain other of our acquaintances
+had taken in the struggle, we must
+reserve for another chapter.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_349" id="Page_349">[349]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXVII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE RETURN TO BENZEOR'S HOUSE</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">There</span> were several motives in the mind of
+Little Peter which made him eager to overtake
+Ted and the fat and kicking Jeshurun,
+not the least of which was the sense of protection
+he felt in the presence of the powerful
+man. Boyish as Ted was in many ways, his
+great size and wonderful physical strength
+made him a companion to be desired in the
+midst of such dangers as the troubled lad
+was compelled to face in those sad times in
+Old Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, Little Peter ran eagerly forward,
+hoping to overtake Ted before he
+should arrive at Benzeor's house, which now
+was not more than two miles away. Long
+before he came within sight of the place, he
+discovered Ted and his steed in advance of
+him, and from their motionless attitude he
+quickly concluded that Jeshurun had been
+seized with another attack of obstinacy.</p>
+
+<p>His surmise proved to be correct, and as he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_350" id="Page_350">[350]</a></span>
+came nearer he beheld Ted seated by the
+roadside holding Jeshurun's bridle in his hand,
+and apparently waiting patiently for the time
+when the little beast should decide to continue
+his journey.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm glad to see you, lad," remarked Ted,
+as Little Peter approached. "I left you
+rather suddenly back there, but when Jesh
+makes up his mind to start, it's time for me
+to go, too, and I can't always stop to say
+good-by to my friends. It's easier than
+walkin', though, but I wish I knew some way
+to fix the little rascal. I've been thinkin' as
+how, if Jeshurun kicked when he waxed fat,
+it might be that if he waxed thin, the kickin'
+would go, too, along with the fatness. I say,
+Little Peter, I want to ask ye a question."</p>
+
+<p>"All right, Ted, go ahead," replied Little
+Peter, as he fanned his dripping face with his
+hat and took a seat beside his companion.</p>
+
+<p>"In your opinion," said Ted soberly, "is
+the oyster a wild animal, or a tame one?"</p>
+
+<p>"What?"</p>
+
+<p>"Is the oyster a wild animal or a tame
+one? Maybe you don't think he's an animal
+at all, only just an insect; but my opinion is
+that he's an animal, and what I'd like to
+know is whether he's wild or tame."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_351" id="Page_351">[351]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"He isn't savage, anyway," remarked
+Little Peter demurely.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not talkin' about whether he's savage
+or not, but whether he's wild or tame.
+That's been a-botherin' me a good bit, and I
+just can't find any answer. Whoa! Whoa
+there, Jesh! What's the matter with ye?
+If ye want to start on, I'm your man."
+These last remarks were directed at the mule,
+which had begun to display some of the
+qualities of the famous character for whom
+he had been named; but his owner's words
+served to calm him, and Jeshurun soon stood
+in such an abject attitude that, to one who
+was not familiar with his ways, wickedness
+and kicking would never have been suspected
+of him.</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe the oyster's a bird more than he
+is an insect," said Little Peter. "When his
+shell is spread out it looks something like
+wings."</p>
+
+<p>"No, he isn't a bird, he's a animal," said
+Ted, "and what I want to know is whether
+he's a tame or a wild one."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you want to know for?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, the way of it is this: Some time
+ago I planted an oyster-bed off the mouth of
+the river, and the first thing I knew my<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_352" id="Page_352">[352]</a></span>
+neighbors was a-helpin' themselves to it.
+When I said I didn't like that very much,
+and those oysters was mine, all the men did
+was to laugh. Yes, sir, jest laughed," repeated
+Ted, as if he felt aggrieved at the
+levity of his neighbors. "Then, they went
+on to tell me that I couldn't plant oysters,
+same as I did 'taties and things in my garden.
+Oysters was wild things and belonged to anybody
+that found them, jest the same as turtles
+and clams and wild geese did. I've been
+a-puzzlin' my head a good deal over it, and I
+can't make it out. I planted them oysters
+for Sallie,&mdash;she's my wife, ye know,&mdash;and
+as long as she had all she wanted of 'em, I
+didn't care how much the neighbors helped
+themselves; but when it comes to sayin' that
+them oysters I planted don't belong to me,
+but any one can go and take all he wants,
+jest as if they was clams, or gooseberries, or&mdash;or&mdash;or&mdash;saltwater,
+I don't know what
+to do about it. What do you think, Little
+Peter?" he added anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know; I never thought of it
+before."</p>
+
+<p>Absurd as the question appears to us, it
+was far from being so to the people of Old
+Monmouth in the times of which we are<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_353" id="Page_353">[353]</a></span>
+writing. So warm had the discussion become
+that it was soon after carried into the
+courts, and in 1808 a case was tried before
+the supreme court, but no definite decision
+was gained. In 1821 another famous trial
+was held, and finally in 1858 the supreme
+court decided that oysters were both tame
+and wild. Where they had grown naturally
+and without being planted, they were to be
+considered as wild and the property of any
+one who chose to take them; but where they
+had been planted, and there was no natural
+growth, the oysters were "tame" and the
+property of the one who had made the bed.
+Even after that decision there was trouble for
+a long time in Old Monmouth over the question,
+although to-day it is generally accepted
+that a man may own oysters as he does other
+animals.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm sorry ye can't help me," said Ted.</p>
+
+<p>"So am I, but I'm not thinking of oysters
+just now. I want to go up to Benzeor
+Osburn's more than anything else."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm with ye. We're so near, maybe
+Jeshurun will be willing to go, if he doesn't
+have to carry me on his back. I'll try him
+and see."</p>
+
+<p>To the surprise of both, Jeshurun appeared<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_354" id="Page_354">[354]</a></span>
+to be willing to resume the journey and obediently
+followed Ted, who led him by the bridle
+rein which he slipped over the mule's head.</p>
+
+<p>In this wise they all walked on, but as they
+came nearer to the end of their journey, conversation
+ceased. Little Peter was thinking
+of the children and trying to devise some
+plan by which he might care for them. What
+his companion's thoughts were did not appear,
+but the expression upon his face had
+undergone a change, and from the occasional
+word he dropped, which sounded very like
+"Hangin' Sallies," the lad thought he knew
+what was going on in Ted's mind. What
+would occur if Benzeor should be found at
+his home, Little Peter could not determine;
+but he felt assured from Ted's manner that
+this time his neighbor would not escape so
+easily as he had when the angry man had
+given him his involuntary bath in the waters
+of the Shrewsbury River.</p>
+
+<p>However, there was a deal of comfort for
+the lad in the company of his powerful friend;
+and as Benzeor's little house now appeared in
+the distance, he was more and more rejoiced
+that he was not compelled to approach it alone.
+If Indian John's words were correct, Benzeor
+was not there now; but it was more than<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_355" id="Page_355">[355]</a></span>
+possible that John had been mistaken, or that
+the man had returned since his visit in the
+early morning.</p>
+
+<p>These possibilities were sufficiently strong
+to increase Little Peter's excitement, and
+when they turned into the lane which led up
+to the house his heart was beating rapidly
+and his breathing was hard and fast. As he
+glanced toward the place, he suddenly discovered
+some children playing in the yard
+and instantly recognized two of them as his
+own little brothers.</p>
+
+<p>The children, then, were safe; and with a
+sigh of relief he turned to his companion and
+said, "There are my little brothers! They're
+all right, and so far it looks better."</p>
+
+<p>"Hangin' Sallies!" muttered Ted; and
+Little Peter said no more, as he perceived that
+his companion's rage over the treatment his
+wife had received had returned with increased
+force.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly out from the barn beyond the
+house started two men on horseback, riding
+directly down the lane toward them. Startled
+and perplexed by the sight, both Little Peter
+and Ted stopped and waited for the men to
+approach. If the lad had been alone he
+would instantly have turned and fled without<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_356" id="Page_356">[356]</a></span>
+waiting to see who the strangers were; but
+Ted's presence restrained him, and although
+he was thoroughly alarmed, he waited with
+his companion.</p>
+
+<p>As the horsemen came nearer he discovered
+that they were Barzilla Giberson and Jacob
+Vannote, the two men who had been with
+Tom and Benzeor on their voyage to New
+York just before Tom's departure from his
+foster-father's home. Quickly recalling what
+Tom had reported of their conversation at
+that time, the sight of them now did not
+tend to allay his fears; but Ted's presence
+was a source of comfort, and, although he
+was trembling in his excitement, he did not
+speak.</p>
+
+<p>Barzilla instantly stopped his horse as he
+recognized Little Peter, and, leaning forward
+on his horse's neck as he spoke, said,
+"Where's Benzeor?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know," replied Little Peter.
+"Isn't he here?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, he isn't here. He came back last
+night, but he's gone again, and the women
+folks pretend they don't know where he is.
+It's lucky for him."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you want of him?"</p>
+
+<p>"You and he both will know more about<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_357" id="Page_357">[357]</a></span>
+that after we've found him," replied Barzilla,
+as he touched his horse with his spurs, and
+both men rode swiftly down the lane and
+soon disappeared from sight up the road.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter told his companion of his suspicions
+as they resumed their walk, and Ted
+quickly stopped, and, shaking his fist in the
+direction in which the horsemen had disappeared,
+said, "Hangin' Sallies! Maybe I'd
+better take after them, if I don't find Benzeor."</p>
+
+<p>"No, no, Ted. Come on, we're almost
+here now."</p>
+
+<p>They soon entered the yard, and as the
+children discovered the presence of their
+brother they ran eagerly to him and threw
+themselves into his arms.</p>
+
+<p>"I want to go home. I want to go home.
+May we go home now?" said one of them.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter's eyes filled with tears as he
+lifted the child in his arms and said, "No, I'm
+afraid not. We haven't any home now."</p>
+
+<p>"But I want to go home," persisted the
+little fellow pleadingly. "I don't want to
+stay here any longer. I want to go home."</p>
+
+<p>"Hasn't Benzeor been good to you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, but he isn't here. I want to go
+home. I want to go home."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_358" id="Page_358">[358]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Little Peter glanced up and saw that Ted's
+face was moving strangely, and that the tears
+were streaming from his eyes. The powerful
+man had a heart as tender as a woman's, and
+the piteous pleadings of the homeless, motherless
+little lad were more than he could endure.</p>
+
+<p>"Here, Little Peter!" said Ted hastily.
+"You go in the house, and I'll look after
+the babies while you're gone. Here, my
+lads and lassies all! Come take a ride on
+the back of Jeshurun."</p>
+
+<p>In a moment the grief of the little ones
+was forgotten, and, laughing in their delight,
+they were lifted upon the back of Jeshurun,
+who to all appearances had suddenly become
+as mild and gentle as a lamb.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter glanced back at the laughing
+group as he started toward the house, and
+then looking up beheld Sarah standing in the
+doorway. Her face was red with weeping
+and she evidently was in great distress.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, Sarah!" exclaimed Little Peter.
+"What's the trouble? What is it?"</p>
+
+<p>"My father! My father!" sobbed Sarah,
+burying her face in her hands.</p>
+
+<p>"What's happened to him? Is he killed?
+Is he dead?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, no. It's worse than that."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_359" id="Page_359">[359]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Worse than that? What do you mean?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Little Peter, don't <i>you</i> know?" exclaimed
+the girl, looking up again as she
+spoke.</p>
+
+<p>Peter made no reply. He did not know
+just what it was to which Sarah referred, and
+although he had his own suspicions, he did
+not feel that he could refer to them in the
+presence of the troubled girl.</p>
+
+<p>"Have you seen Tom?" said Sarah suddenly.</p>
+
+<p>"No. He's in the army, I think, and I
+haven't been near that."</p>
+
+<p>"You wouldn't have to go very far. They
+say they're both near here, and that there
+either has been a battle or there will be one
+soon. I wish Tom was here. If you see
+him, won't you tell him to come back just as
+soon as he can?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, if I see him. I don't know that I
+shall very soon, though. I don't know what
+to do, Sarah. I came to see about the children."</p>
+
+<p>"They're all right. They seem to be
+now, don't they?" she said, as a burst of
+laughter came from the noisy group. "Perhaps
+you don't want to leave them here now,
+though," she added, her eyes filling with<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_360" id="Page_360">[360]</a></span>
+tears once more as she spoke. "I wish you
+would leave them. It isn't much we can do
+for you, but we want to do what we can."</p>
+
+<p>There was an intensity in Sarah's manner
+which Little Peter could not understand.
+He was in ignorance of all that Sarah knew,
+and perhaps if he had known his reply might
+have been somewhat different.</p>
+
+<p>"It's good of you, Sarah. I don't know
+what to do or where to go."</p>
+
+<p>"You can stay here, too."</p>
+
+<p>"No, no. I can't do that," he said hastily;
+and then fearing that he had said too much,
+added, "I'll leave the children for a little
+while. They'll be safe here till after the
+battle you tell about."</p>
+
+<p>"I wish you would, Peter. You couldn't
+please us better. Who's that man with
+you?" she added, apparently for the first
+time becoming aware of Ted's presence.</p>
+
+<p>"A man to see your father," said Little
+Peter evasively. "Is he home?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, no," and Sarah shuddered as she
+spoke. "He came last night, but he didn't
+stay long. He went away again, and I don't
+know when he'll come again. It'll be a
+long time. I hope"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>What Sarah hoped for she did not explain,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_361" id="Page_361">[361]</a></span>
+and Little Peter said, "I want to talk with
+Ted before I say anything more. He's the
+man out there with the children. I'll be
+back in a minute."</p>
+
+<p>Many minutes passed, however, before the
+lad returned. He called to Ted and for a
+long time they talked together. Ted was
+decidedly averse to the plan of leaving the
+children in Benzeor's home, and freely offered
+to take them with him to the place where he
+had left Sallie and his own little ones, also
+venturing to refer several times to the fact
+that Sallie was his wife.</p>
+
+<p>Pleased as Little Peter would have been to
+accept the offer, Sarah's pleadings could not
+be forgotten, and as he felt that the children
+would be safe where they then were, he
+declined the kind offer of Ted.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll tell you what, my lad," said Ted at
+last. "If the armies are as near here as the
+girl says they are, the thing for you and me
+to do is to go over there. They may need
+us, too. The most I've done so far has
+been to look out for that stuff the men
+brought up the Shrewsbury in the supply
+boat. That's all in good hands now, and I'm
+free to go. Jesh will be glad to go, too."</p>
+
+<p>"But you can't leave Sallie and the babies."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_362" id="Page_362">[362]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I can, too. Sallie's my wife, ye
+know, and when I took her over to the
+Dennises I told her I might not be back for
+a week or two. She won't be disappointed,
+and Jesh will be tickled to pieces to join the
+army. Jest look at his ears now. When his
+ears is that way, I always know Jeshurun
+wants to fight the Dutch butchers."</p>
+
+<p>"We've no other place to go to, or at
+least I haven't," said Little Peter thoughtfully.
+"Well, we'll do as you say. I'll go
+and tell Sarah."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm so glad you'll leave the children,"
+said Sarah eagerly, when Little Peter reported
+the decision which had been made.
+"It isn't much we can do, as I told you, but
+we do want to do everything we can for you."</p>
+
+<p>"It's good of you to take them."</p>
+
+<p>"It's good of you to leave them. There's
+one thing, though, I must tell you. We
+haven't much to eat in the house. There's
+some meal over at the mill, and father would
+have gone for it if he'd been home to-day.
+But he isn't here and I don't know what
+we'll do."</p>
+
+<p>"You'd like to have me go over there and
+get it, before we start," said the boy. "Have
+you got your horses yet?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_363" id="Page_363">[363]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes, there are two in the barn, and you
+can take the heavy wagon. It's kind of
+you to do it, Little Peter, but it won't take
+you long, and you don't know how much it
+will help us just now."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll go right away."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter turned and explained to Ted
+the cause of the delay. At first, Ted insisted
+upon going with him, but as the lad explained
+that only two hours would be required for
+the journey, he persuaded him to remain.</p>
+
+<p>In a few minutes the two horses had been
+led forth from the barn, and hitched to the
+wagon ("geared" was what Ted called the
+task), and then Little Peter mounted the seat,
+grasped the reins in his hands, and turned
+down the lane, on what proved to be the most
+eventful ride in all his life.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_364" id="Page_364">[364]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXVIII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>THE RIDE TO THE MILL</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> early morning had not yet gone when
+Little Peter started on his journey to the
+mill. He knew the place well, for many a
+time had he gone there for his father. It
+was an antiquated structure beside a pond,
+which had been formed by a dam built across
+the very brook near which he and Indian
+John had passed the preceding night.</p>
+
+<p>The work at the mill had been somewhat
+interrupted since the outbreak of the war,
+but the increasing necessities of the people of
+Old Monmouth had led the miller to resume
+his labors, and Sarah had informed Little
+Peter that he would surely find him in his
+accustomed place.</p>
+
+<p>At times, the road led through the woods,
+and the boy could almost touch the bushes
+that grew close to the sandy roadway on
+either side. His view was somewhat obstructed
+by these,&mdash;and that fact, together
+with the unbroken stillness that rested over<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_365" id="Page_365">[365]</a></span>
+all, combined to make Little Peter watchful,
+and somewhat fearful as well.</p>
+
+<p>The sunlight flickered through the treetops
+and cast fantastic shadows on the ground.
+The horses did not increase their speed above
+a slow trot, for the heat was oppressive and
+the sandy road was heavy; and, eager as
+Little Peter was to be back again at Benzeor's
+house, he had not the heart to urge
+on the toiling beasts. The mill was not
+more than three miles from the place from
+which he had started, and at the pace at
+which the horses were then going the lad
+thought he would be back in less than two
+hours.</p>
+
+<p>He had covered about half of the way to
+the mill when his horses, with a sudden snort
+of fear, darted to one side of the roadway.
+Little Peter quickly drew the reins tight, and
+stood up to discover the cause of the alarm.</p>
+
+<p>Two men stepped from the bushes into the
+road, and as they grasped the horses by their
+bits the lad at once recognized them as Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote.</p>
+
+<p>"We thought you were Benzeor," exclaimed
+Barzilla, as he discovered who the
+driver was.</p>
+
+<p>"I've got his horses," replied Little Peter.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_366" id="Page_366">[366]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"So I see. What are you doing with
+them?"</p>
+
+<p>"Going to the mill. You know the children
+are at Benzeor's house, and Sarah
+wanted me to go for some meal. She said
+there was none in the house and her father
+wasn't likely to be home in time to get it, so
+I came for it."</p>
+
+<p>"Where's your father?"</p>
+
+<p>"He's been sent to New York."</p>
+
+<p>"So I've heard. Little Peter, do you
+know who made the attack on your house?"</p>
+
+<p>"It was Fenton's gang, I'm sure."</p>
+
+<p>"So am I, and I ought to know, for I was
+there myself."</p>
+
+<p>"You there?" exclaimed Little Peter.
+He did not refer to the suspicions he had
+entertained concerning the very men who
+then stood before him; but he had never expected
+them to declare their actions so boldly.
+The alarm which he had felt, when the two
+men had suddenly presented themselves in
+the road, was greatly increased now, and for
+a moment he glanced quickly about as if he
+were seeking some avenue of escape.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, we were there," resumed Barzilla,
+apparently ignoring the lad's alarm. "I
+didn't know but you knew it, and I've felt<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_367" id="Page_367">[367]</a></span>
+mean enough about it, too. We didn't have
+anything to do with what happened there,"
+he hastily added; "but the truth is, we
+thought it was about time some kind of a
+stop was put to the doings of the pine robbers,&mdash;so
+Jacob, here, and I pretended to go
+in with them. Of course we didn't like the
+work, but we hoped we could learn enough
+about their plans to trap them. And we've
+almost succeeded. We've been as busy as
+you have, my lad, and pretty soon we hope
+the murderers of your mother will be run to
+cover."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter had never thought of the
+scheme which Barzilla mentioned, and at first
+he did not know whether to believe him or
+not. Certainly appearances were against him,
+but he was in no position to dispute the
+statement.</p>
+
+<p>"Is that what Benzeor was doing, too?"
+he inquired.</p>
+
+<p>"Benzeor? Benzeor Osburn? Don't you
+know what he had to do"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on, Barzilla," interrupted Jacob.
+"Little Peter doesn't know about him, or he
+wouldn't let the children stay there."</p>
+
+<p>"Why? What do you mean? Aren't
+the children safe there?" said Peter quickly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_368" id="Page_368">[368]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Safe? They couldn't be safer if they
+were in China, or some other heathing land,"
+said Barzilla. "Even Benzeor's horses are
+safe. There isn't such a team as that left in
+Old Monmouth," he added, "and if his beasts
+aren't touched, I don't think you need to
+worry very much about the young ones."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't understand," said Little Peter.</p>
+
+<p>"You don't need to," said Jacob quickly,
+"You've got enough to worry about, my
+boy, without bothering your head over Barzilla's
+words. He talks too much, anyway.
+You just go on and get the meal for Sarah;
+that's all you need to think about now."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, but Little Peter ought to know a bit
+more," said Barzilla doggedly. "The truth
+is that we've run some of Fenton's gang into
+these very woods. There are several of us
+scouring the region, and it's only fair to tell
+you that you may run across some of 'em if
+you keep on. For my part I advise you to
+turn back and not go to the mill at all. It
+isn't safe."</p>
+
+<p>"Nobody'll touch him. Let him go on,"
+said Jacob. "The children will have to be
+fed, and he might as well get the meal. He's
+safe enough."</p>
+
+<p>"He can do as he pleases," muttered Barzilla.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_369" id="Page_369">[369]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Little Peter was perplexed, for the actions
+and words of the men were sadly confusing.
+Tom had reported to him some of their previous
+conversations, and his own suspicions,
+as we know, had been aroused. If Barzilla
+spoke truly now, he was in no slight danger
+himself, while the very decided difference of
+opinion between the two men tended to increase
+his confusion.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm goin' to tell you some more," said
+Jacob. "Last night some of Fenton's gang
+went over to Mr. Farr's. You know the old
+man, don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"You mean Thomas Farr, the old man
+who lives with his wife and daughter over on
+the road to Imlaystown?"</p>
+
+<p>"That's the very man. Well, Lew Fenton
+and some of his gang went over there
+about midnight, and attacked the house.
+There wasn't any one in it but the old man
+and his wife and their daughter, and you
+know she's old enough to have arrived at
+years of discretion, to put it mildly. The
+old people barricaded the doors with logs of
+wood just as soon as they discovered who the
+men were.</p>
+
+<p>"The pine robbers tried to break the door
+down with some fence rails, but when that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_370" id="Page_370">[370]</a></span>
+failed, they fired a volley of bullets right
+through the door. One ball broke the leg
+of the old man, but still they wouldn't let
+the pine robbers in. Then the villains went
+around to the back door and succeeded in
+smashing that in. They stuck a bayonet into
+the old man, who was helpless on the floor,
+and then they murdered his wife right before
+his eyes. One of the men struck the daughter
+with the butt of his gun, but, although
+she was pretty badly hurt, she managed to
+get out of the house.</p>
+
+<p>"Fenton's gang didn't wait to plunder the
+place, but, as they were afraid she'd raise an
+alarm, they all cleared out. 'Twas mighty
+lucky for them that they did, for there was a
+lot of us near by. You see we'd seen Benzeor"&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on, Jacob. That's enough. Now,
+Peter, you see what's going on, and it's my
+opinion that some of Fenton's gang, and
+maybe Fenton himself, are in these very
+woods. That's why I advised ye not to go
+on. Now you can do jest as ye like, for
+you've got pretty much the whole story."</p>
+
+<p>"I think you'll be all right," said Jacob.
+"It's only a little way up to the mill, and
+the children need that meal. I should go if<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_371" id="Page_371">[371]</a></span>
+I was in your place, and if I didn't have to
+keep watch here, I'd go with ye myself."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll go," said Little Peter quietly.</p>
+
+<p>"Good luck to ye, then," said Barzilla.
+"We'll see you here when you come back."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter picked up the reins and at
+once started, leaving the two men behind
+him, who remained standing in the road, and
+watched him until he disappeared from sight.
+The lad's feelings, however, had undergone
+a very decided change. He was convinced
+that the story concerning the aged Thomas
+Farr was true, and he was also persuaded
+that his suspicions of Jacob and Barzilla
+were unjust.</p>
+
+<p>Every tree now might be the hiding-place
+of Fenton, or some of his band. Each moment
+he expected to see some one step forth
+into the road before him and stop his horses.
+The very silence in the woods served to increase
+his alarm. He quickened the speed of
+the horses, and soon they were wet with foam,
+as they toiled on through the heavy sand.
+The cry of a bird, or the chattering of a
+squirrel, caused the excited lad to glance fearfully
+in the direction from which the sound
+came. To his excited imagination the woods
+were filled with his enemies, and more than<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_372" id="Page_372">[372]</a></span>
+once a fallen tree or a broken branch took
+on the outlines of a man.</p>
+
+<p>It was with a feeling of intense relief that
+at last he saw the crumbling old mill before
+him. The sound of the water, as it dropped
+from the dam to the bed of the brook below,
+was like music in his ears; and when he discovered
+the miller himself standing in the
+doorway, he again increased the speed of his
+horses, and soon halted before the mill.</p>
+
+<p>"I've come for Benzeor Osburn's grist,"
+he said, as he leaped from his seat to the
+ground.</p>
+
+<p>"They must be pretty hungry over there,
+from the looks of your horses."</p>
+
+<p>"They are. Has any one been here this
+morning?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not a soul. There's no work now, with
+all this fighting going on. Have you heard
+anything from the soldiers?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not much, only that both the armies
+must be near here now."</p>
+
+<p>There was nothing, however, in the presence
+of the old mill to indicate that war's
+rude alarms were to be heard anywhere in the
+region. The monotonous sound of the falling
+water, the dull hum of the big wheel, the
+little garden which the miller had planted<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_373" id="Page_373">[373]</a></span>
+near his log house close by, the dog lying
+asleep on the doorsill, the little urchins playing
+in the waters of the brook, the hens fluttering
+in the roadway and covering themselves
+with dust,&mdash;all seemed to declare that
+only peace and quiet were to be found in the
+region.</p>
+
+<p>And yet, only a few miles away two great
+armies had assembled, and, on the morrow
+the summer air would resound with the booming
+of cannon, and many a buffcoat and redcoat
+would be left lying side by side upon
+the plains of Old Monmouth, never again to
+be mindful of the struggle, or hear or heed
+the calls of their officers as they led the men
+into battle.</p>
+
+<p>At that very time, if the words of Barzilla
+Giberson were true, the woods, which extended
+between the mill and the main road,
+concealed some of the hated pine robbers, as
+well as outraged patriots who were searching
+for their enemies.</p>
+
+<p>The wagon was soon loaded, the miller's
+share of the grist having first been set aside,
+and Little Peter climbed up on the seat and
+grasped the reins, as he prepared to start
+again.</p>
+
+<p>"You'd better be careful," said Little<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_374" id="Page_374">[374]</a></span>
+Peter. "I'm told some of the pine robbers
+are hiding in these woods."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not afraid," laughed the miller.
+"I never harmed them and they won't harm
+me."</p>
+
+<p>The lad related the story of the attack
+upon the house of Thomas Farr, but still the
+miller to all appearances was not deeply impressed.</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't any money and they've nothing
+to gain by disturbing me. I grind
+my grists just the same, whether it's a king
+or Congress that rules over me, and I don't
+care much, for my part, which it is. I don't
+bother my head about such things. All I
+want is good water and plenty of corn, and
+I'm happy all the day long."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter had given his warning, so he
+said no more, but bidding the miller good-day,
+he spoke to his horses and at once
+departed.</p>
+
+<p>His load was heavier now than when he
+had come, and consequently he was compelled
+to let his horses walk. Even then the sweltering
+beasts labored heavily under the intense
+heat, and he was compelled to stop
+frequently and permit them to rest in some
+cool and shady spot.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_375" id="Page_375">[375]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>His own fears had not departed, however,
+but every turn of the heavy wheels brought
+him nearer to the main road, and once there
+he thought he would be safe. Already one
+of the three miles had been left behind him,
+and he was about to start on, after the brief
+rest he had given the horses, when he was
+startled by the sound of something breaking
+through the bushes that lined the road in
+front of him.</p>
+
+<p>Tremblingly he waited a moment, gazing
+with frightened face at the place in the road
+where the man, or animal, or whatever it
+was, would first appear. His suspense was
+not relieved when a horse and rider broke
+through the bushes and stopped only a few
+yards in advance of him.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter's face was deadly pale when he
+instantly recognized the man as none other
+than Lewis Fenton himself. He noted the
+great size, the broad shoulders, the powerful
+arms, for the pine robber was riding without
+a coat, and his shirt-sleeves were rolled back,
+disclosing the great bunches of muscles; but
+more than all else the brutal face terrified him.</p>
+
+<p>Before he could speak or move, Fenton
+leaped to the ground, and leaving his horse
+by the roadside approached the wagon.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_376" id="Page_376">[376]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"How now, young man? Give an account
+of yourself. Where you going? Who
+are you? As I live, if it isn't Little Peter
+Van Mater!" he added in evident astonishment.</p>
+
+<p>As he spoke, he grasped the frightened
+lad by the shoulder and dragged him to
+the ground. Then the brutal, cowardly man
+struck him two savage blows. The sight of
+the woods and even of the pine robber faded
+from Little Peter's eyes, and the unconscious
+boy dropped heavily upon the sand. Even
+then Fenton was not satisfied, for again and
+again he kicked the body, apparently not yet
+convinced that life was extinct.</p>
+
+<p>But Little Peter suffered no pain. With
+sightless eyes, his blood-stained face looked
+up at the blue sky above the treetops, but
+neither the passing clouds nor the further
+actions of the brutal pine robber were heeded
+by the lad.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_377" id="Page_377">[377]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXIX</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>AFTER THE BATTLE</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Tom Coward</span>, as we know, had been selected
+to serve as one of the guides of the
+American army. The roads were not so
+numerous as to cause any fear of serious trouble
+from confusion; but boys and young men
+from the region were nevertheless assigned
+to this duty, and in some instances were said
+to have been so greatly excited as to have
+failed in finding the way themselves. To
+this cause some assigned the failure of Morgan's
+dragoons to enter the battle; but doubtless
+there were other causes as well which
+prevented that terrible band of riflemen from
+having a share in the struggle.</p>
+
+<p>Tom had been reserved to move with the
+troops that were under the command of General
+Washington himself, and that followed
+the division which General Lee had failed to
+lead into battle. Frightened as the lad was,
+he still noted keenly all that was occurring
+about him, and had been as highly excited as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_378" id="Page_378">[378]</a></span>
+any over the interview which took place between
+Washington and Lee when the latter
+was retreating. The impressions he there
+received were those which the people of Old
+Monmouth ever after retained concerning
+Charles Lee, for he was remembered, not for
+his experiences abroad or for his successes in
+the south, but as the man who had been the
+traitor in the battle.</p>
+
+<p>When the engagement began, Tom's duties
+as guide were ended, but as no one gave him
+any instructions, he was driven from one
+band of men to another, and while he still
+retained the rifle which he had taken when
+he had departed from Benzeor's house, he
+had not made any use of it.</p>
+
+<p>For a time he remained within sight of
+the young lieutenant, and they were together
+when in the early part of the battle Captain
+Molly had done the deed which has caused
+her name to be remembered until this day.
+Molly had marched with her husband, and as
+the advanced batteries opened fire upon each
+other the intrepid woman had been running
+back and forth between the men and a little
+spring, which was near by, bringing water to
+her husband and his companions. Her task
+was no light one in the heat of that day.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_379" id="Page_379">[379]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>As she had started to return from one
+of her visits to the spring, she turned just
+in time to see her husband fall as he was
+advancing to his post, for he was a cannoneer,
+as we already know. Molly hastily ran to
+his assistance, but she at once perceived that
+he was dead. She heard an officer order the
+cannon to be moved from its position, but
+instantly controlling her grief, she declared
+her purpose to take her husband's place.
+Amidst the cheers of the men she did so, and
+so bravely and well did she perform the
+duty, that after the battle was ended General
+Greene himself presented her to the great
+commander and related the story of her
+bravery. Washington added his words of
+praise and bestowed upon her a lieutenant's
+commission. The men received the news
+with loud cheers, and then themselves bestowed
+upon "Molly Pitcher" the title of
+"Captain Molly," and as Captain Molly she
+was known thereafter.</p>
+
+<p>Another story, told afterwards by the
+Frenchmen, reflected great credit upon General
+Clinton, and perhaps in a measure atoned
+for the action of that commander in wantonly
+burning so many of the houses in Old Monmouth.
+An American officer with about<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_380" id="Page_380">[380]</a></span>
+twenty of his men advanced under the English
+batteries to observe their position. The
+redcoats opened fire, and the officer's aid-de-camp
+fell at his side. The men, who were
+dragoons, instantly turned and fled,&mdash;that
+is, all save the officer, who, although he was
+directly under the fire of the cannon, calmly
+dismounted and advanced to discover whether
+the fallen man was dead or not, or whether
+the wound had been mortal. Quickly discovering
+that the man was dead, the American
+officer, visibly weeping, turned and remounted
+his horse and slowly rejoined his
+comrades. The officer was the young Marquis
+de Lafayette, and his white charger had
+been recognized by General Clinton, who
+himself ordered his men not to fire, and
+doubtless thereby saved the life of the brave
+young nobleman. It was long cherished as
+the one deed of mercy in the midst of a campaign
+and battle which left its marks of
+suffering and sorrow on every side.</p>
+
+<p>An instance of the other side of the British
+commander's character came to Tom's
+attention not long afterwards, when he heard
+of the misfortune of an old lady seventy
+years of age, in whose house General Clinton
+made his headquarters. The British officer,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_381" id="Page_381">[381]</a></span>
+noticing that his hostess had caused all of
+her better furniture and valuables to be removed,
+informed her that she need have had
+no fears for the safety of her possessions,
+for he himself would protect her and them,
+and urged her to have them brought back
+again. As the old lady expressed her fears
+and objected, he repeated his assurances so
+strongly that she yielded and sent a man
+with a wagon to the place in which they had
+been concealed.</p>
+
+<p>When the wagon-load arrived in front of
+her door, she in person applied to the British
+commander for a guard; but the permission
+was refused and, not even giving her a change
+of dress for herself or her aged husband, the
+goods were at once confiscated, and the old
+lady was compelled to give up her bedroom
+and sleep with the negro women upon the
+floor of the kitchen.</p>
+
+<p>Among the congregation which had assembled
+at the "new church" to watch the
+battle was one man who, instead of joining
+his friends upon the roof or steeple, took his
+seat upon one of the gravestones. Not long
+afterwards, a cannon-ball came speeding in
+that direction, and struck the unfortunate
+man.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_382" id="Page_382">[382]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The congregation upon the roof did not
+wait for the customary benediction to be pronounced,
+we may be sure, and while the most
+of them hastily dispersed, a few remained to
+carry the wounded man into the "meeting-house,"
+where he died within a few minutes,
+and the stains of his blood remained for
+many years upon the floor. It was within
+six feet of the west end of this same "new
+church" that the body of the unfortunate
+British Colonel Monckton, over which the
+contending forces had such a desperate struggle,
+was buried.</p>
+
+<p>Within the vicinity of Monmouth Court
+House many houses and farm buildings were
+set on fire and burned by the redcoats, some
+of whom openly declared that there was no
+hope of conquering the rebels until "they
+had burned every house and killed every
+man, woman, and child." Just how they
+expected to conquer <i>after</i> they had burned
+the buildings and slain the people is not
+clear to us to-day; but doubtless the expression
+and the purpose alike were born of the
+fury of the battle, and was only one among
+many of the results of war, which even in
+its mildest forms appeals to all that is bad
+in men. And as the campaign in Old Monmouth<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_383" id="Page_383">[383]</a></span>
+presented none of the milder forms of
+war, such deeds, terrible as they were, were
+not unnatural.</p>
+
+<p>Nor were they all confined to one side, for
+the men in buff and blue were as much
+aroused as the men in scarlet, and, while
+naturally the anecdotes and incidents of the
+battle are largely those of the cruel deeds of
+the redcoats, doubtless if all things had been
+recorded, we should have found that many of
+those brave ancestors of ours were not entirely
+guiltless of similar deeds.</p>
+
+<p>An unusual story was that of Captain Cook
+of the Virginia Corps, who was shot through
+the lungs. He was carried into a room in a
+near-by house and ordered by the surgeon not
+to speak. A brother officer came into the
+room and tenderly asked of the wounded man
+whether anything could be done for him.
+Captain Cook, in spite of his sufferings, was
+mindful of the surgeon's words and made no
+reply. Mistaking the cause of the silence,
+his friend departed from the house and reported
+to Washington that Captain Cook was
+dead, and then the commander ordered a
+coffin to be placed under the window of the
+room in which the brave captain was supposed
+to be lying dead. But Captain Cook was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_384" id="Page_384">[384]</a></span>
+not dead, nor did he die until many years
+afterwards, and lived to visit several times the
+good people in Old Monmouth, who had tenderly
+ministered to his wants until he was
+able to rejoin the army.</p>
+
+<p>After the battle, many of the dead were
+found beneath the shade of trees, or beside
+the little streams to which they had crawled
+for shelter or for water; and many of these
+had perished, not from wounds, but from
+their labors in the intense heat of the day.
+Several houses at Monmouth Court House
+were filled with the wounded after the battle,
+and every room in the Court House itself was
+likewise filled. The suffering soldiers lay
+upon the straw which had been scattered over
+the floors, and the groans and cries of the
+wounded and the moanings of the dying resounded
+together. The faces of many were
+so blackened that their dearest friends did
+not recognize them, and as fast as they died
+their bodies were taken and buried in pits,
+which were only slightly covered by the sand.</p>
+
+<p>A similar service was rendered for the
+enemy's dead, and among them was found a
+sergeant of dragoons whose immense body
+had been a familiar sight to both armies, for
+the man was said to have been the tallest soldier<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_385" id="Page_385">[385]</a></span>
+ever seen in all the struggle of the Revolution,
+and to have measured seven feet and
+four inches in height.</p>
+
+<p>So, side by side, or in neighboring graves,
+the nameless bodies of friends and foes were
+left for their last long sleep. The roar of
+the cannon, the shouts of the men, the calls
+of the officers, the bitter feelings of the awful
+war were never to disturb or arouse them
+again. They had done their part, and done
+it well; but the land for which they struggled
+could never mark their resting-places,
+nor perhaps recall the names of all. But the
+heroes whose names we praise would never
+have been honored except for the part the
+faithful and brave, but nameless and forgotten,
+heroes took. In honoring the one class,
+let us never forget to pay a tribute of honor
+and of praise to the unknown and forgotten
+heroes of Old Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>The loss of the Americans in the battle
+had been three hundred and sixty-two. That
+of the British, while it was reported to have
+been four hundred and sixteen, was doubtless
+much greater, for the Americans buried no
+less than two hundred and forty-five of the
+redcoats, and had no means of knowing how
+many had been carried away. Washington<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_386" id="Page_386">[386]</a></span>
+himself believed the loss to have been as
+great as twelve hundred.</p>
+
+<p>Who were the victors on the plains of Old
+Monmouth? What were the effects of the
+campaign upon the fortunes of the struggling
+States? Most American writers have claimed
+that the victory belonged to the Continentals
+because they had driven the British from the
+field, while many British writers have claimed
+that it was a drawn battle.</p>
+
+<p>Certainly, Washington must have felt bitterly
+disappointed, for he had hoped to defeat
+the enemy and capture their baggage and
+stores. His failure to do so was not due to
+the British, but to the treachery of Charles
+Lee. Had Lee carried out the orders given
+him, there can be little doubt to-day that the
+battle of Monmouth would have aided in
+putting an end to the war long before peace
+came.</p>
+
+<p>We are not concerned by what might have
+been the result, however, but by what was
+the result. Clinton succeeded in withdrawing
+his troops and saving his baggage train,
+and with both soon after embarked (June
+30) upon the ships which Lord Howe had
+been keeping in waiting off Sandy Hook,
+and thereby gained the safety of New York.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_387" id="Page_387">[387]</a></span>
+But his men were greatly disheartened, and
+came to regard the despised "rebels" in an
+entirely new light. Indeed, within a week
+more than two thousand deserted, the most
+of whom were Hessians, and the confidence of
+those who remained was sadly broken. While
+it is a current saying that "nothing succeeds
+like success," it is also evident that nothing
+fails like failure, and this was as true in
+those trying days of the Revolution as it is
+to-day, and General Clinton soon found it to
+be so.</p>
+
+<p>Upon the Americans, the moral effect of
+the campaign and battle was more needed
+than the material effect. Valley Forge was
+passed now, Philadelphia had been abandoned
+by the British, and the Americans had found
+upon the plains of Old Monmouth, as they
+had at Trenton and Princeton, that their
+men were not inferior to their enemies, while
+their officers were among the best the world
+had known. The opponents and enemies of
+Washington, and they were many at the time
+both within and without Congress, were compelled
+to be silent, and the great commander
+was free to face his difficulties and dangers,
+which were not ended after the battle of
+Monmouth. That campaign had served<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_388" id="Page_388">[388]</a></span>
+chiefly to place behind him one more of his
+problems, but, as we shall see, many yet
+remained to try the soul of the noblest American
+of them all.</p>
+
+<div class="figleft" style="width: 302px;">
+<img src="images/illus399.jpg" width="302" height="500" alt="HE DISCOVERED THAT THE SOLDIER WAS HIS FRIEND" title="" />
+<span class="caption">HE DISCOVERED THAT THE SOLDIER WAS HIS FRIEND</span>
+</div>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, what had become of the lad
+Tom Coward? Alarmed by the battle, not
+daring to fight and yet not knowing where
+to withdraw, although his fear had not been
+strong enough to lead to such a result, he
+was driven about by the movements of the
+men, and in one of the lulls which came in
+the conflict, he found himself almost alone.
+He was near a barn which stood beyond the
+borders of the battlefield, and was just about
+to turn the corner when he stumbled over
+the body of a fallen man.</p>
+
+<p>As he glanced down, he was almost overcome
+when he discovered that the soldier was
+his friend, the young lieutenant. A hurried
+examination revealed that he was still living,
+though he was badly wounded in the throat.
+The lad lifted the head of the suffering man,
+but a groan caused him to desist. Almost
+overcome by grief and fear, he turned to seek
+for aid.</p>
+
+
+
+<p>As he looked quickly about him, he perceived
+a man in the distance on the border
+of the woods away from the battle-ground.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_389" id="Page_389">[389]</a></span>
+Instantly he turned and ran toward him, and
+to his surprise discovered that the man was
+none other than Friend Nathan Brown.</p>
+
+<p>"Come, Nathan! come! Be quick! Lieutenant
+Gordon's over here by the barn.
+He's terribly wounded and may die any
+moment. Come and help me with him!"</p>
+
+<p>The Quaker instantly responded, and without
+explaining how it had happened that he
+should be discovered so near a scene to
+which in spirit as well as in practice he was
+strongly opposed, ran by the side of the
+eager lad to the place where the wounded
+man had fallen.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_390" id="Page_390">[390]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXX</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>TOM COWARD'S PATIENT</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The</span> place where young Lieutenant Gordon
+was lying was in the rear of the barn which
+belonged to the parsonage of the "new
+church." After the bullet had hit him, he
+had managed to crawl to that secluded place,
+but the sounds of the battle, which was still
+being waged in the vicinity, were not long
+heard by the wounded officer, for he had
+soon become unconscious, and the roar of the
+cannon and the shouts of the men were all
+unheeded and unheard.</p>
+
+<p>"Is he dead?" said Nathan in a low
+voice, as he looked down upon the unconscious
+man.</p>
+
+<p>"No! no!" replied Tom hastily; "or at
+least he wasn't a minute ago. No, he's still
+alive," he added after a hurried examination.
+"We must carry him away from this place."</p>
+
+<p>"I see no place for thy friend. These
+sons of Belial are not likely to permit thee to
+depart unnoticed."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_391" id="Page_391">[391]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Friend Nathan was trembling, and his face
+betrayed his alarm. And there was much to
+frighten him. Clouds of smoke could be
+seen not far away, and the loud shouts of
+men and the reports of their guns could be
+distinctly heard. The struggle near the
+meeting-house was one of the most severe
+in all the battle, and the danger of which
+the frightened Nathan spoke was not unreal.
+But Tom's fears had departed now, and
+although he never fully understood the cause
+of the change in his feelings, the sight of his
+suffering friend and his determination to aid
+him had banished all thoughts concerning
+his own personal safety.</p>
+
+<p>At a distance of a half mile, Tom could
+see a little farmhouse, and he hastily decided
+that the young lieutenant must be carried
+there. The building was on the border of
+the plain and on the side opposite to the
+place where the struggle was going on.</p>
+
+<p>There would be danger in the attempt to
+carry him across the field, but thinking only
+of his friend, Tom said hastily, "We must
+carry him to that farmhouse yonder, Nathan.
+I don't know who lives there, but whoever
+does won't refuse to receive a wounded man,
+I know. You take hold of his feet, and I'll<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_392" id="Page_392">[392]</a></span>
+lift the head and shoulders, and we'll get
+him there somehow. Come, Nathan, we
+mustn't delay a minute."</p>
+
+<p>"Have it thine own way, Friend Thomas,"
+replied Nathan, as he stooped and grasped
+the legs of the wounded officer.</p>
+
+<p>Tom gently lifted the head of the young
+lieutenant at the same time, and carefully
+across the field the two men began to move
+with their burden. Their progress necessarily
+was slow, and the lad's fears were not
+allayed by the evident alarm of his companion.
+Nathan repeatedly glanced behind him, and
+several times Tom was compelled to speak
+sharply to recall the frightened man to their
+present task. The shouts and reports of the
+guns were increasing, and Tom's strongest
+desire was to avoid attracting the attention of
+any of the combatants.</p>
+
+<p>They had safely passed beyond the orchard,
+and he was just beginning to hope that their
+efforts would be successful, when suddenly
+Nathan's hat was lifted from his head and
+the sound of a whistling musket-ball was
+heard as it passed above them.</p>
+
+<p>For a moment, the startled Nathan looked
+down at his hat, and as he perceived the hole
+in it which the bullet had made, he instantly<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_393" id="Page_393">[393]</a></span>
+dropped his burden, and turning sharply
+about, started in a swift run across the field.</p>
+
+<p>"Come back, Nathan! Come back! Don't
+leave me here!" pleaded Tom; but Nathan
+did not heed the call.</p>
+
+<p>His pace was a marvelous one for a man
+of his years, and as he bent low over the
+ground, as if to avoid other bullets which
+might be coming toward him, and sped
+swiftly forward, under other circumstances
+Tom might have felt inclined to laugh at the
+ludicrous sight the fleeing man of peace presented.
+But as it was he felt much more
+inclined to cry than to laugh, and, as he
+realized his own helplessness, he knew not
+what to do. If he had been alone he might
+have followed Nathan and gained a place of
+safety, but, as he glanced down upon the
+suffering man, who now lay stretched upon
+the ground, his whole soul rebelled against
+the thought of deserting his friend in a time
+like that.</p>
+
+<p>What could he do? The desperate lad
+looked about him hoping to discover some
+one whom he might summon to his aid. In
+the distance he could see the bands of struggling
+soldiers, and their shouts and shots
+could be clearly heard. But they were all<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_394" id="Page_394">[394]</a></span>
+intent upon their own contest, and there was
+no one who would hear or heed him if he
+should call.</p>
+
+<p>He could not abandon his friend&mdash;that
+much at least was certain; and at last he
+determined to do his utmost to carry the
+helpless, wounded man himself. Placing his
+arms beneath the shoulders of the unconscious
+lieutenant, and striving to rest the
+head against his own body, he started slowly
+on, dragging the man with him. His progress
+was necessarily slow, and he was compelled
+to stop frequently, both for his own
+sake and that of his friend. Still, on and on
+he persistently made his way. The intense
+heat of the day, his constant fear that life
+would depart from the body he was dragging
+forward, the sound of the battle behind him,
+all combined to increase his troubles; but
+not for a moment did he think of abandoning
+his efforts for his friend.</p>
+
+<p>Proceeding slowly, stopping at frequent
+intervals and then resuming his efforts, he
+steadily drew nearer to the farmhouse he
+had perceived in the distance. How much
+time had been consumed he could not determine.
+The minutes seemed like hours to the
+struggling lad. His own danger was all forgotten<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_395" id="Page_395">[395]</a></span>
+for the time, and the one purpose in
+his mind was to carry Lieutenant Gordon to
+some place of safety, where it should be possible
+to do something for the relief of the
+desperately wounded man.</p>
+
+<p>At last, only one more lot remained to be
+crossed, and with renewed hope Tom was
+about to lift his burden, which he had
+dropped for one of his brief rests, when he
+suddenly discovered a man running toward
+him. Startled and alarmed by the sight he
+quickly perceived that the approaching man
+was Friend Nathan, who, hatless and with a
+dripping face, was soon by his side.</p>
+
+<p>"Thou hast put me to shame, Friend
+Thomas," said Nathan soberly. "Thou art
+a better man than I, as well as a braver. I
+know not why it was, but when my hat was
+lifted from my head, and I perceived that
+hole the bullet had made, I lost my self-control.
+My teaching has been that of peace
+and I am poorly prepared for the contests of
+war. I will give thee no cause to complain
+now."</p>
+
+<p>"Take hold, then," said Tom quickly.
+"We must get the lieutenant out of this
+heat, or there'll be no hope for him."</p>
+
+<p>Nathan eagerly responded, and tenderly<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_396" id="Page_396">[396]</a></span>
+lifting the wounded man they proceeded
+across the lot.</p>
+
+<p>When they halted for their first rest, Nathan
+said, "I have a word to say to thee,
+Friend Thomas. What did Washington say
+to thee when he heard thy demand for a
+recompense for the beast I let thee have?"</p>
+
+<p>"Say? He didn't say anything, because
+I didn't say anything to him. You don't
+suppose he hadn't anything more to do than
+to talk with a boy like me about your old,
+broken-winded razor-back, do you? I don't
+even know what has become of the beast. I
+know I'm glad I don't have to ride it any
+more."</p>
+
+<p>"'Tis well, Friend Thomas," replied Nathan,
+although Tom thought he discovered
+a trace of disappointment in the expression
+upon his face. "'Tis well, and I would not
+have it otherwise. I have been humiliated
+by my weakness in deserting thee, a mere
+lad, at such a time as this. I would like also
+to restore to you the half-joe you paid me for
+my beast." And as Nathan spoke, he drew
+the coin from his pocket and held it forth
+for Tom to take.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't want your money," said the lad
+quickly. "Take hold of the lieutenant again,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_397" id="Page_397">[397]</a></span>
+and this time we'll not stop before we come
+to the house."</p>
+
+<p>Once more they tenderly took up their burden,
+and slowly advancing, soon approached
+the house. In the doorway a man and a
+young woman, evidently his daughter, were
+standing, watching the movements of the
+approaching men with a curiosity which the
+noise of the battle in the distance could not
+entirely dispel.</p>
+
+<p>Tom's heart was lighter when he recognized
+the man as Jonathan Cook and the
+young woman as his daughter Mary.</p>
+
+<p>"We've brought this man here," said
+Tom quickly, "to find a resting-place for
+him. It's Lieutenant Gordon, and he's
+terribly wounded. Will you let us put him
+in one of your beds?"</p>
+
+<p>"We will that," said Mr. Cook. "We've
+got one poor fellow here now, and will do all
+we can for another, too. Take him right in
+here," he added, leading the way to a bedroom
+adjoining the living-room on the
+ground floor.</p>
+
+<p>Tom and Nathan eagerly followed him,
+and in a brief time had placed the suffering
+man on the high bed. Although the lad
+was almost exhausted by his efforts, with<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_398" id="Page_398">[398]</a></span>
+Nathan's aid he soon removed the clothing
+of the young officer, and then Mary came
+and bathed his bleeding face, and with many
+expressions of sympathy listened to the story
+the weary boy had to tell.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose it's been wise or safe
+for us to stay here," said Mary, "but we just
+couldn't leave the old place until we had to.
+We've been keeping watch all day long, and
+if the redcoats come this way we shall have
+to go. It's been a good thing we've stayed,
+though, for Captain Nealey is upstairs and
+he's almost as badly wounded as this poor
+man is. Oh, it's horrible, horrible!"</p>
+
+<p>But intense as Mary's feelings were, they
+did not prevent her from bestowing a very
+tender care upon the unconscious young lieutenant,
+and as soon as Tom was satisfied that
+his friend was receiving better nursing than
+he could give, the lad went out of the room.</p>
+
+<p>He discovered Nathan bathing his face and
+hands near the water-barrel, which stood beneath
+the corner of the eaves, and after he
+had followed his example, he began to be
+sensible of his own feeling of exhaustion.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, Friend Thomas, thee must lie down
+and get some sleep," said Nathan. "I will
+assist Mary in her care of thy friend, and I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_399" id="Page_399">[399]</a></span>
+insist that my words he obeyed. The heavy
+task has been thine, and my own cowardice
+has added to thy burdens, so that now it is
+thy turn to rest."</p>
+
+<p>The tired lad was easily persuaded, and
+after again going into the room in which the
+unconscious lieutenant was lying, he followed
+Mr. Cook up the stairs to a room above, and
+soon threw himself heavily upon the bed and
+fell into a deep sleep.</p>
+
+<p>It was dark when he awoke, and at first
+it was almost impossible for him to recall
+the events of the day. They soon returned,
+however, and hastily arising, he made his
+way down the stairs and entered the living-room,
+where he discovered Nathan seated in
+one of the large wooden chairs. The moonlight
+came in through the open windows, and
+as Nathan perceived the lad, he said,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"And did sleep come to thee, Friend
+Thomas?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes. I'm rested now. How's the lieutenant?"</p>
+
+<p>"There has been no change. Mary comes
+every hour and bathes his face in cool water
+from the well, but he does not open his eyes."</p>
+
+<p>"Is the battle ended? I don't hear any
+guns."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_400" id="Page_400">[400]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I know not. Since sunset all has been
+quiet, and it is now midnight."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll watch now, and you go upstairs and
+get some sleep."</p>
+
+<p>"Nay. I ought not to rest after my cowardice."</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind that. You will do all the
+more if you rest awhile now."</p>
+
+<p>Nathan was soon persuaded, and Tom took
+his place as watch. He could hear the troubled
+breathing of the suffering man, but it
+was the only sound to be heard. Outside
+the house all was silent, and as the slow
+hours passed, the only break which came was
+the occasional visit of Mary to bathe the face
+of the sufferer.</p>
+
+<p>At daybreak, Mr. Cook brought the news
+of the retreat of the British, and great was
+the rejoicing in the old farmhouse when it
+was learned that at least the Americans had
+not suffered defeat in the battle of the preceding
+day.</p>
+
+<p>Lieutenant Gordon was still living, although
+no signs of improvement in his condition
+could be discovered. Tom speedily
+decided that, as he was not enrolled in the
+army, there was nothing to prevent him from
+remaining and caring for his friend. Nathan<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_401" id="Page_401">[401]</a></span>
+also declared that he would return to his aid
+as soon as he had gone home and explained
+to Rachel the necessity for a further absence,
+and the lad did not protest, for he thought
+he understood the motive which prompted
+the action.</p>
+
+<p>During the day, Mr. Cook brought the
+reports of the battle, the hundred prisoners
+taken, the number of the dead and wounded,
+and the measures which were being taken in
+the scattered farmhouses and the old Court-House
+for the care of the sufferers.</p>
+
+<p>Tom did not leave the house. His one
+thought now was of his wounded friend, and
+all that loving hearts and gentle hands could
+do was bestowed upon the suffering soldier,
+who as yet had not shown that he was aware
+of what was going on about him.</p>
+
+<p>The long day passed and the dreary night
+followed, but still Tom and Mary cared for
+the sufferer. Captain Nealey was said to be
+improving rapidly, but no change as yet had
+come in the condition of the young lieutenant.</p>
+
+<p>It was the morning of the second day, and
+in the early light Tom had gone out to the
+water-barrel again to bathe his face and
+hands. His heart was heavy, for apparently<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_402" id="Page_402">[402]</a></span>
+Lieutenant Gordon was worse, and all the
+efforts of the lad and Mary had produced no
+improvement in his condition.</p>
+
+<p>As Tom started to enter the house he
+halted upon the doorstep and looked up the
+road. A heavy farm wagon drawn by two
+horses was approaching, and as it came nearer
+the lad suddenly started as he thought he
+recognized the team. Surely those were Benzeor
+Osburn's horses. A moment later his
+suspicions were confirmed, and he knew that
+the lumbering wagon was his foster-father's.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_403" id="Page_403">[403]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXXI</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>AMONG THE PINES</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Tom's</span> surprise was still further increased
+when he recognized one of the men on the
+seat as Little Peter, and by his side a sergeant,
+who was driving. It was Little Peter's
+condition, however, which quickly drew all of
+Tom's attention, for the lad was carrying one
+arm in a sling, one of his eyes was discolored,
+and the marks of suffering were plainly to be
+seen on his face.</p>
+
+<p>Tom quickly ran out into the road, and as
+his friend recognized him, at a word from
+him the horses stopped, and the two boys
+looked at each other for a moment as if each
+was trying to understand how it was that
+they both were there.</p>
+
+<p>"What's the matter? Were you in the
+battle?" said Tom, who was the first to
+speak.</p>
+
+<p>"No, that is, I wasn't in the battle by the
+Court-House. I met Fenton three days ago
+up by the old mill, and these are a few<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_404" id="Page_404">[404]</a></span>
+tokens of his regard which he left with me,"
+said Little Peter, slightly moving his wounded
+arm as he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>As Tom still looked blankly at him, the
+lad continued, "I suppose Fenton thought
+he left me dead, and it's likely I should
+have died if Barzilla Giberson and Jacob
+Vannote hadn't found me. They took me
+up and carried me over to Benzeor's, though
+I <ins title="Transcriber's Note: original reads 'did't'">didn't</ins> know anything about it at the time.
+Sarah and her mother took such good care
+of me that I'm all right now, or at least I'm
+a good deal better."</p>
+
+<p>"You don't look as if you ought to be
+here," replied Tom. "You say Barzilla and
+Jacob found you and took you over to Benzeor's?
+I don't understand."</p>
+
+<p>"They're all right; I understand just how
+it is now."</p>
+
+<p>"What, Benzeor all right?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, Barzilla and Jacob. I know all
+about Benzeor, too," he added in a low voice.</p>
+
+<p>"Where is he?"</p>
+
+<p>"He hasn't been seen or heard from in
+four days. I don't think he'll come home
+again very soon. Tom, Sarah wanted me to
+tell you, if I saw you, that you were to come
+home just as soon as you could. I think she<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_405" id="Page_405">[405]</a></span>
+wants to explain something to you," he
+added, noting Tom's expression of surprise.
+"Since she's found out about Benzeor she
+feels all broken up, and wants you to come
+home."</p>
+
+<p>"Then she knows about Benzeor, does
+she?" inquired Tom thoughtfully.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and so do I. You'll go, won't
+you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I can't now; perhaps I will after a while,"
+and Tom went on to explain the circumstances
+which seemed to make his return to Benzeor's
+impossible for a time.</p>
+
+<p>"But how does it happen that you are here
+so early in the morning, and with Benzeor's
+team? You're almost the last person I expected
+to see."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, the way of it is like this. Barzilla
+and Jacob and some of the Whigs have been
+on the track of Fenton for several days now.
+We've got word that he's down in the pines,
+about two miles below Blue Ball. Several
+parties are out after him, for they've made
+up their minds to rid Old Monmouth of the
+outlaw, if such a thing can be done. Well,
+Barzilla came up to Benzeor's yesterday, and
+when he found I was all right again, he suggested
+that Ted and I report the matter to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_406" id="Page_406">[406]</a></span>
+some of the officers in the American army,
+and get a detachment to go down there, so
+that's what we've done, you see."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I don't see," replied Tom, looking
+about for the detachment of soldiers of which
+Little Peter had spoken. "Ted? Ted who?"</p>
+
+<p>"Ted Wilson, if you please," said that
+worthy, suddenly rising from beneath the
+straw with which the wagon-box was apparently
+filled. "I'm the Ted what Little
+Peter means. Yes, sir, I'm on the lookout
+for those fellows that go around hangin'
+Sallies. She's my wife, ye know."</p>
+
+<p>Startled as Tom was by the unexpected
+appearance of the mighty Ted, he nevertheless
+was compelled to laugh, as the huge man
+stood before him striving to shake himself
+free from the bits of straw which covered his
+face, and shaking his fist at imaginary Fentons,
+who went about engaged in the detestable
+occupation of "hanging Sallies."</p>
+
+<p>"We saw General Lee yesterday, but he
+had so much trouble of his own that he
+couldn't listen much to ours," explained
+Little Peter, "but he managed to give us a
+sergeant and two men. The sergeant here
+is driving, and the men are with Ted under
+the straw."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_407" id="Page_407">[407]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Tom's first thought was to inquire concerning
+the trouble of General Lee, which Little
+Peter referred to, but Ted interrupted his
+question by declaring, "Yes, sir, I've got
+two companions in my misery, cooped up
+here under the straw. I don't see why they
+don't let us sit up straight like men; but no,
+they must cover us all over with straw, and
+then put two or three barrels in the wagon-box
+too. 'Tisn't my way o' doin' things, for
+I'd take Jesh and go straight down to the
+pines and hang Fenton on the first tree I
+found. That's the way I'd do it. But I
+suppose I'll have to obey orders."</p>
+
+<p>"That's what you will," said the sergeant,
+who had been manifesting signs of impatience
+for several minutes. "We mustn't stand here
+in the road talking all day. Lie down, Ted,
+and we'll cover you up again."</p>
+
+<p>Reluctantly the huge man consented, and
+was soon hidden from sight by the straw
+which was thrown over him. The barrels
+were again arranged to present the appearance
+of an ordinary load, and then the sergeant,
+picking up the reins which were lying
+loose in his hands, spoke to the horses and
+started down the road.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter turned and watched Tom, who<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_408" id="Page_408">[408]</a></span>
+had remained by the roadside, gazing eagerly
+after the departing wagon, and when at last
+he could see him no longer, once more gave
+all his thought to the dangerous expedition
+on which he had started with his companions.</p>
+
+<p>Benzeor's horses were in much better condition
+than those of his neighbors, for reasons
+that are apparent now to all our readers, and
+they maintained so steady a pace that by
+noontime the party had entered within the
+borders of the pines.</p>
+
+<p>The road here became rough and heavy,
+and the progress, as a consequence, was correspondingly
+slow. The tall stately trees,
+the whisperings of the wind, the silence of
+the great forest, and above all, the knowledge
+that they had entered upon the most dangerous
+portion of their journey, made all the
+men in the wagon anxious and watchful.
+Not a word was spoken now, even Ted
+having ceased to complain of his narrow
+quarters, and having no remarks to make
+concerning the outlaws, whose disposition led
+them to go about the country attacking defenseless
+men and "hanging Sallies."</p>
+
+<p>Every tree might conceal an enemy, and at
+any moment the discharge of a gun might
+indicate that their presence had been discovered.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_409" id="Page_409">[409]</a></span>
+The habitations of men had been left
+behind them soon after they had entered the
+sombre forests, and the few rude little shanties
+near the border, occupied by negroes and
+people whose reputation in Old Monmouth
+was not of the best, had all been passed.
+The vegetation was scanty, and long barren
+stretches of sand could be seen on every side.
+The sunlight only penetrated the gloom in
+places, and its presence served to increase
+the dark and sombre appearance of the unbroken
+forest.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter maintained a careful watch
+upon one side as they advanced, and the sergeant
+watched the other, but they seldom
+spoke now, and then only in whispers. The
+full sense of the danger of entering a region,
+known to be used by the pine robbers as their
+headquarters, was appreciated as it had not
+been when they started. They had no means
+of knowing how many men Fenton might
+have with him, and hard as the outlaws were
+against the defenseless people of Old Monmouth,
+doubtless they would display the honor
+which it is said thieves maintain toward one
+another, and if others should be within hailing
+distance when Fenton was attacked they
+would all quickly rally to his assistance.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_410" id="Page_410">[410]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>And the resistance which Fenton himself
+would be likely to make was not forgotten.
+The vision of him, as he suddenly appeared
+to Little Peter on that lonely road to the old
+mill a few days previous to this time, came up
+before the lad now. His big and burly frame,
+his bared and powerful arms, the brutal and
+merciless expression upon his evil face, were
+all seen again, and the lad shuddered as he
+recalled his experiences with him.</p>
+
+<p>"What's wrong?" whispered the sergeant
+quickly. "See anything?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not yet."</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter had not been in the region
+since the breaking out of the war, although
+before that time he and Tom had made frequent
+visits there. Still, he recognized the
+locality, and knew the place to which Barzilla
+had reported that Fenton had gone. It
+was a rude log house, built of the pine-trees,
+and could not be more than two miles in
+advance of them.</p>
+
+<p>The horses were toiling now as they dragged
+the heavy wagon through the deep sand.
+Fish-hawks had their nests in the tops of the
+lofty trees, and occasionally Peter obtained
+a glimpse of the great birds as they sailed in
+the air far above him. A brown rabbit now<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_411" id="Page_411">[411]</a></span>
+and then came forth from his burrow, and
+after eying the intruders a moment, would
+go bounding away into the thickets, or else
+dart swiftly back into his underground home.
+The note of a wood-thrush now and again
+broke in upon the stillness with its clear,
+sweet whistle, and the watchful men would
+glance quickly about them, almost thinking
+that the sound was the call of the pine robbers
+to one another.</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter's fear and the pain he was
+suffering from his recent encounter with Fenton
+made his face pale, and as the sergeant
+again turned to him and marked his appearance,
+he said, "'T was too bad, my lad, that
+you had to come."</p>
+
+<p>"I knew the way. I had to come and show
+you."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, yes. I know it, but it's hard, for
+all that."</p>
+
+<p>"We're almost there now. The place
+can't be more than a quarter of a mile farther
+on."</p>
+
+<p>The sergeant did not reply, but turned
+quickly at the words, and peered keenly
+into the forest before him. No one could
+be seen, and the tall trees guarded well their
+secret. The toiling horses were pulling steadily<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_412" id="Page_412">[412]</a></span>
+on their load, and they, at least, felt no
+alarm; but Little Peter and his companion
+were anxious now, and were keeping their
+eyes steadily fixed upon the road before
+them.</p>
+
+<p>"There! That's the place!" whispered the
+lad excitedly, as he obtained a glimpse of a
+little clearing not far in advance of them.</p>
+
+<p>The sergeant did not reply, but he tightened
+his grasp upon the reins, and glanced
+down at the gun which he had placed within
+easy reach. Little Peter's excitement had
+become intense, and he was peering eagerly
+ahead of him, while his breathing was quick
+and hard. They would soon know what the
+result of the expedition was to be.</p>
+
+<p>The heavy wagon came out into the clearing,
+and drew near to the one small house,
+which was standing within it. The house
+was of logs, and corresponded exactly to the
+description which Barzilla had given of it.
+As yet, no human being had been seen, and
+the sergeant was just about to declare that
+the place was not inhabited when the door
+was suddenly opened and a man stepped forth
+to view. Evidently he had heard the sounds
+of the approaching wagon, and had come out
+to investigate.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_413" id="Page_413">[413]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>He was a tall, broad-shouldered, powerful-appearing
+man. He was clad in a pair of
+rough trousers and high boots, which looked
+as if they might have belonged to some Hessian
+dragoon at one time, and the red flannel
+shirt which partially covered his chest could
+not entirely conceal the great bunches of
+muscle there. In one hand he grasped a
+pistol, and the expression upon his face might
+well have caused a man with a much stouter
+heart than Little Peter had to tremble.</p>
+
+<p>The sergeant glanced inquiringly at the
+lad by his side, and Little Peter nodded his
+head in reply to the unspoken question. The
+man was Fenton himself,&mdash;the one who had
+robbed the widows and the fatherless, had
+made the midnight attacks upon the defenseless
+people of Old Monmouth, had hanged
+trembling women from the limbs of trees,
+and tortured his helpless victims into revealing
+the places where their scanty savings
+had been concealed. He had been the
+leader of bands as desperate and wicked as
+himself, and the suffering and woe which
+the good people of the surrounding region
+had experienced at his hands can never be
+told. And now the man himself stood waiting
+for the wagon, in which were Little Peter,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_414" id="Page_414">[414]</a></span>
+himself a victim of the pine robbers' cruelty,
+and his companions, to approach.</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on!" called Fenton. "You're
+movin' too fast. What ye doin' here?"</p>
+
+<p>The sergeant stopped his horses, and as
+Fenton approached and stood near the wheel,
+he said, "We've come down here to look for
+a man we want to find."</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon I'll do as well as any other.
+Look at me! Ye're not goin' any farther,
+ye might as well understand that now as any
+time. Got a bottle with ye?"</p>
+
+<p>The sergeant drew forth a bottle of brandy
+and handed it to the outlaw. Fenton took
+it, and raised one foot upon the hub of the
+wheel. As he lifted the bottle to his lips,
+his eyes fell upon Little Peter, who had been
+endeavoring to conceal himself behind his
+companion.</p>
+
+<p>Instantly recognizing the lad, he shouted,
+"You here? You? I thought I left ye
+dead up by the mill the other day! You
+rascal! One whipping wasn't enough, was
+it? I'll give ye what ye deserve now!"</p>
+
+<p>Fenton reached back with one hand to
+grasp the pistol he had thrust into his
+pocket when he had taken the bottle.
+Quickly the sergeant kicked the foot of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_415" id="Page_415">[415]</a></span>
+Ted Wilson under the straw, and instantly
+the men arose, and before Fenton could act,
+had brought their guns to their shoulders
+and the reports rang out together.</p>
+
+<p>The pine robber pitched heavily forward,
+and lay dead upon the sand. Oh, it was
+horrible, awful! A sensation of sickness, of
+faintness, swept over Little Peter as he looked
+down upon the face of the dead outlaw.</p>
+
+<p>"What's that? What's that?" said Ted
+quickly.</p>
+
+<p>It was the sound of a gun not far away.
+It might be the answer of other bands of pine
+robbers to the volley which had just been
+fired; and hurriedly throwing the body of
+Fenton into the wagon, the sergeant turned
+his horses about and started swiftly back up
+the road.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_416" id="Page_416">[416]</a></span></p>
+<h2>CHAPTER XXXII</h2>
+
+<div class='chaptertitle'>CONCLUSION</div>
+
+
+<p><span class="smcap">In</span> spite of the heavy sand the horses were
+driven swiftly, until their heaving sides and
+dripping flanks compelled their driver to give
+them a much-needed rest. Ted Wilson and
+one of the soldiers then leaped lightly to the
+ground and ran into the woods on either
+side of the road to ascertain whether they
+were pursued or not.</p>
+
+<p>As the silence of the great forest was unbroken
+they speedily returned, and the flight
+was resumed. No one was concealed beneath
+the straw in the wagon-box now, and every
+one stood waiting and ready to share in the
+defense which at any moment might become
+necessary.</p>
+
+<p>On past the tall pine-trees, on through the
+heavy sandy road, rushed the returning party,
+and at last, when they obtained a glimpse of
+the open country, they breathed a sigh of
+relief as they realized that the danger of
+immediate pursuit was gone. It was not until<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_417" id="Page_417">[417]</a></span>
+nearly a year after this time that they learned
+that the gun they had heard had been discharged
+by De Bow, the desperate leader of
+another band of outlaws as evil in every way
+as those whom the detested Fenton had himself
+led.</p>
+
+<p>It was near the close of the day when the
+party, of which Little Peter was a member,
+drove up to Monmouth Court-House. Carelessly,
+almost brutally, the sergeant and one
+of his companions seized the body of the dead
+outlaw, and flinging it from the wagon into
+one of the trenches the soldiers had made,
+shouted, "Here's a cordial for your tories
+and wood robbers!"</p>
+
+<p>Little Peter had no share in the rejoicing
+which followed when it was known that the
+pine robber was no more. It was true, he
+knew Fenton had richly deserved his fate,
+and that no more would the defenseless people
+of Old Monmouth suffer from the evil
+deeds of his marauding band. He, too, had
+known something of Fenton's wickedness, for
+he was motherless, homeless, and almost
+fatherless because of him, and his own body for
+many days bore the traces of his meeting with
+him on his return from the mill; but in spite
+of all that, his heart was sick whenever he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_418" id="Page_418">[418]</a></span>
+thought of the dead face he had seen looking
+up at him from the wagon-box, and the brutal
+rejoicings of the men who had shot him near
+his abode among the pines.</p>
+
+<p>On the following day Tom Coward returned
+to Benzeor's house for a brief visit, reporting
+a very decided improvement in the condition
+of young Lieutenant Gordon. A long interview
+between Tom and Sarah followed, and
+as the troubled girl explained to the lad what
+she had learned concerning the evil deeds of
+her own father, and begged him to return
+and aid her in caring for the family in the
+presence of such dangers and perplexities,
+Tom could not find it in his heart to refuse.
+The kindness bestowed upon him in the home,
+and the obligations to repay as best he could
+the care he himself had received there, were
+too strong to be ignored, and greatly to the
+joy of Sarah and her mother he yielded to
+their urgent pleas. He had not yet enlisted
+in the army, and so was free to decide the
+question for himself.</p>
+
+<p>He was aided in making the decision by
+the fact that Little Peter was also to remain.
+His own home had been destroyed, and as
+there was no place to which he could take his
+little brothers and sisters, there was every<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_419" id="Page_419">[419]</a></span>
+reason why he should accept the invitation
+and increase the defenses of the household.</p>
+
+<p>It was not considered probable that Benzeor
+would return, nor was it known what had become
+of the man, who had gradually and yet
+steadily been drawn into the power of the
+pine robbers, until at last he was considered
+by them all as one of themselves, and indeed
+he was. Neither the boys nor Sarah knew
+then whither he had gone. Tom thought he
+might have been killed in the battle, and it
+was not until more than a year had passed
+that word came from the missing Benzeor;
+but where he had been and what he had been
+doing do not belong to this story.</p>
+
+<p>On the day following the great battle of
+Monmouth, General Lee had, to a certain extent,
+recovered from his chagrin at the public
+rebuke General Washington had administered
+to him, and in his arrogance, and as a relief
+to his feeling of mortification, he wrote a childish
+letter to the commander, demanding an
+apology for the words he had spoken in the
+presence of the soldiers.</p>
+
+<p>Washington's reply to Lee's letter was as
+follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"<span class="smcap">Sir</span>,&mdash;I received your letter, expressed,
+as I conceive, in terms highly improper. I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_420" id="Page_420">[420]</a></span>
+am not conscious of making use of any very
+singular expressions, at the time of meeting
+you, as you intimate. What I recollect
+to have said was dictated by duty and warranted
+by the occasion. As soon as circumstances
+will permit, you shall have an opportunity
+of justifying yourself to the army, to
+Congress, to America, and to the world in
+general; or of convincing them that you were
+guilty of a breach of orders, and of misbehavior
+before the enemy on the 28th instant,
+in not attacking them as you had been directed,
+and in making an unnecessary, disorderly, and
+shameful retreat."</p>
+
+<p>Lee's reply to this letter, as impudent as it
+was childish, certainly did not tend to elevate
+him in the estimation of the men of his own
+time, or of ours. His letter was as follows:
+"You cannot afford me greater pleasure than
+in giving me the opportunity of showing to
+America the sufficiency of her respective servants.
+I trust that temporary power of office,
+and the tinsel dignity attending it, will not
+be able, by all the mists they can raise, to
+obfuscate the bright rays of truth."</p>
+
+<p>Washington's reply to this insulting letter
+was to arrest Lee. The traitor was at once
+court-martialed and charged with disobedience<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_421" id="Page_421">[421]</a></span>
+of orders, misbehavior on the field, making a
+disgraceful retreat, and also with gross disrespect
+to his commander-in-chief. The trial
+lasted more than a month, and the result was
+that Lee was suspended for the term of one
+year. If strict justice had been measured out
+to the man, doubtless he would not have
+escaped with so light a sentence; but Washington
+was merciful, and although Lee did
+not appreciate the kindness shown him, he
+owed his life to the man whose heart and
+mind were so much greater than his own.</p>
+
+<p>General Washington did not long delay in
+Old Monmouth after the battle. The British
+army had gained New York, and so the
+American commander moved to the Hudson,
+and on the 20th of July went into camp at
+White Plains, having left some of the militia
+to look well to the needs of the country in
+which the great battle had been fought.</p>
+
+<p>And Monmouth was a great battle. Not
+only did the men struggle with a determination
+such as has been seldom displayed, but
+the results of the engagement itself were also
+marked and strong. While the two armies,
+after Washington had gone to the Hudson
+and Clinton to New York, occupied much
+the same relative positions as in the latter<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_422" id="Page_422">[422]</a></span>
+part of '76, the motives which controlled each
+were exactly reversed. The Americans now
+became the aggressors, and the British were
+compelled to defend themselves.</p>
+
+<p>All this was intensified by the action of
+France. Benjamin Franklin had succeeded
+in arranging a treaty between that land and
+ours. France was to send a fleet of sixteen
+war vessels under D'Estaing to our shores,
+and also an army of four thousand men. It
+was the coming of this fleet which, as we
+know, caused the British to depart from Philadelphia
+and hasten to the defense of New
+York, which place they thought would be
+first attacked. The march of the redcoats
+and Hessians across New Jersey gave Washington
+an opportunity to pursue them, and
+while he failed in accomplishing all that he
+hoped, and much that he might have done
+had it not been for the treacherous actions of
+Lee, still he virtually had won a victory. He
+compelled the British to retreat with great
+losses, he strengthened his own position, he
+silenced his enemies in Congress, and, above
+all, he aroused a new feeling of hope and
+determination in the hearts of the struggling
+Americans.</p>
+
+<p>The British very promptly declared war<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_423" id="Page_423">[423]</a></span>
+against France, and then coolly invited the
+Americans to join them, promising all that
+the colonists had asked three years before
+this time. The offer had come too late, however,
+for now the colonies had become States,
+and independence had been declared, and independence
+the new nation would have. So
+the war was continued, but the part which
+the new allies took and the further struggles
+of the determined Americans belong to another
+story.</p>
+
+<p>It only remains to refer briefly to the experiences
+of our friends, whose fortunes we
+have followed in the course of this book.</p>
+
+<p>Lieutenant Gordon at last recovered from
+his wound. Tom Coward divided his time
+between caring for his friend and the labor
+on Benzeor's farm. In the former task he
+was aided by Friend Nathan Brown until
+such a time as the young lieutenant could be
+removed to his own home.</p>
+
+<p>Friend Nathan had been unable to remain
+away from the battle of Monmouth, and while
+both his feelings and professions had prevented
+him from entering into the struggle,
+still his interest had been so intense that he
+had started from his home to the scene of the
+struggle. There he met Tom, and the part<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_424" id="Page_424">[424]</a></span>
+he then took in caring for the wounded young
+officer we already know.</p>
+
+<p>Neither Tom nor Little Peter was idle.
+There was much work to be done on both
+farms, and the lads aided each other. The
+crop on the ten-acre lot was successfully
+grown and harvested, and the immediate
+problem of food in Benzeor's household was
+in a measure solved.</p>
+
+<p>Indian John was never seen by our boys
+again. Whether he had been slain by the
+British or the pine robbers, or had departed
+from the homes of his ancestors for a region
+into which the redcoats and buffcoats did
+not enter, was never known. Both Tom
+and Little Peter were inclined to the latter
+conclusion, however, and their opinion was
+strengthened by the fact that "Charlie"
+Moluss, and his wife Bathsheba, and her sister
+"Suke" were never seen or heard from
+again.</p>
+
+<p>Several times the boys made their way into
+Indian John's cave by the brook, but they
+never discovered any signs of their friend.
+He had forever disappeared, but his stories
+concerning the origin of the Jersey mosquitoes,
+his interpretations of the roar of the
+ocean and the calls of the sea-birds, and above<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_425" id="Page_425">[425]</a></span>
+all the assistance he had rendered Little Peter
+in the trying days of '78 were never forgotten.</p>
+
+<p>Weeks had passed before Little Peter positively
+learned that Benzeor's statement concerning
+his father had been correct, but at
+last he received definite information that he
+was a prisoner in New York. What that
+meant to the troubled lad, few of us to-day
+can understand. The sufferings on board
+the prison-ships and in the prison-houses of
+New York almost baffle description; but we
+may be sure of one thing, and that is that
+Little Peter did not sit idly down, nor rest
+content to leave his father where he was
+without making some efforts in his behalf.
+But that, too, belongs to another record.</p>
+
+<p>Barzilla Giberson and Jacob Vannote
+after the death of Fenton did not find it
+necessary to play a double part. They believed
+that their efforts to run the pine robbers
+to cover had been successful, and that
+now they could boldly and openly take their
+stand on the side of the patriots. And take
+that stand they did, and their services in the
+New Jersey militia are known in all the
+region of Old Monmouth.</p>
+
+<p>Ted Wilson, with Jeshurun "waxen fatter"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_426" id="Page_426">[426]</a></span>
+and consequently still more inclined to
+kick, returned to his home after the death of
+Fenton. He found Sallie and the babies
+safe at the Dennises, but all of the mighty
+Ted's former indifference as to his rulers had
+departed. The taste of the struggle he had
+had seemed only to whet his appetite for
+more, and not many days had passed before
+Ted and Jeshurun once more started forth
+in quest of service and adventure.</p>
+
+<p>Sarah Osburn labored faithfully and cheerfully
+for the welfare of her enlarged household,
+and the boys did not fail to appreciate
+her kindness. Tom thought he understood
+the motive which prompted much of her care
+for Little Peter's younger brothers and sisters,
+but throughout the long absence of
+Benzeor he never directly or indirectly referred
+to it.</p>
+
+<p>There was a brief lull in the outrages and
+attacks of the pine robbers after the death
+of Fenton, but it was very brief. Stephen
+Burke (or Stephen Emmons as he was sometimes
+called), Stephen West, Ezekiel Williams,
+Jonathan West, Richard Bird, Davenport,
+De Bow, and others were yet living, and as
+each was the leader of a band as desperate
+as himself, and as all were as reckless and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_427" id="Page_427">[427]</a></span>
+brave as Fenton had been, in a brief time
+the suffering people of Old Monmouth found
+that their troubles were by no means ended.</p>
+
+<p>Redcoat and buffcoat were again to contend
+within their borders, salt-works and
+houses were to be burned, gunboats were to
+anchor off her shore and their crews were to
+engage in conflicts with the patriots; whigs
+and tories were not yet reconciled, the pine
+robbers were not yet subdued. Five long
+and terrible years of the struggle of the
+Revolution were yet to come, and the sands
+of Old Monmouth were again and again to
+be dyed by the blood of fallen men.</p>
+
+<p>The waves which came creeping, crawling
+up the long sandy shore, the tall pine-trees
+whose tops whispered together as they bent
+beneath the summer winds and winter storms,
+the fertile plains and noble forests of oak
+and chestnut, were unchanged; but the
+struggling men and women of Old Monmouth
+were yet to endure the bitter hardships
+and fierce contests, which the closing
+days of the Revolution brought to them in
+greater numbers than to almost any other
+people of our land.</p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<div class='tnote'><h3>Transcriber's Notes:</h3>
+<p>Obvious punctuation errors repaired.</p>
+
+<p>The remaining corrections made are indicated by dotted lines under the corrections. Scroll the mouse over the word and the original text will <ins title="Transcriber's Note: original reads 'apprear'">appear</ins>.</p></div>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<pre>
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+***** This file should be named 34864-h.htm or 34864-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/3/4/8/6/34864/
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/34864-h/images/coverpage.jpg b/34864-h/images/coverpage.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9eeb600
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/coverpage.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/images/emblem.png b/34864-h/images/emblem.png
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6eca17a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/emblem.png
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/images/illus002.jpg b/34864-h/images/illus002.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..74d71e4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/illus002.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/images/illus097.jpg b/34864-h/images/illus097.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d6c5064
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/illus097.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/images/illus163.jpg b/34864-h/images/illus163.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6e16d6e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/illus163.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864-h/images/illus399.jpg b/34864-h/images/illus399.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..001cdd6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864-h/images/illus399.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/34864.txt b/34864.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..30c2528
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,9589 @@
+Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: The Boys of Old Monmouth
+ A Story of Washington's Campaign in New Jersey in 1778
+
+Author: Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+Release Date: January 6, 2011 [EBook #34864]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: "WHAT ABOUT THE BOY?" (page 13)]
+
+
+
+
+
+THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH
+
+A Story of Washington's Campaign in New Jersey in 1778
+
+BY EVERETT T. TOMLINSON
+
+_Author of "Washington's Young Aids," "Guarding the Border," "The Boys
+with Old Hickory," "Ward Hill at Weston," etc., etc._
+
+[Illustration: The Riverside Press]
+
+BOSTON AND NEW YORK HOUGHTON MIFFLIN COMPANY The Riverside Press,
+Cambridge
+
+
+
+
+ COPYRIGHT, 1898, BY EVERETT T. TOMLINSON
+ ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+ I. OLD MONMOUTH 1
+ II. TOM INVESTIGATES 15
+ III. THE MEETING ON THE RIVER 27
+ IV. BENZEOR'S VISITOR 40
+ V. THE MESSENGER 53
+ VI. IN THE TEN-ACRE LOT 67
+ VII. THE PARTING OF THE WAYS 82
+ VIII. INDIAN JOHN 96
+ IX. THE YOUNG LIEUTENANT 112
+ X. THE STORY OF THE MISCHIANZA 126
+ XI. TO REFUGEE TOWN 141
+ XII. BATHSHEBA'S FEAST 156
+ XIII. WITH THE REDCOATS 169
+ XIV. THE WAY TO CRANBERRY 182
+ XV. THE BOAT ON THE BAR 195
+ XVI. TED WILSON'S VICTIM 208
+ XVII. A FRUITLESS CHASE 221
+ XVIII. A RARE BEAST 233
+ XIX. THE RELEASE OF BENZEOR 246
+ XX. THE FLEET OF BARGES 259
+ XXI. THE RIDE WITH THE LIEUTENANT 272
+ XXII. A SOLDIER WOMAN 286
+ XXIII. AN INTERRUPTED JOURNEY 298
+ XXIV. THE ABODE OF INDIAN JOHN 310
+ XXV. THE BEGINNING OF THE GREAT FIGHT 323
+ XXVI. THE BATTLE OF MONMOUTH 336
+ XXVII. THE RETURN TO BENZEOR'S HOUSE 349
+ XXVIII. THE RIDE TO THE MILL 364
+ XXIX. AFTER THE BATTLE 377
+ XXX. TOM COWARD'S PATIENT 390
+ XXXI. AMONG THE PINES 403
+ XXXII. CONCLUSION 416
+
+
+
+
+THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+OLD MONMOUTH
+
+
+OLD Monmouth is an expression dear to the heart of every native-born
+Jerseyman. The occasional visitor seeking health among its whispering
+pines, or relaxation in the sultry summer days along its shore, where
+the roll of the breakers and the boundless sweep of the ocean combine to
+form one of the most sublime marine views on all the Atlantic seaboard,
+may admire the fertile farmlands and prosperous villages as much as the
+man to the manor born, but he never speaks of "Old" Monmouth.
+
+Nor will he fully understand what the purebred Jerseyman means when he
+uses the term, for to the stranger the word will smack of length of
+days, and of the venerable position which Monmouth holds among the
+counties of the State.
+
+Monmouth is old, it is true, and was among the first of the portions of
+New Jersey to be settled by the Woapsiel Lennape, the name which the
+Indians first gave to the white people from across the sea, or by the
+Schwonnack,--"the salt people,"--as the Delawares afterwards called
+them. But the true Jerseyman is not thinking alone of the age of
+Monmouth when he uses the word "Old." To him it is a term of affection
+also, used it may be as schoolboys or college mates use it when they
+address one another as "old fellow," though but a few years may have
+passed over their heads.
+
+The new-comer or the stranger may speak of Fair Monmouth, and think he
+is giving all the honor due to the beautiful region, but his failure to
+use the proper adjective will at once betray his foreign birth and his
+ignorance of the position which the county holds in the affections of
+all true Jerseymen.
+
+Still, Monmouth is old in the sense in which the summer visitor uses the
+word. Here and there in the county an antiquated house is standing
+to-day, which if it were endowed with the power of speech could tell of
+stirring sights it had seen more than a century ago. Redcoats, fleeing
+from the wrath of the angry Washington and his Jersey Blues, marched
+swiftly past on their way to the Highlands and the refuge of New York.
+Fierce contests between neighbors, who had taken opposite sides in the
+struggle of the colonies for freedom from the yoke of the mother
+country, or step-mother country, as some not inappropriately termed her
+in these days, occurred in the presence of these ancient
+dwelling-places, and sometimes within their very walls. Many, too, would
+be the stories of the deeds of tories, and refugees, and pine robbers
+contending with stanch and sturdy whigs. Up the many winding streams,
+boat-loads of sailors made their way from the gunboat or privateer
+anchored off the shore, to burn the salt works of the hardy pioneers, or
+lay waste their lands as they searched for plunder or for forage.
+
+The forked trees along the shore, in whose branches the lookouts were
+concealed as they swept the ocean for miles watching for the appearance
+of the hostile boat, were standing until recent years. In their last
+days broken, it is true, and almost destroyed by the winter storms and
+their weight of long years, still they stood as the few remaining tokens
+of that century when our fathers contended for "their lives, their
+fortunes, and their sacred honor." At last the pathos and weakness of
+old age prevailed, and to-day there remains scarcely a vestige of those
+ancient landmarks.
+
+Perhaps if the boys and girls of New Jersey had been as mindful of those
+old trees as the Cambridge lads and lassies have been of the spreading
+elm beneath whose branches the noble-hearted Washington assumed the
+command of the little American army, some of them might still be
+standing; but as it is, the most of them have crumbled and fallen and
+disappeared as completely as have the men who sought the shelter of
+their branches in the trying times of '78.
+
+So, too, for many years stood the famous tree from whose limbs the noble
+patriot, Captain Huddy, was hanged,--as dastardly a deed as was
+committed by either side in that struggle which tried the souls of our
+fathers. But the trees are gone, and only a few quaint houses and
+venerable landmarks and heirlooms remain of those things which witnessed
+the contests, and deeds high or base, of that far-away time.
+
+The lofty monument on the old battle-ground of Monmouth is surmounted by
+the figure of a man whose face is shaded by his hand, as if he were
+still striving to obtain a glimpse of the redcoats in the darkness as
+they hastened to gain the Highlands and the refuge of the waiting boats
+which were to bear them away to the safety of the great city. But it is
+itself essentially modern, and only in its brief records, carved by
+patriotic hands upon its sides, and in its figure of the granite soldier
+standing upon its summit, does its suggestiveness lie. It looks down
+upon a thriving village and out upon the lands of thrifty and prosperous
+farmers, and there is nothing in all the vision to remind one that the
+soil was ever stained by the blood of soldiers clad in uniforms of
+scarlet, or of buff and blue.
+
+And yet, as fierce a struggle as our country ever knew occurred within
+the region. Women toiled in the fields while their husbands and sons
+fought, or even gave up their lives to drive away their oppressors. Yes,
+even in the battles some of the women found places, and Captain Molly
+Pitcher was only one among many who had a share in the actual struggle
+of the Revolution. Houses were doubly barred at night against the
+attacks of prowling bands of refugees or pine robbers, and many times
+were defended by the patriotic women themselves. Spies crept in among
+them, and evil men who owned no allegiance to either side seized the
+opportunity to prey alike upon friend and foe. At times it almost seemed
+as if the words spoken many centuries ago were then fulfilled, and that
+"a man was set at variance against his father, and the daughter against
+her mother, and the daughter-in-law against her mother-in-law, and that
+a man's foes were they of his own household."
+
+But with all the suffering and bloodshed there were many heroes and
+heroines, and even the boys and girls were not without a share in the
+struggles of the times which tried men's souls. The houses in which they
+dwelt may have disappeared and given place to far more imposing
+structures; their very names may no longer be recalled; but, after all,
+they displayed many qualities which the world ought not willingly to
+permit to die, and the heritage which they have bequeathed to us will
+lose nothing of its value if we go back in our thoughts and strive to
+comprehend more clearly the price which our fathers paid for the land we
+love.
+
+In the early summer of 1778, while the feelings of the Monmouth people
+had been deeply stirred,--and indeed the patriots of the county had
+been among the foremost to pass resolutions and be enrolled among the
+defenders of the new nation,--there had not as yet come the intense
+excitement which followed the advance of General Clinton's army from
+Philadelphia. The long winter at Valley Forge had at last come to an
+end, and when the British moved out from the city,--for holding it
+longer seemed to be useless,--Washington had led his troops into the
+town almost as soon as the enemy departed. Nor was that all, for he
+quickly decided to follow after the departing general, and overtake and
+give him battle before Clinton could lead his men across the Jerseys.
+
+The American commander knew that his own forces numbered nearly as many
+as those the British general had; and as, in spite of the dreadful
+sufferings of the winter, his men were in far better condition than they
+had ever been before,--thanks to the tireless energy of Baron
+Steuben,--he resolved to depart from Philadelphia and follow after the
+British.
+
+Clinton had sent the recently enrolled tories to New York by water, and
+as there were some three thousand of these alone, he soon decided that
+his troops must go by land.
+
+Accordingly, the journey was begun, but the Continentals, going a little
+farther to the north than the line of Clinton's march, planned to gain a
+position in advance of the enemy by the rapidity of their movements, and
+then, turning about in their course, fall upon the redcoats face to face
+and offer them battle in some advantageous place.
+
+The baggage wagons of Clinton stretched out in a long line of twelve
+miles as they followed after the army, and in other ways the British
+leader was somewhat embarrassed. Consequently, when he learned of
+Washington's plan, he quickly decided to change the direction of his
+march, and, by passing through "Old Monmouth," lead his army to the
+Navesink Highlands and there have them all embark for New York.
+
+Washington had first offered the command of his advance forces to young
+Lafayette, but he was somewhat perplexed by the return of General Lee to
+his army, and knew not just what to do.
+
+Lee had been captured a little more than a year before this time,
+through his own carelessness, near Morristown, and we may be sure that
+Washington was not greatly troubled by the loss. Lee had steadily
+opposed him, and was plotting to secure his position for himself.
+However, the British general Prescott, whose capture by the Americans
+had been effected in a manner not unlike that in which Lee himself had
+been taken, had been exchanged, and Lee once more returned to the
+American army.
+
+He was still the same Lee, sensitive, jealous, and suspected of being in
+league with Howe, who recently had sailed away for England to explain to
+Parliament the causes of his failures in the preceding year.
+
+Much as he disliked to make the change, Lee's return compelled
+Washington to recognize his presence, and after some tactful efforts he
+removed Lafayette and gave Lee his position as leader of the advanced
+forces. Lee had bitterly opposed the project of following Clinton, and
+steadily objected to the march across the Jerseys.
+
+Washington, however, was firm in his determination, and the march was
+soon begun; but the lack of confidence which he felt in General Lee must
+have sadly increased the troubles of the great commander, already beset
+by perils of so many kinds. Whether he was mistaken in his estimate of
+the man, we shall learn in the course of this story.
+
+Such then was the general condition of affairs as the summer of 1778
+drew on. Those of the people of Old Monmouth who were at home heard
+occasional rumors of the advance of the two armies, but few of them had
+any thought of the stirring scenes which were to be enacted in their
+midst before the summer was ended.
+
+It was now late in June. The summer had been unusually warm, and the men
+and boys, as well as the women, who were at home had labored busily in
+the fields, in the hope of an early as well as an abundant harvest. For
+those who cared to avail themselves of them, the markets in New York
+provided a ready place for the sale of their produce, and not only the
+tories, but some of the men whose sympathies as yet had not led them
+openly to declare their preferences for either side, or who perhaps
+cared more for the prices they were likely to receive in New York for
+the results of their labors than they did for liberty or any such
+abstract quality, were not averse to loading up the boats, which many of
+the farmers near the shore owned, and sailing away for the city.
+
+Down the lower bay one such boat was swiftly making its way one
+afternoon in June, 1778. On board were four men, three of whom
+evidently were in middle life, but the fourth was a sturdy lad about
+seventeen years of age, and it was plain that he was not in full
+sympathy with his companions. He took but little part in the
+conversation, and the expression upon his face frequently betrayed the
+feelings in his heart. The three men with him apparently did not give
+him much thought or attention, and evidently were too well satisfied
+with the results of their expedition to waste any time in questioning
+the lad as to the cause of his silence.
+
+"There's the old tree now," said one of the men as they came within
+sight of the landmark. "If nothing has gone wrong, we'll soon be in the
+Navesink."
+
+"Yes, and back at work again," grumbled another. "For my part I think
+Fenton and Davenport and the rest of the pine robbers have the easiest
+time of all. They swoop down upon some whig farmer, and all they have to
+do is to take what he has worked out. I don't see why it isn't all fair
+enough in war."
+
+"If it wasn't for that skull of Fagan, with that pipe stuck in its
+mouth, nailed up on the tree over there beyond the Court House, I'd go
+in myself," said the first speaker. "The grin on it is almost more than
+I can bear."
+
+"That'll do to frighten women and children with," said the third man,
+who had been silent for a time. "Fagan got a little too bold, that was
+the trouble with him. He carried it a little too far. I happen to know
+that there are some men who know enough to put a finger in, and not get
+it burned either."
+
+"Perhaps you've done a little yourself in that line, Benzeor Osburn?"
+queried the last speaker. "I've thought sometimes you could tell some
+tales if you wanted to."
+
+"And who knows but I might?" replied Benzeor. "I may be able to keep my
+place from being confiscated and sold, the way my brother's was two
+years ago, but that may not mean either that I don't know what's to my
+own advantage when I see it. You'd do the same, wouldn't you, Jacob
+Vannote?"
+
+"That I would," replied Jacob, "and so would Barzilla Giberson here,
+too. All we want is that some good man like you, Benzeor, should tell us
+how to do it."
+
+"I can tell you," said Benzeor quietly. "I've made up my mind that I've
+held off just as long as I am going to. I'm going in, and if you have a
+mind to join, I'll let you in, too."
+
+"Tell us about it," said Jacob eagerly. "What about the boy?" he added
+in a low voice, glancing toward the fourth member of the party as he
+spoke.
+
+"What? Tom Coward? He's a coward by name as well as by nature. You
+haven't anything to fear from him. He's been in my home since he was
+five year old. He won't make any trouble."
+
+Nevertheless, the speaker lowered his voice, and for a long time the
+trio conversed eagerly upon the new topic. So intent were they that not
+one of them noted the flush upon the lad's face at the brutal reference
+to him, nor saw the look of determination which came a little later in
+its place.
+
+Apparently Tom was not giving any attention to the men with him in the
+swift sailing boat. He retained his seat near the bow, and seemed to be
+interested only in the waves before him. A brisk wind was blowing, and
+the waters betrayed the tokens of a coming storm.
+
+The boat was pitching more and more as it sped on, and Tom watched the
+rolling waves, many of them capped with white and rising steadily
+higher and higher. The darker hues gave place to a lighter green as they
+rose, and the increasing roughness seemed to reflect somewhat the
+feelings in his own heart.
+
+Far away in the distance stretched the long sandy beach of the Hook,
+becoming more and more distinct as the boat drew nearer. The gulls were
+flying low, and the weird cries of the sea-birds were heard on every
+side.
+
+Suddenly Tom stood upright, and, after gazing intently for a moment at
+some object on the shore, turned to his companions and said,--
+
+"Some one's up in the tree, and the signal's out, too."
+
+The men instantly ceased from their conversation, and peered intently at
+the tree in the distance.
+
+Evidently the sight was not altogether pleasing, for with an exclamation
+of anger Benzeor Osburn, who was holding the tiller, quickly changed the
+course of the boat, and started back in the direction from which they
+had come.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+TOM INVESTIGATES
+
+
+THERE were many exclamations of impatience heard in the boat as Benzeor
+changed her course, and the helmsman himself appeared to be the most
+impatient of all. A drizzling rain was now falling and there were many
+signs apparent that a stormy night was approaching.
+
+"I wish I knew just what the warning was for," muttered Benzeor. "Fine
+night this, to be prowling around the bay in!"
+
+"There was no mistake about the sign, though," replied Jacob. "There's
+something wrong, or we shouldn't have seen the white flag. That means
+there's something going on up the Navesink."
+
+"All the more reason for going home then!" said Benzeor. "Who was on the
+lookout to-day? Does any one know?"
+
+"Yes, 't was Peter Van Mater," said Tom, who up to this time had taken
+no part in the conversation. "He told me yesterday that he was to be in
+the tree to-day."
+
+"What! Little Peter?" demanded Benzeor quickly.
+
+"Yes," replied Tom. "I saw him out by their cornfield yesterday. He was
+there driving away the crows and blackbirds."
+
+"Little" Peter was so called to distinguish him from his father who bore
+the same name; and although his son, a well-grown young fellow of
+eighteen, towered more than a half head above "Big" Peter now, the
+distinctive names given several years before this time still clung to
+them both.
+
+The Van Mater place joined the Osburn farm, and for years Tom and Little
+Peter had been the best of friends. On those rare occasions when a brief
+break in the arduous labors on the farms had come, together they had
+gone crabbing, or had sailed down to Barnegat, where the sea-fowl
+gathered in great flocks when the proper seasons came.
+
+Tom's heart had gone out to Little Peter as it had not to any other
+person. Peter's round face shone with an expression of good nature which
+nothing but the mention of a tory or a pine robber seemed to be able to
+ruffle. A reference to either of them never failed to arouse the dormant
+anger of the lad, and with all the intensity of his quiet and strong
+nature he hated both. For the Van Maters, even to the mother and the
+girls, were patriots of the strongest kind, and now Big Peter was away
+in Washington's army and had left his eldest son and namesake to protect
+the family and manage the farm in his absence.
+
+And Little Peter had accepted the task with an outward assent that
+deceived even his own father. Only to Tom had he mentioned his true
+feelings, and expressed his determination to buy up his time, so that
+he, too, might be enrolled in the patriot army.
+
+Tom Coward well knew that the words expressed Little Peter's feelings
+and desires rather than his purpose, for he was satisfied that nothing
+would induce his friend to desert his mother and the children in their
+time of need. But he had fully sympathized with Peter in his desire to
+buy up his time, and there were special reasons why the words meant much
+more to him than they did to his friend.
+
+About a decade before this time, when one of the numerous "September
+gales" was raging along the Jersey shore, a great crowd had assembled on
+the beach watching the efforts of a schooner they could see, about a
+mile out on the ocean, to weather the storm. All day long the crowd had
+remained there, powerless to aid the stricken people on board the
+storm-tossed boat, for this was long before the time of the life-saving
+crews and their noble work along the coast.
+
+Late in the afternoon on that eventful day, when the storm had abated
+somewhat, although the waves, like moving mountains of water, still came
+thundering in upon the beach, a boat had been manned and started forth
+to the aid of the people in their peril; but before the brave band could
+gain the schooner, she had foundered and gone to the bottom.
+
+The men who had gone forth to the rescue had been about to return to the
+shore, when they thought they saw something floating over the boisterous
+waves toward them. When a second glance was obtained they started
+swiftly toward the object, and, as they drew near, saw a huge cotton
+bale with a woman and a little lad strapped upon it. At last, after some
+desperate efforts, the bodies were rescued, but that of the woman was
+lifeless and that of the lad was nearly so.
+
+The rough men had brought both ashore, and, after some labor on the part
+of the women in the assembly, the lad had been restored, but the woman
+was beyond all earthly aid. Upon some of the clothing of the rescued boy
+the name Coward had been found, and "Tom" was improvised, for that would
+do as well as any other for the name of a stranger lad whose home and
+parents were to be, as the people of Old Monmouth thought, forever
+wrapped in mystery.
+
+Tom Coward had been the sole survivor of the wreck. For days some
+portions of the ill-fated schooner and its cargo were washed ashore, but
+no clue was ever found as to her name or destination.
+
+What to do with the rescued lad then became the perplexing problem among
+the simple folk of Monmouth, and it was at last solved by "binding him
+out" to Benzeor Osburn, which simply meant that Tom was to live with the
+man who had taken him until he was twenty-one years of age, and in
+return for the home he received he was to give his labor and life until
+that eventful day should arrive when he, too, would become a man.
+
+The lad had gone, for he had no voice in the matter, and all the home he
+had ever known had been with Benzeor and his family. Only a faint
+recollection of the wreck remained in his mind, but he had heard the
+story many times and thought much over it in secret. Often had he
+visited the unmarked grave in the churchyard, where he was informed that
+all that was mortal of his mother lay resting. But her name and face
+were both alike unknown to him. In his dreams, or when he had been
+working alone in some of the distant fields, it would almost seem to him
+that something of another existence would rise before him, or that he
+could almost see the face of a gracious woman bending low over him whom
+he could call "mother."
+
+Who he might be he could not determine. Who he was, was a matter much
+more easily settled, for all knew him as the "bound boy" of Benzeor
+Osburn; and while some of the country people might occasionally think of
+him as the little lad, who years before had been rescued from a sinking
+schooner, they seldom referred to it, and the past had been crowded out
+by the present. But Tom Coward had not entirely forgotten.
+
+Benzeor had received him into his home the more readily because, as he
+expressed it, "all of his boys had been born girls," and he felt the
+need of the aid and presence of a boy about the place. And Benzeor in
+his way had not been unkind to the stranger lad, or at least not
+intentionally so, but the labor on the farms in those days had been
+severe, and he was a man to whom money had been the one thing needful.
+He did not spare himself, and certainly he had no thought of sparing
+those who were dependent upon him; and, as a natural consequence,
+neither the girls nor Tom, and much less the overworked, spiritless
+little mother of the family, found much to relieve the monotonous round
+of labor on the farm.
+
+At first, Tom had not complained and had accepted all as a matter of
+course, but of late his heart had rebelled against his lot more and
+more. It was not that he did not appreciate the rough kindness which was
+extended to him, especially by the patient, uncomplaining mother and the
+two girls, Sarah and Mercy, who were nearest his own age. But certain
+undefined longings kept rising in his soul, he knew not how, and the
+increasing eagerness of Benzeor "to make his place pay" had apparently
+driven all else from the mind of his foster father.
+
+Perhaps more than any of these things, his interviews with his friend
+Little Peter had stirred his soul, for Peter had longings, too, and, as
+has been said, had even declared his intention "to buy up his own time."
+That he was a son in his own home, and was surrounded by the love of
+father and mother, had not made the purpose in Peter's heart appear in
+the least strange or unusual, for the custom was not unknown among those
+sturdy forefathers of ours. When they had cared for a boy in his infancy
+and helpless years, it was considered as no more than a just return that
+the years of early manhood, which would naturally be of value to the
+fathers in their labors on the farms, should belong not to the son but
+to the father. So whenever a well-grown boy felt that he would like to
+start in for himself, it was not unusual for him to offer, or to promise
+to pay as soon as he could earn the money, the amount which was
+considered as a fair equivalent for the value of his services in the few
+years before he became "of age," and could enter upon his own career.
+
+In those days the obligation of the child to his father was emphasized.
+In our own time the obligation of the father to his child is considered
+the more important, and all that love and devotion can offer are laid at
+the feet of the children.
+
+Perhaps justice lies somewhere between these two extremes, and no one of
+us desires to return to the harsher methods of those earlier years; but
+certainly the children who are so fortunate as to be born in these more
+fortunate times have some need of recalling the words of one who, long
+before the trying days of the Revolution, exhorted all to "honor their
+fathers and mothers."
+
+Be that as it may, Tom Coward thought much and long over his friend
+Peter's project, and even went so far at one time as to hint to Benzeor
+that he would not be averse to entering into some such arrangement with
+him. But Benzeor's indignation, and the grief with which Sarah heard of
+the proposal, had silenced him, and he had not referred to the matter
+again.
+
+None the less, however, did it remain in his thoughts, and of late the
+suspicion with which he had come to regard many of Benzeor's actions had
+increased his feeling of discontent, for Tom's sympathies were all with
+the colonies in their struggle.
+
+Many a time had he and Peter talked over the matter, and the eagerness
+of one to serve in the army was fully shared by the other. But Benzeor's
+patriotism seemed all to be dormant, and as the troubles increased, his
+zeal to make money steadily increased also. At times he would be absent
+from home for days together, and more than once Tom had been awakened
+in the night by the sound of strange voices heard in conversation with
+Benzeor in the room beneath that in which he was sleeping.
+
+Thoughts of all these things had been in Tom's mind throughout that
+voyage to New York, and they, as well as his youthfulness, served to
+explain the silence he had maintained since he had set sail. He had
+known, however, that Peter was to serve as the lookout that day, and
+when he volunteered the information it was the first time he had spoken
+aloud for a half hour.
+
+The rain now was steadily increasing, and the uneasiness of the men on
+board the little boat became more marked. They were far from the tree by
+this time, and no one appeared to know just what plan to follow.
+
+"If I was alone, I'd take all the risks," said Benzeor at last.
+
+"You needn't stop on our account," replied Jacob. "I don't believe
+there's much danger in starting up the river, any way, for my part.
+Little Peter may not have seen anything to amount to much. If you want
+to chance it, go ahead."
+
+"We don't just know what's ahead of us," said Barzilla uneasily. "It
+may be nothing, and then again it may not be. I wish there was some way
+of finding out before we risk too much."
+
+"Why not land farther down the shore and let Tom go up and see?" said
+Jacob. "If Little Peter's gone, it will mean the danger's gone, too, and
+if he hasn't, why Tom here can find out for us and report; though for my
+part I'm not afraid to go up the river as it is. It's too dark for any
+one to see us, or it will be soon."
+
+"That's a good suggestion," said Benzeor quickly, as he brought the boat
+about. "We'll land down the shore and let Tom go up for us. You're not
+too much of a 'coward' to do that, are you Tom?"
+
+"I'll go," said Tom quietly, although his cheeks flushed with anger at
+Benzeor's antiquated and brutal pun. He had heard it many times, but
+never without feeling angry, although he well knew that Benzeor spoke
+the words lightly.
+
+With the change in the course the wind seemed to increase. The spray was
+dashed into their faces, and the men were soon drenched. The sail had
+been shortened, but the little boat dashed ahead with ever increasing
+speed.
+
+"It's a rough night outside," said Benzeor, when at last he gained the
+desired point on the shore. "It's lucky for us we're inside the Hook.
+Now then, Tom!" he added. "Bestir yourself, lad, and come back soon."
+
+Tom leaped ashore and ran swiftly along the beach toward the tree. He
+was familiar with its location and knew that he could find it in the
+darkest night. The rain beat upon him and the darkness momentarily
+increased, but the wind was with him, and in a brief time he recognized
+the dim outlines of the tree.
+
+Then ceasing to run, he began to approach more cautiously. He was not
+positive that Peter was there now, for some one might have taken his
+place. Certainly caution was the better part in any event.
+
+He stopped and whistled the half dozen notes which he and Peter used as
+a call. He waited a moment, but as no answer was heard he advanced a
+little nearer and whistled again.
+
+"That you, Tom?" came from some one in the tree.
+
+"Yes," replied Tom.
+
+In a moment Peter dropped from his position, and began to explain to his
+friend the cause of the display of the signal of danger.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+THE MEETING ON THE RIVER
+
+
+"I'VE been here since noon," began Peter, "but it seems more like a
+whole day to me. I've listened to the calls of the sea-birds and heard
+the roar of the storm which I knew was coming, till it almost seemed to
+me I couldn't bear it any longer. I'm glad you've come, for I've got a
+chance to stretch now, and the sound of a voice will help to quiet my
+nerves again."
+
+"I didn't know you had any nerves," replied Tom. "But we can't stand
+here in this storm talking about such things. Benzeor sent me over to
+find out what you meant by hanging out the white flag. You haven't seen
+anything suspicious, have you?"
+
+"I have that," said Peter eagerly. "I was beginning to think that my
+coming here was all a piece of foolishness, when along about four
+o'clock--leastwise I should think it was about that time, though I
+didn't have any dial anywhere about to mark the time for me--what
+should I see but a whaleboat making for the river? You had better
+believe I forgot all about the time and everything else but the boat
+then, for I didn't know but some more of the Greens were coming up the
+Navesink on another trip such as they made the other day."
+
+Peter referred to an expedition which a band of several hundred tories
+from New Jersey, commonly known as the "Greens," had made a few weeks
+before this time. They had set forth from New York and had made a visit
+to some of their former neighbors and friends, and the tokens of their
+affection which they had left behind them had chiefly consisted of the
+ashes of burned homes and empty barns. The raid had been a cruel one,
+and its object apparently was more for devastation than for plunder, and
+many of the good people of Red Bank and Middletown and the adjoining
+towns had good cause to remember it so long as they lived. The numbers
+of the invaders had rendered them safe from all attacks, and the wanton
+destruction they wrought before they returned to New York had been the
+chief reason for keeping a watch stationed in the old tree every day
+since their visit. And Peter had received strict orders not to depart
+from his place of observation, if he saw anything suspicious, until he
+was satisfied that all danger was past. And Peter was faithful, that was
+well known, or he would not have been selected for the duty that day.
+
+"Well," resumed Peter, "I watched the boat till it went out of sight up
+the river. There were seven men on board of her, six of 'em pulling at
+the oars and the seventh steering. No more boats followed her, and I
+shouldn't have been suspicious if I hadn't thought I recognized the man
+who was steering."
+
+"Who was he?"
+
+"He looked to me a good deal like Fenton."
+
+"What? The pine robber?"
+
+"Yes, though of course I may have been mistaken. I never saw him but
+once and that was when he was a blacksmith over by the Court House
+before the war. My father had sent me over there to have one of the
+horses shod at his shop. I don't know that I should have remembered him
+if it hadn't been for something he did that day. I saw him take a
+half-inch bar of iron and bend it almost double with his hands. That
+made a great impression upon me, for I didn't believe there was another
+man in the colony who could do that."
+
+"Probably not," replied Tom. "But what made you think this was one of
+Fenton's whaleboats?"
+
+"Nothing but Fenton himself. Of course I've heard of the stories of what
+he's been doing since he became a pine robber. His gang is one of the
+worst, you know, and the minute I set my two eyes on him I suspected it
+was Fenton himself."
+
+"Why didn't you get word up the river as soon as you saw him?"
+
+"They've got watchers farther up, and that's their business. Besides, I
+didn't care to have him double me up the way he did that iron bar. Then,
+my business was to stay here and give the warning to anybody that might
+be going up the stream, you see. That's why I waved the flag when I saw
+you coming."
+
+"And they haven't come back yet?" inquired Tom eagerly.
+
+"No. That's what I'm waiting for. There isn't any fun in hanging out
+here in the wet, I can tell you. Just as soon as I can see that
+whaleboat coming out into the bay again I'm done."
+
+"All right, Peter, I'll go right back and report to Benzeor. Maybe he'll
+take you on board and carry you home."
+
+"Not unless I see the whaleboat again," said Peter doggedly as he
+prepared to climb to his seat in the tree again.
+
+Tom hurriedly departed and started to return with his message to the
+waiting Benzeor and his men, who he knew would be becoming impatient by
+this time. As he ran along the beach the storm smote him full in the
+face, but in spite of the driving rain the night was not very dark. The
+moon was near the full and gave sufficient light to enable him to see
+far out over the tossing waters. He could even discern the outlines of
+the little boat far up the shore, and as he ran swiftly forward he was
+thinking of the report he was to make to the waiting Benzeor, and his
+thoughts were not entirely pleasing.
+
+Fenton's deeds had become notorious in Old Monmouth. At the head of his
+brutal band, composed of men as desperate and reckless as he, he had
+pillaged and plundered throughout the county during the preceding year,
+and up to this time no one had been found strong enough to put a stop to
+his evil deeds. Any unprotected farmhouse was liable to receive one of
+his visits, and such a visit was seldom made without profit to the
+outlaws, for such in fact they were, and with their ill-gotten gains
+they hastened away to store them in their hiding-places among the pines.
+
+Nor was Fenton's band the only one which had its headquarters in that
+lonely and unfrequented region known in Old Monmouth as the "Pines."
+West, Disbrow, Fagan, Davenport, and many others of the lawless men, had
+engaged in similar occupations, and all had their hiding-places in the
+same wild spot, and in a measure protected and aided one another.
+
+Up to this time Fagan had been the only one to suffer the well-deserved
+penalty of his crimes, and in the preceding winter a band of two hundred
+of the desperate patriots had assembled and driven the famous, or rather
+infamous, outlaw to bay. At last he had been taken, and the infuriated
+men, mindful not only of the sufferings of their own families at his
+hands, but also of their possible future sufferings as well, had
+measured out a stern justice to the man, and with their own hands had
+hanged him from the long limb of a tree which stood by the side of the
+road which led from Monmouth Court House[1] to Trenton. Afterwards some
+of the patriots who had suffered most from his evil deeds had severed
+the skull from the body and nailed it to the tree, and then, placing the
+pipe between the grinning jaws, had left the uncanny sight as a warning
+to all who might be disposed to follow in the footsteps of the outlaw.
+
+For a few weeks the suffering patriots found relief, but only for a few
+weeks.
+
+Despite the terrible warning, the other bands of pine robbers soon
+renewed their labors, and now in the early summer of '78 the region was
+suffering more from the marauding bands than ever had been known before.
+
+It was all a part of the horrors of war. Sometimes, when we read of the
+brave deeds which have made famous some of the men who had a share in
+the struggle, we are prone to think only of the heroism displayed. And
+there was many a true hero in that and in every other war which our
+country has waged. We are never to forget that; but there was another
+side which has, to a large extent, passed from the memory of the present
+generation. The loss of property and of life, the sufferings of the
+women and children in the lonely homes, the barbarity and cruelty of
+evil men who, freed from the restraint of law in a time when the worst
+passions of men were aroused, gave free rein to their avarice and all
+that was bad in them, have frequently been ignored or forgotten. The
+glory of war or the pride in true heroism cannot entirely atone for the
+sufferings that were only too common in the scattered homes or lonely
+places.
+
+And Fenton's band was one of the worst. From their strongholds among the
+pines, into which few men had the hardihood to enter, they would set
+forth on horseback some dark night, and the tale they might have told
+upon their return was ever one of blood and sorrow. People tortured
+until in their agony they were compelled to yield up their scanty
+savings, raids upon the flocks and herds already becoming far too small
+for the necessities of their owners, burning houses, and men and women
+deliberately shot by the outlaws, were only a few among the many results
+of their raids.
+
+Not the least of the evils was the knowledge that among the people of
+Monmouth there were some who, while they might not openly be known as
+members of the bands, still gave the desired information to the leaders
+as to the places where possessions were secreted, or of the times when
+the patriots were aroused and it was best for the "Barons of the Pines,"
+as some termed them, to remain in hiding among the tall dark trees.
+Professedly, the outlaws acknowledged no allegiance to either side in
+the struggle, but somehow it had come to pass that a stanch whig was
+liable to suffer far more from their depredations than his tory
+neighbor, and as a natural consequence the feeling between neighbors and
+those who had been friends was becoming more and more strained and
+bitter.
+
+Thoughts of these things were passing rapidly through Tom's mind as he
+ran swiftly on through the storm to rejoin his companions. Fenton? Yes,
+he had heard of him too many times not to recognize his name and to feel
+well assured that a visit from him in such a night could promise little
+good for any of the patriots dwelling near the Navesink.
+
+"Well, what is it, Tom?" said Benzeor, as the panting lad rejoined them.
+"Is it Little Peter on the lookout? He must have seen a ghost to have
+warned us to stay out here in the bay in such a night as this. I'm wet
+to the skin."
+
+"It's Fenton," replied Tom huskily, for he had not yet recovered his
+breath. "Peter said he saw him and six of his men go up the Navesink
+about four o'clock."
+
+"Fenton?" said Jacob quickly. "Then we're in for a night of it. We don't
+want to fall into the hands of that pine robber when our pockets are as
+well lined as they are to-night."
+
+"I'm not so sure about that," replied Benzeor slowly. "There's ten
+chances to one that they won't come back before morning, and if they do
+they won't be likely to find us in such a storm as this."
+
+As he spoke a fresh gust swept the rain directly into their faces. The
+storm certainly was increasing, and the prospect of spending a night in
+the bay was dreary enough to cause the most stout-hearted to hesitate.
+And it may have been that other thoughts than that of the storm
+influenced Benzeor.
+
+At any rate he gruffly responded, "You can do as you please, but I'm
+going up the Navesink. If you're afraid, you can stay here or start out
+across the country on foot. You'll have to speak quick if you go with
+me, for I'm off."
+
+Benzeor turned and grasped the bow of his boat to push her off the
+beach upon which she had grounded. Before he had succeeded, however,
+Jacob spoke up quickly and said, "We're with you, Benzeor. If you can
+stand it, we can."
+
+"Get aboard then, every one of you!" said Benzeor gruffly.
+
+Tom and Barzilla quickly took their places in the stern, while Benzeor,
+with the aid of Jacob, soon sent the boat out from the shore.
+
+The sail was soon rigged and shortened, and the little party then
+started for the narrow mouth of the Navesink. The boat rolled and
+pitched in the storm, but Benzeor had her well in hand, and soon steered
+into the more quiet waters of the river. Tom could see the tree as they
+passed, and was positive that Peter could also see them, but no hail was
+given, and the point was soon left far behind them.
+
+Then up the narrower waters of the river the boat sped on in her course,
+but not a word was spoken by any of those on board. The storm was still
+raging and Benzeor's attention was largely occupied in managing his
+craft, and the others were busied with thoughts which perhaps they did
+not care to express.
+
+Tom was decidedly anxious. A meeting with Fenton and his band was
+something of which he was fearful, and as they sped on his fears
+increased each moment. Benzeor's apparent indifference had not deceived
+him, and deep in his heart there was a lurking suspicion that perhaps he
+might be able to account for it, if he felt so disposed.
+
+However, he too was silent, and a half hour had passed and as yet no
+signs of danger had appeared. Benzeor was steering as close inshore as
+the wind permitted, and Tom was beginning to hope that they would
+succeed in making their way up the river without being discovered.
+
+Suddenly Jacob, who was seated in the bow and was keeping a constant
+lookout ahead, shouted, "Port! Port your helm, Benzeor! Quick! Quick!"
+
+Benzeor instantly heeded the warning, but his quick movement barely
+served to enable them to pass a boat which loomed up in the darkness. It
+was a whaleboat, and with a sinking heart Tom saw that there were six
+men rowing, while a seventh was seated in the stern and was serving as
+helmsman.
+
+Instantly Peter's words flashed into his mind, and he knew that they had
+barely escaped a collision with the very boat which the lookout had
+discovered making its way up the Navesink late in the afternoon. The
+party could be none other than that of Fenton and his outlaw band.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[1] Freehold.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+BENZEOR'S VISITOR
+
+
+"HOLD on there! Hold on, I say! Stop, or we'll shoot!"
+
+The words were shouted by some one in the whaleboat, and Benzeor
+evidently was about to heed the sharp command. He quickly changed the
+course of the boat, and as the shortened sail flapped in the wind as the
+little craft came about, the whaleboat came alongside and some one
+reached forth with a boat-hook, and the progress was instantly stayed.
+
+Tom's heart was beating rapidly in his excitement. A wild impulse to
+leap into the river seized him, but before he could leave his position
+in the bow, two of the other crew clambered on board, and he knew that
+an attempt to escape would now be useless. Doubtless the men were armed,
+and the darkness was not deep enough to conceal him from their sight.
+His only hope now depended upon the actions of the men and the course
+which Benzeor should decide to follow.
+
+The sail was instantly lowered in obedience to the sharp command of the
+men who had boarded the boat, and, in great fear, the lad waited for the
+purpose of their captors to be declared. He drew back in his position in
+the bow, hoping to escape the notice of all on board, as he saw that
+Benzeor had arisen from his seat and stood facing the men.
+
+"Who are you? What ye out in a night like this for? Whose boat is this?"
+exclaimed the one who appeared to be the leader.
+
+"Is that you, Fenton?" replied Benzeor in a low voice.
+
+"Ho, it's Benzeor Osburn!" exclaimed the man, peering intently into the
+face before him as he spoke. "I thought it was strange we didn't find
+you in your house. We waited an hour as we agreed to, but when you
+didn't put in an appearance, we thought we'd start back. Where ye been,
+Benzeor? What's up now?"
+
+"I'd been back home in time if it hadn't been for the storm and an alarm
+we had back in the bay. I think ye'd better go back with me now, Fenton.
+I've got some facts that may interest you, and we can't talk them over
+here."
+
+"Who are these men with you?" inquired Fenton suspiciously.
+
+"Oh, they're all right. I'll vouch for them, every one," replied
+Benzeor. "You haven't anything to fear from any of my friends. Come up
+to my house and I'll tell ye all about it."
+
+Fenton hesitated a moment before he replied, and Tom peered intently at
+the man of whom he had already heard so many tales. He could see his
+great form, although he could not distinguish the features of his face
+in the darkness. His deep voice and gruff manner had not tended to allay
+the lad's fears, and now Benzeor's words and actions filled his heart
+with a new alarm. Was Benzeor about to cast in his lot with Fenton? His
+words betrayed the fact of their previous acquaintance, and all the
+recent suspicious actions of his foster father came back to him. No one
+in the party had yet spoken, except Benzeor and Fenton, but the recent
+conversation on board the boat, much of which Tom had overheard,
+convinced the troubled lad that no very strong protest would be made
+against any proposal that Benzeor might feel disposed to make.
+
+"I'm rather of the opinion," said Fenton roughly, "that it's about time
+you went home with me. I don't know who these fellows on board here are,
+and I don't care. You're the one I'm after, Benzeor, and it seems to me
+the time's come for you to join us or quit. You've been shilly-shallying
+long enough."
+
+"Hush! Don't speak so loud!" replied Benzeor anxiously.
+
+Fenton laughed outright at Benzeor's evident alarm, and, turning to his
+companions in the whaleboat, said, "I think we'd better take the boat
+along with us. We can land this crew anywhere along the shore, or we can
+sink 'em in the river, just which you please. It's too much of a storm
+for us to be hanging around here on the Navesink."
+
+"Fenton," said Benzeor, rising and stepping up to the side of the
+outlaw, "you'd better do as I say. I've got something to tell ye, and
+it's worth hearing, too."
+
+A low conversation followed between the two men which Tom, with all his
+efforts, was not able to hear. The result of it, however, quickly became
+apparent when Fenton turned to his companions and said, "It's all right,
+boys. You go on without me, and I'll join you to-morrow. I'm going up
+to Benzeor's now."
+
+The boat-hook was quickly withdrawn at his command, and the sound of the
+oars of the departing boat soon ceased to be heard.
+
+The sail of Benzeor's boat was then hoisted again, and once more the
+little party, increased now by the addition of Fenton, began to make
+their way up the Navesink. Though the rain was steadily falling, the
+wind was favoring, and the boat, handled by the skillful Benzeor, held
+steadily to its way. The low shores could be seen in the distance on
+either side, and an occasional light betrayed the location of some
+lonely farmhouse, whose occupants in the confidence begotten of the
+storm had ventured to sit up till a later hour than was customary in
+those days.
+
+Not a word was spoken on board the boat, and Fenton had taken a position
+near Tom from which he did not move. All were drenched, but a summer
+rain was something which none of them minded in such a time as that.
+
+When an hour had passed, Benzeor ran his boat closer inshore and in a
+few moments landed. Then turning to his companions he said, "Come over
+to my house to-morrow, Jacob, and I'll give you and Barzilla your
+shares of the money."
+
+"We'll go with you now," replied Jacob, evidently not desiring to put
+off the day of reckoning too long, a desire in which Barzilla also
+shared.
+
+"No, I can't fix it up to-night. You can take the bag, though, if you
+want to, and bring me my share to-morrow."
+
+Benzeor's confidence in his fellows served the desired purpose, and
+Jacob and Barzilla speedily departed, taking with them the little bag of
+gold which had been received as the price of the produce they had taken
+to New York.
+
+"Tom, you look out for the boat," called Benzeor, as he and Fenton
+started towards the little house whose outlines could be discerned in
+the distance.
+
+Tom obeyed, and as he worked over the little boat, looking well to all
+the details, his thoughts were far more busy than his hands. The changes
+which he had noted in Benzeor of late seemed almost to have reached
+their climax. Was the man intending now to go with Fenton? All his
+recent absences from home came up before the lad's mind, and the strange
+visitors he had received there of late were not forgotten. What was it
+Benzeor was planning to do? He was not much like the man he had been a
+few years before this time, and as Tom thought over all the changes, he
+was troubled more and more.
+
+He knew that Sarah had not been unaware of what was going on, for many a
+time had they talked it all over together. Sarah had remained a
+steadfast champion of her father, but Tom had not failed to see that she
+was none the less troubled by his strange actions. His grasping
+disposition had become more and more apparent of late, and while he had
+never in the presence of his family referred to anything he had in his
+mind to do against the patriots, his very silence in such times was more
+threatening than any words he could utter. But Sarah had steadily
+refused to believe that her father would desert the cause for which at
+the outbreak of the war he had professed the most ardent attachment;
+still, it was impossible for her not to discover, what Tom for a long
+time had seen, that he was strangely silent of late.
+
+The change in Benzeor Osburn had been so gradual as to deceive many of
+his friends and neighbors. All had known his "closeness," as the country
+people termed his love of money, but few of them had thought it would
+ever lead him into the position in which the man at that time really
+stood.
+
+Benzeor in '76 had been among the loudest in his expressions of loyalty
+to the cause of the colonies, and had been foremost in blaming his own
+brother for his "toryism." His brother's property had been confiscated,
+but Benzeor's had been left unmolested, so confident had all the whigs
+been in the sincerity of his expressions. And at the time Benzeor had
+meant what he said, and said what he meant. But never for a moment had
+he dreamed that the struggle would be such a long-continued one as it
+had proved to be, nor had he thought that patriotism would affect his
+own possessions. All that would be done would be to make a strong
+protest against the unjust taxation, for Benzeor had hated taxes as he
+did few things in this world, and then a compromise would be effected,
+which would permit the colonists to go on with their occupations, and
+the mother country would soon see that it was not to her own advantage
+to drive her rebellious children too far.
+
+The first shock had come to him when the Continental Congress had
+declared the country to be a free and independent nation. That was
+going too far, Benzeor thought, and so he freely expressed himself; but
+still hoping that a compromise of some kind would be made, and that his
+own possessions would not be disturbed, he had uttered no further
+protests, though his voice ceased to be heard in favor of the rebellion.
+
+As further events betrayed the weakness of the patriot cause, and he had
+found that patriotism was likely to prove a somewhat expensive virtue,
+his feelings had undergone a still more decided change. At first he had
+entered into one or two secret projects by which he had succeeded in
+enriching his own pockets, and the success had so affected him that as
+his patriotism decreased his hopes of gains correspondingly increased;
+and soon from deeds for which he tried to justify himself, he had been
+gradually drawn into others which even his own seared conscience
+proclaimed to be wrong. In some of the latter he had come into contact
+with the outlaws of Fenton's class, and his association with them had
+soon banished the feeling of disgust he had formerly cherished for them,
+until it had even come to pass that Fenton himself was a not unwelcome
+guest in his own home.
+
+At first the visits had been made secretly, and the promises of rich
+harvests to be reaped, as the result of their evil deeds, had appealed
+to Benzeor more strongly than even he himself was aware. The lawless
+times, the constant turmoils, the bitterness between those who had
+recently been the warmest of friends, the ease with which raids were
+made, and the apparent impossibility of detection, had all combined to
+arouse the avaricious Benzeor more and more; and now not very much was
+needed to draw him still farther within the toils of Fenton and his
+band.
+
+Not all of these things were apparent to Tom when at last he left the
+boat and started towards the house, but he had seen sufficient to make
+him suspicious of Benzeor, and he was as perplexed as he was troubled.
+All his own feelings had gone out more and more to the patriot cause,
+and more than once had he been sadly tempted to depart from his home
+without waiting for the formality of buying up his time, and he had even
+gone so far as to suggest to Sarah several times what he had it in his
+mind to do. Sarah's grief, however, and the confidence which she still
+professed to feel in her father, as well as the dislike in his own heart
+to do anything which bore any resemblance to stealing,--for so the
+troubled lad regarded the taking of time which did not really belong to
+him as the bound boy of Benzeor Osburn,--had hitherto held him back. How
+long such feelings would continue to sway him Tom could not decide when
+at last he lifted the latch and entered the kitchen.
+
+Benzeor and his guest were seated before the fire which had been started
+in the wide and open fireplace, and were drying their wet clothing as
+they conversed eagerly together.
+
+As Tom came in, Benzeor glanced up hastily and said, "You can go to bed,
+Tom. You must be wet and tired, and there is a lot of work to be done
+to-morrow." Benzeor's voice was not unkind, but Tom did not fail to see
+that his presence was not desired. He quickly lighted a candle with a
+splinter which he thrust into the fire and held until it was in a flame,
+and then went up the low stairway to his room directly over the kitchen
+in which the men were seated.
+
+As he entered the room he noted the gleam which came through the open
+space near the rude chimney, and, placing the candle on the low table,
+he advanced and peered down at the men. He could see both plainly, and,
+after observing them for a moment, he was about to turn away and take
+off his dripping clothing, when he suddenly stopped. He had overheard a
+word which caused his heart to beat much more rapidly, and in a moment
+he was upon his knees striving to hear what more would be said.
+
+He remained in the same position for an hour, and at last arose only
+when Fenton opened the door and went out into the darkness. Then Benzeor
+closed and barred the door, and started directly up the stairway.
+
+Instantly Tom blew out his candle and leaped into bed, all wet and muddy
+as he was, and drew the bedclothes close up around his face.
+
+Benzeor came slowly on and then stopped before the door of Tom's room.
+The lad was trembling in his excitement, for he well knew that if the
+man should enter and discover that he had not removed his clothing
+before going to bed, his suspicions would at once be aroused. And above
+all things Benzeor's suspicion at that time was what Tom most desired to
+lull.
+
+There were wild thoughts in Tom's mind of leaping from the bed and,
+rushing past the man, making a break for the outside. Perhaps the man
+might not enter, however, and, trembling with fear and excitement, Tom
+waited.
+
+It seemed to him that a long time had elapsed, and still no sound
+outside the door could be heard. Had Benzeor gone on? The light of his
+candle which still shone through the cracks disproved that. What could
+he then be doing?
+
+Tom tried to conjecture what must be going on on the stairway, but the
+silence was still unbroken. The minutes were like hours to the
+frightened lad. It seemed to him as if the beatings of his heart must be
+heard throughout the house.
+
+His suspense was soon ended--when Benzeor lifted the latch and Tom felt
+the light of the candle streaming in full upon his face.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+THE MESSENGER
+
+
+FOR a moment Tom closed his eyes and waited for the words which he
+expected and feared to hear. His body was trembling and all his strength
+was required to prevent his teeth from chattering. If Benzeor should
+enter the room Tom knew that at once his predicament would be
+discovered, and in the present state of his foster father's feelings he
+was aware that he could expect no mercy at his hands.
+
+He heard no footstep, but he felt that the light of the candle was still
+shining upon his face and knew that Benzeor had not departed. At last,
+unable to bear the suspense longer, he opened his eyes, for he felt that
+he must see what was going on in the room. There stood Benzeor in the
+doorway holding the candle with one hand, and intently regarding the
+apparently sleeping boy before him.
+
+"I'll be down directly," said Tom drowsily, as if he were just awaking.
+"I didn't know it was time to get up. I'll be with you in a minute."
+
+"It isn't time to get up," replied Benzeor slowly. "I'm just going to
+bed. I stopped to see if you were all right. Have you been asleep long?"
+
+"I--I don't know. Is there anything wrong?" Tom still kept the
+bedclothes drawn tightly about his face, and although he was feigning
+that he had been sleeping, he was in a state of terror. If Benzeor
+should approach the bed he well knew what would follow.
+
+"No, there's nothing wrong," replied Benzeor. "I just wanted to see if
+you were all right. It's been a hard trip, and there's much work to be
+done to-morrow."
+
+Tom closed his eyes and did not continue the conversation, hoping that
+the man would feel satisfied and leave him to himself. Nor was he
+disappointed, for Benzeor soon withdrew and closed the door behind him.
+
+Tom could hear him as he stumbled about in the adjoining room, preparing
+for bed. Frightened as the lad had been, he had not failed to notice the
+expression upon Benzeor's face. It seemed to him that fear and
+recklessness were combined there, and that in the recent decision which
+the man had made, he had bidden farewell to everything good in his
+nature.
+
+Benzeor had not been without his good qualities. Even then, in spite of
+his alarm, Tom recalled his rough kindnesses, and thought how much
+better in many ways his foster father had treated him than had some of
+the true fathers treated their own sons, for the times were rough and
+the one thing which was demanded of all the growing boys was implicit
+obedience to their elders. And this obedience had been ofttimes
+compelled by no gentle means. The use of the strap upon boys who were as
+large as their fathers was not unknown, and no one ever thought of
+resenting the harsh treatment. But Benzeor had seldom struck him. Tom
+almost wished that he had, for it would make the carrying out of the
+project he had already formed much easier.
+
+Then, too, all the kindness he had received at the hands of Benzeor's
+wife and of the girls came back to him. It was true that this had been
+largely of a negative character, but in times like these through which
+the troubled lad was then passing, even that was not forgotten. He had
+toiled early and late, and knew that he had given more than a full
+equivalent for the scanty food and rough clothing he had received. But
+after all, Benzeor's home had been all the home he had ever known, and
+he was not unmindful of the benefits he had received.
+
+His soul now, however, was in a state of turmoil. The words he had
+overheard had proved conclusively that Benzeor was a changed man, and as
+Tom thought of the project which Fenton had presented, and into which
+his foster father had entered with apparent eagerness, his own
+indignation increased. The long waiting was past now, and the time for
+action, the time of which he had dreamed and thought so much of late,
+had come at last.
+
+He removed the bed-clothing and sat up on the side of the bed, listening
+intently. Benzeor had ceased to move about in his room, and the sounds
+which now came indicated clearly that he was asleep. Against the little
+window the rain was still beating, and the darkness was so intense in
+the room that Tom could not distinguish any object.
+
+For several minutes he continued in his position, undecided whether he
+had better make the attempt to depart from the house by the way of the
+stairs, or through the window in his room. If he should select the
+former, the stairs would be sure to creak under his feet; and then, too,
+there would be the bars which must be drawn from the door. There were
+too many possibilities of detection to make that method of departure the
+desirable one.
+
+If he should go through the window, all he would have to do would be to
+drop upon the woodpile directly beneath,--a pile which Tom knew was
+there, for he himself had drawn and cut the wood only a few days before
+this time. He decided to use the window.
+
+Stepping slowly and carefully, he approached and quietly raised the
+sash. As he looked out into the night, the farm buildings could be seen,
+and yonder was the road he was to seek.
+
+Hesitating no longer, the resolute boy crawled through the open window,
+and then, clinging for a moment to the sash with his hands, dropped upon
+the woodpile below. There was a noise as the wood rolled from under him,
+but, quickly rising, he ran to the long lane which led out to the road,
+and then stopped to learn whether his departure had been discovered or
+not.
+
+The silence was unbroken. The outlines of the rude little house stood
+out in the darkness, the rain was falling steadily, and the heavy clouds
+hung low over the earth. Not even the dog had been disturbed, and with a
+lighter heart Tom turned and ran down the lane and was soon in the road.
+
+The mud was now thick and heavy, and he found his progress difficult.
+But as he had not far to go, he ran steadily on, and soon came within
+sight of Little Peter's house. There was no light to be seen within it,
+and he was not at all certain that his friend had returned.
+
+He approached and stood beneath the window of the boy's room, which,
+like his own, was over the kitchen. Then he gave the low whistle which
+they both had used as a "call." At first there was no response, and when
+he had given it two or three times he concluded that his friend had not
+returned from his work as the lookout in the tree by the mouth of the
+Navesink. Nothing then remained to be done but to rouse the family, for
+Tom was determined, and was well aware that what he planned to do must
+be done quickly.
+
+Approaching the kitchen door he rapped loudly upon it. Twice had he
+repeated the summons before a window was raised, and some one looking
+out upon him called, "Who's there? Is that you, Peter?"
+
+"No, it's not Peter. It's Tom Coward, and I want to get in. I've got
+something to tell you."
+
+"I'll be down in a moment," said Peter's mother, for Tom had recognized
+the voice as her's.
+
+Tom soon heard the heavy bars withdrawn, and in a brief time the door
+was opened, and then closed and carefully barred behind him.
+
+"What's wrong, Tom?" inquired the woman anxiously. "Has anything
+happened to Peter?"
+
+"I don't think so," replied Tom. "He was all right when I left him a few
+hours ago down by the Hook. But what I want to know now is whether
+you've had any word from his father?"
+
+"Not a word, except that it's reported the army's on the march again.
+Why do you ask?"
+
+"I don't know that I ought to tell you," replied Tom hesitatingly, "but
+the truth of the matter is that I happened to hear that he was coming
+home."
+
+"You've heard something more than that, Tom Coward," said the woman now
+thoroughly alarmed. "I know you've heard more, or you wouldn't have come
+over here at this time of night and in such a storm. What is it? What is
+it?"
+
+Tom perceived that he had gone too far to retreat now, and so he began
+his story. He did not go into all the details, for as yet he did not
+desire to implicate Benzeor, at least in the eyes of all his neighbors.
+
+"The way of it is this," began Tom hesitatingly. "I happened to be
+to-night where I overheard the talk between two men, and one of 'em was
+Fenton, the pine robber."
+
+Tom could perceive the expression of alarm which swept over the face of
+the woman, who was still standing before him. Apparently ignoring it,
+however, he went on. "It seems that both of the armies are on the march
+across Jersey, and that Washington has halted over by Hopewell. Somehow,
+Fenton had got word that your husband was coming home for a day, and
+he's fixed up a plan to trap and take him."
+
+"I haven't heard a word," said the woman slowly. "When was he coming?"
+
+"To-morrow."
+
+"And Fenton knows of it?"
+
+"Yes. And he knows something more, too, or at least he pretends to. I
+heard him say that you had some money hidden in an old sock, which you'd
+stored away in the garret."
+
+Tom saw the woman start at his words, and knew then that Fenton's
+statement had been correct, although he could not conjecture how the
+pine robber had received his information. Little Peter's mother was a
+resolute woman, but even the stoutest heart might well be alarmed to
+hear that Fenton was aware of such possessions.
+
+"Have you any idea when Little Peter will come home?"
+
+"No. It's too bad to keep him out in such a night. And we need him here
+now."
+
+"I'll wait till he comes," said Tom quietly. "There's no danger
+to-night, but I want to see him, and I don't think you'll object to my
+staying, will you?"
+
+"No," said the woman eagerly. "Oh, what times these are! My husband has
+been in the army more than a year, and the end hasn't come yet. What
+will become of us? What shall we do? Tom," she added suddenly, "what was
+Fenton going to do with him if he caught him?"
+
+"Take him and send him to New York. You know there's a reward for every
+prisoner taken. But he hasn't got him yet."
+
+"No, that's so; and what's more he won't either, if it can be prevented.
+Have you told Benzeor about it? Hark! There's some one at the door now!"
+
+The woman was not mistaken, for a low tapping on the kitchen door could
+be distinctly heard. For a moment neither spoke, but they could not
+conceal their fears from each other. Just then a stronger gust of wind
+drove the rain with added force against the windows. The sound of the
+storm seemed to increase the fear of those within the house. Perhaps
+Fenton himself had even then come; or, as was more probable, Tom
+thought, his own departure had been discovered, and Benzeor had come for
+him. As between the two, Tom decidedly preferred to meet Fenton at that
+time.
+
+Again the low rapping was heard, and Tom knew that some response must be
+made. "I'll open the door. Maybe it's Little Peter come back," he
+whispered.
+
+"No, it isn't Peter. He wouldn't come in that way."
+
+"I'll find out who it is," replied Tom more resolutely, although his
+heart was oppressed by a great fear. His hands were trembling, and he
+almost expected that the moment he drew back the bars a rush against the
+door would be made.
+
+"You stand ready to push against the door," he said as he grasped the
+bar. Slowly he drew it back, and standing away from the slight opening
+called out, "Who's there?"
+
+No reply was heard, and the wind which swept through the open space
+quickly extinguished the candle, leaving them both in total darkness.
+For a moment Tom thought they were being attacked, and he instantly
+slammed the door back, and shot the bar into its place.
+
+The rapping upon the door was quickly repeated, and the voice of some
+one outside could be heard. "Don't light the candle again," whispered
+Tom. "It'll let them see what's inside here. Who's out there?" he called
+in louder tones. "Who's there? You'll have to tell who you are, or we
+shan't let you in. Who is it?"
+
+Another rap was the only reply, and Tom was almost decided not to heed
+the summons longer, but to leave the callers, whoever they might be, out
+there in the storm.
+
+"I'll go upstairs and look out of the window," whispered Peter's mother;
+and, creeping softly out of the room, she soon made her way up the
+stairway to the room overhead from which she had replied to Tom's own
+summons a few minutes before.
+
+Tom waited and listened. The rapping was not repeated, and no sound
+could be heard outside the door. What could it all mean? Had the
+marauders gone around to some of the windows? These were barred by heavy
+inside shutters, and no light could be seen to reveal the presence of
+any one. The darkness in the room was intense, and Tom almost thought he
+could feel it. He was breathing hard in his excitement, but he had not
+left his position by the door.
+
+Soon he heard the sound of the woman returning down the stairway. He
+waited breathlessly, and she soon rejoined him.
+
+"I can't see but one man," she whispered. "He's right there in front of
+the door."
+
+"Is it Benzeor?"
+
+"I couldn't see. You'd better open the door and let him in. We can
+handle one."
+
+Tom did not feel so positive about that, but bidding her light the
+candle, he again drew back the bar. "Come in! Come in! Quick!" he
+called.
+
+Some one pushed past him, and the door was instantly closed and barred
+again.
+
+The candle was not yet lighted, and in the darkness he felt as if some
+one were about to grasp him. He could almost feel hands upon him now. He
+stepped farther back from the door, and waited in breathless suspense
+for the candle to be lighted.
+
+After several attempts, the woman succeeded in igniting a splinter from
+the embers in the ashes on the fireplace, and the beams of the lighted
+candle quickly dispelled the darkness.
+
+"It's Indian John!" said Tom with a great sigh of relief as he saw the
+man before him.
+
+The visitor was a strange appearing being, clad in the leggings and
+moccasins of his race, while over his shoulders he wore a faded coat
+which once had done duty for some Continental soldier. His dark eyes
+burned as if they had caught a reflection from the sputtering candle,
+but with a countenance unmoved he gazed quietly at his companions in the
+room.
+
+"Oh, John, what a fright you gave us!" said the woman at last. "What
+brings you here on a night like this?"
+
+The Indian made no reply, save to draw a letter from the pocket of the
+dripping, faded coat, and quietly held it forth to the woman.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+IN THE TEN-ACRE LOT
+
+
+LITTLE Peter's mother instantly grasped the letter, and seating herself
+by the table, and drawing the candle nearer, at once began to read. Tom
+watched her eagerly, but she did not speak, and the expression upon her
+face did not betray any of the emotions in her heart.
+
+The Indian still stood motionless in the position he had taken when he
+first entered the room, and except for the occasional turning of his
+dark eyes from the boy to the woman, so far as appearances went he might
+have been a statue. The rain still dashed against the windows, and the
+sounds of the wind outside showed that the storm was unabated. The
+flickering candle served to intensify the darkness, and the alarm which
+Tom had felt had not entirely departed.
+
+The woman read the letter all through carefully, and then, without a
+word of explanation, began to read it again. Tom hardly knew what to
+do. He had given her his warning, and whether she would care for his
+further services he could not determine. He did not feel like
+interrupting her, and yet he feared that his presence now might not be
+altogether welcome, for he had no means of knowing what the message was,
+or who had sent it.
+
+His uncertainty was quickly dispelled, however, as the woman laid the
+letter upon the table, and turning to him said, "You were right, Tom.
+Peter is coming home; but how you found it out, I cannot even guess."
+
+Tom did not feel at liberty to enlighten her upon the subject beyond
+what he had told her already, for he was sadly troubled about Benzeor
+and his relations with Fenton. Doubtless Benzeor was implicated, but
+matters had not yet gone so far that he felt he was at liberty to betray
+his foster father to the neighbors.
+
+"Yes," resumed the woman, "Peter is coming home, but only for a day or
+two."
+
+"Where is he? What does he say of the army?" inquired Tom.
+
+"Washington is at Hopewell, as you said, Tom. When he found out that
+Clinton really intended to march across Jersey, he detached General
+Maxwell's brigade and some of the militia to obstruct and bother the
+British, and Peter was in the militia, you know. They were to keep close
+to the redcoats, and by their skirmishes keep them from going too fast,
+and so give Washington a chance to pass them, and then, when the place
+he wanted was found, turn about and fight. When the army crossed the
+Delaware at Coryell's Ferry, Washington sent Colonel Morgan with six
+hundred of the riflemen to reinforce Maxwell, and with the rest of his
+men he set out to march toward Princeton."
+
+"I thought you said he was at Hopewell now," said Tom.
+
+"So he is, Peter writes, but Hopewell isn't but a few miles from
+Princeton, you know, and he decided to stop there and give his army a
+good rest. Peter writes that all the men now think that Clinton is
+marching so slowly on purpose, and that his plan is to let the Americans
+go on into the lower country and then gain the right of our army by a
+quick march and get possession of the higher ground on the right of our
+men. Peter writes that that is what all the Continentals think Clinton
+is trying to do, and so General Washington has halted at Hopewell.
+That's only five miles from Princeton, you see, and he is going to stay
+there a few days so that he can give his men a good rest before any
+engagement takes place; and he can find out what Clinton's plans are,
+too."
+
+"And while the army is waiting there, Big Peter thinks he'll run up home
+for a day, does he?" said Tom.
+
+"Yes, that's just it. He's sent me word of his coming by Indian John,
+here. But you must have been delayed John," she said, turning to the
+Indian as she spoke.
+
+"Heap wet," said the Indian quietly.
+
+"When does he say he expects to be here?" inquired Tom.
+
+"To-morrow; no, to-day, for it must be long past midnight now. I
+shouldn't be surprised to see him any time."
+
+"Well I've given you my message, and you'll know what to do now. I think
+perhaps I'd better be going back home, that is, unless there's something
+you think I can do to help you."
+
+"No, there's nothing more now, Tom. Little Peter will soon be here, and
+with him and Indian John in the house, I don't think we shall have much
+to fear. It was good of you to come, Tom. I shall never forget you, and
+I know that Peter will not, either. I am sadly troubled, but I think it
+will be all right."
+
+"Good-night, then," said Tom.
+
+"Good-night, and thank you again for all your trouble and kindness."
+
+Tom drew back the bar, and, opening the door, passed out into the night,
+little dreaming that he had looked upon the face of Little Peter's
+mother for the last time.
+
+As he ran along the lonesome road, he could see that the clouds were
+breaking, and in low masses were swept by the wind across the sky. The
+rain had almost ceased now, but the air was damp and heavy and strangely
+oppressive. Perhaps it was the oppressiveness which affected Tom more
+than the excitement through which he had just passed, for the lad was
+much depressed as he came nearer to Benzeor's house. All the
+conversation he had overheard between the men came back to him, and he
+almost wished that he had not left Peter's mother alone with Indian John
+and the children. His feeling of obligation to Benzeor had mostly
+departed now, and as he recalled the plots of his foster father his
+heart was hot within him. He even thought of going over to the Court
+House and reporting the matter to Sheriff Forman that very night; but
+the hope that Benzeor still might not join Fenton in the evil project
+they had formed deterred him, and as he just then obtained a glimpse of
+the house which for more than ten years had been the only home he had
+ever known, his mind was recalled to his own immediate plans. At least
+he had given Peter's mother the warning, and if Fenton's band should
+make the proposed visit, in any event she would be prepared to receive
+them.
+
+At first Tom thought he would not return to his room, but would pass the
+night in the barn; still the fear that Benzeor might discover his
+absence, and be led to suspect its cause, quickly presented itself, and
+the troubled lad decided to go back to his accustomed place.
+
+Carefully he climbed up on the woodpile, and grasping the sill drew
+himself up and passed through the open window. He stood for a moment in
+the room and listened intently. Not a sound could be heard, and even the
+long drawn-out snores with which Benzeor had been wont to proclaim to
+the household the fact that he had entered the land of dreams were
+silent now. He waited several moments, and as the silence was still
+unbroken he proceeded carefully to remove his wet clothing, and climbed
+into his high bed.
+
+For the first time then he realized how thoroughly tired he was. The bed
+had never been more grateful to him, and a heavy sigh of relief escaped
+his lips. He heard the crowing of the cocks and knew that the morning
+could not be far away now.
+
+Not even the exciting events of the day, or the treacherous project of
+Benzeor, or his anxiety for the safety of Little Peter's father, now
+availed to keep the wearied lad awake.
+
+How long he slept he did not know, but it was broad daylight when he
+opened his eyes. Some one was pounding upon his door, and with a
+confused thought that Fenton was besieging the house, or that Washington
+had begun an attack upon Clinton's forces, he quickly sat up in the bed
+and listened.
+
+The summons was repeated, and Tom at once realized where he was and what
+was expected of him. There was no mistaking Benzeor's rude method of
+proclaiming the presence of the morning, and if he had had any doubts,
+they would have been quickly dispelled by the words which followed.
+
+"Come, Tom, get up! It's high time we were at work again!"
+
+"I'll be down in a minute," replied Tom as he leaped out of bed and
+hastily dressed.
+
+While he was engaged in that occupation he tried desperately to collect
+his thoughts and think of some way out of the troubles which he feared
+were sure to come that day. Should he tell Benzeor plainly that he could
+no longer remain under his roof? Ought he to tell him what he had
+overheard the night before? Had the time come for him to declare himself
+and to take the open stand which he had for a long time secretly planned
+to do? Thoughts of Sarah and the toiling, careworn little mother of the
+household presented themselves before his troubled mind, and the longer
+he thought, the more perplexed he became.
+
+The problem was not solved when he passed down the stairs and went out
+of the house to the barrel which stood beneath the corner of the eaves.
+He took the rude wooden bowl and filled it with water, and desperately
+tried to arrive at some conclusion as he bathed his flushed face.
+
+The family were already seated at the breakfast-table, and the sounds of
+Benzeor's gruff voice could be distinctly heard through the open
+windows. The hens with their broods were moving about the yard, and the
+dog came and rubbed against his leg as the lad dried his face and hands
+on the rough towel that was hanging near the water barrel. The storm had
+passed, and the summer sun was shining clear and strong now.
+
+As he lifted his eyes and looked out over Benzeor's fertile lands, only
+a vision of peace and restfulness could be seen on every side. It was
+all so different from the storm which was in his own soul that Tom
+almost groaned aloud as he turned to enter the kitchen and take his
+accustomed place at the table.
+
+As he entered the room, Benzeor said, "You're late this morning, lad,
+but I thought I would let you sleep, you had such a hard day of it
+yesterday. But there's no trip to New York this morning, and not likely
+to be one again soon."
+
+Benzeor's manner was not unkind, and as Tom glanced at him he wondered
+whether the man was in any wise suspicious of him or not. Apparently he
+was not, but without making any reply Tom seated himself and quietly
+decided to wait until they were alone before he spoke of what was in his
+mind.
+
+"Tom," said Benzeor after a brief silence, "I want you to go over to the
+ten-acre lot to-day. The ground's wet, but the corn there needs hoeing,
+and we can't wait."
+
+The "ten-acre lot" was on the border of Benzeor's possessions, and was
+nearly a mile distant from the house. On all sides it was bordered by
+woods, and was as lonely a place as could be found in all the region.
+
+"Are you going, too?" inquired Tom, with an apparent indifference he was
+far from feeling.
+
+"No. I've got to go in another direction to-day. I may not be back at
+night either, though I can't say as to that. You'd better take your
+dinner, too, Tom, and I'll leave one of the muskets for you. You can
+load it up with bird-shot and keep the blackbirds and crows away.
+They're raising the mischief this year, and corn's going to be worth
+money this fall, if I'm not greatly mistaken."
+
+Tom made no reply, although his heart was beating a little more rapidly
+than usual. Benzeor's absence from home promised little good, and the
+words which he had overheard the night before came back now with
+redoubled force. Where was Benzeor going? And why did he send him to
+work in the distant field, when he was positive that some of the corn
+nearer the house was in far greater need of hoeing than that in the
+ten-acre lot?
+
+However, he did not voice his questions, and immediately after the
+breakfast was over Benzeor mounted his horse and departed up the road,
+going in the opposite direction to that which led to Little Peter's
+house.
+
+Tom went up into the unfinished room in which Benzeor kept his guns and
+ammunition, but instead of taking the musket to which the man had
+referred, he selected a rifle, and loaded it with a ball instead of the
+bird-shot as Benzeor had directed. Just why he did this Tom could not
+have explained even to himself, but somehow there was the feeling in his
+heart that he might need to be prepared to deal with larger game that
+day than the thieving blackbirds or the noisy crows.
+
+"I've got your dinner all ready, Tom," said Sarah, as the boy came back
+with his gun into the kitchen. "Why, you've got the rifle!" she added in
+surprise, as she noted the weapon he had in his hands. "There's nothing
+wrong, is there?" she said anxiously.
+
+"I hope not. I don't know. I thought I'd take this gun," replied Tom in
+some confusion.
+
+Sarah said nothing more, but Tom knew from her manner that she was
+alarmed. He would have been glad to quiet her fears, but the anxiety in
+his own heart rendered him somewhat embarrassed, and without saying
+anything more he shouldered his gun, and picking up the little pail, or
+"blicky," as the country people termed it, having adopted the Dutch word
+whether they themselves were Dutch or not, he set forth on his walk to
+the distant ten-acre lot.
+
+He stopped in the barn long enough to select a hoe, and then with the
+added implement resumed his journey across the fields. When he came to
+the borders of the woods through which he was to pass, he turned and
+looked back at the house.
+
+Sarah was still standing in the doorway, and as she saw Tom stop she
+waved at him the sunbonnet which she was holding in one hand by the
+strings. Tom waved his "blicky" by way of a return, and then entered the
+woods, which shut out the view of all that lay behind him.
+
+The birds were flitting about in the trees and filling the air with
+their songs. The squirrels darted along the branches, stopping only
+occasionally to chatter at the intruder. High over all he could see a
+fish-hawk and his mate circling in the air, and Tom knew that their nest
+was not far away, and doubtless they were watching him to see that he
+did no harm to their little ones, which by this time must be well grown.
+
+As he came near to a marshy little pond which lay in the centre of an
+open place in the woods, he stopped for a moment when he heard the angry
+notes of a ground thrush near by. He soon saw that the bird was engaged
+in a fierce contest with a water snake which had crawled up the bank and
+doubtless had been endeavoring to make his breakfast upon the
+fledgelings in the nest he had discovered.
+
+Tom watched the contest for a moment, and then advanced to the aid of
+the bird, which was beating the ground with her wings, and occasionally
+darting swiftly at her foe. His approach was instantly seen by the
+snake, which quickly abandoned the contest, and, squirming down the
+bank, slid into the stagnant water; but Tom could still see the head
+which was lifted above the water, and the glittering little eyes were
+intently watching his movements, although the rest of the long slimy
+body was concealed in the pond.
+
+"That's just like Benzeor," said Tom aloud, as he dropped his pail, and
+picking up a stone threw it savagely at the head he could see a few
+yards out from the bank.
+
+The head instantly disappeared, and Tom turned to watch the bird, which
+now was hopping about in the bushes, uttering harsh little notes of
+relief.
+
+"You're all right now, old lady," said Tom. "Go back and tend to your
+babies. I only wish I could serve every crawling thing the way I served
+your enemy."
+
+He soon arrived at the end of his journey, and, placing his gun within
+easy reach, began his task for the day. Why he had put off his
+conversation with Benzeor he could not explain. But the energy with
+which he began his work served to afford a measure of relief for his
+pent-up feelings, and when the noon hour at last came he had done far
+more work than a morning often witnessed.
+
+Once he had stopped suddenly when he thought he heard the report of a
+gun in the distance. The sound had twice been repeated, but it seemed to
+be muffled and far away, and as he resumed his labor he tried to
+persuade himself that it was only Little Peter firing at the blackbirds
+or the thieving crows.
+
+The reports had made him anxious, however, and when he had stopped for
+dinner he had kept his gun near him all the time. The silence served to
+increase his feeling of loneliness. On every side stood the forests; and
+the great trees, which had never as yet felt the stroke of the axe, were
+companions without sympathy.
+
+With a feeling of desperation Tom soon resumed his labors. The sun
+passed over his head and began to sink below the tops of the taller
+trees. He had stopped for a moment to wipe his dripping face and gain a
+brief rest, when he was startled by the sight of some one emerging from
+the forest.
+
+He gazed for a moment intently at the new-comer, and soon recognized
+Sarah. What was the trouble? Her dress had been torn by the bushes, her
+hair had become loose and was streaming down her back. But her
+disheveled appearance was not the worst, for as Tom dropped his hoe and
+ran across the lot to meet her, he saw that her eyes were filled with an
+expression of terror, and her face betrayed the wild alarm which seemed
+to possess the swiftly running girl.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE PARTING OF THE WAYS
+
+
+"WHAT'S wrong, Sarah? What is it? What is it?" said Tom excitedly, as he
+drew near the almost breathless girl. "Has anything happened at the
+house?"
+
+"Oh, Tom!" was all that Sarah at first could say. The reaction from her
+excitement and the swift pace at which she had been running had come,
+and the frightened girl burst into a flood of tears.
+
+Tom looked on in helpless amazement. Sarah was usually such a strong and
+self-contained girl that her present distress was all the more
+perplexing. He looked at her a moment, feeling how utterly unable he was
+to comprehend the state of her feelings and how helpless he was to aid
+or comfort her. Benzeor might be faced; and even Fenton, in spite of the
+fear with which Tom regarded him, might be met; but a weeping girl was
+entirely outside the realm of all his previous experiences, and he stood
+leaning upon his gun, eager to do something to aid Sarah, and feeling a
+deep sympathy for her as he silently watched her.
+
+Perhaps his silence was the very best aid he could offer, for in a brief
+time the resolute Sarah gained control of herself, and lifting her
+tear-stained face to that of the troubled lad by her side she said, "Oh
+Tom, they've killed Little Peter's mother!"
+
+"What!" exclaimed Tom in amazement. "Killed her? You can't mean it! Who
+killed her?"
+
+"Yes, they shot her, and have carried off his father, too."
+
+"I don't understand, Sarah," said Tom more quietly. "Tell me about it."
+
+"Little Peter came over to our house just a little while ago to leave
+the children, and he told us all about it. It seems, he was the lookout
+yesterday down by the Hook and didn't get home till it was almost light
+this morning.
+
+"He said he went up to his room and laid down upon his bed, and must
+have gone to sleep, but he was waked up by the sound of the voices of
+men in the house. He jumped out of bed and listened, and pretty soon he
+heard one of them tell his mother that she must hand over the money she
+had hidden in a stocking up in the garret, and tell where his father
+was.
+
+"She refused to do either, and then Little Peter hurriedly dressed and
+ran down the stairs, but some of the men just grabbed him and held him
+fast so that he couldn't do anything to help his mother. He said the men
+all had masks on their faces except Fenton, for he thinks it was
+Fenton's band that did the work, and he was sure he recognized the
+blacksmith."
+
+"No doubt about that!" exclaimed Tom. "What did they do then?"
+
+"They held his mother while some of them ran up into the garret, and
+pretty soon one of them came back with the stocking. They made quite a
+time over that, and Little Peter thought they wouldn't do anything more,
+but it seems they didn't find as much money in the stocking as they
+expected. Little Peter explained it to me by saying that his mother had
+divided it, and had hidden a part in the garden back of the house and
+left only a part in the stocking.
+
+"For a little time they didn't suspect that, but wanted to know where
+her husband was. Of course she didn't tell them. How could she, when he
+wasn't there? Well, they searched the place high and low. They tore open
+the feather beds, and broke down the walls in two or three places, but
+they couldn't find Peter. Then they went out into the barns and searched
+them, but not a trace of him could they find. They must have been pretty
+angry by that time, for when they came back to the house they told her
+they knew there must be more money than they had found in the stocking,
+and she must tell them where it was.
+
+"Just then one of the children called out that she knew where it was for
+she had seen her mother dig a hole in the ground and put a bag of money
+in it. Two of the men then took the child out into the garden and tried
+to make her show them the place where the money was, but she must either
+have forgotten or else did not know, for the men came back into the
+house more angry than before, and told her mother that she must go with
+them and show them the place.
+
+"Of course she refused, and then Fenton raised his gun and told her he'd
+give her till he could count five, to tell. She didn't say a word, and
+when the blacksmith had counted four he stopped a minute to give her a
+chance to speak. He waited, and as she only shook her head the outlaw
+pulled the trigger and shot her in the breast."
+
+"And killed her?" inquired Tom in a low voice.
+
+"Yes, killed her. The bullet must have struck her heart, for Little
+Peter said she fell dead. They threw the body on the bed and then they
+turned upon Little Peter. He said he thought his turn had come then, but
+at that very minute the guard they had stationed down by the road came
+running into the house, and going up to Fenton whispered something in
+his ear.
+
+"Little Peter didn't know what it was, he said, but in a minute Fenton
+turned to his men and gave them some directions, and they all stopped
+and went out of the house, that is, all except two, who were looking
+after Little Peter and the children.
+
+"In almost no time Little Peter heard some one coming up the lane on
+horseback and stop right before the kitchen door. He heard him jump off
+from the horse, and after a pause of a minute the men all made a rush
+out of the house. Pretty soon they came back, and Little Peter saw that
+his own father was a prisoner in their hands.
+
+"He said his father took on fearfully when he saw his wife dead, and
+what the men had been doing, but in a minute they bound him hand and
+foot, and put a gag in his mouth, and then he was as helpless as a baby
+in their hands.
+
+"Little Peter said he didn't know what was coming next. He thought
+they'd torture him or his father into telling where the money was, or
+would set fire to the house; but before they could do anything the guard
+came running into the house again and called out that some one was
+coming.
+
+"They only stopped long enough to tie Little Peter to the post of the
+very bed on which his mother was lying dead, and then they made a break
+out of the house and took their horses and were off down the lane in no
+time."
+
+"How did you hear about it? How did Little Peter get away?" said Tom
+slowly.
+
+"Why, in a few minutes Indian John came into the house, and he set
+Little Peter free. 'Twas lucky for him that he did, for Fenton might
+have come back, you see."
+
+"And Little Peter came over to your house with the children, then?"
+
+"Yes, he brought them all over, and they're at our house now. But, oh
+Tom, it's dreadful! dreadful! I'm so afraid they'll come to our place
+next, and so I ran out here to get you. Come Tom! Come right away! They
+may be there now!"
+
+Tom hesitated, not knowing just what to do. He was only a boy, and knew
+that alone he could do nothing against Fenton and his band. But the
+appeal of Sarah and the unprotected condition of the children and her
+mother moved him strongly, and his first impulse was to return with the
+frightened girl.
+
+"Sarah," said he abruptly, "where is your father?"
+
+"Why, you know he went away this morning, and he hasn't come back yet.
+He said he might not be back before to-morrow morning. We're all alone,
+Tom, and you must come right away. Oh, it's awful!" And Sarah buried her
+face in her hands again as she spoke.
+
+It was almost upon Tom's lips to tell her what he knew of Benzeor. But
+the misery of the weeping girl before him was even stronger than the
+impression produced by the sad tale she had just related, and he could
+not quite bring himself up to the point of telling her what he
+suspected,--that her own father had been connected with the attack upon
+Little Peter's home. But he had decided now as to the course of action
+he must follow.
+
+"Sarah," said he gently, "there isn't the least danger in the world that
+your house will be attacked. I can't tell you how I know, but I know
+it's so."
+
+"But we're all alone, Tom! I don't know what you mean! We're as likely
+to be attacked as any one. You must go back with me! We must go right
+away, for they may be there now! Poor mother, she was so frightened that
+she didn't want me to leave and come over here for you! Come! We must go
+right back now!"
+
+"Sarah, I'm never going into that house again. You can tell your father
+that I've slept for the last time under his roof."
+
+"Not going back with me?" said Sarah aghast, and looking up in surprise
+as she spoke. "Not going back?" she repeated, as if she did not fully
+understand what Tom had said.
+
+"No, I'm not going back," said Tom firmly. "You know I've been thinking
+a good while of leaving, and after what you've just told me I know the
+time has come."
+
+The color slowly faded from Sarah's face and a different expression came
+into her eyes. Even her alarm was apparently forgotten for the moment,
+and as Tom looked at her, her eyes seemed to snap and a sneer replaced
+the look of sorrow.
+
+"Tom Coward, you're afraid!" she said; "that's what's the trouble with
+you. You're afraid, that's what you are! You'd rather leave mother and
+me alone there with the children than run any risks of meeting the
+blacksmith! I wouldn't have believed it, but my father was right. You're
+a coward by nature as well as by name."
+
+"Sarah"--began Tom, his face flushing at the words of the angry girl.
+
+"Don't 'Sarah' me! I know you now! I never could have believed it,
+never! But I've heard you with my own ears, and now I know it's true!
+You're afraid! You're a coward, that's just what you are! Oh, you're
+well named, you are! Very well, sir, it shall be as you say. Perhaps we
+shall be better off without you than we would with you, for it would
+only make another child for us to look after if you should come back!
+I'll go back home and face Fenton and every one of his band myself! I'm
+afraid, but I'm no coward!"
+
+[Illustration: "TOM COWARD, YOU'RE AFRAID!"]
+
+Turning abruptly away, after giving Tom a glance which he never forgot,
+she started resolutely and swiftly back along the pathway which she had
+followed in her flight to the ten-acre lot.
+
+Tom looked after her in helpless amazement. Never before had he heard
+such an outburst from the gentle and even-tempered Sarah, who had been
+the leading spirit in Benzeor's household. The children had gone to her
+with their troubles rather than to their mother, and Sarah had never
+failed to have a word of comfort or of help for every one. Even Benzeor
+himself had come to depend upon her judgment in many of his affairs, and
+she had been as patient and gentle with him as she had been with the
+troubled little ones.
+
+And to Tom she had been the one true friend he had ever known. Somehow
+she had always understood him, and from the days of their early
+childhood it had always been a matter of pride to him that he was her
+acknowledged champion and protector. Many a time, when he was a sturdy
+little lad, had he taken her part against the tormenting boys in the
+school. For her he had carved quaint and strange looking dolls out of
+horse-chestnuts, and the childish Sarah had never failed to receive
+them with many expressions of pleasure, and had lavished a wealth of
+affection upon them which was almost as pleasing to Tom as to the little
+mother herself. For her he had gathered the chestnuts in the autumn and
+the bright colored flowers in the springtime; and when, with the passing
+of the years, there had come to them both new feelings and new
+interests, he still had shared with her all those dimly perceived
+ambitions and longings which are ever present in the boyish heart when
+it arrives at that position where it can look out upon the time when the
+boy is to become a man.
+
+Perhaps Tom had enjoyed her sympathy and interest the more because of
+the loneliness of his own position. But Sarah never by word or act had
+caused him to feel that he was only Benzeor Osburn's "bound boy," and
+not truly one of the household.
+
+Tom was thinking of some of these things as he watched the departing
+girl, and, forgetting for the moment all the anger and shame which her
+last words had aroused, he called aloud after her.
+
+"Sarah! Sarah!" he shouted. "Wait a minute! Come back! Come back!"
+
+Sarah apparently did not hear him, or heed him if she heard, and without
+once turning her head or looking behind her soon disappeared in the
+forest.
+
+An impulse to follow her seized Tom, and he even ran a few steps after
+her, but quickly stopped. How could he explain himself to her without
+informing upon Benzeor? And then her sorrow would be harder for him to
+bear than her present anger, hard as that was. No; all he could do was
+to remain silent for the time, and trust that in the future some
+explanation might be made which should set him aright once more in the
+estimation of the best friend the homeless boy had ever known.
+
+The departure of Sarah left him face to face with the perplexing problem
+of what he was now to do. To return to Benzeor's house was impossible;
+but where should he go?
+
+Tom stood for several minutes in deep thought. There was no home which
+would now be open to him except Little Peter's, and that had been
+wrecked by the dreadful deeds of Fenton and his followers. Washington's
+army he had heard was at Hopewell, and that was at least forty miles
+away. It was to the army he had ultimately hoped to go, and perhaps the
+present was the very time to which he had been looking forward so long.
+
+The longer he thought about it the more strongly was he impressed with
+the conviction that his best plan would be to try to make his way to
+Hopewell, or to the place to which the army might have moved by this
+time. It was true he was without provisions, and he knew of no place in
+which he would be likely to obtain any, or in which he might find a
+resting-place for a night. Of the long journey he thought but little,
+for a walk even of forty miles had no terrors for him.
+
+Tom decided to start for Washington's army, but first he must stop at
+Little Peter's and learn what his friend's plans were to be, and offer
+him such aid as it lay within his power to give.
+
+The decision once made, Tom picked up his rifle, which now he somehow
+had come to regard as his own property, and started through the forest
+toward the distant road.
+
+When at last he gained it and started towards Little Peter's home, he
+was startled as he saw some one running down the road, and his first
+impulse was to conceal himself in the forest and wait for the stranger
+to pass; but his fears were relieved when he recognized the long lope of
+the runner, and then knew that his old friend Indian John was
+approaching.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+INDIAN JOHN
+
+
+INDIAN JOHN had for years been a frequent visitor in the home of
+Benzeor, as he had in many of the other homes of the region. He was an
+old man now,--how old no one knew, perhaps not even Indian John
+himself,--but he had lingered about old Monmouth long after the
+Schwonnack had taken possession of the lands and his own tribe had
+gradually relinquished their homes and mostly withdrawn from the region.
+
+For months together he would disappear, and no one would know whither he
+had gone, although it was thought that he was on a visit to some of his
+kindred, who had withdrawn farther into the interior of the country; but
+he would soon return and resume his wandering life. At such times,
+Indian John would be restless and uneasy. Perhaps then he realized more
+fully the loss of the homes of his ancestors, and his heart would be
+filled with thoughts he never uttered. He continued to be friendly with
+the settlers, and though he never refused to accept the food which
+almost every housewife was willing to give him, he had never been
+willing to pass a night under a roof. It was commonly reported that he
+used a cave in the woods not far away as his abode, but he never had
+welcomed any one there, nor had any one ever seen the aged Indian in the
+place. Still the report was believed, and "Indian John's cave" was a
+well-known name among the boys of Old Monmouth.
+
+Between Tom and the lonely warrior there had been a very strong feeling
+of sympathy, although not even Tom himself was able to explain it. It
+had come about, however, as the result of an accidental meeting between
+them a few years previous to this time. Tom had gone down to the shore
+one day when a storm had been raging, and the great breakers had been
+rolling in upon the beach.
+
+As the lad had walked on over the sand, he had been surprised to see the
+figure of a man in the distance, standing motionless, and evidently
+watching the tumult of the angry waters. He had not changed from his
+position as Tom approached, and the lad did not know that his presence
+was even recognized by the Indian, who seemed to be absorbed in his
+reflections as he looked out over the tossing waves.
+
+Tom had gone on and at last touched the Indian upon the shoulder. Indian
+John had then slowly turned his head, and Tom knew that his presence had
+been perceived, but for a moment neither had spoken.
+
+Then the aged warrior, with a gesture toward the ocean, had said, "Boy
+no home. Warrior no home. Brothers."
+
+It was the first time Tom had known that Indian John was aware of his
+own early history, and his heart had been deeply touched by the sympathy
+of the red man.
+
+"Boy no home. Warrior no home. Both like waves. Driven here. Driven
+there. No rest. No home. Storm there. Storm here," said the Indian
+laying his hand upon his bosom as he spoke.
+
+From that time, although Indian John never referred to his loneliness
+again, a strong bond of sympathy had existed between the two, and every
+time Tom had seen the old man, he thought of his quiet eloquence in the
+presence of that storm which they both had witnessed from the shore.
+
+And Indian John had been kind and thoughtful to all the white children
+of the region. He had made bows for the boys, and taught them their use,
+and as their skill had increased, his pride was as marked, although it
+had not been as demonstrative, as that of the youthful warriors
+themselves. He had taught them how to make and set their traps for the
+foxes and the rabbits, and how to catch the eels in the river.
+Apparently his happiest hours had been those which he passed with his
+young companions.
+
+Highly as the boys had prized the lessons he had given them, still more
+did they prize the marvelous tales which Indian John could tell. To them
+he told what the waves were saying when they came rolling in upon the
+sandy shore. He knew what the tall trees were whispering when the wind
+swept through their branches and brought the leaves into contact with
+one another. The hoarse calls of the wild geese, when they passed high
+overhead on their long journeys in the spring and autumn, were all known
+to Indian John, and the screams of the eagles and the fish-hawks were
+all in a language which he clearly understood.
+
+He knew, also, all the tales his fathers had told him of the first
+appearance of the Woapsiel Lennape in Old Monmouth, when, in the spring
+of 1524, John de Verrazano, in his good ship The Dolphin, had entered
+Sandy Hook, and had soon after written a long letter to King Francis the
+First of France, and had given a full account of the marvelous
+adventures which had befallen him, and the no less marvelous country he
+had discovered. He had heard, also, of the visit, in the summer of 1609,
+which Sir Henry Hudson had made in The Half Moon, and how that one of
+his crew had fallen as the first victim of the rage of the Indians at
+the invasion of their lands.
+
+The tale which Tom had always enjoyed most, however, was that of the
+origin of the troublesome little pests which, in the warm days of the
+summer, were the torment of the people, for Jersey mosquitoes were not
+unknown in those far-off times of the Revolution.
+
+It seemed that ages before this time, indeed away back in the days
+before John de Verrazano or Henry Hudson had come, or even the memory of
+the oldest warriors could run, the Great Spirit had permitted two huge
+monsters to appear and prey upon the red men of Monmouth as a penalty
+for some crime they had committed, a crime the nature of which Indian
+John did not know, or, if he knew, he never explained.
+
+In size these monsters were larger than any house. They had long slender
+legs which held their huge bodies higher in the air than the tallest
+trees could have done. They also had immense wings, which, although they
+were as fine in texture as the finest silk, were so large and strong
+that when the huge monsters used them they created such a breeze that
+even the strongest trees of the forest fell before them.
+
+Their most distinguishing characteristic, however, was an immense
+"bill," which was as long as the tallest pine-tree and as sharp and
+delicate in its point as that of the smallest needle. With this they
+wrought incalculable destruction and suffering among the helpless
+people. The largest man served only as a single "bite," and the bodies
+of little children seemed only to whet the appetite of these savage
+monsters.
+
+The helpless warriors knew not what to do. They sacrificed, and prayed,
+and besought the Great Spirit to free them from their tormentors, but
+all was without avail. Their prayers were unanswered, and the Great
+Spirit was not appeased.
+
+No man could describe the destruction wrought by the huge tormentors.
+Whole tribes disappeared before them, and it soon came to pass that the
+warriors dared not venture forth in search of food for their starving
+little ones, who were kept concealed in dens and caves of the earth.
+Watchers were stationed to give warning of the approach of the monsters,
+for their great bodies cast shadows upon the earth like those of the
+low-passing clouds on a summer day, and long before they appeared in the
+sky the cry of the watchman sent all within the sound of his voice to
+their places of refuge under the ground. Not even then were they always
+safe, for the monsters could bore into the ground with their bills, and
+often brought to the surface the body of a man, who struggled and kicked
+much after the fashion of a frog impaled on the beak of some long-legged
+heron. The torments of the people increased. The women neglected their
+fields, and the warriors remained in their hiding-places, while the
+frightened children cried for food.
+
+At last, rendered desperate by their sufferings, the warriors of the
+entire region banded themselves together, and one day fell upon the
+monsters as they were lying asleep in a valley which their immense
+bodies almost filled.
+
+The carnage was frightful to behold. All day long the contest was waged,
+and the multitudes of men that fell could not be counted up for numbers.
+But at last the red men were victorious, and when the few remaining
+warriors left the field of battle, their enemies lay stretched upon the
+valley, dead.
+
+Great was the rejoicing among the people. They came forth from their
+hiding-places, and their feastings and songs of victory were continued
+for two entire days. The land was freed from its tormentors, and peace
+and prosperity would now return, or so at least they thought.
+
+Great was the astonishment and sorrow of Indian John's forefathers when,
+upon the third day, they discovered that their troubles were not ended.
+As decay had begun to work upon the dead bodies of the mammoth
+mosquitoes, little particles became loosened, and as they were lifted
+into the air by the summer wind, each tiny and separate atom became
+endowed with life and received a body in shape exactly like that of the
+huge monsters themselves, only they were exceedingly small in size. Day
+after day clouds of these tiny torments were borne away by the breezes
+from the valley of the dead, and, filled with a burning desire to avenge
+the death of their parents, they fell upon the unprotected people.
+
+From these there had been no relief. The camp-fires of the warriors did
+not avail, and although the men went valiantly forth to give them
+battle, their efforts were all futile, and from that day until the
+present time the Jersey mosquito has remained a foe to the red man and
+the white, and ever consumed by the one purpose, to avenge the death of
+the parents, who had fallen years ago in their battle with the
+red-skinned warriors of Old Monmouth.
+
+To Indian John this story of the origin of the pests of New Jersey had
+been eminently satisfactory, and never by word or deed had he shown that
+he had the slightest doubt of the accuracy of the tradition which had
+come down to him through many generations. Tom at first had received the
+account with all the implicit faith of an ardent admirer of Indian John,
+and his first rude shock had come when Benzeor had laughed aloud upon
+his relating the story with all seriousness one morning at the
+breakfast-table. With the passing of the years other doubts as to the
+entire reliability of some of Indian John's stories had crept into his
+mind. Alas that it should be so with us all! But his strong regard for
+the old warrior had never ceased, and Tom's heart was glad that morning
+when he recognized the new-comer as his long-time friend.
+
+"Where have you been, John?" he said, as the Indian approached.
+
+"See Peter."
+
+"Have you seen him?" said Tom eagerly. "Where is he? Has he got away?"
+
+"How?" replied the Indian quickly; and Tom at once perceived from the
+expression upon his face that he was aware of some but not of all the
+recent events in Peter's home.
+
+As he related the story which Sarah had told him, Indian John made no
+reply, although his eyes seemed to blaze as he listened to Tom's words.
+He then explained that he had left the house soon after Tom had departed
+on the preceding night, to intercept Big Peter on the road and give to
+him the warning which his wife had bidden him to carry. But Peter must
+have returned by a different route from that which he had been expected
+to use, and as a natural result Indian John had not seen him, the
+warning word had not been given, and Big Peter had returned to learn of
+the sad death of his wife and to be carried away a prisoner by Fenton
+and his brutal band.
+
+"I don't know just what to do now, John," said Tom. "I want to go and
+join the army. You have been there, and perhaps you would like to go
+back with me."
+
+Indian John had been with the soldiers in Washington's army, but he made
+no reply to Tom's words, and indeed the lad was not certain that he had
+heard, for he stood looking upon the ground and evidently was thinking
+deeply.
+
+"Where Little Peter now?" said the Indian abruptly, looking up at Tom as
+he spoke.
+
+"I don't know. Fenton didn't take him with him, though I don't know why
+he didn't."
+
+"Little Peter home," said the Indian decidedly. "Go see Little Peter."
+
+Tom hesitated. He, too, had longed to go to his friend, not only to
+express his sympathy but also to learn what his plans were to be, for he
+knew that Little Peter would not remain in his home now. Indeed, he
+could not, if he would, after such a scene as that which he had
+witnessed there. But Tom's mind was filled with thoughts of Benzeor, and
+a meeting with him certainly was not very desirable at that time.
+
+"Go see Little Peter," said the Indian again, starting on up the road as
+he spoke.
+
+"All right, I'll go with you," replied Tom, as he joined his companion.
+
+Little Peter's house was not far away, and he would not lose much time
+in going there. It was almost night now, and if his friend should be at
+home they might be able to devise some plan by which they could act
+together. Besides all that, Tom was more than glad to have an
+opportunity to express his sympathy for his friend in his sorrow.
+
+They soon came within sight of the house, and both stopped when they saw
+a little group of people near the garden. Tom knew at once what their
+presence meant, for they were near the spot where two of the members of
+the family had been buried. He had seen the rude wooden headstones which
+marked their graves many times before this.
+
+The few neighbors who had assembled to perform the last rites for Little
+Peter's mother had just returned to the house as Tom and Indian John
+approached. Tom at once went to his friend, and the warm grasp of the
+hand was all he could give. Not one of the children save Little Peter
+was there, and the hurried duties had been hastily performed by kind,
+though rough hands.
+
+The two boys withdrew from the house, and after an awkward silence Tom
+said in a low voice, "What are you going to do now?"
+
+"I'm going to leave the children at Benzeor's house. He has been very
+kind, or rather Sarah has, Tom. And then I'm going to start for Refugee
+Town; I think father may be there."
+
+"Refugee Town?" said Tom in surprise. "Do you think that will be safe?"
+
+Tom well knew the place. It was a spot on the outer beach of the Hook,
+where some of the more desperate refugees, tories and negroes, had
+assembled. A few huts and tents served as their dwelling-places, and the
+men were supposed to be in league with the men on board the boats which
+the British had stationed near by, for a part of Howe's fleet was
+already anchored there, waiting for the coming of Clinton's men.
+Clinton's original plan had been to march across Jersey to New
+Brunswick, there embark his men on the Raritan, and sail away for New
+York; but the rapid march of Washington had caused him to abandon the
+project, and word had been sent for the fleet to be ready for him when
+he should arrive at the Highlands.
+
+Refugee Town had become a familiar name within the past few weeks.
+
+"No, it isn't safe exactly, but I've got to do something for father. If
+he's taken to New York and shut up in the sugar-house I'll go with him;
+and if he's still there at the Town I may be able to do something,
+though I don't know what," said Little Peter sadly.
+
+"But there are the children," protested Tom. "What'll become of them?"
+
+"They're at Benzeor's, and they'll be all right. You'll help look after
+them, won't you?"
+
+"I've left Benzeor's."
+
+"Left Benzeor's? What for?"
+
+"I'm going to join the army. It's time I was doing my share."
+
+Tom gave no other reason. He knew the children would be safe at
+Benzeor's, and with what Little Peter then had it in his mind to do it
+would perhaps be unwise to tell him all he knew. However, he intended
+to tell him all, and that soon.
+
+"Going to join the army?" repeated Little Peter, as if he did not
+comprehend the words.
+
+"Yes; you know I've been thinking of it a long time, and now that
+they're on the march, and coming this way, I've made up my mind that my
+turn has come. I didn't know but you would want to go, too, now."
+
+"I'd like to, but I can't. I've got this other matter on hand. Come into
+the house, Tom, and spend the night with me. You can start in the
+morning as well as now, and besides it's almost dark. You can't go in
+the night."
+
+Tom hesitated, but finally consented, and with his friend went into the
+house which so recently had been the scene of the greatest sorrow which
+had ever entered Little Peter's life.
+
+Indian John followed them, but after his custom refused to remain,
+although he promised to return early in the morning. One of the women of
+the neighborhood had stayed to look after Little Peter's immediate
+wants, but as soon as her duties were done she departed for her own home
+with an eagerness she could not entirely conceal. And Tom did not blame
+her, for he himself was not without fear when at last Little Peter
+closed the doors for the night, and, after having slipped the heavy bars
+into their places, the two boys sought their bed in the low room over
+the kitchen.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+THE YOUNG LIEUTENANT
+
+
+IT was long before daylight when the boys were stirring on the morning
+which followed the events recorded in the preceding chapter. No one had
+disturbed them, and with the return of the day their courage was
+somewhat revived. Tom, however, had decided to start at once for the
+army, which he knew from Indian John's words was not many miles away. He
+was thoroughly familiar with all the roads in the county, for he had
+ridden over them many times in company with Benzeor, or when he had been
+sent on errands to the more remote regions by his foster father, and
+consequently had no fears of losing his way.
+
+Little Peter did not urge his friend to accompany him on his expedition
+to Refugee Town, for he was aware of the perils that were likely to
+beset him on his journey. He would not listen to any of the protests of
+Tom, for he was fully determined to learn what had become of his
+father, and even share his experiences if the occasion demanded. And Tom
+could not find it in his heart to blame Little Peter, hopeless as he
+considered all his efforts likely to be. Perhaps he would do the same
+thing if his own father had been carried away by the pine robbers, and
+he found himself conjecturing how it was a boy would feel in such
+circumstances as those in which his friend had been placed. The feeling
+was one of which he knew nothing by experience, and his own loneliness
+seemed to press upon him with a heavier weight.
+
+However, he still said nothing to Little Peter concerning Benzeor's
+recent actions, for he was well assured that his friend's younger
+brothers and sisters could be in no place where they would so easily
+escape all further troubles for the present as in his foster father's
+house; and then all of Little Peter's plans would be changed at once if
+he knew the part which his neighbor had taken in the tragedy which had
+recently occurred.
+
+"Perhaps Indian John will go with me," said Little Peter. "He'll be a
+great help if he'll go."
+
+"That he will," replied Tom, "and I'm sure he'll be glad to go with
+you. I should like to go myself."
+
+"That's all right, Tom; I know you would, but you couldn't do any good,
+and might only get into trouble yourself. Perhaps I'll be with you in a
+day or two, if I don't hear anything about my father down by Refugee
+Town,--that is, if Benzeor is willing for the children to stay in his
+house. I'll have to look after them, you see, for it's likely I'll have
+to be father and mother, as well as big brother, now," he added sadly.
+
+"I know, I know," said Tom; "but I'm hoping you'll have good luck, and
+if the army really is coming here, it may be that you'll get some help
+from the Continentals if you need it then. Good-by, Peter."
+
+"Good-by, Tom," replied his friend.
+
+Tom placed some bread in his pockets, and then started forth on his
+journey. Somewhere off towards Hopewell the American army must be,
+according to all the reports which had come, and to that place he must
+make his way. The time for which he had been waiting at last had come,
+and with a lighter heart than he had known for days the lad began his
+journey.
+
+The summer morning was clear and warm. The birds were flitting about in
+the trees and filling the air with their songs. In spite of the heat,
+there was a delicious freshness in the early morning air, and as he
+walked rapidly forward he soon came to feel a sense of exhilaration
+which not even the loss and grief of his boy friend could entirely
+banish.
+
+By the time the sun rose red and full in the east, he had placed several
+miles between him and Little Peter's home, but with unabated zeal he
+steadily pushed onward, resolved to make the best possible use of the
+early hours before the more intense heat of the day should come.
+
+By the middle of the forenoon more than ten miles had been left behind
+him, but he was beginning to feel the effects of his exertions. His face
+was flushed and streaming with perspiration. The rough road was hot and
+dusty, for only a single day had been required to dry out all the
+vestiges of the recent storm. He was beginning to feel somewhat tired,
+and was about to stop for a brief rest by the roadside, when he saw some
+one approaching on horseback.
+
+He quickly drew back among the trees which grew close to the road,
+thereby hoping to escape all notice by the stranger; but his plan was
+quickly changed when he discovered, as the horseman came nearer, that he
+was clad in the uniform of the Continental army. His relief was greater
+when he recognized the man as the son of one of Benzeor's neighbors, who
+more than a year before this time had enlisted and had passed the
+preceding winter in Valley Forge.
+
+He quickly resolved to hail the man as he passed, and accordingly
+stepped out into the road and waved his arms as a signal for the
+horseman to stop. The man quickly heeded, and as he drew the rein and
+checked his horse he peered down at the lad by the roadside, and Tom's
+fears were instantly relieved when he perceived that he had been
+recognized.
+
+"Why, Tom Coward, what are you doing here? Nothing wrong over home, is
+there?"
+
+"Yes, there is;" and Tom at once proceeded to give young Lieutenant
+Gordon an account of all that had occurred in the past three days.
+
+"That's bad," said the lieutenant slowly, patting his horse's dripping
+neck as he spoke. "That's bad. I wish I could take a company and go over
+there this minute. I can't, though; it's out of the question. But the
+army will be here shortly now, and there may be a chance to give these
+pine robbers a dose then. Where are you going now, Tom?"
+
+"I thought I'd start for the army," replied Tom. "I've no other place to
+go to, and I've been waiting to join it a long time."
+
+The lieutenant smiled at the lad's words as he replied, "That's all
+right. You're a well-grown fellow, and I doubt not they'll find a place
+somewhere for you in the Jersey militia. There are younger fellows than
+you there."
+
+"So I hear," replied Tom eagerly. "Indian John told me the army was over
+by Hopewell, and had halted there, so I thought I'd put straight for
+that place."
+
+"There isn't very much of the militia there now," said the lieutenant.
+"They're mostly regulars at Hopewell, and I doubt not have started from
+there before this."
+
+"Where are the militia then?" said Tom quickly. "I've got a rifle here,
+and if I'm to join them I want to know where they are."
+
+"That would be a little difficult to say just at present, my lad,"
+replied the lieutenant, assuming a more fatherly air than the
+difference between their years would seem to warrant. "That would be a
+little difficult to say."
+
+As Tom plainly showed his disappointment, the young officer continued:
+"You see it's this way, Tom. It was early in the morning of the 18th
+when the last of General Clinton's forces marched out of the city of
+Philadelphia. They went by the way of Gloucester Point, about three
+miles below Camden, and then the entire force, with Knyphausen and his
+Hessians in advance, marched over to Haddonfield and halted there. We
+had means up at Valley Forge of finding out what was going on, and
+before they were fairly out of Philadelphia some of our scouting parties
+and light horse were in the city, and they gathered in about sixty or
+seventy prisoners and were back again at the Forge with the men and the
+news. By three o'clock that same day General Lee's division had started,
+and by five o'clock General Wayne's had gone, too. They lost no time
+over there, I can tell you."
+
+"But I don't understand," said Tom. "Where are the militia, and what are
+you doing here?"
+
+"That's what I'm explaining to you," replied the lieutenant. "Well, at
+five o'clock the next morning,--that was the 19th of June, you
+know,--Washington had the rest of the army on the march for Coryell's
+Ferry; but the roads were so heavy--for we've been having some great
+rains this month--that the divisions which had been sent out didn't
+cross the Delaware until Saturday morning, and the main body till
+Monday. And all this time the British were mighty careful, let me tell
+you. They thought Washington was after their baggage-wagons and stores,
+you see. Clinton and his main body moved out of Haddonfield on Friday,
+but he left Knyphausen and his Dutch butchers, as well as two brigades
+of the regulars behind him, while he marched eight miles up to Evesham
+and went into camp there. He wanted to keep his train of baggage-wagons
+well protected, you see, for the militia were doing all sorts of
+mischief. You wanted to know where they were. Well, that's where they
+were."
+
+"They're away down at Haddonfield, then, are they?"
+
+"No, no. But they'd been sent out to bother the British, you see, and
+try to hold them back by skirmishes and a few such gentle deeds. They
+were tearing up bridges and firing at the regulars from the woods, and
+doing all sorts of things. Why, when Clinton was marching from
+Haddonfield to Evesham, General Leslie, who was in command of his
+advanced guard, fell in with a party of these very militia I'm telling
+you about. Leslie hid some of his men in a rye-field, and they saw
+Captain Jonathan Beesley. He was a captain in the Cumberland County
+militia, you know, and had been in the army two years,--yes, and he was
+one of the best men we ever had, too, let me tell you. Well, Leslie's
+men saw Beesley and a couple of his officers reconnoitring in advance of
+their companies, and they fired on them. Captain Beesley was wounded,
+and of course they took him prisoner and carried him with them into
+camp. They tried to get him to own up what Washington's plans were, but
+Captain Beesley just stopped them by saying they wouldn't get a word out
+of him. And they didn't; but the next day the poor fellow died from his
+wounds. They'd taken him into Hinchman Haines's house, you see, and that
+was where he died. I understand that they buried him there with the
+honors of war, and I understand, too, that they've given permission for
+the body to be taken up and placed in the Friends' burying-ground down
+at Haddonfield. It may have been done before this, for all that I know.
+Captain Beesley was a good man. The redcoats couldn't do too much for
+him."
+
+"But where are the militia now? That's what I want to know."
+
+"And that's what I'm trying to tell you. This is too hot to be standing
+out here in the road. Let's go into the shade. I've got time enough, and
+it may be a bit safer there, too."
+
+The lieutenant led his horse a short distance into the woods, and,
+slipping the bridle-rein over his head, he permitted him to graze, while
+he himself resumed his story.
+
+"At four o'clock the next morning,--that was Saturday, the
+20th,--Clinton took up the line of march, but he only went seven miles,
+as far as Mount Holly, and there he halted till Monday. On Sunday,
+Knyphausen joined him, having marched by the way of Moorestown. The next
+morning they all marched on to Black Horse and halted again, but at five
+o'clock Tuesday morning they were up and at it once more. They divided
+their forces there a bit, Leslie going by the way of Bordentown,
+Clinton keeping on along the road to Crosswicks, while Grant and the
+Dutch butchers brought up the rear and served as a kind of guard for the
+baggage-train. All this was only yesterday, the 23d, you see."
+
+"But where are the militia now?" protested Tom. "They are the ones I
+want to join, not the British. You keep telling me about them. What I
+want is the other side."
+
+"Listen, then, and you shall hear. Yesterday General Dickinson, with the
+Jersey militia, was right there in Bordentown."
+
+"What! when the British came up?"
+
+"Yes, when the British came up, that is, when Leslie's division did. Not
+all of the militia were there, though. A good many had been withdrawn
+and posted where they could do the most good. There weren't very many
+left in Bordentown, but when they found out that Leslie was almost upon
+them, they made up their minds in very short order that the climate
+there was not the best in the world, so they cleared out and left. But
+before they went they left a few slight tokens of their regard. They
+pulled up the planks of the bridge there over Crosswicks Creek, and
+raised the draw so that Leslie had to find another crossing-place.
+Before they did that they tried to fix up the bridge, but they were
+fired upon, and I understand that four were killed and quite a large
+number were wounded.
+
+"Clinton, too, wasn't finding his road all covered over with roses
+either. About five hundred of our men met him as he came up nearer to
+Crosswicks, and they thought they were ready, but they weren't anything
+of the kind. They had cut down a lot of trees and stretched them across
+the road, but that didn't stop the British. They came on just as if they
+didn't mind marching over such little things as trees, and there was a
+little skirmish there, and two or three of the redcoats were killed. One
+of their officers was shot and they took him up to a house near by, and
+left him there. Of course the Americans couldn't stand there long, but
+they didn't run very far.
+
+"Well, the British divisions joined then and started on again. They came
+to another bridge and our men had it all fixed so that they could just
+let it fall by one or two strokes of an axe. They had one or two little
+cannons there, too."
+
+"Who did? The British?"
+
+"No, our men. You know Sam Clevenger, don't you? Well, he stood there
+on the bridge with his axe in his hands when the British came in sight.
+He'd cut the sleepers almost through, and when he saw the redcoats
+coming, he lifted his axe, and the third time he struck down went the
+bridge and all. Then Clevenger started to run, but the British fired at
+him and he fell dead. They'd shot him in the back of the head. Our men
+then fired their cannon once or twice, but all they hit was the Friends'
+meeting-house. Of course the British didn't mind that, and then our men
+pulled back and left. That was only yesterday. I shouldn't be surprised
+if the British were over here by Allentown or Imlaystown now, or it may
+be both."
+
+"What! not more than ten or fifteen miles away?" said Tom excitedly.
+
+"That's what I say. And they'll be nearer, too, before they're farther
+off, let me tell you."
+
+"Why? How? What do you mean?"
+
+"They'll never go to Brunswick or Amboy, for Washington's right in front
+of them, and ready to head them off. They'll just have to come this way
+or go back, and that they won't do, for 'Britons never retrograde.'
+That's one of their pet words, you know. Isn't that what John Burgoyne
+said, too?"
+
+"I don't know anything about that," said Tom. "Then General Washington
+has been using a part of the militia and a part of the regulars to
+bother Clinton and keep him from getting to Brunswick or Amboy, has he?"
+
+"Yes, that's just it."
+
+"Well, I shan't have very far to go, then, to join them now."
+
+"Oh, you're not going to join them. You're coming with me. You're just
+such a lad as I have been looking for, and you can help me, if I'm not
+greatly mistaken."
+
+As Tom made no reply except to look up in surprise, the young officer at
+once began to explain to him the nature of the task to which he had
+referred.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+THE STORY OF THE MISCHIANZA
+
+
+"I'VE been sent out, as a good many others have been, to look up the
+bridges over the creeks" (the young officer called them "runs," as many
+of the Jerseymen did then, and still do for the matter of that) "and
+find out the lay of the land. As I happened to be born in Old Monmouth,
+and lived here till I was a man grown, it was naturally thought I'd be
+pretty well informed, so you see I was selected for this special work. I
+don't know that I object to it, but I'd rather be back with my men."
+
+"And that's what you've been doing, is it?" said Tom.
+
+"Yes, I've been in that work ever since the British started out from
+Philadelphia. I've kept just a little ahead of the men all the way, and
+have gone back every night to report, and then the next day they'd
+follow all my plans. You see I've got a map of every road in the county
+here," and as he spoke the young lieutenant drew from his pocket a
+paper on which had been traced every road and every little stream in the
+region, while the places where bridges were to be found were indicated
+by red marks.
+
+"Whew!" he added, throwing back his coat. "Isn't it warm! I don't
+believe there's been a summer like this in years. We've had showers and
+thunder-storms almost every day. The air now feels as if we'd get
+another one pretty soon, too."
+
+The air was exceedingly sultry, and a strange stillness seemed to be
+resting over all. Not a leaf was stirring, and as Tom looked up through
+the tops of the trees the bright blue of the sky appeared to be more
+intense than ever he had seen it before. Here and there separate masses
+of heavy clouds could be seen, which, with the sunlight streaming
+through them, glistened almost like silver. He knew the signs well.
+There was the appearance of a coming shower.
+
+"It's too hot to go on," said the young lieutenant. "I'm almost afraid
+to take my horse out in such heat. I've got the most of my work for the
+day done, though, and I thought that perhaps you might be able to help
+me out, Tom. You must know every bridge in this part of the country.
+Now you go over this map with me, and tell me if the places are marked
+right. I've been gone so long I'm not sure of myself, but you ought to
+know. It'll save me a trip in this broiling sun, if you can help me."
+
+Tom took the map and looked over it carefully. He was thoroughly
+familiar with the roads and streams, as the lieutenant had intimated,
+and in a brief time he had given him all the information he possessed.
+
+"There," said the lieutenant at last, folding the paper and restoring it
+to his pocket again, "that helps me out. I'd been over most of the way,
+and the two or three places you have told me about finishes the whole
+thing. I'm ready to go back and report. I think I'll take a bite,
+though, before I start, and wait and see what the weather is likely to
+be."
+
+Going to his saddle-bags the young officer brought out the dinner which
+he carried with him. "Sometimes I stop at some farmhouse and get
+something to eat," he explained, "but it isn't always safe to trust to
+that, you see, so I always go provided. I want you to join me, Tom.
+It'll seem almost like old times."
+
+The horse had been tied to one of the trees, and, as the lieutenant
+seated himself upon the ground, Tom gladly joined him. He was tired and
+hungry, and the piece of bread which he had in his own pocket would
+keep, and, as he was aware that he might find further use for it, he was
+the more willing to accept the invitation which had been given him. For
+a few minutes neither spoke, for they both seemed to be intent upon the
+immediate duty.
+
+As soon, however, as the first pangs of his hunger were relieved Tom
+said, "I never understood just why it was that the British left
+Philadelphia. They'd been there all winter, and after holding the city
+so long I never could understand why it was that they abandoned it
+without even a skirmish. What did they do it for?"
+
+"Why, the way of it was this," replied the lieutenant, taking an
+unusually large bite of the bread he was holding in his hand, as he
+spoke. "You see, we'd been trying for a long time to get up some kind of
+a treaty with France. Ben Franklin, and I don't know who all, had been
+over there trying to work it up, and at last the Frenchmen agreed. Our
+Congress ratified the treaty on the 4th of last May, and that
+completely changed the plans of the redcoats."
+
+"I don't see just how that could do it," replied Tom, somewhat puzzled.
+
+"Why it really means a declaration of war by the French against the
+British. I don't believe the Frenchmen care very much for us, barring
+young Lafayette and a few others of his kind, but they hate the British,
+and took this way to get even with them. It's expected that they'll send
+a fleet over here, and of course the redcoats have got to be ready to
+meet it,--that is, if they can. Well, Philadelphia doesn't amount to
+very much any way in war times. It isn't very easy to get into it, so
+the British there thought they'd better get out and go over to New York,
+which was a good deal more likely to be threatened by the French fleets.
+That's the cause of the change, my lad."
+
+"I should think the redcoats would feel like giving up, now that the
+French are going to join us."
+
+The young officer laughed as he replied: "That's just where you're
+mistaken, my young friend. They don't feel that way after they've sent
+so many armies over here and have spent so much money in discovering
+us, you see. And then, too, they don't object to getting a few taxes and
+such like things out of us, either. I've a dim suspicion that the
+Frenchmen may have just a bit of a dream that they may get back some of
+the country that dropped out of their hands during the French and Indian
+war. But, however that may be, we're glad to have their help now, for we
+need it badly enough, and will have to let the future take care of
+itself."
+
+"I don't see that any one can blame the British for wanting to hold on
+to us. They have spent a lot of money, and lots of their soldiers have
+been killed in the wars with the Indians and the Frenchmen."
+
+"Oh no, we don't blame them," laughed the lieutenant. "We don't blame
+them. It's all natural enough for them to want to hold on to us, but how
+about ourselves? What about the Stamp Act and the tea tax? What about
+all their oppression and the way they've treated us? They seem to forget
+that we're men of like passions with themselves. Oh, it's all natural
+enough for them to want to keep a good hold on us, but it's just as
+natural for us to object to being held on to. And, Tom, such things as
+have happened lately, too! Why, this story about Little Peter's mother
+is only one of a thousand here in Jersey. I've been pretty much all over
+the colony--the state, I mean--and it's the same story everywhere. It's
+just plundering, and robbing, and worse. And then to bring over here
+those Dutch butchers,--that's the worst of it all! To think of hiring
+those butchers! Why, it just makes my blood boil to think of it! And
+against us, too, who are their own blood relatives! That's more than
+human nature can stand!"
+
+Tom felt the contagion of the young lieutenant's enthusiasm, but he made
+no reply, and his companion continued, "The redcoats had a great time
+when they cleared out of Philadelphia. I was there and saw it myself."
+
+"You were there? I thought you were up at Valley Forge all winter!"
+
+"So I was, when I wasn't in Philadelphia. I had to go there sometimes,
+but I never wore my uniform then. Oh no, I didn't think it was very
+becoming to my peculiar style of beauty, so I always left it behind me."
+
+"What were you, a spy?"
+
+"That isn't what we call it," replied the young officer, lowering his
+voice and glancing quickly about him at Tom's words, "Never mind what I
+was, but I was there and that's enough. I'm telling you now about the
+time the redcoats had when Sir William Howe gave over the command to Sir
+Henry Clinton. His officers got it up as a kind of a farewell, you see.
+They called it the Mischianza."
+
+"What's that? I don't understand."
+
+"What, the Mischianza? Oh, that's an Italian word, and means a 'mix up'
+or a 'medley,' or some such thing; I don't know just what. But I'm
+telling you now what it was, and what they did. It commenced with a kind
+of a regatta which they'd arranged in three divisions. Up the river in
+front came the Ferret galley, and on board were some of the general
+officers and their ladies. Then came the Centre galley,--that was called
+the Hussar,--and carried both the Howes and Clinton and their suites,
+along with a lot of ladies. Behind came the Cornwallis galley, in which
+were Knyphausen and some of the British generals, and, of course, a lot
+of ladies.
+
+"Well, sir, they looked fine, I can tell you, for I was in the crowd
+which watched the affair from the shore, and I saw every bit of it. On
+each quarter of the galleys there were five flatboats, all lined with
+green, and having lots of people on board. Then, in front of the
+galleys, were three more flatboats, and a band of music was on board of
+each, and they could play, too, let me tell you, if they were redcoats.
+Six rowed along each flank, and they were all dressed up in bright
+colors, and so were the ships and the transport boats, which made a line
+all the way down to the city. All the wharves were crowded and the
+people were just wild. The boats started out from Knight's wharf--that's
+away up in the northern part of the city, you know--and rowed all the
+way down to Market wharf. There they rested on their oars, the bands
+played 'God save the King,' the people shouted and sang, and I couldn't
+help feeling something of the excitement, though I hate the very sight
+of a redcoat.
+
+"Well, they landed at the Old Fort, and the bands were still playing,
+and the Roebuck fired seventeen guns and then the Vigilant fired
+seventeen more. The grenadiers had been drawn up in a double file on
+shore, and the company then marched up between the lines. They had
+horsemen there, too, and what with the bright dresses of the ladies and
+the bright favors of blue and white ribbons on the breasts of the
+managers, who moved in front of the procession, and the uniforms and
+all, it was a great sight. I should have thought Lord Howe would almost
+have been sorry he was going to leave.
+
+"The avenue led up to a big lawn, which was all fixed up with arches and
+rows of benches, rising one above another, where the ladies were to be
+seated; and then they had some tilts and tournaments, something as they
+used to have in old England. There were young ladies there, too, lots of
+them, and they were all dressed up in Turkish costumes, and such like.
+
+"Pretty soon the trumpets sounded, and then a band of knights, dressed
+in red and white silk, on horses all decked out in the same colors,
+advanced. Lord Cathcart was the chief, and he had squires to carry his
+lances and others to carry his shield, and two black slaves with silver
+clasps on their bare necks and arms held his stirrups. The band then
+marched around the square and saluted the ladies, and then the herald,
+after a great flourish of trumpets, declared the ladies of the Blended
+Rose were ahead of all others.
+
+"When the challenge had been given the third time, some other heralds
+and a trumpeter came in, along with a lot of knights dressed up in black
+and orange, and after going through a lot of motions and the bands had
+played, the herald proclaimed that the Knights of the Burning Mountain
+were prepared to contest the claim of the others. Then the gauntlet was
+thrown down and picked up, and the encounter began.
+
+"After they had met four times, the two leaders, Lord Cathcart and
+Captain Watson, advanced and began a contest between themselves. After
+they had kept it up a little while, the marshal of the field rushed in
+between them, and declared the ladies were all right on either side, and
+commanded the men to stop. Then bands filed off in different directions,
+playing lively tunes and saluting the ladies as they marched.
+
+"Then the whole company marched through great arches to the garden, and
+then up into the hall, which had been painted up to resemble Sienna
+marble. They had a faro table in that room and one great cornucopia all
+filled with flowers and fruit, and another one empty. Then they went to
+the ballroom, which was all painted in pale blue, and there were
+festoons of flowers, and I don't know what all. I never saw anything
+like it before. There were eighty-five big mirrors in the room, and they
+were all fixed out with ribbons and flowers, and as they sent back the
+light from the branches of waxlights, it made the room look bright
+enough, I can tell you. On that same floor they had four drawing-rooms,
+where they got their refreshments, and these rooms were all decorated
+and lighted up, too.
+
+"They kept up the dancing till ten, and then the fireworks began and the
+windows were all thrown open. I remember that the first of the fireworks
+was a great bouquet of rockets,--but that was only one, and they kept it
+up till twelve o'clock.
+
+"When midnight came, the great folding doors, which had been all covered
+over with flowers so that no one knew they were there, were thrown open,
+and there was a great room all decorated and lighted up, most too
+wonderful to tell about; and there, too, was a great table, which they
+said had twelve hundred dishes on it--just think of that, will you?--and
+four hundred and thirty people could sit down to the table at the same
+time.
+
+"They had supper then, and when they had finished that part of the
+programme the herald and trumpeters entered and proclaimed the health of
+the king and the royal family. Of course all the people there responded,
+and then there was a toast for the knights, and the ladies, and lots of
+others, and there was a great flourish of trumpets as each toast was
+announced.
+
+"Then they all went back to the ballroom and began to dance again. They
+kept it up till four o'clock, and I don't know how much later, for I
+left then."
+
+"And you saw it all?" said Tom slowly.
+
+"Yes, almost every bit of it; 'twas a great sight, too. The like of it
+has never been seen before on this side of the water, and never will be
+again, I'm thinking. By the way, Tom, I heard a man there called by your
+name. It was Captain Coward, I think--though it may have been colonel or
+judge; I don't just recollect."
+
+"I'm sorry for him."
+
+"You needn't be. Just show that the name's of no account. But I've got
+to start now. I wish I could take you with me, but I can't. I'll see you
+soon, though, so good luck to you till we meet again."
+
+"But it's raining," said Tom quickly, as the patter of the falling
+drops could be heard on the leaves.
+
+"Can't stop for that; I'm due at five o'clock, rain or no rain. Good-by
+to you, Tom, and thank you for your help. You've saved me a hard ride in
+such a day as this!"
+
+The young lieutenant was gone, and Tom waited for the shower to pass.
+The rain continued only a few minutes, but left the air still more
+sultry than it had been before, and walking became much more difficult.
+
+However, Tom started on as soon as the rain ceased, and kept steadily to
+his work until the sun was low in the heavens. His thoughts had been
+withdrawn, in a measure, from the camp at Hopewell, and he was thinking
+of the description which the young lieutenant had given of the
+Mischianza, and the brilliant scene which it must have presented. What
+could the poor and desperate Continentals do against men who had feasts
+like that? And Captain, or Colonel, Coward, who was he? Tom found
+himself thinking of the man, and wondering how he came to have the name.
+
+He turned the bend in the road and saw a band of soldiers marching
+directly toward him, and not far away. Startled by the sight, he
+stopped a moment and gazed intently at them, striving to discover
+whether they wore red coats or buff; but they were covered with dust and
+he could not decide.
+
+He quickly realized that he must act, and he had just turned about,
+prepared to run back in the road, when he heard several shots fired at
+the approaching men from the woods by the roadside.
+
+The band instantly halted and prepared to defend themselves. Without
+waiting to watch the contest, he once more turned to run, when he
+obtained a glimpse of men behind him, partially concealed among the
+trees and standing with their guns raised to their shoulders, and with
+their attention fixed upon the advancing soldiers.
+
+Were the men friends or foes? Tom could not determine; and, trembling
+with fear and excitement, he stopped. He was between the opposing bands,
+while off on his right it was evident that other men were concealed.
+Thoughts of the Mischianza and of the captain with the unfortunate name
+were all gone now. He could not advance; he dared not retreat.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+TO REFUGEE TOWN
+
+
+WHEN Little Peter reentered the lonely house after his friend Tom
+departed, the full sense of his own sorrow for the first time swept over
+him. Up to this time the necessity of action had prevented him from
+fully realizing his loss. The death of his mother, the capture of his
+father, the provision he was compelled to make at once for his younger
+brothers and sisters, had so absorbed his thoughts that he had had but
+little time to dwell upon his own sorrow.
+
+With the departure of Tom, however, there came the reaction, and for a
+few moments the heartbroken lad was almost overcome. The very silence
+was oppressive. The only sound he could hear was the loud and regular
+ticking of the tall clock which stood in one corner of the kitchen. How
+proud his mother had always felt of that ancient timepiece! Many a time
+had she told him of its history and the pride with which she had
+received it from her own father, when as a young bride she had first
+entered the new house which henceforth was to be hers. To Peter, it
+almost seemed as if the stately clock had been a member of the family,
+and its voice was almost human to him. On the summer afternoons, when he
+was a little fellow and his mother had been busied in her household
+duties, he had often stretched himself upon the sanded floor, and,
+resting his face upon his hands, with eager eyes had gazed up into the
+face of the old timepiece and listened to the swing of its long
+pendulum, which for him had had a language all its own.
+
+And now in the light of the early morning the old clock still stood in
+the corner and regularly ticked off the passing hours, as if it were
+unmindful of all the sad scenes to which it had recently been a witness.
+And yet to Peter it almost seemed, too, as if there was a tone of
+sadness after all in the monotonous tickings that day. Perhaps the old
+clock was striving to express its sympathy for the sorrowing boy, but
+not even its sympathy must be permitted to interfere with its duty in
+marking the passage of the swiftly flying minutes.
+
+The few antiquated chairs were standing just as they had stood when his
+mother had been there. The brass-rimmed mirror, the one ornament of the
+room, which hung over the low mantelpiece, reflected the scene before
+it, but in all the picture one figure was wanting and would be
+forevermore. Overcome by the full knowledge of his loss, Little Peter
+bowed his head upon his hands and leaned low upon the table, and burst
+into a flood of tears--the first he had shed since the sad event had
+occurred. Indian John was forgotten, the few chores about the place were
+ignored, and for a time the heartbroken lad gave way to his sorrow for
+the loss of his mother, upon whose face he never was to look again.
+
+How long he remained in that attitude he did not know, but he was
+recalled to the necessities of the present by the sound of footsteps
+outside the door. His first thought was that Indian John had returned,
+and he hastily rose to greet him; but quickly he perceived that the
+new-comer was not his Indian friend, but Barzilla Giberson, one of his
+nearest neighbors. If Little Peter had looked carefully into his
+neighbor's face, he would doubtless have noticed that the man was
+evidently somewhat troubled, and apparently was not overjoyed at the
+prospect of an interview; but the lad was too busied with his own
+thoughts and sorrows to bestow a critical examination upon a neighbor's
+countenance, and Barzilla's evident uneasiness, therefore, was all
+passed by unnoticed.
+
+"Good-morrow to you, Little Peter," said Barzilla. "The women folks
+wanted me to come over and say to you that you were welcome to make your
+home with them, if you so chose."
+
+"Thank you, Barzilla," replied Peter. "If I were going to stay here I
+should be glad to do that, but I'm going away this morning."
+
+"Sho! Ye don't say so! Where ye goin', if I may be so bold as to ask?"
+
+"I'm going to look up my father."
+
+"Where ye goin' to look him up?" said Barzilla, somewhat uneasily.
+
+"I'm going down to Refugee Town first. I don't know what I'll do if I
+don't find him there."
+
+"Ye won't find him there," said Barzilla quickly. "In course I don't
+know where he is," he hastily added, "but I don't b'lieve ye'll find him
+there; and, besides, that's no place for a lad like you to go to alone,
+for I take it ye're goin' alone?"
+
+"Yes, I'm going alone," replied Peter, to whom Barzilla's anxiety was
+not apparent.
+
+"In course it isn't for me to say what ye shall do and what ye shan't,
+but I don't believe a trip there will do ye any good. Ye've got to
+remember that other folks has suffered, too. Yer marm isn't the only one
+that's been shot, and yer pop isn't the only man that's been carried off
+by the British."
+
+"It wasn't the British that carried my father away," said Peter quickly.
+
+"'Twan't the British? Who was it then, I'd like to know?"
+
+"'Twas Fenton and his band, that's who it was."
+
+"Sho! I can't believe that! I reckon ye're mistaken, Peter. It must 'a'
+been the redcoats."
+
+"It was Fenton," repeated Peter decidedly.
+
+"I can't b'lieve it," said Barzilla, rising as he spoke. "I can't
+b'lieve it. However, Peter, we'll look after yer place. The women folks
+or I will do the chores for ye, while ye're gone. It's only neighborly,
+ye know, and what's friends good for if they can't help in a time like
+this?"
+
+"Thank you," said Peter quietly. "There isn't much to be done, but if
+you'll look after what there is, I shall be glad. The children are at
+Benzeor's house, you know."
+
+"So I hear. So I hear. Well, they're in good hands; ye can rest easy
+about that. Well, I must be a-goin'. Ye still think ye'd better go down
+to Refugee Town, do ye?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, good luck to ye. Good luck to ye. We'll look after the place,"
+called Barzilla as he departed.
+
+If Peter had gone to the door, he would have discovered that Barzilla
+had not departed to go to his own house, but that after he had entered
+the road he had turned quickly and started in the direction in which the
+Navesink lay. But as Peter did not rise from his seat, he missed all
+that, and, besides, in all probability he would only have been puzzled
+by his neighbor's actions and unable to account for the haste with which
+he had made the change.
+
+Peter prepared his breakfast, and then waited for the coming of Indian
+John. The minutes passed, but the Indian did not put in an appearance,
+and the lad began to suspect that he would not return. At last, when the
+sun had appeared, his suspicions passed into certainty, and, resolving
+to wait for him no longer, he closed the house and started resolutely
+on the path which led down to the bank of the Navesink, where he kept
+his little skiff concealed.
+
+He soon arrived at the familiar place, and, after taking his oars from
+their hiding-place on the bank, pushed the little boat out into the
+stream and began to row. The heat of the morning soon began to make
+itself felt, but Peter did not cease from his labors. He was thinking of
+his father and where he might then be. He was hoping that he would be
+retained and sent to New York as a prisoner, for Little Peter was well
+aware of the value of the reward which was offered for every prisoner
+taken; but Fenton, eager as he was for money, was not likely to incur
+any unnecessary risk for himself by keeping any one near him who might
+prove to be a source of danger. And Little Peter knew that his father,
+especially after the recent events, was not likely to be quiet. Of what
+might then occur, the lad hardly dared to think. He only knew that what
+he was to do must be done quickly, if it was to avail, and he rowed on
+and on without once stopping for rest.
+
+He had covered about half the distance he was to go, when he heard a
+hail from down the river. Hastily turning about at the unexpected
+summons, he saw a little cat-boat slowly coming up the river, and now
+not many yards away.
+
+"It's Benzeor Osburn," said Peter to himself, as he obtained a glimpse
+of the man at the helm. "But who's that with him? It's Jacob Van Note.
+Yes, and that's Barzilla Giberson, too. What in the world"--
+
+His meditations were interrupted by Benzeor's hail, "Where ye bound this
+mornin', Little Peter? There's to be no lookout to-day, is there?"
+
+"I haven't heard of any," replied Peter, looking at Barzilla and
+striving to understand how it was that the man who had so recently left
+his house could now be with Benzeor sailing up the Navesink.
+
+"I came down here after I left you," said Barzilla, as if he felt that
+he must reply to the question expressed in Peter's manner, "and I fell
+in with Benzeor, so I stopped and came back to tell him all about the
+doin's that have been goin' on since he went away. Benzeor's been gone
+from home two days and more, ye know."
+
+"Has he?" replied Peter. "No. I didn't know. Benzeor, the children are
+at your house. Sarah said I could leave them there and she'd look after
+them. If it isn't all right, I'll take them away as soon as I come
+back."
+
+"It's all right. In course it's all right. Barzilla here has been
+tellin' me about your troubles. It's hard, Peter, but then ye know that
+lots of people have been served the same way. 'Misery loves company,' ye
+know."
+
+As Peter made no reply, Benzeor quickly began to talk again, too quickly
+the lad might have perceived, if he had not been so filled with his own
+thoughts that all else seemed to escape his observation. "Barzilla tells
+me as how ye're goin' down to Refugee Town to look up yer pop. Is that
+so?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, I'm tellin' ye it won't do any good. He isn't there--leastwise,
+that is, I don't believe he's there. In course I don't know anything
+about it, but it stands to reason he isn't. Ye'd better let me take yer
+skiff in tow, as I've done with Barzilla's, and come along back with
+us."
+
+"I think I'll go on. If I don't find him there I can report to Captain
+Dennis. Perhaps he'll be able to help me a bit, if it's not too late."
+
+Captain Dennis was in command of the local militia, and he and his men
+already had had several skirmishes with the pine robbers. Indeed, the
+militia had been enrolled with the very purpose of protecting the
+scattered homes from the inroads of the outlaws and refugees. Thus far,
+however, their efforts had not met with a very marked success.
+
+Peter did not observe the scowl which crept over Benzeor's face at the
+mention of the name of Captain Dennis. "Have it your own way then," said
+the man gruffly. "They say there's no fool like an old fool, but for
+downright foolishness give me the young fool every time. I'm tellin' ye
+that ye won't find yer pop down at Refugee Town, but ye'll have to find
+it out for yerself, I suppose."
+
+Surprised as Peter was at the abrupt change in Benzeor's manner, his own
+purpose was not changed, and without replying he picked up his oars and
+began to row again. He could see the men in earnest conversation as he
+drew away from them, but it had not yet entered his thoughts that
+anything could be wrong with them. He was puzzled to account for
+Barzilla's unexpected presence, but his offer to look after his home in
+his absence was still fresh in his mind, and left no room for suspicion.
+
+As for Benzeor, Little Peter knew that he was considered as a strange
+man,--"odd," the country people termed it,--and he gave little heed to
+him or his words. His one purpose now was to go to Refugee Town. He had
+but little fear of meeting the men who had assembled there, although he
+knew they were all desperate and reckless. They would not harm him, he
+thought, and it was possible that he might find his father there, or
+learn of his whereabouts. Just what he would do if he should find him,
+he did not know. In any event, he would be with him again, and if he was
+to be sent as a prisoner to the sugar-house in New York, or to the
+Whitby or the Jersey, at least his captivity might be shared.
+
+Accordingly, Little Peter rowed steadily forward and in the course of an
+hour arrived at the mouth of the Navesink. Then he landed and hauled his
+skiff up on the shore, striving to conceal it among the bushes which
+grew there. It was only a mile now across the sandy strip to the shore
+of the ocean, and the lad began to walk rapidly. Refugee Town was not
+far away, and the end of his journey would soon be gained.
+
+The heat of the sun was now intense. Across the sands he could see
+eddies in the heated air, and he felt as if he were breathing the blasts
+from an oven. His face was streaming with perspiration, while the touch
+of the sand beneath his feet seemed almost as if it would blister them.
+
+He soon arrived at a place from which he could look out upon the ocean,
+and it was with a sigh of relief he felt its first cool breath upon his
+face. Refugee Town now was not far away, so he began to run.
+
+He stopped as he saw two gunboats riding at anchor about a quarter of a
+mile out from the shore. What could it all mean? They were British
+vessels, their flags disclosed that; but what was their purpose in
+casting their anchors there?
+
+He was upon the beach now, and stopped for a moment to gaze at the
+graceful vessels. He thought he could almost make out the figures of the
+sailors on the deck. And a little boat was just approaching the larger
+of the gunboats. Doubtless it had been ashore and was now returning.
+
+"How!"
+
+Peter turned suddenly as he heard the exclamation, and saw Indian John
+standing before him. His alarm subsided as he recognized his friend, and
+he said reprovingly, "I thought you were going to go with me this
+morning, John. Why didn't you?"
+
+"John been. Go to 'Gee Town. No fader there."
+
+"What, my father isn't there? Are you sure, John?"
+
+The Indian made no reply, evidently considering his first words
+sufficient. He was gazing intently at the boats in the distance, and
+Little Peter almost unconsciously turned and followed his look. At first
+he could discover nothing to indicate what had interested his companion;
+but he soon saw that the little boat, which he had thought was returning
+to the gunboat, was coming to the shore. Startled by the sight, he was
+about to inquire of John whether he knew anything concerning the
+vessels, when he heard a shout.
+
+At a distance of a hundred yards up the beach he saw a motley crowd
+approaching. Negroes and poorly clad men were among them, and the
+appearance of all revealed that they were doubtless from Refugee Town.
+
+Their own presence was discovered at the same time, and a shout greeted
+them.
+
+"Come!" said Indian John quickly; and in an instant Little Peter obeyed,
+and both were running swiftly over the sand along the beach.
+
+Their flight was greeted by another shout from the men behind them, and
+one or two guns were discharged, but the bullets passed harmlessly over
+the heads of the fugitives. One glance, however, showed Peter that some
+of the men had started in pursuit.
+
+"They're after us, John!" he said in a low voice to his companion.
+
+Instantly increasing their efforts, they sped swiftly on in their
+flight, but the shouts, which were now redoubled, betrayed that the
+pursuit had not been abandoned. On and on ran pursuers and pursued,
+while at intervals a gun was discharged and the calls and shouts could
+be distinctly heard.
+
+[Illustration: "THEY'RE AFTER US, JOHN!"]
+
+For a half mile the flight had continued, and Peter was beginning to
+feel that he could go no farther. The hot air of the summer morning, the
+burning sand beneath his feet, as well as the weariness arising from his
+previous exertions, combined to sap his strength. His breath was coming
+in gasps now, and down his face the perspiration was pouring in
+streams. He felt that he could go no farther.
+
+Another glance behind him showed that the men had not abandoned the
+pursuit. A half dozen of them were still running swiftly along the
+beach, and to Little Peter it seemed as if they were gaining upon him.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+BATHSHEBA'S FEAST
+
+
+INDIAN JOHN had been slightly changing the direction in which they were
+running, although Little Peter had not perceived the change. At first
+they had kept close to the water's edge, and at times the creeping tide
+had rolled up to their feet. As his companion had gradually drawn closer
+to the higher ridge which extended somewhat farther back from the beach,
+Peter had thought nothing of the slight divergence, except that the
+Indian was desirous of keeping a little farther from the water.
+
+Along this ridge in advance of him, Peter saw that thick bushes and
+stunted trees were growing, and he thought of the possibility of finding
+some hiding-place there; but he was hardly prepared for the change which
+Indian John then made. They had just passed a bend in the ridge which
+shut out the view of their pursuers, and come to a little gully which
+the winter storms had in the course of many years cut deep into the
+bank. Here Indian John turned sharply, and, bidding his companion follow
+him, turned directly into the woods, which extended from the shore far
+back into the adjoining country.
+
+Little Peter instantly followed, but they had not gone many yards before
+they came suddenly upon a wigwam in the midst of the forest. Indian John
+stopped, and, after a few hurried words with the Indian who was standing
+near and who had silently watched the approaching fugitives, beckoned
+for Peter to follow him, and both entered the conical shaped dwelling
+and threw themselves upon the ground.
+
+The lad was so thankful for the respite, and was so nearly exhausted by
+his efforts, that for a time he said nothing, being only too glad of an
+opportunity to rest. Every moment he expected to hear the voices of
+their pursuers, and more than once was on the point of starting forth
+from the hut and resuming his flight, so certain was he that the men had
+discovered the hiding-place.
+
+After a time he was positive that he was not deceived. He could hear the
+voices of men in conversation with the Indians, and all of his fears
+returned. His companion placed his hand upon the arm of the trembling
+lad, and Peter waited, listening intently, and fearful every moment that
+some one would enter the hut and summon them to come forth.
+
+The conversation lasted several minutes, and then abruptly ceased. Peter
+could not determine whether the strangers had departed or not; but he
+waited anxiously and did not speak.
+
+The moments slowly passed and his suspense increased. It seemed to him
+that he must escape from the place in which he was concealed. The very
+air was strangely oppressive, and the ignorance as to what was going on
+outside the wigwam increased the anxiety of the frightened boy.
+
+He did not know where he was, nor who were the people whose abode Indian
+John had so unceremoniously entered. No voice within or without the hut
+could now be heard, and the silence itself added to his alarm.
+
+He could see that Indian John was seated upon the ground with his head
+resting upon his knees. He had not moved nor changed his position since
+they had entered. Motionless as a statue he remained seated, as if he
+were utterly unmindful of all about him.
+
+"John!" whispered Little Peter at last.
+
+The Indian raised his head and looked at his companion, but did not
+speak.
+
+"John, don't you think we'd better start on again?"
+
+Indian John still made no reply, and his head dropped again upon his
+knees. Peter then perceived that his companion intended neither to speak
+nor to depart, and that he must wait in silence for him to explain his
+purpose, or to act.
+
+The impatient lad endeavored to possess his soul in patience, but as the
+moments passed his anxiety and fear increased. The uncertainty, he
+thought, was even more difficult to be borne than was the pursuit
+itself, for action of some kind was then possible, while this waiting in
+silence was almost unbearable. Not a sound could now be heard. The very
+birds were silent under the burning heat of the noontime, and the
+grating notes of the crickets had ceased.
+
+At last it seemed to him he could bear it no longer, and he was about to
+arise and go forth from the hut, regardless of consequences, when some
+one entered and spoke a few words in an unknown tongue to Indian John.
+
+"Come," said the Indian gently, standing erect as he spoke; and Little
+Peter at once followed him out into the open air.
+
+He glanced quickly about him, but no one was to be seen except three
+Indians, one of whom was a man, and the others, two women. Little Peter
+instantly recognized them as Moluss, or "Charlie" Moluss, as many of the
+whites called him, and his wife and her sister.
+
+The two women were busily engaged in preparing the contents of a small
+iron vessel, which was hanging from a stick supported by two forked
+branches, driven into the ground, and beneath which a brisk fire was
+burning.
+
+One of the women was feeding the fire, while the other was stirring the
+contents of the hanging pot. A savory odor greeted Little Peter's
+nostrils, and as soon as he perceived that he was in no immediate danger
+he realized that he was hungry; and, with the passing of his alarm,
+there came an eager interest in the occupation of the two women before
+him.
+
+Little Peter had seen the trio many times before this. They had their
+home with others of their tribe in a little settlement several miles
+back in the interior. This settlement was commonly known as Edgepelick,
+or Edge Pillock, and to it the Indians had gradually withdrawn after
+they had disposed of their lands, for the good people of Old Monmouth
+were as scrupulous as their New England cousins in not taking the lands
+from the dusky owners without giving a so-called equivalent for them.
+
+It is true that this "equivalent" sometimes was a barrel of cider, or a
+piece of bright-colored cloth; but perhaps the Indians thought that was
+better than nothing, and as their lands were certain to be taken from
+them, even such an equivalent as that which was offered was not to be
+despised, and so they had submitted to the unequal exchange. At all
+events, the exchanges had been made, and in the summer of 1778, many of
+the Indian families were dwelling in Edge Pillock, and there continued
+to reside until the year 1802, when the men who had driven such shrewd
+bargains with them caused them all to be removed to Oneida Lake, in the
+neighboring State of New York.
+
+Charlie Moluss, with his wife and her sister, had been frequent visitors
+in Little Peter's home, and he knew them almost as well as he did Indian
+John. Somehow, they had not been content to abide continuously in Edge
+Pillock, and at least twice each year came down to the shore, where they
+erected a wigwam, and while Moluss fished and gathered oysters and
+clams, the women made baskets and sold them among the scattered homes of
+the settlers. Doubtless this, then, was their annual visit, thought
+Little Peter, and their abiding place had been known to Indian John, who
+had sought its shelter as a place of refuge from their pursuers. And
+Little Peter was quite content, at least for the present, and his
+feeling of relief was not diminished by the savory odor which now arose
+from the iron vessel.
+
+Charlie Moluss's wife was a strikingly handsome Indian woman, and was
+known as Bathsheba, which the irreverent settlers had shortened into
+"Bath," as they had her sister's name into "Suke."
+
+Bathsheba was considered as an Indian queen, and the respect which the
+Indians showed her was, to a certain extent, shared by the white people,
+especially by the Quakers. She was regarded as a highly intelligent
+woman, and the most prominent people of the region were always glad to
+welcome her to their homes.
+
+Little Peter thought of all these things as he seated himself upon the
+ground beside the two men, who were, apparently, as deeply interested in
+the occupation of the women as was he, himself. The work went steadily
+on, and, while Peter found that his hunger was increasing, he
+nevertheless listened to what Indian John told him of Moluss's success
+in turning their pursuers back to their camp at Refugee Town. Some of
+them had followed the fugitives as far as the wigwam, but had turned
+away after the Indian had professed his inability to give them the
+information they desired, and, doubtless, before this time, were safely
+back in "'Gee Town," as Indian John termed their little settlement by
+the Hook.
+
+Just why they had been pursued Indian John could not explain, but he had
+connected it in some way with the appearance of the boat off the shore,
+and Little Peter was not inclined to differ from his conclusion. He was
+satisfied now that his father was not to be found in Refugee Town, and
+he had decided to go farther down the shore to the place where he
+thought he would be likely to find Captain Dennis, or some of the local
+militia who had been stationed near to protect the salt works and
+strive to hold back the pine robbers, many of whom had their places of
+concealment not far away.
+
+Just at present, however, the thought of his dinner was uppermost in his
+mind. He eagerly watched Bathsheba and her sister in their work, and,
+from their movements, he concluded that his waiting time was soon to
+end. One of the women entered the wigwam and brought out several small
+wooden bowls. Into these she dipped some of the steaming contents of the
+iron vessel, placing each bowl upon the ground when it had been filled.
+
+A word from Bathsheba caused Moluss to arise, and, approaching the fire,
+he took one of the bowls in both hands and then seated himself upon the
+ground and proceeded to blow with his breath upon the soup, preparatory
+to drinking it.
+
+His example was speedily followed by Indian John and Little Peter, who
+took their bowls and seated themselves beside Moluss on the ground. An
+expression of deep satisfaction was manifest upon the faces of the two
+men, while the women, apparently proud of their success in the culinary
+art, looked on with evident pleasure. Little Peter also raised the bowl
+in his hands and blew upon it.
+
+"Good!" said Moluss, taking a long draught. "Good hop! Hop good!"
+
+"Good!" muttered Indian John, following his friend's example. "Good hop!
+Good hop!"
+
+"What?" said Little Peter suddenly, placing his bowl again on the ground
+before him as he spoke. "What was that you said, John?"
+
+"Good! Good hop," replied the Indian, with evident satisfaction.
+
+"You don't mean to say that hop-toads are in this soup, do you?"
+
+"Um!" replied Indian John, with a grunt of pleasure. "Good! Little
+hop-hop! John like um! Good hop! John like um little hop-hop!" And,
+suiting the action to the word, he proceeded to take a deeper draught of
+the savory mixture.
+
+All of Little Peter's hunger, however, had disappeared. He quickly arose
+from his seat, and, with an expression of disgust upon his face, which
+he could not entirely repress, prepared to pass the group and go into
+the forest.
+
+A loud laugh greeted his action, and as he passed Moluss, the Indian
+held forth his bowl, and said, "Peter like um hop-hop? Good! Moluss like
+um hop-hop! John like um hop-hop! Squaw like um hop-hop! All like um
+hop-hop! All like um hop-hop! Peter like um, too?"
+
+Little Peter was not to be tempted, and the broad grin upon the faces of
+the women, as well as the loud laugh of the men which followed him as he
+turned into the forest, did not tend to overcome his feeling of disgust.
+How was it possible that they could be willing to eat such filthy
+creatures as hop-toads? Little Peter was all in ignorance of some of the
+dainty viands which, under high-sounding names, are served up in our
+modern restaurants, and so, as a matter of course, could draw no
+comparison between the tastes of the rude, uncivilized savages and those
+of the more highly cultivated men of our own times. Perhaps he would not
+have compared them if he had been possessed of the prophet's foresight.
+He knew, however, that his own hunger had disappeared, and as he walked
+on he found many excuses for his uncivilized friends. They were welcome
+to their own customs, but they must not expect him to join them in their
+feasts.
+
+He had gone so far from the wigwam by this time that he thought the
+repast, which had so highly delighted his friends, would be ended by
+the time he could walk back. Accordingly, he reversed his steps, but as
+he walked on his own pressing problem returned in full force.
+
+His father was not to be found in Refugee Town, of that he felt certain;
+for, while Indian John had not said much, he knew him so well that he
+was satisfied he had known whereof he had spoken.
+
+Where, then, could he be? It was currently reported that Fenton's band
+had a place in the lower part of the county, to which they carried their
+booty and from which they started forth on their raids. It was just
+possible that his father had been taken there by the outlaws in their
+flight, but he would not long be retained there. Fenton knew what
+American prisoners were worth in the New York market, and, doubtless, he
+would find some means by which he could send him there. And the pine
+robber would act soon, too, for with the approach of the armies, there
+would be many opportunities for his own special work, and he would not
+long be hampered by the presence of a single prisoner, whose value would
+be slight compared with that of the plunder he might secure.
+
+Little Peter decided that what he was to do he must do quickly. He
+would start at once for the place where Captain Dennis's men were said
+to be, and place the entire matter in their hands. The captain was a man
+whose bravery was well known in Old Monmouth, and he was ever ready to
+aid the scattered settlers.
+
+Captain Dennis would surely help him, too, Peter thought, and, with his
+heart somewhat lightened, he began to walk more rapidly. He would return
+to the wigwam and inform Indian John of his decision. If John would go
+with him, he would be glad of his aid, but, whether he went or not, the
+lad felt that his own problem was, in a measure, already solved.
+
+"Little Peter, is that you?"
+
+The startled lad looked up quickly at the unexpected summons, and saw,
+standing directly in his pathway, nine men. Each had a musket in his
+hands, but they wore no uniforms, and for a moment Little Peter could
+not determine whether they were friends or foes.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+WITH THE REDCOATS
+
+
+THE fear in Tom Coward's heart, when he discovered that he was between
+the lines of the soldiers, made him almost desperate. The men before him
+already had raised their guns, and at any moment he expected to hear
+their report. When he had glanced behind him he had seen that the men
+there were also prepared to shoot, and he was in a position where he was
+likely to receive the discharges of both sides.
+
+Along by the side of the road was a deep ditch, which had been worn by
+the spring floods. Just at present there was no water in it, and Tom
+instantly threw himself upon the ground, and, still grasping his gun,
+rolled toward the place. As he slipped over the side he heard the
+discharge of the guns, and his heart almost stood still in his terror.
+The bullets, however, had all gone over his head, and the lad was
+unharmed, although he was so frightened that even the thoughts of his
+own personal safety were almost driven from his mind.
+
+Shouts and calls followed the discharge of the guns, and then there was
+a rush of men past the place in which he was lying. From the direction
+from which the men had come, Tom concluded that those who were behind
+him had fled, and that the others were in swift pursuit of them. He did
+not dare to raise his head, nor try to obtain a glimpse of the
+combatants, but lay still in his hiding-place, hoping that in the
+excitement his presence would not be discovered. The shouts continued,
+but as they sounded farther and farther away, the trembling lad
+concluded that pursuers and pursued must have turned the bend in the
+road. If they kept on, he would soon be able to crawl forth from the
+ditch, he thought, and in the woods would find some place in which he
+might remain until all the immediate danger had passed.
+
+Still, he did not yet dare to leave his hiding-place, and, as the
+moments passed, his own fears and anxiety were not allayed. His face and
+hands were covered with the mud which had clung to them when he had slid
+into the ditch. The mosquitoes gathered about him, and, do what he
+would, he could not drive off the tormenting little pests. The
+sultriness which had followed the brief storm was almost unbearable, and
+Tom felt as if he could not have selected a worse place in which to
+conceal himself. There had not been much of any "selecting" about it, he
+grimly thought, for he had crawled into the first shelter that presented
+itself. A place in the muddy ditch was to be preferred to one in the
+middle of the road, and between two contending bands of soldiers. Here
+the bullets were not likely to find him, at least for the present, and
+his only hope depended upon the possibility of his presence not having
+been heeded. Perhaps the soldiers in either band had been so intent upon
+watching what the others would do, that a frightened lad between their
+lines would not be discovered.
+
+This hope was not strong enough to induce him to leave his shelter, and
+he decided to remain in the ditch until he was satisfied that all danger
+was past. The moments dragged on, and the silence which had followed the
+brief contest was unbroken. The heat was becoming more and more intense,
+and Tom felt that he could not remain much longer in his present
+position. Still, he waited and listened, but the sound of the cawing
+crows was all that he could hear. He counted off the minutes, and when
+what he judged must be an hour had passed, he concluded to remain there
+no longer. The men had not been heard in all that time, and doubtless
+must have disappeared from the immediate vicinity.
+
+The sight of the men had shown Tom that he was nearer the army than he
+had supposed. For a moment the thought of his former eager desire to
+join it came into his mind, and when he contrasted his feelings then
+with those he now had, his present position seemed almost ludicrous.
+Bespattered with mud, hiding in a ditch by the roadside, in constant
+fear of the return of the men, he certainly did not present the
+appearance of a very brave young soldier. Even Tom smiled as he thought
+of all this, but he was wiser than he had been a few days before this
+time, and the sound of guns was not exactly like that of which he had
+dreamed.
+
+Tom Coward was not lacking in bravery, however, but the position in
+which he had found himself certainly was a trying one, and perhaps the
+boldest of us might have done no better had we been caught in his
+predicament.
+
+The time had now come, he thought, when it must be safe for him to
+venture out upon the road again, and, grasping his gun, he prepared to
+climb out of the ditch, when he suddenly paused as he thought he heard
+the sound of voices once more.
+
+Yes, there could be no mistake about it; the men were approaching from
+the direction in which both bands had disappeared.
+
+He crouched lower and waited for them to pass. If they were foes, it
+certainly would be wiser, as well as safer, for him not to attract their
+attention; and if they were friends he was hardly in a condition to
+present himself before them.
+
+The men were coming nearer, and were almost opposite his hiding-place
+now. The lad's excitement returned, and he leaned harder against the
+muddy bank. It seemed to him as if the loud beatings of his heart would
+betray him.
+
+The band had halted, and were within a few feet of the ditch. What could
+it mean? Had his hiding-place been discovered? He crouched still lower,
+and did not once look up. He clutched his gun in his hands as if he
+thought he could lean upon that. The suspense was intense, and almost
+unbearable.
+
+"Hello! Here's some one in the ditch!"
+
+Tom's heart sank, and, as he glanced hastily upward, he saw a redcoated
+soldier peering down at him. The end had come, and all his efforts to
+conceal himself had been in vain.
+
+"The fellow's alive," exclaimed the soldier in surprise. "Come up out of
+that and give an account of yourself!"
+
+Tom obeyed, and, crawling up the bank, stood facing the men. There were
+thirty-five or forty of them, and, as he saw that they were clad in the
+British uniform, he realized that he was in the presence of the enemy.
+The suspense, at least, was ended now, and, as he glanced at the
+soldiers, in spite of the fact that he was well aware of his danger,
+much of his alarm had disappeared, for Tom Coward was not unlike others
+in being stronger to face the actual condition than the uncertainty
+which is connected with the approach of perils.
+
+The men glanced curiously at him a moment and then burst into a loud
+laugh. The troubled boy at first could not discover the cause of their
+merriment, but as he glanced at his hands and saw that they were covered
+with the mud which was not yet dry, he realized that doubtless his face
+and clothing were in the same condition. And Tom's appearance was not
+very prepossessing at that moment. His hat was gone, his face was so
+completely covered with mud that any one would have had difficulty in
+deciding whether he was white or black, and his bearing was far from
+being bold.
+
+The laughter of the men continued until an officer approached and said,
+"Who are you? What were you hiding for?"
+
+Tom hesitated a moment, and then replied, "I was trying to keep out of
+the way of your bullets."
+
+Again the soldiers laughed, and the officer said, "You didn't differ
+very much from the other fellows in the band, although they took to the
+woods and you to the ditch."
+
+"What band?"
+
+"Why, those men of Dickinson's we've just driven away. You don't mean to
+say that you didn't belong to them?"
+
+"I didn't belong to any band," said Tom slowly. "I was just coming
+across the country, and when I stepped out into the road I found I was
+right between you and the other fellows. I crawled into the ditch, for I
+was afraid that both of you would hit me."
+
+"Quite right, my lad, quite right. But how does it happen that you carry
+a rifle? The most of the Yankees are glad enough to get muskets, and
+here you are traveling round the country with a rifle. I'm afraid your
+story won't do, my lad. We'll have to take you along with us, and let
+you tell your story to the colonel."
+
+Tom perceived that any further protest on his part would be useless,
+and, as the word to advance was at once given, he obediently took his
+place in the ranks and marched on with the men.
+
+The heat was so intense that they were compelled to halt frequently for
+rests. A few of the men evidently were Hessians, and their high
+jack-boots, their heavy fur hats, as well as the short broadswords they
+carried, in addition to the short guns or carbines which were slung over
+their shoulders, seemed sadly out of place under the burning heat of the
+summer day. Tom did not know how the British officers had protested
+against the customs of their allies, so unsuitable in the country in
+which they were fighting; but the men from Hesse were obstinate, and,
+firmly believing that the equipment which had been good enough for them
+in the old country would certainly be good enough in the new, clung to
+the uncomfortable garments and unwieldy arms, unmindful alike of the
+jeers of their comrades in arms and the danger they incurred by the use
+of them.
+
+In the course of two hours the band arrived at a little camp in command
+of a man whom the leader addressed as Colonel Simcoe. Tom was at once
+summoned by him and taken into the presence of the colonel, or
+lieutenant-colonel, as he then really was.
+
+"What have you here?" inquired the colonel, glancing at Tom as he spoke.
+
+"We picked this fellow out of a ditch back here. We had a little brush
+with a band of Dickinson's men, but they didn't wait for us. We chased
+them a mile or two up the road; but the day was so warm, and as the
+rebels took to the woods, we soon gave it up and came back. We found
+this fellow on our return. He claims he doesn't belong to the rebels;
+but as we found that he carried a rifle, we thought best to bring him
+into camp with us. We didn't know but he might be able to give you some
+of the information you wanted just now."
+
+"You did right, lieutenant. I'll talk with him later. Now tell me what
+you learned. Did you hear anything more about Washington? How are the
+roads and the bridges?"
+
+"The rebels have been tearing up the bridges, and Dickinson has a good
+many of the militia scattered along in the woods. I rather suspect they
+are planning to serve us as the countrymen served Lord Percy up at
+Lexington."
+
+"I fancy we shall be able to put a stop to that, though your report is
+much like that which I have found out myself. Did you hear anything more
+of Washington?"
+
+"I couldn't get a word out of anybody. I don't believe he's moved from
+the position he held yesterday, though."
+
+For several minutes the men conversed, and when at last the younger
+officer departed, Colonel Simcoe turned to Tom and said, "Now, my lad,
+I'll listen to your story."
+
+"I haven't any story," replied Tom. "I was coming through the woods back
+here, and when I stepped out into the road I found myself right between
+the two bands, and as I was afraid I'd be caught by the fire of both of
+them, I crawled into the ditch to be out of the way. That's why I'm
+covered with this dirt," he added apologetically.
+
+"You don't need any one to confirm your words as to that," said the
+colonel, smiling slightly, as he spoke, at Tom's appearance. "Now what I
+want to know is who you are and what you were doing with a rifle? Few
+people here carry rifles, I find."
+
+Tom hesitated a moment, not knowing just what to say in reply to the
+question. The colonel was watching him intently, and the lad felt that
+he must say something. "I live back here," he said at last. "I've lived
+in Old Monmouth all my life. I'd started out from home to go to--to--to
+some of my friends, and, as I told you, I got caught between the lines."
+
+"How about the rifle?"
+
+"My father had the other guns and I had to take that. The last thing he
+told me was to take a gun and scare the blackbirds and crows from the
+ten-acre lot."
+
+"Is your father a loyalist?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"That's good; and now if you can answer my questions, perhaps I'll be
+inclined to let you go. You say you've lived here all your life. Do you
+know all the roads and bridges? Could you find your way anywhere in the
+county?"
+
+"Yes, sir; I think I could."
+
+"Tell me about the bridges. Have many of them been torn up?"
+
+Tom did not know, but he thought of his meeting with young Lieutenant
+Gordon that morning, and boldly answered, "Yes, sir."
+
+"How does it happen that your good father and the other loyalists permit
+that?"
+
+"My father's not at home, and there are too many of the pa--of the
+rebels."
+
+"I thought you told me your father sent you out with your gun," said the
+colonel quickly. "How is that? How could he send you if he wasn't at
+home?"
+
+"He sent me before he left," replied Tom, his voice trembling in spite
+of his efforts to control it.
+
+"Do you know where Washington is?" inquired the colonel abruptly.
+
+"I hear he's up by Hopewell. I don't know." Tom might have added that he
+would be glad to learn, but his wish was not expressed.
+
+"That's right. He _is_ at Hopewell. Is there any talk about his plans?
+Have you heard of any rumors among the rebels as to what he plans to
+do?"
+
+"Yes, sir. I hear he is planning to fall on Clinton's baggage train."
+
+"Sir Henry Clinton, you mean, I suppose," said the colonel sharply. "Do
+you think you could find your way from here to Cranberry?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Do you know every road?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Very well, then, I shall expect you to go with a party to-night and
+show them the way."
+
+"But," protested Tom, "I thought you said I could go if I answered your
+questions."
+
+"You'll have to stay now. Your father's a good loyalist, you say, and
+he'll not object to his son's remaining here for a day or two and
+serving as a guide. I'll see that you have some supper and are ready to
+start before it's dark."
+
+Tom left the colonel's presence, and with a heavy heart turned to look
+about the little camp.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+THE WAY TO CRANBERRY
+
+
+IT was late in the evening when Tom started from Colonel Simcoe's camp
+in company with the lieutenant, whose name he had learned was Ward, and
+the band of six men. A hearty supper had greatly refreshed the weary
+lad, and although he was aware that his companions were not without
+suspicions of him, he still had hopes that he would be able to convince
+them of his knowledge of the country roads, and then could leave them.
+His efforts to convince the colonel that he was merely a country lad,
+who had taken no part in the hostilities, had not been without a measure
+of success, and if they met with no mishap on the road, doubtless they
+would be willing for him to depart.
+
+As to leading the little band into Cranberry, Tom had not the slightest
+objection to that, for it would be going directly toward the place where
+Washington's army lay, and every step was one nearer the men whom he was
+most eager to join.
+
+The entire party were mounted, and a horse was also provided for Tom. To
+be sure, the steed was not a remarkable one, yet, as the lad looked him
+over before he mounted, he was satisfied that riding would be much
+easier than walking, and of walking Tom had had sufficient, he thought,
+on that hot June morning.
+
+"Now, my lad," said Lieutenant Ward, as the party prepared to move, "if
+you do well by us this night, I have two half joes for you in my pocket.
+On the other hand, if you fail us, or try to lead us into any trap, you
+shall have a good taste of the lead my men carry, or know how it feels
+to dance at one end of a rope with your feet a good yard from the
+ground. You hear what I'm saying, don't you?"
+
+"Yes, sir," Tom replied. "I can lead you straight to Cranberry, but of
+course I can't tell what men we shall meet on the way. All I know is
+that General Dickinson has men out, just as you have."
+
+"Never mind your 'General' Dickinson. I only wish we might have the good
+fortune to meet the rebel himself. You show us the way and we'll look
+after any of his men we may fall in with. All we want of you is to show
+us the way. They won't be likely to be out on the road in the night."
+
+Tom by no means felt so positive concerning that as the lieutenant did,
+but the word to start was then given, and mounting his horse he departed
+from the camp with the men.
+
+The moon was now full and hung low in the heavens like a great ball of
+fire. The frogs in the swamps were croaking loudly as the men rode past.
+The air of the summer night was almost motionless, and the heat of the
+day had only slightly decreased with the coming of the darkness. In all
+his life in Jersey, Tom had never known a hotter "spell"--as the natives
+termed it--than they had experienced during the past few days. A Hessian
+was riding beside him, and Tom could not understand how it was that he
+still insisted upon wearing the heavy fur hat in such weather.
+
+So intensely warm was the night that the band were compelled to halt at
+frequent intervals to rest their dripping steeds. The occasional breeze
+was like the hot breath from an oven, and, in spite of the fact that he
+was riding, Tom's face was wet with perspiration. The progress was
+necessarily slow, but the lad soon came to Doctor's Creek, and as they
+found the bridge across that stream intact, the lieutenant was pleased
+and warmly praised the young guide.
+
+The Assanpink Creek was crossed not long afterwards, and as the bridge
+across that also was still standing, the elation of the leader was
+visibly increased and he ordered the men to halt for another rest. Some
+without removing their clothing waded into the stream, which was narrow
+and shallow where they were, and led their horses in after them. The
+heaving sides of the poor beasts were wet with sweat and foam, and the
+men themselves seemed to be but little better. Tom thought he had never
+suffered more from the heat.
+
+After a rest of a half hour the men resumed their journey. Thus far no
+one had been met on the road, and the confidence of the band was
+steadily increasing, in spite of the fact that they were approaching the
+region in which the American army was supposed to be.
+
+Five miles farther on they came to Rocky Branch and the bridge over this
+stream was as strong and safe as those they had left behind them.
+
+"The half joes are likely to be yours, my boy," said the lieutenant.
+
+Tom made no reply, for he was thinking that something beside safe
+bridges might be discovered before they arrived at their destination.
+Only one more stream remained to be crossed, and then they would be in
+Cranberry. Just where they were then to go, or what was to be done, Tom
+did not know. Not a word had been spoken to him concerning the object of
+the expedition, and all that he was expected to do was to lead the band
+to Cranberry.
+
+"How much farther have we to go, my boy?" inquired the leader.
+
+"That depends upon the place you've started for," replied Tom. "We shall
+be in Cranberry after we've gone about ten miles farther, but it covers
+a good many miles. The township is a big one."
+
+"We'll decide that after we get there. Have we any more streams to
+cross?"
+
+"Yes. The Millstone river isn't very far away now."
+
+The rests had become so frequent that morning could not be far away, Tom
+thought. With the appearance of the sun their dangers were likely to be
+increased, but he made no mention of the fears in his heart, and the
+band soon started on again.
+
+When they arrived at the Millstone, the first break in the success of
+the expedition was found, for the bridge was down. This plainly showed
+that the Americans were not far distant now, and as the lieutenant drew
+rein on his horse, he said,--
+
+"This means that Sir Henry will find difficulty in getting his baggage
+train across here. Do you know whether the stream can be forded?"
+
+"Yes," replied Tom, pointing as he spoke to a place a little farther
+down the stream. "We can wade our horses across there."
+
+"But can the baggage wagons be driven through?"
+
+"That I cannot say. I think not."
+
+"We'll soon find out," said the lieutenant, leading the way to the ford.
+
+The men all followed him, but as the water came well up to their horses'
+flanks, it was at once evident that Clinton would find great difficulty
+in getting his baggage train across. The party halted near the bank
+after they had crossed the stream, and the lieutenant had an earnest
+conversation with one of his men.
+
+Tom could not hear their words, but he had no doubt that they were
+discussing the possibilities of Clinton's march by the way they had
+come that night.
+
+"We'll go on a bit farther," said the lieutenant at last, and the men
+obediently mounted and followed their leader.
+
+The gray of the dawn had just appeared in the east, and the air was
+filled with the songs of the birds. They were now in the township of
+Cranberry, and the end of their journey could not be far away, Tom
+thought, although he did not know what that end was to be. Thus far they
+had come without trouble, but with the coming of the morning, and their
+proximity to the American army, their difficulties were likely soon to
+be increased.
+
+The men were silent as they rode slowly forward, and were keeping a
+constant watch on every side. The sun by this time had made its
+appearance, and the day gave promise of being even warmer than the
+preceding one. Before them they could see two rude little houses on
+opposite sides of the road and at the end of lanes which led back from
+the roadside. The one on the left Tom instantly recognized as the abode
+of a Quaker named Nathan Brown, or "Friend Nathan," as his neighbors
+called him. Many a time had Tom been there, and even then he recalled
+many of the quaint expressions of the gentle man who had steadily
+opposed all the hostilities, in accordance with his creed which forbade
+even the resistance to tyrants.
+
+As the lieutenant saw the two houses he drew the rein on his horse, and
+the party halted.
+
+"It's time we had some breakfast," he said. "I am wondering whether we
+can't find something here in these houses. Do you know anything about
+them, my lad?"
+
+"I know the man that lives in the house on the left. He is a Quaker,"
+replied Tom.
+
+"All the better for us. I think I'll let you go up to his house, and
+I'll send a man up to the other. The rest of us had better stay here and
+keep watch, for there may be some prowling rebels around here, for all
+that we may know."
+
+"I'll go," said Tom quickly. "But I can leave you then, can't I? We're
+in Cranberry now and all you wanted of me was to lead you there."
+
+"Yes, if you wish," replied the lieutenant. "You've done well, but you'd
+do better still to go back with us. The rebels are not far away, and you
+may get into trouble. You must do as you like, though," he added.
+"You've earned your pay," and he drew the two half joes from his pocket
+and handed them to Tom.
+
+The lad received the money, no small amount to him, and, after thanking
+the lieutenant, started quickly up the lane which led to Nathan's house.
+As he glanced behind him, he perceived that one of the men had started
+towards the other house, while all the others had dismounted and were
+still in the road, although they evidently were keeping a careful watch.
+
+When Tom drew near the house he saw the Quaker standing in the doorway.
+His broad-brimmed hat and the peaceful expression upon his face were in
+marked contrast to the warlike men he had just left behind him in the
+road.
+
+"How now?" said Nathan, as he perceived who the approaching man was.
+"Thee travels early, Friend Thomas; I trust all is well at thy house."
+
+Tom quickly dismounted, and in a few words explained how it was that he
+happened to be there, and what the purpose of his visit was.
+
+"Thee doesn't say so!" said Nathan in surprise. "And the redcoats even
+now are at my door and seek refreshment?"
+
+"They are out in the road. They want some breakfast, and I think they'll
+pay you for it."
+
+"Friend Thomas, I think I can trust thee. I have known thee since thou
+wert a little lad. Ah, these are sad times for men of peace! The sons of
+Belial are on all sides. Verily, these days are days of wrath."
+
+Tom was puzzled by Nathan's manner and made no reply. The man turned
+quickly into the house and soon returned with a well-filled stocking in
+his hands. Tom instantly surmised what the stocking contained, for he
+was well aware of the banking purposes to which that article of clothing
+was turned in many of the homes.
+
+"Come with me, Friend Thomas," said Nathan, grasping a hoe as he spoke
+and leading the way into his garden. There he dug a hole, and, placing
+his "bank" within it, covered it again with the earth.
+
+"But Nathan," protested Tom, "if these men search your place for money
+they'll find this spot, and it'll show at once you've hidden something
+there. The earth is all fresh and moist here, and it's dry all around
+it."
+
+"Yea, thou speakest truly, Friend Thomas, but I have a thought by which
+I may yet outwit these men of war. Tarry here till I return."
+
+The Quaker instantly turned and again entered the house. In a moment he
+appeared, bearing a large bowl in each hand. One contained water, which
+he poured over the place where his money was concealed, and the other
+was filled with corn. He quickly scattered the corn over the wet ground,
+and then, turning towards the barn, called, "Chick! Chick! Chick! Come,
+chick! Come, chick!"
+
+Instantly there was a fluttering within the barns, the doors to which
+were wide open, and the hens came running from every direction.
+
+Nathan's face took on a meaning smile as he watched his flock hastening
+toward him for their breakfast, and then, turning to Tom, he said, "Is
+it plain to thee, Friend Thomas, that it is still possible for a man of
+peace to outwit these sons of Belial? Now go and tell thy companions
+that such food as I have shall be set before them."
+
+Tom laughed at the trick of the Quaker, and then ran back to his horse,
+and, mounting, started towards his recent companions, whom he could see
+still waiting in the road. Doubtless they were becoming impatient by
+this time, and, without waiting to go all the way back to the road, he
+stopped at a distance and called to them, beckoning with his hand for
+them to come, as he shouted.
+
+As soon as he perceived that the lieutenant heard him, he turned about
+and once more rode back to Nathan's house. He then dismounted and tied
+his horse to a post which stood near to the kitchen door.
+
+As he glanced up he saw that the leader was riding alone up the lane and
+now was near the house. Just then he heard the sound of a horse behind
+him, and, turning quickly about, saw young Lieutenant Gordon dash past
+him on horseback.
+
+Amazed by the sudden and unexpected appearance of his friend, he stood
+still and watched him as he rode swiftly up the lane directly toward the
+approaching men. Gordon was leaning low on his horse's neck, and Tom
+could see that he was grasping a pistol in his right hand.
+
+Before the startled lad could fairly realize what was occurring, he saw
+the young lieutenant raise his weapon and aim it at the approaching
+horseman. He waited for the report, but none came. Again Gordon raised
+his pistol, and once more it flashed without a report.
+
+His heart almost stopped when he perceived that the other members of the
+band had now entered the lane and were riding towards their leader,
+although as yet they were far behind him. The young lieutenant had also
+discovered them, and, instantly turning his horse about, dashed back up
+the lane, with the British lieutenant in swift pursuit.
+
+Unmindful of Tom, they swept past him, and Gordon turned the corner of
+the barn. Twice around the barn the men raced their horses, and then
+Gordon turned his horse into the open doorway and dashed through to the
+other side.
+
+After him followed the leader of the British band in desperate pursuit,
+and then, as Tom glanced up, he saw his recent companions come shouting
+and hallooing into the yard which was between the barn and Friend
+Nathan's little house.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+THE BOAT ON THE BAR
+
+
+WHEN Little Peter discovered the presence of the men before him, his
+first impulse had been to turn and make a dash into the woods; but the
+call which he heard quickly changed all that. As one after another of
+the band appeared, he recognized some of them as men who had been
+enrolled in the local militia, and his alarm for a moment subsided.
+
+The one who had addressed him he remembered as a young man not much
+older than himself, who had all the summer been away from his home,
+busied with his friends and neighbors in protecting the salt works along
+the shore, and striving to hold back the outlaws from their raids in the
+county.
+
+The salt works were of especial value at this time, as some of them were
+owned by the government and aided in increasing the scanty revenues of
+the poverty-stricken country. Several of them already had been burned by
+tories or bands of sailors, who had landed from some of the gunboats
+which had come to anchor off the shore for the purpose of inflicting
+such damage as lay within their power upon the adjacent region.
+
+"What are you doing here, Peter?" repeated the lad who had first spoken.
+
+As Little Peter now recognized the men before him as friends, he quickly
+related to them the story of the sad misfortunes which had come upon his
+home; and the many expressions of anger and sympathy which his words
+called forth were not unwelcome, we may be assured, to the troubled boy.
+
+When his brief story was told, the young man who had hailed him said,
+"We're on an errand that may fit into your feelings a bit. We're short
+one man, too. Don't you want to join us?"
+
+"What are you trying to do?"
+
+"We've just had word that a boat is aground off here on the bar, and
+we're going to see if we can't get her. We've got a whaleboat down here
+on the shore, and we're going to put out in her and see if we can't pull
+the other boat off and bring her in with us."
+
+"But there are a couple of gunboats not more than three quarters of a
+mile out," protested Peter. "You can't do anything while they are
+there."
+
+"We can try," said the man who was acting as the leader. "We're one man
+short, as Lyman here has just said, and if you feel inclined to join us
+we shall be glad to have you."
+
+Little Peter hesitated. It was not alone the danger of the enterprise
+which troubled him. He was thinking of his father and his own purpose to
+discover whether he had been sent to New York or not.
+
+When he explained the cause of his perplexity, the leader said, "That's
+all right, Peter. We're going down to Tom's River just as soon as we've
+taken this boat out here. You see, our watch told us the boat is loaded
+with supplies, and, if we can get her, we're going to do a double deed,
+for we'll keep the others from having them, and we'll make good use of
+the stuff ourselves. Now, if you'll go along with us, you'll make
+another oar for us, and we'll be all the more likely to succeed. Then
+you can go with us down to Tom's River, and poor company will be better
+than none in times like these."
+
+"I'll go," said Little Peter quickly, and the march was at once
+resumed.
+
+As they approached the wigwam, where Peter had left his Indian friends,
+he stopped for a moment to explain to Indian John the cause of the
+change in his plans.
+
+John listened quietly until the lad had finished, and then said, "Me see
+um again."
+
+Little Peter did not understand just what the Indian meant by his words,
+but he did not wait to inquire, for his friends were already in advance
+of him, and he hastened to rejoin them.
+
+No one spoke as they silently walked on to the shore, but when they had
+gained the bluff, Lyman suddenly said, "There! Look there, will you? The
+word was all right. The boat's aground out there on the bar."
+
+Little Peter instantly recognized the boat as the one which he had seen
+approaching from the gunboats, and for which the band of men from
+Refugee Town had evidently been waiting. Doubtless they had mistaken him
+and Indian John for members of the neighboring militia, and the cause of
+their pursuit was now explained.
+
+The men did not hesitate now, but going to a place a little farther up
+the shore, they hastily removed a pile of brush and drew forth the long
+whaleboat which they had concealed beneath it. The boat was not heavy,
+and, lifting it in their arms, they bore it down to the water's edge.
+
+Then grasping its sides, they ran with it into the water, and, at the
+word from the leader, scrambled on board. In a moment they were all
+seated, the long oars were drawn forth, and the men gave way with a
+will.
+
+Little Peter was in the bow, next to his friend Lyman. The excitement
+now for a time banished from his mind the thoughts of his sorrow, and
+even the search for his father was for the moment forgotten.
+
+About three-quarters of a mile out at sea were the two gunboats riding
+at anchor, and resting as gracefully upon the water as if they had been
+birds. Directly before them was the supply boat, about a quarter of a
+mile from the shore, and not more than that distance in advance. They
+could see that four men were on board, and they were still striving
+desperately to push her off from the bar on which she had grounded.
+
+Not a word was spoken on the whaleboat now, and the men were all rowing
+with long and steady strokes. The ocean was unusually calm, but every
+lift of the heavy groundswell disclosed to them more clearly the
+outlines of the boat they were seeking. Their purpose had not yet been
+discovered by the men on the other boat, or if it had been discovered no
+token was displayed. It was more than possible that they were regarded
+as friends coming to the aid of the unlucky boat.
+
+In this manner several minutes passed, the whaleboat, meanwhile, making
+rapid progress over the water, driven forward by the efforts of the
+determined men. The long, sandy shore stretched away in the distance,
+the masses of clouds in the sky seemed to be lined with silver as the
+rays of the sun shone through them, and not a sound could be heard
+except the heavy breathing of the men and the regular clicks of the oars
+in the row-locks.
+
+In spite of the peacefulness of the scene, however, all the men in the
+whaleboat fully realized the desperate nature of their undertaking, and
+the likelihood that in a moment everything might be changed. Still,
+there were no evidences of action on the gunboats, and the men on the
+grounded boat betrayed no signs of alarm.
+
+"There are some men on the shore up yonder," said the leader, as he saw
+a group standing on the beach directly opposite the boat they were
+seeking. "They don't seem to be able to help them," he added. "I don't
+believe we've anything to fear from them. Give way, men! Give way!"
+
+The band responded with a will, and the whaleboat darted forward with
+increasing speed. The other boat lay only a few yards away, and the end
+had almost come. The excitement on board was intense now, and, although
+no one spoke, the expression on every face betrayed the feelings of the
+men. They could see that the others were watching them, but still they
+manifested no alarm at the approach of the whaleboat.
+
+As the latter ran in alongside, and the men quickly backed water, one of
+the sailors on the stranded boat--for such their uniforms disclosed them
+to be--called out, "You're just in time, men! We thought we'd never get
+this tub off the bar. The tide's coming in, but we're stuck fast."
+
+"That's just what we came for," replied the leader, as he threw a rope
+to the other boat. "Now make fast and we'll yank you off before you know
+it."
+
+One of the sailors caught the rope and made it fast, but evidently a
+change came over his feelings then, for, glancing suspiciously at the
+men before him, the one who had acted as the leader said, "You're from
+Refugee Town, aren't you? You're strangers to me, but I take it for
+granted you're all right!"
+
+"No, sir; we're militia from Old Monmouth. We've come out here to get
+you and your boat, too. Here, none of that!" he quickly added, as he saw
+the men turn to grasp their guns. "We'll send you to the bottom before
+you can tell your names if you try any of your games on us."
+
+At his command the men in the whaleboat quickly covered the others with
+their guns. For a moment the silence was unbroken. The advantage for the
+present was very decidedly with the attacking party. Not only did they
+outnumber the others, but they were also in a condition to act, and act
+quickly. The situation, however, could not long remain as it was. The
+gunboats were not more than a half mile away, and, doubtless, assistance
+would be sent as soon as the predicament of the men should be
+discovered.
+
+Then, too, there were the men on the shore to be reckoned with.
+Apparently, they had no boat with which they could come to the rescue
+of the luckless sailors, but they might soon obtain one, for Refugee
+Town was not far away. Why they had not already gone there was not
+apparent. Perhaps they were trusting to the aid of the rising tide and
+the efforts of the men.
+
+"Pass over your guns!" said the leader on the whaleboat.
+
+The men obeyed, and silently picked up and handed their guns to the
+attacking party.
+
+"Now we'll see what can be done," said the leader, after he had
+deposited the weapons on the bottom of the whaleboat. "These fellows are
+harmless now, and we'll take our oars and see if we can't pull them off
+from the bar."
+
+His men grasped their oars and began to row. The rope tightened, the
+boat started a little, but still stuck fast to the bottom. Again the men
+pulled desperately, but with all their efforts they could not move the
+grounded boat.
+
+"I'm afraid we'll have to cast overboard a part of the load," said the
+leader, when the third effort proved as futile as its predecessors.
+
+He arose from his seat and grasped the rope to pull the whaleboat
+nearer, when the four men before him suddenly united in a loud shout,
+and, leaping from their seats, together grasped some other guns which
+had been concealed beneath the sailcloth, and, turning about before
+their captors could recover from their surprise, stood aiming their
+weapons directly at their faces.
+
+"It's our turn," laughed one of the men. "You'll hand over your own guns
+now!"
+
+No one in the whaleboat moved from his position. The leader still stood,
+leaning over the side and grasping the rope with his hands. Every one
+had been so startled by the unexpected summons that he seemed almost
+incapable of action.
+
+"Come, be quick about it!" said the sailor, as the men still did not
+move.
+
+A faint sound of a shout now could be heard from the shore, and the
+movements of the men there, as they ran about the beach, betrayed the
+fact that they were aware that something was wrong. In the distance,
+Little Peter could see that two barges filled with men were starting
+forth from the gunboats. The situation was becoming rapidly worse,
+critical as it then was.
+
+"Their guns aren't loaded, men!" called the leader suddenly. "They can't
+harm us."
+
+Still his men did not respond. For an instant no one moved, while their
+fear was plainly evident from the expressions upon their faces. No one
+knew whether the leader's words were true or not, and in breathless
+suspense they waited, fearing every moment to hear the reports of the
+guns in the other boat.
+
+As the men did not fire, the leader quickly shouted again, "They're not
+loaded, I tell you! They can't hurt us! Don't pay any attention to
+them!"
+
+His words instantly served to arouse his companions, for they now knew
+that if the guns had been loaded they would have been discharged before
+this.
+
+The sight of the barges which had started forth from the gunboats, and
+the increasing confusion of the men on the shore, combined to render the
+attacking party desperate now. Whatever they were to do they must do
+quickly.
+
+The leader called to his companions to cover the others with their guns,
+and, drawing the whaleboat close up, said: "The boat's loaded with guns
+and powder! That's just what we want. Now you take your oars and push
+while my men row," he added, speaking to the sailors. "The first one of
+you that draws back will get a dose of lead. Now! Quick! Do as I tell
+you!"
+
+The men sullenly laid down the empty guns, and, picking up their oars,
+began to push against the sandy bottom. The men in the whaleboat were
+rowing desperately, and soon could feel that the other boat had started.
+
+It was not yet free, however, and the leader called again to the
+sailors, "Harder, men, harder! You aren't half pushing. That's right!
+Harder yet! Harder, I say! We'll be out of this in a minute. Give way,
+men! You aren't asleep, are you? Pull! Pull!"
+
+In his eagerness, the leader laid down his gun, and, hastily grasping an
+oar, began to pull with his companions. Slowly the grounded boat
+responded to their efforts. Inch by inch it slipped from the bar, but
+was not yet free.
+
+Meanwhile, the confusion on the shore was increasing. The men were
+running up and down the beach, waving their arms and shouting. The two
+barges were coming swiftly from the gunboats, and if the loaded boat was
+not soon dragged from the bar, it would once more be in the possession
+of the enemy.
+
+They were still working desperately. The perspiration stood out in great
+drops upon their faces. They braced their feet against the seats in
+front of them and put forth all their strength. The moments seemed like
+hours to the struggling men, but the loaded boat was slow to respond to
+their efforts. It was steadily yielding, however, and at last they saw
+the boat slide from the bar and rest easily upon the open water.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+TED WILSON'S VICTIM
+
+
+A SHOUT arose from the eager crew as they perceived the success which
+had crowned their desperate efforts, but an answering shout from the men
+in the two approaching barges quickly recalled them to the necessity for
+further and immediate action. Why it was that the guns of the gunboats
+had remained silent they could not understand, but there was no time now
+for investigations. It was sufficient that they had not been molested
+thus far; and as the leader at once gave the command for them to resume
+their labors with their oars, the men at once responded and gave way
+together, the supply boat still being towed.
+
+The whaleboat had been built for speed, and was long, narrow, and light.
+Had it not been for the laden supply boat, which as yet they were not
+willing to abandon, they would easily and speedily have drawn away from
+the pursuing barges. As it was, they swept forward swiftly, and
+apparently were almost holding their own in the race.
+
+For several minutes the desperate efforts of the men continued. The
+heavy clouds had gathered in the sky, and the blaze of the sun had
+disappeared. The air was sultry and oppressive, and the unusual calm
+which rested over the waters indicated that the storm which had been
+threatening was fast approaching. No one glanced at the heavens,
+however, the set and streaming faces indicating that the immediate task
+in hand was sufficient of itself to occupy all their thoughts.
+
+On and on rowed the men, and on and on swept the pursuing barges. Less
+than a quarter of a mile lay between them, and, heavily laden as the
+supply boat was, it materially decreased the speed which otherwise the
+whaleboat might have made. The moments passed, but the efforts were not
+relaxed. Together, the long oars struck the water, and the bodies of the
+men swayed back and forth as if they were controlled by a common
+impulse. The distance between the boats was not materially changed,
+although if any change was to be seen it was in favor of the barges.
+
+"This will never do," said the leader at last, letting his oar go, and
+rising in his seat as he spoke. "Here, you men," he added, grasping his
+gun and facing the prisoners in the other boat as he spoke, "it's time
+for you to work your passage. Take those oars and pull your prettiest!
+Four oars are better than one, and I can do more with a gun than I can
+by pulling. Take your oars, every one of you, and the first one to drop
+will be fired on!"
+
+The four men in the supply boat sullenly obeyed, and the increased
+impulse of their efforts at once became manifest. The leader stood in
+the stern of the whaleboat facing the prisoners, and watchful of their
+every movement. His words of encouragement served to inspire his
+companions, and for a time it appeared as if they were gaining upon
+their pursuers.
+
+Still, the distance between them did not materially increase, and such
+efforts as the men were then making could not be long maintained.
+Indeed, signs of distress were already becoming apparent, and Little
+Peter felt every time he drew in his oar as if he had not strength
+enough left to pull another stroke. His face betrayed the pain he was
+suffering, but his condition was not much worse than that of some of
+the other men with him in the boat.
+
+The exciting contest could not be continued much longer, and as the
+leader glanced about the boat he almost decided to cut the rope which
+held the supply boat, and, leaving that behind, seek safety in flight.
+
+He had drawn his knife from his pocket, and was standing ready to free
+them from their heavy load, when the rain began to fall. In a moment the
+wind swept down upon them, and the storm was at hand.
+
+Prom the first of the pursuing barges came a shot, but no damage was
+done, and the leader muttered, "That's all right. It's a farewell salute
+you're giving us. You might as well say good-by to us, for I take it
+you'll never see us again."
+
+The waves were now rising, and the rain was falling in torrents. Between
+them and the shore it almost seemed as if a cloud intervened, so heavy
+was the downpour. The voice of the leader could hardly be heard by his
+men. The deep-toned thunder sounded almost continuously, and the darting
+lightning appeared to be all about them. In escaping from one peril they
+had encountered another.
+
+The barges could now no longer be seen, and, with the passing of the
+fear of pursuit, the men gave all their attention to their efforts to
+keep the whaleboat out of the trough of the rolling waves. Still, the
+supply boat was not cut loose, for the determined men were resolved to
+hold to that so long as it lay within their power to do so.
+
+For a half hour the shower continued, and although much water was
+shipped, and the men were compelled to bail the boats, they behaved
+well. When at last the storm had passed and the low mutterings of the
+thunder sounded far out to sea, they all looked keenly behind them to
+discover the whereabouts of their pursuers.
+
+Neither of the barges was to be seen. Doubtless, with the approach of
+the shower, they had both put back to the gunboats for safety. The
+whaleboat had weathered the storm, and the supply boat was still safely
+in tow.
+
+Drenched though the men were, new strength seemed to come with the
+knowledge that they were no longer being pursued, and then, relieved of
+their fear, they continued on their way down the shore.
+
+They frequently stopped for rest and to scan the waters behind them,
+but no boat could anywhere be seen. Nor was any one to be discerned upon
+the beach. Doubtless the men from Refugee Town had fled for safety and
+shelter, or, as the leader grimly said, "They were afraid of being wet,
+for water was something to which all the men assembled there were
+strongly opposed."
+
+For mile after mile they held steadily to their course, even their
+excitement apparently having mostly disappeared. The supply boat
+contained guns and ammunition, and if there was anything of which the
+militia stood in need, it was of that very commodity.
+
+At first it was thought that they would put in at the entrance to Shark
+River, but it was soon decided to continue on their way until they
+should come to Manasquan Inlet, and then go up the river to a place
+where some of their friends were to be found. To gain Tom's River they
+would be compelled to keep on to Barnegat Inlet, and then retrace their
+way up Barnegat Bay, to the place where the river entered; and as that
+would require a voyage of thirty miles more, no one regretted the change
+in the plan.
+
+They were all nearly worn out by their exertions, and no one knew what
+British vessel might be met before they could gain the shelter of Tom's
+River.
+
+Little Peter, in spite of his eagerness to go on to the place where he
+hoped to learn something concerning his father, was so weary from the
+work of the day, and as he had not tasted food since early that morning,
+he rejoiced with the others when at last the boats turned into Manasquan
+Inlet and began to make their way up the little stream.
+
+The sun was now low in the western sky, and the night would soon be upon
+them. The shadows already were lengthening when the two boats passed out
+of the inlet into the waters of the river. The leader, however, had not
+yet given the word to rest on their oars, and Little Peter did not know
+where they were to pass the night.
+
+The whaleboat kept steadily on in its course, and the wearied men were
+still pulling at the oars. The river was becoming narrower now, and more
+than one was hoping that the word would soon be given for them to land.
+
+Suddenly, the leader called to his men, and, standing erect, pointed
+excitedly to a place on the shore not far in advance of them. His
+companions quickly looked in that direction and saw on the little point
+of land, around which the river swept in its course, two men standing
+in the water. But what was it they were doing? One of them was holding
+the other and frequently forcing his head beneath the surface of the
+river. He would hold him in that position for a moment and then lift him
+upon his feet again, and shake him, much as a dog might have done with a
+rabbit. Apparently neither had observed the approaching boats, nor had
+either uttered a sound which the men in the whaleboat could hear.
+
+"The fellow's drowning him!" said the leader excitedly. "He's drowning
+him. Give way, men, and we'll lend a hand."
+
+The men, no less excited than their leader, instantly responded, and the
+boats dashed rapidly forward. The eyes of all were fixed upon the two
+men before them, and the leader shouted and called; but apparently,
+unmindful of their approach, the strange actions continued. The larger
+of the two men again and again forced the head of his companion under
+the water, and then would lift him up and repeat the shaking. So
+thoroughly intent was he upon his strange occupation, that he did not
+once heed the hail, or even glance toward the whaleboat.
+
+Nearer and nearer swept the boats, and finally, when they were almost
+upon him, the man ceased his efforts and glanced coolly up at the
+approaching men, still, however, retaining his grasp on his victim, who
+apparently was helpless in his hands.
+
+A startled exclamation escaped Little Peter's lips when he saw that the
+smaller of the men was none other than his own neighbor, Benzeor Osburn.
+"Help him! Help him!" he said excitedly to the leader. "It's Benzeor!
+It's Benzeor Osburn! He's my neighbor! He's being drowned! He'll be
+killed!"
+
+"Be still!" said the leader roughly. "It's Ted Wilson that's got him.
+Ted knows what he's doing. What's the trouble, Ted? What's gone wrong?"
+he added quickly, addressing the man who still held Benzeor tightly in
+his grasp.
+
+The huge man slowly turned his head as he heard himself addressed, and
+Little Peter thought he never before had seen such an expression of rage
+upon any human countenance. His great muscular arms were bare, and his
+entire body seemed to express the marvelous strength he possessed.
+Benzeor was not struggling, and indeed there seemed to be but little
+hope of protecting himself from the powerful man whose prisoner he was.
+
+Little Peter could see that, although Benzeor was almost breathless, he
+had recognized him, but he made no effort to speak and scarcely glanced
+at the men before him.
+
+"What's wrong, Ted?" repeated the leader. "What's the matter with the
+man?"
+
+"The matter isn't with the man, it's with me," said Ted slowly, speaking
+in a deep, gruff voice, which betrayed the strong feeling under which he
+labored.
+
+"You're not going to drown him, are you?"
+
+"Naw--though the snake deserves it. Drownin' is too good for such as
+he!"
+
+Ted had not moved from his position, and still was standing up to his
+waist in the water.
+
+"Tell us about it. Maybe we can help you a bit."
+
+"Naw, ye can't help any. It's my business. I don't mind tellin' ye how
+it came about, though. This forenoon I sold some corn and stuff up here
+at the mill, and got my pay in coin, too. Well, this fellow was there
+and he saw me get paid off, and I half suspected the reptile from the
+way he looked at me when he saw me take the money. Here you!" he
+quickly added, as Benzeor struggled slightly. "Ye want some more, do ye?
+Well, I'll give ye all ye want and all ye need, too," and again he
+thrust the helpless Benzeor's head beneath the water.
+
+"Let him up. You'll drown him!" said the leader, when Ted had held his
+victim several seconds under the water.
+
+"It's no more than he deserves," replied the huge man, nevertheless
+lifting his victim and shaking him again. "Now will ye keep still?"
+
+As Benzeor was unable to reply, Ted again turned to the men in the boat
+and said, "Well, I took that money home and gave it to Sallie. She's my
+wife, ye know, and I always gives her what money I get, not that it's
+ever very much, though. I didn't ferget the eyes o' this fellow,
+however, and I told Sallie,--she's my wife, ye know, and as likely a
+woman as there is in Old Monmouth, if I do say it as ought not to,--I
+told her to keep a good lookout for the pine robbers, fer I had a kind
+of a suspicion this here reptile might know where they was, and might
+get word to 'em, too.
+
+"I took my axe and went off down into my swamp-lot to cut some wood, and
+left Sallie up in the house. Sallie's my wife, ye know. I felt uneasy
+like all the time, but I worked on for three hours or more, but I kept
+a-gettin' uneasier and uneasier, and, finally, I just couldn't stand it
+any longer and put straight fer the house.
+
+"'Twas mighty lucky I did, too, I'm tellin' you, fer when I came in
+sight o' the house,--ye can see it up there now," and Ted pointed to his
+home, a short distance up the bank, giving the unfortunate Benzeor an
+additional shake as he did so,--"I see somethin' was wrong. There was
+three or four men a-standin' out by the big maple in front o' my house,
+and the minit I looked I see what they was up to. Somebody was a hangin'
+from a bedcord they'd threw over a limb o' that very maple-tree.
+
+"Mebbe ye know how I felt when I see it was my Sallie; she's my wife, ye
+know. They was a-drawin' her up and then lettin' her down, and I knew
+then they was tryin' to make her own up where that money was. I had my
+axe in my hands, and when I see what they was up to, I didn't wait very
+long, I'm tellin' ye. I cut Sallie loose,--she wasn't very much hurt;
+she's my wife, ye know,--and then I took after the rascals. They
+scattered in every direction, but this vermin started for the river and
+I after him."
+
+"You got him, I see."
+
+"Did I get him? Let him answer for hisself."
+
+And the angry Ted again shook the helpless Benzeor until the men
+wondered that his trembling limbs still held together.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+A FRUITLESS CHASE
+
+
+THE surprise of Tom Coward was not diminished as the novel race
+continued. Twice through the open doors of the barn dashed the two
+riders, their horses' hoofs slipping on the rough floor and almost
+throwing the men from their seats. Both continued to maintain their
+positions, however, and would no sooner disappear from Tom's sight than
+they would be seen coming around the corner of the barn again, the young
+American lieutenant still in advance and the British officer in close
+pursuit.
+
+Friend Nathan was standing in the doorway of his house, and, in spite of
+his peaceful professions, there was an eager expression upon his face
+which betrayed the fact that he was not an uninterested observer of the
+strange contest. Tom had not moved from his position, and his excitement
+had almost deprived him of the power of speech.
+
+Again through the open doorways of the barn the riders had urged their
+swiftly running horses, but as yet their relative positions had remained
+unchanged. The British officer was leaning forward on his horse's neck
+and endeavoring to grasp the bridle of the young lieutenant's horse, but
+the quick movements of the latter had prevented him, and the mad race
+continued.
+
+As Lieutenant Gordon dashed around the corner of the barn, and for the
+fourth time prepared to enter the open door, Tom saw that the other
+members of the band were just entering the yard. The excited lad could
+not longer remain silent. His friend was beset by new perils and must be
+warned.
+
+"Look out! Look out!" shouted Tom.
+
+Young Gordon looked up and for the first time beheld the increase in the
+number of his enemies. Without hesitating a moment, he turned his horse
+toward the low fence and cleared it at a bound. Then, directly across
+the open lot toward the woods in the distance he urged his trusty steed,
+and almost before the men in the yard perceived what had occurred, he
+had placed a considerable distance between him and the barn.
+
+The confusion, however, lasted but a moment, for, with a shout, several
+of the men urged their horses forward, and, leaping the low fence,
+renewed the pursuit. Those who did not follow raised their guns and
+discharged them at the fleeing officer; but either his movements were
+too swift, or their excitement prevented them from taking careful aim,
+for the bullets went wide of their mark, and in a very brief time the
+young lieutenant disappeared within the woods, and soon after his
+pursuers followed him.
+
+"Thee didn't seem to catch him," said Nathan blandly to the men who
+remained in the yard.
+
+"They'll get him. They'll get him," replied the leader. "They'll soon
+run him down, never you fear. But he's a bold fellow, there's no mistake
+about that. What did you call out to him for?" he added, turning sharply
+to Tom.
+
+"Did I call out to him?" replied Tom. "I don't just know what I did, I
+was so excited. I thought you had him."
+
+"So I would, if it hadn't been for the barn floor."
+
+Tom thought the barn floor was perhaps as much of a disadvantage to the
+pursued as to the pursuer, but he discreetly held his peace and said no
+more.
+
+"Now, old man, you can get us some breakfast. My men will be back here
+in no time with the young rebel, and will have all the better appetite
+because of their morning's work. You can feed us all, can't you?" said
+the officer.
+
+"I have spoken to Rachel. Doubtless she will do her best for thee."
+
+The men at once proceeded to place their horses in the barn and serve
+them freely from the Quaker's store. Then they entered the house and
+seated themselves at the table which Rachel had spread for them,
+although they first stationed one of their companions as guard.
+
+For a time no one spoke, so busied were they in their occupation, and
+Tom Coward was not one whit behind any of them. He was tired and hungry,
+and the breakfast was doubly welcome to him. Rachel moved quietly about
+the room, her drab dress and broad white collar being in marked contrast
+to the brilliant uniforms of her self-invited guests.
+
+"Old man," said the officer at last, "I wish you'd tell me how it
+happened that that young rebel was here on your place. You weren't
+sheltering him, were you?"
+
+"Nay," replied Nathan. "In times like these, Friends are not prone to
+shelter any soldiers. Our guests are only those who come without any
+bidding of ours."
+
+"Ha! ha!" laughed the officer. "I fancy you mean that as a reproach for
+us. Well, we'll pay you for our breakfast, never you fear about that.
+Your scruples don't carry you so far that you object to receiving a
+return in good yellow or white metal, do they?"
+
+"The laborer is ever worthy of his hire. I shall be thankful for any
+equivalent it may seem good unto thee to bestow upon me."
+
+"That's right, that's right. Trust a broad brim for that every time. I'm
+not complaining, old man, I'm not complaining. You don't happen to know
+just where the rebel army is at present, do you?"
+
+"It is reported that Washington is on the march for this very place.
+Even now he may be approaching."
+
+"Do you know that?" inquired the officer in a lower tone.
+
+"Nay. I know nothing of their movements. It is all of the current report
+I am speaking to thee. I fear me that a man of peace is likely to suffer
+double ills between the two armies, for it is also reported that the
+British and their Hessian companions are also likely to march through
+this very region."
+
+If the officer had glanced at the old Quaker he would have discovered
+that there was a very keen expression upon his face as he ventured the
+last supposition. But as he did not look up it was all lost upon him,
+and perhaps if he had seen it, he would not have understood its meaning,
+since his host was ostensibly a man of peace.
+
+"I'm not so sure of that," said the officer quietly. "We've come to look
+over the land and report to Colonel Simcoe. What makes you think the
+rebels are near here, and are likely to march this way?"
+
+"I will tell thee truly. The young man whom your companions are pursuing
+slept last night in my barn. He informed me frankly that Washington was
+to pass this way"--
+
+"And fall on our army?" broke in the officer eagerly.
+
+"That is the natural inference for thee to draw. It's a sad day for the
+Friends. They are ground between the upper and the nether millstones,
+for I understood thee to say that the British also were to come
+hither."
+
+"You can understand what you please," replied the leader gruffly.
+"You've given me the information I most desire and Colonel Simcoe would
+be glad to reward you for it, but being, as you are, a man of peace, of
+course you wouldn't be willing to take anything from a man whose
+occupation is blood letting. Hello! here's the guard!" he added, rising
+abruptly from the table as he spoke. "What's wrong?"
+
+"Nothing," replied the guard, "except that our men are returning from
+the woods."
+
+"And did they catch the young rebel?"
+
+"No, or at least he's not with them now."
+
+All hurriedly left the table and rushed out into the yard, Tom also
+going with them. The men could be seen returning across the lot, but it
+was at once evident that the young lieutenant was not with them.
+
+"What's the trouble? How was it that you let the slippery little rebel
+get away from you?" demanded the leader, as the soldiers once more
+entered the yard.
+
+"Simply because he could ride faster than we could," replied one of the
+band in a surly tone. "His horse was fresh and ours had been out all
+night."
+
+The officer was angry, but, after a few sharp words to his men, he bade
+them enter the kitchen and get their breakfast.
+
+"Did thee find him?" inquired Nathan.
+
+"No, we didn't find him. I'd chase him right into camp if it wasn't that
+I must hurry back to the colonel with the word you've given me. You're
+sure about what you told me?"
+
+"What did I tell thee?" inquired Nathan blandly.
+
+"About the march of the rebels," replied the officer angrily. "I half
+believe you're in league with them yourself, in spite of all your
+whining words. If I thought you were I'd leave your body for the crows
+to pick."
+
+"And is that the method which seemeth to thee to prove thou art right,
+and that I am no man of peace?"
+
+"Oh, never mind, old man, never mind my words. Perhaps I'm a little too
+hard with you. This young rebel's getting away from us has put me out of
+temper. What I want to know is whether you believe what you said about
+the rebels coming through Cranberry."
+
+"I have given thee the words as they were given me. I am not in the
+councils of the 'rebels,' as it seemeth good to thee to call them, and
+cannot say more. It is for thee to judge, not me, who am a man of peace
+and not familiar with the ways of warlike men."
+
+By this time the men had finished their breakfast, and a hurried
+consultation followed. The decision at which they arrived was soon
+apparent when the leader approached Nathan, and, holding forth some
+silver in his hand, said, "There, take that for the breakfast you've
+given us."
+
+"I thank thee," replied Nathan, accepting the money.
+
+"Are you going back with us, lad?" said the officer, turning to Tom as
+he spoke.
+
+"No. You said all you wanted of me was to point out the way to
+Cranberry."
+
+"So I did, but if this old man speaks the truth,--and I'm inclined to
+think he does,--you'll be better off with us than you will be to stay
+behind when the rebels are coming. You'll have a good horse to ride,
+too; you must not forget that."
+
+"I think I'll stay. I'm not afraid of the rebels, and can find my way
+all right." Tom's heart was beating rapidly, and the fear that
+permission for him to remain would not be granted was uppermost in his
+thoughts.
+
+"Have it your own way, lad, have it your own way. I only spoke what I
+thought was for your own best good."
+
+He gave a few orders to his men, and in a brief time the band departed,
+riding swiftly up the road and soon disappearing from sight.
+
+"This was not a bad morning's work, Friend Thomas," said Nathan, when at
+last the men were gone, jingling the silver in his pocket as he spoke.
+
+"It was a good deal better than I ever expected to have," replied Tom.
+
+Neither of them realized, however, the full consequences, for Nathan's
+words, in addition to what the officer had already discovered, caused
+him to return in all haste with the information he had received to
+Colonel Simcoe. That officer, upon receiving the word, which was
+corroborated by other discoveries he had made, at once reported to Sir
+Henry Clinton, and an immediate change in the plans of the British was
+made. The advance to the Raritan was speedily abandoned, the route to
+the Highlands was at once chosen, and it was decided that the army
+should march by the way of Monmouth Court House. The battle of Monmouth,
+which soon followed, thus became possible, and that, with all its
+consequences to the struggling patriots, turned upon the information
+which Colonel Simcoe had received, and which he speedily carried to his
+commander.
+
+Upon such slight events do those which we sometimes call the greater
+ones turn. Perhaps as we grow older and wiser we shall come to perceive
+more clearly the true relation which the so-called little things of life
+bear to the greater ones. A very wise man once declared that "he who was
+faithful in the little affairs of life was very greatly faithful." In
+any event, we have partially learned the lesson that it is a test of
+true greatness to be able to do little things well, and that the very
+best evidence of a man's being able to do the greater things is that he
+is willing to do the smaller ones, as they come to him, faithfully and
+honestly.
+
+However, neither Nathan nor Tom was moralizing after this fashion when
+they entered the house after watching the departure of the British
+soldiers. Tom then related all his recent experiences to Nathan, not
+omitting the story of Benzeor's misdeeds.
+
+The old Quaker listened attentively, and it was apparent from his
+frequent expressions of anger that his interest in the success of the
+Continentals was not entirely banished by his peaceful professions.
+
+"What thee needs now, friend Thomas," he said, when at last the lad's
+story was ended, "is a good rest. Rachel has a bed ready for thee."
+
+Tom followed his friend to the room upstairs, and soon stretched himself
+upon the bed. How grateful it seemed to the weary lad! For a moment he
+gazed at the four high posts, but soon everything was forgotten and he
+was asleep.
+
+How long he slept he did not know, but he was awakened by Nathan, who
+called to him and said, "Friend Thomas, there is some one below who
+desires to see thee."
+
+Tom leaped from the bed and followed the Quaker down the stairs,
+wondering who it was that wished to see him. There were confused
+thoughts in his mind of the British officer and Benzeor, but he was not
+in the least prepared for the sight upon which he looked when he entered
+the room.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A RARE BEAST
+
+
+IT is necessary now for us to turn and follow some of the movements of
+that army which Tom Coward was so eager to join.
+
+Sir Henry Clinton fully understood that he had little to gain from an
+engagement with Washington's army at this time. The Americans were not
+holding any position which he desired to gain, their stores and
+equipments were of slight value, and if Washington should be defeated,
+the result would be that his men would simply be scattered in the
+surrounding region, where they would still be free to carry on their
+straggling methods of warfare, and harass the British by falling upon
+their baggage trains and shooting at the men as they marched along the
+country roads.
+
+On the other hand, Clinton's stores were numerous and of no little
+value. The loss of them would be a serious blow to the redcoats, while
+the possession of them by the Continentals would put new life into the
+cause of the poorly equipped patriots. And above all of these things,
+the danger which now threatened from the approach of a French fleet led
+the British commander to hasten forward to the defense of New York,
+which he feared was likely to be the first place to be attacked by the
+allies of the colonies.
+
+The very motives which caused Sir Henry to wish to avoid an engagement
+were those which appealed most strongly to Washington to enter into one.
+He had but little to lose and much to gain. A defeat for the British
+would mean a weakening of the defense of New York, and the long train of
+baggage wagons was a most tempting prize. The possession of those stores
+would replenish the scanty supplies of the Americans; and, as we know,
+Washington had eagerly pushed his army forward, hoping to gain a
+position in advance of the British and fall upon them in some
+advantageous position which he himself could select.
+
+The main body had advanced as far as Hopewell, as we have already
+learned in the course of this story, but there had halted for a brief
+time. The weather had been unusually trying, and as a consequence the
+men were suffering intensely. Even the "oldest inhabitants" had never
+known such a summer. The thermometer had climbed well up into the
+nineties and then had stayed there. The frequent thunder showers
+apparently did not cool the air and afforded no relief, as the
+sultriness seemed to be increased by each one. The roads had become
+heavy and well-nigh impassable in places, and when at last the men had
+marched to the plains of Hopewell, Washington wisely halted to give them
+their much needed rest.
+
+Another matter led the great commander to remain there for a time. He
+had now gained a position which offered him a considerable advantage,
+and he wished to call a council of his officers to consult concerning
+his further movements.
+
+Accordingly, the second of the councils since the army had departed from
+Philadelphia was then called, and the one question in the mind of the
+commander was this: "Will it be advisable to hazard a general
+engagement?"
+
+General Charles Lee, who was second in command, and was by some even
+then suspected of being in secret league with Howe, was present, and his
+voice was soon heard. Lee was a Welshman, brilliant in certain ways,
+and had seen much service in the armies of Europe. Many had preferred
+him to Washington as the commander-in-chief of the American armies, and
+Lee himself was not averse to the idea. He affected to regard Washington
+with contempt, looking upon him as a man who lacked military training
+and of but little ability. His jealousy already had been the cause of
+many serious troubles, and at the present time, in spite of the fact
+that he had been exchanged for the British general Prescott, captured in
+a manner not unlike that in which Lee himself had been taken in a
+previous winter at Morristown, he apparently was unmindful of all the
+regard bestowed upon him, and was not unwilling to see Washington make
+some mistakes which would bring upon the leader the anger of his
+fellows, and perhaps open the way for Lee to gain his position. This
+view of the case is certainly to be preferred to that which marked him
+simply as a traitor and in league with the enemy, although in all
+likelihood both, in a measure, were correct. Probably Washington
+understood the man thoroughly at the time, and we may be certain that
+his troubles were not decreased by his knowledge.
+
+Lee was possessed of a strikingly ugly face, and his plain features were
+the cause of many rude jests among the soldiers who were opposed to him.
+But whatever his lacks in personal beauty or moral character may have
+been, he at least had a most persuasive tongue. His eager and impulsive
+manner, his commonly accredited ability, and his foreign training, which
+had great influence among many of his ruder and unpolished companions,
+caused some of the men about him to become ready listeners to what he
+had to say.
+
+In the council which Washington called at Hopewell, Lee exerted himself
+to the utmost to oppose the proposition to enter into an engagement with
+the advancing British. So persuasive were his words that the majority of
+the officers voted with him that it would not be advisable to detach
+more than fifteen hundred men from the main body to harass the enemy on
+their flank and rear, while the remainder of the army should preserve
+their present position relative to the British, and be governed by
+circumstances.
+
+Just what Lee's motive was is not fully apparent. Whether he wished to
+avoid a battle or simply desired to cause Washington to fail in taking
+advantage of the favorable opportunity, which Lee himself must have seen
+had presented itself, is not clearly known. It may have been a
+combination of both wishes.
+
+General Wayne bitterly opposed the proposition of Lee, and generals such
+as Greene, Lafayette, Steuben, and others, expressed themselves as being
+decidedly of the opinion that, at the very least, twenty-five hundred
+men should be detached from the main body and sent forward to carry out
+Washington's plan.
+
+Lee's motion, however, prevailed; but while Washington seemingly
+consented to the decision of the council, we can now see, as we look
+backward, that his own purpose was not changed. Perhaps he was
+strengthened in his opinion by the words of General Wayne and General
+Greene, spoken after the breaking up of the assembly, for we know that
+they then expressed themselves very freely to their leader.
+
+Apparently yielding to the expressed wishes of the majority, Washington
+dispatched General Scott with fifteen hundred men "to gall the enemy's
+left flank and rear," as he expressed it in the letters he wrote that
+day to General Dickinson and the president of the Continental Congress;
+and on the following day advanced with his army to Kingston, and halted
+there on the very day when Tom Coward arrived at the house of Friend
+Nathan Brown in Cranberry.
+
+As Tom came down the stairs and entered the room below, his surprise was
+great when he saw young Lieutenant Gordon standing before him.
+"Where--where did you come from?" said the astonished boy. "I thought
+they chased you out into the woods!"
+
+"So they did. So they did," laughed the young officer; "but that doesn't
+mean that I was bound to stay there, does it? I had spent the night with
+Friend Nathan here, and I had such a good time I almost decided to come
+back for another. And then, too, I left a lad here whose face haunted
+me, he looked so scared and white."
+
+"I was scared," said Tom, "for I thought they'd got you. How in the
+world did you ever manage to get away from them?"
+
+"Oh, I've learned by experience," replied the lieutenant, laughing.
+"This was about the closest call I ever had, and once there, when my
+horse slipped on the barn floor, I thought I was done for; but it's all
+come out right, you see. When I once got into the woods I knew I was
+all right, and I didn't have to go very far, either. About noon I
+thought I'd venture back and see what had become of Friend Nathan and
+Tom Coward, for I didn't believe those redcoats would stay here very
+long after they found out that our army is over here by Kingston."
+
+"Kingston?" said Tom quickly. "Kingston? Why, that's only ten miles from
+here!"
+
+"Correct, my son; correct. They'll be nearer yet, very soon."
+
+Tom was excited in a moment, and eagerly began to ask many questions.
+The young lieutenant replied to them all, and then said to the Quaker,
+who had remained silent during the conversation, "And now, Friend
+Nathan, you feel sure that those redcoats will carry the word back to
+Clinton that we've turned out of our way to meet them, do you?"
+
+"Verily, I do," replied Nathan. "It was for the very purpose of learning
+the plans of Washington that they dared to venture as far as this. I
+endeavored to learn from the soldier what effect he thought his report
+would have upon the British leader, but he did not speak in many words.
+Doubtless he considered them valueless to a man of peace. But thy
+surmise is correct, I doubt not."
+
+"Then the sooner we put out of this the better, Tom; that is, if you're
+still of the same mind you were day before yesterday."
+
+"I'm ready to go," replied Tom eagerly.
+
+The thought of the American army being only ten miles away aroused all
+his enthusiasm once more. He knew nothing of camp life, and the
+hardships were not in his thoughts. He knew that he had no place to
+which he could go, and now that he had left Benzeor's home he felt like
+an outcast. Besides, he had dreamed of joining the army, and, now that
+at last the longed-for day had arrived, all his curiosity and eagerness
+returned in full measure.
+
+"But I haven't any horse and you're mounted," he added. "I don't see how
+I can go with you. You can't wait for me to trudge along on foot."
+
+"That is something of a poser," replied the lieutenant. "No, it's a fact
+I can't waste much time on the road with such news as I have to carry
+back to camp. Perhaps my horse will carry double part of the way."
+
+"I have a beast I might let thee have," said Nathan.
+
+"That's the way to talk!" said the lieutenant eagerly. "Where is this
+horse of yours?"
+
+"It is out in the back lot in the woods. My heart was filled with fears
+of the war men, and I dared not to leave any of my property within their
+sight."
+
+As Nathan still hesitated, the lieutenant said quickly, "Hurry up,
+Nathan! Get your horse and let us start. We've no time to lose."
+
+"Thou knowest that I am a man of peace," said the Quaker slowly. "It is
+not for me to waste my property in this wicked war."
+
+"That's the way the wind blows, is it?" laughed the lieutenant. "Well, I
+don't know that I can promise you very much, but I'll do what I can for
+you after I get back to camp. But I'll tell you what, Nathan, you'll not
+be the loser to give up the horse to us, and with a good grace, too.
+Both of the armies are likely to pass this way, and you won't have much
+left on your place, I can tell you. Now, if you give it up you may get
+something for it, and then, too, you'll have the credit of doing
+something for your country."
+
+"What did the war men give thee, Friend Thomas? Did I not hear thee say
+that the war men rewarded thee for thy services?"
+
+"Yes," said Tom quickly, drawing the two half joes forth from his pocket
+as he spoke. "Here they are. You can have them and welcome."
+
+"The beast is not what would be considered a valuable one, Friend
+Thomas, and yet he is still capable of rendering some service to me. I
+will take one of thy half joes and leave the other with thee. Then thou
+canst see that I am suitably repaid after thou hast joined thy comrades
+in the war."
+
+The young lieutenant slyly winked at Tom as the lad handed the man one
+of his half joes, and then said, "Hurry up, Nathan! We've got to start
+soon, and ought to be off now. We'll do the best we can for you, as we
+said. You're going to give us something to eat, aren't you, before we
+go?"
+
+"It shall be according to thy desire. Rachel, if thou hast some milk and
+a small portion of corn bread, set it before these guests whilst I am
+gone for my beast."
+
+The old man departed, and his wife carried out his request. The
+lieutenant and Tom at once seated themselves at the table and hastily
+ate the food she set before them, for neither knew when another
+opportunity might be found. In the ten miles which lay between them and
+the army of Washington many adventures might be awaiting them, and it
+was only the part of wisdom to make the most of the present.
+
+"I have thy beast for thee," said Nathan, soon afterwards entering the
+room. "He is not what might be called by thee a swift beast, but he is
+still possessed of some excellent qualities. Thou hast promised to see
+that I am further rewarded for my gift."
+
+Tom and the lieutenant hastened out of the room to examine Nathan's
+"gift," and, as they saw the horse which he had tied to the post, they
+both stopped in surprise and the lieutenant broke into a loud laugh.
+
+"Oh, Friend Nathan," said he, adopting the Quaker's style of speech,
+"thou art a friend indeed! Dost thou call that thing a 'beast'? Thou
+hast cheated the lad woefully. A good half joe for that scarecrow? Thou
+oughtest to reward Thomas for riding him, for I am of the opinion that I
+shall be compelled to carry him into camp in two pieces if he mounts
+that 'razorback.' Oh, Nathan, Nathan! Who would have believed it of
+thee?"
+
+The horse was old and gaunt. A spavin was apparent in one leg, while on
+another was a great ringbone. One eye betrayed its blindness, and,
+altogether, the poor animal presented a most woe-begone and helpless
+appearance.
+
+"He hath not beauty, as I told thee," said Nathan soberly. "But he is of
+value to me, and thou hast promised to see that I am suitably rewarded."
+
+"Oh, Tom! Tom!" laughed the lieutenant. "What a sight you'll be on the
+back of that bunch of bones! There's no help for it, though. Come on and
+we'll see what the poor 'beast' can do!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE RELEASE OF BENZEOR
+
+
+BENZEOR'S plight was a sad one, but as he gazed about him in his
+helplessness the only face upon which he could discover any traces of
+sympathy or compassion was that of Little Peter. The lad had had no
+suspicion of his neighbor, and was ignorant, as we know, of the part
+which Benzeor had taken in the attack on his father's house. Even now it
+was difficult for him to believe that Ted had spoken truly. He must have
+been mistaken, Peter thought, as he recalled the kindness of Sarah and
+Benzeor's wife in permitting the children to find a shelter in their
+home.
+
+Perhaps the perplexed lad's face betrayed his feelings, for just at that
+moment Benzeor looked up and said,--
+
+"There! That boy knows me!" and he pointed at Little Peter as he spoke.
+"He knows all about me, for he's a neighbor of mine. I tell you there's
+been a mistake. I'm not the man you're"--
+
+Benzeor's words were suddenly interrupted by Ted, who thrust his head
+again under the water, and when he lifted him out once more the prisoner
+was sputtering and gasping for breath.
+
+"Made a mistake, did I?" exclaimed the angry giant. "Well, mebbe I did,
+but I reckon the biggest one was in not keepin' you under the river all
+the time. Runnin' round here prowlin' on defenseless women folks and
+tryin' to steal what little money they've got left! Drownin' 's too good
+for such as you!" And, unable to restrain himself, the angry man again
+shook his helpless victim till it seemed as if the little breath Benzeor
+retained must be driven from his body.
+
+"I--I--I'm telling you the truth," gasped Benzeor when he had recovered
+sufficiently to be able to speak again. "Won't you help me? Won't you
+save me from this--this--man?" he pleaded, turning to the men in the
+whaleboat. "That--that boy there knows me, and he'll tell you I--I--I'm
+all right. Won't you, Little Peter? Please! Please, tell them!"
+
+"Do you know him?" said the leader to Little Peter.
+
+"Yes," replied the lad quietly.
+
+"Ye don't know any good of him, do ye?" said Ted, interrupting, and
+tightening his grasp upon the collar of his victim as he spoke.
+
+"He is a neighbor of mine, as he said. I never knew any bad of him. And
+his wife and girl are taking care of the children. I know that." Little
+Peter was perplexed, and his suspicions had been aroused by the
+discovery of his neighbor in his present predicament, but the
+recollection of Sarah's kindness moved him to refer to their recent
+actions, in the hope that he might aid her father.
+
+"Ho! ho! ho!" laughed Ted. "Then his wife takes care of her children,
+does she? She must be a wonderful woman to do that. Well, let her take
+care of her brats, and I'll take care of her man, and good care, too!"
+
+As Ted acted as if he were about to renew his attentions, the leader
+hastily said, "The lad doesn't mean this fellow's children, but his own
+little brothers and sisters," and in a few words he related the story of
+the attack on Little Peter's home, and the sad loss which had occurred
+there.
+
+"Ye don't say so!" said Ted, bestowing a glance of sympathy upon the
+boy. "That's bad! It is indeed! And ye say this fellow has taken yer
+little brothers and sisters into his place?"
+
+"Yes," said Peter eagerly.
+
+"Well, all I can say is that I'd about as soon put a hawk to look after
+chickens, if it was my doin's."
+
+"Yes," said Benzeor quickly, striving to take advantage of the
+impression which Little Peter's words had momentarily created. "Yes, the
+children are all at my house, and being well looked after, too. That
+doesn't look very much, does it, as if I was a bad man? I tell you
+there's been a mistake! There's been a mistake! I didn't have anything
+to do with the attack on this man's place. Help me! Help me!" he hastily
+cried out, as Ted acted as if he were about to repeat his former
+actions.
+
+"Hold on a minute, Ted. Perhaps the man's got something more to say,"
+said the leader.
+
+"I am a-holdin' on. Can't ye see that?" replied Ted grimly, once more
+tightening his grasp upon the unfortunate Benzeor's collar.
+
+"I have got something to say. Something you want to hear, too," said
+Benzeor eagerly, and appealing to the leader in the whaleboat as he
+spoke.
+
+"Say it," said Ted gruffly.
+
+"The British are going to make an attack on the ship down in the bay."
+
+"What's that you say?" said the leader quickly. "Do you mean on the
+Washington?"
+
+"Yes, yes, that's just what I mean. There are a couple of gunboats off
+the shore here now, and they're going to land some men and get her back
+again."
+
+"There are two boats off the shore, Ted. I happen to know that, for this
+very craft we've got along with us we took from them this afternoon,"
+said the leader. And he briefly related the story of the capture.
+
+"There, ye see I'm right!" said Benzeor, eager to follow up the
+impression his words and those of the leader had created. "Now if you'll
+help me out of the clutches of"--
+
+"Keep still, you!" interrupted Ted angrily. "It'll be time enough for
+you to talk when I let go on ye. I reckon nobody is a-goin' to take you
+out o' my clutches till I get good and ready to let ye go. Now then,
+stand up straight and speak yer piece like a little man! How did ye
+happen to know the British was a-goin' to make an attack on the
+Washington?"
+
+"I heard one of the men up by your house say so."
+
+"I thought ye didn't have anything to do with that attack on poor
+Sallie! She's my wife, I'd have ye know. I thought you was a-sayin' you
+wasn't there, and all the time I see ye, and chased ye right out o' my
+yard, clear down to the river! And now ye say ye heard one of the men
+there tell about the plan the British have on deck to get the Washington
+back again!"
+
+"I didn't say I wasn't there," pleaded Benzeor. "All I said was that I
+didn't have anything to do with it, and I didn't."
+
+"Ye"--began Ted, all his anger instantly returning.
+
+"Hold on, Ted! Hold on! Let's hear what the man has to say," exclaimed
+the leader.
+
+"I'll hold on, never ye fret yerself about that!" replied Ted, still
+retaining a firm grasp on his victim, but nevertheless abandoning the
+action he had evidently had in mind.
+
+"I was there, I'm not denying that," pleaded Benzeor; "but I didn't have
+a gun in my hands, and I didn't touch the rope either. I fell in with
+the men and they made me go with them. I just couldn't help myself. And
+it was while I was there I heard 'em talking about the plan to take the
+Love--I mean the Washington," he hastily added. "They're going to take
+her in the morning."
+
+"You mean they're going to try to take her," said the leader.
+
+"Yes, that's what I mean; they're going to try to take her."
+
+"The reptile may be tellin' the truth," said Ted soberly. "I had some o'
+the best o' the Washington's cargo myself. Ye know they brought about
+all that was aboard o' her up to Manasquan, and sold it here, or
+leastwise Marshal John Stokes sold it for 'em. I happen to know about
+that, and the vermin here may be tellin' the truth. Sometimes he does it
+by mistake, I suppose."
+
+A few weeks prior to this time the British ship Love and Unity ran
+ashore near Tom's River. There were those among the people of the region
+who wagged their heads and winked slyly whenever they referred to the
+misfortune of the vessel, for it was a prevailing impression there that
+the pilot had not been especially favorable to the British, and more by
+design than by accident had grounded the vessel near the shore.
+
+Be that as it may, the militia had quickly rallied, and as most of the
+men were as much at home upon the water as they were upon the land, they
+seized the unfortunate Love and Unity, and brought her safely into port
+as a prize.
+
+The cargo was considered a very valuable one, consisting, as it did,
+chiefly of sugar and various liquors highly prized by the men of those
+days, and, after being duly advertised, was sold by John Stokes at
+Manasquan.
+
+The Love and Unity was renamed the Washington, and at this time was
+lying at anchor near the mouth of Tom's River, within the shelter of
+Barnegat Bay. As most of the men in the whaleboat, as well as the mighty
+Ted himself, were familiar with these facts, the words of Benzeor
+naturally created a far deeper impression than they might otherwise have
+done.
+
+"I'll tell ye what," said Ted suddenly, turning Benzeor about so that he
+could look directly into his face as he spoke, "ye seem so well posted
+I've half a mind to let ye go."
+
+"I'm telling you just exactly what I heard," said Benzeor, his hope of
+escape instantly increasing. "That's what I heard the men say."
+
+"And it was in the mornin' when they was goin' to come?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Well, I'm a-goin' to let you off. Hold on a minit," he added as Benzeor
+strove to free himself. "I haven't finished yet. I'm thinkin' of lettin'
+ye go on one condition."
+
+"What's that?" said Benzeor eagerly.
+
+"I'm comin' to that pretty quick. I'm pretty comfortable here, so to
+speak, and don't appear to be in such a hurry as you." As the two men
+were still standing in the water, and Benzeor's teeth were chattering
+from cold or fear, the words of the huge man were perhaps not fully
+appreciated by his prisoner. "Ye appear to be so happy over yer
+information--though fer my part I don't see what ye held it back till
+this time fer--that I'm a-goin' to give ye a treat. I'm a-goin' to let
+ye go, yes, I am; ye needn't be scart about that. Ye're goin', and I'll
+tell ye where ye're goin', too. Ye're goin, to join the crew o' this
+whaleboat and go down and help them defend the Washington against her
+enemies. That's the condition I'm placin' on ye, and that's what I'm
+goin' to do with ye."
+
+And the powerful man picked Benzeor up in his arms and placed him in
+the whaleboat next to Peter, who, we may be sure, had not been an
+uninterested observer of all that had occurred.
+
+"There ye be," said Ted, breaking forth into a loud laugh as he saw the
+dripping Benzeor hastily take his seat and glance apprehensively toward
+him. "Now, then," he added, turning to the leader, and still remaining
+in the water, which came well up to his shoulders as he placed his hand
+on the side of the supply boat, "if ye want me to, I'll take charge o'
+yer prize. You'll be puttin' straight fer Tom's River, I doubt not, and
+ye won't want to be bothered by an extra craft. I'll hide her in a good
+place up the shore, and likely enough I may come down to the bay myself
+in the night. Ye'll be settin' up a-waitin' fer me, won't ye?" he added,
+speaking to Benzeor.
+
+As that individual made no reply, Ted again began to converse with the
+leader of the band, and in a few minutes all the details were arranged.
+The captured boat was to be left in his charge, and soon the whaleboat
+started down the river toward the ocean.
+
+The sun had now disappeared from sight, but the approach of night was
+all the more favorable for the plans of the men. When once they were
+out on the ocean, they hoisted a sail and sped rapidly down the coast.
+
+A sail of a little more than twenty miles brought them to Barnegat
+Inlet, and as they entered the bay it was decided to make use of the
+oars again. It was almost midnight when at last they saw the Washington
+at anchor in Tom's River, and their hail was quickly answered.
+
+Little Peter was so thoroughly wearied by the labors of the long day
+that he was rejoiced to be told that he could turn in for the night.
+Benzeor was to have a hammock near him, and, tired as the lad was, he
+eagerly began to ply the man with questions when they had withdrawn from
+their fellows.
+
+"Benzeor, I came down here to find out about father. I suppose you know
+he was taken by Fenton's gang and that my mother was shot?"
+
+"I heard about it."
+
+"It was terrible, Benzeor. I don't know what I should have done if Sarah
+hadn't taken the children. 'Twas good of her, and of you, too, for you
+know all about it, I see. I shan't forget it very soon."
+
+As Benzeor made no reply, Peter continued: "I don't know just what to
+do to find out about father. The pine robbers have their quarters down
+here, I'm told, and I thought I'd tell Captain Dennis about it and
+perhaps he would send out a party to search for him. I didn't know just
+what to make of your being here at first, but I see you have had trouble
+with them, too. That was mean of Ted to treat you as he did when you
+said the pine robbers made you go with them. Was it Fenton's band that
+got hold of you?"
+
+"Yes; that is, I don't think so. I'm not just sure who they were."
+
+"Couldn't have been Fenton then, for you know him when you see him, I'm
+sure. Benzeor, don't you think I'd better report the capture of my
+father to Captain Dennis and ask him if he won't send out a searching
+party?"
+
+"No," said Benzeor slowly. "I don't think that will do any good."
+
+"Why not? What else can I do?"
+
+"Why, the fact is," said Benzeor, "I heard those men talking about your
+father, too."
+
+"Did you?" said Peter eagerly, sitting up in his hammock as he spoke. He
+could not see his companion's face in the darkness, and perhaps it was
+as well for the troubled lad that he could not, for he would have seen
+little to comfort him expressed upon it.
+
+"Yes, I heard 'em. There's no use in your reporting it to Captain Dennis
+or to any one else."
+
+"Why not? Why not? They haven't shot him, have they?"
+
+"No. He's been sent to New York."
+
+Peter said no more. The thick darkness seemed like that within his own
+soul. All his efforts had been worse than useless, and the troubled boy
+knew not what next to do.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE FLEET OF BARGES
+
+
+THE present visit was by no means the first which Little Peter had made
+to Barnegat Bay and the vicinity of Tom's River. Before the outbreaking
+of the war he had occasionally gone there with Webberly West, the most
+noted hunter of deer and wolves in all the region. Great had been the
+pride of Little Peter when he had returned home with his first deer,
+some four or five years before this time; and, as he lay in his hammock
+that night, again and again his thoughts wandered from his present
+difficulties to the days when he had tramped through the region with the
+venerable hunter Webberly.
+
+The old man had died just before the war began, but many of his quaint
+expressions and kindly acts remained in Little Peter's memory. He it was
+who had taught him how to dig the pits and cover them over with brush,
+and place the tempting pieces of meat as a decoy for the prowling
+wolves. Little Peter could never forget the first time success had
+crowned his efforts, and he had looked down upon the eyes of the wolf
+which had fallen into the pit. He could feel the thrill of that
+excitement even now.
+
+And Webberly had taught him also how to catch the great snapping turtles
+which abounded in the streams. Sometimes turtles were taken which
+weighed fully thirty pounds each. What savage creatures they were! and
+yet the old hunter had handled them as if he had known no fear. A
+constant war was waged upon these creatures by the settlers for two
+reasons, one of which was that they were highly valued as an article of
+food. The captive would be thrown into a barrel and for a few days fed
+upon the refuse from the tables, to which perhaps at times more
+substantial food would be added, and then when the turtles had gained
+the proper degree of plumpness, a feast would be made to which friends
+and neighbors were not infrequently invited. The eggs of the turtles
+also were highly valued; and so plentiful were they in the warm sand
+along the shore that a bushel-basket was frequently filled with them
+after a brief search. It was true the foxes were as eager as the men to
+dig out and devour the turtles' eggs, but the supply appeared to be
+almost inexhaustible and there were more than enough for all.
+
+Another reason which prompted the settlers to prey upon the huge turtles
+was the fact that their ducks suffered from the savage creatures. A
+turtle would seize a duck in his claws and tear and devour the bird in
+an incredibly short time. Naturally, the owners of the ducks objected to
+the methods of the turtles, and a constant warfare was the result.
+
+Peter had occasionally gone down to Barnegat with Indian John also. The
+Indian always seemed to know just where the clams could be found in
+greatest abundance, and he knew as well just how they ought to be
+cooked. He would dig a hole in the sand and then fill it with wood, to
+which he would set fire. Then the clams would be poured into the place
+and covered over with seaweed and brush. When a sufficient time had
+passed, the brush and seaweed would be raked out, and the cooked clams
+were considered as a great luxury. This custom of the Indians was
+bequeathed to the whites, and their method of cooking the clams remains
+in some portions of the land until this day.
+
+Between the thoughts of his own troubles and his recollections of former
+visits to the place in which he then was, not much sleep came to Little
+Peter that night. The knowledge that his father had been sent to New
+York--for the troubled lad did not think of doubting Benzeor's
+words--and the prospect of an attack upon the Washington on the
+following morning were both sources of deep anxiety to the sadly
+troubled boy. Only four men were on board when the whaleboat had
+returned; and while the addition of the ten men she brought, or eleven
+if Benzeor was to be included in the list of the Washington's defenders,
+materially increased her strength, still, the prospect of a strong
+defense was not very bright, and if the truth was known Little Peter was
+not the only one on board who passed a sleepless night.
+
+In addition to all this, the lad was sorely troubled as to his own
+future movements. With his father a prisoner in New York and the
+children quartered for the present at Benzeor's, Little Peter could not
+determine what was best for him to do. To go to the city and seek to aid
+his father there would be worse than useless now; nor was he able to
+provide for his younger brothers and sisters. The problem had not been
+solved when at last he fell into a troubled sleep, from which he was
+awakened by the sound of men moving about on deck.
+
+Hastily arising, and noting that Benzeor already was astir, he soon made
+his way up to his companions. The sun was well up in the eastern sky,
+and the men were preparing for such a defense as might be made against
+any attempt to retake the boat.
+
+Little Peter found that the most of the men did not believe that any
+such attempt would be made; and the suspicion with which they regarded
+Benzeor increased the feeling of sympathy which the lad felt for him,
+for to him it seemed as if his neighbor had been most unjustly treated,
+not only by the powerful Ted, but by the men of the whaleboat as well.
+He thought he had abundant cause for believing in Benzeor's honesty, for
+had he not received his own little brothers and sisters into his home?
+Surely, a man who would do that could not be bad, and his indignation
+against his recent companions increased as he noticed their
+ill-concealed dislike for his neighbor.
+
+The men all had breakfast on board; and while a constant watch was
+maintained, nothing as yet had been seen to arouse their suspicion that
+an attack was likely to be made. Even Little Peter was beginning to
+think that either Benzeor had been mistaken or that the British had
+changed their plans, and that nothing would be done that morning. He was
+about to approach the leader and explain to him the necessity for his
+own departure, when he was startled by a cry from the watch.
+
+Looking out over the bay, Little Peter could see a number of barges
+approaching. Startled by the sight, he counted the boats until he could
+distinctly make out eight of them. Doubtless there were eight or ten men
+in each boat, and altogether there must be at least seventy in the
+approaching party.
+
+The excitement on board the Washington at once became intense. The men
+stood together on the deck watching the little fleet on the bay. The
+only means by which they could defend themselves were their muskets, and
+it was soon discovered that these would not avail much against the
+enemy, for with the aid of a glass it was discovered that in the bow of
+one of the approaching boats a small cannon had been mounted.
+
+A hurried consultation was held by the men on board, to which neither
+Little Peter nor Benzeor was invited; the former because he was
+considered too young to be of much account, and the latter because no
+one trusted him.
+
+"They'll get this craft now," said Benzeor, approaching the place where
+the lad was standing. "Perhaps these fellows will believe me another
+time."
+
+There was a tone of exultation in Benzeor's voice that startled Little
+Peter, and turning quickly about he said, "You did speak truly, Benzeor.
+I wish I were out of this. We stand no chance at all."
+
+"You needn't be alarmed. There won't be any fighting done. You took my
+part yesterday, and I'll not see you suffer now. I'll fix you out all
+right."
+
+"You'll fix me out? I don't see what you can do. We ought to leave the
+ship this minute. I don't see what we're waiting for." Little Peter
+spoke anxiously and was at no pains to conceal the alarm he felt.
+
+"I hope they won't run," said Benzeor quietly. His air of confidence was
+confusing; but as yet Little Peter was not suspicious of his neighbor.
+
+"They don't act as if they were going to," said the lad quickly, as the
+assembly of the men broke up and all began to rush about the deck.
+
+"Come, my lad! come!" said the leader. "Lend a hand here! And you, too,"
+he added to Benzeor; "bestir yourself."
+
+Benzeor's face fell, but he was in no position to refuse to obey. Such
+defenses as the Washington possessed were rolled together behind the
+rail, and it was at once evident that the men were not planning to give
+up the ship without a struggle.
+
+The long whaleboat was placed in readiness to receive them, in case
+flight became necessary, and then the men waited for the approach of the
+attacking party.
+
+The boats came steadily on, keeping well together. Little Peter found
+himself sharing in the excitement, but as the outlines of the men became
+more distinct his fears increased. What could be done against so many,
+for it was now seen that there were more men in the barges than at first
+had been estimated. The boats were spread out in a semicircle, but they
+were all converging toward the Washington, and plainly would begin the
+attack together. There were more of those small cannon also than at
+first had been seen; and as the boats came nearer and nearer, it was
+discovered that a man was standing near each and ready to fire at the
+word of command.
+
+The faces of the men on board the Washington were all pale now, and not
+a word had been spoken for several minutes. Each man was intent upon the
+movements of the men in the barges, and did not turn away from the sight
+before him. Benzeor was the sole exception, and Little Peter could not
+understand the meaning of the half exultant smile upon his face. For
+himself, he was too badly frightened to speak, and the evident fear
+manifested by his companions did not tend to allay his own.
+
+The waters in the mouth of the river spread out almost as smooth as
+glass. The rays of the morning sun were reflected from the surface of
+the water and made it sparkle like silver. The occasional call of some
+seabird or the flight of the low flying gulls were all that broke in
+upon the silence, but no one heeded them. It was that slow moving but
+steadily approaching fleet of barges that held the attention of all.
+
+Little Peter wondered why the command to shoot was not given, for the
+boats were all within range now. His own hands were trembling in his
+excitement, but he was eager to act. At one moment he longed to leap
+overboard and try to swim to the shore, and then again he would feel as
+if he must do something to check the approach of those men in the
+barges.
+
+Not a word had yet been spoken, however. The oars of the approaching men
+could now be distinctly seen as they rose and fell together. Steadily on
+and on came the little fleet, and now could not be more than two hundred
+yards away. Why did not the men on board do something? He felt that the
+time for action had come, but all were standing silent and motionless,
+apparently fascinated by the sight before them. The smile on Benzeor's
+face was almost mocking, and Little Peter saw him look from the fleet to
+the men on board, almost as if he were exulting in their predicament.
+What could it all mean? Why was not something done? Surely the time for
+action had come, but still no one spoke.
+
+A hail now came from the approaching fleet, and the man who evidently
+was in command stood up in his place. He was still too far away for his
+words to be heard, and again the barges, which had halted for a moment,
+resumed their approach and with an increased speed.
+
+"Men," suddenly called the leader of those on board the Washington, in a
+low voice, "we must get out of this! We're outnumbered seven or eight to
+one, and it would be just murder for us to stay here. Man the whaleboat,
+and we'll put out for the shore."
+
+The hopelessness of any defense was so apparent that the men instantly
+responded and made a rush for the whaleboat, which had been made ready
+for just such an emergency. In a moment the men were on board and had
+grasped their oars preparatory to starting for the shore, when Little
+Peter suddenly noticed that Benzeor was not with them.
+
+"Hold on! Hold on a minute!" he called. "Benzeor isn't here!"
+
+The leader, who had remained on deck to be the last to leave, turned
+quickly at the words and discovered Benzeor striving to conceal himself
+among the defenses which had been piled together against the rail.
+
+"Here, you!" he shouted. "Come out of that and get aboard! Be quick
+about it! I'll wing you if you don't," he added, raising his gun as he
+spoke, noticing that his call was not likely to be heeded.
+
+Benzeor quickly responded, and sullenly took his place on board the
+whaleboat; but the men were all too intent upon their escape to bestow
+much attention upon him.
+
+In a moment the leader leaped on board and gave the order to give way.
+The long whaleboat darted swiftly forward as the men began to pull
+desperately at their oars. They needed no encouragement now, for, with
+their departure from the Washington, their only hope of safety lay in a
+quick passage to the shore, which lay about a hundred yards away.
+
+A shout from the men in the barges greeted the appearance of the
+whaleboat as it shot out into sight, but the hail was not heeded. One of
+the small cannon was discharged, and from one of the barges came a
+volley; but only one man was hit, and the whaleboat rapidly increased
+its speed.
+
+The shore was near now, and the desperate men were putting forth all
+their strength. The barges did not pursue, for the sailors were intent
+upon gaining the ship first of all. In a few moments the whaleboat
+grounded, and the men leaped out and started quickly for the woods which
+grew close to the shore.
+
+Little Peter was in the rear, and as he turned back to see what would be
+done by the other party, he was astonished to see Benzeor turn quickly
+and start at full speed for the whaleboat again. In a moment he had
+leaped on board, and, seizing one of the oars, with a strong push sent
+the boat far out upon the river.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+THE RIDE WITH THE LIEUTENANT
+
+
+TOM COWARD followed young Lieutenant Gordon as he led the way to the
+post to which Friend Nathan had tied the steed, and then stopped and for
+a moment gazed ruefully at the beast. His friend's good-natured laugh
+broke forth again as he beheld Tom's evident hesitancy about mounting to
+the back of the animal; and surely to a boy who had been accustomed to
+ride the colts in Benzeor's pastures without saddle or bridle, and dash
+about the lots in sheer delight at the antics and efforts of the
+unbroken steeds to dislodge their rider, there was not much to inspire
+or impress him in the sight of the broken-winded beast which Nathan had
+provided. Even the horse himself appeared to be conscious of his
+degradation, and stood motionless and with hanging head, as if he, too,
+would protest against any warlike efforts on his part.
+
+"I've only one request to make, Nathan," said the lieutenant. "I'm sure
+you will not object to it, but I think I'd better make it before we
+start."
+
+"What is thy request?" said the Quaker.
+
+"If General Washington once sees that horse, he'll want it for himself.
+You'll not object, will you, to his use of it?"
+
+"Nay. I think not that George Washington will care for this beast of
+mine," protested Nathan soberly, and apparently not suspecting that the
+young officer was poking fun at him. "Still, he may be able to make him
+of some use. Thee will not forget to see that I am suitably rewarded?"
+
+"Never fear as to that, though I doubt not my friend Tom here will be of
+the opinion that you ought to pay him handsomely for the pain he will
+suffer after he has ridden your beast a few miles. That is, if the horse
+can go as far as that."
+
+"Thy heart may rest easy as to that. He may limp when he first starts,
+but as soon as his joints are warmed he will do thy service."
+
+"We'll warm his joints, then," laughed the lieutenant. "You might be
+warming him up now, Tom," he added, turning to his companion, "while I'm
+getting my horse ready. He's in the barn, and I'll join you in a minute
+or two."
+
+In a brief time the officer returned, but his steed was showing the
+evidences of his recent hard work, and Nathan's eyes twinkled with
+satisfaction at the sight, for his own horse, perhaps, might not then be
+at such a disadvantage, and the prospect of a "suitable" reward became
+more promising.
+
+The young men quickly mounted, and, after thanking their host in a
+substantial manner for his hospitality, started down the long lane which
+led to the road beyond. Tom's horse limped painfully and caused no
+little delight to young Gordon, who again and again laughed aloud and
+offered all manner of suggestions to the lad concerning the impression
+he would create when the army should discover his approach.
+
+At times Tom thought of dismounting and, turning the horse loose in the
+road, strive to make his own way on foot; but the creaking joints of the
+poor beast seemed to find relief with action, and the young riders had
+not gone far on their way before, to the surprise of both, Nathan's
+steed was proving his ability to keep up with the lieutenant's horse,
+which evidently had been overridden and was in no condition for a hard
+ride.
+
+But, with the discovery of the service which Tom's horse might render,
+all the disposition to regard their journey lightly departed from the
+riders, and the serious nature of their undertaking rendered both of
+them silent. The American army could not be far distant now, but between
+them and it all the dangers had not disappeared. The visit of the
+British band at the home of Nathan Brown had indicated that other
+parties might be in the region on similar errands; but Tom was not
+thinking of these possibilities so much as was the young officer who was
+riding by his side.
+
+Tom's meditations were mostly concerning the American army. For months
+his strongest desire had been to join it, and now that the time had come
+when his desires were likely to be satisfied, he discovered that much of
+his eagerness was gone. Not that he had any thought of turning back, but
+the proximity of the two armies clearly indicated that a meeting between
+the forces was not improbable, and Tom's thoughts were largely of that.
+The glamour was all gone now, and the serious nature of his undertaking
+was uppermost in his mind. The silence also of his companion did not
+tend to allay his fears, but the lad did not refer to them, and was
+doing his utmost to make his horse keep up the pace at which he was
+going.
+
+"Whew! This is a warm morning! Let's give our horses a drink and a
+rest," said the lieutenant at last, as he turned into a little brook
+that crossed the road.
+
+Tom followed his example, and the dripping horses thrust their heads
+deep into the water. The sun had now appeared and the beams fell full on
+their faces. The air was motionless, and even at that early hour was in
+places quivering under the heat of the summer sun. The very birds were
+silent, while high overhead the heavens were like brass. On the horizon
+masses of dark clouds were piled, and a low, deep rumble startled both
+the young riders.
+
+"Was that a cannon, or was it thunder?" inquired Tom quickly.
+
+"Thunder. We may hear the cannon before long, though."
+
+"Why don't we start on, then? The sooner we gain the army the better. We
+don't want to be caught in here between them." Tom spoke anxiously, and
+his fear was as apparent in the expression upon his face as in his
+words.
+
+"We've got to give our horses a bit of a rest. Mine has been going hard
+all night, and yours won't be able to go far in such heat as this. We'll
+have to be careful of their strength, or we shall be worse off than we
+are now."
+
+"Have you been out all night? What have you been doing?"
+
+"Finding out what Clinton is up to. When I was talking with Nathan I
+knew all the time more about it than he did."
+
+"Did you find out?" said Tom eagerly. "What are the redcoats doing now?"
+
+"Pretty much the same thing they've been doing right along. They're
+making a change in the direction they're going, unless I'm greatly
+mistaken. And then, too, they've done something else which doesn't
+promise very well."
+
+"What's that?"
+
+"They've drawn all their stronger forces into the rear guard and sent on
+the Hessians with the baggage train in front, for one thing."
+
+"Why do you suppose they have done that?"
+
+"Oh, they've an idea, I fancy, that we're going to try to take their
+supplies. They'll find out, though, that we're after men more than we
+are after their baggage wagons. However, that explains the change in
+the direction of their march, if I'm not greatly mistaken. They've put
+the Hessians in front and the best men behind."
+
+"I wish they had left the Dutch butchers there!" said Tom impulsively.
+"I hate the Hessians. I hate the very name and sight of them! Think of
+it! A lot of men just hired to come over here and shoot and kill and
+steal! I wish they had been left where they were, that is, if General
+Washington is ready for them!"
+
+"I think you'll find him ready when the time comes," remarked the
+lieutenant quietly. "But about the Hessians. I don't like them any
+better than you do, but somehow I can't bring myself to feel about it as
+some of the men do. I can't see that they're to be blamed for being
+brought over here, or even being engaged in such work as they're doing;
+and I know more about that than you do, too. The ones who are the worst
+are not those who have come over here, but those who have sent them.
+Just think of a petty little prince, or king, being able to hire out a
+lot of his own subjects to pay off his own debts with! These men feel
+just the same as you or I would, I have thought. They have wives and
+mothers and children, and yet they have to leave them all and come over
+here and be marks for our bullets, whether they want to be or not. They
+just haven't anything to say about it. They're told to come and come
+they must, though there won't be so many to go back as came over, I'm
+thinking. At least, I'm going to do all I can to thin out their ranks,
+though I feel sorry for the poor fellows all of the time."
+
+This was a new way of looking at the hated "Dutch butchers," at least it
+was entirely new to Tom Coward. He had heard only the expressions of
+rage among the colonists which their coming had aroused, and their
+strange words and brutal acts had never received much mercy in the
+judgment which he had heard passed upon them by his acquaintances.
+
+The anger of the patriots, perhaps, was but natural; but the employment
+of the Hessians has not furnished the only instance in history where the
+first and most apparent view has not always been the most correct one.
+Indeed, it frequently happens that the troubles between men, to say
+nothing of boys, arises from a misunderstanding; and it is the part of
+wisdom, as well as of justice, to look below the surface and try to
+discover the true conditions.
+
+"Then the British are to be blamed, if what you say is true," said Tom,
+after a brief silence. "They are the ones at the bottom of it all."
+
+"Yes, the British are the ones who are most to be blamed. But even
+there, Tom, if I'm correctly informed, it's the leaders and not the
+people. The way I understand it is that the rank and file of the common
+people in England are opposed to this war, and would put a stop to it in
+a moment if they could."
+
+"If they could?" repeated Tom. "I don't understand what you mean."
+
+"Just what I say. The very best people in England have, from the very
+beginning of this war, been opposed to the taxes, the use of the
+Indians, and the hiring of these Hessians. It's the king and Lord North
+and a few others of the pig-headed fellows who are doing it all. Tom, my
+father and my mother both came from England. As far back as I can
+remember they have told me stories of our old home and of the friends we
+have over there. Why, do you know it's been the dream of my life to go
+over there some day, and meet some of my cousins and see the place
+where my father and mother were born."
+
+"I didn't know you were a tory," said Tom slowly.
+
+"Tory? I haven't a drop of tory blood in my veins, and hope I never
+shall have."
+
+"But--but--you talk like one."
+
+"Is it tory talk for me to say I don't blame the Hessians for coming
+over here, but those who hired them and sent them? Is it tory talk for
+me to say I love to think of the place where my father and mother were
+born, and that I should be glad to look into the faces of those who bear
+the same name I do, and who have some of the same kind of blood in their
+veins? Is it tory talk for me to say that I'm proud of what Old England
+has done, or rather of many things she has done, from the days of
+William the Conqueror until now? And that belongs to me as much as it
+does to them, for my own grandfather was one of the bravest men in the
+whole British army! This war is like one between brothers, and it's all
+the more wicked on that account. And it's worse yet, because the most of
+the Englishmen are not in favor of it at all."
+
+"I don't just see why you don't fight with the redcoats, instead of
+against them, then."
+
+"Because this is my home and this is my country, and because the king
+and his court aren't fit to govern cannibals, to say nothing of men. No,
+sir, it's just because I do believe in all I've said that I'm fighting
+for my country and shall till the war is ended--which I hope will be
+soon!"
+
+"And would you shoot a redcoat or a Dutch butcher?"
+
+"Every time! It was a sad thing that the war had to come, but as come it
+did, it would be sadder still not to do everything in our power now to
+carry it through. I'm sorry for the Hessians, but I'd shoot every one of
+them if I could do it. I'm sorry for the redcoats, and I know they are
+not to be blamed, or at least some of them are not, but I'd mow them
+down now, every one of them, as I'd cut the grass in haying-time. Fight?
+Why, my lad, I'm in this war from the crown of my head to the sole of my
+foot! And I wouldn't stop till the redcoats cry 'enough,' or we drive
+them right into the Atlantic ocean, the way Parson Tennent used to tell
+about the pigs in Gadara being chased by the devils right into the sea.
+Not that I think the ones who are doing the chasing are in any way
+connected with the swine drivers in the parson's story," he added,
+laughing lightly as he spoke. "But we must be going. Our horses are
+rested now, and we'll be running into a thunder-storm before we see the
+Continentals, if we don't look out."
+
+The ride was quickly resumed, but Tom Coward was silent and sadly
+puzzled to account for his friend's words. Apparently, he was
+enthusiastic in his devotion to the cause of the patriots, but he had
+never heard any one talk in that manner before. His friends and
+neighbors were all hard and bitter, and the bitterness seemed to
+increase as the war continued. But here was his friend, fighting with
+all the devotion of his heart, and yet not blaming the very men he was
+trying hard to conquer for the part they were taking in the war.
+
+It seemed to him all strange, and while he was deeply impressed by many
+of the words of the enthusiastic young lieutenant, his own feelings were
+of a very decidedly different character. For a half hour they rode
+forward as swiftly as their steeds could carry them, but the heavy
+clouds had meanwhile been climbing higher in the heavens, and the
+mutterings of the thunder had now become deeper and heavier.
+
+"We'll put into that barn ahead there, and wait for the storm to pass,"
+said the lieutenant, pointing as he spoke to a rude barn by the
+roadside.
+
+As the rain was now falling, Tom was glad to follow the advice, and in a
+few moments they approached the open door. They had not dismounted when
+a strangely clad being stepped forth from the barn and shouted:--
+
+"Halt, will yez? I'll be after havin' yez give an account of yerselves,
+that I will."
+
+Tom glanced up in fear and surprise, and the sight before him did not
+tend to allay his alarm. The soldier presented a gun, but was its bearer
+a man or woman? A long petticoat certainly looked like the garb of a
+woman, but the soldier also was clad in an artilleryman's coat, while a
+cocked hat and feathers crowned the head of the strange being.
+
+Tall, broad-shouldered, and with a voice that was gruff and deep, the
+strangely clad soldier bore but slight resemblance to a woman, though
+the dress certainly seemed to proclaim the sex of the speaker.
+
+The rain was now falling in torrents and Tom was drenched in a moment;
+but in the brief silence which followed the demand of the soldier, he
+could not determine what course his companion would decide to follow.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+A SOLDIER WOMAN
+
+
+"WHY, Molly, you aren't going to keep us out here in the rain, are you?"
+
+Tom looked up in surprise as he heard the young lieutenant's words; and
+while his fears were somewhat relieved by the assurance that his
+companion evidently had recognized the peculiar being before them, his
+confusion was not diminished by the reply which the strangely clad woman
+quickly made.
+
+"Sure, and it's me bye! It's me beautiful bye! Come in, me darlint! What
+for should ye be standin' out there in the storm?"
+
+The two dripping young soldiers speedily accepted the invitation, and
+entered the barn, leading their horses with them. To their surprise they
+now discovered that several men were also in the building, and that
+other horses were stalled in the barn.
+
+The appearance of Tom's horse was greeted by a shout of delight, and the
+person whom Lieutenant Gordon had addressed as "Molly" approached, and,
+after critically examining the poor beast for a moment, said:--
+
+"And where in the world did ye be after findin' that? It's a pity, it is
+indade, to be after compellin' such poor bastes as that to be fightin'
+the Dootch butchers! Sure, and it's the surgeon the poor thing is after
+needin'."
+
+Molly's hair was of a bright red color, her face was covered with
+freckles, which were like great blotches upon the skin, and her eyes
+were so faded as to be almost colorless; but her expression was so
+evidently one of good nature that Tom was compelled to join in the laugh
+which her words raised among the half dozen men who quickly assembled to
+pass judgment upon the steed which had been led into the barn.
+
+"Oh, that's something we bought back here to carry my friend as far as
+the army."
+
+"It's lucky, it is, that ye haven't very far to go, thin," laughed
+Molly.
+
+"Perhaps you're right, Molly," replied the lieutenant. "How far back is
+the army now?"
+
+"About a mile, I'm thinkin'."
+
+"What? What's that you say? Only a mile from here?"
+
+"That's what I'm tellin' yez. The army's been marchin' in the night; but
+this rain will be after compellin' it to halt right in--in Gooseberry,
+as I'm told they call it."
+
+"Cranberry," laughed the lieutenant.
+
+"Cranberry or Gooseberry is all one and the same thing to me. Now, me
+bye, ye'll be after wantin' some breakfast, I'm thinkin'. Jest say the
+word and I'll be fixin' ye out, and have a bit left over for yer poor
+baste, which doesn't look as if he'd been livin' any too high of late."
+
+"No, no, Molly," protested the lieutenant quickly, and, as Tom thought,
+with an eagerness he could not understand. "We're not hungry, for we had
+some breakfast before we started this morning. We did indeed," he added,
+as he noted the woman's apparent unbelief. "We're not hungry, but it's
+kind of you to think of us, and we thank you just the same as if you had
+fed us."
+
+In the course of the conversation between the young lieutenant and the
+men in the barn, Tom learned that the main body of the army was now less
+than a mile away. The little band had been one of the advance parties,
+and the storm had compelled them to seek the shelter of the barn by the
+roadside.
+
+Meanwhile, the rain continued to fall, and long after the thunder ceased
+the storm showed no signs of abating. The water almost covered the road
+and penetrated the roof of the barn, which was far from being in a good
+state of repair. The heavy downpour, however, did not seem to cool the
+air, and the men and horses were in a sad plight. Just why they should
+have sought the shelter, which virtually was no shelter at all, Tom
+could not understand; but he asked no questions, and busied himself in
+listening to the conversation of the men, and watching the intrepid
+Molly, who to all appearances was not aware of the fact that she was not
+as much of a true soldier as any of the men.
+
+After a half hour had passed the lieutenant approached the boy, who was
+standing before the open door, looking out upon the storm.
+
+"Who is she? What is she?" inquired Tom, indicating by a glance of his
+eyes the strange woman whom his friend had addressed as "Molly."
+
+"She? Oh, she's the wife of one of the cannoneers. She's been in the
+army for a long time. She's from New Jersey, too, I understand, though
+her husband's home is in Pennsylvania."
+
+"I didn't know there were women in the army."
+
+"Oh yes, there have always been some. Why, even on that expedition of
+Arnold's to Quebec there were several women who marched all the way with
+their husbands, and they say they stood the long tramps and the cold
+better than a good many of the men did."
+
+"Why did you call this woman 'Molly'? Is that her name?"
+
+"Oh, in the army, or at least in this army, the women have been the ones
+to bring us water on the warm days, and so we call each one Molly
+'Pitcher.' They've been kept busy during this hot spell, too. This
+woman's name I believe is really Molly, though,--Molly McCauley. Then
+you didn't expect to see women with their husbands in the army?" laughed
+the lieutenant, as he noticed that Tom was regarding Mistress McCauley
+curiously.
+
+"No, I didn't. I don't think I like it."
+
+"You'll find all sorts and kinds of people in the ranks. Some of the
+women have been worth more than the men. There was one up at Fort
+Clinton. She was very much such a looking woman as Captain Molly here,
+only she was a good deal more careless. They used to call her 'Dirty
+Kate,' because she wasn't always very neat in her personal appearance.
+But she was brave as a lion, and such a fighter! Why, she fired the last
+cannon at the British, as they came scrambling over the ramparts, which
+happened to be about the same time our men were leaving. Well, Kate's
+husband was a cannoneer, just as Molly's here is, and he was holding the
+match in his hand ready to fire the gun when he saw the redcoats coming,
+and the sight suddenly reminded him that he had some work to do outside
+the fort which demanded his immediate attention. Well, Kate just picked
+up the match her husband had dropped, touched off the cannon, and then
+scampered away after the men. She was a brave woman, and so is Captain
+Molly, here. She'd do as well as Kate did, if she had the chance, and
+perhaps she will before the end comes. I shouldn't want to have her
+fight me, I can tell you!"[2]
+
+Tom turned and looked again at the woman. She stood talking with her
+husband now, and her strange garb served to intensify her peculiarities.
+Her great size and evident strength were plainly to be seen, but her
+face beamed with good nature, and her enjoyment of the life she was
+living was indicated by her every word and action.
+
+Tom thought of Sarah, and the contrast between her gentleness and the
+rough appearance and masculine manners of Captain Molly aroused within
+him a feeling which was not altogether in favor of the soldier woman. It
+is true that the name of Sarah is unknown to-day, while that of Captain
+Molly Pitcher is recorded in all our school histories; but, after all,
+notoriety may not be the most valuable quality in life, and while the
+names of many men and women who lived quiet, faithful, honest lives may
+have been forgotten by their descendants, they may not have been of the
+less value to the world because of that fact. A good name is sometimes
+better than a notorious one, and an honest man, though he may be soon
+forgotten, may be greater than a dishonest man whose name is frequently
+mentioned. Few of us would desire to be like Benedict Arnold, although
+his name is a very familiar one to all.
+
+"I don't see any use in staying here," said Tom at last. "It's wet
+inside the barn, and it can't be much worse outside. Why don't we start
+on?"
+
+Now that he was so near to the American army, the lad was eager to go
+forward. All his dreams and visions of the forces which were fighting
+against the redcoats came back to him, and his impatience to proceed
+increased each moment. Perhaps the sight and presence of Captain Molly,
+as well as the account the young lieutenant had given of her, had
+created a still greater desire in Tom's heart to quit the place; but, be
+that as it may, he was ready to go, and apparently his companion shared
+in his feeling.
+
+"If you think your horse will stand up for a mile, we might do as you
+say," replied the lieutenant. "I think we'll be going on," he added,
+turning to the men as he spoke. "I've some important information to give
+the general, and as I don't see any signs of the rain stopping, I think
+we ought not to delay longer. We can't be much worse off than we are
+now."
+
+"Sure, and ye'll not be after goin' out in such a storm as this!"
+protested Molly. "It would be a shame to take that poor baste out into
+the rain now. He has all he can do to stand up in the barn, to say
+nothin' of havin' to be carryin' a load. It's the last drop that'll be
+after breakin' of his back, yez know."
+
+The men all laughed at the woman's words, but the lieutenant was not to
+be deterred, and accordingly the horses were brought forth and the two
+men speedily mounted. Tom's horse was limping painfully when he started,
+and as the lad glanced backward he could see Captain Molly standing in
+the doorway, her hands resting upon her hips, and her broad, freckled
+face beaming with delight over the sorry spectacle he was well aware
+that he presented.
+
+A feeling of disgust arose in his heart as he watched her. Surely she
+must be lacking in all the qualities which he had most honored in the
+women he knew. Coarseness was in place of delicacy, boldness instead of
+modesty, and her entire bearing was such that Tom never afterwards could
+hear her name mentioned without expressing his disgust. Not even the
+bravery of the deed which Captain Molly Pitcher did not many hours after
+this time, and which Tom Coward himself witnessed, entirely banished the
+prejudice which he entertained against the coarse, good-natured, manly,
+unwomanly woman.
+
+The storm had ceased when, after a short ride, Tom and his companion
+first came within sight of the American army. All the long pent-up hopes
+of the lad were now about to be fulfilled, and for the first time in his
+life he was to look upon the men whose names and deeds had long been
+familiar to him. His eagerness brought a smile to his companion's face,
+but while he watched the lad he did not speak.
+
+Molly Pitcher had spoken truly, and the American army had halted after a
+brief march from Kingston in the preceding night, and now were compelled
+to remain during the entire day in Cranberry. Only the advance corps had
+moved forward, and at that time were holding a position on the road to
+Monmouth Court House and within five miles of the rear of the British.
+
+In spite of his own excitement, and that which was apparent among the
+men in the camp when Tom and the lieutenant entered, the lad's first
+feeling was one of keen disappointment. Were these the men of whom he
+had heard so much and from whom so much was expected? Mud-stained, worn
+by their recent exertions, plainly showing the effects of the intense
+heat, many of them without uniforms, some hatless and coatless, to the
+vision of Tom Coward they presented far more the appearance of a mob
+than of the orderly and well-trained soldiers he had expected to see.
+
+The young lieutenant had left him as soon as they entered the camp,
+leading the two horses away with him,--a fact over which Tom did not
+long lament, we may be sure. An hour passed before the young officer
+returned, for he was to make a report of all that he had learned, and
+Tom's hopes were not strengthened as he watched the men about him during
+his companion's absence.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon noticed the expression upon Tom's face when he
+rejoined him, but, attributing it to the fear which he supposed the lad
+felt, he did not refer to it, and in the labors which soon followed no
+opportunity to explain was given by either.
+
+General Dickinson, with the New Jersey militia, was not with the main
+body, as we already know, and Tom found that he could not be assigned to
+them. Through the lieutenant's influence, he was to be retained with the
+main body, and to assist in serving as a guide for the army, an office
+which Tom was well fitted to hold, although it was not just in accord
+with the plans he had formed in his own mind.
+
+Reports came into the camp during the day which clearly indicated that
+the advance corps was too far away to be properly supported at once in
+the present condition of the roads. But on Saturday morning Lafayette,
+with his troops, was ordered to file off by his left towards
+Englishtown, and in the same day the main body, under General
+Washington, marched out from Cranberry and encamped within three miles
+of the place.
+
+This brought the two opposing armies now within eight miles of each
+other, while General Lee's forces, five thousand strong, without
+Morgan's dragoons or the New Jersey militia, were three miles nearer the
+British.
+
+Such was the condition of affairs on that night of Saturday, June 27
+(1778), and Tom Coward, as well as many of the men in Washington's army,
+slept but little, with the knowledge that on the morrow the long delayed
+battle would doubtless be begun.
+
+FOOTNOTE:
+
+[2] In many of our histories the "Captain Molly" of Monmouth has been
+confounded with "Dirty Kate" of Fort Clinton. They were, however, two
+women,--not one. Lossing, in the first edition of his _Field Book of the
+American Revolution_, referred to them as if they were identical, but
+the correction was to have been made for his second edition, and was in
+type, but through an oversight was omitted.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+AN INTERRUPTED JOURNEY
+
+
+THE surprise of Little Peter at the unexpected action of Benzeor was
+increased when the escaping man seated himself in the whaleboat and
+quickly began to row the long craft back toward the Washington.
+
+"Hurrah for the redcoats! Hurrah for King George! Hurrah for the
+British!" shouted Benzeor defiantly.
+
+This boldness was as surprising to Peter as the sudden departure had
+been; but, as he glanced toward the Washington and saw that the
+attacking party had already boarded her, and then realized that he
+himself had been left alone by his recent companions, he was quickly
+recalled to the necessity of action on his own part. Without waiting to
+observe the further movements of Benzeor or the British, he instantly
+turned and entered the woods; but a quarter of an hour had elapsed
+before he overtook the men, whom he found resting by the side of the
+road which led past the home of Ted Wilson.
+
+To this house the entire party now made their way, and as Ted listened
+to the story of Benzeor's perfidy, his anger broke forth afresh.
+
+"I never ought to have let the rascal go!" exclaimed Ted excitedly. "I
+had him right there in the river, and if you hadn't interfered with me
+I'd have fixed him so that he never would have betrayed any one again.
+Now the rascal's where he can keep up his evil doings."
+
+"He's shown where he stands, any way. That's some comfort," said one of
+the men.
+
+"It may comfort you, but it doesn't me," replied Ted. "I'm a peaceable
+man, I am, and I never cared much about whether it was to be the King of
+England or the Continental Congress that ruled over me. I don't see as
+it would make very much difference to me, for my part. But when that
+rascal hangs my Sallie up on the limb of a tree,--Sallie's my wife, ye
+know,--why, then Benzeor Osburn has jest got to look out for himself."
+
+Ted's anger was so evident that Little Peter almost had a feeling of
+sympathy for Benzeor, angry as he himself was at the treachery his
+neighbor had displayed.
+
+"Are you going to follow him up, Ted?" inquired the leader.
+
+"Am I goin' to follow him? That's just what I'm going to do! I'm goin'
+to send Sallie and the babies over to your house, and I'm just goin' to
+leave my place here,--they can't steal that, any way,--and follow up
+Benzeor Osburn till I find him. I don't care if he runs clear to the
+other side of the Alleghany Mountains,--I've heard as how there was some
+mountains by that name away out west somewhere,--why, Benzeor'll wake up
+some fine mornin' and find himself a-shakin' hands with me. Yes, sir,
+this land o' ours may put up with the Hessians, but it isn't big enough
+to hold such a fellow as Benzeor! Hangin' Sallies! I'll put a stop to
+his fine work! Sallie's my wife, ye know!"
+
+"Remember us to him when you meet him, Ted," said the leader. "You can
+charge him for the loss of the Washington, too!"
+
+"His door will be free of all chalk scores when I'm done with him," said
+Ted savagely. "That's goin' to be my work, clearin' the land of pine
+robbers, just as I once cleared it of pine stumps!"
+
+"We must start on now," said the leader. "Take your wife and children up
+to my house, Ted. The women can fight together against the pine robbers,
+if they come there."
+
+"They won't come there," replied Ted. "There'll be fewer of 'em when
+I've done my duty. There'll be no more hangin' Sallies. Sallie's my
+wife, ye know."
+
+"I suspected as much from your words," said the leader. "Are you going
+with us?" he added, turning, as he spoke, to Little Peter.
+
+"No," replied the lad.
+
+"What are you going to do now? You can't get your father out of the New
+York prisons. You'd better come with us."
+
+"I can't. I've other work to do."
+
+"Have it your own way, my lad, though I think you're making a mistake
+not to come with us."
+
+The band soon departed, leaving Little Peter and the huge Ted behind
+them. There was slight likelihood that the men who had captured the
+Washington would venture on shore to pursue the fugitives, and the
+knowledge of this fact had made all the parties feel comparatively safe.
+
+"What are you goin' to do now?" said Ted, when he and Little Peter were
+left alone.
+
+"I'm going straight to Benzeor's house. After what I have just seen, I'm
+afraid to leave the children there another minute. I never would have
+thought Benzeor was a traitor, never! But he is, there's no doubt about
+it now! I don't know what will become of them. I don't know where to
+turn, or what to do."
+
+Little Peter then went on to relate the story of the sad loss which had
+occurred in his home, Ted listening meanwhile with intense interest.
+
+"It's Benzeor's work!" he said excitedly when the lad at last stopped.
+"Yes, sir! You mark my words, Benzeor Osburn was at the bottom of it
+all. You'll have to go in with me and help rid the land of him! The
+rascal! Goin' round hangin' Sallies and shootin' mothers!"
+
+"I've all I want to do to look after my little brothers and sisters,"
+said Little Peter quietly. "I don't know what I can do with them, but I
+can't leave them at Benzeor's!"
+
+"No more you can't," said Ted. "I'll tell you what to do with 'em. Jest
+bring 'em all down here and leave 'em with Sallie over at the captain's.
+I think they'll be safe enough there."
+
+"Thank you; but it's most too far to bring them, I'm afraid. It's a good
+twenty miles from here, and we haven't a horse left."
+
+"I wish I could let ye have one, but all of mine are gone too, except
+one little mule; and you'd have to turn him round and make him go
+backward if you wanted to go anywhere, he's such an obstinate little
+beast. I'll tell you what I'll do, Peter! Just as soon as I've taken
+Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--and the babies over to the captain's,
+I'll go with ye and help ye out. That's what I'll do for ye."
+
+"Thank you again," replied Peter, "but I don't think you had better do
+it. You may be needed around here, and I don't know yet what I shall
+do."
+
+"Maybe you're right, Peter, maybe you're right. Well, have it your own
+way. When are you goin' to start?"
+
+"Right away."
+
+Little Peter at once bade his friend good-by and started forth on his
+long walk. He had appreciated the offer of the mighty Ted, but there
+were many reasons why he wished to be alone, for a time at least.
+Benzeor's treachery was still so fresh in his mind that he knew not what
+to do, and the excitement attending the escape from the Washington had
+not yet disappeared. Then, too, he did not know what the angry giant
+might be moved to do. Ordinarily good-natured and easy-going as the
+powerful man was, when once his wrath was aroused there would be no
+limits to what it might lead him into. And Little Peter's heart was too
+heavy, under the burden of his recent sorrows and present perplexities,
+to permit the lad to be drawn aside from the task which had presented
+itself to him.
+
+He had gone about half the way down the long lane which led from Ted's
+house to the road, when he heard some one calling to him. Looking
+quickly behind him, he discovered Ted himself running rapidly down the
+path toward him.
+
+Startled by the sight and fearful that some new danger had appeared, he
+stopped, and then turned back to meet the man.
+
+"What is it? What is it?" he called.
+
+Ted stopped as the lad called, and, shaking one of his great fists in
+the air, replied, "Hangin' Sallies! Hangin' Sallies!"
+
+"What? Have they tried it again?"
+
+"No! Once was enough, I should think, when Sallie's my wife, ye know! I
+just wanted to remind ye what the password was. It's 'Hangin' Sallies,'
+that's what it is! Ye won't forget it, will ye?"
+
+"No," replied Peter soberly. "I'll try to keep it in mind."
+
+"That's right! See that ye do! Hangin' Sallies, that's the word. I jest
+wanted to remind ye of it, that was all. Hangin' Sallies! Hangin'
+Sallies!"
+
+Little Peter resumed his journey, but, until he passed around the bend
+in the road, whenever he looked behind him he could see the mighty Ted
+standing in the lane, and shaking his fist in the air if he perceived
+that the lad beheld him.
+
+What a strange man Ted was, thought Little Peter as he walked on. He had
+known him for years, as had most of the people in Old Monmouth. His
+feats in the country wrestling matches had made him famous, and
+marvelous were the tales told concerning his almost superhuman strength.
+It had been related that Ted one time had lifted a great ox bodily from
+the ground, and Little Peter had believed the report. And yet, with it
+all, Ted had always seemed to him like a boy. Kind-hearted, ever willing
+to grant a favor or do anything within his power for another, he had
+never before seen him when his wrath was kindled. "Hanging Sallies!"
+Perhaps Ted's feelings were only natural when he had discovered the
+pine robbers in their cruel act. Benzeor would not be likely to escape
+from his hands so easily, if the angry man once held him in his grasp
+again.
+
+But Sallie Wilson was still alive, and the lad thought Ted's position
+was far better than his own. His mother shot by the pine robbers, his
+father sent away a prisoner, perhaps to die of starvation in those
+dreadful prison ships of which so many stories already had been told,
+and his younger brothers and sisters homeless and helpless, and all
+looking to him as their sole support. What could he do? Surely no one in
+Old Monmouth had suffered more than he, although Old Monmouth itself had
+known more of the evils of war than almost any other portion of our land
+in all that fearful struggle of the American Revolution.
+
+"How?"
+
+Little Peter's meditations were suddenly interrupted by Indian John, who
+stepped forth into the road and greeted him with his customary
+salutation.
+
+"Where did you come from, John? I thought you were up in Moluss's
+wigwam."
+
+"Moluss gone, Bath gone, John gone, too. Come to help friend. Find
+fader?" he suddenly added, peering keenly, as he spoke, into Little
+Peter's face.
+
+"No; my father has been sent to New York."
+
+"Bad. What boy do now?"
+
+"I'm going back to Benzeor's to look after the children."
+
+The Indian's eyes betrayed the question he might have asked, but did
+not. Indian John soon induced his companion to abandon the road and
+follow him through the forests. Many a mile was saved in this manner,
+and, under the burning heat of the sun, the shade of the great trees was
+most grateful to the sadly troubled lad. There was something in the
+presence of the majestic trees which seemed to appeal to Little Peter.
+He was alone and yet not alone with such companions. Indian John also
+seemed to share in his feelings, and seldom spoke. For mile after mile
+they continued on their journey, and the shadows were lengthening when
+at last they stepped forth into the road, which Peter recognized, and
+then knew that Benzeor's house was not far away. The long journey would
+soon be ended now, and fresh hope came to the weary lad, as he thought
+that he would see the children again.
+
+What he should do with them, however, was a problem still unsolved, and
+the solution apparently was no nearer than when he had set forth on his
+journey from the home of Ted Wilson. With all of the anger which had
+come with the discovery of Benzeor's treachery, Little Peter could not
+bring himself to believe that either Sarah or her mother had any
+knowledge of his evil deeds. His confidence in them was still unbroken,
+and his sole hope was that they might be able to suggest some plan by
+which the children could be cared for. As for leaving them at Benzeor's,
+that was impossible; and as the lad thought again of the discovery of
+his neighbor's crimes, he quickened his pace, and he and his companion
+began to walk more rapidly along the hot and dusty road. Not more than
+two miles remained between them and the end of their journey, and, in
+his eagerness, Little Peter almost forgot his weariness and constantly
+urged the Indian by his side to increase their speed.
+
+They had been in the road but a few minutes when they heard the sound of
+horsemen approaching from behind them. All unsuspicious of danger,
+Little Peter and Indian John halted, waiting for the men to pass. There
+were five of them in the band, and all were riding swiftly. Their horses
+were dripping, and with almost every step flung the foam from their
+mouths. Surely something must be wrong, to induce men to ride like that
+upon such a warm day, thought Little Peter; but his surmises were
+quickly driven from his mind when he recognized Fenton and Benzeor in
+advance of the band.
+
+Startled by the unexpected sight, he hardly knew what to do. The men
+were too near for him to hope to escape their notice now; and, even
+while he hesitated, he saw Benzeor quickly draw the rein on the horse he
+was riding and leap to the ground.
+
+"Get him! Shoot him! Stop that boy!" shouted Benzeor.
+
+Indian John had been keenly watching the approaching band, and as he
+heard the shout of the angry man, he touched Peter upon the arm, and
+said, "Come."
+
+Little Peter instantly responded, and followed his companion as he
+started swiftly across the open lot toward the woods which lay beyond
+it.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+THE ABODE OF INDIAN JOHN
+
+
+THE pursuit of Little Peter and Indian John was not long continued, nor
+was a single gun discharged; a fact for which the frightened lad was
+unable to account at the time, although on the following morning the
+cause for it was made clear.
+
+Wearied though the lad was by his long journey, the shout of Benzeor had
+provided an impulse sufficiently strong to compel him to keep up with
+his companion, who was running swiftly toward the shelter of the woods
+which were not far away.
+
+In a brief time the breathless fugitives gained its shelter, and then
+for the first time turned and glanced behind them. The men had turned
+back and now could be seen still standing by the roadside, near the
+place where Peter and the Indian had started across the lot. What they
+were doing could not be discovered; but, without waiting for further
+investigations, the flight was at once resumed, and, keeping well
+together, the lad and his companion ran swiftly forward, and soon the
+distance between them and the pine robbers had been still further
+increased.
+
+The sunlight had now departed from the forest, and the dusk had settled
+over all. The air was close and oppressive, and Peter's dripping face
+betrayed the force of his recent exertions and the excitement under
+which he was laboring. Already the night birds had made their
+appearance, and here and there among the branches of the lofty trees the
+bats could be seen darting about in quest of their evening meal. The
+very silence served to increase the feeling of utter loneliness which
+swept over the weary, heartbroken lad, and for a moment it almost seemed
+to him as if any further efforts on his part were as useless as they
+were difficult. Benzeor's anger promised little good for the children
+who had been left in his home, and fears for his little brothers and
+sisters were mingled in Little Peter's mind with the consciousness of
+his own weariness and the thought of his own forlorn condition.
+
+Difficult as the problem doubtless was, he knew he must not give way to
+it, and when Indian John indicated in a few moments that the time had
+come when they must go on, the lad resolutely again turned to follow
+him, although he had not the slightest conception of the plan which was
+in his companion's mind.
+
+Carefully they walked on through the increasing gloom, and within a half
+hour Little Peter heard the sounds of a running brook in the distance.
+He instantly recognized the locality, for many a time had he and Tom in
+the springtime followed the course of the "run," as the people of Old
+Monmouth called the stream, and the strings of fish which they had
+brought home with them had borne ample witness to the success which had
+crowned their efforts.
+
+But none of these things were in Little Peter's mind as he followed
+Indian John, who had now turned and was proceeding along the bank and
+making his way up the stream. As they walked on, the sound of a
+waterfall began to be more and more distinctly heard, and soon they came
+out into a place from which, in the deepening gloom, the falling waters
+could be seen. Into the basin which had been formed by the sharp fall of
+the stream, a tall, large tree had fallen years before this time. Its
+broken roots had torn up the earth, and now stood like a barrier on the
+bank, and Indian John led the way directly toward this spot.
+
+As they approached, Peter discovered a hole in the rocks, but he was not
+prepared for the action of his companion; for, without a word, the
+Indian dropped upon his hands and knees and crawled into the entrance
+and speedily disappeared from sight.
+
+Hesitating only a moment, Little Peter soon followed his companion, and
+after crawling along on his hands and knees for a number of yards,
+suddenly beheld a large, open space directly before him. Indian John had
+provided a light by this time, for he had been willing to follow the
+customs of his more civilized neighbors to the extent of making use of
+candles, and as Peter arose and glanced about him, he knew at once that
+he was in the cave which it was reported was the abode of the red man.
+
+Frequently as the lad had passed the very place into which he had
+crawled that night, it had never occurred to him that it was anything
+more than a hole in the rocks that formed the bank of the "run," and his
+surprise was therefore the greater at the sight before him. The spot was
+considerably above the bed of the stream, and consequently was
+comparatively dry. Straw and dry leaves lay scattered about over the
+floor, and the sheltered place apparently was safe from all approach or
+danger.
+
+Indian John at once indicated to his companion that he was to pass the
+night there, and the weary lad was glad to accept the invitation, and
+soon stretched himself upon the bed of straw. The light of the candle
+was extinguished, and the Indian then speedily followed the example of
+Peter. The sounds of the running brook came faintly to the ears of the
+troubled lad, but that was all he could hear. The darkness was intense,
+and for a time the fear of other occupants of various kinds prevented
+Peter from sleeping, but at last even that was forgotten in the
+dreamless sleep that followed.
+
+When he awoke, Little Peter at first could not determine where he was,
+but as the outlines of the cave were seen in the dim light which
+penetrated it, the experiences of the preceding day were recalled, and
+he quickly arose. Indian John was not in the cave, however, and as the
+lad now was aware that the morning had come, he hastily crawled through
+the passageway that led to the bank.
+
+As he regained the bank, he saw that his companion was busily engaged in
+roasting some birds he had shot. The sight was a welcome one, for Peter
+was now aware of the fact that he was decidedly hungry, and, following
+his companion's advice, he departed in search of some berries to add to
+the morning meal. In the course of a half hour he returned with his hat
+well filled, and, after bathing his hands and face in the cool waters of
+the brook, prepared at once to join his companion.
+
+For a few minutes neither spoke, but the rapid manner in which the
+roasted birds disappeared showed that conversation was not uppermost in
+their minds.
+
+At last, when several of the birds had been eaten, and many of the
+berries had disappeared, Indian John turned to his companion and said,
+"Boy want 'hop-hop' now? Plenty 'hop-hop.' Make um good."
+
+"No, no," replied Peter quickly. "The birds are enough. Where did you
+get them, John?"
+
+"Shoot um. Plenty birds; plenty 'hop-hop.'"
+
+"You must have been up early this morning, John. I didn't hear you."
+
+The Indian made no reply and remained silent for several minutes. Then,
+turning abruptly and looking keenly at Peter, he said, "What boy do
+now?"
+
+"I don't know," replied Little Peter disconsolately.
+
+The words brought him face to face again with the problem that must be
+solved. The fresh cool air of the morning, the silence of the forest,
+and, above all, the enjoyment of the breakfast which John had provided,
+made him at first wish that he might remain there and forget all the
+troubles that were so near. But Peter was not a selfish lad, and knew
+that the motherless children must be provided for.
+
+"I was going to Benzeor's," he said after a time, "but I don't know what
+to do now. I can't understand what he meant by coming back here in broad
+daylight after what has happened. He knows that I know all about it, and
+that was the reason why he wanted to catch me last night. I can't go up
+to his house now, and yet I don't dare leave the children there,
+either."
+
+"Boy go," said Indian John quietly.
+
+"But I can't go, John. How can I? There were four men with Benzeor, and
+you heard what he said. It wouldn't be safe for me to go there now. I
+don't know what to do."
+
+"Boy go; Benzeor no there."
+
+"Benzeor not there? How do you know? What makes you think that, John?"
+
+"John been there."
+
+"When? This morning?"
+
+The Indian nodded his head, and then said, "Man no there. Girl there.
+Two, t'ree little Peters there. Boy go. All safe."
+
+"You don't mean it?" said Peter eagerly, and standing erect as he spoke.
+"Come on, then, John; we'll start this minute."
+
+"Boy go; Indian no go."
+
+"Why not? I thought you were going with me."
+
+"John no go. John no home, no papoose, no notin'. All white man now. All
+gone. Indian no stay. Boy go."
+
+"All right, John; I won't urge you. But if you're right, and Benzeor
+isn't at home, you needn't be afraid."
+
+The Indian's eyes snapped at the words, but he made no reply, and Little
+Peter was too eager to start now to realize the force of his own words.
+As he departed, he saw his recent companion standing on the bank of the
+brook in an attitude as if he were listening to sounds far off in the
+forest. Perhaps if the lad had realized that it was the last time he
+would ever behold the face of Indian John, he would have lingered
+longer; but, as it was, his desire to go to Benzeor's house and learn of
+the present condition of the children banished all other thoughts from
+his mind, and in a few moments he had started toward the road.
+
+He retraced his way across the open lot, and as he came within sight of
+the road he suddenly stopped, as he saw a mounted man there. Apparently
+the man was alone, and what was strange was the fact that he apparently
+was not moving.
+
+Little Peter waited several minutes, but as the man still retained his
+position, and no one joined him, he resolved to proceed. Approaching
+cautiously, and ready to run at the first appearance of danger, his
+surprise was increased as he beheld the strange manner in which the
+horseman was seated on his beast. Instead of sitting with his face
+toward the head of his steed, his position was exactly reversed, and to
+all appearances he either was going in a direction opposite to that of
+his horse or else was riding backward.
+
+Puzzled to account for the strange attitude, Peter also noticed as he
+approached that the beast on which the man was mounted was a mule and
+had stopped in the middle of the road. In a moment he recognized the man
+as Ted Wilson, and with a shout he ran forward.
+
+"Why, my lad, what are you doing here?" exclaimed Ted, as he beheld the
+approaching boy.
+
+"It's more to the point to ask what you are doing here. What are you
+sitting on that mule that way for? What have you stopped for? Why don't
+you go ahead?"
+
+"There are several good reasons," replied Ted blandly. "In the first
+place, if the mule won't go, I can't go. Then, if he stops, I have to
+stop, too. As to the reason for my being here, why, I'm looking for
+Benzeor."
+
+"I don't know where you expect to find him," laughed Peter--forgetting
+his own anxiety for the moment in the ludicrous sight before him.
+
+"Well, I got to thinking of it yesterday after you left me; and when I'd
+taken Sallie and the babies up to the captain's,--Sallie's my wife, ye
+know,--I jest made up my mind as how I'd got to look after Benzeor afore
+he did any more damage. Goin' around the country hangin' Sallies! The
+rascal! Old Monmouth never'll be safe till Benzeor Osburn has been
+'tended to. And if I'm not the man to do it, I don't know who is. So
+Jeshurun and I decided to start out last night, and we've been travelin'
+ever since."
+
+"Jeshurun? I don't see anybody with you," said Peter, glancing quickly
+about him as he spoke.
+
+"Ha! ha!" laughed Ted. "Ye're lookin' too far afield, young man. This
+here fellow's Jeshurun. Whoa, Jesh! Whoa!" he suddenly added, as the
+mule darted to one side and turned several circles in the road before
+his rider could stop him.
+
+"Yes, sir; this is Jeshurun, and a more onery little beast never lived.
+I told ye about him yesterday, and how he'd suddenly take it into his
+head to go backwards for a bit. That's the reason I ride him this way
+part of the time. He thinks I want to go the other way, ye see, and
+that's how I come it over him by jest sittin' the wrong way, too.
+Besides, a good twist of his tail is worth more than a bridle sometimes.
+Instead of controllin' him with a bridle, as any decent beast would be
+glad to have me do, I just have to steer him by twistin' his tail,
+same's I use the rudder in my boat, ye see. Whoa there, Jesh! Whoa
+there! What's the matter with ye, anyhow? Whoa! Whoa!"
+
+These last remarks of Ted were caused by a sudden movement on the part
+of Jeshurun, whose heels were thrown into the air, while with his teeth
+he almost literally bit the dust. The mule was small and the feet of his
+rider almost touched the ground, and the antics of the pair caused Peter
+to laugh aloud.
+
+"Where did you get that name for him?" he inquired when quiet was
+restored.
+
+"Oh, it came to him jest natural like. Two years ago when I bought him,
+and was a-leadin' him home, I got him into the yard and then he just
+began to make his heels fly like a pair o' drumsticks. It's likely there
+was some noise made by him or me, I don't jest know which, and the first
+thing I knew, Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--and a whole lot o' folks
+came a-runnin' out o' the house to see what all the rumpus was about.
+They was havin' meetin' in the house, though I didn't know anything
+about that, or I wouldn't have argued with the mule as I was doin', o'
+course. Well, sir, if you'd believe it, the parson had been a-preachin'
+about somebody in the Old Testament. His text was: 'But Jeshurun waxed
+fat and kicked: thou art waxen fat, thou art grown thick, thou art
+covered with fatness.' Yes, sir; those were his very words. Well, when
+Sallie--she's my wife, ye know--set eyes on this here beast, she said
+Jeshurun should be his name, and Jeshurun it's been ever since. Whoa
+there! Whoa, I say! What ye up to now?"
+
+Perhaps Jeshurun objected to the story, for he suddenly whirled about
+and started swiftly up the road. In vain Ted tried to restrain him, but
+after his attempts failed, he turned and shouted, "I'll see you farther
+on! Jesh'll get tired o' this."
+
+As Jeshurun and his rider disappeared in a cloud of dust, Little Peter
+quickly recovered from his surprise and started briskly after them.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+THE BEGINNING OF THE GREAT FIGHT
+
+
+THE morning of Sunday, June 28, 1778, dawned clear and warm. Not a cloud
+could be seen in the sky, and the air was motionless, save in occasional
+places where it quivered under the burning heat of the summer sun. By
+eight o'clock the thermometer already had indicated ninety-six degrees,
+and before the day was done it had risen considerably above a hundred.
+
+The British forces had now arrived within ten or twelve miles of the
+Heights of Middletown, and if once they should succeed in gaining that
+position, all attempts on the part of the Americans to attack them would
+be worse than useless, for it was now as well known by Washington as it
+was by Clinton that British vessels were lying at anchor off Sandy Hook,
+ready and waiting to receive the advancing army and its stores on board,
+and transport all in safety to New York.
+
+Clinton, as we already know, still believed that the Americans were
+seeking only to capture his stores and train of baggage wagons, and,
+therefore, wisely had placed them in the care of General Knyphausen and
+the Hessian soldiers, in advance of the place of danger, as he supposed,
+and also of the place where the brave leader himself took his stand with
+his men. All of the British grenadiers, light infantry, and chasseurs of
+the line were encamped in the strong position that Clinton had selected
+in the parting of the road which led from Monmouth Court House to
+Middletown, the right wing extending about a mile and a half beyond the
+court house itself, while the left lay stretched for three miles along
+the road from Allentown. Thick woods afforded strong protection to the
+flanks, while a swamp extended toward the rear and the left, and woods
+also covered their front. The British general had chosen his place
+wisely, and there he waited until that eventful Sunday morning.
+
+General Washington was well aware of all that was going on, and had
+determined to attack the British the moment they moved from the position
+they then occupied. Late on Saturday night, the commander had given
+orders for General Maxwell to send out parties of observation, who were
+to watch the British and report instantly any signs they might discover
+of an attempt to retreat during the night, and to keep up a constant
+communication with himself. General orders had also been given Lee to be
+prepared to attack Clinton's forces the moment they should depart from
+their camping-place.
+
+General Lee's treachery or incompetency, or both, are well known to-day,
+and the only cause of surprise is that General Washington should have
+given him such discretionary orders. The great commander must have been
+fully aware of Lee's true feelings, for already he had suffered much
+from his jealousy and his traitorous designs; but perhaps the rest of
+the army did not know what Washington himself well knew, and on the eve
+of battle he chose the lesser of the two evils, and thought he would
+suffer less by permitting Lee to continue to act, than he would from the
+misunderstanding and confusion that might arise if he dealt with the man
+at that time as he justly deserved. At all events, his orders were
+somewhat general, and the fact that he had not given specific commands
+is all that remains to-day to be quoted in favor of the guilty Lee.
+
+It was about five o'clock in the morning when a messenger arrived in
+Washington's camp from General Dickinson--who, with the New Jersey
+militia, was nearest the enemy's lines--with the information that the
+front of the British line had begun its march toward the Heights of
+Middletown. Instantly Washington's army was put in motion, and one of
+his aids was sent in all haste to inform General Lee of the movement of
+the British, and to urge him forward to attack them at once unless some
+very strong obstacle should be found, and to assure him that the main
+body of the American army would be rushed forward to his support.
+
+I am very certain that if my readers could somehow have been privileged
+to witness the march of Washington's soldiers, they would not have been
+greatly impressed by the sight. Many of them were without uniforms, and
+their flushed and streaming faces under the burning heat, while they
+bore an expression of determination, after all would not have been very
+prepossessing in their appearance. Numbers of the Continentals had
+either cast aside their coats or rolled them up and strapped them across
+their backs, so that entire ranks appeared to be marching to battle in
+their shirt-sleeves. However, although their personal bearing was not
+made more forceful by the absence of coats, their personal comfort was
+decidedly improved; and, as we shall soon see, their work in the battle
+was not hindered by their lack of bright colored uniforms.
+
+Meanwhile, the advanced corps under General Lee had moved from
+Englishtown, and was now advancing toward the British. The redcoats were
+also in motion, and the left wing had marched more than a mile beyond
+Monmouth Court House when it discovered that the American columns had
+out-flanked it on the north. Lee's forces had marched along the main
+road, successfully crossing the deep ravines and causeways. They had
+halted frequently to receive reports from the scouts and the men in
+advance as to the movements of the British, but these reports apparently
+were somewhat contradictory and created some confusion among the
+American ranks.
+
+One of these halts had been made near the "new church," which was so
+called to distinguish it from the smaller structure, which until 1752
+had stood upon the same site. This "new church" was of wood, its sides
+covered with shingles, and painted white. There such famous preachers as
+Whitefield, the missionary Brainerd, Tennent, and others had given their
+messages of peace, but it can be safely asserted that in all its long
+history the "old" church or the "new" had never seen such a "service" as
+that which was held there on that Sunday morning in June, 1778. Before
+the day was done bullet marks and the effect of cannon shot were
+apparent on its walls, and while the roof and even the steeple were said
+to have been covered with people on that day, who had assembled to watch
+the battle, probably no other congregation in all our land had ever been
+gathered by such summons, or had taken their seats on the roof of the
+building instead of in the accustomed place within the walls.
+
+Young General Lafayette, who had command of Lee's right, soon passed the
+Court House, and was advancing upon the other end of the British line on
+the south at the same time when the left wing was folding about
+Cornwallis on the north; and General Wayne, who was in command of the
+American centre, was also pressing strongly forward. Apparently, all
+things were favoring the rugged Continentals, and had it not been for
+Lee's cowardice or treachery, or both, they would have won the battle
+there and then, before Washington could come with the aid of his
+advancing troops.
+
+Some slight minor engagements had already occurred, though not one of
+them was of much importance; but now General Wayne discovered that most
+of the British forces before him had descended from the high ground they
+had occupied and were advancing along the same route, over the plains of
+Monmouth, which the Hessians had followed when they departed earlier in
+the morning.
+
+Instantly the impetuous Wayne sent a messenger to General Lee requesting
+permission for his own "troops to be pressed on." No such permission was
+given, however, until it was discovered that a band of eight or nine
+hundred of the redcoats had halted, and, turning about, appeared to be
+inviting an attack. General Wayne was then ordered to take about four
+hundred men and advance.
+
+Despite the smallness of the number, Wayne eagerly obeyed, when the
+Queen's light dragoons were sent back by Clinton to check the movement.
+
+So excited was the little band of Americans that they instantly formed,
+and drove the horsemen back upon a body of foot soldiers who had been
+sent to their aid. A much larger body of troops were soon discovered to
+be moving upon General Wayne's right, but he immediately opened fire
+upon them with the two pieces of artillery he possessed, sent back for
+reinforcements, and gallantly prepared for the battle.
+
+During this time General Lee apparently was trying to cut off the force
+with which Wayne was engaged by making a detour and falling upon the
+line of Clinton's march between the rear of the main body and that
+detachment.
+
+This action of Lee's, together with those which three of the others of
+the divisions of the American forces were making at the same time, led
+Clinton to suppose that his baggage train was what the Americans were
+striving to gain. As we already know, this, all the time, had been his
+understanding of the purpose of Washington, and now the action and
+movements of the various bodies of troops strengthened his suspicion.
+
+The first thing the British commander did was to send the Queen's light
+dragoons against Wayne. Then he sent a detachment from the men in
+advance to strengthen his own right, and next he arranged for the main
+body, of which Lord Cornwallis was in command, to form on the plain and
+prepare to attack General Lee and the various divisions which were under
+him at the time.
+
+General Wayne and his brave men were now fighting desperately, and to
+all appearances success was about to crown his efforts, when he was
+dumfounded by an order he received from Lee to make only a feigned
+attack, and not to press too hard against the redcoats in front of him.
+
+Wayne did not know what to make of the order. He was chagrined and angry
+to receive such a word at a time when all things seemed to favor his
+determined band. It is said that he made use of some very forceful
+language, and even expressed his opinion of his superior officer in no
+very complimentary terms; but he was too good a soldier not to obey;
+and, although he could not understand what Lee meant by giving him such
+directions at such a time, he held back his men, hoping all the time
+that Lee himself would come up and grasp the victory which almost seemed
+to be in his hand.
+
+General Lee had been watching the movements of the British, and
+perceived what Clinton was trying to do by the actions to which we
+already have referred. Instead of meeting them boldly, and permitting
+his soldiers, who were all now eager for the battle, to advance, he at
+once prepared to withdraw them from the field.
+
+Young Lafayette had just discovered a body of British cavalry advancing
+toward Lee's right, and, quickly riding up to his commander, he begged
+for permission to advance and gain their rear, and so cut them off from
+the main body.
+
+"Sir," replied Lee, "you do not know British soldiers. We cannot stand
+against them. We shall certainly be driven back at first, and we must be
+cautious."
+
+"It may be so, general," said Lafayette quietly, "but British soldiers
+have been beaten, and they may be again. At any rate I am disposed to
+make the trial."
+
+Reluctantly Lee yielded, so far as to permit the brave young marquis to
+wheel his column by the right and make an attempt to gain the left of
+the British, but at the same time he ordered three regiments to be
+withdrawn from Wayne's command, thereby weakening him for reasons which
+neither Wayne nor any one of his men ever understood.
+
+General Lee then rode off to reconnoitre, as he afterwards declared, and
+to his astonishment discovered another large body of British soldiers
+marching back on the Middletown road toward the Court House. If there
+was one thing more than another which Lee apparently disliked at that
+time, it was the sight and presence of men clad in scarlet coats, and he
+instantly gave orders for the several corps in his division to retreat,
+or to make a "retrograde movement," as he afterwards explained it.
+
+His friends claimed for him, and, indeed, Lee afterwards claimed for
+himself, that he had only ordered the right to fall back, and had
+commanded the left, under Scott and Maxwell, to advance, and his order
+was misunderstood; and that when Maxwell's men perceived the retreat of
+their comrades on the left, they thought all was ended and they must
+save themselves. But, at all events, proof of the truthfulness of his
+statement was wanting, and all his men were soon retreating toward the
+"new meeting-house," on the roof and steeple of which were assembled the
+people of the congregation.
+
+Few of the men beside Lee himself knew why the retreat was made. The
+soldiers were angry and were giving vent to their feelings in terms
+which had not been carefully selected. General Wayne's men were the only
+ones who had even fired a shot, and the anger of Wayne himself was
+steadily increasing. Every soldier felt as if he were being robbed of
+success, which by right belonged to him and to his country.
+
+Between the "meeting-house" and the parsonage, General Washington, all
+unaware of Lee's disgraceful actions and the retreat of the advanced
+division, met a fifer, who appeared to be in great haste to leave the
+region.
+
+Reining in his horse, the great commander ordered the fleeing man to
+halt, and then said sternly:--
+
+"Who are you? Do you belong to the army? Why are you running in this
+fashion?"
+
+"I am a soldier," replied the trembling man, "but all the Continentals
+are running, too."
+
+"It isn't true! It can't be true! I'll have you whipped if you dare to
+mention such a thing to another living man!" cried the astonished
+commander.
+
+Nevertheless, he put the spurs to his horse, and in a few minutes
+discovered two or three other men, who apparently were in as great
+haste to depart as the fifer had been.
+
+Instantly the trembling men halted at his sharp command, and again the
+excited general demanded an explanation of their actions.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+THE BATTLE OF MONMOUTH
+
+
+EVIDENTLY, the reply which General Washington received from the men, who
+were as greatly frightened by the bearing of the commander as they had
+been by the sight of the redcoats, did not convince him that they had
+spoken truly. He had not heard any firing, except that of a few cannon a
+considerable time before this, and he could not believe that the picked
+men under Lee's command had ingloriously retreated without making even
+an attempt to stand against the forces of Sir Henry Clinton.
+
+This second report, however, caused Washington to send forward two of
+his trusty officers, whom he ordered to ride swiftly in the direction of
+the Court House, and, after they should have discovered the true
+condition of affairs, to report instantly to him.
+
+As the two brave men quickly obeyed and started their horses into a run,
+they met on the bridge the members of a regiment in a disorderly
+retreat. A little farther on another regiment was discovered, and soon
+still another appeared in sight.
+
+Colonel Ogden, who was in command of the last, in a towering passion
+declared, in reply to the question of the officers, that Lee's men were
+indeed retreating and that "they were flying from a shadow."
+
+Still hoping that they would find that a stand had been made farther
+back, the two officers pushed eagerly forward and soon met General
+Maxwell and his men. That gallant officer was also in a state of great
+anger, and not only confirmed the report that Lee was retreating, but
+also added some words of his own, expressing his opinion of that officer
+and of the movement in words that would have caused the cheeks of the
+treacherous general to tingle, if he had chanced to hear them.
+
+Still hoping against hope, the two aids pressed forward and soon met
+General Lee himself. His face at all times was decidedly plain, and
+indeed, as we know, he had the reputation of having the "ugliest face in
+America;" but at this time a scowl rested upon it which doubtless did
+not tend to increase his beauty, and he sullenly refused to reply to the
+questions of the men.
+
+The two officers did not long delay to talk to him, but still urged
+their horses swiftly forward, although the straggling, disorderly troops
+now almost filled the road, and their worst fears were confirmed each
+moment.
+
+At last, in the post of danger and nearest to the pursuing British, the
+two officers discovered General Wayne and his men. "Mad Anthony" was
+certainly "mad" at that time, and while he assured the aids that the
+retreat was genuine and general, at the same time he declared that it
+was absolutely needless. He also declared that "Lee had drawn off his
+best men at the very time when he was facing a body of British far
+superior to himself in numbers, but that even then the redcoats could be
+beaten if a stand were made against them."
+
+There was no time for an extended conversation, but, doubtless, the two
+officers understood what the exceedingly vigorous language of Mad
+Anthony Wayne was intended to convey, and after receiving the
+suggestions he sent by them to General Washington, and assured now that
+they had discovered the worst, they put spurs to their horses and rode
+swiftly back to give the information they had received to the great
+commander.
+
+Meanwhile, General Washington himself had not been idle, we may be well
+assured. Riding swiftly forward, he met band after band of the
+retreating, disorderly Continentals, and heard many expressions of anger
+and disgust, very like to that which had already greeted the two
+officers he had sent forward.
+
+At last, in the rear of the retreating column, he met General Wayne and
+his angry men. Hastily summoning Mad Anthony and two or three of his
+officers, the great leader told them that he "should depend upon them
+that day to give the enemy a check," and quickly directed General Wayne
+to form his men, and, with their two pieces of artillery, strive to stop
+the progress of the redcoats.
+
+It was just at this moment that General Lee himself rode up, and the
+scene which followed was one which those who witnessed it never forgot.
+There is no more sublime sight in all this world than the towering
+passion of a great man. Not pettiness, not irritability, but the just
+and righteous anger of a noble, large-hearted man in the presence of
+wickedness.
+
+General Washington probably never before in all his life had been so
+angry as he was at that time. Thoughts of the cause of the country he
+loved, the lives of thousands of brave and devoted patriots, the sight
+of angry, desperate men all about him, the disappointment at the loss of
+what he had confidently counted upon, the loss also of that for which so
+many noble men had been sacrificing and toiling through many weary days
+and on their long marches, rushed upon him like a flood. And before him
+stood the guilty man who alone was to be blamed for it all. Small wonder
+is it that Washington was almost beside himself with rage and sorrow.
+
+The name of Benedict Arnold is one that is hated to-day by every
+American schoolboy, for, after all, most boys can be trusted to hate
+evil in whatever form it presents itself. But the treachery of Benedict
+Arnold had at least the merit of being unmasked and comparatively open,
+for he took his stand boldly on the side of the redcoats, whom he at one
+time had fought with a bravery none can ever forget. But the memory of
+Charles Lee has not even that redeeming quality, for his actions on the
+field of Monmouth can only be explained on the ground of treachery or
+cowardice, and a coward is not very greatly to be preferred to a
+traitor. If both Lee and Arnold had fallen in battle, how much better
+it would have been for them and their friends, for "a good name is to be
+preferred above great riches," and they left neither. Perhaps the
+strange desire which Lee later expressed in his will, that his "body
+should not be interred in any church or churchyard, or within a mile of
+any Presbyterian or Baptist church," was not entirely out of keeping
+with the man himself.
+
+The conversation between Washington and Lee at the time they met on the
+retreat at Monmouth has been variously reported; but doubtless the fact
+that those who heard it were as excited as the generals themselves may
+in part account for the differences in the reports which have come down
+to us. We may be sure the conversation was not extended to the length
+which some have said it was, or that it savored largely of the
+high-flown expressions which have been quoted.
+
+One of the men who was present is reported to have said that Washington
+in his sternest manner looked at Lee, and demanded, "What is the meaning
+of all this, sir?"
+
+Dismayed by the terrible appearance of the commander-in-chief, and
+mortified that he should be so addressed in the presence of his
+soldiers, the crestfallen general could only stammer, "Sir? sir?"
+
+Again the enraged commander demanded the meaning of the retreat, and Lee
+attempted to explain. His orders, he said, had been misunderstood, his
+officers had not obeyed his commands, he had not thought it wise to
+attempt to make a stand against the British with his detachment; but the
+angry Washington would not stay to listen to the lame attempts at
+explanation, and muttering something about a "poltroon," he hastened
+back to the high ground between the meeting-house and the bridge, where
+he quickly formed the regiments which were waiting there.
+
+Apparently thinking better of his words, he then rode back to General
+Lee and inquired whether he still desired to retain the command on that
+height or not. "If you will," he added, "I will return to the main body
+and have it formed on the next height."
+
+As Lee accepted the offer, Washington said: "I expect you will take
+proper means for checking the enemy."
+
+"Your orders shall be obeyed," replied Lee, "and I shall not be the
+first to leave the ground."
+
+Meanwhile, the British general Clinton had also been busy. He had
+ordered back many of the troops which the Hessian general Knyphausen
+commanded, and was making vigorous attempts to compel the Americans to
+keep up the retreat, which Lee had ordered with such disastrous results.
+
+The forces under Mad Anthony had rallied at the call of their leader,
+and were bravely holding their position near the parsonage. The British
+grenadiers climbed over the fence which crossed the lot in front of
+Wayne, but were quickly driven back by the angry Continentals.
+
+Again the determined British advanced, and again were driven back. Then
+their brave leader, Colonel Monckton, placing himself at their head, and
+calling upon his men to follow him, led the charge. But Mad Anthony and
+his men were waiting for them, and under their terrible fire the brave
+colonel and many of his men went down as the grass falls before the
+scythe of the mower. Desperate was the struggle then for the body of the
+fallen leader. Hand to hand, clubbing their muskets, using their
+bayonets any way, every way, the men fought on; but the band of sturdy
+Americans held both the body and the place, and as the British fell back
+it was not to attack Mad Anthony's men again during that day.
+
+Sir Henry Clinton then moved the main body of his troops against the
+left of the Americans, where General (Lord) Stirling was in command, but
+the batteries were so well handled that there also the redcoats were
+repulsed.
+
+Then they turned toward the American right; but that sturdy blacksmith
+from Rhode Island, Nathanael Greene, was there, and no better success
+crowned their desperate and determined efforts. And Mad Anthony and his
+men had rushed to the assistance of their comrades. When his men
+perceived the nature of the work which was expected of them, they
+prepared for the action after their own peculiar manner. As we already
+know, many of them had cast aside their coats when they entered the
+battle, but now some of them stopped and deliberately rolled up their
+shirt sleeves. A shout greeted the men, when their action was perceived,
+and in a moment their companions had followed their example. Then, with
+cheers and calls, the unsoldierly appearing soldiers rushed into the
+fray, and so vigorous was their work that soon the redcoats were
+compelled to retreat behind the defile, where the first stand had been
+made in the beginning of the battle.
+
+There they felt secure. On either side lay heavy swamps and thick woods,
+while in front of them was a narrow pass, through which the Americans
+must go if they continued the attack.
+
+And that was just what General Washington determined to do. Carefully he
+arranged for divisions to move upon the right and upon the left, while
+the artillery was to be brought up and pour its terrible fire directly
+into the front of the position the British had taken.
+
+The men responded with a will, but before the detachments could gain the
+desired position the night had come, and darkness spread over the field,
+wrapping friend and foe alike within its folds. Although the eager
+Americans could not then advance, they resolved to pass the night in the
+positions they then held, which were very near to the lines of the
+British, and renew the attack as soon as the light of the morning came.
+
+Guards were established, and then the entire army prepared for the
+night. The exhausted men threw themselves upon the ground, many of them
+lying at full length with their arms spread wide and their faces resting
+directly upon the sand. Seldom have men been more completely worn out
+than were those hardy soldiers on that day of the battle of Monmouth.
+Many had fallen, and when their friends examined their bodies for the
+marks of the fatal bullets not a scratch could be found.
+
+The beams of the summer sun had accomplished what, in many instances,
+the bullets of the enemy had failed to do. All day long the sun had hung
+in the heavens like a great red ball of fire. Steadily the heat had
+risen higher and higher, until it had arrived at a point which even the
+"oldest inhabitants" could not exaggerate in their stories. The tongues
+of some of the men had swelled so that speech became impossible. The
+poor Hessians, condemned to wear their heavy fur hats, left many a
+lifeless body behind them which the heat had conquered before the
+desperate Americans could accomplish the same result.
+
+For hours that night not a sign of life appeared in the American camp.
+Motionless as logs the exhausted soldiers lay stretched upon the ground,
+and the sounds of their deep breathing were all that could be heard.
+They had not stopped even to bury their dead, so little life did the
+living men apparently retain.
+
+Great was the astonishment in the American camp when the first faint
+streaks of the dawn appeared on the following morning, and it was
+discovered that not a soldier remained in the British camp. Sir Henry
+Clinton had permitted his weary men to rest until ten o'clock, and then,
+in silence, preparations were made to join the forces of General
+Knyphausen, who, meanwhile, had marched on and gone into camp at Nut
+Swamp, near the Heights of Middletown.
+
+The British soldiers hastily had collected their wounded, leaving only
+forty of the poor fellows behind them, and then under the light of the
+moon began their march to the position which Knyphausen was holding. So
+wearied were the American soldiers, so heavy was their slumber, and so
+silent were all the movements of Clinton's men, that their departure was
+not discovered before the morning came, and by that time the redcoats
+were with the Hessians and safe from all danger of an attack.
+
+General Washington considered a further pursuit as "impracticable and
+fruitless," and greatly to the chagrin of his army no attempt was made
+to push forward. The great battle of Monmouth had been fought. The
+soldiers hastily prepared to bury their dead, and so hurried were their
+movements that one man afterwards declared he had seen the bodies of
+thirteen men cast into one shallow pit which had been dug in the sand.
+Yet the Continentals were neither brutal nor indifferent. A British army
+was near them, and desperate haste was considered necessary.
+
+The results of the battle, its effect upon the redcoats and buffcoats,
+and those who wore no coats at all, and the parts which Tom Coward and
+certain other of our acquaintances had taken in the struggle, we must
+reserve for another chapter.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+THE RETURN TO BENZEOR'S HOUSE
+
+
+THERE were several motives in the mind of Little Peter which made him
+eager to overtake Ted and the fat and kicking Jeshurun, not the least of
+which was the sense of protection he felt in the presence of the
+powerful man. Boyish as Ted was in many ways, his great size and
+wonderful physical strength made him a companion to be desired in the
+midst of such dangers as the troubled lad was compelled to face in those
+sad times in Old Monmouth.
+
+Accordingly, Little Peter ran eagerly forward, hoping to overtake Ted
+before he should arrive at Benzeor's house, which now was not more than
+two miles away. Long before he came within sight of the place, he
+discovered Ted and his steed in advance of him, and from their
+motionless attitude he quickly concluded that Jeshurun had been seized
+with another attack of obstinacy.
+
+His surmise proved to be correct, and as he came nearer he beheld Ted
+seated by the roadside holding Jeshurun's bridle in his hand, and
+apparently waiting patiently for the time when the little beast should
+decide to continue his journey.
+
+"I'm glad to see you, lad," remarked Ted, as Little Peter approached. "I
+left you rather suddenly back there, but when Jesh makes up his mind to
+start, it's time for me to go, too, and I can't always stop to say
+good-by to my friends. It's easier than walkin', though, but I wish I
+knew some way to fix the little rascal. I've been thinkin' as how, if
+Jeshurun kicked when he waxed fat, it might be that if he waxed thin,
+the kickin' would go, too, along with the fatness. I say, Little Peter,
+I want to ask ye a question."
+
+"All right, Ted, go ahead," replied Little Peter, as he fanned his
+dripping face with his hat and took a seat beside his companion.
+
+"In your opinion," said Ted soberly, "is the oyster a wild animal, or a
+tame one?"
+
+"What?"
+
+"Is the oyster a wild animal or a tame one? Maybe you don't think he's
+an animal at all, only just an insect; but my opinion is that he's an
+animal, and what I'd like to know is whether he's wild or tame."
+
+"He isn't savage, anyway," remarked Little Peter demurely.
+
+"I'm not talkin' about whether he's savage or not, but whether he's wild
+or tame. That's been a-botherin' me a good bit, and I just can't find
+any answer. Whoa! Whoa there, Jesh! What's the matter with ye? If ye
+want to start on, I'm your man." These last remarks were directed at the
+mule, which had begun to display some of the qualities of the famous
+character for whom he had been named; but his owner's words served to
+calm him, and Jeshurun soon stood in such an abject attitude that, to
+one who was not familiar with his ways, wickedness and kicking would
+never have been suspected of him.
+
+"Maybe the oyster's a bird more than he is an insect," said Little
+Peter. "When his shell is spread out it looks something like wings."
+
+"No, he isn't a bird, he's a animal," said Ted, "and what I want to know
+is whether he's a tame or a wild one."
+
+"What do you want to know for?"
+
+"Why, the way of it is this: Some time ago I planted an oyster-bed off
+the mouth of the river, and the first thing I knew my neighbors was
+a-helpin' themselves to it. When I said I didn't like that very much,
+and those oysters was mine, all the men did was to laugh. Yes, sir, jest
+laughed," repeated Ted, as if he felt aggrieved at the levity of his
+neighbors. "Then, they went on to tell me that I couldn't plant oysters,
+same as I did 'taties and things in my garden. Oysters was wild things
+and belonged to anybody that found them, jest the same as turtles and
+clams and wild geese did. I've been a-puzzlin' my head a good deal over
+it, and I can't make it out. I planted them oysters for Sallie,--she's
+my wife, ye know,--and as long as she had all she wanted of 'em, I
+didn't care how much the neighbors helped themselves; but when it comes
+to sayin' that them oysters I planted don't belong to me, but any one
+can go and take all he wants, jest as if they was clams, or
+gooseberries, or--or--or--saltwater, I don't know what to do about it.
+What do you think, Little Peter?" he added anxiously.
+
+"I don't know; I never thought of it before."
+
+Absurd as the question appears to us, it was far from being so to the
+people of Old Monmouth in the times of which we are writing. So warm
+had the discussion become that it was soon after carried into the
+courts, and in 1808 a case was tried before the supreme court, but no
+definite decision was gained. In 1821 another famous trial was held, and
+finally in 1858 the supreme court decided that oysters were both tame
+and wild. Where they had grown naturally and without being planted, they
+were to be considered as wild and the property of any one who chose to
+take them; but where they had been planted, and there was no natural
+growth, the oysters were "tame" and the property of the one who had made
+the bed. Even after that decision there was trouble for a long time in
+Old Monmouth over the question, although to-day it is generally accepted
+that a man may own oysters as he does other animals.
+
+"I'm sorry ye can't help me," said Ted.
+
+"So am I, but I'm not thinking of oysters just now. I want to go up to
+Benzeor Osburn's more than anything else."
+
+"I'm with ye. We're so near, maybe Jeshurun will be willing to go, if he
+doesn't have to carry me on his back. I'll try him and see."
+
+To the surprise of both, Jeshurun appeared to be willing to resume the
+journey and obediently followed Ted, who led him by the bridle rein
+which he slipped over the mule's head.
+
+In this wise they all walked on, but as they came nearer to the end of
+their journey, conversation ceased. Little Peter was thinking of the
+children and trying to devise some plan by which he might care for them.
+What his companion's thoughts were did not appear, but the expression
+upon his face had undergone a change, and from the occasional word he
+dropped, which sounded very like "Hangin' Sallies," the lad thought he
+knew what was going on in Ted's mind. What would occur if Benzeor should
+be found at his home, Little Peter could not determine; but he felt
+assured from Ted's manner that this time his neighbor would not escape
+so easily as he had when the angry man had given him his involuntary
+bath in the waters of the Shrewsbury River.
+
+However, there was a deal of comfort for the lad in the company of his
+powerful friend; and as Benzeor's little house now appeared in the
+distance, he was more and more rejoiced that he was not compelled to
+approach it alone. If Indian John's words were correct, Benzeor was not
+there now; but it was more than possible that John had been mistaken,
+or that the man had returned since his visit in the early morning.
+
+These possibilities were sufficiently strong to increase Little Peter's
+excitement, and when they turned into the lane which led up to the house
+his heart was beating rapidly and his breathing was hard and fast. As he
+glanced toward the place, he suddenly discovered some children playing
+in the yard and instantly recognized two of them as his own little
+brothers.
+
+The children, then, were safe; and with a sigh of relief he turned to
+his companion and said, "There are my little brothers! They're all
+right, and so far it looks better."
+
+"Hangin' Sallies!" muttered Ted; and Little Peter said no more, as he
+perceived that his companion's rage over the treatment his wife had
+received had returned with increased force.
+
+Suddenly out from the barn beyond the house started two men on
+horseback, riding directly down the lane toward them. Startled and
+perplexed by the sight, both Little Peter and Ted stopped and waited for
+the men to approach. If the lad had been alone he would instantly have
+turned and fled without waiting to see who the strangers were; but
+Ted's presence restrained him, and although he was thoroughly alarmed,
+he waited with his companion.
+
+As the horsemen came nearer he discovered that they were Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote, the two men who had been with Tom and
+Benzeor on their voyage to New York just before Tom's departure from his
+foster-father's home. Quickly recalling what Tom had reported of their
+conversation at that time, the sight of them now did not tend to allay
+his fears; but Ted's presence was a source of comfort, and, although he
+was trembling in his excitement, he did not speak.
+
+Barzilla instantly stopped his horse as he recognized Little Peter, and,
+leaning forward on his horse's neck as he spoke, said, "Where's
+Benzeor?"
+
+"I don't know," replied Little Peter. "Isn't he here?"
+
+"No, he isn't here. He came back last night, but he's gone again, and
+the women folks pretend they don't know where he is. It's lucky for
+him."
+
+"What do you want of him?"
+
+"You and he both will know more about that after we've found him,"
+replied Barzilla, as he touched his horse with his spurs, and both men
+rode swiftly down the lane and soon disappeared from sight up the road.
+
+Little Peter told his companion of his suspicions as they resumed their
+walk, and Ted quickly stopped, and, shaking his fist in the direction in
+which the horsemen had disappeared, said, "Hangin' Sallies! Maybe I'd
+better take after them, if I don't find Benzeor."
+
+"No, no, Ted. Come on, we're almost here now."
+
+They soon entered the yard, and as the children discovered the presence
+of their brother they ran eagerly to him and threw themselves into his
+arms.
+
+"I want to go home. I want to go home. May we go home now?" said one of
+them.
+
+Little Peter's eyes filled with tears as he lifted the child in his arms
+and said, "No, I'm afraid not. We haven't any home now."
+
+"But I want to go home," persisted the little fellow pleadingly. "I
+don't want to stay here any longer. I want to go home."
+
+"Hasn't Benzeor been good to you?"
+
+"Yes, but he isn't here. I want to go home. I want to go home."
+
+Little Peter glanced up and saw that Ted's face was moving strangely,
+and that the tears were streaming from his eyes. The powerful man had a
+heart as tender as a woman's, and the piteous pleadings of the homeless,
+motherless little lad were more than he could endure.
+
+"Here, Little Peter!" said Ted hastily. "You go in the house, and I'll
+look after the babies while you're gone. Here, my lads and lassies all!
+Come take a ride on the back of Jeshurun."
+
+In a moment the grief of the little ones was forgotten, and, laughing in
+their delight, they were lifted upon the back of Jeshurun, who to all
+appearances had suddenly become as mild and gentle as a lamb.
+
+Little Peter glanced back at the laughing group as he started toward the
+house, and then looking up beheld Sarah standing in the doorway. Her
+face was red with weeping and she evidently was in great distress.
+
+"Why, Sarah!" exclaimed Little Peter. "What's the trouble? What is it?"
+
+"My father! My father!" sobbed Sarah, burying her face in her hands.
+
+"What's happened to him? Is he killed? Is he dead?"
+
+"No, no. It's worse than that."
+
+"Worse than that? What do you mean?"
+
+"Oh, Little Peter, don't _you_ know?" exclaimed the girl, looking up
+again as she spoke.
+
+Peter made no reply. He did not know just what it was to which Sarah
+referred, and although he had his own suspicions, he did not feel that
+he could refer to them in the presence of the troubled girl.
+
+"Have you seen Tom?" said Sarah suddenly.
+
+"No. He's in the army, I think, and I haven't been near that."
+
+"You wouldn't have to go very far. They say they're both near here, and
+that there either has been a battle or there will be one soon. I wish
+Tom was here. If you see him, won't you tell him to come back just as
+soon as he can?"
+
+"Yes, if I see him. I don't know that I shall very soon, though. I don't
+know what to do, Sarah. I came to see about the children."
+
+"They're all right. They seem to be now, don't they?" she said, as a
+burst of laughter came from the noisy group. "Perhaps you don't want to
+leave them here now, though," she added, her eyes filling with tears
+once more as she spoke. "I wish you would leave them. It isn't much we
+can do for you, but we want to do what we can."
+
+There was an intensity in Sarah's manner which Little Peter could not
+understand. He was in ignorance of all that Sarah knew, and perhaps if
+he had known his reply might have been somewhat different.
+
+"It's good of you, Sarah. I don't know what to do or where to go."
+
+"You can stay here, too."
+
+"No, no. I can't do that," he said hastily; and then fearing that he had
+said too much, added, "I'll leave the children for a little while.
+They'll be safe here till after the battle you tell about."
+
+"I wish you would, Peter. You couldn't please us better. Who's that man
+with you?" she added, apparently for the first time becoming aware of
+Ted's presence.
+
+"A man to see your father," said Little Peter evasively. "Is he home?"
+
+"No, no," and Sarah shuddered as she spoke. "He came last night, but he
+didn't stay long. He went away again, and I don't know when he'll come
+again. It'll be a long time. I hope"--
+
+What Sarah hoped for she did not explain, and Little Peter said, "I
+want to talk with Ted before I say anything more. He's the man out there
+with the children. I'll be back in a minute."
+
+Many minutes passed, however, before the lad returned. He called to Ted
+and for a long time they talked together. Ted was decidedly averse to
+the plan of leaving the children in Benzeor's home, and freely offered
+to take them with him to the place where he had left Sallie and his own
+little ones, also venturing to refer several times to the fact that
+Sallie was his wife.
+
+Pleased as Little Peter would have been to accept the offer, Sarah's
+pleadings could not be forgotten, and as he felt that the children would
+be safe where they then were, he declined the kind offer of Ted.
+
+"I'll tell you what, my lad," said Ted at last. "If the armies are as
+near here as the girl says they are, the thing for you and me to do is
+to go over there. They may need us, too. The most I've done so far has
+been to look out for that stuff the men brought up the Shrewsbury in the
+supply boat. That's all in good hands now, and I'm free to go. Jesh will
+be glad to go, too."
+
+"But you can't leave Sallie and the babies."
+
+"Yes, I can, too. Sallie's my wife, ye know, and when I took her over to
+the Dennises I told her I might not be back for a week or two. She won't
+be disappointed, and Jesh will be tickled to pieces to join the army.
+Jest look at his ears now. When his ears is that way, I always know
+Jeshurun wants to fight the Dutch butchers."
+
+"We've no other place to go to, or at least I haven't," said Little
+Peter thoughtfully. "Well, we'll do as you say. I'll go and tell Sarah."
+
+"I'm so glad you'll leave the children," said Sarah eagerly, when Little
+Peter reported the decision which had been made. "It isn't much we can
+do, as I told you, but we do want to do everything we can for you."
+
+"It's good of you to take them."
+
+"It's good of you to leave them. There's one thing, though, I must tell
+you. We haven't much to eat in the house. There's some meal over at the
+mill, and father would have gone for it if he'd been home to-day. But he
+isn't here and I don't know what we'll do."
+
+"You'd like to have me go over there and get it, before we start," said
+the boy. "Have you got your horses yet?"
+
+"Yes, there are two in the barn, and you can take the heavy wagon. It's
+kind of you to do it, Little Peter, but it won't take you long, and you
+don't know how much it will help us just now."
+
+"I'll go right away."
+
+Little Peter turned and explained to Ted the cause of the delay. At
+first, Ted insisted upon going with him, but as the lad explained that
+only two hours would be required for the journey, he persuaded him to
+remain.
+
+In a few minutes the two horses had been led forth from the barn, and
+hitched to the wagon ("geared" was what Ted called the task), and then
+Little Peter mounted the seat, grasped the reins in his hands, and
+turned down the lane, on what proved to be the most eventful ride in all
+his life.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+THE RIDE TO THE MILL
+
+
+THE early morning had not yet gone when Little Peter started on his
+journey to the mill. He knew the place well, for many a time had he gone
+there for his father. It was an antiquated structure beside a pond,
+which had been formed by a dam built across the very brook near which he
+and Indian John had passed the preceding night.
+
+The work at the mill had been somewhat interrupted since the outbreak of
+the war, but the increasing necessities of the people of Old Monmouth
+had led the miller to resume his labors, and Sarah had informed Little
+Peter that he would surely find him in his accustomed place.
+
+At times, the road led through the woods, and the boy could almost touch
+the bushes that grew close to the sandy roadway on either side. His view
+was somewhat obstructed by these,--and that fact, together with the
+unbroken stillness that rested over all, combined to make Little Peter
+watchful, and somewhat fearful as well.
+
+The sunlight flickered through the treetops and cast fantastic shadows
+on the ground. The horses did not increase their speed above a slow
+trot, for the heat was oppressive and the sandy road was heavy; and,
+eager as Little Peter was to be back again at Benzeor's house, he had
+not the heart to urge on the toiling beasts. The mill was not more than
+three miles from the place from which he had started, and at the pace at
+which the horses were then going the lad thought he would be back in
+less than two hours.
+
+He had covered about half of the way to the mill when his horses, with a
+sudden snort of fear, darted to one side of the roadway. Little Peter
+quickly drew the reins tight, and stood up to discover the cause of the
+alarm.
+
+Two men stepped from the bushes into the road, and as they grasped the
+horses by their bits the lad at once recognized them as Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote.
+
+"We thought you were Benzeor," exclaimed Barzilla, as he discovered who
+the driver was.
+
+"I've got his horses," replied Little Peter.
+
+"So I see. What are you doing with them?"
+
+"Going to the mill. You know the children are at Benzeor's house, and
+Sarah wanted me to go for some meal. She said there was none in the
+house and her father wasn't likely to be home in time to get it, so I
+came for it."
+
+"Where's your father?"
+
+"He's been sent to New York."
+
+"So I've heard. Little Peter, do you know who made the attack on your
+house?"
+
+"It was Fenton's gang, I'm sure."
+
+"So am I, and I ought to know, for I was there myself."
+
+"You there?" exclaimed Little Peter. He did not refer to the suspicions
+he had entertained concerning the very men who then stood before him;
+but he had never expected them to declare their actions so boldly. The
+alarm which he had felt, when the two men had suddenly presented
+themselves in the road, was greatly increased now, and for a moment he
+glanced quickly about as if he were seeking some avenue of escape.
+
+"Yes, we were there," resumed Barzilla, apparently ignoring the lad's
+alarm. "I didn't know but you knew it, and I've felt mean enough about
+it, too. We didn't have anything to do with what happened there," he
+hastily added; "but the truth is, we thought it was about time some kind
+of a stop was put to the doings of the pine robbers,--so Jacob, here,
+and I pretended to go in with them. Of course we didn't like the work,
+but we hoped we could learn enough about their plans to trap them. And
+we've almost succeeded. We've been as busy as you have, my lad, and
+pretty soon we hope the murderers of your mother will be run to cover."
+
+Little Peter had never thought of the scheme which Barzilla mentioned,
+and at first he did not know whether to believe him or not. Certainly
+appearances were against him, but he was in no position to dispute the
+statement.
+
+"Is that what Benzeor was doing, too?" he inquired.
+
+"Benzeor? Benzeor Osburn? Don't you know what he had to do"--
+
+"Hold on, Barzilla," interrupted Jacob. "Little Peter doesn't know about
+him, or he wouldn't let the children stay there."
+
+"Why? What do you mean? Aren't the children safe there?" said Peter
+quickly.
+
+"Safe? They couldn't be safer if they were in China, or some other
+heathing land," said Barzilla. "Even Benzeor's horses are safe. There
+isn't such a team as that left in Old Monmouth," he added, "and if his
+beasts aren't touched, I don't think you need to worry very much about
+the young ones."
+
+"I don't understand," said Little Peter.
+
+"You don't need to," said Jacob quickly, "You've got enough to worry
+about, my boy, without bothering your head over Barzilla's words. He
+talks too much, anyway. You just go on and get the meal for Sarah;
+that's all you need to think about now."
+
+"Yes, but Little Peter ought to know a bit more," said Barzilla
+doggedly. "The truth is that we've run some of Fenton's gang into these
+very woods. There are several of us scouring the region, and it's only
+fair to tell you that you may run across some of 'em if you keep on. For
+my part I advise you to turn back and not go to the mill at all. It
+isn't safe."
+
+"Nobody'll touch him. Let him go on," said Jacob. "The children will
+have to be fed, and he might as well get the meal. He's safe enough."
+
+"He can do as he pleases," muttered Barzilla.
+
+Little Peter was perplexed, for the actions and words of the men were
+sadly confusing. Tom had reported to him some of their previous
+conversations, and his own suspicions, as we know, had been aroused. If
+Barzilla spoke truly now, he was in no slight danger himself, while the
+very decided difference of opinion between the two men tended to
+increase his confusion.
+
+"I'm goin' to tell you some more," said Jacob. "Last night some of
+Fenton's gang went over to Mr. Farr's. You know the old man, don't you?"
+
+"You mean Thomas Farr, the old man who lives with his wife and daughter
+over on the road to Imlaystown?"
+
+"That's the very man. Well, Lew Fenton and some of his gang went over
+there about midnight, and attacked the house. There wasn't any one in it
+but the old man and his wife and their daughter, and you know she's old
+enough to have arrived at years of discretion, to put it mildly. The old
+people barricaded the doors with logs of wood just as soon as they
+discovered who the men were.
+
+"The pine robbers tried to break the door down with some fence rails,
+but when that failed, they fired a volley of bullets right through the
+door. One ball broke the leg of the old man, but still they wouldn't let
+the pine robbers in. Then the villains went around to the back door and
+succeeded in smashing that in. They stuck a bayonet into the old man,
+who was helpless on the floor, and then they murdered his wife right
+before his eyes. One of the men struck the daughter with the butt of his
+gun, but, although she was pretty badly hurt, she managed to get out of
+the house.
+
+"Fenton's gang didn't wait to plunder the place, but, as they were
+afraid she'd raise an alarm, they all cleared out. 'Twas mighty lucky
+for them that they did, for there was a lot of us near by. You see we'd
+seen Benzeor"--
+
+"Hold on, Jacob. That's enough. Now, Peter, you see what's going on, and
+it's my opinion that some of Fenton's gang, and maybe Fenton himself,
+are in these very woods. That's why I advised ye not to go on. Now you
+can do jest as ye like, for you've got pretty much the whole story."
+
+"I think you'll be all right," said Jacob. "It's only a little way up to
+the mill, and the children need that meal. I should go if I was in your
+place, and if I didn't have to keep watch here, I'd go with ye myself."
+
+"I'll go," said Little Peter quietly.
+
+"Good luck to ye, then," said Barzilla. "We'll see you here when you
+come back."
+
+Little Peter picked up the reins and at once started, leaving the two
+men behind him, who remained standing in the road, and watched him until
+he disappeared from sight. The lad's feelings, however, had undergone a
+very decided change. He was convinced that the story concerning the aged
+Thomas Farr was true, and he was also persuaded that his suspicions of
+Jacob and Barzilla were unjust.
+
+Every tree now might be the hiding-place of Fenton, or some of his band.
+Each moment he expected to see some one step forth into the road before
+him and stop his horses. The very silence in the woods served to
+increase his alarm. He quickened the speed of the horses, and soon they
+were wet with foam, as they toiled on through the heavy sand. The cry of
+a bird, or the chattering of a squirrel, caused the excited lad to
+glance fearfully in the direction from which the sound came. To his
+excited imagination the woods were filled with his enemies, and more
+than once a fallen tree or a broken branch took on the outlines of a
+man.
+
+It was with a feeling of intense relief that at last he saw the
+crumbling old mill before him. The sound of the water, as it dropped
+from the dam to the bed of the brook below, was like music in his ears;
+and when he discovered the miller himself standing in the doorway, he
+again increased the speed of his horses, and soon halted before the
+mill.
+
+"I've come for Benzeor Osburn's grist," he said, as he leaped from his
+seat to the ground.
+
+"They must be pretty hungry over there, from the looks of your horses."
+
+"They are. Has any one been here this morning?"
+
+"Not a soul. There's no work now, with all this fighting going on. Have
+you heard anything from the soldiers?"
+
+"Not much, only that both the armies must be near here now."
+
+There was nothing, however, in the presence of the old mill to indicate
+that war's rude alarms were to be heard anywhere in the region. The
+monotonous sound of the falling water, the dull hum of the big wheel,
+the little garden which the miller had planted near his log house close
+by, the dog lying asleep on the doorsill, the little urchins playing in
+the waters of the brook, the hens fluttering in the roadway and covering
+themselves with dust,--all seemed to declare that only peace and quiet
+were to be found in the region.
+
+And yet, only a few miles away two great armies had assembled, and, on
+the morrow the summer air would resound with the booming of cannon, and
+many a buffcoat and redcoat would be left lying side by side upon the
+plains of Old Monmouth, never again to be mindful of the struggle, or
+hear or heed the calls of their officers as they led the men into
+battle.
+
+At that very time, if the words of Barzilla Giberson were true, the
+woods, which extended between the mill and the main road, concealed some
+of the hated pine robbers, as well as outraged patriots who were
+searching for their enemies.
+
+The wagon was soon loaded, the miller's share of the grist having first
+been set aside, and Little Peter climbed up on the seat and grasped the
+reins, as he prepared to start again.
+
+"You'd better be careful," said Little Peter. "I'm told some of the
+pine robbers are hiding in these woods."
+
+"I'm not afraid," laughed the miller. "I never harmed them and they
+won't harm me."
+
+The lad related the story of the attack upon the house of Thomas Farr,
+but still the miller to all appearances was not deeply impressed.
+
+"I haven't any money and they've nothing to gain by disturbing me. I
+grind my grists just the same, whether it's a king or Congress that
+rules over me, and I don't care much, for my part, which it is. I don't
+bother my head about such things. All I want is good water and plenty of
+corn, and I'm happy all the day long."
+
+Little Peter had given his warning, so he said no more, but bidding the
+miller good-day, he spoke to his horses and at once departed.
+
+His load was heavier now than when he had come, and consequently he was
+compelled to let his horses walk. Even then the sweltering beasts
+labored heavily under the intense heat, and he was compelled to stop
+frequently and permit them to rest in some cool and shady spot.
+
+His own fears had not departed, however, but every turn of the heavy
+wheels brought him nearer to the main road, and once there he thought he
+would be safe. Already one of the three miles had been left behind him,
+and he was about to start on, after the brief rest he had given the
+horses, when he was startled by the sound of something breaking through
+the bushes that lined the road in front of him.
+
+Tremblingly he waited a moment, gazing with frightened face at the place
+in the road where the man, or animal, or whatever it was, would first
+appear. His suspense was not relieved when a horse and rider broke
+through the bushes and stopped only a few yards in advance of him.
+
+Little Peter's face was deadly pale when he instantly recognized the man
+as none other than Lewis Fenton himself. He noted the great size, the
+broad shoulders, the powerful arms, for the pine robber was riding
+without a coat, and his shirt-sleeves were rolled back, disclosing the
+great bunches of muscles; but more than all else the brutal face
+terrified him.
+
+Before he could speak or move, Fenton leaped to the ground, and leaving
+his horse by the roadside approached the wagon.
+
+"How now, young man? Give an account of yourself. Where you going? Who
+are you? As I live, if it isn't Little Peter Van Mater!" he added in
+evident astonishment.
+
+As he spoke, he grasped the frightened lad by the shoulder and dragged
+him to the ground. Then the brutal, cowardly man struck him two savage
+blows. The sight of the woods and even of the pine robber faded from
+Little Peter's eyes, and the unconscious boy dropped heavily upon the
+sand. Even then Fenton was not satisfied, for again and again he kicked
+the body, apparently not yet convinced that life was extinct.
+
+But Little Peter suffered no pain. With sightless eyes, his
+blood-stained face looked up at the blue sky above the treetops, but
+neither the passing clouds nor the further actions of the brutal pine
+robber were heeded by the lad.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+AFTER THE BATTLE
+
+
+TOM COWARD, as we know, had been selected to serve as one of the guides
+of the American army. The roads were not so numerous as to cause any
+fear of serious trouble from confusion; but boys and young men from the
+region were nevertheless assigned to this duty, and in some instances
+were said to have been so greatly excited as to have failed in finding
+the way themselves. To this cause some assigned the failure of Morgan's
+dragoons to enter the battle; but doubtless there were other causes as
+well which prevented that terrible band of riflemen from having a share
+in the struggle.
+
+Tom had been reserved to move with the troops that were under the
+command of General Washington himself, and that followed the division
+which General Lee had failed to lead into battle. Frightened as the lad
+was, he still noted keenly all that was occurring about him, and had
+been as highly excited as any over the interview which took place
+between Washington and Lee when the latter was retreating. The
+impressions he there received were those which the people of Old
+Monmouth ever after retained concerning Charles Lee, for he was
+remembered, not for his experiences abroad or for his successes in the
+south, but as the man who had been the traitor in the battle.
+
+When the engagement began, Tom's duties as guide were ended, but as no
+one gave him any instructions, he was driven from one band of men to
+another, and while he still retained the rifle which he had taken when
+he had departed from Benzeor's house, he had not made any use of it.
+
+For a time he remained within sight of the young lieutenant, and they
+were together when in the early part of the battle Captain Molly had
+done the deed which has caused her name to be remembered until this day.
+Molly had marched with her husband, and as the advanced batteries opened
+fire upon each other the intrepid woman had been running back and forth
+between the men and a little spring, which was near by, bringing water
+to her husband and his companions. Her task was no light one in the heat
+of that day.
+
+As she had started to return from one of her visits to the spring, she
+turned just in time to see her husband fall as he was advancing to his
+post, for he was a cannoneer, as we already know. Molly hastily ran to
+his assistance, but she at once perceived that he was dead. She heard an
+officer order the cannon to be moved from its position, but instantly
+controlling her grief, she declared her purpose to take her husband's
+place. Amidst the cheers of the men she did so, and so bravely and well
+did she perform the duty, that after the battle was ended General Greene
+himself presented her to the great commander and related the story of
+her bravery. Washington added his words of praise and bestowed upon her
+a lieutenant's commission. The men received the news with loud cheers,
+and then themselves bestowed upon "Molly Pitcher" the title of "Captain
+Molly," and as Captain Molly she was known thereafter.
+
+Another story, told afterwards by the Frenchmen, reflected great credit
+upon General Clinton, and perhaps in a measure atoned for the action of
+that commander in wantonly burning so many of the houses in Old
+Monmouth. An American officer with about twenty of his men advanced
+under the English batteries to observe their position. The redcoats
+opened fire, and the officer's aid-de-camp fell at his side. The men,
+who were dragoons, instantly turned and fled,--that is, all save the
+officer, who, although he was directly under the fire of the cannon,
+calmly dismounted and advanced to discover whether the fallen man was
+dead or not, or whether the wound had been mortal. Quickly discovering
+that the man was dead, the American officer, visibly weeping, turned and
+remounted his horse and slowly rejoined his comrades. The officer was
+the young Marquis de Lafayette, and his white charger had been
+recognized by General Clinton, who himself ordered his men not to fire,
+and doubtless thereby saved the life of the brave young nobleman. It was
+long cherished as the one deed of mercy in the midst of a campaign and
+battle which left its marks of suffering and sorrow on every side.
+
+An instance of the other side of the British commander's character came
+to Tom's attention not long afterwards, when he heard of the misfortune
+of an old lady seventy years of age, in whose house General Clinton made
+his headquarters. The British officer, noticing that his hostess had
+caused all of her better furniture and valuables to be removed, informed
+her that she need have had no fears for the safety of her possessions,
+for he himself would protect her and them, and urged her to have them
+brought back again. As the old lady expressed her fears and objected, he
+repeated his assurances so strongly that she yielded and sent a man with
+a wagon to the place in which they had been concealed.
+
+When the wagon-load arrived in front of her door, she in person applied
+to the British commander for a guard; but the permission was refused
+and, not even giving her a change of dress for herself or her aged
+husband, the goods were at once confiscated, and the old lady was
+compelled to give up her bedroom and sleep with the negro women upon the
+floor of the kitchen.
+
+Among the congregation which had assembled at the "new church" to watch
+the battle was one man who, instead of joining his friends upon the roof
+or steeple, took his seat upon one of the gravestones. Not long
+afterwards, a cannon-ball came speeding in that direction, and struck
+the unfortunate man.
+
+The congregation upon the roof did not wait for the customary
+benediction to be pronounced, we may be sure, and while the most of them
+hastily dispersed, a few remained to carry the wounded man into the
+"meeting-house," where he died within a few minutes, and the stains of
+his blood remained for many years upon the floor. It was within six feet
+of the west end of this same "new church" that the body of the
+unfortunate British Colonel Monckton, over which the contending forces
+had such a desperate struggle, was buried.
+
+Within the vicinity of Monmouth Court House many houses and farm
+buildings were set on fire and burned by the redcoats, some of whom
+openly declared that there was no hope of conquering the rebels until
+"they had burned every house and killed every man, woman, and child."
+Just how they expected to conquer _after_ they had burned the buildings
+and slain the people is not clear to us to-day; but doubtless the
+expression and the purpose alike were born of the fury of the battle,
+and was only one among many of the results of war, which even in its
+mildest forms appeals to all that is bad in men. And as the campaign in
+Old Monmouth presented none of the milder forms of war, such deeds,
+terrible as they were, were not unnatural.
+
+Nor were they all confined to one side, for the men in buff and blue
+were as much aroused as the men in scarlet, and, while naturally the
+anecdotes and incidents of the battle are largely those of the cruel
+deeds of the redcoats, doubtless if all things had been recorded, we
+should have found that many of those brave ancestors of ours were not
+entirely guiltless of similar deeds.
+
+An unusual story was that of Captain Cook of the Virginia Corps, who was
+shot through the lungs. He was carried into a room in a near-by house
+and ordered by the surgeon not to speak. A brother officer came into the
+room and tenderly asked of the wounded man whether anything could be
+done for him. Captain Cook, in spite of his sufferings, was mindful of
+the surgeon's words and made no reply. Mistaking the cause of the
+silence, his friend departed from the house and reported to Washington
+that Captain Cook was dead, and then the commander ordered a coffin to
+be placed under the window of the room in which the brave captain was
+supposed to be lying dead. But Captain Cook was not dead, nor did he
+die until many years afterwards, and lived to visit several times the
+good people in Old Monmouth, who had tenderly ministered to his wants
+until he was able to rejoin the army.
+
+After the battle, many of the dead were found beneath the shade of
+trees, or beside the little streams to which they had crawled for
+shelter or for water; and many of these had perished, not from wounds,
+but from their labors in the intense heat of the day. Several houses at
+Monmouth Court House were filled with the wounded after the battle, and
+every room in the Court House itself was likewise filled. The suffering
+soldiers lay upon the straw which had been scattered over the floors,
+and the groans and cries of the wounded and the moanings of the dying
+resounded together. The faces of many were so blackened that their
+dearest friends did not recognize them, and as fast as they died their
+bodies were taken and buried in pits, which were only slightly covered
+by the sand.
+
+A similar service was rendered for the enemy's dead, and among them was
+found a sergeant of dragoons whose immense body had been a familiar
+sight to both armies, for the man was said to have been the tallest
+soldier ever seen in all the struggle of the Revolution, and to have
+measured seven feet and four inches in height.
+
+So, side by side, or in neighboring graves, the nameless bodies of
+friends and foes were left for their last long sleep. The roar of the
+cannon, the shouts of the men, the calls of the officers, the bitter
+feelings of the awful war were never to disturb or arouse them again.
+They had done their part, and done it well; but the land for which they
+struggled could never mark their resting-places, nor perhaps recall the
+names of all. But the heroes whose names we praise would never have been
+honored except for the part the faithful and brave, but nameless and
+forgotten, heroes took. In honoring the one class, let us never forget
+to pay a tribute of honor and of praise to the unknown and forgotten
+heroes of Old Monmouth.
+
+The loss of the Americans in the battle had been three hundred and
+sixty-two. That of the British, while it was reported to have been four
+hundred and sixteen, was doubtless much greater, for the Americans
+buried no less than two hundred and forty-five of the redcoats, and had
+no means of knowing how many had been carried away. Washington himself
+believed the loss to have been as great as twelve hundred.
+
+Who were the victors on the plains of Old Monmouth? What were the
+effects of the campaign upon the fortunes of the struggling States? Most
+American writers have claimed that the victory belonged to the
+Continentals because they had driven the British from the field, while
+many British writers have claimed that it was a drawn battle.
+
+Certainly, Washington must have felt bitterly disappointed, for he had
+hoped to defeat the enemy and capture their baggage and stores. His
+failure to do so was not due to the British, but to the treachery of
+Charles Lee. Had Lee carried out the orders given him, there can be
+little doubt to-day that the battle of Monmouth would have aided in
+putting an end to the war long before peace came.
+
+We are not concerned by what might have been the result, however, but by
+what was the result. Clinton succeeded in withdrawing his troops and
+saving his baggage train, and with both soon after embarked (June 30)
+upon the ships which Lord Howe had been keeping in waiting off Sandy
+Hook, and thereby gained the safety of New York. But his men were
+greatly disheartened, and came to regard the despised "rebels" in an
+entirely new light. Indeed, within a week more than two thousand
+deserted, the most of whom were Hessians, and the confidence of those
+who remained was sadly broken. While it is a current saying that
+"nothing succeeds like success," it is also evident that nothing fails
+like failure, and this was as true in those trying days of the
+Revolution as it is to-day, and General Clinton soon found it to be so.
+
+Upon the Americans, the moral effect of the campaign and battle was more
+needed than the material effect. Valley Forge was passed now,
+Philadelphia had been abandoned by the British, and the Americans had
+found upon the plains of Old Monmouth, as they had at Trenton and
+Princeton, that their men were not inferior to their enemies, while
+their officers were among the best the world had known. The opponents
+and enemies of Washington, and they were many at the time both within
+and without Congress, were compelled to be silent, and the great
+commander was free to face his difficulties and dangers, which were not
+ended after the battle of Monmouth. That campaign had served chiefly to
+place behind him one more of his problems, but, as we shall see, many
+yet remained to try the soul of the noblest American of them all.
+
+Meanwhile, what had become of the lad Tom Coward? Alarmed by the battle,
+not daring to fight and yet not knowing where to withdraw, although his
+fear had not been strong enough to lead to such a result, he was driven
+about by the movements of the men, and in one of the lulls which came in
+the conflict, he found himself almost alone. He was near a barn which
+stood beyond the borders of the battlefield, and was just about to turn
+the corner when he stumbled over the body of a fallen man.
+
+As he glanced down, he was almost overcome when he discovered that the
+soldier was his friend, the young lieutenant. A hurried examination
+revealed that he was still living, though he was badly wounded in the
+throat. The lad lifted the head of the suffering man, but a groan caused
+him to desist. Almost overcome by grief and fear, he turned to seek for
+aid.
+
+[Illustration: HE DISCOVERED THAT THE SOLDIER WAS HIS FRIEND]
+
+As he looked quickly about him, he perceived a man in the distance on
+the border of the woods away from the battle-ground. Instantly he
+turned and ran toward him, and to his surprise discovered that the man
+was none other than Friend Nathan Brown.
+
+"Come, Nathan! come! Be quick! Lieutenant Gordon's over here by the
+barn. He's terribly wounded and may die any moment. Come and help me
+with him!"
+
+The Quaker instantly responded, and without explaining how it had
+happened that he should be discovered so near a scene to which in spirit
+as well as in practice he was strongly opposed, ran by the side of the
+eager lad to the place where the wounded man had fallen.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+TOM COWARD'S PATIENT
+
+
+THE place where young Lieutenant Gordon was lying was in the rear of the
+barn which belonged to the parsonage of the "new church." After the
+bullet had hit him, he had managed to crawl to that secluded place, but
+the sounds of the battle, which was still being waged in the vicinity,
+were not long heard by the wounded officer, for he had soon become
+unconscious, and the roar of the cannon and the shouts of the men were
+all unheeded and unheard.
+
+"Is he dead?" said Nathan in a low voice, as he looked down upon the
+unconscious man.
+
+"No! no!" replied Tom hastily; "or at least he wasn't a minute ago. No,
+he's still alive," he added after a hurried examination. "We must carry
+him away from this place."
+
+"I see no place for thy friend. These sons of Belial are not likely to
+permit thee to depart unnoticed."
+
+Friend Nathan was trembling, and his face betrayed his alarm. And there
+was much to frighten him. Clouds of smoke could be seen not far away,
+and the loud shouts of men and the reports of their guns could be
+distinctly heard. The struggle near the meeting-house was one of the
+most severe in all the battle, and the danger of which the frightened
+Nathan spoke was not unreal. But Tom's fears had departed now, and
+although he never fully understood the cause of the change in his
+feelings, the sight of his suffering friend and his determination to aid
+him had banished all thoughts concerning his own personal safety.
+
+At a distance of a half mile, Tom could see a little farmhouse, and he
+hastily decided that the young lieutenant must be carried there. The
+building was on the border of the plain and on the side opposite to the
+place where the struggle was going on.
+
+There would be danger in the attempt to carry him across the field, but
+thinking only of his friend, Tom said hastily, "We must carry him to
+that farmhouse yonder, Nathan. I don't know who lives there, but whoever
+does won't refuse to receive a wounded man, I know. You take hold of his
+feet, and I'll lift the head and shoulders, and we'll get him there
+somehow. Come, Nathan, we mustn't delay a minute."
+
+"Have it thine own way, Friend Thomas," replied Nathan, as he stooped
+and grasped the legs of the wounded officer.
+
+Tom gently lifted the head of the young lieutenant at the same time, and
+carefully across the field the two men began to move with their burden.
+Their progress necessarily was slow, and the lad's fears were not
+allayed by the evident alarm of his companion. Nathan repeatedly glanced
+behind him, and several times Tom was compelled to speak sharply to
+recall the frightened man to their present task. The shouts and reports
+of the guns were increasing, and Tom's strongest desire was to avoid
+attracting the attention of any of the combatants.
+
+They had safely passed beyond the orchard, and he was just beginning to
+hope that their efforts would be successful, when suddenly Nathan's hat
+was lifted from his head and the sound of a whistling musket-ball was
+heard as it passed above them.
+
+For a moment, the startled Nathan looked down at his hat, and as he
+perceived the hole in it which the bullet had made, he instantly
+dropped his burden, and turning sharply about, started in a swift run
+across the field.
+
+"Come back, Nathan! Come back! Don't leave me here!" pleaded Tom; but
+Nathan did not heed the call.
+
+His pace was a marvelous one for a man of his years, and as he bent low
+over the ground, as if to avoid other bullets which might be coming
+toward him, and sped swiftly forward, under other circumstances Tom
+might have felt inclined to laugh at the ludicrous sight the fleeing man
+of peace presented. But as it was he felt much more inclined to cry than
+to laugh, and, as he realized his own helplessness, he knew not what to
+do. If he had been alone he might have followed Nathan and gained a
+place of safety, but, as he glanced down upon the suffering man, who now
+lay stretched upon the ground, his whole soul rebelled against the
+thought of deserting his friend in a time like that.
+
+What could he do? The desperate lad looked about him hoping to discover
+some one whom he might summon to his aid. In the distance he could see
+the bands of struggling soldiers, and their shouts and shots could be
+clearly heard. But they were all intent upon their own contest, and
+there was no one who would hear or heed him if he should call.
+
+He could not abandon his friend--that much at least was certain; and at
+last he determined to do his utmost to carry the helpless, wounded man
+himself. Placing his arms beneath the shoulders of the unconscious
+lieutenant, and striving to rest the head against his own body, he
+started slowly on, dragging the man with him. His progress was
+necessarily slow, and he was compelled to stop frequently, both for his
+own sake and that of his friend. Still, on and on he persistently made
+his way. The intense heat of the day, his constant fear that life would
+depart from the body he was dragging forward, the sound of the battle
+behind him, all combined to increase his troubles; but not for a moment
+did he think of abandoning his efforts for his friend.
+
+Proceeding slowly, stopping at frequent intervals and then resuming his
+efforts, he steadily drew nearer to the farmhouse he had perceived in
+the distance. How much time had been consumed he could not determine.
+The minutes seemed like hours to the struggling lad. His own danger was
+all forgotten for the time, and the one purpose in his mind was to
+carry Lieutenant Gordon to some place of safety, where it should be
+possible to do something for the relief of the desperately wounded man.
+
+At last, only one more lot remained to be crossed, and with renewed hope
+Tom was about to lift his burden, which he had dropped for one of his
+brief rests, when he suddenly discovered a man running toward him.
+Startled and alarmed by the sight he quickly perceived that the
+approaching man was Friend Nathan, who, hatless and with a dripping
+face, was soon by his side.
+
+"Thou hast put me to shame, Friend Thomas," said Nathan soberly. "Thou
+art a better man than I, as well as a braver. I know not why it was, but
+when my hat was lifted from my head, and I perceived that hole the
+bullet had made, I lost my self-control. My teaching has been that of
+peace and I am poorly prepared for the contests of war. I will give thee
+no cause to complain now."
+
+"Take hold, then," said Tom quickly. "We must get the lieutenant out of
+this heat, or there'll be no hope for him."
+
+Nathan eagerly responded, and tenderly lifting the wounded man they
+proceeded across the lot.
+
+When they halted for their first rest, Nathan said, "I have a word to
+say to thee, Friend Thomas. What did Washington say to thee when he
+heard thy demand for a recompense for the beast I let thee have?"
+
+"Say? He didn't say anything, because I didn't say anything to him. You
+don't suppose he hadn't anything more to do than to talk with a boy like
+me about your old, broken-winded razor-back, do you? I don't even know
+what has become of the beast. I know I'm glad I don't have to ride it
+any more."
+
+"'Tis well, Friend Thomas," replied Nathan, although Tom thought he
+discovered a trace of disappointment in the expression upon his face.
+"'Tis well, and I would not have it otherwise. I have been humiliated by
+my weakness in deserting thee, a mere lad, at such a time as this. I
+would like also to restore to you the half-joe you paid me for my
+beast." And as Nathan spoke, he drew the coin from his pocket and held
+it forth for Tom to take.
+
+"I don't want your money," said the lad quickly. "Take hold of the
+lieutenant again, and this time we'll not stop before we come to the
+house."
+
+Once more they tenderly took up their burden, and slowly advancing, soon
+approached the house. In the doorway a man and a young woman, evidently
+his daughter, were standing, watching the movements of the approaching
+men with a curiosity which the noise of the battle in the distance could
+not entirely dispel.
+
+Tom's heart was lighter when he recognized the man as Jonathan Cook and
+the young woman as his daughter Mary.
+
+"We've brought this man here," said Tom quickly, "to find a
+resting-place for him. It's Lieutenant Gordon, and he's terribly
+wounded. Will you let us put him in one of your beds?"
+
+"We will that," said Mr. Cook. "We've got one poor fellow here now, and
+will do all we can for another, too. Take him right in here," he added,
+leading the way to a bedroom adjoining the living-room on the ground
+floor.
+
+Tom and Nathan eagerly followed him, and in a brief time had placed the
+suffering man on the high bed. Although the lad was almost exhausted by
+his efforts, with Nathan's aid he soon removed the clothing of the
+young officer, and then Mary came and bathed his bleeding face, and with
+many expressions of sympathy listened to the story the weary boy had to
+tell.
+
+"I don't suppose it's been wise or safe for us to stay here," said Mary,
+"but we just couldn't leave the old place until we had to. We've been
+keeping watch all day long, and if the redcoats come this way we shall
+have to go. It's been a good thing we've stayed, though, for Captain
+Nealey is upstairs and he's almost as badly wounded as this poor man is.
+Oh, it's horrible, horrible!"
+
+But intense as Mary's feelings were, they did not prevent her from
+bestowing a very tender care upon the unconscious young lieutenant, and
+as soon as Tom was satisfied that his friend was receiving better
+nursing than he could give, the lad went out of the room.
+
+He discovered Nathan bathing his face and hands near the water-barrel,
+which stood beneath the corner of the eaves, and after he had followed
+his example, he began to be sensible of his own feeling of exhaustion.
+
+"Now, Friend Thomas, thee must lie down and get some sleep," said
+Nathan. "I will assist Mary in her care of thy friend, and I insist
+that my words he obeyed. The heavy task has been thine, and my own
+cowardice has added to thy burdens, so that now it is thy turn to rest."
+
+The tired lad was easily persuaded, and after again going into the room
+in which the unconscious lieutenant was lying, he followed Mr. Cook up
+the stairs to a room above, and soon threw himself heavily upon the bed
+and fell into a deep sleep.
+
+It was dark when he awoke, and at first it was almost impossible for him
+to recall the events of the day. They soon returned, however, and
+hastily arising, he made his way down the stairs and entered the
+living-room, where he discovered Nathan seated in one of the large
+wooden chairs. The moonlight came in through the open windows, and as
+Nathan perceived the lad, he said,--
+
+"And did sleep come to thee, Friend Thomas?"
+
+"Yes. I'm rested now. How's the lieutenant?"
+
+"There has been no change. Mary comes every hour and bathes his face in
+cool water from the well, but he does not open his eyes."
+
+"Is the battle ended? I don't hear any guns."
+
+"I know not. Since sunset all has been quiet, and it is now midnight."
+
+"I'll watch now, and you go upstairs and get some sleep."
+
+"Nay. I ought not to rest after my cowardice."
+
+"Never mind that. You will do all the more if you rest awhile now."
+
+Nathan was soon persuaded, and Tom took his place as watch. He could
+hear the troubled breathing of the suffering man, but it was the only
+sound to be heard. Outside the house all was silent, and as the slow
+hours passed, the only break which came was the occasional visit of Mary
+to bathe the face of the sufferer.
+
+At daybreak, Mr. Cook brought the news of the retreat of the British,
+and great was the rejoicing in the old farmhouse when it was learned
+that at least the Americans had not suffered defeat in the battle of the
+preceding day.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon was still living, although no signs of improvement in
+his condition could be discovered. Tom speedily decided that, as he was
+not enrolled in the army, there was nothing to prevent him from
+remaining and caring for his friend. Nathan also declared that he would
+return to his aid as soon as he had gone home and explained to Rachel
+the necessity for a further absence, and the lad did not protest, for he
+thought he understood the motive which prompted the action.
+
+During the day, Mr. Cook brought the reports of the battle, the hundred
+prisoners taken, the number of the dead and wounded, and the measures
+which were being taken in the scattered farmhouses and the old
+Court-House for the care of the sufferers.
+
+Tom did not leave the house. His one thought now was of his wounded
+friend, and all that loving hearts and gentle hands could do was
+bestowed upon the suffering soldier, who as yet had not shown that he
+was aware of what was going on about him.
+
+The long day passed and the dreary night followed, but still Tom and
+Mary cared for the sufferer. Captain Nealey was said to be improving
+rapidly, but no change as yet had come in the condition of the young
+lieutenant.
+
+It was the morning of the second day, and in the early light Tom had
+gone out to the water-barrel again to bathe his face and hands. His
+heart was heavy, for apparently Lieutenant Gordon was worse, and all
+the efforts of the lad and Mary had produced no improvement in his
+condition.
+
+As Tom started to enter the house he halted upon the doorstep and looked
+up the road. A heavy farm wagon drawn by two horses was approaching, and
+as it came nearer the lad suddenly started as he thought he recognized
+the team. Surely those were Benzeor Osburn's horses. A moment later his
+suspicions were confirmed, and he knew that the lumbering wagon was his
+foster-father's.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+AMONG THE PINES
+
+
+TOM'S surprise was still further increased when he recognized one of the
+men on the seat as Little Peter, and by his side a sergeant, who was
+driving. It was Little Peter's condition, however, which quickly drew
+all of Tom's attention, for the lad was carrying one arm in a sling,
+one of his eyes was discolored, and the marks of suffering were plainly
+to be seen on his face.
+
+Tom quickly ran out into the road, and as his friend recognized him, at
+a word from him the horses stopped, and the two boys looked at each
+other for a moment as if each was trying to understand how it was that
+they both were there.
+
+"What's the matter? Were you in the battle?" said Tom, who was the first
+to speak.
+
+"No, that is, I wasn't in the battle by the Court-House. I met Fenton
+three days ago up by the old mill, and these are a few tokens of his
+regard which he left with me," said Little Peter, slightly moving his
+wounded arm as he spoke.
+
+As Tom still looked blankly at him, the lad continued, "I suppose Fenton
+thought he left me dead, and it's likely I should have died if Barzilla
+Giberson and Jacob Vannote hadn't found me. They took me up and carried
+me over to Benzeor's, though I didn't know anything about it at the
+time. Sarah and her mother took such good care of me that I'm all right
+now, or at least I'm a good deal better."
+
+"You don't look as if you ought to be here," replied Tom. "You say
+Barzilla and Jacob found you and took you over to Benzeor's? I don't
+understand."
+
+"They're all right; I understand just how it is now."
+
+"What, Benzeor all right?"
+
+"No, Barzilla and Jacob. I know all about Benzeor, too," he added in a
+low voice.
+
+"Where is he?"
+
+"He hasn't been seen or heard from in four days. I don't think he'll
+come home again very soon. Tom, Sarah wanted me to tell you, if I saw
+you, that you were to come home just as soon as you could. I think she
+wants to explain something to you," he added, noting Tom's expression of
+surprise. "Since she's found out about Benzeor she feels all broken up,
+and wants you to come home."
+
+"Then she knows about Benzeor, does she?" inquired Tom thoughtfully.
+
+"Yes, and so do I. You'll go, won't you?"
+
+"I can't now; perhaps I will after a while," and Tom went on to explain
+the circumstances which seemed to make his return to Benzeor's
+impossible for a time.
+
+"But how does it happen that you are here so early in the morning, and
+with Benzeor's team? You're almost the last person I expected to see."
+
+"Oh, the way of it is like this. Barzilla and Jacob and some of the
+Whigs have been on the track of Fenton for several days now. We've got
+word that he's down in the pines, about two miles below Blue Ball.
+Several parties are out after him, for they've made up their minds to
+rid Old Monmouth of the outlaw, if such a thing can be done. Well,
+Barzilla came up to Benzeor's yesterday, and when he found I was all
+right again, he suggested that Ted and I report the matter to some of
+the officers in the American army, and get a detachment to go down
+there, so that's what we've done, you see."
+
+"No, I don't see," replied Tom, looking about for the detachment of
+soldiers of which Little Peter had spoken. "Ted? Ted who?"
+
+"Ted Wilson, if you please," said that worthy, suddenly rising from
+beneath the straw with which the wagon-box was apparently filled. "I'm
+the Ted what Little Peter means. Yes, sir, I'm on the lookout for those
+fellows that go around hangin' Sallies. She's my wife, ye know."
+
+Startled as Tom was by the unexpected appearance of the mighty Ted, he
+nevertheless was compelled to laugh, as the huge man stood before him
+striving to shake himself free from the bits of straw which covered his
+face, and shaking his fist at imaginary Fentons, who went about engaged
+in the detestable occupation of "hanging Sallies."
+
+"We saw General Lee yesterday, but he had so much trouble of his own
+that he couldn't listen much to ours," explained Little Peter, "but he
+managed to give us a sergeant and two men. The sergeant here is driving,
+and the men are with Ted under the straw."
+
+Tom's first thought was to inquire concerning the trouble of General
+Lee, which Little Peter referred to, but Ted interrupted his question by
+declaring, "Yes, sir, I've got two companions in my misery, cooped up
+here under the straw. I don't see why they don't let us sit up straight
+like men; but no, they must cover us all over with straw, and then put
+two or three barrels in the wagon-box too. 'Tisn't my way o' doin'
+things, for I'd take Jesh and go straight down to the pines and hang
+Fenton on the first tree I found. That's the way I'd do it. But I
+suppose I'll have to obey orders."
+
+"That's what you will," said the sergeant, who had been manifesting
+signs of impatience for several minutes. "We mustn't stand here in the
+road talking all day. Lie down, Ted, and we'll cover you up again."
+
+Reluctantly the huge man consented, and was soon hidden from sight by
+the straw which was thrown over him. The barrels were again arranged to
+present the appearance of an ordinary load, and then the sergeant,
+picking up the reins which were lying loose in his hands, spoke to the
+horses and started down the road.
+
+Little Peter turned and watched Tom, who had remained by the roadside,
+gazing eagerly after the departing wagon, and when at last he could see
+him no longer, once more gave all his thought to the dangerous
+expedition on which he had started with his companions.
+
+Benzeor's horses were in much better condition than those of his
+neighbors, for reasons that are apparent now to all our readers, and
+they maintained so steady a pace that by noontime the party had entered
+within the borders of the pines.
+
+The road here became rough and heavy, and the progress, as a
+consequence, was correspondingly slow. The tall stately trees, the
+whisperings of the wind, the silence of the great forest, and above all,
+the knowledge that they had entered upon the most dangerous portion of
+their journey, made all the men in the wagon anxious and watchful. Not a
+word was spoken now, even Ted having ceased to complain of his narrow
+quarters, and having no remarks to make concerning the outlaws, whose
+disposition led them to go about the country attacking defenseless men
+and "hanging Sallies."
+
+Every tree might conceal an enemy, and at any moment the discharge of a
+gun might indicate that their presence had been discovered. The
+habitations of men had been left behind them soon after they had entered
+the sombre forests, and the few rude little shanties near the border,
+occupied by negroes and people whose reputation in Old Monmouth was not
+of the best, had all been passed. The vegetation was scanty, and long
+barren stretches of sand could be seen on every side. The sunlight only
+penetrated the gloom in places, and its presence served to increase the
+dark and sombre appearance of the unbroken forest.
+
+Little Peter maintained a careful watch upon one side as they advanced,
+and the sergeant watched the other, but they seldom spoke now, and then
+only in whispers. The full sense of the danger of entering a region,
+known to be used by the pine robbers as their headquarters, was
+appreciated as it had not been when they started. They had no means of
+knowing how many men Fenton might have with him, and hard as the outlaws
+were against the defenseless people of Old Monmouth, doubtless they
+would display the honor which it is said thieves maintain toward one
+another, and if others should be within hailing distance when Fenton was
+attacked they would all quickly rally to his assistance.
+
+And the resistance which Fenton himself would be likely to make was not
+forgotten. The vision of him, as he suddenly appeared to Little Peter on
+that lonely road to the old mill a few days previous to this time, came
+up before the lad now. His big and burly frame, his bared and powerful
+arms, the brutal and merciless expression upon his evil face, were all
+seen again, and the lad shuddered as he recalled his experiences with
+him.
+
+"What's wrong?" whispered the sergeant quickly. "See anything?"
+
+"Not yet."
+
+Little Peter had not been in the region since the breaking out of the
+war, although before that time he and Tom had made frequent visits
+there. Still, he recognized the locality, and knew the place to which
+Barzilla had reported that Fenton had gone. It was a rude log house,
+built of the pine-trees, and could not be more than two miles in advance
+of them.
+
+The horses were toiling now as they dragged the heavy wagon through the
+deep sand. Fish-hawks had their nests in the tops of the lofty trees,
+and occasionally Peter obtained a glimpse of the great birds as they
+sailed in the air far above him. A brown rabbit now and then came forth
+from his burrow, and after eying the intruders a moment, would go
+bounding away into the thickets, or else dart swiftly back into his
+underground home. The note of a wood-thrush now and again broke in upon
+the stillness with its clear, sweet whistle, and the watchful men would
+glance quickly about them, almost thinking that the sound was the call
+of the pine robbers to one another.
+
+Little Peter's fear and the pain he was suffering from his recent
+encounter with Fenton made his face pale, and as the sergeant again
+turned to him and marked his appearance, he said, "'T was too bad, my
+lad, that you had to come."
+
+"I knew the way. I had to come and show you."
+
+"Yes, yes. I know it, but it's hard, for all that."
+
+"We're almost there now. The place can't be more than a quarter of a
+mile farther on."
+
+The sergeant did not reply, but turned quickly at the words, and peered
+keenly into the forest before him. No one could be seen, and the tall
+trees guarded well their secret. The toiling horses were pulling
+steadily on their load, and they, at least, felt no alarm; but Little
+Peter and his companion were anxious now, and were keeping their eyes
+steadily fixed upon the road before them.
+
+"There! That's the place!" whispered the lad excitedly, as he obtained a
+glimpse of a little clearing not far in advance of them.
+
+The sergeant did not reply, but he tightened his grasp upon the reins,
+and glanced down at the gun which he had placed within easy reach.
+Little Peter's excitement had become intense, and he was peering eagerly
+ahead of him, while his breathing was quick and hard. They would soon
+know what the result of the expedition was to be.
+
+The heavy wagon came out into the clearing, and drew near to the one
+small house, which was standing within it. The house was of logs, and
+corresponded exactly to the description which Barzilla had given of it.
+As yet, no human being had been seen, and the sergeant was just about to
+declare that the place was not inhabited when the door was suddenly
+opened and a man stepped forth to view. Evidently he had heard the
+sounds of the approaching wagon, and had come out to investigate.
+
+He was a tall, broad-shouldered, powerful-appearing man. He was clad in
+a pair of rough trousers and high boots, which looked as if they might
+have belonged to some Hessian dragoon at one time, and the red flannel
+shirt which partially covered his chest could not entirely conceal the
+great bunches of muscle there. In one hand he grasped a pistol, and the
+expression upon his face might well have caused a man with a much
+stouter heart than Little Peter had to tremble.
+
+The sergeant glanced inquiringly at the lad by his side, and Little
+Peter nodded his head in reply to the unspoken question. The man was
+Fenton himself,--the one who had robbed the widows and the fatherless,
+had made the midnight attacks upon the defenseless people of Old
+Monmouth, had hanged trembling women from the limbs of trees, and
+tortured his helpless victims into revealing the places where their
+scanty savings had been concealed. He had been the leader of bands as
+desperate and wicked as himself, and the suffering and woe which the
+good people of the surrounding region had experienced at his hands can
+never be told. And now the man himself stood waiting for the wagon, in
+which were Little Peter, himself a victim of the pine robbers' cruelty,
+and his companions, to approach.
+
+"Hold on!" called Fenton. "You're movin' too fast. What ye doin' here?"
+
+The sergeant stopped his horses, and as Fenton approached and stood near
+the wheel, he said, "We've come down here to look for a man we want to
+find."
+
+"I reckon I'll do as well as any other. Look at me! Ye're not goin' any
+farther, ye might as well understand that now as any time. Got a bottle
+with ye?"
+
+The sergeant drew forth a bottle of brandy and handed it to the outlaw.
+Fenton took it, and raised one foot upon the hub of the wheel. As he
+lifted the bottle to his lips, his eyes fell upon Little Peter, who had
+been endeavoring to conceal himself behind his companion.
+
+Instantly recognizing the lad, he shouted, "You here? You? I thought I
+left ye dead up by the mill the other day! You rascal! One whipping
+wasn't enough, was it? I'll give ye what ye deserve now!"
+
+Fenton reached back with one hand to grasp the pistol he had thrust into
+his pocket when he had taken the bottle. Quickly the sergeant kicked the
+foot of Ted Wilson under the straw, and instantly the men arose, and
+before Fenton could act, had brought their guns to their shoulders and
+the reports rang out together.
+
+The pine robber pitched heavily forward, and lay dead upon the sand. Oh,
+it was horrible, awful! A sensation of sickness, of faintness, swept
+over Little Peter as he looked down upon the face of the dead outlaw.
+
+"What's that? What's that?" said Ted quickly.
+
+It was the sound of a gun not far away. It might be the answer of other
+bands of pine robbers to the volley which had just been fired; and
+hurriedly throwing the body of Fenton into the wagon, the sergeant
+turned his horses about and started swiftly back up the road.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+CONCLUSION
+
+
+IN spite of the heavy sand the horses were driven swiftly, until their
+heaving sides and dripping flanks compelled their driver to give them a
+much-needed rest. Ted Wilson and one of the soldiers then leaped lightly
+to the ground and ran into the woods on either side of the road to
+ascertain whether they were pursued or not.
+
+As the silence of the great forest was unbroken they speedily returned,
+and the flight was resumed. No one was concealed beneath the straw in
+the wagon-box now, and every one stood waiting and ready to share in the
+defense which at any moment might become necessary.
+
+On past the tall pine-trees, on through the heavy sandy road, rushed the
+returning party, and at last, when they obtained a glimpse of the open
+country, they breathed a sigh of relief as they realized that the danger
+of immediate pursuit was gone. It was not until nearly a year after
+this time that they learned that the gun they had heard had been
+discharged by De Bow, the desperate leader of another band of outlaws as
+evil in every way as those whom the detested Fenton had himself led.
+
+It was near the close of the day when the party, of which Little Peter
+was a member, drove up to Monmouth Court-House. Carelessly, almost
+brutally, the sergeant and one of his companions seized the body of the
+dead outlaw, and flinging it from the wagon into one of the trenches the
+soldiers had made, shouted, "Here's a cordial for your tories and wood
+robbers!"
+
+Little Peter had no share in the rejoicing which followed when it was
+known that the pine robber was no more. It was true, he knew Fenton had
+richly deserved his fate, and that no more would the defenseless people
+of Old Monmouth suffer from the evil deeds of his marauding band. He,
+too, had known something of Fenton's wickedness, for he was motherless,
+homeless, and almost fatherless because of him, and his own body for
+many days bore the traces of his meeting with him on his return from the
+mill; but in spite of all that, his heart was sick whenever he thought
+of the dead face he had seen looking up at him from the wagon-box, and
+the brutal rejoicings of the men who had shot him near his abode among
+the pines.
+
+On the following day Tom Coward returned to Benzeor's house for a brief
+visit, reporting a very decided improvement in the condition of young
+Lieutenant Gordon. A long interview between Tom and Sarah followed, and
+as the troubled girl explained to the lad what she had learned
+concerning the evil deeds of her own father, and begged him to return
+and aid her in caring for the family in the presence of such dangers and
+perplexities, Tom could not find it in his heart to refuse. The kindness
+bestowed upon him in the home, and the obligations to repay as best he
+could the care he himself had received there, were too strong to be
+ignored, and greatly to the joy of Sarah and her mother he yielded to
+their urgent pleas. He had not yet enlisted in the army, and so was free
+to decide the question for himself.
+
+He was aided in making the decision by the fact that Little Peter was
+also to remain. His own home had been destroyed, and as there was no
+place to which he could take his little brothers and sisters, there was
+every reason why he should accept the invitation and increase the
+defenses of the household.
+
+It was not considered probable that Benzeor would return, nor was it
+known what had become of the man, who had gradually and yet steadily
+been drawn into the power of the pine robbers, until at last he was
+considered by them all as one of themselves, and indeed he was. Neither
+the boys nor Sarah knew then whither he had gone. Tom thought he might
+have been killed in the battle, and it was not until more than a year
+had passed that word came from the missing Benzeor; but where he had
+been and what he had been doing do not belong to this story.
+
+On the day following the great battle of Monmouth, General Lee had, to a
+certain extent, recovered from his chagrin at the public rebuke General
+Washington had administered to him, and in his arrogance, and as a
+relief to his feeling of mortification, he wrote a childish letter to
+the commander, demanding an apology for the words he had spoken in the
+presence of the soldiers.
+
+Washington's reply to Lee's letter was as follows:--
+
+"SIR,--I received your letter, expressed, as I conceive, in terms highly
+improper. I am not conscious of making use of any very singular
+expressions, at the time of meeting you, as you intimate. What I
+recollect to have said was dictated by duty and warranted by the
+occasion. As soon as circumstances will permit, you shall have an
+opportunity of justifying yourself to the army, to Congress, to America,
+and to the world in general; or of convincing them that you were guilty
+of a breach of orders, and of misbehavior before the enemy on the 28th
+instant, in not attacking them as you had been directed, and in making
+an unnecessary, disorderly, and shameful retreat."
+
+Lee's reply to this letter, as impudent as it was childish, certainly
+did not tend to elevate him in the estimation of the men of his own
+time, or of ours. His letter was as follows: "You cannot afford me
+greater pleasure than in giving me the opportunity of showing to America
+the sufficiency of her respective servants. I trust that temporary power
+of office, and the tinsel dignity attending it, will not be able, by all
+the mists they can raise, to obfuscate the bright rays of truth."
+
+Washington's reply to this insulting letter was to arrest Lee. The
+traitor was at once court-martialed and charged with disobedience of
+orders, misbehavior on the field, making a disgraceful retreat, and also
+with gross disrespect to his commander-in-chief. The trial lasted more
+than a month, and the result was that Lee was suspended for the term of
+one year. If strict justice had been measured out to the man, doubtless
+he would not have escaped with so light a sentence; but Washington was
+merciful, and although Lee did not appreciate the kindness shown him, he
+owed his life to the man whose heart and mind were so much greater than
+his own.
+
+General Washington did not long delay in Old Monmouth after the battle.
+The British army had gained New York, and so the American commander
+moved to the Hudson, and on the 20th of July went into camp at White
+Plains, having left some of the militia to look well to the needs of the
+country in which the great battle had been fought.
+
+And Monmouth was a great battle. Not only did the men struggle with a
+determination such as has been seldom displayed, but the results of the
+engagement itself were also marked and strong. While the two armies,
+after Washington had gone to the Hudson and Clinton to New York,
+occupied much the same relative positions as in the latter part of '76,
+the motives which controlled each were exactly reversed. The Americans
+now became the aggressors, and the British were compelled to defend
+themselves.
+
+All this was intensified by the action of France. Benjamin Franklin had
+succeeded in arranging a treaty between that land and ours. France was
+to send a fleet of sixteen war vessels under D'Estaing to our shores,
+and also an army of four thousand men. It was the coming of this fleet
+which, as we know, caused the British to depart from Philadelphia and
+hasten to the defense of New York, which place they thought would be
+first attacked. The march of the redcoats and Hessians across New Jersey
+gave Washington an opportunity to pursue them, and while he failed in
+accomplishing all that he hoped, and much that he might have done had it
+not been for the treacherous actions of Lee, still he virtually had won
+a victory. He compelled the British to retreat with great losses, he
+strengthened his own position, he silenced his enemies in Congress, and,
+above all, he aroused a new feeling of hope and determination in the
+hearts of the struggling Americans.
+
+The British very promptly declared war against France, and then coolly
+invited the Americans to join them, promising all that the colonists had
+asked three years before this time. The offer had come too late,
+however, for now the colonies had become States, and independence had
+been declared, and independence the new nation would have. So the war
+was continued, but the part which the new allies took and the further
+struggles of the determined Americans belong to another story.
+
+It only remains to refer briefly to the experiences of our friends,
+whose fortunes we have followed in the course of this book.
+
+Lieutenant Gordon at last recovered from his wound. Tom Coward divided
+his time between caring for his friend and the labor on Benzeor's farm.
+In the former task he was aided by Friend Nathan Brown until such a time
+as the young lieutenant could be removed to his own home.
+
+Friend Nathan had been unable to remain away from the battle of
+Monmouth, and while both his feelings and professions had prevented him
+from entering into the struggle, still his interest had been so intense
+that he had started from his home to the scene of the struggle. There he
+met Tom, and the part he then took in caring for the wounded young
+officer we already know.
+
+Neither Tom nor Little Peter was idle. There was much work to be done on
+both farms, and the lads aided each other. The crop on the ten-acre lot
+was successfully grown and harvested, and the immediate problem of food
+in Benzeor's household was in a measure solved.
+
+Indian John was never seen by our boys again. Whether he had been slain
+by the British or the pine robbers, or had departed from the homes of
+his ancestors for a region into which the redcoats and buffcoats did not
+enter, was never known. Both Tom and Little Peter were inclined to the
+latter conclusion, however, and their opinion was strengthened by the
+fact that "Charlie" Moluss, and his wife Bathsheba, and her sister
+"Suke" were never seen or heard from again.
+
+Several times the boys made their way into Indian John's cave by the
+brook, but they never discovered any signs of their friend. He had
+forever disappeared, but his stories concerning the origin of the Jersey
+mosquitoes, his interpretations of the roar of the ocean and the calls
+of the sea-birds, and above all the assistance he had rendered Little
+Peter in the trying days of '78 were never forgotten.
+
+Weeks had passed before Little Peter positively learned that Benzeor's
+statement concerning his father had been correct, but at last he
+received definite information that he was a prisoner in New York. What
+that meant to the troubled lad, few of us to-day can understand. The
+sufferings on board the prison-ships and in the prison-houses of New
+York almost baffle description; but we may be sure of one thing, and
+that is that Little Peter did not sit idly down, nor rest content to
+leave his father where he was without making some efforts in his behalf.
+But that, too, belongs to another record.
+
+Barzilla Giberson and Jacob Vannote after the death of Fenton did not
+find it necessary to play a double part. They believed that their
+efforts to run the pine robbers to cover had been successful, and that
+now they could boldly and openly take their stand on the side of the
+patriots. And take that stand they did, and their services in the New
+Jersey militia are known in all the region of Old Monmouth.
+
+Ted Wilson, with Jeshurun "waxen fatter" and consequently still more
+inclined to kick, returned to his home after the death of Fenton. He
+found Sallie and the babies safe at the Dennises, but all of the mighty
+Ted's former indifference as to his rulers had departed. The taste of
+the struggle he had had seemed only to whet his appetite for more, and
+not many days had passed before Ted and Jeshurun once more started forth
+in quest of service and adventure.
+
+Sarah Osburn labored faithfully and cheerfully for the welfare of her
+enlarged household, and the boys did not fail to appreciate her
+kindness. Tom thought he understood the motive which prompted much of
+her care for Little Peter's younger brothers and sisters, but throughout
+the long absence of Benzeor he never directly or indirectly referred to
+it.
+
+There was a brief lull in the outrages and attacks of the pine robbers
+after the death of Fenton, but it was very brief. Stephen Burke (or
+Stephen Emmons as he was sometimes called), Stephen West, Ezekiel
+Williams, Jonathan West, Richard Bird, Davenport, De Bow, and others
+were yet living, and as each was the leader of a band as desperate as
+himself, and as all were as reckless and brave as Fenton had been, in a
+brief time the suffering people of Old Monmouth found that their
+troubles were by no means ended.
+
+Redcoat and buffcoat were again to contend within their borders,
+salt-works and houses were to be burned, gunboats were to anchor off her
+shore and their crews were to engage in conflicts with the patriots;
+whigs and tories were not yet reconciled, the pine robbers were not yet
+subdued. Five long and terrible years of the struggle of the Revolution
+were yet to come, and the sands of Old Monmouth were again and again to
+be dyed by the blood of fallen men.
+
+The waves which came creeping, crawling up the long sandy shore, the
+tall pine-trees whose tops whispered together as they bent beneath the
+summer winds and winter storms, the fertile plains and noble forests of
+oak and chestnut, were unchanged; but the struggling men and women of
+Old Monmouth were yet to endure the bitter hardships and fierce
+contests, which the closing days of the Revolution brought to them in
+greater numbers than to almost any other people of our land.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Transcriber's Notes:
+
+Obvious punctuation errors repaired.
+
+Page 260, "Webberley" changed to "Webberly" (And Webberly had taught)
+
+Page 404, "did't" changed to "didn't" (didn't know anything)
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's The Boys of Old Monmouth, by Everett T. Tomlinson
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE BOYS OF OLD MONMOUTH ***
+
+***** This file should be named 34864.txt or 34864.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/3/4/8/6/34864/
+
+Produced by Emmy, Juliet Sutherland and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/34864.zip b/34864.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5ffafbf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/34864.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1787115
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #34864 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/34864)